Motor Protection System: Grid Solutions
Motor Protection System: Grid Solutions
Motor Protection System: Grid Solutions
Grid Solutions
M60
Motor Protection System
Instruction Manual
Product version: 8.2x
GE publication code: 1601-0108-AL2
E83849
S T ER
GI
ED
RE
ISO 9001
LISTED
G
E
IN
M U LT I L
IND.CONT. EQ.
52TL
1601-0108-AL2
Copyright © 2021 GE Multilin. All rights reserved.
M60 Motor Protection System Instruction Manual for version 8.2x.
M60, FlexLogic, FlexElement, FlexCurve, FlexAnalog, FlexInteger, FlexState, EnerVista,
CyberSentry, HardFiber, Universal Relay, Multilin, and GE Multilin are trademarks or
registered trademarks of GE Multilin or General Electric Company Corporation.
The contents of this manual are the property of GE Multilin. This documentation is
furnished on license and may not be reproduced in whole or in part without the permission
of GE Multilin. The content of this manual is for informational use only and is subject to
change without notice.
Part number: 1601-0108-AL2 (July 2021)
M60 Motor Protection System
Table of contents
6.7 Records...................................................................................................................6-29
6.7.1 User programmable fault reports.............................................................................. 6-29
6.7.2 Motor start ............................................................................................................................ 6-29
6.7.3 Motor learned data ........................................................................................................... 6-30
6.7.4 Event records ....................................................................................................................... 6-32
6.7.5 Oscillography....................................................................................................................... 6-33
6.7.6 Data logger ........................................................................................................................... 6-34
6.7.7 Breaker maintenance ...................................................................................................... 6-34
6.8 Product information.............................................................................................6-35
6.8.1 Model information ............................................................................................................. 6-35
6.8.2 Firmware revisions ............................................................................................................ 6-36
ABBREVIATIONS
INDEX
Chapter 1: Introduction
Introduction
Indicates a hazardous situation which, if not avoided, will result in death or serious injury.
Indicates a hazardous situation which, if not avoided, could result in death or serious injury.
Indicates a hazardous situation which, if not avoided, could result in minor or moderate injury.
Ensure that all connections to the product are correct so as to avoid accidental risk of shock
and/or fire, for example such as can arise from high voltage connected to low voltage terminals.
Follow the requirements of this manual, including adequate wiring size and type, terminal torque settings, voltage,
current magnitudes applied, and adequate isolation/clearance in external wiring from high to low voltage circuits.
Use the device only for its intended purpose and application.
Ensure that all ground paths are uncompromised for safety purposes during device operation and service.
Ensure that the control power applied to the device, the alternating current (AC), and voltage input match the ratings
specified on the relay nameplate. Do not apply current or voltage in excess of the specified limits.
Only qualified personnel are to operate the device. Such personnel must be thoroughly familiar with all safety
cautions and warnings in this manual and with applicable country, regional, utility, and plant safety regulations.
1 Hazardous voltages can exist in the power supply and at the device connection to current transformers, voltage
transformers, control, and test circuit terminals. Make sure all sources of such voltages are isolated prior to
attempting work on the device.
Hazardous voltages can exist when opening the secondary circuits of live current transformers. Make sure that
current transformer secondary circuits are shorted out before making or removing any connection to the current
transformer (CT) input terminals of the device.
For tests with secondary test equipment, ensure that no other sources of voltages or currents are connected to such
equipment and that trip and close commands to the circuit breakers or other switching apparatus are isolated,
unless this is required by the test procedure and is specified by appropriate utility/plant procedure.
When the device is used to control primary equipment, such as circuit breakers, isolators, and other switching
apparatus, all control circuits from the device to the primary equipment must be isolated while personnel are working
on or around this primary equipment to prevent any inadvertent command from this device.
Use an external disconnect to isolate the mains voltage supply.
Personal safety can be affected if the product is physically modified by the end user. Modifications to the product
outside of recommended wiring configuration, hardware, or programming boundaries is not recommended end-use
practice. Product disassembly and repairs are not permitted. All service needs to be conducted by the factory.
LED transmitters are classified as IEC 60825-1 Accessible Emission Limit (AEL) Class 1M. Class 1M
devices are considered safe to the unaided eye. Do not view directly with optical instruments.
This product is rated to Class A emissions levels and is to be used in Utility, Substation Industrial
environments. Not to be used near electronic devices rated for Class B levels.
Product description
port supports IEC 61850, Modbus/TCP, TFTP, and PTP (according to IEEE Std. 1588-2008 or IEC 61588), and it allows access
to the relay via any standard web browser (M60 web pages). The IEC 60870-5-104 protocol is supported on the Ethernet
port. The Ethernet port also supports the Parallel Redundancy Protocol (PRP) of IEC 62439-3 (clause 4, 2012) when
purchased as an option.
GOOSE and secure Routable GOOSE (R-GOOSE) are supported with software options. Process Bus GOOSE is supported with
a hardware module and software options.
With a Process Bus Module that supports IEC 61850-9-2LE and IEC 61869, PRP is supported on two Ethernet ports to IEC
2 62439, and High-availability Seamless Redundancy (HSR) is supported on four Ethernet ports for dual HSR ring
architecture.
The EnerVista UR Setup software suite contains an automatic configurator for motor starting settings. The configurator
automatically populates settings and operands for input relays, output relays, trip bus, AC inputs, and signal sources
based on user requirements and the relay features.
Settings and actual values are accessible from the front panel and the EnerVista software.
The M60 uses flash memory technology that allows field upgrading as new features are added. Firmware and software
are upgradable.
The following single-line diagram illustrates the relay functionality using American National Standards Institute (ANSI)
device numbers.
Table 2-1: ANSI device numbers and functions supported
Device number Function Device number Function
27P Phase Undervoltage 51N Neutral Time Overcurrent
27X Auxiliary Undervoltage 51P Phase Time Overcurrent
32 Sensitive Directional Power 59N Neutral Overvoltage
37 Undercurrent 59P Phase Overvoltage
37P Underpower 59X Auxiliary Overvoltage
46 Current Unbalance 59_2 Negative Sequence Overvoltage
47 Phase Sequence Voltage 66 Starts Per Hour, Time Between Starts
49 Thermal Model 67N Neutral Directional Overcurrent
50BF Breaker Failure 67P Phase Directional Overcurrent
50G Ground Instantaneous Overcurrent 81O Overfrequency
50N Neutral Instantaneous Overcurrent 81U Underfrequency
50P Phase Instantaneous Overcurrent 87S Stator Differential
51G Ground Time Overcurrent --- Mechanical Jam
52
Trip Close 59N 59P 27P 59_2 47 81O 81U
2
50G 51G
M
RTD
Metering
87S
2.2 Security
The following security features are available:
• Password security — Basic security present by default
• EnerVista security — Role-based access to various EnerVista software screens and configuration elements. The
feature is present by default in the EnerVista software.
• CyberSentry security — Advanced security available using a software option. When purchased, the option is enabled
automatically, and the default Password security and EnerVista security are disabled.
To maximize security, see the UR Family Secure Deployment Guide.
based strong cryptography for authentication and credential protection. In other words, this option uses a RADIUS
server for user authentication.
• A Role-Based Access Control (RBAC) system that provides a permission model that allows access to UR device
operations and configurations based on specific roles and individual user accounts configured on the AAA server.
That is, Administrator, Supervisor, Engineer, Operator, and Observer roles are used.
• Security event reporting through the Syslog protocol for supporting Security Information Event Management (SIEM)
systems for centralized cybersecurity monitoring
• Strong encryption of all access and configuration network messages between the EnerVista software and UR devices
using the Secure Shell (SSH) protocol, the Advanced Encryption Standard (AES), and 128-bit keys in Galois Counter
2
Mode (GCM) as specified in the U.S. National Security Agency Suite B extension for SSH and approved by the National
Institute of Standards and Technology (NIST) FIPS-140-2 standards for cryptographic systems
Administrator
Engineer
Operator
Observer Supervisor
842838A2.CDR
Table Notes:
RW = read and write access
R = read access
Supervisor = RW (default), Administrator = R (default), Administrator = RW (only if Supervisor role is disabled)
NA = the permission is not enforced by CyberSentry security
The M60 is available as a 19-inch rack horizontal mount or reduced-size (¾) vertical unit. It consists of the following
modules: power supply, CPU, CT/VT, contact input and output, transducer input and output, and inter-relay
communications. Module options are specified at the time of ordering.
The order codes shown here are subject to change without notice. See the web page for the product for the latest options.
The letters in the top row of the table correspond to slots in the UR chassis, for example slot F, H, or U.
The R-GOOSE protocol described in IEC 61850-8-1 is available through the IEC 61850 software option. R-GOOSE
2 security requires the CyberSentry software option.
Process Bus GOOSE requires an IEC 61850-9-2LE / IEC 61869 Process Bus Module, as well as IEC 61850, PRP, and
IEEE 1588 software options.
For Japanese, the settings display in Japanese on the graphical front panel, while the keys printed on the panel are
in English.
2 7C
7D
7F
7G
7C 1300 nm, single-mode, ELED, 1 Channel
7D 1300 nm, single-mode, Laser, 1 Channel
7F Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, multimode
7G Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode ELED
7H 7H 820 nm, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
7I 7I 1300 nm, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
7J 7J 1300 nm, single-mode, ELED, 2 Channels
7K 7K 1300 nm, single-mode, Laser, 2 Channels
7M 7M Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, multimode, LED
7N 7N Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode, ELED
7P 7P Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode, Laser
7Q 7Q Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode Laser
7R 7R G.703, 1 Channel
7S 7S G.703, 2 Channels
7T 7T RS422, 1 Channel
7W 7W RS422, 2 Channels
M60 - * ** - * * * - F ** - H ** - M ** - P/R ** Reduced Size Vertical Mount (see note regarding P/R slot below)
GU | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + Rotor broken bar + IEC 61850
GV | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + Rotor broken bar + Ethernet Global Data (EGD) + IEC 61850
J0 | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103
J1 | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + EGD
J3 | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + IEC 61850
J4 | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + EGD + IEC 61850
JS | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + Rotor broken bar
JT | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + Rotor broken bar + EGD
JU | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + Rotor broken bar + IEC 61850
JV | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + Rotor broken bar + EGD + IEC 61850
K0 | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + PRP + IEC 60870-5-103
K1 | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + PRP + IEC 60870-5-103 + EGD
K3 | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + PRP + IEC 60870-5-103 + IEC 61850
2
K4 | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + PRP + IEC 60870-5-103 + EGD + IEC 61850
KS | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + PRP + IEC 60870-5-103 + Rotor broken bar
KT | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + PRP + IEC 60870-5-103 + Rotor broken bar + EGD
KU | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + PRP + IEC 60870-5-103 + Rotor broken bar + IEC 61850
KV | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + PRP + IEC 60870-5-103 + Rotor broken bar + EGD + IEC 61850
L0 | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + IEEE 1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1
L1 | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + IEEE 1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + EGD
L3 | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + IEEE 1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + IEC 61850
L4 | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + IEEE 1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + EGD + IEC 61850
LS | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + IEEE 1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + Rotor broken bar
LT | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + IEEE 1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + Rotor broken bar + EGD
LU | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + IEEE 1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + Rotor broken bar + IEC 61850
LV | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + IEEE 1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + Rotor broken bar + EGD + IEC 61850
MOUNT/COATING V | | | | | | Vertical (3/4 rack)
B | | | | | | Vertical (3/4 rack) with harsh environmental coating
FRONT PANEL + INTERFACE F | | | | | English display
D | | | | | French display
R | | | | | Russian display
K | | | | | Enhanced front panel with English display
M | | | | | Enhanced front panel with French display
Q | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Russian display
U | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Chinese display
L | | | | | Enhanced front panel with English display and user-programmable pushbuttons
N | | | | | Enhanced front panel with French display and user-programmable pushbuttons
T | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Russian display and user-programmable pushbuttons
V | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Chinese display and user-programmable pushbuttons
W | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Turkish display
Y | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Turkish display and user-programmable pushbuttons
I | | | | | Enhanced front panel with German display
J | | | | | Enhanced front panel with German display and user-programmable pushbuttons
POWER SUPPLY H | | | | 125 / 250 V AC/DC power supply
L | | | | 24 to 48 V (DC only) power supply
CT/VT DSP | | XX | No DSP module
8L | 8L | Standard 4CT/4VT with enhanced diagnostics
8M | 8M | Sensitive Ground 4CT/4VT with enhanced diagnostics
8N | 8N | Standard 8CT with enhanced diagnostics
8R | 8R | Sensitive Ground 8CT with enhanced diagnostics
CONTACT INPUTS/OUTPUTS XX XX XX No module
4A 4A 4A 4 Solid-State (no monitoring) MOSFET outputs
4B 4B 4B 4 Solid-State (voltage with optional current) MOSFET outputs
4C 4C 4C 4 Solid-State (current with optional voltage) MOSFET outputs
4D 4D 4D 16 Contact inputs with Auto-Burnishing (maximum of three modules within a case)
4L 4L 4L 14 Form-A (no monitoring) Latching outputs
67 67 67 8 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs
6A 6A 6A 2 Form-A (voltage with optional current) and 2 Form-C outputs, 8 contact inputs
6B 6B 6B 2 Form-A (voltage with optional current) and 4 Form-C outputs, 4 contact inputs
6C 6C 6C 8 Form-C outputs
6D 6D 6D 16 Contact inputs
6E 6E 6E 4 Form-C outputs, 8 contact inputs
6F 6F 6F 8 Fast Form-C outputs
6G 6G 6G 4 Form-A (voltage with optional current) outputs, 8 contact inputs
6H 6H 6H 6 Form-A (voltage with optional current) outputs, 4 contact inputs
6K 6K 6K 4 Form-C and 4 Fast Form-C outputs
6L 6L 6L 2 Form-A (current with optional voltage) and 2 Form-C outputs, 8 contact inputs
6M 6M 6M 2 Form-A (current with optional voltage) and 4 Form-C outputs, 4 contact inputs
6N 6N 6N 4 Form-A (current with optional voltage) outputs, 8 contact inputs
6P 6P 6P 6 Form-A (current with optional voltage) outputs, 4 contact inputs
6R 6R 6R 2 Form-A (no monitoring) and 2 Form-C outputs, 8 contact inputs
6S 6S 6S 2 Form-A (no monitoring) and 4 Form-C outputs, 4 contact inputs
6T 6T 6T 4 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs, 8 contact inputs
6U 6U 6U 6 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs, 4 contact inputs
6V 6V 6V 2 Form-A outputs, 1 Form-C output, 2 Form-A (no monitoring) latching output, 8 contact inputs
6W 6W 6W 30 Contact inputs - pin terminals (max 4 modules)
6X 6X 6X 18 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs - pin terminals (max 4 modules)
TRANSDUCER INPUTS/OUTPUTS 5A 5A 5A 4 DCmA inputs, 4 DCmA outputs (only one 5A or 5D module is allowed)
(select a maximum of 3 per unit) 5C 5C 5C 8 RTD inputs
5D 5D 5D 4 RTD inputs, 4 DCmA outputs (only one 5A or 5D module is allowed)
5E 5E 5E 4 RTD inputs, 4 DCmA inputs
5F 5F 5F 8 DCmA inputs
INTER-RELAY COMMUNICATIONS 2A C37.94SM, 1300 nm single-mode, ELED, 1 channel single-mode
(select a maximum of 1 per unit) 2B C37.94SM, 1300 nm single-mode, ELED, 2 channel single-mode
For the last module, rear slot P is used for digital 2H IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, 128 kbps, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
and transducer input/output modules; rear slot R 2I Channel 1 - IEEE C37.94, MM, 64/128 kbps; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode, Laser
2J Channel 1 - IEEE C37.94, MM, 64/128 kbps; Channel 2 - 1550 nm, single-mode, Laser
is used for inter-relay communications modules. 72 1550 nm, single-mode, Laser, 1 Channel
73 1550 nm, single-mode, Laser, 2 Channel
76 IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, 64 kbps, multimode, LED, 1 Channel
77 IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, 64 kbps, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
7A 820 nm, multimode, LED, 1 Channel
7B 1300 nm, multimode, LED, 1 Channel
7C 1300 nm, single-mode, ELED, 1 Channel
7D 1300 nm, single-mode, Laser, 1 Channel
7F Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, multimode
7G Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode ELED
7H 820 nm, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
7I 1300 nm, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
7J 1300 nm, single-mode, ELED, 2 Channels
7K 1300 nm, single-mode, Laser, 2 Channels
7M Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, multimode, LED
7N Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode, ELED
M60 - * ** - * * * - F ** - H ** - M ** - P/R ** Reduced Size Vertical Mount (see note regarding P/R slot below)
7P Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode, Laser
7Q Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode Laser
7R G.703, 1 Channel
7S G.703, 2 Channels
7T RS422, 1 Channel
7W RS422, 2 Channels
2 Table 2-6: M60 order codes for horizontal units with process bus
BASE UNIT
M60
M60
- *
|
**
|
- *
|
*
|
* - F **
| |
- H **
|
- M **
|
- P **
|
- U **
|
- W/X **
|
Full Size Horizontal Mount
Base Unit
CPU T | | | | | | | | | | RS485 + three multimode fiber 100Base-FX (SFP with LC)
U | | | | | | | | | | RS485 + two multimode fiber 100Base-FX (SFP with LC) + one 10/100Base-TX (SFP
with RJ45)
V | | | | | | | | | | RS485 + three 10/100Base-TX (SFP with RJ45)
W | | | | | | | | | | RS485 + two 100Base-FX Ethernet, multimode ST + one 10/100Base-TX Ethernet,
RJ-45
SOFTWARE OPTIONS 00 | | | | | | | | | No software options
01 | | | | | | | | | Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
03 | | | | | | | | | IEC 61850
04 | | | | | | | | | Ethernet Global Data (EGD) + IEC 61850
28 | | | | | | | | | Broken rotor bar detection
29 | | | | | | | | | Broken rotor bar detection + Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
30 | | | | | | | | | Broken rotor bar detection + IEC 61850
31 | | | | | | | | | Broken rotor bar detection + Ethernet Global Data (EGD) + IEC 61850
A0 | | | | | | | | | CyberSentry Lvl 1
A1 | | | | | | | | | CyberSentry Lvl 1 + Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
A3 | | | | | | | | | CyberSentry Lvl 1 + IEC 61850
A4 | | | | | | | | | CyberSentry Lvl 1 + IEC 61850 + Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
AS | | | | | | | | | CyberSentry Lvl 1 + Broken rotor bar detection
AT | | | | | | | | | CyberSentry Lvl 1 + Broken rotor bar detection + Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
AU | | | | | | | | | CyberSentry Lvl 1 + Broken rotor bar detection + IEC 61850
AV | | | | | | | | | CyberSentry Lvl 1 + Broken rotor bar detection + IEC 61850 + Ethernet Global
Data (EGD)
B0 | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588
B1 | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
B3 | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + IEC 61850
B4 | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + IEC 61850 + Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
BS | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + Broken rotor bar detection
BT | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + Broken rotor bar detection + Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
BU | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + Broken rotor bar detection + IEC 61850
BV | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + Broken rotor bar detection + IEC 61850 + Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
C0 | | | | | | | | | Parallel Redundancy Protocol (PRP)
C1 | | | | | | | | | PRP + Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
C3 | | | | | | | | | PRP + IEC 61850
C4 | | | | | | | | | PRP + Ethernet Global Data (EGD) + IEC 61850
CS | | | | | | | | | PRP + Rotor broken bar
CT | | | | | | | | | PRP + Rotor broken bar + Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
CU | | | | | | | | | PRP + Rotor broken bar + IEC 61850
CV | | | | | | | | | PRP + Rotor broken bar + Ethernet Global Data (EGD) + IEC 61850
D0 | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + CyberSentry Lvl 1
D1 | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
D3 | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + IEC 61850
D4 | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + IEC 61850 + Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
DS | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + Broken rotor bar detection
DT | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + Broken rotor bar detection + Ethernet Global Data
(EGD)
DU | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + Broken rotor bar detection + IEC 61850
DV | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + Broken rotor bar detection + IEC 61850 + Ethernet
Global Data(EGD)
E0 | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + PRP
E1 | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + PRP + Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
E3 | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + PRP + IEC 61850
E4 | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + PRP + Ethernet Global Data (EGD) + IEC 61850
ES | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + PRP + Rotor broken bar
ET | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + PRP + Rotor broken bar + Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
EU | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + PRP + Rotor broken bar, + IEC 61850
EV | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + PRP + Rotor broken bar + Ethernet Global Data (EGD) + IEC 61850
F0 | | | | | | | | | PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1
F1 | | | | | | | | | PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
F3 | | | | | | | | | PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + IEC 61850
F4 | | | | | | | | | PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + Ethernet Global Date (EGD) + IEC 61850
FS | | | | | | | | | PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + Rotor broken bar
FT | | | | | | | | | PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + Rotor broken bar + Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
FU | | | | | | | | | PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + Rotor broken bar + IEC 61850
FV | | | | | | | | | PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + Rotor broken bar + Ethernet Global Data (EGD) + IEC
61850
G0 | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1
G1 | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
G3 | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + IEC 61850
G4 | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + Ethernet Global Data (EGD) + IEC 61850
GS | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + Rotor broken bar
GT | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + Rotor broken bar + Ethernet Global Data
(EGD)
GU | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + Rotor broken bar + IEC 61850
GV | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + Rotor broken bar + Ethernet Global Data
(EGD) + IEC 61850
J0 | | | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103
J1 | | | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + EGD
J3 | | | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + IEC 61850
J4 | | | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + EGD + IEC 61850
JS | | | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + Rotor broken bar
JT | | | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + Rotor broken bar + EGD
JU | | | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + Rotor broken bar + IEC 61850
JV | | | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + Rotor broken bar + EGD + IEC 61850
K0 | | | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + PRP + IEC 60870-5-103
2
LU | | | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + IEEE 1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + Rotor broken bar + IEC
61850
LV | | | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + IEEE 1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + Rotor broken bar + EGD
+ IEC 61850
MOUNT/COATING H | | | | | | | | Horizontal (19” rack)
A | | | | | | | | Horizontal (19” rack) with harsh environmental coating
FRONT PANEL + INTERFACE C | | | | | | | English display
D | | | | | | | French display
R | | | | | | | Russian display
P | | | | | | | English display with 4 small and 12 large programmable pushbuttons
G | | | | | | | French display with 4 small and 12 large programmable pushbuttons
S | | | | | | | Russian display with 4 small and 12 large programmable pushbuttons
K | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with English display
M | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with French display
Q | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Russian display
U | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Chinese display
L | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with English display and user-programmable pushbuttons
N | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with French display and user-programmable pushbuttons
T | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Russian display and user-programmable pushbuttons
V | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Chinese display and user-programmable pushbuttons
W | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Turkish display
Y | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Turkish display and user-programmable pushbuttons
I | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with German display
J | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with German display and user-programmable pushbuttons
H | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Polish display
O | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Polish display and user-programmable pushbuttons
E | | | | | | | 7" Graphical front panel display in multiple languages with USB front port and
programmable pushbuttons (English, French, Chinese, Russian, Turkish, German,
Polish, Japanese)
POWER SUPPLY H | | | | | | 125 / 250 V AC/DC power supply
(redundant supply must be same H | | | | | RH 125 / 250 V AC/DC with redundant 125 / 250 V AC/DC power supply
type as main supply) L | | | | | | 24 to 48 V (DC only) power supply
L | | | | | RL 24 to 48 V (DC only) with redundant 24 to 48 V DC power supply
PROCESS BUS XX 81 XX | XX | IEC 61850 Process Bus Module for HardFiber, 8 x
(non-HardFiber requires IEC 61850, XX 85 XX | XX | IEC 61850-9-2LE and IEC 61869 Process Bus Module, 2 x 1000Base-SX, LC
PRP, IEEE 1588 software options) XX 86 XX | XX | IEC 61850-9-2LE and IEC 61869 Process Bus Module, 4 x 1000Base-SX + 4 x
100Base-FX, LC
XX 87 XX | XX | IEC 61850-9-2LE and IEC 61869 Process Bus Module, 4 x 100Base-FX, LC
CONTACT INPUTS/OUTPUTS XX XX XX XX XX No module
4A 4A | 4 Solid-State (no monitoring) MOSFET outputs
4B 4B | 4 Solid-State (voltage with optional current) MOSFET outputs
4C 4C | 4 Solid-State (current with optional voltage) MOSFET outputs
4D 4D | 16 Contact inputs with Auto-Burnishing (maximum of three modules within a
case)
4L 4L | 14 Form-A (no monitoring) Latching outputs
67 67 | 8 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs
6A 6A | 2 Form-A (voltage with optional current) and 2 Form-C outputs, 8 contact inputs
6B 6B | 2 Form-A (voltage with optional current) and 4 Form-C outputs, 4 contact inputs
6C 6C | 8 Form-C outputs
6D 6D | 16 Contact inputs
6E 6E | 4 Form-C outputs, 8 contact inputs
6F 6F | 8 Fast Form-C outputs
6G 6G | 4 Form-A (voltage with optional current) outputs, 8 contact inputs
6H 6H | 6 Form-A (voltage with optional current) outputs, 4 contact inputs
6K 6K | 4 Form-C and 4 Fast Form-C outputs
6L 6L | 2 Form-A (current with optional voltage) and 2 Form-C outputs, 8 contact inputs
6M 6M | 2 Form-A (current with optional voltage) and 4 Form-C outputs, 4 contact inputs
6N 6N | 4 Form-A (current with optional voltage) outputs, 8 contact inputs
6P 6P | 6 Form-A (current with optional voltage) outputs, 4 contact inputs
6R 6R | 2 Form-A (no monitoring) and 2 Form-C outputs, 8 contact inputs
6S 6S | 2 Form-A (no monitoring) and 4 Form-C outputs, 4 contact inputs
6T 6T | 4 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs, 8 contact inputs
6U 6U | 6 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs, 4 contact inputs
6V 6V | 2 Form-A outputs, 1 Form-C output, 2 Form-A (no monitoring) latching output, 8
contact inputs
6W 6W | 30 Contact inputs - pin terminals (max 4 modules)
6X 6X | 18 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs - pin terminals (max 4 modules)
INTER-RELAY COMMUNICATIONS 2A C37.94SM, 1300 nm single-mode, ELED, 1 channel single-mode
(select a maximum of 1 per unit) 2B C37.94SM, 1300 nm single-mode, ELED, 2 channel single-mode
2H IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, 128 kbps, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
2I Channel 1 - IEEE C37.94, MM, 64/128 kbps; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode,
Laser
2J Channel 1 - IEEE C37.94, MM, 64/128 kbps; Channel 2 - 1550 nm, single-mode,
Laser
72 1550 nm, single-mode, Laser, 1 Channel
73 1550 nm, single-mode, Laser, 2 Channel
76 IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, 64 kbps, multimode, LED, 1 Channel
77 IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, 64 kbps, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
7A 820 nm, multimode, LED, 1 Channel
7B 1300 nm, multimode, LED, 1 Channel
7C 1300 nm, single-mode, ELED, 1 Channel
7D 1300 nm, single-mode, Laser, 1 Channel
7F Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, multimode
7G Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode ELED
7H 820 nm, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
7I 1300 nm, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
7J 1300 nm, single-mode, ELED, 2 Channels
7K 1300 nm, single-mode, Laser, 2 Channels
7M Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, multimode, LED
Table 2-7: M60 order codes for reduced-size vertical units with process bus
2 BASE UNIT
CPU
M60
M60
- *
|
T
U
** - *
|
|
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
* - F **
|
|
|
|
|
|
- H **
|
|
|
- M **
|
|
|
- P/R **
|
|
|
Reduced Size Vertical Mount (see note regarding P/R slot below)
Base Unit
RS485 + three multimode fiber 100Base-FX (SFP with LC)
RS485 + two multimode fiber 100Base-FX (SFP with LC) + one 10/100Base-TX (SFP with RJ45)
V | | | | | | | | RS485 + three 10/100Base-TX (SFP with RJ45)
W | | | | | | | | RS485 + two 100Base-FX Ethernet, multimode ST + one 10/100Base-TX Ethernet, RJ-45
SOFTWARE OPTIONS 00 | | | | | | | No software options
01 | | | | | | | Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
03 | | | | | | | IEC 61850
04 | | | | | | | Ethernet Global Data (EGD) + IEC 61850
28 | | | | | | | Broken rotor bar detection
29 | | | | | | | Broken rotor bar detection + Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
30 | | | | | | | Broken rotor bar detection + IEC 61850
31 | | | | | | | Broken rotor bar detection + Ethernet Global Data (EGD), and IEC 61850
A0 | | | | | | | CyberSentry Lvl 1
A1 | | | | | | | CyberSentry Lvl 1 + Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
A3 | | | | | | | CyberSentry Lvl 1 + IEC 61850
A4 | | | | | | | CyberSentry Lvl 1 + IEC 61850 + Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
AS | | | | | | | CyberSentry Lvl 1
AT | | | | | | | CyberSentry Lvl 1 + Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
AU | | | | | | | CyberSentry Lvl 1 + IEC 61850
AV | | | | | | | CyberSentry Lvl 1 + IEC 61850 + Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
B0 | | | | | | | CyberSentry Lvl 1 + Broken rotor bar detection
B1 | | | | | | | CyberSentry Lvl 1 + Broken rotor bar detection + Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
B3 | | | | | | | CyberSentry Lvl 1 + Broken rotor bar detection + IEC 61850
B4 | | | | | | | CyberSentry Lvl 1 + Broken rotor bar detection + IEC 61850 + Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
BS | | | | | | | IEEE 1588
BT | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
BU | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + IEC 61850
BV | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + IEC 61850 + Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
C0 | | | | | | | Parallel Redundancy Protocol (PRP)
C1 | | | | | | | PRP + Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
C3 | | | | | | | PRP + IEC 61850
C4 | | | | | | | PRP + Ethernet Global Data (EGD) + IEC 61850
CS | | | | | | | PRP + Rotor broken bar
CT | | | | | | | PRP + Rotor broken bar + Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
CU | | | | | | | PRP + Rotor broken bar + IEC 61850
CV | | | | | | | PRP + Rotor broken bar + Ethernet Global Data (EGD) + IEC 61850
D0 | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + Broken rotor bar detection
D1 | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + Broken rotor bar detection + Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
D3 | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + Broken rotor bar detection + IEC 61850
D4 | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + Broken rotor bar detection + IEC 61850 + Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
DS | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + CyberSentry Lvl 1
DT | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
DU | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + IEC 61850
DV | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + IEC 61850 + Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
E0 | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + PRP
E1 | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + PRP + Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
E3 | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + PRP + IEC 61850
E4 | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + PRP + Ethernet Global Data (EGD) + IEC 61850
ES | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + PRP + Rotor broken bar
ET | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + PRP + Rotor broken bar + Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
EU | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + PRP + Rotor broken bar + IEC 61850
EV | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + PRP + Rotor broken bar + Ethernet Global Data (EGD) + IEC 61850
F0 | | | | | | | PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1
F1 | | | | | | | PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
F3 | | | | | | | PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + IEC 61850
F4 | | | | | | | PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + Ethernet Global Date (EGD) + IEC 61850
FS | | | | | | | PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + Rotor broken bar
FT | | | | | | | PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + Rotor broken bar + Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
FU | | | | | | | PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + Rotor broken bar + IEC 61850
FV | | | | | | | PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + Rotor broken bar + Ethernet Global Data (EGD) + IEC 61850
G0 | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1
G1 | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
G3 | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + IEC 61850
G4 | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + Ethernet Global Data (EGD) + IEC 61850
GS | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + Rotor broken bar
GT | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + Rotor broken bar + Ethernet Global Data (EGD)
GU | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + Rotor broken bar + IEC 61850
GV | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + Rotor broken bar + Ethernet Global Data (EGD) + IEC 61850
J0 | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103
J1 | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + EGD
J3 | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + IEC 61850
J4 | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + EGD + IEC 61850
JS | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + Rotor broken bar
JT | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + Rotor broken bar + EGD
JU | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + Rotor broken bar + IEC 61850
JV | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + Rotor broken bar + EGD + IEC 61850
K0 | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + PRP + IEC 60870-5-103
K1 | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + PRP + IEC 60870-5-103 + EGD
K3 | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + PRP + IEC 60870-5-103 + IEC 61850
K4 | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + PRP + IEC 60870-5-103 + EGD + IEC 61850
KS | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + PRP + IEC 60870-5-103 + Rotor broken bar
KT | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + PRP + IEC 60870-5-103 + Rotor broken bar + EGD
KU | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + PRP + IEC 60870-5-103 + Rotor broken bar + IEC 61850
KV | | | | | | | IEEE 1588 + PRP + IEC 60870-5-103 + Rotor broken bar + EGD + IEC 61850
L0 | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + IEEE 1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1
L1 | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + IEEE 1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + EGD
L3 | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + IEEE 1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + IEC 61850
L4 | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + IEEE 1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + EGD + IEC 61850
M60 - * ** - * * * - F ** - H ** - M ** - P/R ** Reduced Size Vertical Mount (see note regarding P/R slot below)
LS | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + IEEE 1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + Rotor broken bar
LT | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + IEEE 1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + Rotor broken bar + EGD
LU | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + IEEE 1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + Rotor broken bar + IEC 61850
LV | | | | | | | IEC 60870-5-103 + IEEE 1588 + PRP + CyberSentry Lvl 1 + Rotor broken bar + EGD + IEC 61850
MOUNT/COATING V | | | | | | Vertical (3/4 rack)
B | | | | | | Vertical (3/4 rack) with harsh environmental coating
FRONT PANEL + INTERFACE F | | | | | English display
D | | | | | French display
R | | | | | Russian display
K | | | | | Enhanced front panel with English display
M | | | | | Enhanced front panel with French display
Q | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Russian display
U | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Chinese display
2
L | | | | | Enhanced front panel with English display and user-programmable pushbuttons
N | | | | | Enhanced front panel with French display and user-programmable pushbuttons
T | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Russian display and user-programmable pushbuttons
V | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Chinese display and user-programmable pushbuttons
W | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Turkish display
Y | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Turkish display and user-programmable pushbuttons
I | | | | | Enhanced front panel with German display
J | | | | | Enhanced front panel with German display and user-programmable pushbuttons
POWER SUPPLY H | | | | 125 / 250 V AC/DC power supply
L | | | | 24 to 48 V (DC only) power supply
PROCESS BUS XX 81 XX | IEC 61850 Process Bus Module for HardFiber, 8 x
(non-HardFiber requires IEC 61850, XX 85 XX | IEC 61850-9-2LE and IEC 61869 Process Bus Module, 2 x 1000Base-SX, LC
PRP, IEEE 1588 software options) XX 86 XX | IEC 61850-9-2LE and IEC 61869 Process Bus Module, 4 x 1000Base-SX + 4 x 100Base-FX, LC
XX 87 XX | IEC 61850-9-2LE and IEC 61869 Process Bus Module, 4 x 100Base-FX, LC
CONTACT INPUTS/OUTPUTS XX XX XX No module
4A 4 Solid-State (no monitoring) MOSFET outputs
4B 4 Solid-State (voltage with optional current) MOSFET outputs
4C 4 Solid-State (current with optional voltage) MOSFET outputs
4D 16 Contact inputs with Auto-Burnishing (maximum of three modules within a case)
4L 14 Form-A (no monitoring) Latching outputs
67 8 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs
6A 2 Form-A (voltage with optional current) and 2 Form-C outputs, 8 contact inputs
6B 2 Form-A (voltage with optional current) and 4 Form-C outputs, 4 contact inputs
6C 8 Form-C outputs
6D 16 Contact inputs
6E 4 Form-C outputs, 8 contact inputs
6F 8 Fast Form-C outputs
6G 4 Form-A (voltage with optional current) outputs, 8 contact inputs
6H 6 Form-A (voltage with optional current) outputs, 4 contact inputs
6K 4 Form-C and 4 Fast Form-C outputs
6L 2 Form-A (current with optional voltage) and 2 Form-C outputs, 8 contact inputs
6M 2 Form-A (current with optional voltage) and 4 Form-C outputs, 4 contact inputs
6N 4 Form-A (current with optional voltage) outputs, 8 contact inputs
6P 6 Form-A (current with optional voltage) outputs, 4 contact inputs
6R 2 Form-A (no monitoring) and 2 Form-C outputs, 8 contact inputs
6S 2 Form-A (no monitoring) and 4 Form-C outputs, 4 contact inputs
6T 4 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs, 8 contact inputs
6U 6 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs, 4 contact inputs
6V 2 Form-A outputs, 1 Form-C output, 2 Form-A (no monitoring) latching output, 8 contact inputs
6W 30 Contact inputs - pin terminals (max 4 modules)
6X 18 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs - pin terminals (max 4 modules)
INTER-RELAY COMMUNICATIONS 2A C37.94SM, 1300 nm single-mode, ELED, 1 channel single-mode
(select a maximum of 1 per unit) 2B C37.94SM, 1300 nm single-mode, ELED, 2 channel single-mode
For the last module, rear slot P is used for digital 2H IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, 128 kbps, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
input/output modules; rear slot R is used for inter- 2I Channel 1 - IEEE C37.94, MM, 64/128 kbps; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode, Laser
2J Channel 1 - IEEE C37.94, MM, 64/128 kbps; Channel 2 - 1550 nm, single-mode, Laser
relay communications modules. 72 1550 nm, single-mode, Laser, 1 Channel
73 1550 nm, single-mode, Laser, 2 Channel
76 IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, 64 kbps, multimode, LED, 1 Channel
77 IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, 64 kbps, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
7A 820 nm, multimode, LED, 1 Channel
7B 1300 nm, multimode, LED, 1 Channel
7C 1300 nm, single-mode, ELED, 1 Channel
7D 1300 nm, single-mode, Laser, 1 Channel
7F Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, multimode
7G Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode ELED
7H 820 nm, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
7I 1300 nm, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
7J 1300 nm, single-mode, ELED, 2 Channels
7K 1300 nm, single-mode, Laser, 2 Channels
7M Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, multimode, LED
7N Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode, ELED
7P Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode, Laser
7Q Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode Laser
7R G.703, 1 Channel
7S G.703, 2 Channels
7T RS422, 1 Channel
7W RS422, 2 Channels
2 |
|
|
|
3P
3G
3S
3B
|
|
|
|
Horizontal front panel with keypad, user-programmable pushbuttons, and English display
Horizontal front panel with keypad, user-programmable pushbuttons, and French display
Horizontal front panel with keypad, user-programmable pushbuttons, and Russian display
Horizontal front panel with keypad, user-programmable pushbuttons, and Chinese display
| 3K | Enhanced front panel with English display
| 3M | Enhanced front panel with French display
| 3Q | Enhanced front panel with Russian display
| 3U | Enhanced front panel with Chinese display
| 3L | Enhanced front panel with English display and user-programmable pushbuttons
| 3N | Enhanced front panel with French display and user-programmable pushbuttons
| 3T | Enhanced front panel with Russian display and user-programmable pushbuttons
| 3V | Enhanced front panel with Chinese display and user-programmable pushbuttons
| 3I | Enhanced front panel with German display
| 3J | Enhanced front panel with German display and user-programmable pushbuttons
| 3H | Enhanced front panel with Polish display
| 3O | Enhanced front panel with Polish display and user-programmable pushbuttons
| 3Z | Enhanced front panel with Japanese display
| 3X | Enhanced front panel with Japanese display and user-programmable pushbuttons
| 3E | 7" Graphical front panel display in multiple languages with USB front port and user-programmable pushbuttons
CONTACT INPUTS AND OUTPUTS | 4A | 4 Solid-State (no monitoring) MOSFET outputs
| 4B | 4 Solid-State (voltage with optional current) MOSFET outputs
| 4C | 4 Solid-State (current with optional voltage) MOSFET outputs
| 4D | 16 Contact inputs with Auto-Burnishing
| 4L | 14 Form-A (no monitoring) Latching outputs
| 67 | 8 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs
| 6A | 2 Form-A (voltage with optional current) and 2 Form-C outputs, 8 contact inputs
| 6B | 2 Form-A (voltage with optional current) and 4 Form-C outputs, 4 contact inputs
| 6C | 8 Form-C outputs
| 6D | 16 Contact inputs
| 6E | 4 Form-C outputs, 8 contact inputs
| 6F | 8 Fast Form-C outputs
| 6G | 4 Form-A (voltage with optional current) outputs, 8 contact inputs
| 6H | 6 Form-A (voltage with optional current) outputs, 4 contact inputs
| 6K | 4 Form-C and 4 Fast Form-C outputs
| 6L | 2 Form-A (current with optional voltage) and 2 Form-C outputs, 8 contact inputs
| 6M | 2 Form-A (current with optional voltage) and 4 Form-C outputs, 4 contact inputs
| 6N | 4 Form-A (current with optional voltage) outputs, 8 contact inputs
| 6P | 6 Form-A (current with optional voltage) outputs, 4 contact inputs
| 6R | 2 Form-A (no monitoring) and 2 Form-C outputs, 8 contact inputs
| 6S | 2 Form-A (no monitoring) and 4 Form-C outputs, 4 contact inputs
| 6T | 4 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs, 8 contact inputs
| 6U | 6 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs, 4 contact inputs
| 6V | 2 Form-A outputs, 1 Form-C output, 2 Form-A (no monitoring) latching outputs, 8 contact inputs
| 6W | 30 Contact inputs - pin terminals (max 4 modules)
| 6X | 18 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs - pin terminals (max 4 modules)
CT/VT MODULES | 8L | Standard 4CT/4VT with enhanced diagnostics
(not available for the C30) | 8N | Standard 8CT with enhanced diagnostics
| 8M | Sensitive Ground 4CT/4VT with enhanced diagnostics
| 8R | Sensitive Ground 8CT with enhanced diagnostics
PROCESS BUS MODULES | 81 | IEC 61850 Process Bus Module for HardFiber, 8 x
| 85 | IEC 61850-9-2LE and IEC 61869 Process Bus Module, 2 x 1000Base-SX, LC
| 86 | IEC 61850-9-2LE and IEC 61869 Process Bus Module, 4 x 1000Base-SX + 4 x 100Base-FX, LC
| 87 | IEC 61850-9-2LE and IEC 61869 Process Bus Module, 4 x 100Base-FX, LC
INTER-RELAY COMMUNICATIONS | 2A | C37.94SM, 1300 nm single-mode, ELED, 1 channel single-mode
| 2B | C37.94SM, 1300 nm single-mode, ELED, 2 channel single-mode
| 2H | IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, 128 kbps, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
| 2I | Channel 1 - IEEE C37.94, multimode, 64/128 kbps; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode, Laser
| 2J | Channel 1 - IEEE C37.94, multimode, 64/128 kbps; Channel 2 - 1550 nm, single-mode, Laser
| 72 | 1550 nm, single-mode, Laser, 1 Channel
| 73 | 1550 nm, single-mode, Laser, 2 Channel
| 76 | IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, multimode, LED, 1 Channel
| 77 | IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
| 7A | 820 nm, multimode, LED, 1 Channel
| 7B | 1300 nm, multimode, LED, 1 Channel
| 7C | 1300 nm, single-mode, ELED, 1 Channel
| 7D | 1300 nm, single-mode, Laser, 1 Channel
| 7F | Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, multimode
| 7G | Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode ELED
| 7H | 820 nm, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
| 7I | 1300 nm, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
| 7J | 1300 nm, single-mode, ELED, 2 Channels
| 7K | 1300 nm, single-mode, Laser, 2 Channels
| 7M | Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, multimode, LED
| 7N | Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode, ELED
| 7P | Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode, Laser
| 7Q | Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode Laser
| 7R | G.703, 1 Channel
| 7S | G.703, 2 Channels
| 7T | RS422, 1 Channel
| 7W | RS422, 2 Channels
TRANSDUCER INPUTS/OUTPUTS | 5A | 4 DCmA inputs, 4 DCmA outputs (only one 5A or 5D module is allowed)
| 5C | 8 RTD inputs
| 5D | 4 RTD inputs, 4 DCmA outputs (only one 5A or 5D module is allowed)
| 5E | 4 DCmA inputs, 4 RTD inputs
| 5F | 8 DCmA inputs
2
| 3M | Enhanced front panel with French display
| 3Q | Enhanced front panel with Russian display
| 3U | Enhanced front panel with Chinese display
| 3L | Enhanced front panel with English display and user-programmable pushbuttons
| 3N | Enhanced front panel with French display and user-programmable pushbuttons
| 3T | Enhanced front panel with Russian display and user-programmable pushbuttons
| 3V | Enhanced front panel with Chinese display and user-programmable pushbuttons
| 3I | Enhanced front panel with German display
| 3J | Enhanced front panel with German display and user-programmable pushbuttons
CONTACT INPUTS/OUTPUTS | 4A | 4 Solid-State (no monitoring) MOSFET outputs
| 4B | 4 Solid-State (voltage with optional current) MOSFET outputs
| 4C | 4 Solid-State (current with optional voltage) MOSFET outputs
| 4D | 16 Contact inputs with Auto-Burnishing
| 4L | 14 Form-A (no monitoring) Latching outputs
| 67 | 8 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs
| 6A | 2 Form-A (voltage with optional current) and 2 Form-C outputs, 8 contact inputs
| 6B | 2 Form-A (voltage with optional current) and 4 Form-C outputs, 4 contact inputs
| 6C | 8 Form-C outputs
| 6D | 16 Contact inputs
| 6E | 4 Form-C outputs, 8 contact inputs
| 6F | 8 Fast Form-C outputs
| 6G | 4 Form-A (voltage with optional current) outputs, 8 contact inputs
| 6H | 6 Form-A (voltage with optional current) outputs, 4 contact inputs
| 6K | 4 Form-C and 4 Fast Form-C outputs
| 6L | 2 Form-A (current with optional voltage) and 2 Form-C outputs, 8 contact inputs
| 6M | 2 Form-A (current with optional voltage) and 4 Form-C outputs, 4 contact inputs
| 6N | 4 Form-A (current with optional voltage) outputs, 8 contact inputs
| 6P | 6 Form-A (current with optional voltage) outputs, 4 contact inputs
| 6R | 2 Form-A (no monitoring) and 2 Form-C outputs, 8 contact inputs
| 6S | 2 Form-A (no monitoring) and 4 Form-C outputs, 4 contact inputs
| 6T | 4 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs, 8 contact inputs
| 6U | 6 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs, 4 contact inputs
| 6V | 2 Form-A outputs, 1 Form-C output, 2 Form-A (no monitoring) latching outputs, 8 contact inputs
| 6W | 30 Contact inputs - pin terminals (max 4 modules)
| 6X | 18 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs - pin terminals (max 4 modules)
CT/VT MODULES | 8L | Standard 4CT/4VT with enhanced diagnostics
(not available for the C30) | 8N | Standard 8CT with enhanced diagnostics
| 8M | Sensitive Ground 4CT/4VT with enhanced diagnostics
| 8R | Sensitive Ground 8CT with enhanced diagnostics
PROCESS BUS | 81 | IEC 61850 Process Bus Module for HardFiber, 8 x
| 85 | IEC 61850-9-2LE and IEC 61869 Process Bus Module, 2 x 1000Base-SX, LC
| 86 | IEC 61850-9-2LE and IEC 61869 Process Bus Module, 4 x 1000Base-SX + 4 x 100BaseFx, LC
| 87 | IEC 61850-9-2LE and IEC 61869 Process Bus Module, 4 x 100Base-FX, LC
INTER-RELAY COMMUNICATIONS | 2A | C37.94SM, 1300 nm single-mode, ELED, 1 channel single-mode
| 2B | C37.94SM, 1300 nm single-mode, ELED, 2 channel single-mode
| 2H | IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, 128 kbps, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
| 2I | Channel 1 - IEEE C37.94, multimode, 64/128 kbps; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode, Laser
| 2J | Channel 1 - IEEE C37.94, multimode, 64/128 kbps; Channel 2 - 1550 nm, single-mode, Laser
| 72 | 1550 nm, single-mode, Laser, 1 Channel
| 73 | 1550 nm, single-mode, Laser, 2 Channel
| 76 | IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, 64 kbps, multimode, LED, 1 Channel
| 77 | IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, 64 kbps, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
| 7A | 820 nm, multimode, LED, 1 Channel
| 7B | 1300 nm, multimode, LED, 1 Channel
| 7C | 1300 nm, single-mode, ELED, 1 Channel
| 7D | 1300 nm, single-mode, Laser, 1 Channel
| 7F | Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, multimode
| 7G | Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode ELED
| 7H | 820 nm, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
| 7I | 1300 nm, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
| 7J | 1300 nm, single-mode, ELED, 2 Channels
| 7K | 1300 nm, single-mode, Laser, 2 Channels
| 7M | Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, multimode, LED
| 7N | Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode, ELED
| 7P | Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode, Laser
| 7Q | Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode Laser
| 7R | G.703, 1 Channel
| 7S | G.703, 2 Channels
| 7T | RS422, 1 Channel
| 7W | RS422, 2 Channels
TRANSDUCER INPUTS/OUTPUTS | 5A | 4 DCmA inputs, 4 DCmA outputs (only one 5A or 5D module is allowed)
| 5C | 8 RTD inputs
| 5D | 4 RTD inputs, 4 DCmA outputs (only one 5A or 5D module is allowed)
| 5E | 4 DCmA inputs, 4 RTD inputs
| 5F | 8 DCmA inputs
I Frequency
D
T
RMS
values
Synchro-
Sampling phasors Analog Outputs
frequency filtering
DSP module module
Tracking
HMI frequency Events
selection,
Protection
Ethernet algorithms
ports
estimation Control Comtrade, data
I> elements,
Commun logger
Serial i-cation Z< monitoring
Serial
ports protocols U< elements,
FlexLogic, DNP, Modbus,
IEC60870
IRIG-B Accurate
Real- Time PMU (IEEE C37.118,
IEEE stamping
Ethernet
1588 Time Synchrophasors IEC 61850-90-5)
clock Aggregation,
SNTP calculations post-filtering IEC 61850 (GOOSE,
CPU module MMS Server)
comms module
Contact Inputs
Analog Inputs
Inter-relay
Inter-relay
module
module
G.703, RS-422,
Optoisolated C37.94, direct fiber DCmA, RTD
859740A1.vsd
The UR samples its AC signals at 64 samples per cycle, that is, at 3840 Hz in 60 Hz systems, and 3200 Hz in 50 Hz systems.
The sampling rate is adjusted dynamically to the actual system frequency by an accurate and fast frequency tracking
system.
The analog/digital converter has the following ranges of AC signals:
Voltages:
Currents:
Current harmonics are estimated based on raw samples with the use of the full-cycle Fourier filter. Harmonics 2nd through
25th are estimated. 2
True RMS value for the current is calculated on a per-phase basis. The true RMS can be used for demand recording or as an
input signal to Time Overcurrent function, if the latter is intended for thermal protection. The true RMS is calculated as per
the widely accepted definition:
t
1 2
I RMS t = -- ³ i t dt
T
t – T Eq. 2-3
RMS values include harmonics, inter-harmonics, DC components, and so on, along with fundamental frequency values.
The true RMS value reflects thermal effects of the current and is used for the thermal related monitoring and protection
functions.
Protection and control functions respond to phasors of the fundamental and/or harmonic frequency components
(magnitudes and angles), with an exception for some functions that have an option for RMS or fundamental
measurements, or some function responding to RMS only. This type of response is explained typically in each element's
section in this instruction manual.
Currents are pre-filtered using a Finite Impulse Response (FIR) digital filter. The filter is designed to reject DC components
and low-frequency distortions, without amplifying high-frequency noise. This filter is referred to as a modified MIMIC filter,
which provides excellent filtering and overall balance between speed and accuracy of filtering. The filter is cascaded with
the full-cycle Fourier filter for the current phasor estimation.
Voltages are pre-filtered using a patented FIR digital filter. The filter has been optimized to reject voltage-transformer-
specific distortions, such as Capacitive Voltage Transformer (CVT) noise and high-frequency oscillatory components. The
filter is cascaded with the half-cycle Fourier filter for the voltage phasor estimation.
The URs measure power system frequency using the Clarke transformation by estimating the period of the waveform from
two consecutive zero-crossings in the same direction (negative-to-positive). Voltage or current samples are pre-filtered
using a Finite Impulse Response (FIR) digital filter to remove high frequency noise contained in the signal. The period is
used after several security conditions are met, such as true RMS signal must be above 6% nominal for a certain time. If
these security conditions are not met, the last valid measurement is used for a specific time after which the UR reverts to
nominal system frequency.
Synchrophasors are calculated using a patented convolution integral algorithm. This algorithm allows use of the same
time-stamped samples, which are used for protection and taken at the same sampling frequency. This allows URs to use
one sampling clock for both protection algorithms and synchrophasors.
Synchrophasors on firmware versions 7.23 and up have been tested and certified to meet IEEE C37.118-2011 and
C37.118.1a-2014 standards for both metering and protection classes with outputs available up to 60 synchrophasors per
second for the metering class and 120 synchrophasors per second for the protection class. Synchrophasors measurement
is also available via IEC 61850-90-5 protocol.
The contact inputs threshold is settable in the firmware with 17, 33, 84, and 166 V DC settings available. Inputs are scanned
every 0.5 ms and can be conditioned for the critical applications, using debounce time timer, settable from 0.0 to 16.0 ms.
Contact inputs with auto-burnishing are available as well, when external contacts are exposed to the contamination in a
harsh industrial environment.
All measured values are available in the UR metering section on the front panel and via communications protocols.
Measured analog values and binary signals can be captured in COMTRADE format with sampling rates from 8 to 64
samples per power cycle. Analog values can be captured with the Data Logger, allowing much slower rates extended over
a long period of time.
Other advanced UR order code options are available to support IEC 61850 (including fast GOOSE, ICD/CID/IID files, and so
on), IEEE 1588 (IEEE C37.238 power profile) based time synchronization, CyberSentry (advanced cyber security), the Parallel
Redundancy Protocol (PRP), IEC 60870-5-103, and so on.
2.5 Specifications
2 Specifications are subject to change without notice.
THERMAL MODEL
Timing characteristics: Standard curve (motor) (curve multiplier: 0.00 to 16.00 in steps of 0.01 s)
FlexCurve (curve multiplier: 0.00 to 600.00 in steps of 0.01)
Standard curve (motor) with Voltage Dependent Curve (curve multiplier: 0.00 to 16.00 in steps of
0.01)
IEC (IEC curve time constant: 0 to 1000 in steps of 1)
Thermal overload pickup: pu = overload factor FLA
Overload factor (OF): 1.00 to 1.50 in steps of 0.01
Motor full load current (FLA): 0.050 to 1.000 pu in steps of 0.001
Standard overload curve, cutoff effect:
TD u 2.2116623
t trip = ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
I motor 2 I motor
0.02530337 u ------------- – 1· + 0.05054758 u § ------------
§ - – 1·
© FLA ¹ © FLA ¹
STATOR DIFFERENTIAL
Pickup: 0.050 to 1.00 pu in steps of 0.01
Slope 1 and 2: 1 to 100% in steps of 1
Break 1: 1.00 to 1.50 pu in steps of 0.01
Break 2: 1.50 to 30.00 pu in steps of 0.01
Operate time: <¾ cycle at Idiff > 5 × pickup
PHASE/NEUTRAL/GROUND TOC
Current: Phasor or RMS 2
Pickup level: 0.020 to 30.000 pu in steps of 0.001 (standard CT for ground)
0.002 to 3.000 pu in steps of 0.001 (sensitive ground CT)
0.005 to 30.000 pu in steps of 0.001 (Process Bus Module, ground)
Dropout level: 97% of pickup
Level accuracy:
0.1 to 2.0 CT: ±0.5% of reading or ±0.4% of rated (whichever is greater)
> 2.0 CT: ±1.5% of reading > 2.0 CT rating
Timing characteristics: IEEE Moderately/Very/Extremely Inverse; IEC (and BS) A/B/C and Short Inverse; GE IAC Inverse,
Short/Very/ Extremely Inverse; I2t; FlexCurves™ (programmable); (Curve multiplier 0.00 to 600.00
in steps of 0.01 s)
Definite Time (Time delay = 0.00 to 600.00 in steps of 0.01 s)
Reset type: Instantaneous/Timed (per IEEE)
Curve timing accuracy at 1.03 to 20 x pickup:
±3.5% of operate time or ±½ cycle (whichever is greater) from pickup to operate (see NOTE 1)
Voltage restraint: Modifies pickup current for voltage in the range of 0.1 < V < 0.9 VT Nominal in a fixed linear rela-
tionship
PHASE/NEUTRAL/GROUND IOC
Current: Phasor only
Pickup level: 0.020 to 30.000 pu in steps of 0.001 (standard CT for ground)
0.002 to 3.000 pu in steps of 0.001 (sensitive ground CT)
0.005 to 30.000 pu in steps of 0.001 (Process Bus Module, ground)
Dropout level: 97% of pickup
Level accuracy:
0.1 to 2.0 CT rating: ±0.5% of reading or ±0.4% of rated (whichever is greater)
> 2.0 CT rating: ±1.5% of reading
Overreach: <2%
Pickup delay: 0.00 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01
Reset delay: 0.00 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01
Operate time: <16 ms at 3 pickup at 60 Hz (Phase IOC) (see NOTE 1)
<20 ms at 3 pickup at 60 Hz (Neutral IOC) (see NOTE 1)
<25 ms at 3 x pickup at 60 Hz (Ground IOC) (see NOTE 1)
Timer accuracy: ±3.5% of operate time or ±1/4 cycle (whichever is greater)
AMP UNBALANCE
Average and full load amps: RMS
I_1 and I_2 amps: phasor
Pickup level: 0.0 to 100.0% in steps of 0.1
Dropout level: 97 to 98% of pickup
Level accuracy: ±0.1
Pickup delay: 0.00 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01
Reset delay: 0.00 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01
Operate time: <20 ms at 1.10 pickup at 60 Hz (see NOTE 1)
Timer accuracy: ±3% of operate time or ±20 ms, whichever is greater
MECHANICAL JAM
Operating condition: Phase overcurrent
Arming condition: Motor not starting
Pickup level: 1.00 to 10.00 FLA in steps of 0.01
Dropout level: 97 to 98% of pickup
Level accuracy:
at 0.1 to 2.0 CT: ±0.5% of reading
at >2.0 CT rating: ±1.5% of reading
Pickup delay: 0.10 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01
Reset delay: 0.00 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01
Timer accuracy: ±3% of operate time or ±20 ms, whichever is greater
ACCELERATION TIME
Acceleration current: 1.00 to 10.00 FLA in steps of 0.01
Acceleration time: 0.00 to 180.00 s in steps of 0.01
Operating mode: Definite Time, Adaptive
Timer accuracy: ±100 ms or ±0.5% of total time (whichever is greater)
Level accuracy: ±0.5% of reading or ±0.4% of rated (whichever is greater) at 0.1 to 2.0 × CT rating; ±1.5% of read-
ing at >2.0 × CT rating
UNDERPOWER
Operation: three-phase apparent power
Number of elements: 2, alarm and trip stages in each element
Pickup level: 0.05 to 2.00 pu in steps of 0.01
Pickup level accuracy: ±1.0% of reading
Hysteresis: 3%
Pickup delay: 0 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01
Timer accuracy: ±3% of operate time or ±10 ms, whichever is greater
Operate time: <35 ms at 60 Hz
UNDERCURRENT
Operation: per-phase current
PHASE UNDERVOLTAGE
Voltage: Phasor only
Pickup level: 0.004 to 3.000 pu in steps of 0.001
Dropout level: 102% of pickup
Level accuracy: ±0.5% of reading from 10 to 208 V
Timing characteristics: GE IAV Inverse (Curve multiplier 0.00 to 600.00 in steps of 0.01 s)
Definite Time (Time delay = 0.00 to 600.00 in steps of 0.01 s)
FlexCurves (programmable, Curve multiplier = 0.00 to 600.00 in steps of 0.01 s)
Reset delay: 0 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01 s
Curve timing accuracy at <0.90 x pickup:
±3.5% of operate time or ±1/2 cycle (whichever is greater) from pickup to operate
Operate time: <30 ms at 0.9 pickup at 60 Hz for Definite Time mode
AUXILIARY UNDERVOLTAGE
Pickup level: 0.004 to 3.000 pu in steps of 0.001
Dropout level: 103% of pickup
Level accuracy: ±0.5% of reading from 10 to 208 V
Timing characteristics: GE IAV Inverse (Curve multiplier = 0.00 to 600.00 in steps of 0.01 s);
Definite Time (Time delay = 0.00 to 600.00 in steps of 0.01 s)
FlexCurves (programmable, Curve multiplier = 0.00 to 600.00 in steps of 0.01 s)
Reset delay: 0 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01 s
Curve timing accuracy at <0.90 x pickup:
±3.5% of operate time or ±1/2 cycle (whichever is greater) from pickup to operate
Operate time: <30 ms at 0.9 pickup at 60 Hz for Definite Time mode
PHASE OVERVOLTAGE
Voltage: Phasor only
Pickup level: 0.004 to 3.000 pu in steps of 0.001
Dropout level: 98% of pickup
Level accuracy: ±0.5% of reading from 10 to 208 V
Timing characteristics: GE IAV Inverse (Curve multiplier 0.00 to 600.00 in steps of 0.01 s);
Definite Time (Time delay = 0.00 to 600.00 in steps of 0.01 s);
FlexCurves (programmable, Curve multiplier = 0.00 to 600.00 in steps of 0.01 s)
Reset delay: 0 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01 s
Curve timing accuracy at >1.10 × pickup:±3.5% of operate time or ±1 cycle (whichever is greater) from pickup to operate
Operate time: <30 ms at 1.10 pickup at 60 Hz for Definite Time mode
NEUTRAL OVERVOLTAGE
Pickup level: 0.004 to 3.000 pu in steps of 0.001
Dropout level: 97% of pickup
Level accuracy: ±0.5% of reading from 10 to 208 V
Pickup delay: 0.00 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01 (definite time) or user-defined curve
Reset delay: 0.00 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01
Curve timing accuracy at >1.1 × pickup: ±3.5% of operate time or ±1 cycle (whichever is greater) from pickup to operate
Operate time: <30 ms at 1.10 × pickup at 60 Hz
2 AUXILIARY OVERVOLTAGE
Pickup level: 0.004 to 3.000 pu in steps of 0.001
Dropout level: 97% of pickup
Level accuracy: ±0.5% of reading from 10 to 208 V
Timing characteristics: Definite Time (Time delay = 0.00 to 600.00 in steps of 0.01 s);
GE IAV Inverse (Curve multiplier= 0.00 to 600.00 in steps of 0.01 s);
FlexCurves (programmable, Curve multiplier= 0.00 to 600.00 in steps of 0.01 s)
Reset delay: 0 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01
Curve timing accuracy at >1.10 x pickup:±3.5% of operate time or ±1 cycle (whichever is greater) from pickup to operate
Operate time: <30 ms at 1.10 pickup at 60 Hz for Definite Time mode
UNDERFREQUENCY
Minimum signal: 0.10 to 1.25 pu in steps of 0.01
Pickup level: 20.00 to 65.00 Hz in steps of 0.01
Dropout level: pickup + 0.03 Hz
Level accuracy: ±0.001 Hz
Time delay: 0 to 65.535 s in steps of 0.001
Timer accuracy: ±3% of operate time or ±1/4 cycle (whichever is greater)
Operate time: typically 4 cycles at 0.1 Hz/s change
typically 3.5 cycles at 0.3 Hz/s change
typically 3 cycles at 0.5 Hz/s change
Typical times are average operate times including variables, such as frequency change instance, and test method, and can vary by ±0.5
cycles.
OVERFREQUENCY
Pickup level: 20.00 to 65.00 Hz in steps of 0.01
Dropout level: pickup – 0.03 Hz
Level accuracy: ±0.001 Hz
Time delay: 0 to 65.535 s in steps of 0.001
Timer accuracy: ±3% of operate time or ±1/4 cycle (whichever is greater)
BREAKER FAILURE
Mode: 1-pole, 3-pole
Current supervision:
Current supv. pickup:
phase, neutral current
0.020 to 30.000 pu in steps of 0.001
2
Current supv. dropout: 97% of pickup
Current supv. accuracy:
0.1 to 2.0 CT rating: ±0.75% of reading or ±2% of rated (whichever is greater)
above 2 CT rating: ±2.5% of reading
BREAKER FLASHOVER
Operating quantity: phase current, voltage, and voltage difference
Pickup level voltage: 0.004 to 1.500 pu in steps of 0.001
Dropout level voltage: 97% of pickup
Pickup level current: 0.020 to 1.500 pu in steps of 0.001
Dropout level current: 97% of pickup
Level accuracy: ±0.5% or ±0.1% of rated, whichever is greater
Pickup delay: 0 to 65.535 s in steps of 0.001
Timer accuracy: ±3% of operate time or ±42 ms, whichever is greater
Operate time: <42 ms at 1.10 pickup at 60 Hz (see NOTE 1)
BREAKER RESTRIKE
Principle: detection of high-frequency overcurrent condition ¼ cycle after breaker opens
Availability: one per digital signal processor (DSP)
Pickup level: 0.1 to 2.00 pu in steps of 0.01
Reset delay: 0.000 to 65.535 s in steps of 0.001
RTD PROTECTION
Pickup: 1 to 249°C in steps of 1
Dropout level: 2°C of pickup
Timer accuracy: <1 s
Elements: trip and alarm
FLEXCURVES™
Number: 4 (A through D)
Reset points: 40 (0 through 1 of pickup)
Operate points: 80 (1 through 20 of pickup)
Time delay: 0 to 65535 ms in steps of 1
FLEX STATES
Number: up to 256 logical variables grouped under 16 Modbus addresses
Programmability: any logical variable, contact, or virtual input
FLEXELEMENTS™
Number of elements: 16
Operating signal: any analog actual value, or two values in differential mode
Operating signal mode: signed or absolute value
Operating mode: level, delta
Comparator direction: over, under
Pickup level: –90.000 to 90.000 pu in steps of 0.001
Hysteresis: 0.1 to 50.0% in steps of 0.1
Delta dt: 20 ms to 60 days
Pickup and dropout delay: 0.000 to 65.535 s in steps of 0.001
NON-VOLATILE LATCHES
Type: set-dominant or reset-dominant
Number: 16 (individually programmed)
Output: stored in non-volatile memory
Execution sequence: as input prior to protection, control, and FlexLogic
LED TEST
Initiation: from any contact input or user-programmable condition
Number of tests: 3, interruptible at any time
Duration of full test: approximately 3 minutes
Test sequence 1: all LEDs on
Test sequence 2: all LEDs off, one LED at a time on for 1 s
Test sequence 3: all LEDs on, one LED at a time off for 1 s
USER-PROGRAMMABLE PUSHBUTTONS
Number of pushbuttons: 12 on basic front panel
16 on enhanced horizontal front panel
6 on enhanced vertical front panel
48 on graphical front panel (8 physical pushbuttons, 40 graphical interface pushbuttons)
Mode: self-reset, latched
Display message: 2 lines of 20 characters each
Drop-out timer: 0.00 to 60.00 s in steps of 0.05
Autoreset timer: 0.2 to 600.0 s in steps of 0.1
Hold timer: 0.0 to 10.0 s in steps of 0.1
SELECTOR SWITCH
Number of elements: 2
Upper position limit: 1 to 7 in steps of 1
Selecting mode: time-out or acknowledge
Time-out timer: 3.0 to 60.0 s in steps of 0.1
Control inputs: step-up and 3-bit
Power-up mode: restore from non-volatile memory or synchronize to a 3-bit control input or synch/restore mode
DIGITAL ELEMENTS
Number of elements: 96
Operating signal: any FlexLogic operand
Pickup delay: 0.000 to 999999.999 s in steps of 0.001
Dropout delay: 0.000 to 999999.999 s in steps of 0.001
Timing accuracy: ±3% or ±4 ms, whichever is greater
2.5.3 Monitoring
OSCILLOGRAPHY
Number of records: 3 to 64, configurable
Sampling rate: 8, 16, 32, or 64 samples per power cycle, configurable
Triggers: any FlexLogic operand, configurable
Trigger position: 0 to 100%, configurable
Recorded data: raw AC input channels
up to 64 configured digital channels, representing any FlexLogic operand
up to 16 configured analog channels, representing any measured analog value
Data storage: in non-volatile memory
Format: COMTRADE IEEE C37.111 (1999 or 2013)
EVENT RECORDER
Capacity: 1024 events
Time-tag: to 1 microsecond
Triggers: any FlexLogic operand, configurable
Data storage: in non-volatile memory
2 Pre-fault trigger:
Fault trigger:
any FlexLogic operand
any FlexLogic operand
Recorder quantities: 32 (any FlexAnalogTM value)
DATA LOGGER
Number of channels: 1 to 16
Parameters: any available analog actual value
Sampling rate: 15 to 3600000 ms in steps of 1
Trigger: any FlexLogic operand
Mode: continuous or triggered
Storage capacity: (NN is dependent on memory)
1-second rate:
01 channel for NN days
16 channels for NN days
60-minute rate:
01 channel for NN days
16 channels for NN days
2.5.4 Metering
RMS CURRENT: PHASE, NEUTRAL, AND GROUND
Accuracy at
0.1 to 2.0 CT rating: ±0.25% of reading or ±0.1% of rated (whichever is greater)
2.0 CT rating: ±1.0% of reading
RMS VOLTAGE
Accuracy: ±0.5% of reading from 10 to 208 V
FREQUENCY 2
Accuracy for 20 to 65 Hz input at
V = 0.8 to 1.2 pu: ±0.001 Hz (when voltage signal is used for frequency measurement)
I = 0.1 to 0.25 pu: ±0.02 Hz (when current signal is used for frequency measurement)
I > 0.25 pu: ±0.005 Hz (when current signal is used for frequency measurement)
2.5.5 Inputs
AC CURRENT
CT rated primary: 1 to 50000 A
CT rated secondary: 1 or 5 A by connection
Relay burden: < 0.2 VA at rated secondary
Conversion range:
Standard CT: 0.02 to 46 CT rating RMS symmetrical
Sensitive Ground CT module: 0.002 to 4.6 CT rating RMS symmetrical
Current withstand: 20 ms at 250 times rated
1 sec at 100 times rated
continuous 4x Inom
Short circuit rating: 150000 RMS symmetrical amperes, 250 V maximum (primary current to external CT)
AC VOLTAGE
VT rated secondary: 25.0 to 240.0 V
VT ratio: 1.00 to 24000.00
Relay burden: < 0.25 VA at 120 V
Conversion range: 1 to 275 V
Voltage withstand: continuous at 260 V to neutral
1 min/hr at 420 V to neutral
FREQUENCY
Nominal frequency setting: 25 to 60 Hz
Sampling frequency: 64 samples per power cycle
Tracking frequency range with DSP: 20 to 70 Hz
with Process Bus Module 81, 85, 86, 87: 20 to 65 Hz
CONTACT INPUTS
Dry contacts: 1000 maximum
Wet contacts: 300 V DC maximum
Selectable thresholds: 17 V, 33 V, 84 V, 166 V
Tolerance: ±10%
Contacts per common return: 4
Recognition time: < 1 ms
Debounce time: 0.0 to 16.0 ms in steps of 0.5
Continuous current draw: 4 mA (when energized)
Tolerance: ±10%
Contacts per common return: 2
Recognition time: < 1 ms
Debounce time: 0.0 to 16.0 ms in steps of 0.5
Continuous current draw: 4 mA (when energized)
Auto-burnish impulse current: 50 to 70 mA
Duration of auto-burnish impulse: 25 to 50 ms
2 DCMA INPUTS
Current input (mA DC): 0 to –1, 0 to +1, –1 to +1, 0 to 5, 0 to 10, 0 to 20, 4 to 20 (programmable)
Input impedance: 379 ±10%
Conversion range: –1 to + 20 mA DC
Accuracy: ±0.2% of full scale
Type: Passive
RTD INPUTS
Types (3-wire): 100 Platinum, 100 and 120 Nickel, 10 Copper
Sensing current: 5 mA
Range: –50 to +250°C
Accuracy: ±2°C
Isolation: 36 V pk-pk
IRIG-B INPUT
IRIG formats accepted: B000…B007, B120…B127
IRIG control bits: IEEE Std C37.118.1-2011
Amplitude modulation: 1 to 10 V pk-pk
DC shift:
Operating range: 0 to 10 V DC
TTL logic low: 0.0 to 0.8 V DC
TTL logic high: 2.0 to 5.0 V DC
Input impedance: 50 k
Isolation: 2 kV
DIRECT INPUTS
Input points: 32
Remote devices: 16
Default states on loss of comms.: On, Off, Latest/Off, Latest/On
Ring configuration: Yes, No
Data rate: 64 or 128 kbps
CRC: 32-bit
CRC alarm:
Responding to: Rate of messages failing the CRC
Monitoring message count: 10 to 10000 in steps of 1
Alarm threshold: 1 to 1000 in steps of 1
Unreturned message alarm:
Responding to: Rate of unreturned messages in the ring configuration
Monitoring message count: 10 to 10000 in steps of 1
Alarm threshold: 1 to 1000 in steps of 1
TELEPROTECTION
Input points: 16
Remote devices: 3
Default states on loss of comms.: On, Off, Latest/Off, Latest/On
Ring configuration: No
Data rate: 64 or 128 kbps
CRC: 32-bit
HIGH RANGE
Nominal DC voltage: 125 to 250 V
Minimum DC voltage: 88 V
Maximum DC voltage: 300 V
Nominal AC voltage: 100 to 240 V at 50/60 Hz
Minimum AC voltage: 88 V at 25 to 100 Hz
Maximum AC voltage: 265 V at 25 to 100 Hz
Voltage loss hold-up: 200 ms duration at maximum load
ALL RANGES
Volt withstand: 2 Highest Nominal Voltage for 10 ms
Power consumption: typical = 15 to 20 W/VA
maximum = 45 W/VA
contact factory for exact order code consumption
INTERNAL FUSE
Ratings:
Low range power supply: 8 A / 250 V
High range power supply: 4 A / 250 V
Interrupting capacity:
AC: 100 000 A RMS symmetrical
DC: 10 000 A
2.5.7 Outputs
FORM-A RELAY
Make and carry for 0.2 s: 30 A as per ANSI C37.90
Carry continuous: 6A
Break (DC inductive, L/R = 40 ms):
Voltage Current
24 V 1A
48 V 0.5 A
125 V 0.3 A
250 V 0.2 A
LATCHING RELAY
Make and carry for 0.2 s: 30 A as per ANSI C37.90
Carry continuous: 6 A as per IEEE C37.90
Break (DC resistive as per IEC 61810-1):
Voltage Current
24 V 6A
48 V 1.6 A
2 125 V
250 V
0.4 A
0.2 A
Voltage Current
24 V 1A
48 V 0.5 A
125 V 0.3 A
250 V 0.2 A
DIRECT OUTPUTS
Output points: 32
DCMA OUTPUTS
Range: –1 to 1 mA, 0 to 1 mA, 4 to 20 mA
Max. load resistance: 12 k for –1 to 1 mA range
12 k for 0 to 1 mA range
600 for 4 to 20 mA range
Accuracy: ±0.75% of full-scale for 0 to 1 mA range
±0.5% of full-scale for –1 to 1 mA range
±0.75% of full-scale for 0 to 20 mA range
99% Settling time to a step change: 100 ms
Isolation: 1.5 kV
Driving signal: any FlexAnalog quantity
Upper and lower limit for the driving signal: –90 to 90 pu in steps of 0.001
RS485
1 rear port: up to 115 kbps, Modbus RTU, DNP 3, IEC 60870-5-103
Typical distance: 1200 m
Isolation: 2 kV, isolated together at 36 Vpk
OTHER
TFTP, SFTP, HTTP, IEC 60870-5-104, Ethernet Global Data (EGD), IEEE C37.118
RS422 distance is based on transmitter power and does not take into consideration the clock source provided by
2
the user.
Emitter, fiber type Cable type Transmit power Received Power budget Maximum
sensitivity optical input
power
820 nm, Multimode 62.5/125 μm -16 dBm -32 dBm 16 dBm -8 dBm
50/125 μm -20 dBm 12 dBm
1300 nm, Multimode 62.5/125 μm -16 dBm -32 dBm 16 dBm -8 dBm
50/125 μm -20 dBm 12 dBm
1300 nm, Single 9/125 μm -15 dBm -32 dBm 17 dBm -8 dBm
mode
1300 nm Laser, 9/125 μm 0 dBm -34 dBm 34 dBm -8 dBm
Single mode
1550 nm Laser, 9/125 μm 5 dBm -34 dBm 39 dBm -10 dBm
Single mode
The following specifications apply to filter interface modules implemented before January 2012.
The power budgets are calculated from the manufacturer’s worst-case transmitter power and worst case receiver
sensitivity.
The power budgets for the 1300 nm ELED are calculated from the manufacturer's transmitter power and receiver
sensitivity at ambient temperature. At extreme temperatures these values deviate based on component tolerance.
On average, the output power decreases as the temperature is increased by a factor of 1 dB / 5 °C.
2 1300 nm LED,
multimode
62.5/125 μm
50/125 μm
ST
ST
4 km
4 km
5 km
5 km
1300 nm ELED, 9/125 μm ST 11.4 km 20 km
single mode
1300 nm Laser, 9/125 μm ST 64 km 65 km
single mode
1550 nm Laser, 9/125 μm ST 105 km 125 km
single mode
Typical distances listed are based on the following assumptions for system loss. As actual losses vary from one
installation to another, the distance covered by your system can vary.
FIBER LOSSES
820 nm multimode: 3 dB/km
1300 nm multimode: 1 dB/km
1300 nm single mode: 0.35 dB/km
1550 nm single mode: 0.25 dB/km
Splice losses: one splice every 2 km at 0.05 dB loss per splice
SYSTEM MARGIN
3 dB additional loss added to calculations to compensate for all other losses.
Compensated difference in transmitting and receiving (channel asymmetry) channel delays using GPS satellite clock: 10 ms
LED INDICATORS
Functions: 5 device status indicators
9 event cause indicators
8 user-programmable pushbutton indicators
PUSHBUTTONS
Type: membrane
Functions: 5 bottom Tab pushbuttons and 1 Home pushbutton for page recall
4 directional, 1 ENTER, and 1 ESCAPE pushbutton element selection
10 side pushbuttons for power system element control 2
RESET pushbutton
INGRESS PROTECTION
IP code: IP40 front (IP54 front with IP54 mounting collar accessory)
IP10 back (IP20 back with IP20 cover accessory)
2.5.12 Environmental
AMBIENT TEMPERATURES
Maximum operating range: –40 to 85°C
Continuous operating range: –40 to 60°C1
1 Based on IEC 60068-2-1 and IEC 60068-2-2, Variant Bd and Ad for 16 hrs. The UR can operate up to a surrounding ambient of 85°C,
however operating outside the recommended continuous temperature range for extended periods can result in MTBF degradation and
decrease the response time of the LCD.
HUMIDITY
Humidity: operating up to 95% (non-condensing) at 55°C (as per IEC 60068-2-30 variant 1, 6 days)
OTHER
Altitude: 2000 m (maximum)
Pollution degree: II
Overvoltage category: II
Ingress protection: IP20 front, IP10 back (basic front panel and Rev. 1 enhanced front panel)
IP40 front, IP10 back (Rev. 2 enhanced front panel)
IP54 front with IP54 mounting collar accessory (Rev. 2 enhanced front panel)
Ingress protection with IP20 cover accessory:
IP20 back
Noise: 0 dB
2 Damped oscillatory
Electrostatic discharge
IEC 61000-4-18 / IEC 60255-22-1
EN 61000-4-2 / IEC 60255-22-2
2.5 kV CM, 1 kV DM
Level 3
RF immunity EN 61000-4-3 / IEC 60255-22-3 Level 3
Fast transient disturbance EN 61000-4-4 / IEC 60255-22-4 Class A and B
Surge immunity EN 61000-4-5 / IEC 60255-22-5 Level 3 and 4
Conducted RF immunity EN 61000-4-6 / IEC 60255-22-6 Level 3
1
Power frequency immunity EN 61000-4-7 / IEC 60255-22-7 Class A and B
Voltage interruption and ripple DC IEC 60255-11 12% ripple, 200 ms interrupts
Radiated and conducted emissions CISPR11 / CISPR22 / IEC 60255-25 Class A
Sinusoidal vibration IEC 60255-21-1 Class 1
Shock and bump IEC 60255-21-2 Class 1
Seismic IEC 60255-21-3 Class 1
Power magnetic immunity IEC 61000-4-8 Level 5
Pulse magnetic immunity IEC 61000-4-9 Level 4
Damped magnetic immunity IEC 61000-4-10 Level 4
Voltage dip and interruption IEC 61000-4-11 0, 40, 70, 80% dips; 250 / 300 cycle interrupts
Damped oscillatory IEC 61000-4-121 2.5 kV CM, 1 kV DM
Conducted RF immunity, 0 to 150 kHz IEC 61000-4-16 Level 4
Voltage ripple IEC 61000-4-17 15% ripple
1
Ingress protection IEC 60529 IP20 front, IP10 back
Cold IEC 60068-2-1 –40°C for 16 hours
Hot IEC 60068-2-2 85°C for 16 hours
Humidity IEC 60068-2-30 6 days, variant 1
Damped oscillatory IEEE/ANSI C37.90.1 2.5 kV, 1 MHz
RF immunity IEEE/ANSI C37.90.2 20 V/m, 80 MHz to 1 GHz
Safety UL 508 e83849 NKCR
Section 43 - Temperature test
Energization of Contact Inputs and/or Contact
Outputs for continuous duty is not to exceed a
total of 31 W of power
Safety UL C22.2-14 e83849 NKCR7
Safety UL 1053 e83849 NKCR
Safety IEC 60255-27 Insulation: class 1, Pollution degree: 2, Over
voltage cat II
2.5.15 Approvals
APPROVALS
Compliance Applicable council directive According to
CE Low voltage directive EN 60255-5
EMC directive EN 60255-26 / EN 50263
EN 61000-6-5
C-UL-US --- UL 508
UL 1053
2
C22.2 No. 14
2.5.16 Maintenance
MOUNTING
Attach mounting brackets using 20 inch-pounds (±2 inch-pounds) of torque.
CLEANING
Normally, cleaning is not required. When dust has accumulated on the front panel display, wipe with a dry cloth.
To avoid deterioration of electrolytic capacitors, power up units that are stored in a de-energized
state once per year, for one hour continuously.
Chapter 3: Installation
Installation
This chapter outlines installation of hardware and software. You unpack, mount, wire the unit, turn on power, then install
the software and configure settings.
Model: M60D00HCHF8AH6AM6BP8BX7A
M60
RATINGS:
Mods: 000
Control Power: 88-300V DC @ 35W / 77-265V AC @ 35VA
Motor Management Relay Contact Inputs: 300V DC Max 10mA
Wiring Diagram:
Inst. Manual:
See manual
1601-0108
Contact Outputs: Refer to Instruction Manual Serial Number: MAZB98000029
E83849 Firmware: D
GE Multilin Mfg. Date: NOV 26, 2012
- M A A B 9 7 0 0 0 0 9 9 -
PO Num: 600001234.56
Item Num:
LISTED
IND.CONT. EQ.
52TL - M A A B 9 7 0 0 0 0 9 9 -
833722A3.CDR
4. Any protective plastic film on the front panel is normally peeled off, but also can be left on.
5. For any issues, contact GE as outlined in the For Further Assistance section in chapter 1.
6. Check that you have the latest copy of the M60 Instruction Manual and the UR Family Communications Guide, for the
applicable firmware version, at http://www.gegridsolutions.com/multilin/manuals/index.htm
The Instruction Manual outlines how to install, configure, and use the unit. The Communications Guide is for advanced use
with communication protocols. The warranty is included at the end of this instruction manual and on the GE Grid Solutions
website.
11.016”
[279,81 mm]
9.687”
[246,05 mm]
17.56”
[446,02 mm]
3
7.460”
[189,48 mm]
6.995” 6.960”
[177,67 mm] [176,78 mm]
19.040”
[483,62 mm] 842807A1.CDR
9.687”
[24.605 cm] 10.97”
[27.86 cm]
6.995” 6.96”
[17.767 cm] [17.68 cm]
7.13” 4.000”
[181.1 mm] [101,60 mm]
17.750”
[450,85 mm] 842808A2.CDR
BEZEL OUTLINE
8x0.156”
(9.5 mm)
0.375”
(3.962 mm)
(47.6 mm)
10.90”
1.875”
8.97”
(227.8 mm) (276.8 mm)
9.80”
(248.9 mm) 6.960”
(9.5 mm)
0.375”
(176.8 mm)
(121.5 mm)
4.785”
0.375”
17.52” Brackets repositioned (9.5 mm)
(445.0 mm) for switchgear mounting 5.000” 0.375”
(127.0 mm)
9.520” (9.5 mm)
14.520” (241.8 mm)
CUTOUT
7.13” 4.00”
(181.1 mm) (101.6 mm) 7.00”
(177.8 mm)
17.75” 19.00”
(450.8 mm) (482.6 mm)
827704B5.cdr
µ
>PP@
´
>PP@
µ µ
>PP@ >PP@
µ
>PP@
$FGU
MOUNTING PANEL
8.34”
[21.18 cm]
7.65”
[19.43 cm]
IP54 COLLAR
NOTES
1. INSPECT THE COLLAR BEFORE INSTALLATION, VERIFY GASKET IS ADHERED TO THE METAL ON ALL SIDES
2. MAKE SURE THE RELAY IS POSITIONED CENTER TO THE CUT OUT
3. INSTALL IP-54 COLLAR, CONFIRM THE GASKET PROPERLY MATES WITH THE PANEL ON ALL SIDES
SECURE USING #8-32 HEX NUT AT 6 PLACES. 842497A1.cdr
)URQW
%H]HO
µ
µ PP
PP
3
9HUWLFDO(QKDQFHG6LGH9LHZ
)URQWRI3DQHO
9HUWLFDO(QKDQFHG)URQW9LHZ µ
PP
µ µ
PP PP µ
µ PP
PP
7HUPLQDO%ORFNV
µ
µ PP &87287
PP
)URQWRI3DQHO
5HIHUHQFHRQO\ µ
PP
µ
PP
0RXQWLQJ%UDFNHW
9HUWLFDO(QKDQFHG7RS9LHZ
µ PP
3ODFHV 9HUWLFDO(QKDQFHG0RXQWLQJ3DQHO
$FGU
)URQW
EH]HO
PP PP
9HUWLFDOVLGHYLHZ
9HUWLFDOIURQWYLHZ
µ
PP
PP
µ µ
PP PP
3DQHOVKRZQIRU
UHIHUHQFHRQO\
PP 0RXQWLQJEUDFNHW
PP
PP
µ
µ
7HUPLQDOEORFNV
PP
9HUWLFDOERWWRPYLHZ
PP
SODFHV
$&'5 9HUWLFDOSDQHOPRXQWLQJ
For side-mounting M60 devices with the enhanced front panel, see the following documents available on the UR DVD and
the GE Grid Solutions website:
• GEK-113180 — UR-Series UR-V Side-Mounting Front Panel Assembly Instructions
• GEK-113181 — Connecting a Remote UR-V Enhanced Front Panel to a Vertical UR Device Instruction Sheet
• GEK-113182 — Connecting a Remote UR-V Enhanced Front Panel to a Vertically-Mounted Horizontal UR Device
Instruction Sheet
DISPLAY CABLE
#10-32 NYLOCK
NUT
P/N: 1422-1032
For side-mounting M60 devices with the basic front panel, use the following figures.
3-9
PANEL CUTOUTS
3
PANEL CUTOUTS CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION
6.66"
(169.2)
5.33"
(135.4)
INCHES
(MILLIMETERS) 2.83"
1.00"
(71.9)
(25.4)
PANEL SHOWN FOR
0.68" 0.04" 1.33" REFERENCE ONLY
(17.3) (1.0) (33.9) (VIEWED FROM FRONT)
3 'X' 'X'
1.00"
(25.4)
OUT
T-
CU
5.27"
(133.8)
12.20"
(309.9)
'X' 'X'
Ground
Model: M60D00HCHF8AH6AM6BP8BX7A
M60
RATINGS:
Mods: 000
Control Power: 88-300V DC @ 35W / 77-265V AC @ 35VA
Motor Management Relay Contact Inputs: 300V DC Max 10mA
Wiring Diagram:
Inst. Manual:
See manual
1601-0108
Contact Outputs: Refer to Instruction Manual Serial Number: MAZB98000029
E83849 Firmware: D
GE Multilin Mfg. Date: NOV 26, 2012
- M A A B 9 7 0 0 0 0 9 9 -
PO Num: 600001234.56
Item Num:
LISTED
IND.CONT. EQ.
52TL - M A A B 9 7 0 0 0 0 9 9 -
X W V U T S R P N M L K J H G F D B
c b a c b a c b a c b a
b a
LK1
Tx1 1
1
2
Rx1
ACT1
2
3
LK2
3
Tx1
4
4
5
Tx2 b a
ACT2 5
6
3
1
1
2 LK3
2 6
3
Rx2 3 7
4
4 7
8
Tx2 ACT3 8
IN
Do not touch any rear terminals while the relay is energized, else death or serious injury can
result from electrical shock.
Small form-factor pluggable ports (SFPs) are pluggable transceivers. They transmit, receive, and
convert electrical signals to optical signals and vice-versa. Supplied with the device, they are
inserted into the Ethernet ports on the CPU and/or Process Bus modules. A photo in the Maintenance
chapter shows this plug-in device. Do not use non-validated transceivers or install validated
transceivers in the wrong Ethernet slot, else damage can occur.
When using a copper SFP with a Process Bus Module, GE recommends limiting the length of the
copper Ethernet cable to three meters (9.8 feet) and confining it within one bay/cubicle.
When using a Process Bus Module, to view if the SFP is 100 Mbps or 1 Gbps, enter the IP address of
the M60 in a web browser and access Process Card Menu > Process Card SFP Information.
Terminal number assignments are three characters long and assigned by module slot position, row number, and column
letter. Two-slot wide modules take their slot designation from the first slot position (nearest to CPU module), indicated by
an arrow on the terminal block. The figure shows an example of rear terminal assignments.
J H G F Slot position
c b a c b a Column letter
Torque 9 inch-pounds
842761A2.CDR
The torque used to connect the screws that connect the terminal blocks (top screws a, b, c) and the metal plates over
empty slots to the chassis is 9 inch-pounds. For the screws used to wire the terminal blocks (rows 1 to 8), use 19±1 inch-
pounds.
The CPU module type depends on order code. During manufacturing, the power supply and CPU modules are installed in
slots B and D of the chassis with 13 inch-pounds of torque on the screws at the top and bottom of the modules. Wire
connections to these two modules at 13 inch-pounds.
Figure 3-12: CPU modules and power supply
E D
/. /. /.
5-
/& FRSSHU
ILEHU
$&7 $&7 $&7 /LQN
/. /. /. $FWLYLW\
E D
$&7
E D
$&7
E D
$&7
E D
/. /. /.
%1&
67
IRU $&7 $&7 $&7 ILEHU
,5,*%
,1 ,1 ,1 ,1
The following figure shows the optical connectors for CPU modules.
Speeds for the LC connections on non-HardFiber Process Bus Modules are as follows:
• Order code 85 — 1000Base-SX ports 1a and 1b, or ports 3a and 3b
• Order code 86 — 1000Base-SX ports 1a, 1b, 3a, 3b; 100Base-FX ports 2a, 2b, 4a, 4b
• Order code 87 — 100Base-FX ports 1a, 1b, 2a, 2b 3
3.3 Wiring
3.3.1 Typical wiring
For Sampled Value (SV) applications using a Process Bus Module with order code 85, 86, or 87 with IRIG-B for
synchronization, follow the recommended cables and grounding connections outlined here and later.
%
&
)XVH *URXQG
LVRODWLRQ
OLQN
0D
0D
0D
0D
0E
0E
0E
0E
0F
0F
0F
0F
)D
)D
)D
)D
)D
)D
)D
)E
)E
)E
)E
)F
)F
)F
)F
)F
)F
)F
9%
9&
9$
,*
,*
9%
9&
,*
,*
,*
9$
,*
,$
,$
,%
,&
,$
,&
,&
,%
,%
,$
,$
,%
,&
,$
,&
,&
,%
,%
&855(17683(59,6,21
92/7$*($1'
92/7$*(,13876 &855(17,13876 &855(17,13876
)* )*
3D &217$&7,13873D ',*,7$/,138762873876 * , 3D 7&
3F &217$&7,13873F 3 3E
9
3D &217$&7,13873D 3F
3F &217$&7,13873F , 3D
3E &200213E 3 3E
92/7$*(683(59,6,21
9
3F
3D &217$&7,13873D
, 3D
3F &217$&7,13873F
3 3E 7&
3D &217$&7,13873D 9
3F
3F &217$&7,13873F
, 3D
3E &200213E
3 3E
9
3E 685*( 3F
+D +RW
&
57'+
+F &RPS
'%
+E 5HWXUQ IRU57'V+DQG+
56
+D +RW IURQW
'&21/<
57'+
+F &RPS
+D +RW
57'+
+F &RPS
3RZHU
+E 685*( VXSSO\
%
%E
&5,7,&$/
%D )$,/85(
%E ' &38
%D 9'&
'& 287387
%E
)
32:(56833/<
%E +,
&21752/ &797
$&RU'& %E /2 *
32:(5
%D
%D 685*( +
%E ),/7(5 57'
-
2SWLF
)LEUH 7[ %DVH);
3257
.
&387
5[
/
7[ %DVH); &217$&766+2:1
3257
5[ :,7+12 0
6KLHOGHG 7[ %DVH); &21752/32:(5 &797
*URXQGDW 5[
3257 1
WZLVWHGSDLUV
85
'D 3
'HYLFH
56 ,QSXWV
'D &20 5 RXWSXWV
'D FRP
'E 6
'D ,5,*%
5HDUYLHZ
,QSXW
&RD[LDO %1& 9(57,&$/
02'8/($55$1*(0(17
$&'5
+25,=217$/02'8/($55$1*(0(17
; : 9 8 7 6 5 3 1 0 / . - + * ) ' %
7KLVGLDJUDPLVEDVHGRQWKHIROORZLQJRUGHUFRGH
1R$:* 07+&+))+&0)3*8;;:;;
PLQLPXP ,QSXW 97&7 57' 97&7 &38 3RZHU 7KLVGLDJUDPSURYLGHVDQH[DPSOHRIKRZWKHGHYLFH
02'8/(60867%(
RXWSXW 6XSSO\
*5281'(',) LVZLUHGQRWVSHFLILFDOO\KRZWRZLUHWKHGHYLFH3OHDVH
*5281'
%86
7(50,1$/,6 5HDU9LHZ UHIHUWRWKH,QVWUXFWLRQ0DQXDOIRUDGGLWLRQDOGHWDLOVRQ
3529,'('
2SWLRQDO ZLULQJEDVHGRQYDULRXVFRQILJXUDWLRQV
+F S
+E 5HWXUQ IRU57'V+DQG+
+RWWHVW
6WDWRU 56 +D +RW
57'+
57' +F &RPS
57'
+D +RW
57'+
+F &RPS
$1$/2*
2873876
&RP FSP
237,21,2
6KLHOG +E 5HWXUQ IRU57'V+DQG+
VKOG 0(7(5
6KLHOG +D +RW
57'+
+F &RPS
3/&
75$16'8&(5,138762873876
) +E 685*(
%E
557' &5,7,&$/
%D )$,/85(
5HPRWH57'0RGXOH %E
%D 9'&
'& 287387
%E
&+$11(/ &+$11(/ &+$11(/
%E +,
%E ),/7(5
$&'5 +25,=217$/0
; : 9 8 7 6 5 3 1 0
1R$:*
PLQLPXP ,QSXW 97&
02'8/(60867%(
RXWSXW
Figure 3-15: Typical wiring with remote RTD unit
*5281'(',)
*5281'
7(50,1$/,6
%86
3529,'('
2SWLRQDO
$&'5
3-15
WIRING
3
WIRING CHAPTER 3: INSTALLATION
Filter networks and transient protection clamps are used in the hardware to prevent damage caused
by high peak voltage transients, radio frequency interference (RFI), and electromagnetic interference
(EMI). These protective components can be damaged by application of the ANSI/IEEE C37.90
specified test voltage for longer than the specified minute.
Power supplied to the relay must be connected to the matching power supply range of the relay. If
incorrect voltage is applied or voltage is applied to the wrong terminals, damage can occur.
The M60, like almost all electronic relays, contains electrolytic capacitors. These capacitors are well-
known to deteriorate over time if voltage is not applied periodically. Deterioration can be avoided by
powering up the relay at least once a year.
The power supply module is ordered with one of two possible voltage ranges, and the M60 can be ordered with or without
a redundant power supply module option. Each range has a dedicated input connection for proper operation. The ranges
are as follows (see the Specifications section of chapter 2 for details):
• Low (LO) range — 24 to 48 V (DC only) nominal
• High (HI) range — 125 to 250 V nominal
The power supply module provides power to the relay and supplies power for dry contact input connections.
The power supply module provides 48 V DC power for dry contact input connections and a critical failure relay (see the
Typical Wiring Diagram earlier). The critical failure relay is a form-C device that is energized once control power is applied
and the relay has successfully booted up with no critical self-test failures. If ongoing self-test diagnostic checks detect a
critical failure (see the Self-Test Errors section in chapter 7) or control power is lost, the relay de-energizes.
Connect all wires at the back of a UR before connecting to power, else death or serious injury can
result from electrical shock.
127(
$&RU'& JDXJHVWUDQGHG
ZLUHZLWKVXLWDEOH
GLVFRQQHFWGHYLFHV
LVUHFRPPHQGHG
+HDY\FRSSHUFRQGXFWRU )XVHV
RUEUDLGHGZLUH
$&'5
Channels 4 and 8 are intended for connection to a single-phase source. For voltage inputs, these channels are labelled as
auxiliary voltage (VX). For current inputs, these channels are intended for connection to a CT between system neutral and
ground, and are labelled as ground current (IG).
Verify that the connection made to the relay terminals for nominal current of 1 A or 5 A matches the
secondary rating of the connected CTs. Unmatched CTs can result in equipment damage or
inadequate protection.
To connect to the module, size 12 American Wire Gauge (AWG) is used commonly; the maximum size is 10 AWG.
CT/VT modules can be ordered with a standard ground current input that is the same as the phase current input. Each AC
current input has an isolating transformer and an automatic shorting mechanism that shorts the input when the module is
withdrawn from the chassis. There are no internal ground connections on the current inputs. Current transformers with 1
to 50000 A primaries and 1 A or 5 A secondaries can be used.
3 CT/VT modules with a sensitive ground input are also available. The ground CT input of the sensitive ground modules is 10
times more sensitive than the ground CT input of standard CT/VT modules. However, the phase CT inputs and phase VT
inputs are the same as those of regular CT/VT modules.
These modules have enhanced diagnostics that can detect automatically CT/VT hardware failure and take the relay out of
service.
CT connections for both ABC and ACB phase rotations are identical, as shown in the Typical Wiring Diagram.
The exact placement of a zero-sequence core balance CT to detect ground fault current is shown as follows. Twisted-pair
cabling on the zero-sequence CT is recommended.
Figure 3-17: Zero-sequence core balance CT installation
UNSHIELDED CABLE SHIELDED CABLE
Ground connection to neutral
Stress cone
Source must be on the source side Source shields
A B C N G A B C
Ground
outside CT
To ground;
LOAD must be on
load side
LOAD 996630A6.CDR
The phase voltage channels are used for most metering and protection purposes. The auxiliary voltage channel is used as
input for the synchrocheck and volts-per-hertz features, which are optional features for some UR models.
Substitute the tilde “~” symbol with the slot position of the module in the following figure.
IA5 ~ 1a
IA ~ 1b
IA1 ~ 1c
IB5 ~ 2a
IA5 ~1a IB ~ 2b
IA ~1b IB1 ~ 2c
IB5 ~2a IC ~ 3b
IB ~2b IC1 ~ 3c
3
Current inputs
IC5 ~3a IG ~ 4b
Current inputs
IC ~3b IG1 ~ 4c
IG5 ~4a IA ~ 5b
IG ~4b IA1 ~ 5c
VA ~5a IB ~ 6b
VA ~5c IB1 ~ 6c
VB ~6a IC5 ~ 7a
Voltage inputs
VB ~6c IC ~ 7b
VC ~7a IC1 ~ 7c
VC ~7c IG5 ~ 8a
VX ~8a IG ~ 8b
VX ~8c IG1 ~ 8c
842766A4.CDR
Figure 3-19: Form-A and solid-state contact outputs with voltage and current monitoring
~#a ~#a
I I
~#b ~#b Load
V Load V
~#c + ~#c +
a) Voltage with optional
Voltage monitoring only Both voltage and current monitoring
current monitoring
~#a ~#a
V V
I ~#b
Load
I ~#b Load
3
~#c + ~#c +
b) Current with optional
Current monitoring only Both voltage and current monitoring
voltage monitoring
(external jumper a-b is required)
~#a
~#b
Load
~#c +
c) No monitoring
827862A5.CDR
The operation of voltage and current monitors is reflected with the corresponding FlexLogic operands (CONT OP # VON, CONT
OP # VOFF, and CONT OP # ION) that can be used in protection, control, and alarm logic. The typical application of the voltage
monitor is breaker trip circuit integrity monitoring; a typical application of the current monitor is seal-in of the control
command.
See the Digital Elements section of chapter 5 for an example of how form-A and solid-state relay contacts can be applied
for breaker trip circuit integrity monitoring.
Consider relay contacts unsafe to touch when the unit is energized. Death or serious injury can
result from touching live relay contacts.
Where a tilde “~” symbol appears, substitute the slot position of the module. Where a number sign “#” appears,
substitute the contact number.
When current monitoring is used to seal-in the form-A and solid-state relay contact outputs, give the
FlexLogic operand driving the contact output a reset delay of 10 ms to prevent damage of the output
contact (in situations when the element initiating the contact output is bouncing, at values in the
region of the pickup value).
For high-density input/output modules 6W and 6X, use the following guidelines to connect. The new I/O modules use pin
type terminal blocks instead of the current ring type. The new terminals are required to achieve higher I/O count per
module.
• 12 to 24 AWG (3.3 mm2 to 0.2 mm2), single wire termination
• 16 to 24 AWG (1.31 mm2 to 0.2 mm2), multiple wire termination with matching wire sizes and stranding. Two wires
maximum per circuit.
• Suggested wiring screw tightening torque is a minimum 4.43 in-lb (0.5 Nm) and maximum 5.31 in-lb (0.6 Nm)
3 •
•
Minimum suggested temperature rating for the conductors is 75°C
Wire type: copper
Table 3-3: Contact input and output module assignments
~6A module ~6B module ~6C module ~6D module
Terminal Output or Terminal Output or Terminal Output Terminal Output
assignment input assignment input assignment assignment
~1 Form-A ~1 Form-A ~1 Form-C ~1a, ~1c 2 Inputs
~2 Form-A ~2 Form-A ~2 Form-C ~2a, ~2c 2 Inputs
~3 Form-C ~3 Form-C ~3 Form-C ~3a, ~3c 2 Inputs
~4 Form-C ~4 Form-C ~4 Form-C ~4a, ~4c 2 Inputs
~5a, ~5c 2 Inputs ~5 Form-C ~5 Form-C ~5a, ~5c 2 Inputs
~6a, ~6c 2 Inputs ~6 Form-C ~6 Form-C ~6a, ~6c 2 Inputs
~7a, ~7c 2 Inputs ~7a, ~7c 2 Inputs ~7 Form-C ~7a, ~7c 2 Inputs
~8a, ~8c 2 Inputs ~8a, ~8c 2 Inputs ~8 Form-C ~8a, ~8c 2 Inputs
3 assignment
~1 Form-A
assignment
~1 Not Used
assignment
~1 Not Used
assignment
~1 Not Used
~2 Form-A ~2 Solid-State ~2 Solid-State ~2 Solid-State
~3 Form-A ~3 Not Used ~3 Not Used ~3 Not Used
~4 Form-A ~4 Solid-State ~4 Solid-State ~4 Solid-State
~5 Form-A ~5 Not Used ~5 Not Used ~5 Not Used
~6 Form-A ~6 Solid-State ~6 Solid-State ~6 Solid-State
~7 Form-A ~7 Not Used ~7 Not Used ~7 Not Used
~8 Form-A ~8 Solid-State ~8 Solid-State ~8 Solid-State
842762A4.CDR
.
, ,
a E a a F a
&217$&7,1F a a E a F a
&217$&7,1F a a E
a F a D a
&217$&7,1D a F a D a
&217$&7,1D a F
a D a F a
&217$&7,1F 9 a D a F a
&217$&7,1F 9 a D
, ,
a E a a E a
&20021E a a E a E a
&20021E a a E
a F a F a F
a D a
&217$&7,1D a E 685*(
a D a D a D
a F a
&217$&7,1F
a E a a a E a a E
a D a
&217$&7,1D
a F a F a F
a F a
&217$&7,1F
a D a D a D
a E a
&20021E
a E a a a E a a E
a F a E 685*( a F a F
a D a D
a E a a a E
a F a F
a D a D
a E a a a E
a F a F
a D
',*,7$/,2
a E a
a F
a D
3
a E a
a F
a D a
&217$&7,1D ',*,7$/,2 1 9 a D a D a
&217$&7,1D ',*,7$/,2 3 9 a D
, ,
a F a
&217$&7,1F a a E a F a
&217$&7,1F a a E
a D a
&217$&7,1D a F a D a
&217$&7,1D a F
a F a
&217$&7,1F 9 a D a F a
&217$&7,1F 9 a D
, ,
a E a
&20021E a a E a E a
&20021E a a E
a F a F
a D a
&217$&7,1D a E 685*(
9 a D 9 a D
a F a
&217$&7,1F , ,
a a E a a E
a D a
&217$&7,1D
a F a F
a F a
&217$&7,1F
9 a D 9 a D
a E a
&20021E , ,
a a E a a E
a E 685*( a F a F
9 a D
,
a a E
a F
a D a
&217$&7,1D ',*,7$/,2 5 a D 9 a D
,
a F a
&217$&7,1F a a E a a E
a D a
&217$&7,1D a F a F
a F a
&217$&7,1F a D
a E a
&20021E a a E
a F
a D a
&217$&7,1D
a D a D a
&217$&7,1D ',*,7$/,2 6 a D
a F a
&217$&7,1F
a a E a F a
&217$&7,1F a a E
a D a
&217$&7,1D
a F a D a
&217$&7,1D a F
a F a
&217$&7,1F
a D a F a
&217$&7,1F a D
a E a
&20021E
a a E a E a
&20021E a a E
a E 685*( a F a F
a E 685*(
a D
a a E
a F
a D a
&217$&7,1D ',*,7$/,2 7 a D a D
a F a
&217$&7,1F a a E a a E
a D a
&217$&7,1D a F a F
a F a
&217$&7,1F a D a D
a E a
&20021E a a E a a E
a F a F
a D a
&217$&7,1D
a D a D
a F a
&217$&7,1F
a a E a a E
a D a
&217$&7,1D
a F a F
a F a
&217$&7,1F
a D
a E a
&20021E
a a E
a E 685*( a F
a D a
&217$&7,1D ',*,7$/,2 8 a D
a F a
&217$&7,1F a a E
a D a
&217$&7,1D a F
a D a
&217$&7,1D ',*,7$/,2 9 9 a D
, a F a
&217$&7,1F a D
a F a
&217$&7,1F a a E
a E a
&20021E a a E
a D a
&217$&7,1D a F
a F
a F a
&217$&7,1F 9 a D a E 685*(
, a D
a E a
&20021E a a E
a a E
a F
a D a
&217$&7,1D a F
a D
a F a
&217$&7,1F a D
a a E
a D a
&217$&7,1D a a E
a F
a F a
&217$&7,1F a F
a D
a E a
&20021E a D a D
a E
a F a a E
a E 685*( a F
a F
a D
a a E
a F
$&'5
For proper functionality, observe the polarity shown in the figures for all contact input and output 3
connections.
B1b
B1a Critical failure
B2b
Power supply module
B3a
48 V DC output
B3b
B5b HI+
B6b LO+ Control power
B6a
B8a Surge
B8b Filter
827741A5.CDR
Where a tilde “~” symbol appears, substitute the slot position of the module.
There is no provision in the relay to detect a DC ground fault on 48 V DC control power external output. We recommend
using an external DC supply.
$POUBDU*OQVU
$FGU
The presence of the impedance path (R1) across the contact output allows the stray (distributed) capacitance C1 to charge
as shown, thus developing a voltage across the contact input enough to momentarily operate the input while the
capacitance discharges in the presence of DC ground on the positive terminal of the battery.
The duration of the discharge depends on the value of the distributed capacitance, the initial voltage of the distributed
capacitance, and the input impedance of the contact input. If the duration is greater than the debounce time setting, then
the contact input operates.
The application example that follows describes how to mitigate this issue by connecting a resistor across the contact
input, as shown in the next figure, or by adjusting the debounce time setting to a value greater than the discharge time to
prevent spurious operation of the contact input only if the voltage (with output open) across the contact input due to trickle
current is less than the threshold voltage. This operation of contact inputs also can be prevented by using the Auto-Burnish
contact inputs or contact inputs with active impedance.
Figure 3-25: Contact input connected to a contact output with resistor (R2) across the input
$POUBDU*OQVU
3
$FGU
Application example
This example is for illustrative purposes only and the calculations present the worst-case scenario. In practice, the value of
debounce time can be lower.
Contact input ON state impedance used in the calculation of the discharge period is based on the following table.
Table 3-4: Discharge period
Battery voltage (V) Input impedance (kΩ)
130 50
250 97
50 to 70 mA
3 mA
Time
25 to 50 ms
842749A1.CDR
Regular contact inputs limit current to less than 3 mA to reduce station battery burden. In contrast, contact inputs with
auto-burnishing allow currents up to 50 to 70 mA at the first instance when the change of state is sensed. Then, within 25
to 50 ms, this current is slowly reduced to 3 mA as indicated. The 50 to 70 mA peak current burns any film on the contacts,
allowing for proper sensing of state changes. If the external device contact is bouncing, the auto-burnishing starts when
external device contact bouncing is over.
Another important difference between the auto-burnishing input module and the regular input modules is that only two
contact inputs have common ground, as opposed to four contact inputs sharing one common ground (see the Contact
Input and Output Module Wiring diagrams). This is beneficial when connecting contact inputs to separate voltage sources.
Consequently, the threshold voltage setting is also defined per group of two contact inputs.
The auto-burnish feature can be disabled or enabled using the DIP switches found on each daughter card. There is a DIP
switch for each contact, for a total of 16 inputs.
Figure 3-27: Auto-burnish DIP switches
&RQWDFWLQSXWDXWREXUQLVK 2II
3
&RQWDFWLQSXWDXWREXUQLVK 2II
&RQWDFWLQSXWDXWREXUQLVK 2Q
&RQWDFWLQSXWDXWREXUQLVK 2II
&RQWDFWLQSXWDXWREXUQLVK 2II
&RQWDFWLQSXWDXWREXUQLVK 2Q
&RQWDFWLQSXWDXWREXUQLVK 2Q
&RQWDFWLQSXWDXWREXUQLVK 2Q
$&'5
The auto-burnish circuitry has an internal fuse for safety purposes. During regular maintenance, check the auto-burnish
functionality using an oscilloscope.
30
84 V threshold
166 V threshold
17 V threshold
33 V threshold
e
at
st
e
25
nc
da
pe
im
w
Lo
20
3
Current (millamperes)
15
s
m
oh
K
10
10
166 V threshold
84 V threshold
33 V threshold
5 17 V threshold
Where a tilde “~” symbol appears, substitute the slot position of the module.
$&'5
+RW aD
57' a
&RPS aF
)RU57' a a 5HWXUQ aE 57'WHUPLQDOV
+RW aD
57' a
&RPS aF
3 57'
0D[LPXPWRWDOOHDGUHVLVWDQFH
RKPVIRU3ODWLQXP57'V
$&'5
1: N/A
2: (TXD)
3: (RXD)
RELAY
PERSONAL 4: N/A
COMPUTER 5: (SGND) Signal Ground
FRONT PANEL
6: N/A
PROGRAM PORT 7: N/A
8: N/A
9: N/A
9 PIN
RS232 RS232
D CONNECTOR D CONNECTOR
9 PIN 25 PIN
CONNECTOR CONNECTOR
3.3.9.1 Overview
There is a rear RS485 communication port on the CPU module.
The CPU module does not require a surge ground connection.
For Sampled Value (SV) applications using a Process Bus Module with order code 85, 86, or 87 with IRIG-B for
synchronization, follow the recommended cables and grounding connections. If using a Process Bus Module and IRIG-B as
the synchronizing source, GE recommends moving the grounding from the IRIG-B generator to UR terminal D4a in order to
better protect the IRIG-B input from long bursts of transient noise.
Figure 3-32: CPU module wiring when using a Process Bus Module
00ILEHU
3RUW
7
RSWLFFDEOH 7[ 5[ %DVH);
7[ 5[ %DVH); 3RUW
6KLHOGHGWZLVWHGSDLUFDEOH
7[ 5[ %DVH); 3RUW
'D
56
'D ³
&20
*URXQGDW 'D &20021
85 'E
GHYLFH
'D ³ ,5,*%
LQSXW
&38
%1&
&RD[LDOFDEOH
*URXQGFRD[LDOFDEOHXVLQJWHUPLQDO'D
3 6KLHOGHG(WKHUQHWFDEOH
8
%DVH7; 3RUW
00ILEHU
RSWLFFDEOH 7[ 5[ %DVH); 3RUW
7[ 5[ %DVH); 3RUW
6KLHOGHGWZLVWHGSDLUFDEOH
'D
56
'D ³
&20
*URXQGDW 'D &20021
85 'E
GHYLFH
'D ³ ,5,*%
LQSXW
&38
%1&
&RD[LDOFDEOH
*URXQGFRD[LDOFDEOHXVLQJWHUPLQDO'D
3RUW
9
%DVH7;
6KLHOGHG(WKHUQHWFDEOH
%DVH7; 3RUW
%DVH7; 3RUW
6KLHOGHGWZLVWHGSDLUFDEOH
'D
56
'D ³
&20
*URXQGDW 'D &20021
85 'E
GHYLFH
'D ³ ,5,*%
LQSXW &38
%1&
&RD[LDOFDEOH
*URXQGFRD[LDOFDEOHXVLQJWHUPLQDO'D
6KLHOGHG(WKHUQHWFDEOH
:
%DVH7; 3RUW
00ILEHU
RSWLFFDEOH
7[ 5[ %DVH); 3RUW
7[ 5[ %DVH); 3RUW
6KLHOGHGWZLVWHGSDLUFDEOH
'D
56
'D ³
&20
*URXQGDW 'D &20021
85 'E
GHYLFH
'D ³ ,5,*%
LQSXW
&38
%1&
&RD[LDOFDEOH
*URXQGFRD[LDOFDEOHXVLQJWHUPLQDO'D $&'5
If not using a Process Bus Module (order code 85, 86, 87), the following IRIG-B cable and ground connection is appropriate.
Figure 3-33: CPU module wiring for IRIG-B without Process Bus Module
00ILEHU
3RUW
7
RSWLFFDEOH 7[ 5[ %DVH);
7[ 5[ %DVH); 3RUW
6KLHOGHG 7[ 5[ %DVH); 3RUW
WZLVWHGSDLUV
'D
56
'D ³
&20
*URXQGDW 'D &20021
UHPRWH 'E
GHYLFH
'D ³ ,5,*%
LQSXW
&38
%1&
&RD[LDOFDEOH
8
%DVH7; 3RUW
7[ 5[ %DVH); 3RUW
6KLHOGHG 7[ 5[ %DVH); 3RUW
WZLVWHGSDLUV
'D
56
'D ³
&20
*URXQGDW 'D &20021
UHPRWH 'E
GHYLFH
'D ³ ,5,*%
LQSXW
&38
%1&
&RD[LDOFDEOH
3RUW
9
%DVH7;
%DVH7; 3RUW
6KLHOGHG %DVH7;
WZLVWHGSDLUV 3RUW
'D
56
'D ³
&20
*URXQGDW 'D &20021
UHPRWH 'E
GHYLFH
'D ³ ,5,*%
LQSXW
%1& &38
&RD[LDOFDEOH
$&'5
Lightning strikes and ground surge currents can cause large momentary voltage differences between remote ends of the
communication link. For this reason, surge protection devices are provided internally at both communication ports. An
isolated power supply with an optocoupled data interface also acts to reduce noise coupling. To ensure maximum
reliability, ensure that all equipment has similar transient protection devices installed.
Terminate both ends of the RS485 circuit with an impedance as shown in the figure.
Figure 3-34: RS485 serial connection
COM
3 COMP 485COM
COMP 485COM
Up to 32 devices,
maximum 4000 feet
(1200 m)
Relay
ZT (*)
RS485 +
RS485 –
3.3.10 IRIG-B
There is a round IRIG-B connector at the back of the CPU module, marked "IN." Use is optional.
IRIG-B is a standard time code format that allows stamping of events to be synchronized among connected devices. The
IRIG-B code allows time accuracies of up to 100 ns. The GE MultiSync 100 1588 GPS Clock as well as third-party equipment
are available for generating the IRIG-B signal. This equipment can use a global positioning system (GPS) satellite system to
obtain the time reference so that devices at different geographic locations can be synchronized. The IRIG time code
formats are serial, pulse width-modulated codes that can be either DC level shifted or amplitude modulated (AM). Using
IRIG-B input, the M60 operates an internal oscillator with 1 µs resolution and accuracy.
*36FRQQHFWLRQ *36VDWHOOLWHV\VWHP
85
,5,*% % ,5,*%
WLPHFRGHJHQHUDWRU $ ,5,*%²
5*FRD[LDOFDEOH 5HFHLYHU
'&VKLIWRU
%1&LQ
DPSOLWXGHPRGXODWHG
VLJQDOFDQEHXVHG
*36FRQQHFWLRQ *36VDWHOOLWHV\VWHP
,5,*%
WLPHFRGHJHQHUDWRU 85
6KLHOGHGWZLVWHGSDLUFDEOH
% ,5,*%
'&VKLIWRU
$ ,5,*%²
DPSOLWXGHPRGXODWHG
VLJQDOFDQEHXVHG 5HFHLYHU
%1&LQ
$&'5
Tx
UR 1
Rx
Tx
UR 2
Rx
Tx
UR 3
Rx
Tx
UR 4
3
Rx
842006A2.CDR
Inter-relay communication (IRC) modules with protocol C37.94 and G.703 are designed for back-to-back communication
connections, so the ring configuration shown in the previous figure does not apply. To establish inter-relay communication
in more than two URs, you need to have a two-channel IRC module and enable the DIRECT I/O CHANNEL CROSSOVER setting
in all relays, as shown in the next figure. This configuration can be expanded to 16 URs, and this configuration does not
provide a redundancy ring since both channels are made into a single ring by the channel crossover function. As per the
figure entitled Typical Pin Interconnection between Two G.703 Interfaces later in this chapter, the clock is supplied typically
by multiplexer (MUX) and all URs are in Loop Timing Mode. If there is no MUX, then UR1 and UR3 can be in Internal Timing
Mode and UR2 and UR4 can be in Loop Timing Mode. That is, connected channels must have opposite timing modes.
Figure 3-37: Ring configuration for C37.94 module (concept also applies to G.703)
$&'5
The interconnection for dual-channel type 7 communications modules is shown as follows. Two-channel modules allow
for a redundant ring configuration. That is, two rings can be created to provide an additional independent data path. The
required connections are: UR1-Tx1 to UR2-Rx1, UR2-Tx1 to UR3-Rx1, UR3-Tx1 to UR4-Rx1, and UR4-Tx1 to UR1-Rx1 for the
first ring; and UR1-Tx2 to UR4-Rx2, UR4-Tx2 to UR3-Rx2, UR3-Tx2 to UR2-Rx2, and UR2-Tx2 to UR1-Rx2 for the second ring.
Tx1
Rx1
UR 1
Tx2
Rx2
Tx1
Rx1
UR 2
Tx2
Rx2
Tx1
3
Rx1
UR 3
Tx2
Rx2
Tx1
Rx1
UR 4
Tx2
Rx2
842007A3.CDR
The following figure shows the connection for three UR-series relays using two independent communication channels.
UR1 and UR3 have single type 7 communication modules; UR2 has a dual-channel module. The two communication
channels can be of different types, depending on the type 7 modules used. To allow the direct input and output data to
cross-over from channel 1 to channel 2 on UR2, set the DIRECT I/O CHANNEL CROSSOVER setting to “Enabled” on UR2. This
forces UR2 to forward messages received on Rx1 out Tx2, and messages received on Rx2 out Tx1.
Figure 3-39: Direct input and output single/dual channel combination connection
Tx
UR 1
Rx
Channel 1
Tx1
Rx1
UR 2
Tx2
Rx2
Channel 2
Tx
UR 3
Rx
842013A2.CDR
The inter-relay communications modules are available with several interfaces and some are outlined here in more detail.
Those that apply depend on options purchased. The options are outlined in the Inter-Relay Communications section of the
Order Code tables in Chapter 2. All of the fiber modules use ST type connectors.
Rx1 Rx1
Tx1 Tx1
3
Rx2
Tx2
1 channel 2 channels
831719A3.CDR
Tx1 Tx1
Rx1 Rx1
Tx2
Rx2
1 channel 2 channels
831720A5.CDR
The following figure shows configuration for the 2I and 2J fiber-laser modules.
Rx1
Tx1
Rx2
Tx2 3
2 channels
831827A1.CDR
When using a laser Interface, attenuators can be necessary to ensure that you do not exceed the
maximum optical input power to the receiver.
3.4.4.1 Description
G.703 is an International Telecommunications Union (ITU) standard for the transmission of data and voice signals. Modules
7R (one channel) and 7S (two channels) apply.
The following figure shows the 64K ITU G.703 co-directional interface configuration. This is module 7S.
The G.703 module is fixed at 64 kbps. The SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP DIRECT I/O DIRECT I/O DATA RATE setting is not
applicable to this module.
AWG 24 twisted shielded pair wiring is recommended for external connections, with the shield grounded only at one end.
Connecting the shield to pin X1a or X6a grounds the shield since these pins are connected internally to ground. Thus, if
pin X1a or X6a is used to ground the shield at one end, do not ground the shield at the other end. This interface module is
protected by surge suppression devices.
Figure 3-43: G.703 interface configuration
Shield ~1a
7S
Tx – ~1b
G.703 Rx – ~2a
channel 1
Tx + ~2b
Rx + ~3a
G.703 communications
Surge ~3b
Shield ~6a
Tx – ~6b
G.703 Rx – ~7a
channel 2
Tx + ~7b
Rx + ~8a
Surge ~8b
842773A3.CDR
The following figure shows the typical pin interconnection between two G.703 interfaces. For the actual physical
arrangement of these pins, see the Rear Terminal Layout section earlier in this chapter. All pin interconnections are to be
maintained for a connection to a multiplexer.
Figure 3-44: Typical pin interconnection between two G.703 interfaces
7S
Tx – X1b X1b Tx –
G.703 Rx – X2a X2a Rx – G.703
channel 1 channel 1
Tx + X2b X2b Tx +
Rx + X3a X3a Rx +
G.703 communications
G.703 communications
Surge X3b X3b Surge
Shield X6a X6a Shield
Tx – X6b X6b Tx –
G.703 Rx – X7a X7a Rx – G.703
channel 2 channel 2
3
Tx + X7b X7b Tx +
Rx + X8a X8a Rx +
Surge X8b X8b Surge
831727A5.CDR
Pin nomenclature differs from one manufacturer to another. It is not uncommon to see pinouts numbered TxA, TxB,
RxA, and RxB. In such cases, assume that “A” is equivalent to “+” and “B” is equivalent to “–.”
Ejector/inserter clip
FRONT
Channel 1
Timing selection
switches
Top cover
3
Channel 2
Cover screw
Ejector/inserter clip
REAR
831774A3.CDR
842752A2.CDR
'05 'LIIHUHQWLDO0DQFKHVWHUUHFHLYHU
'05 *; '0; 'LIIHUHQWLDO0DQFKHVWHUWUDQVPLWWHU
*; *WUDQVPLWWHU
*5 *UHFHLYHU
'0; *5
$&'5
In dual loopback mode, the multiplexers are active and the functions of the circuit are divided into two with each receiver/
transmitter pair linked together to deconstruct and then reconstruct their respective signals. Differential Manchester data
enters the Differential Manchester receiver module and then is returned to the differential Manchester transmitter module.
Likewise, G.703 data enters the G.703 receiver module and is passed through to the G.703 transmitter module to be
returned as G.703 data. Because of the complete split in the communications path and because, in each case, the clocks
are extracted and reconstructed with the outgoing data, in this mode there must be two independent sources of timing.
One source lies on the G.703 line side of the interface while the other lies on the differential Manchester side of the
interface.
Figure 3-48: G.703 dual loopback mode
'05 'LIIHUHQWLDO0DQFKHVWHUUHFHLYHU
'05 *; '0; 'LIIHUHQWLDO0DQFKHVWHUWUDQVPLWWHU
*; *WUDQVPLWWHU
*5 *UHFHLYHU
'0; *5
$&'5
3.4.5.1 Description
There are two RS422 inter-relay communications modules available: single-channel (module 7T) and dual-channel (module
7W). The modules can be configured to run at 64 kbps or 128 kbps. AWG 20 to 24 twisted shielded pair cable is
recommended for external connections. These modules are protected by optically-isolated surge suppression devices.
The shield pins (6a and 7b) are connected internally to the ground pin (8a). Proper shield termination is as follows:
• Site 1 — Terminate shield to pins 6a or 7b or both
• Site 2 — Terminate shield to COM pin 2b
Match the clock terminating impedance with the impedance of the line.
Figure 3-49: RS422 interface connections
Single-channel RS422 module Dual-channel RS422 module
3
7W
Tx – ~3b Tx – ~3b
7T
Rx – ~3a Rx – ~3a
RS422 communications
RS422 communications
Common COM ~2b RS422 Tx + ~4a
channel 2
Surge ~8a Rx + ~6b
Shield ~7b
Tx – ~7a
Clock
Rx – ~8b
Common COM ~2b
~ indicates the slot position Surge ~8a
842776A3.CDR
The following figure shows the typical pin interconnection between two single-channel RS422 interfaces installed in slot W.
All pin interconnections are to be maintained for a connection to a multiplexer.
Figure 3-50: Typical pin interconnect between two RS422 interfaces
7
5[² :D :D 5[²
56FRPPXQLFDWLRQV
56FRPPXQLFDWLRQV
RUNESV
$&'5
outputs from the multiplexer (data module 1) connects to the clock inputs of the UR RS422 interface in the usual way. In
addition, the send timing outputs of data module 1 are also paralleled to the terminal timing inputs of data module 2. By
using this configuration, the timing for both data modules and both UR RS422 channels is derived from a single clock
source. As a result, data sampling for both of the UR RS422 channels is synchronized via the send timing leads on data
module 1, shown as follows. If the terminal timing feature is not available or this type of connection is not wanted, the
G.703 interface is a viable option that does not impose timing restrictions.
Figure 3-51: Timing configuration for RS422 two-channel, three-terminal application
'DWDPRGXOH
6LJQDOQDPH
7[ :D 6'$6HQGGDWD
:
3 6KLHOG
:D
:D
56$5HTXHVWWRVHQG576
56%5HTXHVWWRVHQG576
&/2&.
² :E 57$5HFHLYHWLPLQJ
56&20081,&$7,216
'DWDPRGXOH
6LJQDOQDPH
77$7HUPLQDOWLPLQJ
77%7HUPLQDOWLPLQJ
6'$6HQGGDWD
6'%6HQGGDWD
5'$5HFHLYHGGDWD
5'%5HFHLYHGGDWD
56$5HTXHVWWRVHQG576
56%5HTXHVWWRVHQG576
&6$&OHDU7RVHQG
&6%&OHDU7RVHQG
/RFDOORRSEDFN
5HPRWHORRSEDFN
6LJQDOJURXQG
67$6HQGWLPLQJ
67%6HQGWLPLQJ
$&'5
Data module 1 provides timing to the M60 RS422 interface via the ST(A) and ST(B) outputs. Data module 1 also provides
timing to data module 2 TT(A) and TT(B) inputs via the ST(A) and AT(B) outputs. The data module pin numbers have been
omitted in the figure because they vary by manufacturer.
7[FORFN
7[GDWD
$&'5
When using a laser interface, attenuators can be necessary to ensure that you do not exceed
maximum optical input power to the receiver.
Figure 3-53: RS422 and fiber interface connection
+ ~1a
7L, 7M, 7N,
7P, and 74
Clock
channel 1 – ~1b
Common COM ~2b
Tx – ~3b
Rx – ~3a
RS422 Tx + ~2a
channel 1
communications
Rx + ~4b
Shield ~6a
Fiber Tx2 Rx2
RS422
channel 2
Surge ~8a
842777A3.CDR
The connections shown in the figure are for multiplexers configured as data communications equipment (DCE) units.
When using a laser interface, attenuators can be necessary to ensure that you do not exceed the
maximum optical input power to the receiver.
Figure 3-54: G.703 and fiber interface connection
Shield ~1a
Fiber Tx2
G.703
channel 2 Rx2
842778A2.CDR
Digital
UR-series multiplexer,
device IEEE C37.94
compliant
up to 2 km
842755A2.CDR
The UR-series C37.94 communication module can be connected to the electrical interface (G.703, RS422, or X.21) of a non-
compliant digital multiplexer via an optical-to-electrical interface converter that supports the IEEE C37.94 standard. The
following figure shows the concept.
Figure 3-56: IEEE C37.94 connection to non-compliant digital multiplexer 3
IEEE C37.94 RS422
fiber interface interface
Digital
UR-series IEEE C37.94 multiplexer
device converter with EIA-422
interface
up to 2 km
842756A2.CDR
In 2008, GE Grid Solutions released revised modules 76 and 77 for C37.94 communication to enable multi-ended fault
location functionality with firmware 5.60 release and higher. All modules 76 and 77 shipped since the change support this
feature and are fully backward compatible with firmware releases below 5.60. For customers using firmware release 5.60
and higher, the module can be identified with "Rev D" printed on it and is to be used on all ends of M60 communication for
two and three terminal applications. Failure to use it at all ends results in intermittent communication alarms. For
customers using firmware revisions below 5.60, it is not required to match the revision of the modules installed.
The UR-series C37.94 communication module has six switches to set the clock configuration. The following figure shows
the functions of these control switches.
Figure 3-57: Switches
Loop timing mode
Internal timing mode (factory default)
842753A2.CDR
For the internal timing mode, the system clock is generated internally. Therefore, set the timing switch selection to internal
timing for relay 1 and loop timed for relay 2. There must be only one timing source configured.
For the looped timing mode, the system clock is derived from the received line signal. Therefore, set the timing selection to
loop timing mode for connections to higher order systems.
To remove the IEEE C37.94 communications module cover and set the switches:
1. With power to the relay off, remove the IEEE C37.94 module (type 2G, 2H, 2I, 2J, 76, or 77 module) as follows. Record
the original location of the module to help ensure that the same or replacement module is inserted into the correct
slot.
2. Simultaneously pull the ejector/inserter clips located at the top and bottom of each module in order to release the
module for removal.
3. Remove the module cover screw.
4. Remove the top cover by sliding it towards the rear and then lift it upwards.
5. Set the timing selection switches (channels 1 and 2) to the required timing modes (see description earlier).
6. Replace the top cover and the cover screw.
7. Re-insert the IEEE C37.94 module. Take care to ensure that the correct module type is inserted into the correct slot
position. The ejector/inserter clips located at the top and at the bottom of each module must be in the disengaged
position as the module is inserted smoothly into the slot. Once the clips have cleared the raised edge of the chassis,
engage the clips simultaneously. When the clips have locked into position, the module is inserted fully.
Figure 3-58: IEEE C37.94 timing selection switch setting
Bottom cover
Ejector/inserter clip
3 FRONT
Channel 1
Timing selection
switches
Top cover
Channel 2
Cover screw
Ejector/inserter clip
REAR
831774A3.CDR
Modules shipped since January 2012 have status LEDs that indicate the status of the DIP switches, as shown in the
following figure.
^|:
&+/LQN$FWLYLW\/('
&2006
\|:
%
M<@B=]W
:<88rqwmrkpiqshi
OVON
;glerrip
^|:
^|;
\O`N &+/LQN$FWLYLW\/('
^iglrmgepwyttsvx
3
^ip0B8>1;B=?;;;
Pe|0B8>1;8:;8BA \|;
0XY\^RKWO\SMK1
:A88>=@A?;B
QOWypxmpmr
WehimrMerehe ^|;
&+&ORFN&RQILJXUDWLRQ/('
&+&ORFN&RQILJXUDWLRQ/('
The UR-series C37.94SM communication module can be connected directly to any compliant digital multiplexer that
supports C37.94SM, as shown.
C37.94SM
fiber interface
Digital
UR-series
multiplexer
device
C97.94SM
up to 10 km
842757A2.CDR
It also can be connected directly to any other UR-series relay with a C37.94SM module, as shown.
3 C37.94SM
fiber interface
UR-series UR-series
device with device with
C37.94SM C37.94SM
module module
up to 10 km
842758A2.CDR
In 2008, GE Grid Solutions released revised modules 2A and 2B for C37.94SM communication to enable multi-ended fault
location functionality with firmware 5.60 release and higher. All modules 2A and 2B shipped since the change support this
feature and are fully backward compatible with firmware releases below 5.60. For customers using firmware release 5.60
and higher, the module can be identified with "Rev D" printed on it and is to be used on all ends of M60 communication for
two and three terminal applications. Failure to use it at all ends results in intermittent communication alarms. For
customers using firmware revisions below 5.60, it is not required to match the revision of the modules installed.
The UR-series C37.94SM module has six switches that are used to set the clock configuration. The following figure shows
the functions of these control switches.
Figure 3-60: Switches
842753A2.CDR
For the internal timing mode, the system clock is generated internally. Therefore, set the timing switch selection to internal
timing for relay 1 and loop timed for relay 2. There must be only one timing source configured.
For the looped timing mode, the system clock is derived from the received line signal. Therefore, set the timing selection to
loop timing mode for connections to higher-order systems.
To remove the C37.94SM communications module cover and set the switches:
1. With power to the relay off, remove the C37.94SM module (module 2A or 2B) as follows. Record the original location of
the module to help ensure that the same or replacement module is inserted into the correct slot.
2. Simultaneously pull the ejector/inserter clips located at the top and at the bottom of each module in order to release
the module for removal.
3. Remove the module cover screw.
4. Remove the top cover by sliding it towards the rear and then lift it upwards.
5. Set the timing selection switches (channels 1 and 2) to the required timing modes (see description earlier).
Ejector/inserter clip
FRONT
Channel 1 3
Timing selection
switches
Top cover
Channel 2
Cover screw
Ejector/inserter clip
REAR
831774A3.CDR
Modules shipped since January 2012 have status LEDs that indicate the status of the DIP switches, as shown in the
following figure.
^|:
&+/LQN$FWLYLW\/('
&2006
\|:
%
M<@B=]W
:<88rqwmrkpiqshi
OVON
;glerrip
^|:
^|;
\O`N &+/LQN$FWLYLW\/('
3 ^iglrmgepwyttsvx
^ip0B8>1;B=?;;;
Pe|0B8>1;8:;8BA
0XY\^RKWO\SMK1
:A88>=@A?;B
\|;
QOWypxmpmr
WehimrMerehe ^|;
&+&ORFN&RQILJXUDWLRQ/('
&+&ORFN&RQILJXUDWLRQ/('
RELAY SETTINGS: When the relay is powered up, the "Trouble LED" is on, the "In Service" LED is off, and this message
Not Programmed displays, indicating that the relay is in the "Not Programmed" state and is safeguarding (output
relays blocked) against the installation of a relay whose settings have not been entered. This
message remains until the relay is explicitly put into "Programmed" state.
The relay can be activated on the front panel or in the EnerVista software.
To activate the relay using the front panel:
1. Press the MENU key until the SETTINGS header flashes momentarily and the PRODUCT SETUP message displays.
2. Press the MESSAGE right arrow until the SECURITY message displays.
3. Press the MESSAGE down arrow until the INSTALLATION message displays.
4. Press the MESSAGE right arrow until the RELAY SETTINGS: Not Programmed message displays.
SETTINGS
SETTINGS SECURITY
PRODUCT SETUP
DISPLAY
PROPERTIES
INSTALLATION RELAY SETTINGS:
Not Programmed
5. After the RELAY SETTINGS: Not Programmed message displays, press a VALUE key to change the selection to 3
"Programmed."
6. Press the ENTER key to save the change.
7. When the "NEW SETTING HAS BEEN STORED" message appears, the relay is in "Programmed" state and the "In Service"
LED turns on.
To activate the relay using EnerVista software:
1. Navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Installation and change the Relay Settings field to "Programmed."
2. Save the change.
Regional
control
center
Ethernet Remote
10/100 Mbps communications link
Local
control
UR-series IED
EnerVista Engineer
3 GE Multilin F485
communications converter
Modem
RS232
EnerVista
Reports
EnerVista
Troubleshooting
Commissioning
Setting changes
842759A2.CDR
To communicate through the M60 rear RS485 port from a computer RS232 port, the GE Grid Solutions RS232/RS485
converter box is required. This device (catalog number F485) connects to the computer using a straight-through serial
cable. A shielded twisted-pair wire (20, 22, or 24 AWG) connects the F485 converter to the M60 rear communications port.
The converter terminals (+, –, GND) are connected to the M60 communication module (+, –, COM) terminals. See the CPU
Communication Ports section in chapter 3 for details. The line is terminated with an R-C network (that is, 120 , 1 nF) as
described in this chapter.
• 2 GB RAM
• 1280 x 800 display screen
When installing on a computer with Windows Server 2012, its Release 2 needs the KB2919355 update first. Follow the
instructions described in the link, which works in Internet Explorer, not Chrome.
https://www.microsoft.com/en-US/download/details.aspx?id=42334
To install the software from the DVD and using EnerVista Launchpad:
1. Insert the DVD into the DVD drive of your computer.
2. Click the Install Now button and follow the instructions.
3. When installation is complete, start the EnerVista Launchpad application.
4. Click the IED Setup section of the Launch Pad window.
Figure 3-64: Adding a UR device in Launchpad window
5. In the EnerVista Launch Pad window, click the Add Product button and select the appropriate product as follows.
Select the Web option to ensure the most recent software release, or select CD if you do not have an Internet
connection, then click the Add Now button to list software items for the product. EnerVista Launchpad obtains the
software from the Internet or DVD and automatically starts the installation program after prompting about updates.
From the web, the software is downloaded. A wizard opens.
6. In the wizard, click the Next button and complete the process. The files are installed in the directory indicated, and the
installation program automatically creates icons and adds an entry to the Windows start menu.
The UR device is added to the EnerVista Launchpad window, as shown.
Figure 3-66: UR device added to Launchpad window
7. For other than English, configure the language for the front panel in the EnerVista software under Settings > Product
Setup > Display Properties. User-entered strings are not translated, for example relay names, so setting the
language now ensures that the names are entered/displayed in the required language. For the EnerVista software
language, access the View > Language menu item.
Both network and subnet addresses are contained within a range. The number of hosts determines the class and
addresses as follows:
• Class A 255.0.0.0 — The first octet (255) specifies the network, the second to fourth octets (0) specify the subnet and
host. Use this class when you have more than 65,535 hosts (UR devices).
• Class B 255.255.0.0 — The first two octets (255) specify the network, the third octet (0) specifies the subnet, and the
fourth octet (0) specifies the host. Use this class when you have 255 to 65,534 hosts (UR devices).
• Class C 255.255.255.0 — The first three octets (255) specify the network and the last octet (0) specifies the subnet and
host. Use this class when you have up to 254 hosts (UR devices).
An example of implementation is one computer and one UR device. Because there is one UR device, class C addressing is
required. So we use UR 192.167.2.x with subnet mask 255.255.255.0 and computer 192.167.3.x with subnet mask
255.255.255.0.
For older, non-CIDR routing protocols, such as RIP version 1, follow these restrictions:
• Identical subnet masks — Use a single mask for all subnets within a network
• Contiguous subnets — The subnets must be contiguous and not split among networks. The subnets cannot pass
traffic through other networks.
The IP and subnet addresses need to be added to the UR for Ethernet communication.
For serial communication, for example using any front RS232 port and the Quick Connect feature, the addresses are not
required, but typically they are entered to add/configure devices for regular use.
To add the IP addresses:
1. On the front of the UR, press the MENU key until the SETTINGS menu displays.
2. Navigate to one of the ports under SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS NETWORK NETWORK PORT
PRT IP ADDRESS.
3. Enter an IP address, for example 10.11.33.01, and press the ENTER key to save the value. For example, press the period
3 4.
key to clear any existing address, then press the number keys to add a new address.
In the same menu, select the PRT SUBNET IP MASK setting. Enter a subnet IP address, for example 255.000.000.000 for
255.0.0.0. Press the ENTER key to save the value.
5. When connecting through an Ethernet network, also configure the gateway address under SETTINGS PRODUCT
SETUP COMMUNICATIONS IPv4 ROUTE TABLE DEFAULT IPv4 ROUTE GATEWAY ADDRESS. Press the ENTER key to
save the value.
If using a blue or grey Ethernet cable, skip the rest of the this section. If using an orange cross-over Ethernet cable, the
computer needs to be set up as follows.
1. Use an orange Ethernet cross-over cable to connect the computer to the rear Ethernet port. In case you need it, the
following figure shows the pinout for an Ethernet cross-over cable.
Figure 3-67: Ethernet cross-over cable PIN layout
3 4 5 6
END 1 END 2
2 7 Pin Wire color Diagram Pin Wire color Diagram
1 8 1 White/orange 1 White/green
2 Orange 2 Green
3 White/green 3 White/orange
4 Blue 4 Blue
5 White/blue 5 White/blue
6 Green 6 Orange
7 White/brown 7 White/brown
8 Brown 8 Brown
842799A1.CDR
Next, assign the computer an IP address compatible with the relay’s IP address.
1. From the Windows desktop, right-click the My Network Places icon and select Properties to open the network
connections window. Or in Windows 7, access the Network and Sharing Center in the Control Panel.
3. Select the Internet Protocol (TCP/IP) item from the list, and click the Properties button.
C:\WINNT>ipconfig
Windows IP Configuration
Ethernet adapter <F4FE223E-5EB6-4BFB-9E34-1BD7BE7F59FF>:
Connection-specific DNS suffix. . :
IP Address. . . . . . . . . . . . : 0.0.0.0
Subnet Mask . . . . . . . . . . . : 0.0.0.0
Default Gateway . . . . . . . . . :
Ethernet adapter Local Area Connection:
Connection-specific DNS suffix . :
IP Address. . . . . . . . . . . . : 1.1.1.2
Subnet Mask . . . . . . . . . . . : 255.0.0.0
Default Gateway . . . . . . . . . :
C:\WINNT>
Before using the Quick Connect feature through the Ethernet port, disable any configured proxy settings in Internet
Explorer. 3
1. Start the Internet Explorer software.
2. Select the Tools > Internet Options menu item and click the Connections tab.
3. Click on the LAN Settings button to open the following window.
4. Ensure that the “Use a proxy server for your LAN” box is not checked.
If this computer is used to connect to the Internet, re-enable any proxy server settings after the computer has been
disconnected from the M60 relay.
1. Start the Internet Explorer software.
2. Select the UR device from the EnerVista Launchpad to start EnerVista UR Setup.
3 4. Select the Ethernet interface and enter the IP address assigned to the M60, then click the Connect button. The
EnerVista UR Setup software creates a site named “Quick Connect” with a corresponding device also named “Quick
Connect” and displays them on the left side of the screen.
5. Expand the sections to view data directly from the M60 device.
Each time that the EnerVista UR Setup software is initialized, click the Quick Connect button to establish direct
communications to the M60. This ensures that configuration of the EnerVista UR Setup software matches the M60 model
number.
When direct communications with the M60 via Ethernet is complete, make the following changes:
1. From the Windows desktop, right-click the My Network Places icon and select Properties to open the network
connections window.
2. Right-click the Local Area Connection icon and select the Properties item.
3. Select the Internet Protocol (TCP/IP) item from the list provided and click the Properties button.
4. Set the computer to “Obtain a relay address automatically” as shown.
If the computer is used to connect to the Internet, re-enable any proxy server settings after the computer has been
disconnected from the M60 relay.
2.
computer to the RS232 port on the front of the relay.
Start the EnerVista UR Setup software, or in EnerVista Launchpad select the UR device to start the software.
3
3. Click the Device Setup button. The window opens.
4. Click the Add Site button. A new category is added. Enter a site name in the Site Name field. Optionally add a short
Description of the site. This example uses “Location 1” as the site name.
5. Click the Add Device button. A new device is added.
6. Enter a name in the Device Name field, up to 16 characters, and optionally add a Description of the site. The Color is
for the text in the device list in the Online Window.
7. Select “Serial” from the Interface drop-down list. Interface parameters display that must be entered for serial
communications. Try to load automatically the fields by clicking the Read Order Code button.
Figure 3-68: Configuring serial communication
8. Enter the COM port used by the computer, the baud rate, and parity settings from the front panel SETTINGS
PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS SERIAL PORTS menu, and the relay slave address setting from the front panel
SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS MODBUS PROTOCOL MODBUS SLAVE ADDRESS menu in their
respective fields.
Baud Rate — Typically 19200 bits per second (bps) for RS232, and higher for RS485. Both modems need to use the
same rate, meaning at the computer and the M60 ends.
Parity — Set to None if unsure
Bits — Set to 8 if unsure
Stop Bits — Set to 1 if unsure
Post Terminal Window — Enable this option if you have a Schweitzer Engineering (SEL) SEL-203x Communications
Processor, such as an SEL-2030 or SEL-2032. This option enables display of a terminal window to allow interaction
with the other device.
3 9. Click the Read Order Code button to connect to the M60 and upload the order code to the EnerVista software. If a
communications error occurs, ensure that the EnerVista software serial communications values entered in the
previous step correspond to the relay setting values, and also ensure that the same IP address is not assigned to
multiple M60 ports.
10. Click the OK button when the relay order code has been received. The new site and device are added to the Online
Window.
The device has been configured for serial communications. Proceed to the Connect to the M60 section to begin
communication.
8. Enter the relay IP Address, which can be viewed on the device front panel under SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP
COMMUNICATIONS NETWORK NETWORK PORT PRT IP ADDRESS. Once the IP address is entered, try to load
automatically the fields by clicking the Read Order Code button.
9. Enter the relay Slave address and Modbus Port address values from the settings in the front panel SETTINGS
PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS MODBUS PROTOCOL menu.
10. If using a gateway to connect to the device, select Yes from the drop-down list.
11. Click the Read Order Code button to connect to the M60 device and upload the order code. If the device was entered
already, a message displays "Device ’x’ is also using IP address...." If a communications error occurs, ensure that the
values entered in the previous steps correspond to the relay setting values, and also ensure that the same IP address
is not assigned to multiple M60 ports.
12. Click the OK button when the relay order code has been received. The new site and device are added to the Online
Window.
The device has been configured for Ethernet communications. Proceed to the Connect to the M60 section to begin
communications.
2. Start the EnerVista UR Setup software, or in EnerVista Launchpad select the UR device to start the software.
3. Click the Device Setup button. The window opens.
4. Click the Add Site button. A new category is added. Enter a site name in the Site Name field, such as London East.
Optionally add a short Description of the site, such as the address or intersection.
5. Click the Add Device button. A new device is added.
6. Enter a name in the Device Name field, up to 16 characters, and optionally add a Description of the site. The Color is
for the text in the device list in the Online Window.
7. Select “Modem” from the Interface drop-down list. This displays a number of interface parameters that must be
entered.
8. Select "Generic Modem" from the Modem Name drop-down list, then enter the Phone Number to dial to establish
communication with the remote modem.
Post Terminal Window — Enable this option if you have a Schweitzer Engineering (SEL) SEL-203x Communications
3 Processor, such as an SEL-2030 or SEL-2032. It enables display of a terminal window to allow interaction with the
other device.
9. Once the phone number is entered, try to load automatically the device information by clicking the Read Order Code
button.
10. Click the OK button when the relay order code has been received. The new device is added to the Online window.
The UR device has been added to the software.
When multiple computers are connected to a M60 device, EnerVista settings windows are not updated
automatically. They are refreshed when re-opened. If a user changes a setting on one computer, the other users
need to refresh the display by closing and opening the settings window to see the change. To ensure that current
settings are always viewed, close settings windows when not in use so that they are up-to-date when next
accessed.
3
Expand the site list by double-clicking
or selecting the +/– box.
842743A3.CDR
2. If the status indicator is red, verify that the Ethernet network cable is properly connected to the Ethernet port on the
back of the relay and that the relay has been properly set up for communication.
3. If a relay icon appears in place of the status indicator, then a report (such as an oscillography or event record) is open.
Close the report to re-display the green status indicator.
4. The Display Properties settings can now be viewed, edited, or printed.
2. Start the EnerVista UR Setup software, or in EnerVista Launchpad select the UR device to start the software.
3. Click the Quick Connect button. The window opens.
Figure 3-72: Quick Connect window to access a device
3
4. Select the serial Interface and the communications port (COM Port) from the drop-down lists, then click Connect. The
COM Port is that of the computer.
5. The EnerVista software creates a site named “Quick Connect” with a corresponding device also named “Quick
Connect” and displays them in the Online Window. Expand the sections to view data directly from the UR device. Use
the Device Setup button to change the site name.
Each time that the EnerVista UR Setup software is initialized, click the Quick Connect button to establish direct
communications to the M60. This ensures that configuration of the EnerVista UR Setup software matches the M60 model
number.
3 2. Select the Ethernet interface and enter the IP address assigned to the M60, then click the Connect button. The
EnerVista UR Setup software creates a site named “Quick Connect” with a corresponding device also named "Quick
Connect" and displays them in the Online Window.
3. Expand the sections to view data directly from the M60 device. Use the Device Setup button to change the site name.
Each time that the EnerVista software is initialized, click the Quick Connect button to establish direct communications to
the M60. This ensures that configuration of the EnerVista UR Setup software matches the M60 model number.
3
During the commissioning phase, you have the option to bypass the use of passwords. Do so by enabling the Bypass
Access setting under Settings > Product Setup > Security > Supervisory. Be sure to disable this bypass setting after
commissioning the device.
You can change the password for any role either from the front panel or through EnerVista. If using EnerVista, navigate to
Settings > Product Setup > Security. Change the Local Administrator Password, for example. It is strongly
recommended that the password for the Administrator be changed from the default. Changing the passwords for the
other three roles is optional.
3 •
•
Add rows by right-clicking; validation is done later by the software
Use the Comparison Report button to view quickly all differences, whether saved or not
• Use the Target Device Report to view quickly the imported settings, whether saved or not
• Click the Save button to save imports, otherwise none are
The following procedures outline how to import settings, apply to a live device, compare settings, and view imported
settings.
To import settings:
1. In EnerVista, right-click the device in the Offline Window area and select the Import Settings option. A window opens.
If the device is not listed in the Offline Window area, right-click it in the Online Window area and select the Add Device
to Offline Window option.
2. Select the XML file to import, and click the Open button.
When the firmware versions differ, a message displays and the file cannot be imported.
When the firmware versions match, a window opens that compares existing and import settings. Existing settings are
on the left, and settings to be imported are on the right. The window for FlexLogic operands differs, allowing more
granularity.
When the order codes of the existing and imported setting files do not match, but both devices share the same
function(s), then the comparison list shows the common settings instead of all the settings. For example, the distance
protection function exists both in L90 and D60. The software allows importing L90 distance protection to D60 distance,
and vice versa.
With successful launch, the device with the settings to be imported displays on the right, and the targeted device to
receive these settings is on the left. The differences are highlighted in orange. When check boxes are deselected on
the right side, it means that there are no differences or that settings are not present in the target device. (For a
summary, click the Comparison Report button at the top-right, as outlined in the next procedure.)
3. Review the settings, either in the main window or using the Comparison Report.
If required, deselect any settings on the right side that are no longer wanted for import.
If required, copy any setting in the import device by right-clicking the value, selecting the Copy option, and Pasting it
in the target setting field. Or select the Import option.
4. To filter FlexLogic operands, click the Compare by Lines / Compare VOs button to toggle.
Compare by Lines — Displays FlexLogic operands 1 to 1024.
Compare VOs — For virtual outputs, enable the check boxes of those wanted, for both the import and target devices.
5. To import the settings for the window currently active, click the Import button. Or to import all settings, click the
Import All button. The settings are imported, as shown in green.
6. If required, to undo an import, click the Undo Import button. Or, to undo an import and to refresh all entries to their
original state, click the Restore button.
7. To save the changes, click the Save button and confirm at the prompt. Or to cancel all changes, click the Cancel
button. The window closes.
To compare settings:
1. Click the Comparison Report button at the top-right of the window. This displays a summary of activity and includes
following settings: different, missing, imported, and invalid.
Number of Differences — The number of settings in the target device having setting values different from the import
device
Number of Missing Settings — The number of settings that are not found in the target device settings
Number of Settings Imported — The number of settings imported in the target device
Number of Invalid Settings — The number of settings that are same in both devices but the import device setting
value is not within range (out-of-range) of the target device setpoint range. For example, a 'FuncName Block' setting is
available in both import and target devices. The import device 'FuncName Block' setting is configured as '87L TRIP
OPIOC 1 OP,' however operand '87L TRIP OPIOC 1 OP' is not within the range of the target device.
2. To save the display as an HTML file, click the Save to File button.
When no settings have been imported yet, the window shows basic information about the receiving device, such as
order code.
When settings have been imported, whether saved or not, a report displays. It is a comparison of the target device
before and after import.
For invalid settings for the target device, a message displays, they are highlighted in red in the main window, and they
are listed in red at the bottom of the window. This means that the target device does not have the feature and cannot
accept the settings. In the example shown, the device does not have bus functions, so the settings are invalid. Scroll
through the list to review the invalid settings. Note that the sets of invalid setting groups are highlighted in red on the
left side of the window (not shown).
Figure 3-77: Invalid settings on the target device in red
2. To save the display as an HTML file, click the Save to File button.
Chapter 4: Interfaces
Interfaces
This chapter explains the EnerVista software interface, the front panel interface, logic diagrams, and Engineer interface for
logic design and monitoring.
• Remote resources
• Testing
Factory default values are supplied and can be restored after any changes.
The following communications settings are not transferred to the M60 with settings files:
Modbus Slave Address
Modbus TCP Port Number
RS485 COM2 Baud Rate
RS485 COM2 Parity
COM2 Minimum Response Time
COM2 Selection
RRTD Slave Address
RRTD Baud Rate
IP Address (see end of previous chapter for information)
IP Subnet Mask
IP Routing
When a settings file is loaded to a M60 that is in-service, the following sequence occurs:
4 1. The M60 takes itself out of service.
2. The M60 issues a UNIT NOT PROGRAMMED major self-test error.
3. The M60 closes the critical fail contact.
The Maintenance chapter outlines how to use a settings file in the .urs format for backup and restore.
2 1 6 7
10
4
4 5
9 8 842786A2.CDR
When the Offline Window has devices saved to it, it includes a Reserved entry with spare settings when customer-specific
functions are provided on a UR.
When templates are created for online settings, the password is added during the initial template creation step. It
does not need to be added after the template is created.
4
Phase time overcurrent window with template applied via
the Template Mode > View In Template Mode command.
The template specifies that only the Pickup and Curve
Phase time overcurrent settings window without template applied.
settings be available.
842858A1.CDR
Viewing the settings in template mode also modifies the settings menu, showing only the settings categories that contain
editable settings. The effect of applying the template to a typical settings menu is shown as follows.
Figure 4-8: Applying templates using the View in Template Mode settings command
To display settings available for editing and settings locked by the template:
1. Right-click the device in the Online or Offline Window area and apply the template by selecting the Template Mode >
View All Settings option.
2. Enter the template password then click OK to apply the template.
Once the template has been applied, users are limited to edit the settings specified by the template, but all settings are
shown. The effect of applying the template to the phase time overcurrent settings is shown as follows.
Figure 4-9: Applying templates using the View All Settings command
Phase time overcurrent settings window without template applied. Phase time overcurrent window with template applied via
4
the Template Mode > View All Settings command.
The template specifies that only the Pickup and Curve
settings be available.
842859A1.CDR
5.
6.
Click the Save button to save and apply changes to the settings template.
Select the Template Mode > View In Template Mode option to view the template.
4
7. Optionally apply a password to the template by right-clicking the device and selecting the Template Mode >
Password Protect Template option.
Once the template has been applied, users are limited to view and edit the FlexLogic entries not locked by the template.
The effect of applying the template to the FlexLogic entries is shown here.
Figure 4-11: Locking FlexLogic entries through settings templates
Typical FlexLogic™ entries without template applied. Typical FlexLogic™ entries locked with template via
the Template Mode > View In Template Mode command.
842861A1.CDR
The FlexLogic entries are also shown as locked in the graphical view and on the front panel display.
2. Enter the serial number of the M60 device to lock to the settings file in the Serial # Lock field.
3. Click the OK button to apply the change. The serial number is not validated.
The settings file and corresponding secure FlexLogic equations are now locked to the M60 device specified by the serial
number.
The serial number of the UR-series device and the file transfer
date are added to the setting file when setting files
are transferred to the device.
842863A1.CDR
This information is also available in printed settings file reports as shown in the example. A report is generated by right-
clicking and selecting the Print Settings option.
Traceability data
in settings report
4
842862A1.CDR
7UDFHDELOLW\GDWDLQRQOLQH
GHYLFHDFWXDOYDOXHVSDJH
$&'5
This information is also available from the front panel display through the following actual values:
ACTUAL VALUES PRODUCT INFO MODEL INFORMATION SERIAL NUMBER
ACTUAL VALUES PRODUCT INFO MODEL INFORMATION LAST SETTING CHANGE
4 Display
Keypad
Control
pushbuttons (3)
Front panel
RS232 port
Display
Front panel
RS232 port
Small user-programmable
User-programmable Keypad
(control) pushbuttons 1 to 7
pushbuttons 1 to 12
827801A9.CDR
The following figure shows the vertical front panel for relays ordered with the vertical option.
Figure 4-20: Basic vertical front panel
4
GE Multilin
Display
MENU 7 8 9
HELP MESSAGE 4 5 6
ESCAPE 1 2 3
Keypad
ENTER VALUE 0 . +/-
1 3 5
USER LABEL USER LABEL USER LABEL
User-programmable
2 4 6
pushbuttons 1 to 6
USER LABEL USER LABEL USER LABEL
LED panel 2
RS232 port
827830A3.CDR
1 5
IN SERVICE
TROUBLE
TEST MODE
TRIP
ALARM 2 6
4
PICKUP
VOLTAGE
CURRENT 3 7
USB port FREQUENCY
OTHER
PHASE A 4 8
PHASE B
Not used
PHASE C
NEUTRAL / GND
RESET ESC
ENTER
The front panel can be viewed and used in the EnerVista software, for example to view an error message displayed on the
front panel or the LEDs.
To view the front panel in EnerVista software:
1. Click Actual Values > Front Panel, then any option.
Figure 4-24: Home page example with default content (product information)
Setting Group
Alarm Target Relay Date and Time
4
859850A1.cdr
There are multiple ways to navigate pages, by using the pushbuttons and the menu hierarchy. The menu hierarchy is
similar to the other front panels whereby you select a submenu using Up and Down arrow pushbuttons, and press the
ENTER or Right pushbutton. On setting pages, opening a setting for editing is done by highlighting the setting using Up and
Down pushbuttons, and pressing the ENTER or Right pushbutton.
Home page
Press the Home pushbutton to display the root page no matter the state. Any edit, control, or password entry sessions are
canceled. The header shows several relay/system status icons. The default content of the home page is the product
information page and can be user-configured to show the content of any single-line diagram page, annunciator page,
metering page, or event records page for example. The Tab pushbuttons on the bottom row each navigate to their page.
The home page displays for a user-configured time period, then scrolls through user-configured pages, a feature referred
to as rolling.
Holding the Home pushbutton for one second displays the product information page. The Home page also can display
when settings are saved.
Security indicator, showing how many people are logged in, including local and remote users. The lock is red
when one or more users are logged in and other otherwise green.
When no users are logged in because login is not required, an icon does not display.
Identifies the active setting group number (not shown)
Displays when an abnormal annunciator alarm is present. Navigate to the Annunciator for details. When there
are no such alarms, the icon does not display.
Even when you acknowledge/reset an alarm, the icon displays as long as the condition remains. For example, a
breaker trouble alarm displays, you acknowledge it, but the icon remains because the breaker trouble remains.
Active targets symbol, where targets are error messages.
View error messages by pressing the Menu Tab pushbutton, then accessing the TARGETS menu. Pressing the
RESET button clears those messages that can be.
Configure the home page in the software under Settings > Product Setup > Graphical Panel > Home Page. The menu
does not display when there is no graphical front panel.
Rolling mode
After a user-defined period of inactivity, the graphical front display rolls among up to 10 user-selected pages. The roll-to-
pages are selected in the EnerVista software, with the defaults being the product information page. Each page displays for
less than five seconds. Also, the display backlight intensity is lowered after a configurable period to a user-defined level (0,
10, 20, or 30%); lower intensity extends the life of the display.
Configure rolling mode in the software under Settings > Product Setup > Graphical Panel > Rolling Mode.
Operation works as follows:
• Press the Home pushbutton or ESCAPE pushbutton twice to cancel rolling, restore full backlight intensity, and return
to the Home page
• Press the ENTER, ESCAPE, or a pushbutton to pause rolling once and restore full backlight intensity
Rolling is disabled by setting the delay to 0.
The following buttons display at the top of the window:
• Save — Updates the connected device if online or the open setting file if offline with changes made
• Restore — Undoes changes that have not been saved
• Default — Changes all rolling mode settings to their factory default values
• Reset — Displays factory default values. Previous changes are not lost unless you save the reset window.
Single-line diagrams
4
A single-line diagram, or mimic diagram, is a line drawing of elements in an electrical system. The graphical front panel
displays up to five single-line diagrams. Each can be configured to show the arrangement of a portion of the power
system, the status of circuit breakers and of ground and disconnect switches, user-programmable pushbuttons, and
metering and status values. Each also enables control of the displayed breakers and switches when operand status
assigned to the Enable Controls from GFP setting is ON.
One diagram is provided by default, single_bus_line_dsc.mif, which can be modified.
Configure the diagrams under Settings > Product Setup > Graphical Panel > Single Line Diagram Editor.
Each single-line diagram page has a user-configurable name that appears in the header and in the footer Tab pushbutton
label. Factory default names are SLD 1 to SLD 5. Pages that have no configured content have a blank Tab pushbutton
label, and the Tab pushbutton does nothing. The label for the current page has a blue background.
The letters T, S, B, R, and X next to a controllable element have the following meaning. An example (TSB) is shown in the
next figure.
• T — The element is "tagged." Local and remote control of the device are inhibited, both open and close. Tripping is
unaffected unless additional logic has been configured.
• S — The position indication of the device is substituted with a manually entered value
• B — Blocking open/close command is bypassed
• R — Autoreclose is enabled and not blocked
• X — The device is out-of-service and control is not available
Under Settings > System Setup > Switches and Breakers, enable and name the six switches and two breakers. Switch 6,
M568G, has the A/3 Pole Opened setting on.
Figure 4-27: Configure Breaker and Switch settings
In the EnerVista software, open the single-line diagram editor under Settings > Product Setup > Graphical Panel > Single
Line Diagram Editor.
Add the four switches for the top line by clicking the GE switch symbol in the toolbar, then clicking in the window. (If the UR
device is not online, the software attempts to connect.) Right-click to edit properties. Rotate switches SW569 and SW5682
to 270 degrees. Rotate switches 5681 and SW523 to 90 degrees. Ignore the TSB text.
Next is to close circuit breaker CB523. This circuit breaker is shown at the top right of the figure. A vertical line means that
it is open, and the color can be set as red or green.
On the graphical front panel, press the Home pushbutton, then press the SLDs pushbutton to activate the first single-line
4 diagram page.
Figure 4-28: Single-line diagram on graphical front panel
Press the Enable Control pushbutton, which displays when the Settings > Product Setup > Graphical Panel > Home Page
> Enable Controls From GFP setting is configured and its FlexLogic operand is ON. The side pushbutton labels display.
Press the pushbutton to close the breaker, confirming the action at the prompt.
If at the prompt the control action is prevented this is because status of the operand assigned to the Enable
Controls From GFP setting has changed back to OFF before confirming the prompt action. As a result, the
command is not issued, and the screen goes to the top SLD page.
In this diagram, the two circuit breakers have hard-coded actions available to them. No action is possible on the switches.
Note the USER PB 9 and 10 entries in the earlier figure. As outlined later, these are activated by clicking the PB icon on the
software toolbar. These two pushbuttons can be configured under Settings > Product Setup > User-Programmable
Pushbuttons.
When a breaker is tagged, the letter T displays under the breaker in the diagram. The Tag pushbutton shown toggles to
Remove Tag.
Lines
4 Line components represent power system buses or electrical connections between power system elements. They can also
be used as visual dividers and underline.
To add a line component, click it in the toolbox, then click in the window. Double-click a line to open its properties window
to set orientation.
Figure 4-31: Line and bus crossover symbols
Static symbols
Static symbols depicting power system elements are available. For information, see the ANSI/IEEE 315A and IEC 60617
standards.
Up to 32 static symbols can be used per single-line diagram.
To add a symbol, click it in the toolbox, then click in the window. Double-click the symbol to open its properties window to
set orientation.
To add a breaker or disconnect component, click it in the toolbox, then click in the window. Up to 10 dynamic components
can be added to each single-line diagram.
Breaker and disconnect components have three different parts: label, symbol, and flags. Drag each of its parts to their final
locations. Double or right-click any of these parts to open the properties window. Properties that can be edited are label
text, breaker control element or disconnect switch element number, symbol orientation (horizontal or vertical), color
scheme (red - closed, or red - open), and assigned side button (if any). If the selected breaker or disconnect element does
not exist in the target relay or has not been enabled, then the component is displayed in the graphical front panel and in
the drawing edit window in grey. The color scheme selection has no effect when an IEC style symbol is used because IEC
style symbols do not use color.
Symbol orientation
The figure shows the orientation available for the breaker and disconnect switch (taking Open status as examples). The
default position is 0 degrees.
Figure 4-34: Single-line diagram symbol orientation
A question mark displays in a symbol on the graphical front panel when status is bad. The question mark does not rotate
with orientation.
Figure 4-35: Symbols when status is bad
The following figures show the orientation available for the static components. The default position is 0 degrees.
User-programmable pushbuttons
User-programmable pushbuttons 1 to 8 are physical pushbuttons on the right side of the graphical front panel, numbering
down the two columns.
Any remaining user-programmable pushbuttons are programmed among the 10 pushbuttons on the left and right sides of
the screen display. They show dynamically and provide a means to perform the same control as the other pushbuttons.
4 As an example, if you set up a single-line diagram with two breakers and six switches, then eight of the side pushbuttons
are used automatically for control of the breakers and switches. Side pushbuttons 9 and 10 are available. In the single-line
diagram, let us set side pushbutton 9 to clear event records as follows:
• Show side pushbutton 9 on the graphical front panel — Click the PB symbol in the toolbar, then set Side button 9 to
pushbutton 9 in the drop-down list. This pushbutton then displays when appropriate on the right side of the screen
display.
• Program event record clearing — Set Settings > Product Setup > Clear Relay Records > Clear Event Records to
FlexLogic operand PUSHBUTTON 9 ON
• Program pushbutton 9 — Set Settings > Product Setup > User-Programmable Pushbuttons > Pushbutton 9
Function to "Self-reset." When pressed, pushbutton 9 clears the event records.
To instead set the second user pushbutton (not a side pushbutton) to clear events, follow the second and third bullet
points, selecting settings of PUSHBUTTON 2 ON and Pushbutton 2.
Metering components
Metering components show dynamically the value of a FlexAnalog operand or actual value. Up to 16 metering
components can be added to each single-line diagram.
To add a metering component, click the M symbol in the toolbox, then click in the window. Drag it to its final location.
Double-click it to open the properties window. The figure shows the properties that can be edited.
Status components
Status components show dynamically the value of a FlexLogic operand. Up to 16 can be used in a diagram and 30 in all
single-line diagrams.
An example is to show the Off or On state of the ANY MAJOR ERROR FlexLogic operand. The name of the operand displays in
the single-line diagram editor, then as Off or On on the graphical front panel.
To add a status component, click the S symbol in the toolbox, then click in the window. Drag it to its final location. Double-
click it to open the properties window. Properties that can be edited include parameter (any FlexLogic operand), text color
background color, and on and off text.
Optionally add a text label to display beside the status.
Text
Text components show a single line of user-configured text.
Up to 16 text components can be used per single-line diagram.
To add a text component, click the T symbol in the toolbox, then click in the window. Drag it to its final location. Double-
click it to open the properties window. Properties that can be edited are text, color, and size.
Annunciator
An annunciator is a grid of small windows for alarms, actual values, self-test messages, and product information.
The graphical front panel emulates a conventional annunciator panel. The annunciator has 96 windows, each with a
description of the alarm condition that lights the window. The windows are arranged in rows and columns of 3 x 4, 4 x 6, or
6 x 8 over several pages. Each window can have up to three lines of configurable text, and one line can instead be a
metered value. Normally the window background is dark, and when the configured FlexLogic operand becomes On, the
window lights up.
The figure shows that two alarms are active. One alarm is configured red and the other alarm is configured blue. The red
alarm type is Self Reset, so the alarm displays in a solid color. The blue alarm type is Acknowledgeable, so the alarm flashes
until it is acknowledged, for example by navigating with the arrow keys and pressing the ENTER button. The alarm then
remains blue until the trigger condition is eliminated.
To display the annunciator, press the Home pushbutton, then the Annunciator Tab pushbutton. If there is one or more
4 window in alarm or requiring reset, the annunciator page showing the first of these opens. Otherwise the first annunciator
page opens.
Alarms do not display automatically. Set the Home page and/or rolling pages to display annunciator pages.
The Tab pushbutton labels populate with the annunciator pages. The label text for each annunciator page is configurable
and displays in the header and Tab label. The current page has a blue Tab label. Tab labels for annunciator pages that
have an active window (that is, on, latched, or unacknowledged) are red. Pages where alarms are not triggered have a grey
Tab label. Pages that have no configured windows do not have Tab pushbuttons and do not display.
The Up, Down, Left, and Right pushbuttons cause the selection to move one window in the indicated direction. Pressing the
Right pushbutton past the last window in a row scrolls the display to any next annunciator page, not the next row. The
behavior is similar for the other pushbuttons, for example pressing the Up pushbutton while in the top row goes to any
previous page. If no previous page exists, no action occurs.
Annunciator windows are positioned statically, so that all windows are visible no matter their state.
Alarm types of each window can be configured as Self Reset, Latched, or Acknowledgeable. In Self Reset mode, the
window lighting follows the state of the configured FlexLogic operand. The self-reset mode alarm sequence conforms to
ISA-18.1-1979 (R2004) standard type A 4 5 6.
Figure 4-41: Annunciator alarm sequence in Self Reset mode
Process: Normal
Sequence: Normal
Visual: Off
Return to Normal
To Abnormal
Process: Abnormal
Sequence: Acknowledged
Visual: On
859856A1.vsd
Latched mode is intended for transient signals such as trip, and it conforms to ISA-18.1-1979 (R2004) standard type M 6.
Figure 4-42: Annunciator alarm sequence in Latched mode
Process: Normal
Sequence: Normal To Abnormal
Visual: Off
Process: Abnormal
Reset while
Sequence: Acknowledged
Abnormal
Visual: On
859857A1.vsd
4
In Acknowledgeable mode, both Off to On and On to Off state changes in the configured operand cause the background to
flash; the window must be acknowledged/reset to cancel flashing. This mode conforms to ISA-18.1-1979 (R2004) standard
type R-6.
Figure 4-43: Annunciator alarm sequence in Acknowledgeable mode
Process: Normal
Reset Sequence: Normal To Abnormal
Visual: Off
Process: Abnormal
Reset while
Return to Normal Sequence: Acknowledged
Abnormal
Visual: On
859858A1.vsd
An alarm remains in an alarm state (for example, displays red) when the condition remains. That is, if you acknowledged a
flashing alarm but the alarm condition remains, the background color remains red.
The SETTINGS > INPUTS/OUTPUTS > RESETTING > RESET ANNUNCIATOR setting can be used to select a FlexLogic
operand that when activated acknowledges/resets all annunciator windows.
Annunciator editor
The annunciator editor is used to configure alarms and actual value displays for the graphical front panel.
The path in the EnerVista software is Settings > Product Setup > Graphical Panel > Annunciator Editor.
The figure shows the annunciator editor and its preview window. The page name is entered as General at the top right.
Acknowledgeable and self-resetting alarms are set for basic functions, such as online/offline, Ethernet ports, unauthorized
access/failed logins, and battery failure. The text to display in the annunciator window is entered. The IN SERVICE LED is set
to be green because when the device is on, this LED is green. The preview shows what the annunciator looks like with all
alarms triggered. The last window is not configured and displays blank/grey. In order for the Ethernet and battery alarms
to work, the corresponding self-test alarms have been enabled under Settings > Product Setup > User-Programmable
Self Tests (not shown). The LEDs can be viewed on the front panel, so adding them to the annunciator is for illustrative
purposes only.
The three page layouts (3 × 4, 4 × 6, and 6 × 8) select the number of rows x columns of windows that appear in a page.
Annunciator window size and text size shrink as the number of annunciator windows in a page increases.
Properties that can be edited include alarm type (acknowledgeable, latched, self-reset), alarm input (any FlexLogic
operand), text color, and alarm background color.
The following buttons display at the top of the window:
• Save — Updates the connected device if online or the open setting file if offline with changes made
• Restore — Undoes changes that have not been saved
• Default — Changes all annunciator settings to their factory default values
• Reset — Displays factory default values. Previous settings are not lost unless you save the reset window.
Metering editor
The metering editor is an actual values display tool. It creates pages of actual values for the graphical front panel. There
are two types: tables and phasor diagrams. Tabular actual values pages have settings to configure, while phasor actual
values pages have no settings. Five tabular metering pages can be configured, while there can be a phasor page for each
configured AC source. They display on the graphical front panel using the Metering Tab pushbutton.
The path to the editor is Settings > Product Setup > Graphical Panel > Metering Editor.
Figure 4-45: Metering editor with preview window
4
The inputs are selected at the top. Select from the drop-down list or start typing in the field.
The page, page name, and grid layout are set below the inputs.
Content to display is configured with the cell lines. The content can be actual values, a status indicator, or text.
• Actual value — Select from the FlexAnalogs applicable to the M60, where a FlexAnalog is an analog parameter
• Status — Select from the FlexLogic operands identified in the Status Inputs at the top of the window. An example is to
display text to indicate whether the BATTERY FAIL operand is on or off.
• Text — Enter text to display in the table, for example name of table or column heading
If the metering input is other than OFF, the value of the selected metering input displays, formatted according to the size,
text color, units, multiplier, and decimal configuration. Otherwise either the Text or the Off Text displays depending on the
value of the operand selected by setting Status Input/Index.
A maximum of eight Status Inputs/Indexes can be used per metering page and 16 in all metering pages.
The following buttons display at the top of the window:
• Save — Updates the connected device if online or the open setting file if offline with changes made
• Restore — Undoes changes that have not been saved
• Default — Changes all actual value settings to their factory default values
• Reset — Displays factory default values. Previous settings are not lost unless you save the reset window.
The path is Settings > Product Setup > Graphical Panel > Configurable Navigation.
The settings consist of 64 field pairs, each with a condition and an activation page. The condition selects any FlexLogic
operand. The activation page selection is the standard set, such as product information, event records, annunciator pages,
and single-line diagrams.
To use the feature, select a CONDITION, select its ACTIVATE PAGE option, then save. When selecting the condition
operand, open the drop-down list and start typing in the field to auto-fill. For example, typing F displays FIRST ETHERNET
FAIL.
The following buttons display at the top of the window:
• Save — Updates the connected device if online or the open setting file if offline with changes made
• Restore — Undoes changes that have not been saved
SETTINGS
PRODUCT SETUP
HELP 4 5 6
3. Press to scroll third level fields MESSAGE
2. Press to scroll second level:
ESCAPE 1 2 3 PRODUCT SETUP.
4. Press to scroll through values
ENTER VALUE 0 . +/-
5. Press to save change
842231A1.cdr
Up/Down/Left/Right — These pushbuttons move the selector among the options on a page. The selection is
indicated by a yellow background or a yellow border. On menu pages, the Right pushbutton activates the
selected submenu drilling down the menu hierarchy, and the Left pushbutton backs up the menu hierarchy.
These pushbuttons have a typematic feature on some pages: after a short pause, the pushbutton repeats as long
as it is pressed.
ENTER — Activates the selection on the display, for example a submenu, a control, a keypad key, or a setting. Also
stores updated settings.
ESCAPE — If a setting is open for edit, this pushbutton closes the setting without saving. If an item is selected, this
pushbutton deselects it. Otherwise this pushbutton activates the previous page in the page hierarchy.
RESET — Clears all latched LED indications and target messages. When a page with acknowledgeable/resettable
items is displayed, it instead resets/acknowledges all items on that page, or if an item on that page is selected, it
resets/acknowledges that item.
If you reset/acknowledge alarms, they stop flashing but remain in the alarm state as long as that state remains.
In other words, a red alarm does not switch off just because you acknowledged the alarm.
Home — Activates the home page, which is the root page. The page displays product information by default and
is configurable.
Side pushbutton — Five pushbuttons on the left side of the display and five pushbuttons on the right side of the
display. They perform various functions depending on the displayed page, such as switchgear controls. The
display dynamically shows its label next to each side pushbutton when the pushbutton has an assigned function.
These pushbuttons can also be programmed to function as user-programmable pushbuttons 9 and above.
Tab pushbutton — Five pushbuttons under the display. They navigate through the page hierarchy, and on some
pages activate other actions. The display footer dynamically labels the page or action that is activated by the Tab
pushbutton.
User-programmable pushbutton — Eight physical pushbuttons are associated with the first eight user-
4 programmable pushbutton elements. Numbering is down, that is, 1 to 4 down the left column and 5 to 8 down the
right column.
These elements control a set of FlexLogic operands that can be used to initiate outputs or select modes. Each
physical pushbutton has an integrated LED indicator that can be user-configured to display the appropriate
status.
These pushbuttons have clear covers behind which custom labels can be mounted. A utility is available to print
the labels, under File > Front Panel Report in the software.
842811A1.CDR
• IN SERVICE — Indicates that control power is applied, all monitored inputs/outputs and internal systems are fine, and
the relay is in (online) Programmed mode (under Settings > Product Setup > Installation)
• TROUBLE — Indicates that the relay has detected an internal problem. Check the self-test messages outlined at the
end of the Commands and Targets chapter, and view the event records under Actual Values > Records. For a beta /
pre-release, this LED is always on.
• TEST MODE — Indicates that the relay is in test mode. For information, see the Testing section in the Settings chapter.
• TRIP — Indicates that the selected FlexLogic operand serving as a trip input has operated. Set the operand under
Settings > Product Setup > User-Programmable LEDs > Trip & Alarm LEDs. This indicator latches; initiate the reset
command to reset the latch.
• ALARM — Indicates that the FlexLogic operand serving as an alarm switch has operated. Set the operand under
Settings > Product Setup > User-Programmable LEDs > Trip & Alarm LEDs. This indicator never latches.
• PICKUP — Indicates that an element is picked up. This indicator never latches.
The event-cause indicators in the first column are as follows.
Event-cause LEDs are below the status LEDs. They are turned on or off by protection elements that have their respective
target setting selected as either “Enabled” or “Latched.” If a protection element target setting is “Enabled,” then the
corresponding event-cause LEDs remain on as long as the operand associated with the element remains asserted. If a
protection element target setting is “Latched,” then the corresponding event-cause LEDs turn on when the operate
operand associated with the element is asserted and remains on until the RESET button on the front panel is pressed after
the operand is reset. 4
All elements that are able to discriminate faulted phases can independently turn off or on the phase A, B, or C LEDs. This
includes phase instantaneous overcurrent, phase undervoltage, and so on. This means that the phase A, B, and C operate
operands for individual protection elements are ORed to turn on or off the phase A, B, or C LEDs.
• VOLTAGE — This LED indicates voltage was involved
• CURRENT — This LED indicates current was involved
• FREQUENCY — This LED indicates frequency was involved
• OTHER — This LED indicates a composite function that is not solely current, voltage, or frequency based (distance or
power for example) or a control function (digital element or trip bus for example)
• PHASE A — This LED indicates phase A was involved
• PHASE B — This LED indicates phase B was involved
• PHASE C — This LED indicates phase C was involved
• NEUTRAL/GROUND — This LED indicates that neutral or ground was involved
The user-programmable LEDs consist of 48 amber LED indicators in four columns. The operation of these LEDs is user-
defined. Support for applying a customized label beside every LED is provided. Default labels are shipped in the label
package of every M60, together with custom templates. The default labels can be replaced by user-printed labels.
User customization of LED operation is of maximum benefit in installations where languages other than English are used
to communicate with operators. See the User-Programmable LEDs section in chapter 5 for the settings used to program
the operation of the LEDs on these panels.
Status indicators
• IN SERVICE — Indicates that control power is applied, all monitored inputs/outputs and internal systems are fine, and
the relay is in (online) Programmed mode (under Settings > Product Setup > Installation)
4 • TROUBLE — Indicates that the relay has detected an internal problem. Check the self-test messages outlined at the
end of the Commands and Targets chapter, and view the event records under Actual Values > Records. For a beta /
pre-release, this LED is always on.
• TEST MODE — Indicates that the relay is in test mode. For information, see the Testing section in the Settings chapter.
• TRIP — Indicates that the selected FlexLogic operand serving as a trip switch has operated. This indicator always
latches; initiate the reset command to reset the latch.
• ALARM — Indicates that the selected FlexLogic operand serving as an alarm switch has operated. This indicator never
latches.
• PICKUP — Indicates that an element is picked up. This indicator never latches.
Event-cause indicators
Event-cause LEDs are turned on or off by protection elements that have their respective target setting selected as either
“Enabled” or “Latched.” If a protection element target setting is “Enabled,” then the corresponding event cause LEDs remain
on as long as the operand associated with the element remains asserted. If a protection element target setting is
“Latched,” then the corresponding event cause LEDs turn on when the operate operand associated with the element is
asserted and remains on until the RESET button on the front panel is pressed after the operand is reset.
All elements that are able to discriminate faulted phases can independently turn off or on the phase A, B, or C LEDs. This
includes phase instantaneous overcurrent, phase undervoltage, and so on. This means that the phase A, B, and C operate
operands for individual protection elements are ORed to turn on or off the phase A, B, or C LEDs.
• VOLTAGE — Indicates voltage was involved
• CURRENT — Indicates current was involved
• FREQUENCY — Indicates frequency was involved
• OTHER — Indicates a composite function that is not solely current, voltage, or frequency based (distance or power for
example) or a control function (digital element or trip bus for example)
• PHASE A — Indicates phase A was involved
• PHASE B — Indicates phase B was involved
• PHASE C — Indicates phase C was involved
• NEUTRAL/GROUND — Indicates that neutral or ground was involved
User-programmable indicators
The second and third panels provide 48 amber LED indicators whose operation is controlled by the user. Custom labeling
can be done.
User customization of LED operation is of maximum benefit in installations where languages other than English are used
to communicate with operators. See the User-programmable LEDs section in chapter 5 for the settings used to program
the operation of the LEDs on these panels.
Figure 4-50: LED panels 2 and 3 (index template)
Status indicators
• IN SERVICE — Indicates that control power is applied, all monitored inputs/outputs and internal systems are fine, the
relay’s test mode is disabled, and the relay is in (online) Programmed mode (under Settings > Product Setup >
Installation)
• TROUBLE — Indicates that the relay has detected an internal problem. Check the self-test messages outlined at the
end of the Commands and Targets chapter, and view the event records under Actual Values > Records. For a beta /
pre-release, this LED is always on.
• TEST MODE — Indicates that the relay is in Test-Blocked (solid) or Test (flashing) mode. For information, see the Testing
section in the Settings chapter.
• TRIP — Indicates that the selected FlexLogic operand serving as a trip input has operated. Set the operand under
Settings > Product Setup > User-Programmable LEDs > Trip & Alarm LEDs. This indicator latches; initiate the reset
command to reset the latch.
• ALARM — Indicates that the selected FlexLogic operand serving as an alarm input has operated. Set the operand
under Settings > Product Setup > User-Programmable LEDs > Trip & Alarm LEDs.
Figure 4-52: Example of LEDs on graphical front panel
4. Enter the text to appear next to each LED and above each user-programmable pushbutton in the fields provided. The
LED Offsets and Button Offsets buttons move all labels left/right and up/down on the page (they both do the same
action, so use either button). The Button Offsets button does not display when there are no pushbuttons to
customize.
5. Feed the UR front panel label cutout sheet into a printer and press the Print button in the front panel report window.
6. When printing is complete, fold the sheet along the perforated lines and punch out the labels.
7. Remove the UR label insert tool from the package and bend the tabs as described in the following procedures. These
tabs are used for removal of the default and custom LED labels.
Use the tool with the printed side containing the GE part number facing the user.
The label package shipped with every M60 contains the three default labels, the custom label template sheet, and the
label removal tool.
If the default labels are suitable for your application, insert them in the appropriate slots and program the LEDs to match
them. If you require custom labels, use the following procedures to remove the original labels and insert the new ones.
To set up and use the label removal tool:
1. Bend the tabs at the left end of the tool upwards as shown.
4
Bend the tab at the center of the tool tail as shown.
To remove the LED labels from the M60 front panel and insert the custom labels:
1. Use the knife to lift the LED label and slide the label tool underneath. Ensure that the bent tabs are pointing away from
the relay.
2. Slide the label tool under the LED label until the tabs snap out as shown. This attaches the label tool to the LED label.
4. Slide the new LED label inside the pocket until the text is properly aligned with the LEDs, as shown.
To remove the user-programmable pushbutton labels from the M60 front panel and insert the custom labels:
1. Use the knife to lift the pushbutton label and slide the tail of the label tool underneath, as shown. Ensure that the bent
2. Slide the label tool under the user-programmable pushbutton label until the tabs snap out as shown. This attaches the
label tool to the user-programmable pushbutton label.
4. Slide the new user-programmable pushbutton label inside the pocket until the text is properly aligned with the
buttons.
4
4.2.5.2 Basic front panel
After programming LEDs and pushbuttons under Settings > Product Setup > User-Programmable Leds and User-
Programmable Pushbuttons, labels can be created for the front panel.
To create LED and pushbutton labels for a basic front panel:
1. In the EnerVista software, if the M60 is not already listed in the Offline Window area, add it by right-clicking it and
selecting the Add Device to Offline Window option.
2. Click the File > Front Panel Report menu item and select the device.
3. In the Front Panel Report window, double-click an LED or pushbutton slot and type a label. If you need to see the
existing front panel remotely, access Actual Values > Front Panel for the online device. If you need to see the In the
figure, note that labeling is being done for the third set of LEDs because the second panel of LEDs was factory-labeled.
4
4. Optionally save the changes by clicking the Save icon on the toolbar.
5. Click the Print icon on the toolbar. Consider printing to PDF format and adjusting the zoom for appropriate label size,
then print on a physical printer.
6. Cut labels as a block or individually, for example with scissors or an Exacto knife.
7. If there is a plastic cover over the front panel, remove it by gently pushing in on the right side and lifting off the cover.
8. Remove the plastic cover over the LEDs or pushbutton(s) using a screw driver.
9. Insert the labels.
10. Re-attach the plastic covers.
Figure 4-55: Front panel label designer for graphical front panel
5. Click the Print button in the window and select the printer.
6. Once printed, peel the labels off the template and stick them on the front panel. For the enhanced and graphical front
panels, they go over the clear plastic inserts, not under. For the basic front panel, they go under or over the plastic
covers.
Any changes are not saved. Each time that the label designer window opens, the original template displays. Any labels
deleted are not lost.
values. Continually pressing the MESSAGE right arrow from a header display displays specific information for the category.
Conversely, continually pressing the MESSAGE left arrow from a setting value or actual value display returns to the header
display.
Default values are indicated in this instruction manual in mixed case. In the example shown here, the default access level is
Restricted.
Highest level Lowest level (setting value)
Example
ACTUAL VALUES Press the MENU key until the Actual Values header page appears. This page contains system
STATUS and relay status information.
4 SETTINGS
Press the MENU key until the Settings header page appears. This category contains settings to
PRODUCT SETUP configure the relay.
SECURITY Press the MESSAGE right arrow once to display the first sub-header (Security).
ACCESS LEVEL: Press the MESSAGE right arrow once to display the first setting for Security.
Restricted
SECURITY Press the MESSAGE left arrow to return to the Security heading.
DISPLAY Press the MESSAGE down arrow to display the second setting sub-header associated with the
PROPERTIES Product Setup header.
LANGUAGE: Press the MESSAGE right arrow once to display the first setting for Display Properties.
English
SETTINGS Press the MESSAGE left arrow to return to the Display Properties page, then again to return to
SYSTEM SETUP the Product Setup Page. Press the MESSAGE down arrow to move to the next Settings page. This
page contains settings for System Setup.
Numerical data
Each numerical setting has its own minimum, maximum, and increment value associated with it. These parameters define
what values are acceptable for a setting.
FLASH MESSAGE For example, select the SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP DISPLAY PROPERTIES FLASH
TIME: 10.0 s MESSAGE TIME setting.
MINIMUM: 0.5 Press the HELP key to view the minimum and maximum values. Press the key again to view the
MAXIMUM: 10.0 next context sensitive help message.
Two methods of editing and storing a numerical setting value are available.
• 0 to 9 and decimal point — The relay numeric keypad works the same as a calculator. A number is entered one digit at
a time. The leftmost digit is entered first and the rightmost digit is entered last. Pressing the MESSAGE left arrow or
pressing the ESCAPE key, returns the original value to the display.
• VALUE keys — The VALUE up arrow increments the displayed value by the step value, up to the maximum value
allowed. While at the maximum value, pressing the VALUE up arrow again allows the setting selection to continue
upward from the minimum value. The VALUE down arrow decrements the displayed value by the step value, down to
the minimum value. While at the minimum value, pressing the VALUE down arrow again allows the setting selection to
continue downward from the maximum value.
FLASH MESSAGE As an example, set the flash message time setting to 2.5 seconds. Press the appropriate numeric
TIME: 2.5 s keys in the sequence “2 . 5". The display message changes as the digits are being entered.
NEW SETTING Until ENTER is pressed, editing changes are not registered by the relay. Press ENTER to store the
HAS BEEN STORED new value in memory. This flash message momentarily appears as confirmation of the storing
process. Numerical values that contain decimal places are rounded-off if more decimal place digits
are entered than specified by the step value.
Enumeration data
Enumeration settings have data values that are part of a set, whose members are explicitly defined by a name. A set has
two or more members.
ACCESS LEVEL: For example, the selections available for ACCESS LEVEL are "Restricted," "Command," "Setting," and
Restricted "Factory Service."
Enumeration type values are changed using the VALUE keys. The VALUE up arrow displays the next selection while the
VALUE down arrow displays the previous selection.
ACCESS LEVEL: If the ACCESS LEVEL needs to be "Setting," press the VALUE keys until the proper selection displays.
Setting Press HELP at any time for the context sensitive help messages.
NEW SETTING Changes are not registered by the relay until the ENTER key is pressed. Pressing ENTER stores the
HAS BEEN STORED new value in memory. This flash message momentarily appears as confirmation.
4 Alphanumeric text
Text settings have data values that are fixed in length, but user-defined in characters. They can be upper-case letters,
lower-case letters, numerals, and a selection of special characters.
There are several places where text messages can be programmed to allow the relay to be customized for specific
applications. One example is the Message Scratchpad. Use the following procedure to enter alphanumeric text messages.
For example, enter the text “Breaker #1”.
1. Press the decimal point to enter text edit mode.
2. Press the VALUE keys until the character 'B' appears; press the decimal key to advance the cursor to the next position.
3. Repeat step 2 for the remaining characters: r,e,a,k,e,r, ,#,1.
4. Press ENTER to store the text.
5. If you have any problem, press HELP to view context sensitive help. Flash messages appear sequentially for several
seconds each. For the case of a text setting message, pressing HELP displays how to edit and store new values.
Numerical data
This example outlines how to change the FLASH MESSAGE TIME setting. Flash messages are status, warning, error, and
information messages displayed in response to certain key presses during settings programming. An example is a
confirmation message upon saving settings. This setting specifies how long to display the message.
Press the Menu pushbutton to display the main menu.
Use the Up or Down pushbutton to select SETTINGS, then press the Right or ENTER pushbutton.
Figure 4-58: Settings menu 4
Use the Up or Down pushbutton to select DISPLAY PROPERTIES, then press the Right or ENTER pushbutton.
4 Figure 4-60: Display Properties menu
Use the Up or Down pushbutton to select FLASH MESSAGE TIME, then press the Right or ENTER pushbutton. If the relay is
configured to require login to edit settings, and the user is not already logged in, the login page displays. When the user
has successfully logged in, the setting is opened for edit. As the FLASH MESSAGE TIME setting accepts a numerical value, a
keypad displays. The time is to be changed to 4.0 seconds.
The current setting displays. A flashing cursor line marks the insertion point, initially positioned after the last character of
the setting. The setting range displays under the text.
Press the <-- Move Cursor and Move Cursor --> Tab pushbuttons to move the insertion point. Place it after the 2.
Press the Backspace Tab pushbutton to remove the character to the left of the cursor, in this case the 2.
Using the arrow keys, enter another time, for example 4 for four seconds. These Up, Down, Left, and Right pushbuttons
move the keypad key selector. Pressing the ENTER pushbutton with the - key selected inverts the sign. Pressing the ENTER
pushbutton with the decimal point selected enters that character at the insertion point. Push ENTER now to accept the 4.
Press the Save Tab pushbutton, which does a range check on the value, saves the setting when valid, closes the page, and
displays the previous page. 4
When a setting is not saved due to an invalid value, a message flashes, for example being out of range. In cases where the
relay needs to be restarted for settings to take effect, the flash message advises.
Setting entry can be canceled without impact on the original value by pressing the ESCAPE or Home pushbutton.
Alphanumeric text
Settings that accept alphanumeric values display a keyboard. An example is a pushbutton name.
The &123 key toggles between text and numbers.
The shift key (up arrow on keyboard) is green upon activation, while the keyboard letters switch to upper case. Double-
click the shift key to lock capital lettering, or full capitals.
The globe key (shown greyed-out) toggles the keyboard language between English and another display language
selected, for example between English and French. (The second language needs to be activated under Settings > Product
Setup > Display Properties.)
For Japanese and Chinese, up to 10 characters can be input in a field, not 20.
To add accents, highlight a key and hold the ENTER pushbutton on the graphical front panel. Any special characters
associated with the key display.
To avoid conflict with XML programming, do not enter the following characters on the Annunciator and Metering editor
panels: " (quotation mark), ' (apostrophe), < (less than), > (greater than), & (ampersand). When used, the text following the
character does not display or the Annunciator and Metering panels do not display on the graphical front panel.
The configurable name displays in the header and Tab pushbutton label. Factory default names are Page 1, Page 2, and so 4
on.
Figure 4-64: Metered actual values
The phasor sources are configured under Settings > System Setup > Signal Sources. The tables to display the actual
values are configured in the software under Settings > Product Setup > Graphical Panel > Metering Editor.
Press USER 1 This message appears if the correct password is entered or if none is required. This message
To Select Breaker displays for 30 seconds or until the USER 1 key is pressed again.
BKR1-(Name) SELECTED This message displays after the USER 1 key is pressed for the second time. Three possible actions
USER 2=CLS/USER 3=OP can be performed from this state within 30 seconds as per the following items (1), (2) and (3).
(1)
USER 2 OFF/ON If the USER 2 key is pressed, this message appears for 20 seconds. If the USER 2 key is pressed
To Close BKR1-(Name) again within that time, a signal is created that can be programmed to operate an output relay to
close breaker 1.
(2)
USER 3 OFF/ON If the USER 3 key is pressed, this message appears for 20 seconds. If the USER 3 key is pressed
To Open BKR1-(Name) again within that time, a signal is created that can be programmed to operate an output relay to
open breaker 1.
(3)
BKR2-(Name) SELECTED If the USER 1 key is pressed at this step, this message appears showing that a different breaker is
USER 2=CLS/USER 3=OP selected. Three possible actions can be performed from this state as per (1), (2) and (3). Repeatedly
pressing the USER 1 key alternates between available breakers. Pressing keys other than USER 1, 2,
or 3 at any time cancels the breaker control function.
CHANGE SETTING
PASSWORD: No
5. After the CHANGE...PASSWORD message appears on the display, press the VALUE up or down arrow to change the
selection to “Yes.”
6. Press the ENTER key and the display prompts you to ENTER NEW PASSWORD.
7. Type in a password and press the ENTER key.
8. When VERIFY NEW PASSWORD displays, re-type the password and press ENTER.
CHANGE SETTING
PASSWORD: No
NEW PASSWORD
HAS BEEN STORED
9. When the NEW PASSWORD HAS BEEN STORED message appears, your new Setting (or Command) password is active.
Symbol Description
Not. Negates/reverses the output, for example 0 becomes 1.
Connection
S, R Set, Reset
TPKP Timer pickup. Triggered by the settings latch in the diagram.
TRST Timer reset. Triggered by the reset latch in the diagram.
DELAY
AND S TPKP FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
TRIP BUS 1 INPUT 16 TRIP BUS 1 OP
Latch
= Off TRST
R
SETTINGS
TRIP BUS 1 FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
4
FUNCTION
TRIP BUS 1 PKP
= Enabled
TRIP BUS 1 BLOCK AND
= Off
SETTINGS
TRIP BUS 1
LATCHING
= Enabled
TRIP BUS 1 RESET
= Off
OR
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
RESET OP 842023A1.CDR
• Toolbars
4.4.1.1 Examples 4
The symbols are displayed in the UR format.
Preparation — Under Settings > Inputs/Outputs > Virtual Outputs, the first and second virtual outputs are named
OscTrigger
Top logic — Three-minute timer trigger
Bottom logic — Turn on LED 1 for 10 seconds when the trigger starts
Preparation — Under Settings > Inputs/Outputs > Virtual Outputs, virtual outputs 3 and 4 are named DLTrigger
Top logic — Seven-minute timer trigger
Bottom logic — Turn on LED 9 for 10 seconds when the trigger starts
4 Preparation — Under Settings > Inputs/Outputs > Virtual Outputs, virtual output 5 is named EVStart, 6 is named
EVTriggered, and 7 is named EVMakeEvent
Top logic — One-minute timer trigger
Middle logic — Turn on LED 17 for 10 seconds when trigger starts
Bottom logic — Create events at 100 ms intervals for the same 10 second period
The FlexLogic Equation Editor window is in view-only mode when the Logic Designer is open. To instead work in the
FlexLogic Equation Editor, close the Logic Designer window, then re-open the FlexLogic Equation Editor.
A default block diagram opens that shows 48 inputs (boxes) and 48 user-programmable LEDs (circles). 4
For the graphical front panel, no LEDs can be added to the window and the LEDs are removed when opening any
existing files. For these existing files with the LEDs removed, save the file without them.
Figure 4-71: Default view of FlexLogic designer
2. Optionally delete the default logic diagram by right-clicking its tab at the bottom of the window and selecting Delete.
3. To add a blank sheet, click Edit > Add Sheet. A new tab displays. Or use the last tab displayed, which is a blank sheet.
4. Optionally right-click the new tab and Rename it.
5. Add the input blocks to the logic diagram. For example, click the I/O Tokens tab on the right, click the Input element,
4 7. Add the output blocks to the logic diagram. For example, click the I/O Tokens tab, click the Virtual Output element,
then click in the logic sheet to add it. Double-click the block on the sheet to configure it. For the name, make it unique.
The figure shows virtual output 61 is being added, with a suffix of "io" added to the name to make it unique. Note that
the outline color of a block is red until it is configured, and that this properties window varies by block and the
selectable options by order code.
Figure 4-73: Configuring an output block
8. Connect the input blocks to the output blocks by drawing a line as follows. Click at the end of one block and drag the
line to the next block. Or click the Drawing Tools tab, then select the Line option. The cursor needs to be at the
connection point to end the line, not elsewhere on the block. Note that the outline color is no longer red on the blocks.
9. Add any remaining blocks or information. Right-click a block to copy and paste it. Notes are as follows.
Add a text box — Drawing Tools > Text
Add a FlexElement — Elements > FlexElement. An analog input is expected where a small arrow head shows in the
box.
Figure 4-75: FlexElement accepts analog inputs on left side where arrow heads display
Add an Element — Elements tab. Available elements reflect the product, for example the Control Elements category.
Figure 4-76: Elements reflect Control Elements
10. Check for any blocks that have a red outline. These are invalid. Fix them before continuing, for example by configuring
them.
11. Compile the logic diagram to check for errors by clicking the Compile button at the bottom left or by pressing the F7
key.
If prompted about a message about sorting, click Yes to apply the default (for this example), which can be automatic
sorting based on an algorithm that applies fastest execution time.
With successful compiling, the file is saved and the FlexLogic equations populate automatically. Scroll up through the
compile messages, with the red errors being the only messages that require fixing before proceeding.
The figure shows that we forgot to add the "Io" suffix to the names of virtual outputs 62 and 63, as indicated by
"Warning: Virtual output xx using default name." This warning is a minor warning.
The warning "input using disabled feature" means that input needs to be enabled. Double-click the block, click the
View Associated Screen button, enable the setting, save, and recompile.
The output and messages are explained in the next section.
Some information displayed in the compile messages updates automatically, for example messages after a device is
unplugged.
Figure 4-77: Compile and check the logic
12. View the FlexLogic equations by navigating in the Offline Window area to FlexLogic > FlexLogic Equation Editor. The
window opens with the entries displayed in the next tab.
Figure 4-78: Logic displayed in FlexLogic Equation Editor
4
When the Update SCL files option is selected, the CID and IID files in the device folder are updated by the user
configuration in the IEC 61850 panel and thereby become synchronized. The CID file and the IID file (depending on the
preference 'Do not update IID file when updating SCL files') are updated. If the CID file is not already there, it is generated.
The location of these files is C:\ProgramData\GE Power Management\urpc, for example, in the Offline and Online folders.
Any FlexLogic equations entered in the Offline Window area are erased. The logic drawn in the Logic Designer window in
Engineer in the Offline Window area remain. The warning icon disappears after updating.
The following information is contained in the compile window.
Figure 4-80: Compiled results
Number of Lines Saved — The number of compiled logic lines eliminated by using the optimization algorithm, as set in the
Optimize Compiled Output option of the Preferences. In the example shown, no lines were saved because the optimizer is
disabled.
FlexLogic Lines — The number of lines that the compiled logic uses, for example seven of 512 available.
Virtual Output equations — The number of FlexLogic equations used in the Logic Designer window.
Timers used — The number of timers used in the Logic Designer window.
Memory Used — The percent of memory used in the Logic Designer window.
Errors
Table 4-3: Errors from compiling
Category Block or gate Message Description
affected
Error All Number of lines (nnn) exceeds The compiled result exceeds the limit of 512. Reduce the number of
maximum limit of 512 equations to 512 or less.
Error Tag-In Tag-in not configured (TAG_ID, A Tag-In is connected to a circuit but the Tag-In is not referencing an
SheetReference) existing Tag-Out
Error 1 Shots One Shot is over limit The number of One-Shots contained within all of the VO blocks has
(SYMBOL_ID, SheetReference) exceeded the maximum allowed for the firmware revision. This value can
either be 0 or 32.
Error =VO VO has no inputs (VO_ID, A Virtual Output block is located within the FlexLogic diagram and there
SheetReference) is no block connected as input to it. Connect and identify the inputs.
Warnings
When using the 'Reset OP' operand, a warning can appear indicating that this is a disabled feature. This means that the
Reset Settting's FlexLogic operand is set to OFF. Resetting of the relay can be done by pressing the reset button on the
front panel of the relay or by sending a Reset command through communications.
Table 4-4: Warning messages from compiling
Category Block or Message Description
gate
affected
Minor warning Input Input set to unused VO An Input symbol is using an unassigned Virtual Output
4 Major warning Tag-Out
(SYMBOL_ID,Name,Sheet)
Tag-out not connected A Tag-Out symbol has no input
(TAG_ID,Sheet)
Major warning All Symbol not connected A symbol’s input and/or output is not connected and is not part of a
(SYMBOL_ID,Name,Sheet) VO block. Draw the input and/or output to the block.
Minor warning =VO Virtual Output n using default The Assigned Virtual Output is using the default name. Change the
name (VO_ID,Sheet) name.
Minor warning Input Input using default name An Input symbol is using a Contact Input, Contact Output, Digital
(SYMBOL_ID,Name,Sheet) Element, FlexElement, or Digital Counter set to the default name.
Change the name so that it is unique.
Setting warning Input Input using disabled feature An Input symbol is using a disabled Virtual Input, Contact Input, Digital
(SYMBOL_ID,Name,Sheet) Element, FlexElement, Digital Counter, Control Pushbutton,
Programmable Pushbutton, Contact Output, or Protection/Monitoring
Element. Enable it and try again.
Major warning Input Input set to OFF An Input symbol is set to OFF
(SYMBOL_ID,Sheet)
Major warning Input Input set to ON An Input symbol is set to ON
(SYMBOL_ID,Sheet)
Setting warning Input Contact Output Operate is OFF The symbol block is using the default setting of OFF
(SYMBOL_ID, Contacts)
Setting warning Input Contact Output Seal-In is OFF The symbol block is using the default setting of OFF
(SYMBOL_ID, Contacts)
4. In the second sheet, click and drag the Tag In element to the sheet where the first sheet is to connect.
5. Double-click the element and in the window that opens, select the first sheet from the drop-down list to connect the
two sheets.
6. Save the work.
First, when automatic sorting is not enabled, the sequence in which the blocks were drawn is followed.
Second, the order in which equations are executed can be manually changed, as outlined here.
Third, automatic sorting can be set in preferences, as outlined here. It is enabled by default and means that an algorithm is
implemented to give best results and quickest performance, For example, the block with the fastest execution time is
entered first in the FlexLogic. When two block functions have the same execution time the block drawn first displays first in
the FlexLogic. For example, drawing input 61 to output 61, then input 62 to output 62 causes the input/output 61 to be
entered into the FlexLogic first. Automatic sorting takes precedence over manual sort; if you enable this option, manual
sorting is not implemented.
To manually change logic order:
1. In the compile area, click the VO Order tab.
2. If the window is blank, click the Refresh button.
3. Select an entry and click the up or down arrow. To cancel any manual changes, click the Sort or Refresh button.
4. Recompile. The change is not executed or saved if automatic sorting is enabled.
Figure 4-83: Ordering FlexLogic entries
You can also select an element from the drop-down list on the toolbar. It is then highlighted in the logic diagram.
To print labels:
1. In the Front Panel Report window, double-click an LED or pushbutton and enter text.
2. To print the labels, click the Print icon on the toolbar.
3. To save the report and labels, click File > Save As, enter a file name, and select the FPR, JPG, or PDF format.
4. Use the instructions in the second tab of the window to add the labels to the physical device.
4.4.6 Preferences
Preferences determine functionality. As such, you are encouraged to review them. This section outlines some options
available in the menus and preference panels.
Access them in the Logic Designer panel under the View menu and under File > Preferences. The Logic Designer and
Logic Monitor preferences are outlined here, not all preferences for a device.
Workbook Setup
WorkBook
Print Scale — The scale for logic diagram when printing. Scaling a large diagram to 200 percent, for example, results in the
diagram being cut off.
Orphan Protection — When enabled, the printing output prevents Virtual Output circuits from spanning more than a single
page. The largest Virtual Output circuit is scaled to fit on a single page and all remaining Virtual Output circuits are scaled
so that all circuits are printed using the same scale.
Show Title Block — When enabled, places an information box at the bottom right of the diagram when printing. Enter the
information in the File Information panel.
Show Sheet Name — When enabled, shows Sheet 1, Sheet 2, or any other name at the top of the logic diagram when
printing.
Start Sheet On New Page — Places the sheet on the next page when printing.
Show Notes Selection — When other than None, prints the text from any information notes added to the document (under
Drawing Tools tab > Note). The text is printed after the logic diagram.
4
File Information
The text entered here displays at the bottom right of a diagram when printing, provided that the Show Title Block option is
enabled. Note the option to change the logo from the GE logo to your company logo.
Display
The panel sets how the element boxes display. The figure shows how an AND gate displays when the UR default, IEC, or
ISO symbol type is selected.
Figure 4-91: AND gate varies by standard selected
Symbol Style — IEC, ISO, UR Setup — Sets how the gates display in the logic diagram.
Symbol Color — When set to Black & White, only logic blocks with issues continue to display red.
Zoom Operation — Determines what happens when the View > Zoom functions are used. When set to Sheet Only and the
zoom is changed, the single tab changes. When set to Workbook, all tabs change.
Editor
Repeat Symbol — Enable this feature to add element blocks rapidly in sequence, for example when you have inputs 1 to
10, without having to select the element each time. Select the element block from the toolbox, click the diagram, then
continue to click to add additional blocks.
Use first available VO / Timer — When enabled and you copy and paste a virtual output or timer element, the numbering
continues in sequence. For example, you copy timer 5 and paste it as timer 6. When disabled and you copy and paste a
virtual output or timer element, the same number is used. For example, you copy timer 5 and paste it as timer 5.
Auto-Save Logic Designer every x minutes — Logic diagrams with changes are saved automatically according to this
interval. The range is 5 minutes (default) to 30 minutes. With auto-save, the file extension of the saved file is .auto. This file
remains until you save the file manually.
Auto Populate
These options work in the Edit > Auto Populate Workbook function.
VOs per Worksheet — When an existing settings file is opened in the Logic Designer, the Logic Designer populates the
canvas and attempts to evenly distribute the Virtual Output circuits across multiple sheets. A value of 100 in this setting
places all FlexLogic equations on a single sheet until there are 100, then the next ones are placed on another sheet. A value
of 1 places each Virtual Output circuit on a separate sheet.
Show / FlexLogic Merge / Show Unused — If Show Contact Outputs and Show LEDs are selected, for example, the function
places Contact Output and User-programmable LED symbols for settings that are configured. If you disable the LED check
boxes, then the LED tab/sheet does not display when you next open the Logic Designer window. The settings apply to all
products, not just the active window when it is next opened. Close then reopen the Logic Designer window for the setting
to take effect.
Compiler
Show Warnings — Options to filter the messages that display when logic compiles.
Minor — Enable to display minor errors. An example is using the default values of an element added to the diagram, such
as the name of the element. An example is "Warning: Virtual output xx using default name," for which you simply click into
the element to rename it.
4 Major — Enable to display major errors. Examples are an input that does not have a corresponding output, using disabled
features, and failing to connect a symbol. Fix these errors.
Setting — Enable to display error message related to settings, such as an improperly configured setting, such as using ON
or OFF.
Automatically Sort VOs — When enabled, the logic is compiled with an algorithm to give best results and quickest
performance, for example the fastest logic first. The fastest logic displays in the FlexLogic Equation Editor output as the
first entries in the table. Use sorting when virtual outputs have dependencies on other virtual outputs. This setting takes
precedence over order set manually in the VO Order tab in the compiler.
When disabled, the sequence in which the blocks were drawn is followed.
Optimize Compiled Output — Not applicable. Use the check box outlined earlier in the Optimize the Logic section.
Display
The software displays the color specified when an element is on. There is no color when the element is off.
The software displays another color when the status cannot be determined and is unknown.
Timing
Timing Information can be displayed in the monitoring window. This timing information is only an approximate
representation of how Engineer sees transitions. Use the device's Event Record to view accurate timing information.
The timing information can also be streamed to a comma-separated values (CSV) spreadsheet.
The timing information displayed and recorded can be filtered based on six categories. If a category is not selected, any
timing information related to that category does not display and is not recorded to the CSV file.
Show Timing Information in Output Window — Enable to display times in the monitoring window.
Because of the update rate of the Logic Monitoring, the timing information cannot be used as an accurate representation
of the events that occur within the relay. Use instead the device's event record. Timing information can be delayed by 30
seconds.
Save Timing Information to CSV File — Enable to write timing information in a spreadsheet. The timing information is
recorded in a text file that uses commas to separate each of the fields. This file uses the extension CSV that is supported
by any spreadsheet application.
Every change written to the CSV file requires a timestamp.
The format for the timing information in the output window is as follows:
yyyy/mm/dd hh:dd:ss
devicename offline
yyyy/mm/dd hh:dd:ss
devicename ONLINE
yyyy/mm/dd hh:dd:ss
VO1: Virt Out 1- 0
VI4: Virt In 4- 1
DI3: Direct In 3- 0
RI2: Remote In 2- 1
H5a: Contact In 1- 1
H1: Contact Output 1- 0
Data is only appended to the CSV file. The format for the data is as follows:
yyyy/mm/dd hh:dd:ss, devicename, offline
yyyy/mm/dd hh:dd:ss, devicename, ONLINE 4
yyyy/mm/dd hh:dd:ss, VO1: Virt Out 1, 0
yyyy/mm/dd hh:dd:ss, VI4: Virt In 4, 1
yyyy/mm/dd hh:dd:ss, DI3: Direct In 3, 0
yyyy/mm/dd hh:dd:ss, RI2: Remote In 2, 1
yyyy/mm/dd hh:dd:ss, H5a: Contact In 1, 1
yyyy/mm/dd hh:dd:ss, H1: Contact Output 1, 0
Options display for filtering, such as recording timing for Virtual Inputs and Outputs, but not Communications Status.
4.4.7 Toolbars
These are toggled in the View > Toolbar menu.
The UR symbols are displayed for the toolbox icons. They change when the default setting is changed to IEC or ISO
symbols. The symbols displayed in the toolbox also vary by firmware version, reflecting what is supported for each
release.
Open File Open an existing settings file in the URS, CID, or IID format
PDF Report Create a PDF document from Logic Designer diagram(s). Settings can be
changed under File > Preferences > Workbook Setup.
Toggle Compile Window Display or hide the compile window area
Sort Order Select to change the sort order of the Virtual Output list to the right of the
icon. Virtual Outputs can be sorted numerically in ascending and
descending order based on numbers and names.
Select VO to View (x - x) Select a Virtual Output to locate and select it in the workbook. Each Virtual
Output listed also contains the name of the sheet where the Virtual Output
is located.
Edit Mode Switch to Logic Designer mode
Logic Designer
Monitor Mode Switch to Logic Monitor mode
Logic Monitor
Turn On ALL Communications Turn on all communications to all Logic Designer diagrams that are in the
monitoring mode. Default upon each launch of Engineer.
Turn Off All Communications Turn off all communications to all Logic Designer diagrams that are in the
monitoring mode. This is a legacy function for serial communication to turn
off communication to devices. Turning off communication applies to the
current session only. When you re-launch the EnerVista software,
communication is on by default.
4
4.4.7.2 Token Toolbox
Drawing Tools
Draw multiple joined lines. Click and drag for each line. Double-click to finish.
Draw multiple, closed curves. Click for each line. Double-click to finish.
Add text box with rectangle around it. Click to add. Double-click it to change text.
Add figure. Select file in the window that opens, then click on diagram canvas to add figure.
Add note icon and text. Click to add. Double-click to edit the title and text.
I/O Tokens
These are parts used in FlexLogic equations. They are the inputs and outputs of the Virtual Output equations. The display
can vary from that shown here.
Input from another UR device. Teleprotection inputs/outputs and direct inputs/outputs are mutually exclusive and
cannot be used simultaneously.
Teleprotection inputs/outputs and direct inputs/outputs are mutually exclusive and cannot be used simultaneously.
FlexAnalog symbol that can be used as the input to a FlexElement or use the FlexAnalog symbol to monitor an actual
value when in logic Monitoring mode
Contact Input Gate is similar to the Input symbol but is restricted to the operands associated with a Contact Input
Contact Output Gate is similar to the Input symbol but is restricted to the operands associated with a Contact Output.
The Operate and Seal-In settings can be configured graphically.
The Non-Volatile Latch is similar to the Input symbol but is restricted to the operands associated with a Non-Volatile
Latch. The Set and Reset settings can be configured graphically.
The final output of an equation is a numbered register called a virtual output. Virtual outputs can be used as an input
operand in any equation, including the equation that generates the output, as a seal-in or other type of feedback.
Place and configure a Remote Output. The UR's order code and firmware version then determine the availability of the
Remote Output.
Place and configure a Direct Output. The UR's order code and firmware version then determine the availability of the
Direct Output to another UR device.
Place and configure a Teleprotection Output. The UR's order code and firmware version then determine the availability
of the Teleprotection Output.
Place a User Programmable LED in the Logic Designer diagram. Not applicable when using a graphical front panel.
4 A Tag Out can be used in 1 of 2 ways. The first use of the Tag Out is to break up logic that needs to span several sheets.
The second use of the Tag Out is to associate a frequently used block of code with the Tag Out and then repeatedly use
the same block of code using a Tag In. When a Tag Out is referenced more than once, the Tag Out is replaced with a
Virtual Output during the compile phase.
Tag-In can is used to reference an existing Tag-Out. It joins another diagram to a previous diagram.
Boolean Tokens
These symbols are used to create FlexLogic Equations. Use them as intermediate logic for the Virtual Output equations.
The display can vary from that shown here.
Place an OR gate in the Logic Designer diagram. Only one action needs to occur. Any function input on the left side
satisfies the condition.
The number of inputs is configurable from two to 16.
Place an AND gate in the Logic Designer diagram. Multiple actions need to occur. All functions input on the left side are
required to satisfy the condition.
The number of inputs is configurable from two to 16.
Place a NOR gate in the Logic Designer diagram. Gives the value of one when all input operands have a value of zero
and otherwise gives a value of zero. It gives an output signal when there are no input signals. An inverter that reverses
the logic state.
The number of inputs is configurable from two to 16.
Place a NAND gate in the Logic Designer diagram. Gives the value of zero when all input operands have a value of one
and otherwise gives a value of one. It gives an output signal until all signals are present on its inputs. An inverter that
reverses the logic state.
The number of inputs is configurable from two to 16.
Place a XOR gate in the Logic Designer diagram, which is two exclusive OR gates. Only one action needs to occur. If
there are two inputs or there is no input, there is no output.
Place a NOT gate in the Logic Designer diagram. Gives the value of one when the input operand has a value of zero and
otherwise gives a value of zero. It gives an output signal when there is no input signal. An inverter that reverses the
logic state.
Place a latch in the Logic Designer diagram. A latch has two inputs and one output. One input is the Set input, and
other input is the Reset input.
Place a positive one shot symbol that responds to a positive going edge in the Logic Designer diagram. A "one shot" is a
single input gate that generates a pulse ins response to an edge on the input.
Place a negative one shot symbol that responds to a negative going edge in the Logic Designer diagram
Place a positive one shot and a negative one shot symbol in the Logic Designer diagram
4
Place a timer in the Logic Designer diagram
Elements
These blocks configure properties of the element or use element operands as input to FlexLogic equations.
Place and configure a FlexElement. A FlexElement is a universal comparator used to monitor any analog actual value
calculated by the relay or a net difference of any two analog actual values of the same type.
Place and configure a Selector Switch element. Firmware version determines feature availability. The Selector Switch
element is intended to replace a mechanical selector switch. Typical applications include setting group
control or control of multiple logic sub-circuits in user-programmable logic. The element provides for two control inputs.
Place and configure a Digital Element. A Digital Element can monitor any FlexLogic operand
and present a target message and/or enable events recording depending on the output operand state.
Place and configure a Digital Counter element. A Digital Counter counts the number of state transitions
from Logic 0 to Logic 1. The counter is used to count operations such as the pickups of an element.
Select Select components. Click one component and hold down the CTRL key to select others.
Or click and drag an area that contains multiple components to select.
Edit Vertices Shows vertices points for the component selected (if the component support vertices
manipulation)
Properties Shows the properties of the selected component
Zoom Normal Zoom in and center the screen to the spot selected
4 Zoom to Fit Zoom in to a magnitude that fits your entire schema layout on your entire screen
Pan Move the viewable area of your screen around the schema. To activate, select this tool
and then place the hand icon over and part of your schema. Click and drag the hand in
a direction to move around the schema.
Align Top, Middle, Bottom Align the selected components to the top, middle, or bottom of the reference
component
Align Left, Center, Right Align the selected components to the left, middle, or right of the reference component
Space Across Evenly space the selected components across a horizontal axis, starting from the far
left component and ending at the far right component
Space Down Evenly space the selected components across a vertical axis, starting from the top
component and ending at the bottom component
Same Width Set the width of the selected components to the same width as the reference
component
Same Height Set the height of the selected components to the same height as the reference
component
Same Size Set the width and height of the selected components to the same width and height of
the reference component
Only basic objects (lines, rectangles, ellipses) can be rotated and flipped.
Only objects from the Drawing Toolbar can be structured (grouped, ungrouped, forward, backward).
Nudge Up, Down, Left, Right Moves selected component one pixel upward, downward, left, right
Rotate Rotates selected component freely. Once selected, put your mouse cursor over the
component and move the component clockwise or counter-clockwise depending on
what you need.
Rotate Left, Right Rotates selected component 90 degrees counter-clockwise or clockwise
Group, Ungroup Combines all selected components into one combined entity. Ungroups them into
separate components.
Front, Back Moves current components to the absolute front or back of all viewable layers
Forward, Backward Moves current components on layer higher or lower than its original layer hierarchy
Chapter 5: Settings
Settings
This chapter outlines front panel and/or software settings. The relay is not taken out of service when saving settings; the
relay is taken out of service when a settings file is written to it.
Settings can be viewed remotely in a web browser by entering the IP address of the relay, accessing the Device
Information Menu option, then the Front-Panel Display Report option.
When indicated that a restart is required for a setting change to take effect, use the Maintenance > Reboot Relay
Command in the software.
Settings file conversion from previous firmware versions is supported. See the Maintenance chapter.
5 SETTINGS
SYSTEM SETUP AC INPUTS
See page 5-152
SETTING GROUP 2
SETTING GROUP 3
SETTING GROUP 4
SETTING GROUP 5
SETTING GROUP 6
OVERFREQUENCY
See page 5-337 5
START SUPERVISION See page 5-338
5 5.2 Overview
5.2.1 Introduction to elements
For URs, the term element is used to describe a feature that is based around a comparator. The comparator is provided
with an input (or set of inputs) that is tested against a programmed setting (or group of settings) to determine if the input is
within the defined range that sets the output to logic 1, also referred to as setting the flag. A single comparator can make
multiple tests and provide multiple outputs. For example, the time overcurrent comparator sets a pickup flag when the
current input is above the setting and sets an operate flag when the input current has been at a level above the pickup
setting for the time specified by the time-current curve settings. All comparators use analog actual values as the input.
An exception to this rule is digital elements, which use logic states as inputs.
Elements are arranged into two classes, grouped and control. Each element classed as a grouped element is provided with
six alternate sets of settings, in setting groups numbered 1 through 6. The performance of a grouped element is defined by
the setting group that is active at a given time. The performance of a control element is independent of the selected active
setting group.
The main characteristics of an element are shown on a logic diagram. This includes the inputs, settings, fixed logic, and the
output operands generated. The previous chapter explains how to read a logic diagram, and the abbreviations used in a
diagram are defined in the Abbreviations chapter.
Some settings are specified in per-unit (pu) calculated quantities:
pu quantity = (actual quantity) / (base quantity)
Where the current source is from a single current transformer (CT), the base quantity is the nominal secondary or primary
current of the CT. Use the secondary current base to convert per-unit settings to/from a secondary current value, and use
the primary current base to convert to/from a primary current value.
Where the current source is the sum of two or more CTs with different nominal primary current, the primary base quantity
is the largest nominal primary current. For example, if CT1 = 300 / 5 A and CT2 = 100 / 1 A, then in order to sum these, CT2
is scaled to the CT1 ratio. In this case, the base quantity is 300 A primary, 5 A secondary for CT1, and 300/(100/1) = 3 A
secondary for CT2.
For voltage elements, the primary base quantity is the nominal phase-to-phase primary voltage of the protected system
provided that the VT ratio setting is set to the nominal ratio of the VTs and the secondary voltage setting is set to the
phase-to-phase voltage seen by the relay when the voltage of the protected system in nominal. The UR uses the
convention that nominal voltages in a three-phase system are phase-to-phase voltages.
For example, on a system with a 13.8 kV nominal primary voltage, the base quantity is 13800 V. With 14400:120 V delta-
connected VTs, the secondary base quantity and secondary voltage setting is:
13800
-------------- u 120 = 115 V Eq. 5-1
14400
For wye-connected VTs, the primary and secondary base quantities are as before, but the secondary voltage setting (here
a phase-to-ground value) is:
13800 120
-------------- u -------- = 66.4 V
14400 3 Eq. 5-2
Not every operand of a given element in a UR relay generates events, only the major output operands. Elements,
asserting output per phase, log operating phase output only, without asserting the common three-phase operand
event.
5
:LQGLQJ
FXUUHQW
:LQGLQJ
85 3RZHU
WUDQVIRUPHU
:LQGLQJ
&7 &7
$&'5
In conventional analog or electronic relays, the sum of the currents is obtained from an appropriate external connection of
all CTs through which any portion of the current for the element being protected can flow. Auxiliary CTs are required to
perform ratio matching if the ratios of the primary CTs to be summed are not identical. In the UR series of relays, provisions
have been included for all the current signals to be brought to the UR device where grouping, ratio correction, and
summation are applied internally via configuration settings.
A major advantage of using internal summation is that the individual currents are available to the protection device, for
example as additional information to calculate a restraint current, or to allow the provision of additional protection
features that operate on the individual currents, such as breaker failure.
Given the flexibility of this approach, it becomes necessary to add configuration settings to the platform to allow the user
to select which sets of CT inputs are to be added to form the net current into the protected device.
The internal grouping of current and voltage signals forms an AC source. This source can be given a specific name through
the settings and becomes available to protection and metering elements in the UR platform. Individual names can be
given to each source to help identify them for later use. For example, in the scheme shown in the preceding figure, the user
configures one source to be the sum of CT1 and CT2 and can name this source as “Wdg1 I.”
Once the sources have been configured, the user has them available as selections for the choice of input signal for the
protection elements and as metered quantities.
The UR platform allows for a maximum of six sets of three-phase voltages and six sets of three-phase currents. The result 5
of these restrictions leads to the maximum number of CT/VT modules in a chassis to three. The maximum number of
sources is six. A summary of CT/VT module configurations is as follows.
Item Maximum number
CT/VT Module 2
CT Bank (3 phase channels, 1 ground channel) 4
VT Bank (3 phase channels, 1 auxiliary channel) 2
Lost password
If all passwords are lost, reset the unit to default values. Follow the instructions outlined later for COMMANDS RELAY
MAINTENANCE SERVICE COMMAND. Note that the relay is reset to default values, not just the passwords.
Then for CyberSentry, change the default password of ChangeMe1# as outlined in the Set Up CyberSentry and Change
Default Password section at the end of the Installation chapter.
Password requirements
5 A user account requires an alpha-numeric password that meets the following requirements:
• Password is case-sensitive
• Password cannot contain the user account name or parts of the user account that exceed two consecutive
characters
• Password must be 8 to 20 characters in length
• Password must contain characters from all of the following categories:
– English uppercase characters (A through Z)
– English lowercase characters (a through z)
– Base 10 digits (0 through 9)
– Non-alphabetic characters (for example, ~, !, @, #, $,%, &)
For a relay without a CyberSentry software option, any user can activate the RESET button or Reset/Acknowledge
an alarm in the Graphical Front Panel Annunciator without password entry.
ACCESS LEVEL — This setting is viewable on the front panel. The Setting and Command passwords can be changed in the
EnerVista interface.
The "Restricted" option means that settings and commands can be accessed, but there is no access to factory
configuration. Access automatically reverts to the Restricted level according to the ACCESS LEVEL TIMEOUTS values. The
access level is set to Restricted when control power is cycled.
The "Factory Service" level is for factory functions.
There are two user security access levels, setting and command, for which you can set a password for each. Use of a
password for each level controls whether users can enter commands or change settings. Another option is to specify
setting and/or command access for individual user accounts.
• Setting — Allows the user to make any changes to any of the setting values:
– Change any setting
– Test mode operation
• Command — Restricts the user from making any settings changes, but allows the user to perform the following
operations:
–
–
Change the state of virtual inputs
Clear the event records
5
– Clear the oscillography records
– Change the date and time
– Clear the breaker arcing current
– Clear energy records
– Clear the data logger
– Clear the user-programmable pushbutton states
When entering a settings or command password via EnerVista or any serial interface, the user must enter the
corresponding connection password. If the connection is to the back of the M60, use the remote password. If the
connection is to the RS232 port of the front panel, use the local password.
The local setting and command sessions are initiated by the user through the front panel display and are disabled either
by the user or by timeout (via the setting and command level access timeout settings). The remote setting and command
sessions are initiated by the user through the EnerVista software and are disabled either by the user or by timeout.
The state of the session (local or remote, setting or command) determines the state of the following FlexLogic operands:
• ACCESS LOC SETG OFF — Asserted when local setting access is disabled
• ACCESS LOC SETG ON — Asserted when local setting access is enabled
• ACCESS LOC CMND OFF — Asserted when local command access is disabled
• ACCESS LOC CMND ON — Asserted when local command access is enabled
• ACCESS REM SETG OFF — Asserted when remote setting access is disabled
• ACCESS REM SETG ON — Asserted when remote setting access is enabled
• ACCESS REM CMND OFF — Asserted when remote command access is disabled
• ACCESS REM CMND ON — Asserted when remote command access is enabled
A command or setting write operation is required to update the state of the remote and local security operands
listed.
When a setting password or command password is set or updated, user access with a graphical front panel is
removed. Simply log in again on the graphical front panel.
When the setting password is set or updated, the graphical front panel Access Level displays as Command. This is
because the graphical front panel is a Modbus client and it does not have automatic access to the password
change.
PASSWORD ACCESS EVENTS — This setting allows recording of password access events in the event recorder.
As outlined in the previous section, there are two user security access levels, setting and command. Use of a password for
each level controls whether users can enter commands or change settings.
Proper password codes are required to enable each access level. When a CHANGE COMMAND PASSWORD or CHANGE
SETTING PASSWORD setting is programmed to “Yes” via the front panel interface, the following message sequence is
invoked:
5 1.
2.
ENTER NEW PASSWORD: ____________.
VERIFY NEW PASSWORD: ____________.
3. NEW PASSWORD HAS BEEN STORED.
To gain write access to a “Restricted” setting, program the ACCESS LEVEL setting in the main security menu to “Setting” and
then change the setting, or attempt to change the setting and follow the prompt to enter the programmed password. If the
password is correctly entered, access is allowed. Access automatically reverts to the “Restricted” level according to the
access level timeout setting values and when power is cycled.
If the setting and command passwords are identical, then this one password allows access to both commands and
settings.
If a remote connection is established, local passcodes are not visible.
If you establish a local (serial) connection to the relay, you cannot view remote passcodes.
Access supervision
SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP SECURITY ACCESS SUPERVISION
ACCESS ACCESS LEVEL See below
SUPERVISION TIMEOUTS
This menu displays when the ACCESS LEVEL setting is other than Restricted or Command.
The following access supervision settings are available.
INVALID ATTEMPTS BEFORE LOCKOUT — This setting specifies the number of times that an incorrect password can be entered
within three minutes before lockout occurs. When lockout occurs, the LOCAL ACCESS DENIED or REMOTE ACCESS DENIED
FlexLogic operands are set to “On.” These operands return to the “Off” state upon expiration of the lockout.
PASSWORD LOCKOUT DURATION — This setting specifies the time that the M60 locks out password access after the number
of invalid password entries specified by the INVALID ATTEMPTS BEFORE LOCKOUT setting.
The M60 provides a means to raise an alarm upon failed password entry. If password verification fails while accessing a
password-protected level of the relay (either settings or commands), the UNAUTHORIZED ACCESS FlexLogic operand is
asserted. The operand can be programmed to raise an alarm via contact outputs or communications. This feature can be
used to protect against both unauthorized and accidental access attempts.
The UNAUTHORIZED ACCESS operand is reset with the COMMANDS CLEAR RECORDS RESET UNAUTHORIZED ALARMS
command. Therefore, to apply this feature with security, password-protect the Command level. The operand does not
generate events or targets.
If events or targets are required, the UNAUTHORIZED ACCESS operand can be assigned to a digital element programmed with
event logs or targets enabled.
FACTORY SERVICE MODE — A factory service user is supported to perform additional operations intended only for them. This
setting allows access by GE support staff to be turned on and off. A factory service user can log in only when this setting is
configured as Enabled. It is disabled by default. When Enabled, the relay logs events and activates the TROUBLE LED.
GE recommends that Factory Service Mode be disabled when factory operations are not intended to be performed. The
TROUBLE LED de-activates when a user disables Factory Service Mode.
Login is required for this user, and the password is unique for each relay.
A factory service user is logged out with any of the following circumstances:
• UR restarts
• FACTORY SERVICE MODE setting is disabled by Administrator or factory service user
• ACCESS LEVEL setting is changed from "Factory Service" via front panel or serial connection
LOCK FIRMWARE — This setting determines whether the device accepts or blocks a firmware upgrade. When Disabled,
firmware can be updated. When Enabled, the firmware cannot be updated. When Enabled/locked and a firmware
upgrade is attempted using the software, the UNAUTH FW ATTEMPT FlexLogic operand does not assert. When locked and a
firmware upgrade is attempted without using the software, the operand asserts. A user with an Access Level of "Settings"
can modify this setting.
These settings allow the user to specify the length of inactivity required before returning to the Restricted access level.
Note that the access level is set to Restricted when control power is cycled.
COMMAND LEVEL ACCESS TIMEOUT — This setting specifies the length of inactivity (no local or remote access) required to
return to Restricted access from the Command password level.
SETTING LEVEL ACCESS TIMEOUT — This setting specifies the length of inactivity (no local or remote access) required to return
to Restricted access from the Settings password level.
This menu displays when the ACCESS LEVEL setting is other than Restricted or Command.
This feature provides a mechanism to prevent unauthorized or unintended upload of settings to a relay through the local
or remote interface.
The following settings are available through the local (front panel) interface only.
• LOCAL SETTING AUTH — This setting is used for local (front panel or RS232 interface) setting access supervision. Valid
values for the FlexLogic operands are either “On” (default) or any physical “Contact Input ~~ On” value.
If this setting is “On,“ then local setting access functions as normal; that is, a local setting password is required. If this
setting is any contact input on FlexLogic operand, then the operand must be asserted (on) prior to providing the local
setting password to gain setting access.
If setting access is not authorized for local operation (front panel or RS232 interface) and the user attempts to obtain
setting access, then the UNAUTHORIZED ACCESS message displays on the front panel.
If this setting is "Off," firmware upgrades are blocked. If this setting is "On," firmware upgrades are allowed.
• REMOTE SETTING AUTH — This setting is used for remote (Ethernet or RS485 interface) setting access supervision.
If this setting is “On” (the default setting), then remote setting access functions as normal; that is, a remote password is
required. If this setting is “Off,” then remote setting access is blocked even if the correct remote setting password is
provided. If this setting is any other FlexLogic operand, then the operand must be asserted (set as on) prior to
providing the remote setting password to gain setting access.
If this setting is "Off," firmware upgrades are blocked. If this setting is "On," firmware upgrades are allowed.
• ACCESS AUTH TIMEOUT — This setting represents the timeout delay for local setting access. This setting is applicable
when the LOCAL SETTING AUTH setting is programmed to any operand except “On.” The state of the FlexLogic operand
is monitored continuously for an off-to-on transition. When this occurs, local access is permitted and the timer
programmed with the ACCESS AUTH TIMEOUT setting value is started. When this timer expires, local setting access is
immediately denied. If access is permitted and an off-to-on transition of the FlexLogic operand is detected, the
timeout is restarted. The status of this timer updates every five seconds.
The following settings are available through the remote (EnerVista UR Setup) interface only. Select the Settings > Product
Setup > Security menu item to display the security settings window.
The Remote Settings Authorized setting is used for remote (Ethernet or RS485 interface) setting access supervision. If this
setting is “On” (the default setting), then remote setting access functions as normal; that is, a remote password is required.
If this setting is “Off,” then remote setting access is blocked even if the correct remote setting password is provided. If this
setting is any other FlexLogic operand, then the operand must be asserted (on) prior to providing the remote setting
password to gain setting access.
The Access Authorized Timeout setting represents the timeout delay remote setting access. It applies when the Remote
Settings Authorized setting is programmed to any operand except “On” or “Off.” The state of the FlexLogic operand is
continuously monitored for an off-to-on transition. When this occurs, remote setting access is permitted, and the timer
programmed with the Access Authorized Timeout setting value is started. When this timer expires, remote setting access
is denied immediately. If access is permitted and an off-to-on transition of the FlexLogic operand is detected, the timeout
is restarted. The status of this timer updates every five seconds.
• When the EnerVista UR Setup software security system is disabled (passwords are not required), all users have
administrator access
The EnerVista security system allows an administrator to manage access privileges of multiple users of EnerVista. It is
disabled by default to allow access to the device immediately after installation. When security is disabled, all users have
administrator access. GE recommends enabling the EnerVista security before placing the device in service.
To enable the security system and require password use:
1. Select the Security > User Management menu to open the user management window.
5
2. Enable the Enable Security check box in the lower-left corner to enable the security management system.
3. Click the Ok button.
If you force password entry using this feature, ensure that you know the Administrator password. If you do not
know the password and are locked out of the software, reset the device to factory defaults as outlined later for
COMMANDS RELAY MAINTENANCE SERVICE COMMAND. When using CyberSentry, the default password is
"ChangeMe1#".
Security is now enabled for the EnerVista UR Setup software. Upon starting the software, users are now required to enter a
username and password.
3. Select the user access rights by enabling the check box of one or more fields.
3. Modify the user access rights by enabling or disabling one or more of the check boxes.
This feature requires a CyberSentry software option, specified at the time of ordering.
The EnerVista software provides the means to configure and authenticate the M60 access using either a server or the
device. Access to functions depends on user role.
The login screen of EnerVista has two options for access to the M60, these being Server and Device authentication.
When the "Server" Authentication Type is selected, the M60 uses the RADIUS server and not its local authentication
database to authenticate the user.
When the "Device" button is selected, the M60 uses its local authentication database and not the RADIUS server to
authenticate the user. In this case, it uses built-in roles (Administrator, Engineer, Supervisor, Operator, Observer, or
Administrator and Supervisor when Device Authentication is disabled), as login accounts and the associated passwords
are stored on the M60 device. In this case, access is not user-attributable. In cases where user-attributable access is
required, especially for auditable processes for compliance reasons, use server authentication (RADIUS) only.
No password or security information is displayed in plain text by the EnerVista software or the UR device, nor are they ever
transmitted without cryptographic protection.
Only (TCP/UDP) ports and services that are needed for device configuration and for customer enabled features are
open. All the other ports are closed. For example, Modbus is on by default, so its TCP port 502, is open. But if
Modbus is disabled, port 502 is closed. This function has been tested and no unused ports have been found open. 5
When CyberSentry is enabled, Modbus communications over Ethernet is encrypted, which is not always tolerated by
SCADA systems. The UR has a bypass access feature for such situations, which allows unencrypted Modbus over Ethernet.
The Bypass Access setting is available on the SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP SECURITY SUPERVISORY screen. Note that
other protocols (DNP, 101, 103, 104, EGD) are not encrypted, and they are good communications options for SCADA
systems when CyberSentry is enabled.
When using the rear RS485 port and CyberSentry, registers can be read with a maximum buffer of 64 bytes. Settings may
not be written, so use another port or configure the SERIAL INACTIVITY TIMEOUT setting to a high value, such as eight
minutes, to give the relay enough time to finish the task.
For the Device > Settings > Product Setup > Supervisory option, the panel looks like the following.
Figure 5-4: Supervisory panel
5
LOGIN — This setting is applicable for Device authentication only. This setting allows a user to log in with a specific role, as
outlined here. For the Supervisor role, enable the “Supervisor Role” setting. Log out by right-clicking the device in EnerVista
and selecting the Disconnect option.
Whenever a new role is logged in, the user is prompted to enter a password. Passwords must obey the requirements
specified earlier in the chapter in the Password Requirements section.The UR device supports five roles. Roles have their
corresponding passwords, except the Observer role, which does not require a password. There are no time-outs for the
Administrator, Engineer, Operator, and Supervisor when logged in using the front panel; log out manually or use the
Command > Security commands in the software.
The roles are defined as follows:
• Administrator — Complete read/write access to all settings and commands. This role does not allow concurrent
access. This role has an operand to indicate when it is logged on.
• Engineer — Complete read/write access to all settings and commands except configuring Security settings and
firmware upgrades. This role does not allow concurrent access.
• Operator — The Operator has read/write access to all settings under the Commands menu/section. This role does not
exist offline.
• Supervisor — This is only an approving role. This role’s authentication commits setting changes submitted by
Administrator or Engineer. The Supervisor role authenticates to unlock the UR relay for setting changes and not
approve changes after the fact. Only a Supervisor can set the Settings Lock and Firmware Lock in the Security
settings. This role also has the ability to forcefully log off any other role and clear the security event log. This role can
also be disabled, but only through a Supervisor authentication. When this role is disabled its permissions are assigned
to the Administrator role.
• Observer — This role has read-only access to all M60 settings. This role allows concurrent Observer access but it has
no download access to any files on the device. Observer is the default role if no authentication has been done to the
device. This role displays as "None" on the front panel. When local authentication is used, no password is required for
this role. When RADIUS server authentication is used, a password is required. 5
The Factory service role is not available. It is for factory use only. The FACTORY SERVICE MODE setting must be
enabled for access.
The Local Access Denied message on the front panel can mean that you need to log in to the UR in order to
complete the action.
The menu displays on the front panel upon successful login of the Administrator role.
Passwords are stored in text format. No encryption is applied.
In Device authentication mode, the Observer role does not have a password associated with it. In Server
authentication mode the Observer role requires a password.
If you are locked out of the software, reset the device to factory defaults as outlined later for COMMANDS RELAY
MAINTENANCE SERVICE COMMAND. When using CyberSentry, the default password is "ChangeMe1#".
Once the passwords are set, the Administrator with Supervisor approval can change the role-associated password.
In CyberSentry, password encryption is not supported.
Session settings
SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP SECURITY SESSION SETTINGS
SESSION SESSION LOCKOUT: Range: 0 to 99
SETTINGS 3
SESSION LOCKOUT — This setting specifies the number of failed authentications before the device blocks subsequent
authentication attempts for the lockout period. A value of zero means lockout is disabled.
SESSION LOCKOUT PERIOD — This setting specifies the period of time in minutes of a lockout period. A value of 0 means that
there is no lockout period.
Restore defaults
SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP SECURITY RESTORE DEFAULTS
RESTORE DEFAULTS LOAD FACTORY Range: Yes, No
DEFAULTS: No
LOAD FACTORY DEFAULTS — This setting is used to reset all the settings, communication, and security passwords. An
Administrator role is used to change this setting and a Supervisor role (if not disabled) approves it.
Supervisory
SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP SECURITY SUPERVISORY
5 SUPERVISORY
DEVICE
AUTHENTICATION: Yes
Range: Yes, No
The Supervisory menu settings are available for Supervisor role only, or if the Supervisor role is disabled then for the
Administrator role only.
DEVICE AUTHENTICATION — This setting is enabled by default, meaning "Yes" is selected. When enabled, Device
authentication with roles is enabled. When this setting is disabled, the UR only authenticates to the AAA server (RADIUS).
However, the Administrator and Supervisor (when enabled) remain active even after device authentication is disabled and
their only permission is to re-enable Device authentication. To re-enable Device authentication, the Supervisor unlocks the
device for settings changes, then the Administrator re-enables device authentication.
BYPASS ACCESS — The bypass security feature provides an easier access, with no authentication and encryption for those
special situations when this is considered safe. Only the Supervisor, or the Administrator when the Supervisor role is
disabled, can enable this feature.
Mode Front panel or serial (RS232, RS485) Ethernet
Normal mode Authentication — Role Based Access Control (RBAC) Authentication — RBAC and passwords encrypted
and passwords in clear SSH tunneling
Bypass access mode No passwords for allowed RBAC levels No passwords for allowed RBAC levels
No SSH tunneling
LOCK FIRMWARE — Specifies whether the device accepts a firmware upgrade, with a default of Enabled to deny upgrade.
The Supervisor role Disables this setting to allow upgrades. After the upgrade, the Supervisor then Enables the setting to
prevent upgrades.
When the BYPASS ACCESS setting is set to a local or remote option, it overrides LOCK FIRMWARE and allows changes.
Self-tests
SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP SECURITY SUPERVISORY SELF TESTS
SELF TESTS FAILED See below
AUTHENTICATE
FAILED AUTHENTICATE — If this setting is Enabled then the number of failed authentications is compared with the Session
Lockout threshold. When the Session Lockout threshold is exceeded, this minor alarm indication comes up.
FIRMWARE LOCK — If this setting is Enabled, then any firmware upgrade operation attempt when the LOCK FIRMWARE
setting is enabled brings up this self test alarm.
SETTINGS LOCK — If this setting is Enabled then an unauthorized write attempt to a setting for a given role activates this self
test.
SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP SECURITY SUPERVISORY SELF TESTS FAILED AUTHENTICATE
FAILED FAILED AUTHENTICATE: Range: Enabled, Disabled
5 AUTHENTICATE Enabled
CyberSentry setup
When first using CyberSentry security, use the following procedure for setup.
1. Log in to the relay as Administrator by using the VALUE keys on the front panel to enter the default password
"ChangeMe1#". Note that the LOCK SETTINGS setting needs to be disabled (default) in the SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP
SECURITY SUPERVISORY menu.
2. Enable the Supervisor role if you have a need for it.
3. Make any required changes in configuration, such as setting a valid IP address for communication over Ethernet.
4. Log out of the Administrator account by choosing None.
5. Next, Device or Server authentication can be chosen on the login screen, but the choice is available only in EnerVista.
Use Device authentication to log in using the five pre-configured roles (Administrator, Supervisor, Engineer, Operator,
Observer). When using a serial connection, only Device authentication is supported. When Server authentication is
required, characteristics for communication with a RADIUS server must be configured. This is possible only in the
EnerVista software. The RADIUS server itself also must be configured. The appendix called RADIUS Server at the end of
this instruction manual gives an example of how to set up a simple RADIUS server. Once both the RADIUS server and
the parameters for connecting the UR to the server have been configured, you can choose Server authentication on
the login screen of EnerVista.
The use of CyberSentry for devices communicating through an Ethernet-to-RS485 gateway is not
supported. Because these gateways do not support the secure protocols necessary to communicate
with such devices, the connection cannot be established. Use the device as a non-CyberSentry
device.
Users logged in through the front panel are not timed out and cannot be forcefully logged out by a
supervisor. Roles logged in through the front panel that do no allow multiple instances (Administrator,
Supervisor, Engineer, Operator) must switch to None (equivalent to a logout) when they are done in
order to log out.
For all user roles except Observer, only one instance can be logged in at a time, for both login by
front panel and software.
To configure Server authentication:
1. In the EnerVista software, choose Device authentication and log in as Administrator.
2. Configure the following RADIUS server parameters: IP address, authentication port, shared secret, and vendor ID.
3. On the RADIUS server, configure the user accounts. Do not use the five pre-defined roles as user names (Administrator,
Supervisor, Engineer, Operator, Observer) in the RADIUS server. If you do, the UR relay automatically provides the
authentication from the device.
4. In the EnerVista software, choose Server authentication and log in using the user name and password configured on
the RADIUS server for Server authentication login.
5. After making any required changes, log out.
When changing settings offline, ensure that only settings permitted by the role that performs the
settings download are changed because only those changes are applied.
Pushbuttons (both user-control buttons and user-programmable buttons) located on the front panel can be pressed by an
5
Administrator or Engineer role. This also applies to the RESET button, which resets targets, where targets are errors
displayed on the front panel or the Targets panel of the EnerVista software. The RESET button has special behavior in that it
allows these two roles to press it even when they are logged in through the RS232 port and not through the front panel.
To reset the security event log and self-test operands:
1. Log in as Supervisor (if the role is enabled) or Administrator (if the Supervisor role is disabled) and execute a clear
security command under Commands > Security > Clear Security.
Security events
The security events produced when the CyberSentry option is purchased are sent as sytem log (syslog) messages to a
syslog server, if one is configured. The format is as follows.
Security log Event Number Date & Username IP address Role Activity Value
Timestamp
Enumeration Role
0 None
1 Administrator
2 Supervisor
3 Engineer
4 Operator
Enumeration Role
5 Factory
Enumeration Description
1 Authentication Failed
2 User Lockout
3 FW Upgrade
4 FW Lock
5 Settings Lock
6 Settings Change. Because this can fill the entire event log, it is supported by the
already existing Settings_Change.log file. This event is not required.
7 Clear Oscillography command
8 Clear Data Logger command (not applicable to all UR products)
9 Clear Demand Records command (not applicable to all UR products)
10 Clear Energy command (not applicable to all UR products)
11 Clear Unauthorized Access command
12 Clear Teleprotection Counters command (not applicable to all UR products)
13 Clear All Relay Records command
14 Role Log in
15 Role Log out
16 WRITE_SETTING_FILE
5 17 Factory Mode enabled
18 Factory Mode disabled
In addition to supporting syslog, a M60 with CyberSentry also saves the security events in two local security files, these
being SECURITY_EVENTS.CSV and SETTING_CHANGES.LOG. Details on these files and how to retrieve them are available in
the EnerVista software under Maintenance > Retrieve File. Depending on the level of criticality/severity, a syslog server or
a reporting tool gathering information from a syslog server can produce reports, charts, and so on. All severity levels are
per RFC 5424.
Table 5-6: CyberSentry system events recorded
Event Severity Description
FAILED_AUTH, ORIGIN, TIMESTAMP Notice (5) A failed authentication with origin information (username and IP:MAC
address), a time stamp in UTC time when it occurred
AUTH_LOCKOUT, ORIGIN, TIMESTAMP Warning (4) An authentication lockout has occurred because of too many failed
authentication attempts
FIRMWARE_UPGD, ORIGIN, Information (6) Indicates that a change of firmware has occurred
TIMESTAMP
FIRMWARE_LOCK, ORIGIN, Warning (4) An attempt was made to change firmware while the firmware lock was
TIMESTAMP enabled
SETTING_CHG, ORIGIN, TIMESTAMP Notice (5) Indicates setting change(s)
SETTING_LOCK, ORIGIN, TIMESTAMP Warning (4) An attempt was made to change settings while the settings lock was enabled
LOGIN, ORIGIN, TIMESTAMP Information (6) Indicates when a certain role logged in
LOGOUT, ORIGIN, TIMESTAMP Information (6) Indicates when a certain role logged out or timed out
CLEAR_OSCILLOGRAPHY Notice (5) Clear oscillography command was issued
CLEAR_DATA_LOGGER Notice (5) Clear data logger command was issued
CLEAR_DEMAND_RECS Notice (5) Clear demand records command was issued
CLEAR_ENERGY Notice (5) Clear energy command was issued
RESET_UNAUTH_ACCESS Notice (5) Reset Unauthorized access command was issued
CLEAR_TELEPROTECTION_CNT Notice (5) Clear teleprotection counters command was issued
Some relay messaging characteristics can be modified to suit different situations using the display properties settings.
LANGUAGE — This setting selects the language used to display settings, actual values, and targets. This setting displays
when a language other than English was purchased, and the range depends on the order code of the relay.
For Japanese, the settings display in Japanese on the graphical front panel, while the keys printed on the panel are in
English.
For Japanese and Chinese, up to 10 characters can be input in a field on the graphical front panel, not 20.
With the graphical front panel, the language can be changed regardless of the language purchased. That is, all languages
can be used. If you select a language with which you are unfamiliar and want to switch back to English for example, the
menu order remains the same. That is, Settings is always second, Product Setup is always first, Display Properties is
always second, and Language is always first.
If the language is changed after entering user-configured names, such as relay names, the strings are not translated. For
example, a relay name is entered in English, the language is changed to Japanese, and the relay name remains in English.
Set the language before changing settings.
The language can be selected also for the front panel in EnerVista under Maintenance > Change Front Panel.
The language of the EnerVista software can be changed under View > Language. Languages supported by the operating
system display; that is for Polish or Japanese to display, the software needs to be installed on a Polish or Japanese
operating system.
FLASH MESSAGE TIME — Flash messages are status, warning, error, and information messages displayed in response to
certain key presses during settings programming. These messages override any normal messages. Use this setting to
change the duration of flash messages on the display.
DEFAULT MESSAGE TIMEOUT — If the keypad is inactive for a period of time, the relay automatically reverts to a default
message. The inactivity time is modified using this setting to ensure that messages remain on the screen long enough
during programming or reading of actual values. This setting is not supported on the graphical front panel.
DEFAULT MESSAGE INTENSITY — To extend phosphor life in the vacuum fluorescent display, the brightness can be
attenuated during default message display. During keypad interrogation, the display always operates at full brightness.
This setting is not supported on the graphical front panel.
SCREEN SAVER FEATURE and SCREEN SAVER WAIT TIME — These settings are only visible if the M60 has a liquid crystal display
(LCD) and control its backlighting. When the SCREEN SAVER FEATURE is “Enabled,” the LCD backlighting turns off after the
DEFAULT MESSAGE TIMEOUT followed by the SCREEN SAVER WAIT TIME, provided that no keys have been pressed and no
target messages are active. When a keypress occurs or a target becomes active, the LCD backlighting turns on. These
settings are not supported on the graphical front panel.
CURRENT CUT-OFF LEVEL — This setting modifies the current cut-off threshold. Very low currents (1 to 2% of the rated value)
are very susceptible to noise. Some customers prefer very low currents to display as zero, while others prefer the current
to display even when the value reflects noise rather than the actual signal. The M60 applies a cut-off value to the
magnitudes and angles of the measured currents. If the magnitude is below the cut-off level, it is substituted with zero. This
applies to phase and ground current phasors as well as true RMS values and symmetrical components. The cut-off
operation applies to quantities used for metering, protection, and control, as well as those used by communications
protocols. Note that the cut-off level for the sensitive ground input is 10 times lower that the CURRENT CUT-OFF LEVEL
setting value. Raw current samples available via oscillography are not subject to cut-off.
VOLTAGE CUT-OFF LEVEL — This setting modifies the voltage cut-off threshold. Very low secondary voltage measurements
(at the fractional volt level) can be affected by noise. Some customers prefer these low voltages to be displayed as zero,
5 while others prefer the voltage to be displayed even when the value reflects noise rather than the actual signal. The M60
applies a cut-off value to the magnitudes and angles of the measured voltages. If the magnitude is below the cut-off level,
it is substituted with zero. This operation applies to phase and auxiliary voltages, and symmetrical components. The cut-off
operation applies to quantities used for metering, protection, and control, as well as those used by communications
protocols. Raw samples of the voltages available via oscillography are not subject to cut-off.
The CURRENT CUT-OFF LEVEL and the VOLTAGE CUT-OFF LEVEL are used to determine the metered power cut-off levels. The
power cut-off level is calculated using the following equations. For Delta connections:
Lower the VOLTAGE CUT-OFF LEVEL and CURRENT CUT-OFF LEVEL with care as the relay accepts lower signals as valid
measurements. Unless dictated otherwise by a specific application, the default settings of “0.02 pu” for CURRENT
CUT-OFF LEVEL and “1.0 V” for VOLTAGE CUT-OFF LEVEL are recommended.
Use the EnerVista software to configure the graphical front panel. The settings are not accessible from the graphical front
panel.
The following screens are available:
• Home page
• Rolling mode
•
•
Metering editor
Single-line diagram editor
5
• Annunciator editor
• Configurable navigation
The settings menu itself and the event record pages are not configurable.
Multiple screens can be opened in the EnerVista software, but the first remains active and the others can be read-only. For
example, the Annunciator Editor and Single Line Diagram Editor can be open and active, then subsequently opened Rolling
Mode and Home Page screens are read-only. Close the windows, then re-open the one required.
859850A1.cdr
Date Format
Range: yyyy-mm-dd, dd-mmm-yy, yyyy/mm/dd, m/d/yyyy, m/d/yy, mm/dd/yy, mm/dd/yyyy, yy/mm/dd
Default: yyyy-mm-dd
This setting specifies the format for dates on the graphical front panel. It applies to the page header, the events records,
the annunciator, and everywhere else a date displays on the panel. If the relay is synchronized to an external time
source via PTP, IRIG-B, SNTP, and so on, the date/time is shown in white, and otherwise in yellow.
yyyy — four-digit year, for example 2017
yy — two-digit year, for example 17 for 2017
mmm — abbreviation of month name, for example Jan for January
mm — two-digit month, for example 01 for January
m — one or two-digit month, for example 1 for January and 10 for October
dd — two-digit day, for example 08
d — one or two-digit day, for example 8 and 28
To set the date and time, access Synchronize Devices in the software, synchronize to a time source using Settings >
Product Setup > Real Time Clock, or synchronize to the computer using Commands > Set Date and Time.
Time Format
Range: hh:mm:ss, h:mm:ss tt
Default: hh:mm:ss
This setting specifies the format for time on the graphical front panel. It applies to the page header and everywhere else
a time displays on the panel. When the Date Format and the Time Format use the defaults, the date and time are
separated by the character "T" per the ISO convention, such as "2017-09-24T10:58:31". Otherwise the date and time are
separated by a space. If the relay is synchronized to an external time source via PTP, IRIG-B, SNTP, and so on, the date/
time is shown in white, and otherwise in yellow. 5
hh — two-digit hour, for example 02 for two o’clock
h — one or two-digit hour, for example 2 for two o’clock
mm — two-digit minute, for example 51 minutes
ss — two-digit second (can have a decimal and further digits appended), for example 16 seconds
tt — AM or PM based on 12 hour clock
If microseconds have to be displayed, for example, in the event records, the 24-hour clock is adopted. The
representation of an accumulated period (for example hh:mm) is not affected by the selected time format.
To set the date and time, access Synchronize Devices in the software or synchronize to a time source using Settings >
Product Setup > Real Time Clock.
Enable Controls From GFP
Range: FlexLogic operand
Default: ON
This setting enables/disables local control of breakers and switches from the graphical front panel.
The FlexLogic operand assigned to this setting applies to controls of all the single-line diagram pages. The assigned
operand status is reflected in the ENABLE CTRL FROM GFP FlexLogic operand.
When the operand assigned to this setting is ON, controls are enabled, as indicated on a single-line diagram with an
Enable Control label. Pressing the side pushbutton next to the label populates the front panel display with control soft
keys.
When the operand assigned to this setting is OFF, controls are disabled, and the Enable Control label does not display.
If already in control mode and the operand status assigned to this setting changes to OFF, at the confirmation prompt
the control command is not issued and the SLD screen goes to the top SLD page instead.
5
Rolling Mode Delay
Range: 0 to 900 s in steps of 1
Default: 300 s
Set this delay to 0 to disable the rolling mode feature.
Otherwise, after no pushbutton has been pressed for the amount of time specified by this setting, the display
automatically enters rolling mode. While in the rolling mode, the Rolling Mode Pages display. Rolling mode can be
interrupted when a setting changes, such as changing the home page, then resumes rolling.
Automatic Annunciator Recall
Range: Enabled, Disabled
Default: Enabled
When Enabled, an annunciator window changes state, and the display is in rolling mode, this setting terminates rolling
mode and displays the annunciator page containing the changed state.
The Configurable Navigation feature takes precedence over this setting when the Automatic Annunciator Recall and
Configurable Navigation are activated by the same input.
Screen Saver Delay
Range: 0 to 900 s in steps of 1
Default: 300 s
The screen saver mode extends the life of the display. After the amount of time set here, the screen saver activates and
the display intensity is reduced to the level set by the Screen Saver Intensity setting. When in rolling mode, rolling
continues while the screen saver is active. The screen saver terminates when rolling mode terminates. To disable the
screen saver, set the delay to 0.
To avoid conflict with XML programming, do not enter the following characters on the Annunciator and Metering editor
panels: " (quotation mark), ' (apostrophe), < (less than), > (greater than), & (ampersand). When used, the text following the
character does not display or the Annunciator and Metering panels do not display on the graphical front panel.
STATUS INPUTS 1 to 16
Range: OFF, ON, any FlexLogic operand
Default: OFF
This setting identifies the potential inputs for use in the STATUS INDEX fields, for display of the status of FlexLogic
operands.
A maximum of eight Status Inputs can be used per metering page, and 16 in all metering pages.
Select the metering input from the drop-down list. The options reflect the FlexLogic operands applicable to the M60.
They are inputs for all five metering pages, not just the current page.
CURRENT PAGE
Range: Page 1...Page 5
Default: Page 1
Select the metering page to configure from the drop-down list. There are five pages possible, viewable with the Tab
pushbuttons on the graphical front panel.
PAGE NAME
Range: Page 1...Page 5
Default: Page 1
Up to 20 characters can be input here as the name of each metering page. The name displays for the Tab pushbutton on
the graphical front panel.
LAYOUT
Range: 3x4, 4x6, 6x8, 6x4, 8x6, 12x8, 12x4, 16x6, 18x8
Default: 6x4
This setting determines how many rows and columns display on the graphical front panel with the metering information.
The configurable rows in the settings window change dynamically based on this setting.
CONTENT
Range: Actual, Status, Text
Default: Text
Select the type of content to display.
– Actual — an actual value/data. The Configure button becomes active for the actual value to be selected. 5
– Status — one of the operands selected from the STATUS INPUTS fields. Select it in the STATUS INDEX field.
– Text — indicates that text is to display instead of a metered value
STATUS INDEX
Range: 1...16
Default:
This field becomes active when the CONTENT field is set to Status. It selects the input from the STATUS INPUTS to display
the on/off status of the selected operand.
A maximum of eight Status Inputs can be used per metering page, and 16 in all metering pages.
TEXT
Range: up to 20 alphanumeric characters
Default:
Enter the text to display on the graphical front panel. This field is active when the CONTENT field is set to Text or Status.
When Status is selected, the text displays when the status input is in the "on" state.
OFF TEXT
Range: up to 20 alphanumeric characters
Default:
Enter the text to display on the graphical front panel when the element being monitored is in an off/closed state. This
field is active when the CONTENT field is set to Status. The text displays when the status input is in the "off" state.
FONT
Range: 16, 18, 20
Default: 16
Set the font size to display on the graphical front panel.
TEXT COLOR
Range: 24-bit color selector
Default: Black
Set the text color to display in the specified cell.
BACK COLOR
Range: 24-bit color selector
Default: Grey
Set the background color to display in the specified cell.
ACTUAL (Configure)
Range: Configure
Default: Configure
The Configure button becomes active when the CONTENT field is set to "Actual." The window specifies the metering
data to display.
Figure 5-10: Metering value properties window
Parameter
Range: any FlexAnalog parameter
Default:
This setting selects a FlexAnalog parameter that specifies the metered value to display in the metering window. A
FlexAnalog is an analog parameter.
Units
Range: up to eight alphanumeric characters
Default:
This setting specifies the units of measurement for the metered value and is populated based on the Parameter
selected. The field can be left blank when units of measure do not apply.
Scale Factor
Range: G Giga, M Mega, k Kilo, None
Default: None
This setting allows the user to specify the scaling factor for the metering units value. Options depend on the Parameter.
Multiplier
Range: -1000000 to 1000000
Default: 1.0
This setting allows the user to specify a multiplier for the metering parameter value. The multiplier must be in
compliance with the 32-bit floating-point format per IEEE 754, otherwise, the input value is represented as per the IEEE
standard. For example, 1234.56789 is represented as 1234.567871094, and 9876.54321 as 9876.54296875.
Number of Integers
Range: 1 to 12 in steps of 1
Default: 1
This setting specifies the number of integers in the displayed metered value. It can be used to provide for leading
character spacing of the display value.
For example, setting the number to 2 displays 00.000[V] and setting it to 3 displays 000.000[V].
Number of Decimals
Range: 0 to 10 in steps of 1
Default: 3
This setting specifies the number of decimal places in the displayed metered value. For example, setting the number to 1
displays 0.0 and setting it to 2 displays 0.00.
To avoid conflict with XML programming, do not enter the following characters on the Annunciator and Metering editor
panels: " (quotation mark), ' (apostrophe), < (less than), > (greater than), & (ampersand). When used, the text following the
character does not display or the Annunciator and Metering panels do not display on the graphical front panel.
Reset
Range: ON, OFF, any FlexLogic operand
Default: OFF
This setting selects a FlexLogic operand that when activated acknowledges/resets all annunciator windows in the
graphical front panel. For example, to have the first user pushbutton resets all alarms, set this to PUSHBUTTON 1 ON and
turn on the pushbutton under Settings > Product Setup > User-Programmable Pushbuttons. This setting is the same
as the one defined in Settings > Inputs/Outputs > Resetting > Reset Annunciator. See the Resetting section later in this
chapter.
LAYOUT
Range: 3x4, 4x6, 6x8
Default: 3x4
Selects the number of rows and columns to display on the annunciator pages. For example, 3x4 means 12 windows
display per page over eight pages. Up to 96 entries are possible.
To view the layout, click the Preview button.
PAGE NAMES
Range: up to 20 alphanumeric characters
Default: Page 1...Page 8
Up to 20 characters can be input as the name of each annunciator page. The number of pages depends on the Layout.
The name displays for the Tab pushbutton on the graphical front panel.
PARAMETER
Range: Indicator 1...Indicator 96
Default: Indicator 1...Indicator 96
Read-only field. Up to 96 windows are possible.
CONTENT
Range: Actual, Alarm, Mixed
Default: Alarm
Select if the cell is to be an alarm, an actual value, or a combination thereof, for example consists of a single metered
value (set to “Actual”), contains a single alarm indication (set to “Alarm”), or contains both a metered value and an alarm
indication (set to “Mixed”).
ALARM INPUT
Range: OFF, ON, any FlexLogic operand
Default: OFF
Select a trigger for the alarm, or the input signal connected to the alarm. For example, when set to "FIRST ETHERNET
FAIL" and the Ethernet cable connected to port 1 is removed, the alarm is triggered. (Note that when the Ethernet cable
is inserted into an SFP connector and the SFP connector is removed, the alarm is not triggered.) The field is read-only for
an actual value.
The selectable options are the FlexLogic operands specific to the product. 5
ALARM TYPE
Range: Acknowledgeable, Self Reset, Latched
Default: Acknowledgeable
Set the alarm type. The field is read-only for an actual value.
Acknowledgeable — Follow the state transitions, as outlined in the Annunciator section of the Interfaces chapter. The
alarm blinks until acknowledged, then remains on until the condition clears.
Self Reset — Track the state of the input operand. The alarm turns on when the trigger activates and off when the trigger
clears.
Latched — Alarm is on until acknowledged/reset individually or until the RESET button is pressed.
To acknowledge/reset/unlatch an alarm, use the arrow buttons on the graphical front panel and press the ENTER
button.
TEXT (LINE 1 to 3)
Range: up to 10 alphanumeric characters
Default:
The text that displays in the annunciator cell. Three lines can be displayed. Note that a specified metering value replaces
the text for the selected line. This means that a line can display text or be set to show an actual metered value. If the text
does not display it is because an actual metered value is over-riding it; change the line for the text or for the actual value.
TEXT COLOR
Range: 24-bit color selector
Default: White
The color to display for the three text or actual value lines specified.
BACK COLOR
Range: 24-bit color selector
Default: Red
The background color to display for any triggered cell, for example when an alarm is triggered.
ACTUAL (Configure)
Range: Configure
Default: Configure
The Configure button becomes active when the CONTENT field is set to "Actual" or "Mixed." The window specifies the
metering data to display.
Parameter
Range: any FlexAnalog parameter
Default:
This setting selects a FlexAnalog parameter that specifies the metered value to display in the annunciator alarm.
Units
Range: up to eight alphanumeric characters
Default:
This setting specifies the units of measurement for the metered value and is populated based on the Parameter
selected. The field can be left blank when units of measure do not apply.
Scale Factor
Range: G Giga, M Mega, k Kilo, None
Default: None
This setting allows the user to specify the scaling factor for the metering units value. Options depend on the Parameter.
Multiplier
Range: -1000000 to 1000000
Default: 1.0
5 This setting allows the user to specify a multiplier for the metering parameter value. The multiplier must be in
compliance with the 32-bit floating-point format per IEEE 754, otherwise, the input value is represented as per the IEEE
standard. For example, 1234.56789 is represented as 1234.567871094, and 9876.54321 as 9876.54296875.
Number of Integers
Range: 1 to 12 in steps of 1
Default: 1
This setting specifies the number of integers in the displayed analog value. It can be used to provide for leading
character spacing of the display value.
For example, setting the number to 2 displays 00.000[V] and setting it to 3 displays 000.000[V].
Number of Decimals
Range: 0 to 10 in steps of 1
Default: 3
This setting specifies the number of decimal places in the displayed analog value. For example, setting the number to 1
displays 0.0 and setting it to 2 displays 0.00.
Display in Line
Range: 1, 2, 3
Default: 1
This setting specifies the line in the annunciator alarm window to display the metered value. The actual value replaces
the text for the selected line. For example, 2 means the value displays in line 2 of the text; any text configured to display
in that line does not display.
This feature allows FlexLogic operands to trigger page display on the graphical front panel. It consists of 64 setting pairs,
each with a condition and an activation page. The condition selects any FlexLogic operand. The activation page selects
any page available for the graphical front panel. The page opens whenever the selected operand transitions from Off to
On. The page remains open until rolling mode initiates, another trigger initiates from Configurable Navigation, or the Home
button is pressed.
Avoid selecting condition operands that are likely to operate simultaneously but activate different pages, as only one page
can be opened at a time. For example, do not select a single-line diagram page for breaker status open and select an
annunciator page for a trip alarm.
In the example shown, failure of any of the three Ethernet ports triggers the Product Information page to display. With
unauthorized access (such as wrong password), IRIG-B clock failure, or breaker trouble, the Event Records display. When a
breaker opens, a single-line diagram displays. For the Ethernet and IRIG-B failure operation to work, these functions also
have been enabled under Settings > Product Setup > User-Programmable Self Tests.
Figure 5-12: Configurable navigation editor
To use the feature, select a CONDITION, select an ACTIVATE PAGE, then save.
CONDITION
Range: OFF, ON, any FlexLogic operand
Default: OFF
Select the FlexLogic operand for the trigger. When it transitions from Off to On, it opens the page specified by the
ACTIVATE PAGE setting. The FlexLogic operands selectable depend on product. Select it from the drop-down list. Or click
or select the field and start typing to auto-fill. For example, typing F displays FIRST ETHERNET FAIL, while typing BR
displays the first breaker option.
ACTIVATE PAGE
Range: Product Information, SLD 1…5, Annunciator, Annunciator 1…8, Actual Values Phasors 1…6, Tabular 1…5, Event
Records, Targets
Default: Product Information
This setting specifies the page to display on the graphical front panel when the FlexLogic operand selected by its
CONDITON setting transitions from Off to On.
The "Annunciator" option without a page number specifies the first annunciator page in the following sequence:
– The first annunciator page that contains an annunciator window that is in alarm (fast flash)
– The first annunciator page that contains an annunciator window that is in ringback. Ringback is a "return alert."
Visual and audible signals are given when conditions return to normal, then the sequence returns to normal by
pushing the RESET button.
– The first annunciator page that contains an annunciator window that is in abnormal state
– Annunciator page 1
The Tabular option displays a configured actual values/metering page.
The Targets option displays error messages, such as wrong transceiver, similar to event record entries.
5.3.5 Communications
5.3.5.1 Menu
SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS
COMMUNICATIONS SERIAL PORTS See below
RRTD SLAVE ADDRESS: Range: 1 to 254 in steps of 1. Shown only if the COM2
254 USAGE setting is “RRTD.”
RS485 COM2 BAUD Range: 300, 1200, 2400, 4800, 9600, 14400, 19200,
RATE: 19200 28800, 33600, 38400, 57600, 115200. Shown only if
the COM2 USAGE is setting is “RS485.”
RRTD BAUD RATE: Range: 1200, 2400, 4800, 9600, 19200. Shown only if
19200 the COM2 USAGE is setting is “RRTD.”
It is important that the baud rate and parity settings agree with the settings used on the computer or other equipment that
is connected to these ports.
The RS485 port can be connected to a computer running EnerVista UR Setup. This software can download and upload
setting files, view measured parameters, and upgrade the relay firmware. A maximum of 32 relays can be daisy-chained
and connected to a distributed control system (DCS), power line carrier (PLC), or a computer using the RS485 ports.
The baud rate for standard RS485 communications can be selected as 300, 1200, 2400, 4800, 9600, 14400, 19200, 28800,
33600, 38400, 57600, or 115200 bps.
For the RS485 port, the minimum time before the port transmits after receiving data from a host can be set. This feature
allows operation with hosts that hold the RS485 transmitter active for some time after each transmission.
If the COM2 USAGE setting is “RRTD,” then the COM2 port is used to monitor the RTDs on a remote RTD unit. The remote RTD
unit uses the Modbus RTU protocol over RS485. The RRTD device must have a unique address from 1 to 254. The baud rate
for RRTD communications can be selected as 300, 1200, 2400, 4800, 9600, 14400, or 19200 bps.
If the RS485 COM2 port is used for an RRTD, then there must not be any other devices connected in the daisy-chain for any
other purpose. The port is strictly dedicated to RRTD usage when COM2 USAGE is selected as “RRTD.”
For changes to the COM2 USAGE setting to take effect, cycle power to the M60.
Example 1
IP1/Mask1: 10.1.1.2/255.255.255.0 (where LAN 1 is 10.1.1.x/255.255.255.0)
IP2/Mask2: 10.2.1.2/255.255.255.0 (where LAN2 is 10.2.1.x/255.255.255.0)
IP3/Mask3: 10.3.1.2/255.255.255.0 (where LAN3 is 10.3.1.x/255.255.255.0)
Example 2
IP1/Mask1: 10.1.1.2/255.0.0.0 (where LAN1 is 10.x.x.x/255.0.0.0)
5 IP2/Mask2: 11.1.1.2/255.0.0.0 (where LAN2 is 11.x.x.x/255.0.0.0)
IP3/Mask3: 12.1.1.2/255.0.0.0 (where LAN3 is 12.x.x.x/255.0.0.0)
Example 3 — Incorrect
IP1/Mask1: 10.1.1.2/255.0.0.0
IP2/Mask2: 10.2.1.2/255.0.0.0
IP3/Mask3: 10.3.1.2/255.0.0.0
This example is incorrect because the mask of 255.0.0.0 used for the three IP addresses makes them belong to the same
network of 10.x.x.x.
Public Network
SCADA
EnerVista Software
LAN1
ML3000
P1
IP1/ P2 P3
MAC1
UR
859708A2.vsd
Public Network
SCADA
EnerVista Software
LAN1 LAN2
LAN2
ML3000
ML3000 ML3000
P1 P2 P3
IP1/ IP2/ IP2/
MAC1 MAC2 MAC2
Redundancy mode
UR
859709A4.vsd
Public Network
SCADA
EnerVista Software
LAN1 LAN2
LAN3
ML3000
ML3000 ML3000
P1 P2 P3
IP1/ IP2/ IP3/
MAC1 MAC2 MAC3
UR
5 859710A2.vsd
5.3.5.4 Network
As outlined in the previous section, when using more than one Ethernet port, configure each to belong to a different
network or subnet using the IP addresses and mask. Configure the network IP and subnet settings before configuring the
routing settings.
Follow the IP and subnet mask rules outlined in the Set IP Address in UR section of the Installation chapter.
To obtain a list of all port numbers used, for example for audit purposes, contact GE technical support with substantiating
information, such as the serial number and order code of your device.
SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS NETWORK NETWORK PORT 1(3)
NETWORK PORT 1 PRT1 IP ADDRESS: Range: standard IPV4 address format
127.0.0.1
The IP addresses are used with the DNP, Modbus/TCP, IEC 61580, IEC 60870-5-104, TFTP, HTTP, and PRP protocols. PRP is
explained in its own section later.
Use the front panel to change these settings. When online, the EnerVista software can be used to enable/disable each port
only. In the Offline Window area, all settings can be changed except port 2 redundancy (depending on firmware version).
When using GOOSE, in failover or PRP mode, port 3 configuration in the CID file is ignored. The Port 3 ConnectedAP
elements has no meaning, as ports 2 and 3 use the port 2 MAC address, IP address, and mask.
PRT1 (2 or 3) IP ADDRESS — This setting sets the port’s IPv4 address in standard IPV4 format. This setting is valid on port 3 if
port 2 REDUNDANCY is set to None.
PRT1 (2 or 3) SUBNET MASK — This setting sets the port’s IPv4 subnet mask in standard IPV4 format. This setting is valid on
port 3 if port 2 REDUNDANCY is set to None.
PRT1 (2 or 3) FUNCTION — This setting enable/disables network communication on the respective port. When the port
function is Disabled, the network traffic on this port is disabled. The PRT2 redundancy setting has no effect on this
functionality. The change takes effect upon relay restart. 5
If you disable a port here that is used to communicate between the relay and the software, this can take down all
communication between the two. For example, an Ethernet connection set to the IP address of the relay can be disabled
and cannot be reached, even when pinging. The port needs to be re-enabled, IP and any gateway addresses need to be
checked, and the relay needs to be set to Programmed.
PRT2 REDUNDANCY — Determines if ports 2 and 3 operate in redundant or independent mode. If the software options in the
order code include PRP, the available options are None, Failover, and PRP. If the software options in the order code do not
include PRP, the available options are None and Failover. In non-redundant mode (REDUNDANCY set to None), ports 2 and 3
operate independently with their own MAC, IP, and mask addresses. If REDUNDANCY is set to Failover, the operation of ports
2 and 3 is as follows:
• Ports 2 and 3 use the port 2 MAC address, IP address, and mask
• The configuration fields for IP address and mask on port 3 are hidden
• Port 3 is in standby mode and does not actively communicate on the Ethernet network but monitors its link to the
Multilink switch. If port 2 detects a problem with the link, communications is switched to Port 3. Port 3 is, in effect,
acting as a redundant or backup link to the network for port 2. Once port 2 detects that the link between itself and the
switch is good and that communication is healthy for five minutes, then switching back to port 2 is performed. The
delay in switching back ensures that rebooted switching devices connected to the M60, which signal their ports as
active prior to being completely functional, have time to completely initialize themselves and become active. Once
port 2 is active again, port 3 returns to standby mode.
If REDUNDANCY is set to PRP, the operation of ports 2 and 3 is as follows:
• Ports 2 and 3 use the port 2 MAC address, IP address, and mask
• The configuration fields for IP address and mask on port 3 are overwritten with those from port 2. This is visible on the
front panel but not displayed in the EnerVista software.
• Port 2 MCST ADDRESS field is visible
• The port 2 PTP function still uses only port 2 and the port 3 PTP function still uses only port 3. The relay still
synchronizes to whichever port has the best master. When ports 2 and 3 see the same master, as is typically the case
for PRP networks, the port with the better connectivity is used.
The two ports must be connected to completely independent LANs with no single point of failure, such as common
power supplies that feed switches on both LANs.
When REDUNDANCY is set to PRP or failover and the network path with resolved default gateway is broken, then the
ARP table needs approximately five seconds to rebuild. The layer 2 protocols (GOOSE and PTP) are not affected.
However, the TCP/IP or UDP protocols (MMS connections, DNP3.0, and so on) can require reconnection if their active
connection does not ride through re-transmission frames.
For any changes to this setting to take effect, restart the unit.
PRT2 PRP MCST ADDR — This setting allows the user to change the multicast address used by the PRP supervision frames.
This setting is available if REDUNDANCY is set to PRP. All devices in the same PRP network need to have the same multicast
address. Choose an address that does not conflict with another multicast protocol.
The M60 is provided with optional PRP capability, specified as a software option at the time of ordering.
The Parallel Redundancy Protocol (PRP) defines a redundancy protocol for high availability in substation automation
networks. It applies to networks based on Ethernet technology (ISO/IEC 8802-3) and is based on the second edition (July
2012) of IEC 62439-3, clause 4.
PRP is designed to provide seamless recovery in case of a single failure in the network, by using a combination of LAN
duplication and frame duplication. Identical frames are sent on two completely independent networks that connect
source and destination. Under normal circumstances both frames reach the destination and one of them is sent up the OSI
stack to the destination application, while the second one is discarded. If an error occurs in one of the networks and traffic
is prevented from flowing on that path, connectivity is provided through the other network to ensure continuous
communication. Take care when designing the two LANs, so that no single point of failure (such as a common power
supply) is encountered, as such scenarios can bring down both LANs simultaneously.
Figure 5-16: Example of parallel redundant network
PRP uses specialized nodes called doubly attached nodes (DANPs) for handling the duplicated frames. DANP devices have
an additional module, called a Link Redundancy Entity (LRE). LRE is responsible for duplicating frames and adding the
specific PRP trailer when sending the frames out on the LAN, as well as making decisions on received frames as to which
one is sent up the OSI stack to the application layer and which one is discarded. LRE is responsible for making PRP
transparent to the higher layers of the stack.
In addition, there is a second type of specialized device used in PRP networks, called RedBox, with the role of connecting
Single Attached Nodes (SANs) to a redundant network.
UR relays implement the DANP functionality. The RedBox functionality is not implemented.
The original standard IEC 62439-3 (2010) was amended to align PRP with the High-availability Seamless Redundancy (HSR)
protocol. To achieve this, the original PRP was modified at the cost of losing compatibility with the PRP 2010 version. The 5
revised standard IEC 62439-3 (2012) is commonly referred to as PRP-1, while the original standard is PRP-0. The UR relays
support PRP-1.
The relay implements PRP on two of its Ethernet ports, specifically Ports 2 and 3 of the CPU module. Use the previous
section (network port configuration) to configure PRP.
PRP is purchased as a separate option. If purchased (valid order code), PRP can be enabled in configuration through a
setting available on the network configuration menu, REDUNDANCY, which already has the capability of enabling failover
redundancy. The options on this setting must be changed to accommodate two types of redundancy: failover and PRP.
When REDUNDANCY is set to either failover or PRP, the ports dedicated for PRP (Ports 2 and 3) operate in redundant mode.
In this mode, Port 3 uses the MAC, IP address, and mask of Port 2.
IPv4 NETWORK
ROUTE 1
IPv4 NETWORK
ROUTE 6
Configure the network IP and subnet settings before configuring the routing settings.
Router1
Public network
.1
Router2
10.1.2.0/24 10.1.3.0/24
10.1.1.0/24
ML3000 ML3000 .1
EnerVista Software
P1 P2 P3
IP1/ IP2/ IP3/
.2 .2 MAC2 MAC3
MAC1
UR
859714A1.vsd
5
In the figure, the UR connects through the following two Ethernet ports:
• Port 1 (IP address 10.1.1.2) connects the UR to LAN 10.1.1.0/24 and to the Internet through Router1. Router1 has an
interface on 10.1.1.0/24 and the IP address of this interface is 10.1.1.1.
• Port 2 (IP address 10.1.2.2) connects the UR to LAN 10.1.2.0/24 and to the EnerVista software through Router2. Router2
has an interface on 10.1.2.0/24 and the IP address of this interface is 10.1.2.1.
The configuration before release 7.10 was as follows:
• PRT1 IP ADDRESS = 10.1.1.2
PRT1 SUBNET IP MASK = 255.255.255.0
PRT1 GWY IP ADDRESS = 10.1.1.1
PRT2 IP ADDRESS = 10.1.2.2
PRT2 SUBNET IP MASK = 255.255.255.0
The behavior before release 7.10 was as follows. When sending packets to EnerVista, the UR noticed that the destination
was not on a connected network and it tried to find a route to destination. Since the default route was the only route it
knew, it used it. Yet EnerVista was on a private network, which was not reachable through Router1. Hence a destination
unreachable message was received from the router.
The configuration starting with release 7.10 is as follows:
• PRT1 IP ADDRESS = 10.1.1.2
PRT1 SUBNET IP MASK = 255.255.255.0
PRT2 IP ADDRESS = 10.1.2.2
PRT2 SUBNET IP MASK = 255.255.255.0
IPV4 DEFAULT ROUTE: GATEWAY ADDRESS = 10.1.1.1
STATIC NETWORK ROUTE 1: RT1 DESTINATION = 10.1.3.0/24; RT1 NET MASK = 255.255.255.0; and RT1 GATEWAY =
10.1.2.1
The behavior since release 7.10 is as follows. There is one added static network route to the destination 10.1.3.0/24, where
a computer running EnerVista is located. This static route uses a different gateway (10.1.2.1) than the default route. This
gateway is the address of Router2, which has knowledge about 10.1.3.0 and is able to route packets coming from the UR
and destined to EnerVista.
5 Age (min)
Hardware Address
Age, in minutes, of the cache entry. A hyphen (-) means the address is local.
LAN hardware address, a MAC address that corresponds to network address
Type Dynamic or Static
Interface Interface to which this address mapping has been assigned
The serial communication ports utilize the Modbus protocol, unless the port is configured for DNP or IEC 60870-5-103
operation. This allows the EnerVista UR Setup software to be used on the port. UR devices operate as Modbus slave
devices only.
For more information on the protocol, including the memory map table, see the UR Family Communications Guide.
MODBUS SLAVE ADDRESS — When using the Modbus protocol on the RS232 port, the M60 responds regardless of the
MODBUS SLAVE ADDRESS programmed. For the RS485 port, each device on the serial bus must have a unique slave address
from 1 to 254. Address 0 and addresses from 248 and up are reserved by the Modbus protocol specification, and so their
use here is not recommended. Address 0 is the broadcast address to which all Modbus slave devices listen. Addresses do
not have to be sequential, but no two devices can have the same address or conflicts resulting in errors occur. Generally,
starting at 1, set each device added to the link to use the next higher address. When using Modbus TCP/IP, the client must
use the programmed MODBUS SLAVE ADDRESS value in the Unit Identifier field.
MODBUS TCP PORT NUMBER — Modbus over TCP/IP can also be used on any of the Ethernet ports. The listening TCP port 502
is reserved for Modbus communications, and only in exceptional cases when MODBUS TCP PORT NUMBER is set to any other
port. The MODBUS TCP PORT NUMBER setting sets the TCP port used by Modbus on Ethernet. A MODBUS TCP PORT NUMBER of
0 disables Modbus over TCP/IP, meaning closes the Modbus TCP port. When the port number is changed to 0, the change
takes effect when the M60 is restarted. When it is set to 0, use the front panel or serial port to communicate with the relay.
Do not set more than one protocol to the same TCP/UDP port number, as this results in unreliable operation of
those protocols.
The PROTOCOL menu allows selection of one of the following protocols: DNP 3.0, IEC60870-104, or IEC60870-103.
SCADA PROTOCOL — This setting selects the SCADA protocol on which the unit communicates, among DNP3.0, IEC 60870-
104, and IEC 60870-103, with DNP being the default. Options depend on order code. For any change to take effect, restart
the unit.
MMS CONNECTION TIMEOUT — This setting specifies a time delay for the detection of network TCP connection lost. If there is
no data traffic on the TCP connection for greater than the time specified by this setting, the connection is terminated. This
frees up the connection to be re-used by a client. A setting of 10 seconds disables this timer. The TCP connection then is
managed by a standard TCP KeepAlive message sequence. These messages are transmitted every 20 seconds when there
is no MMS communication between the relay and the client. If there are no responses to the TCP KeepAlive messages, the
5
connection is closed. For any change to this setting to take effect, restart the unit. The change takes effect for a new
connection. For any existing open connection when the change is made, close and re-open the connection. Cycling power
to the relay also applies the new setting.
The table shows which of DNP 3.0, IEC 60870-5-104, IEC 60870-5-103, and IEC 61850 protocols are operational on the
RS232, RS485, and Ethernet ports. It shows all possible combinations of the PROTOCOL and DNP CHANNEL 1(2) PORT settings.
5 Channel 1: RS232
Channel 2: RS485
DNP DNP Modbus, IEC 61850
IEC61850 EDITION — Switches between Editions 1 and 2 of the IEC 61850 protocol. For Process Bus GOOSE, the setting is
fixed at Edition 2. When switching, settings default with the change, except GGIO1, GGIO2, GGIO4, and those for the
graphical front panel. A message displays that a reboot is required, which can be done using Maintenance > Reboot
Relay Command.
SFTP PROTOCOL — Enables and disables file transfer to/from the relay by Secure Shell (SSH) and Secure File Transfer
Protocol (SFTP). This setting displays when using IEC 61850 without CyberSentry.
DNP CURRENT SCALE Range: 0.001, 0.01. 0.1, 1, 10, 100, 1000, 10000,
FACTOR: 1 100000, 1000000, 10000000, 100000000
DNP VOLTAGE SCALE Range: 0.001, 0.01. 0.1, 1, 10, 100, 1000, 10000,
FACTOR: 1 100000, 1000000, 10000000, 100000000
DNP POWER SCALE Range: 0.001, 0.01. 0.1, 1, 10, 100, 1000, 10000,
FACTOR: 1 100000, 1000000, 10000000, 100000000
DNP ENERGY SCALE Range: 0.001, 0.01. 0.1, 1, 10, 100, 1000, 10000,
FACTOR: 1 100000, 1000000, 10000000, 100000000
DNP PF SCALE Range: 0.001, 0.01. 0.1, 1, 10, 100, 1000, 10000,
FACTOR: 1 100000, 1000000, 10000000, 100000000
DNP OTHER SCALE Range: 0.001, 0.01. 0.1, 1, 10, 100, 1000, 10000,
FACTOR: 1 100000, 1000000, 10000000, 100000000
The Distributed Network Protocol (DNP) allows for the optimization of control and data acquisition between the equipment
in the substation and the central control center. The protocol is scalable; that is, it is designed to be compatible with the
latest high speed LAN technology yet still be implemented over slower speed serial links.
The DNP improves upon many master-slave protocols by improving overall communication performance requirements
and provides time-stamping with millisecond accuracy.
The M60 supports DNP version 3.0.
DNP is enabled when the SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS PROTOCOL setting is set to DNP 3.0. The M60
can be used as a DNP slave device connected to multiple DNP masters (usually an RTU or a SCADA master station). Since
the M60 maintains two sets of DNP data change buffers and connection information, two DNP masters can actively
communicate with the M60 at one time.
DNP is not available using the USB port on the graphical front panel.
See the UR Family Communications Guide for more information on DNP.
DNP CHANNEL 2 PORT: Range: NONE, COM1 - RS485, COM2 - RS485, FRONT
NONE PANEL - RS232, NETWORK - TCP
The DNP CHANNEL 1 PORT and DNP CHANNEL 2 PORT settings select the communications port assigned to the DNP protocol
for each channel. Once DNP is assigned to a serial port, DNP is the only protocol running on that port; Modbus or IEC
60870-5-103 are disabled. If DNP is assigned to RS485, the protocol must be set to DNP on the serial port configuration as
well, for the change to take effect. When the DNP CHANNEL 1(2) PORT setting is set to “Network - TCP,” the channel 1(2) DNP
protocol can be used over TCP/IP on the Ethernet ports. When this value is set to “Network - UDP,” the DNP protocol can be
used over UDP/IP on channel 1 only. The "Front Panel - RS232" setting does not apply to the graphical front panel; when
selected the DNP client cannot establish a connection on a USB port.
Do not set more than one protocol to the same TCP/UDP port number, as this results in unreliable operation of
those protocols.
The DNP ADDRESS setting is the DNP slave address. This number identifies the M60 on a DNP communications link. Assign a
unique address to each DNP slave.
The M60 can specify a maximum of five clients for its DNP connections. These are IP addresses for the controllers to which
the M60 can connect. The settings follow.
SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS DNP PROTOCOL DNP NETWORK CLIENT ADDRESSES
DNP NETWORK CLIENT ADDRESS 1: Range: standard IP address
CLIENT ADDRESSES 0.0.0.0
The DNP TCP/UDP PORT NUMBER setting is for normal DNP operation. To close the port, set the port number to 0.
The DNP UNSOL RESPONSE FUNCTION is set to “Disabled” for RS485 applications since there is no collision avoidance
mechanism. The DNP UNSOL RESPONSE TIMEOUT sets the time the M60 waits for a DNP master to confirm an unsolicited
response. The DNP UNSOL RESPONSE MAX RETRIES setting determines the number of times the M60 retransmits an
unsolicited response without receiving confirmation from the master; a value of “255” allows infinite re-tries. The DNP
UNSOL RESPONSE DEST ADDRESS is the DNP address to which all unsolicited responses are sent. The IP address to which
solicited responses are sent is determined by the M60 from the current TCP connection or the most recent UDP message.
The DNP scale factor settings are numbers used to scale analog input point values. These settings group the M60 analog
input data into the following types: current, voltage, power, energy, power factor, and other. Each setting represents the
scale factor for all analog input points of that type. For example, if the DNP VOLTAGE SCALE FACTOR setting is set to “1000,”
all DNP analog input points that are voltages are returned with values 1000 times smaller (for example, a value of 72000 V
on the M60 is returned as 72). These settings are useful when analog input values must be adjusted to fit within certain
ranges in DNP masters. Note that a scale factor of 0.1 is equivalent to a multiplier of 10 (that is, the value is 10 times larger).
The DNP DEFAULT DEADBAND settings determine when to trigger unsolicited responses containing analog input data. These
settings group the M60 analog input data into the following types: current, voltage, power, energy, power factor, and other.
Each setting represents the default deadband value for all analog input points of that type. For example, to trigger
unsolicited responses from the M60 when any current values change by 15 A, the DNP CURRENT DEFAULT DEADBAND
setting is set to “15.” Note that these settings are the deadband default values. DNP object 34 points can be used to
change deadband values, from the default, for each individual DNP analog input point.
The DNP TIME SYNC IIN PERIOD setting determines how often the Need Time Internal Indication (IIN) bit is set by the M60.
Changing this time allows the DNP master to send time synchronization commands more or less often, as required.
The DNP MESSAGE FRAGMENT SIZE setting determines the size, in bytes, at which message fragmentation occurs. Large
fragment sizes allow for more efficient throughput; smaller fragment sizes cause more application layer confirmations to
5
be necessary, which provides more robust data transfer over noisy communication channels.
Check the “DNP Points Lists” M60 web page to view the analog inputs and/or binary inputs points lists. This page
can be viewed with a web browser by entering the IP address of the M60 Ethernet port employed to access the
M60 Main Menu, then by clicking the Device Information Menu item, then the DNP Points Lists item.
The DNP OBJECT 1 DEFAULT VARIATION to DNP OBJECT 32 DEFAULT VARIATION settings select the DNP default variation
number for object types 1, 2, 20, 21, 22, 23, 30, and 32. The default variation refers to the variation response when variation
0 is requested and/or in class 0, 1, 2, or 3 scans. See the DNP Implementation section in the UR Family Communications
Guide.
The DNP binary outputs typically map one-to-one to IED data points. That is, each DNP binary output controls a single
physical or virtual control point in an IED. In the M60 relay, DNP binary outputs are mapped to virtual inputs. However,
some legacy DNP implementations use a mapping of one DNP binary output to two physical or virtual control points to
support the concept of trip/close (for circuit breakers) or raise/lower (for tap changers) using a single control point. That is,
the DNP master can operate a single point for both trip and close, or raise and lower, operations. The M60 can be
configured to support paired control points, with each paired control point operating two virtual inputs. The DNP NUMBER
OF PAIRED CONTROL POINTS setting allows configuration of 0 to 32 binary output paired controls. Points not configured as
paired operate on a one-to-one basis.
The DNP TCP CONNECTION TIMEOUT setting specifies a time delay for the detection of dead network TCP connections. If
there is no data traffic on a DNP TCP connection for greater than the time specified by this setting, the connection is
aborted by the M60. This frees up the connection to be re-used by a client.
Up to 256 binary and up to 256 analog input points for the DNP protocol, or the MSP and MME points for IEC 60870-5-104
protocol, can be configured. The value for each point is user-programmable and can be configured by assigning FlexLogic
operands for binary inputs / MSP points or FlexAnalog parameters for analog inputs / MME points.
The menu for the binary input points (DNP) or MSP points (IEC 60870-5-104) follows.
SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS DNP / IEC104 POINT LISTS BINARY INPUT / MSP POINTS
BINARY INPUT / MSP Point: 0 Range: FlexLogic operand
POINTS Off
Up to 256 binary input points can be configured for the DNP or IEC 60870-5-104 protocols. The points are configured by
assigning an appropriate FlexLogic operand. See the Introduction to FlexLogic section in this chapter for the range of
assignable operands.
5 Changes to the DNP / IEC 60870-5-104 point lists take effect when the M60 is restarted.
The menu for the analog input points (DNP) or MME points (IEC 60870-5-104) follows.
SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS DNP / IEC104 POINT LISTS ANALOG INPUT / MME
POINTS
ANALOG INPUT / MME Point: 0 Range: any FlexAnalog parameter
POINTS Off
Up to 256 analog input points can be configured for the DNP or IEC 60870-5-104 protocols. The analog point list is
configured by assigning an appropriate FlexAnalog parameter to each point. See the FlexAnalog Parameters section in
Appendix A for the range of assignable parameters.
Changes to the DNP / IEC 60870-5-104 point lists take effect when the M60 is restarted.
The DNP / IEC 60870-5-104 point lists always begin with point 0 and end at the first “Off” value. Since DNP / IEC
60870-5-104 point lists must be in one continuous block, any points assigned after the first “Off” point are ignored.
The M60 is provided with optional IEC 61850 communications, specified as a software option at the time of
ordering.
The IEC 61850 settings are accessible in EnerVista software or a substation configuration language (SCL) generating tool.
The path is Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 or Settings > IEC 61850. The settings are not
accessible from the front panel of the device.
IEC 61850 messaging can form part of protection schemes. Consider IEC 61850 settings with the same criticality as
protection element settings. To ensure reliable performance of protection schemes utilizing IEC 61850 messaging,
route IEC 61850 traffic on a separate port from SCADA communications, or use redundant, independent ports, and
a high-speed network recovery method, such as PRP.
Overview
IEC 61850 is a series of international standards and technical reports applicable to power utility automation systems. It
includes semantics, abstract communication services, specific communication services, performance specifications,
network engineering guidelines, configuration description methodologies, and engineering processes. The standard
enables interoperability among intelligent electronic devices (IEDs) from different suppliers and interoperability among
software configuration tools from different suppliers. Interoperability in this case is the ability for IEDs to operate on the
same network or communication path sharing information and commands, and for configuration tools to understand
each other's configuration files.
The UR family supports a large subset of IEC 61850 features. These are detailed in the UR Family Communications Guide
and include the information model, GOOSE publish, GOOSE subscribe, buffered report server, unbuffered report server, and
Manufacturing Message Specification (MMS) query, read, write, and control services. In addition, the URs and their
EnerVista UR Setup software support IEC 61850 Substation Configuration Language (SCL) file import/export and merging.
Many settings of UR protection, control, and monitoring elements, that is to say elements that are not concerned with the
IEC 61850 protocol, can nevertheless be accessed via IEC 61850. These settings are documented elsewhere in this Settings
chapter. This section of the Settings chapter deals solely with the settings that configure the IEC 61850 protocol itself.
The maximum number of simultaneous clients supported by the UR family is five. 5
IEC 61850 Editions 1 and 2
This release supports IEC 61850 Edition 1 and Edition 2. The default is Edition 2.
Select IEC 61850 Edition 1 or Edition 2 under Settings > Product Setup > Communications > Protocol. When a non-
HardFiber Process Bus Module is present, only Edition 2 is used. Switching defaults the IEC 61850 settings, except GGIO1,
GGIO2, GGIO4, and those for the graphical front panel. When a message displays that a reboot is required, use
Maintenance > Reboot Relay Command.
Edition 2.0 is used with certain modifications according to IEC/TR 61850-90-5. Only edition 2.0 61850 configuration tools
can interoperate with Edition 2.0 devices, such as the UR 7.3x, 7.4x, or 7.6x release. When using Edition 2, the UR release
uses Edition 2.0 SCL, which differs from Edition 1.0 SCL.
Fixed GOOSE, GSSE, and Edition 1 report services are not supported beyond version 7.2x. Configure UR devices using these
features to use configurable GOOSE to communicate with a 7.3x or later device.
When set to Edition 1
• The test flag in the Tx GOOSE message header is set to TRUE when the TEST MODE FUNCTION is set to Test or Test-
Blocked
• The test flag in the received GOOSE message header is not validated
• Routable GOOSE is not supported
• Process Bus Module is not supported (order code 85, 86, or 87)
• Process Bus GOOSE is not supported
• The FlexLogic category does not display in the IEC 61850 panels in the EnerVista UR Setup software
• With SCL file import, for Edition 1 the IP address in the ConnectedAP element must match one IP address of the device,
while for Edition 2 one of the three IP addresses in the ConnectedAP element must match
The fields that display in the software depend on the Edition selected and the M60. Differences are noted in the sections
that follow. If required, consult the Model Implementation Conformance Statement (MICS) section of the UR Family
Communications Guide to understand what applies to your setup.
The IEC 61850 window is divided into a navigation pane on the left and a settings panel on the right. You expand and click
an option on the left to display its panel on the right. The following figure shows an example for Server Configuration. The
SETTING column contains the names of the settings, and the PARAMETER column is used to enter the settings. Hovering
the mouse over a setting name displays a tool-tip showing the 61850 information model name of the setting or its location
in SCL files.
The content displayed varies with UR firmware version. For example the version 7.4 fields shown differ from the version 7.9
fields.
Opening the IEC 61850 window while online causes the EnerVista UR Setup software to retrieve and import an SCL file from
the M60. This System Configuration Description (SCD) file contains all the settings in the UR at the time of the file request,
both those that are mapped into the IEC 61850 information model (that is, the "public" sections) and those that are not in
the model (that is, the "private" section). The software imports all of these settings into the current session, not just those in
the IEC 61850 window. To avoid loss of any unsaved setting changes made in other panels during the current session, all
other panels for the M60 must be closed before the IEC 61850 panel opens, and the software prompts for this when
5
required. Panels for other devices can be open concurrently to facilitate parameter coordination.
When CyberSentry security is enabled, editable settings depend on the user role logged in. For example, an Administrator
and Engineer can change settings. If prompted for a "Settings password," it means the Administrator or Engineer
password.
The Restore button restores settings in the window to their last saved values. The Default button reverts settings in the
window to factory default values or Oscillography, Data Logger, or FlexLogic Equation Editor pre-configured values. The
Reset button reverts all IEC 61850 settings to the factory default values, not just the current window. (In other settings
windows, the button reverts settings in the window to factory default values.)
When a setting is enabled, its panel continues to read Disabled until relaunched. There is no polling capability to update
automatically the IEC 61850 readings, so the panel needs to be closed then opened for the correct status to display. Good
practice is to close any panel not in use because changes being made by other users are reflected only upon relaunch of
the panel.
Some of the IEC 61850 settings use floating point data, which guarantees accurate representation of real numbers up to
seven digits. Numbers with more than seven digits are approximated within a certain precision. This can result in
differences between what is entered and what is saved, and can result in differences shown on a settings comparison
report.
When the Save button is clicked in the offline IEC 61850 window, the software saves to local storage, for example the hard
drive, a .urs file containing all settings of the device.
Server configuration
The Server Configuration panel contains IEC 61850 settings relevant to the server functions of the IED implementation.
The path is Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > Server Configuration.
The following settings are available, where <iedName> is a syntactic variable representing the present value of the IED
NAME setting. The settings vary with firmware version, IEC 61850 edition, and device capability.
IED NAME
Range: 1 to 58 VisibleString characters
Default: TEMPLATE
The value entered sets the name used by IEC 61850 for the M60. An IED name unique within the network must be
entered for proper operation. Valid characters are upper and lowercase letters, digits, and the underscore (_) character.
The first character must be a letter.
The IED NAME and the Product LD inst name comprise the <LDName> for a product. The longest LD inst are "Master"
and "System" at six characters, with Master being fixed and the others configurable with the configurable Logical device
feature. So the IED NAME is restricted to 58 characters to meet a 64 character limit.
SUBNETWORK1(5) NAME
Range: 0 to 255 ASCII characters
Default: W1, W2, W3, W4, W5
Subnetworks 1 to 3 display for Editions 1 and 2. Subnetworks 4 and 5 display for Edition 2 with Process Bus Module.
When importing an SCL file:
– Subnetwork 1 to 3 names are identified by the contained ConnectedAP element of the target IED
– If a ConnectedAP element is missing, the respective subnetwork name uses the default value
– When the IEC 61850 server Edition is set to 1 (under Product Setup > Communications > Protocol), one
ConnectedAP is available in the SCL file. Only the respective subnetwork name is populated and editable. The rest
of the subnetwork names are read-only with default values. After importing an Edition 1 SCL file, you can select
the Access Point that needs to be populated from the Edition 1 SCL file and you can edit the subnetwork name in
the EnerVista UR Setup software.
– Subnetwork 1 to 3 names need to be unique
When exporting an SCL file:
– Subnetwork 1 to 3 names are preserved
– When the IEC 61850 server Edition is set to 1, the selected Access Point and respective subnetwork names are
populated
Access Point
Range: S1, S2, S3
Default: S1
This setting applies to IEC 61850 Edition 1. It is the subnetwork.
Location
Range: 0 to 255 ASCII characters
Default: Location
The value entered sets the value of the data attribute <LDName>/LPHD1.PhyNam.location. This data attribute is
provided by the protocol to allow the user to declare where the equipment is installed.
Latitude
Range: -90.000 to 90.000 degrees in steps of 0.001 degree 5
Default: 0.000 deg
The value entered sets the value of the data attribute <LDName>/LPHD1.PhyNam.latitude. This data attribute is provided
by the protocol to declare the geographical position of the device in WGS84 coordinates -latitude. Negative values
indicate a southern latitude. WGS refers to the world geodetic system, which is used in global positioning systems (GPS),
and 84 is the current version of the standard.
Longitude
Range: -180.000 to 180.000 degrees in steps of 0.001 degree
Default: 0.000 deg
The value entered sets the value of the data attribute <LDName>/LPHD1.PhyNam.longitude. This data attribute is
provided by the protocol to declare the geographical position of the device in WGS84 coordinates -longitude. Negative
values indicate a western longitude.
Altitude
Range: 0 to 10,0000 m in steps of 1 m
Default: 0.000 m
The value entered sets the value of the data attribute <LDName>/LPHD1.PhyNam.altitude. This data attribute is provided
by the protocol to declare the geographical position of the device in WGS84 coordinates - altitude.
Prefix for GGIO1
Range for Edition 2: 0 to 11 VisibleString characters
Range for Edition 1: 0 to 6 VisibleString characters
Default:
This setting sets the LN Prefix of the FlexLogic operand interface logical node GGIO1 that is described in the GGIO1
section later. Valid characters are upper and lowercase letters, digits, and the underscore (_) character. The first
character must be a letter. The software does not allow entry of a prefix that duplicates any other GGIO1 prefix that is
used by the product, such as ConIn and ConOut.
Logical devices
The Edit Data Model panel contains IEC 61850 settings relevant to the configurable logical devices feature, wherein logical
device naming can be reconfigured and logical nodes re-assigned.
The path is Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > Edit Data Model.
Figure 5-21: Default panel with devices middle and nodes right (Edition 2)
For the Master logical device, the following logical nodes are read-only:
• The LLN0 in the Master logical device, which includes setting group, GOOSE and report control blocks, and datasets
• LPHD1 — Models common issues for physical devices
• GGIO1 — For unmapped FlexLogic operands
• GGIO2 — For Virtual Input control
• GGIO3 — For RxGOOSE Inputs
• GGIO4 — For unmapped FlexAnalog operands
• LGOS logical nodes — For GOOSE subscription
• Process Bus Module logical nodes
The Edit Data Model panel has middle and right panes. The middle pane has a list of the instantiated logical devices in the
sequence that they appear in SCL, with one device selected. The right pane has a list of the logical nodes presently
assigned to the selected logical device in lexicographic order by logical node name.
In the middle pane logical devices are shown with their product-related name, followed in brackets by their function-
related ldName, and followed by the value of their confRev. In the following example, by right-clicking and editing, the
Protection logical device has been set to instance name "Prot," the function-related name "Feeder1Prot" and the
configuration revision "2016-03-07 08:46." The text is clipped on the right if the line is longer than the available width. The
next paragraphs explain how to do this setup.
Figure 5-22: Protection logical node selected
Right-clicking a logical device displays the menu that allows insertion of a new logical device immediately below the
selected one, deletion of the selected logical device, or editing the selected logical device's parameters. The insert option is
disabled and greyed-out if there are already 16 logical devices instantiated. The delete option is disabled and greyed-out if
the selected logical device is Master or it contains any logical nodes other than LLN0.
Figure 5-23: Menu for logical node
The Default LN Name(s) in this LD option resets logical names to default values. When the logical node name is edited, the
logical nodes pane displays the edited name followed by the default logical node name in brackets. The right-click menu
at the IED, logical device, and logical node level provides an option to default the logical node name(s) within the scope of
selection. That means that the defaulting logical node names at the IED level defaults all the logical node names in that IED
and defaulting logical node names at the logical device level defaults the logical node names in that logical device.If the
insert option is selected, or the edit option is selected for other than the Master logical device, a logical device parameters
edit dialog opens.
Figure 5-24: Insert new logical node (Edition 2)
5
If the edit option is selected for the Master logical device, the Product LD inst name setting is not editable.
Figure 5-25: Edit logical node
When the Ok button is clicked, the entered values for Product LD inst name and Functional ldName are checked for
uniqueness within the UR, and they are updated in the pane.
The settings are explained as follows, where <iedName> is a syntactic variable representing the present value of the IED
NAME setting. When adding or editing a logical device entry, these are the fields that need to be completed.
Functional ldName
Range: 0 to 64 VisibleString characters
Default: empty string
Each logical device has this setting. The value is configurable in all logical devices. Valid characters are upper and
lowercase letters, digits, and the underscore (_) character. If the number of characters entered is greater than zero, the
setting sets the value of the function-related name used in communications. If an ldName is entered, it must form an
LDName that is unique within the network for proper operation. The standard recommends choosing this name
according to IEC 81346-1. If the number of characters entered is zero, no function-related name is defined.
Throughout the remainder of this IEC 61850 section, <LDName> is a syntactic variable representing the present
LDName of the master logical device. In other contexts LDName can refer to some other logical device. Depending
on its context, <LDName> can be a product-related name or a function-related name.
configRev
Range: 0 to 255 ASCII characters
Default:
This data attribute is provided by the protocol to declare changes to the semantic of the data model of the UR. The intent
is that the user changes Master configRev each time that the semantic or data model changes, so that clients can
readily detect the change. A semantic change is a logical node getting a new semantic use; for example, an instance of
logical node CSWI is now serving a different physical switch, or an instance of a logical node PDIS is now used for
another zone. A data model change is a change in the presence of logical nodes, data objects, data attributes, or
instance names.
The scope of Maser configRev is the entire relay configuration, as the Master logical device is the root logical device.
Similar settings are provided for the other logical nodes; the scope of these other configRev settings is limited to the
corresponding logical device configuration.
paramRev
Range: -2,147,483,648 to 2,147,483,647
Default: 0
The configurable data attribute paramRev has a scope that includes the entire device, and thus is modified whenever
any setting in the device changes. The UR increments the value of paramRev by one whenever one or multiple setting
changes occurs in one Modbus write request by any means (front panel, Modbus, or MMS) other than by SCL file
download. Incrementing occurs whether or not the setting is represented in the information model. When a UR device or
EnerVista UR Setup accepts an SCL file, paramRev is set to the value in that SCL file. When EnerVista UR Setup changes
one or more settings, and prepares an SCL file, it increments paramRev to the next higher multiple of 10 000.
Each logical device has a name: LDName. (Note the upper case LD.) LDName has both a product-related form and
a function-related form as per IEC 61850 6:2009 8.5.3.
SCL files invariably use the product-related form of LDName. The product-related form is the concatenation of the
IED name of the device and the individual logical device's inst name. The IED name is the value of the "IED NAME"
setting on the Server Configuration panel, and the logical device inst names are each the value of the
corresponding "Product LD inst name" setting here. The "Product LD inst name" of the first logical device is fixed at
"Master."
Communications use the function-related form of LDName if a function-related name is defined, otherwise
communications use the product-related name. The function-related name is the value of the corresponding
"Functional ldName" setting if this setting is not empty, if empty the function-related name is not defined.
In SCL, the function-related name is specified by the LDevice element attribute ldName (note the lower case ld).
Absence of this attribute indicates the function-related name is not defined. In SCL the product-related name is
specified by the name attribute of the IED element and the inst attribute of the LDevice element.
In the right pane, logical nodes assigned permanently to the Master logical device and LLN0 in all logical devices are
greyed-out as shown earlier. These are not movable. Any other logical node can be dragged to any of the logical devices in
5
the middle pane, which causes that logical device to be re-assigned to that logical device. Right-clicking a logical node
device displays a menu that lists the logical devices that this logical node can be moved to. Clicking one of these re-
assigns the logical node. Other common keyboard and/or mouse action can be used to select one or more logical nodes
and move the selected nodes together.
Figure 5-26: Move logical node (Edition 2)
GOOSE
GOOSE, Routable GOOSE, and Process Bus GOOSE are supported, depending on hardware and software options.
The path is Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > GOOSE.
R-GOOSE is available through the IEC 61850 software option. If R-GOOSE security is required, the CyberSentry
software option also is required.
TxGOOSE
IEC 61850 GOOSE is an efficient method for simultaneous high-speed delivery of generic substation event information by a
publishing device to more than one subscribing device. A TxGOOSE is a UR element implementing a single IEC 61850
GOOSE message publishing service. The subscribing function in URs is performed by RxGOOSE elements, as described in
the next section. Each UR with an IEC 61850 order code option has 16 TxGOOSE elements. Each TxGOOSE can either use
the original format specified in IEC 61850 8 1:2011 or the routable GOOSE (R-GOOSE; IEC 61850 Edition 2) format specified
in IEC TR 61850-90-5:2012. Each TxGOOSE element can publish the values of up to 64 attributes of the IEC 61850 nodes in
the UR.
Published TxGOOSE messages configured in the EnerVista UR Setup software can be subscribed by and the published
operand values understood by other UR devices. Furthermore, they can be subscribed to and understood by any device of
any manufacturer that implements the IEC 61850 Edition 1.0 or 2.0 GOOSE subscription mechanism. The messages are
published with a multicast address so that the network sends the messages to all devices; any number of devices that
want to subscribe can.
For wide-area protection, control, and monitoring schemes, R-GOOSE wraps the original format GOOSE in IP/UDP to
multicast (or unicast) the data over a Wide Area Network (WAN). Sample applications are Wide area Remedial Action
Scheme (RAS) and Under Voltage / Frequency Load Shedding Schemes (UVLS/UFLS). R GOOSE uses IGMPv3 (Internet Group
Management Protocol version-3, RFC 3376) for multicasting.
The entity, device, or operand values that are published in GOOSE messages are known as members. The members are
itemized in an ordered list known as a data set. Each TxGOOSE can use any one of the configured data sets. (See the
DataSets section later for details.) The performance of a TxGOOSE is determined by its dataset. Booleans in fast GOOSE
datasets are designed for the TT6 transfer time class (3 ms), while Booleans in the Normal datasets are designed for the
TT3 class (100 ms). Due to the significant amount of CPU time required to compose a TT6 TxGOOSE message and the
limited amount of time allowed by the TT6 class, at most four of these can be configured in a given UR. So only four fast
GOOSE are allowed to be configured, and the UR software has a check to disallow the use of more than four fast datasets
in GOOSE. If six fast datasets are configured outside of UR software and the file sent directly to the relay, the relay rejects
the file. The design does allow six fast datasets to be used in report control blocks, which allows fast scanned data in
reports.
Each enabled TxGOOSE transmits its message whenever a value change is detected in one or more of its members. If the
changed value is a Boolean in a fast dataset, then the change detection occurs in the TT6 detection time of 3 ms or less. If
the member is an analog value in a fast dataset, the change detection occurs in the TT3 time of 100 ms. In Normal GOOSE
Datasets, change detection for all dataset members occurs in the TT3 time of 100 ms. To guard against the possibility that
such a message is lost in the network before it reaches all subscribers, the message is retransmitted quickly several times.
To allow subscribers to verify that their link to the publisher and the publisher itself are healthy, each message is also
retransmitted periodically even while the values are unchanging. These latter messages are known as heartbeat 5
messages, while the former are known as event messages. Heartbeat messages also enable a subscriber newly online to
receive the published values in the absence of an event.
The details of TxGOOSE message construction are contained in the UR Family Communications Guide. Knowledge of these
details is not required to configure GOOSE.
The UR does not implement the fixed-length encoded GOOSE messages option specified in IEC 61850-8-1:2011 clause A.3;
the UR always uses the ASN.1 Basic Encoding Rules (specified in ISO/IEC 8825-1) as specified in IEC 61850 Edition 1.0 and
optional in IEC 61850 Edition 2.0.
Navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > GOOSE > TxGOOSE > TxGOOSE1 to access the
settings for the first TxGOOSE. The settings and functionality for the other entries are similar.
Figure 5-27: IEC 61850 TxGOOSE panel (Edition 2 and with Process Bus Module)
A data set needs to be set up and selected in the TxGOOSEx DatSet field for all content to display.
When saving changes, when a "dataset member is empty" message displays, you need to set the member in the bottom
right of the window.
TxGOOSE1 MODE
Range for Edition 2: Disabled, GOOSE, R-GOOSE
Range for Edition 1: Disabled, GOOSE
Default: Disabled
When set to Disabled, TxGOOSE1 messages are not published. When set to GOOSE, TxGOOSE1 messages are published
in IEC 61850 8 1:2011 GOOSE format. When set to R-GOOSE, TxGOOSE1 messages are published in Routable GOOSE
format according to IEC 61850 90-5, and the TxGOOSE1 DST MAC address is set to 00 00 00 00 00 00 and cannot be
changed.
TxGOOSE1 GoCB name
Range: 0 up to 32 VisibleString characters
Default: GoCB01
The entered value sets the GOOSE control block (GoCB) name value for TxGOOSE1.
An ObjectReference to the control block, which consists of the concatenation of the string "<LDName>/LLN0." and the
control block name, is published in the gocbRef field of TxGOOSE1 messages and is used by subscribers to discriminate
TxGOOSE1 messages from other GOOSE messages. <LDName> is a syntactic variable that is set to the value of setting
Master functional ldName if one or more characters have been entered to that setting, otherwise the value of setting IED
NAME suffixed with "Master".
TxGOOSE1 GoID
Range for Edition 2: 0 to 129 VisibleString characters
Range for Edition 1: 0 to 65 VisibleString characters
Default: TxGOOSE1
The entered value sets the goID value published in TxGOOSE1 messages, and can be used by subscribers to discriminate
the TxGOOSE1 messages from other GOOSE messages. Special characters are not allowed, such as <, >, &, ’, and ".
TxGOOSE1 DatSet
Range: None, TT6DataSet1,TT6 DataSet2, … TT3DataSet01,TT3 DataSet02, …
Default: None
This setting selects the published data set using the UR Setup software designator for the data set. If None is selected, no
TxGOOSE1 messages are sent.
The IEC 61850 name of the data sets are configured in the Datasets panel, as described later.
Some datasets are designed for the TT6 transfer time class (3 ms), while others are designed for the TT3 class (100 ms).
The performance of a TxGOOSE is determined by its dataset. Use TT6 datasets for trips and blocking applications, TT3
datasets for slow automatic interactions. The 61850 name of the datasets are configured in the Datasets panel.
An ObjectReference to the data set, which consists of the concatenation of the string "<LDName>/LLN0." and the data
set name, is published in the datSet field of TxGOOSE1 messages and can be used by subscribers to discriminate
TxGOOSE1 messages from other GOOSE messages. <LDName> is a syntactic variable that is set to the value of setting
Master functional ldName if one or more characters have been entered to that setting, otherwise the value of setting IED
NAME suffixed with "Master".
To configure a DataSet, select it at the top of the window from the drop-down list. In the lower part of the window, drag
and drop configuration items to the right side. Dataset members configured here affect other Report or TxGOOSE control
blocks that use the same DataSet.
The performance of the TxGOOSE is determined by the performance of the selected dataset. When the selection is 5
TT3DataSet01, TT3DataSet02, … it is possible that transient events can be missed.
TxGOOSE1 DST MAC
Range: any 12 digit hexadecimal number
Default: 01-0C-CD-01-00-00 when TxGOOSE1 MODE is set to GOOSE, 00-00-00-00-00-00 when TxGOOSE1 MODE is set to
R-GOOSE
When the TxGOOSE1 MODE is set to R-GOOSE, the value of this setting is not used. If R-TxGOOSE1 DST IP is set to
multicast, the destination MAC address is derived from the configured multicast IP address. If R-TxGOOSE1 DST IP is set
to unicast IP, the UR resolves the destination MAC address using the ARP protocol. If R-TxGOOSE1 DST IP is in the range
of any of the configured static routes (first usable static route), the UR uses the gateway IP of that static route for
resolving the destination MAC. Otherwise, the UR uses the default gateway. The same is repeated on all the configured
ports of the TxGOOSE1 CPU PORT ASSIGNMENT setting.
When the TxGOOSE1 MODE setting is GOOSE, the value entered here sets the Ethernet destination MAC address in
published TxGOOSE1 messages. As the standard requires that the address have the multicast bit set TRUE, that is to say
the second digit is set to an odd number, messages transmitted have the multicast bit set TRUE no matter its value in this
setting.
The destination MAC address can be used by the network to restrict message delivery to selected devices that need to
receive them, reducing network load. This address also can be used by hardware in receiving devices to filter out
messages that are of no interest to them, reducing processor burden. Different filtering algorithms are implemented by
different devices. The standard recommends that the algorithm used by hardware of the receiving device be considered
when assigning destination multicast addresses.
Subscribers can use this address to discriminate TxGOOSE1 messages from other GOOSE messages.
After relay startup, ARP requests are sent to the gateway address (approximately within 30 seconds after relay startup).
When the ARP response is received, the ARP table is updated, and the unicast R-GOOSE messages are published with the
resolved MAC address. Every 20 minutes, the UR flushes the ARP table and rebuilds the ARP table by sending the ARP
requests.
• If the gateway router is offline, the UR retransmits the ARP requests at one second intervals for 10 seconds, and the
same sequence is repeated at approximately six minutes until the ARP response is received
• When the network link is disconnected, at the connection, the UR transmits the ARP messages to rebuild the ARP table
and when the ARP table is updated, the UR publishes the unicast messages. The recovery time could be up to five
minutes for publishing the unicast messages.
• Whenever a change in static route configuration, the UR transmits the ARP requests to the new gateway address
approximately after 70 seconds of static route configuration change
The resolved MAC addresses are displayed in the UR web page.
When using a Process Bus Module (order code 85, 86, or 87) and configuring multiple TxGOOSE to publish, ensure that
the MAC addresses differ. When the MAC addresses are the same, a message displays to change them, for example
"TxGOOSE1 & TxGOOSE2 assigned to PBM have the same DstMAC address. Unique DstMAC addresses are required
between the TxGOOSE for ’PB Port Assignment’ to work correctly."
TxGOOSE1 VLAN PRIORITY
Range: 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 5-4, 6-4, 6-5, 7-4, 7-5, 7-6
Default: 4
When the value entered is 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, or 7, the User Priority value in the IEEE 802.1Q VLAN tag included in published
TxGOOSE1 messages is set to that value. When one of the two-digit values is entered, the dynamic priority feature is
selected: the first event message has the User Priority value of the first digit, and User Priority is decremented in each
following message until reaching the value of the second digit. For instance, if the selected value is 7-5, then the User
Priority values in successive messages beginning with the message triggered by an event is 7, 6, 5, 5, 5, 5, 5, and so on.
Do not make a dynamic priority selection when standard behavior is required.
Network devices can forward a message with a higher priority value before a message with a lower priority value, which
speeds delivery of high-priority messages in heavily loaded networks. The standard recommends that higher-priority
messages, such as GOOSE, have priority values in the range of 4 to 7.
TxGOOSE1 VLAN ID
5 Range: 0 to 4095 in steps of 1
Default: 0
The value entered sets the VID value in the IEEE 802.1Q VLAN tag included in published TxGOOSE1 messages. VID can be
used by network devices to direct messages to only selected devices, reducing network burden. VID values of 0 and 1
are assigned by IEEE 802.1Q to other functions and are not to be used for GOOSE.
TxGOOSE1 ETYPE APPID
Range: 0 to 65535 in steps of 1
Default: 0
The value entered sets the APPID value in published GOOSE messages and can be used by subscribers to discriminate
TxGOOSE1 messages from other GOOSE messages.
The standard reserves the value range 0 to 16383 for GOOSE Type 1 (Fast messages), and reserves the value range
32768 to 41151 for GOOSE Type 1A (Trip messages). Some subscribers can process messages in the Type 1A range
faster than messages in the Type 1 range. The standard reserves the default value (0) to indicate lack of configuration.
The standard strongly recommends unique, source-orientated APPIDs within a given system.
TxGOOSE1 CONFREV
Range: 0 to 4294967295 in steps of 1
Default: 1
The entered value sets the confRev value in published GOOSE messages and can be used by subscribers to discriminate
TxGOOSE messages of the expected configuration revision from messages of a different revision. The standard requires
that CONFREV be incremented each time the members or the order of the members published is changed. The standard
states that the value of 0 is reserved.
When setting PRT2 REDUNDANCY to Failover or to PRP, the TxGOOSE 1 CPU PORT ASSIGNMENT needs to be set to
ports 2 and 3 (Ports-2,3).
Also, Port 3 configuration in the CID file is ignored. The Port 3 ConnectedAP elements has no meaning, as ports 2
and 3 use the port 2 MAC address, IP address, and mask.
TxGOOSE1 PB PORT ASSIGNMENT
Range: Individual ports may or may not be checked (PB Port-1…PB Port-8)
Default: None of the ports are selected
This setting displays when the order code includes a non-HardFiber Process Bus Module.
When using a UR Process Bus Module, this setting specifies the Ethernet ports on the Process Bus Module for
transmission of TxGOOSE1. When none of the ports are selected, a TxGOOSE1 message is not transmitted on any port no
matter the state of GoEna. When set to PB Port-1, TxGOOSE1 is published over Process Bus Module Port-1 only. Similarly,
if all ports are selected (PB Port-1 to PB Port-8) all Process Bus Module ports publish TxGOOSE1.
When the TxGOOSE1 Mode is set to R-GOOSE, the setting is read-only.
A maximum of 64 data attributes (in one or more datasets) are allowed to transmit on all TxGOOSE messages that are
configured to transmit on the Process Bus Module.
R-TxGOOSE1 IP CLASS
Range: 0 to 256 in steps of 1
Default: 46
This setting applies to IEC 61850 Edition 2.
When the TxGOOSE1 MODE setting is other than R-GOOSE, the value of this setting is not used. Otherwise this setting
selects the IPv4 Differentiated Services Code Point-DSCP (formerly called TypeOfService-TOS) value. This value provides
priority routing, when supported in the routers. The default value is for Expedited Forwarding (101110B, 46 or 2EH).
R-TxGOOSE1 DST IP
Range: 0.0.0.0 to 255.255.255 in steps of 1
Default: 224.0.0.0
This setting applies to IEC 61850 Edition 2.
When the TxGOOSE1 MODE setting is other than R-GOOSE, the value of this setting is not used. Otherwise this setting
specifies destination IP address for the R-TXGOOSE1 that is entered in Standard IPV4 address format. The destination IP
address needs to be a valid multicast or unicast IP address. The value specified in this setting is mapped to IPv4 header
32 bit field for Destination IP Address while publishing R-GOOSE1.
The default IP address 224.0.0.0 is reserved, and hence not a valid multicast IP address.
The source IP address is that of the UR port from which the R-GOOSE messages are transmitted.
R-TxGOOSE1 SECURITY
Range: None, Signature, SignatureAndEncryption
Default: None
This setting applies to IEC 61850 Edition 2.
This setting specifies level of security (authentication/encryption) used for TxGOOSE1. None specifies no security
5 mechanisms are to be used. Signature specifies only signature (no encryption) is to be used. SignatureAndEncryption
specifies that both signature and encryption are to be used.
RxGOOSE
Navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > GOOSE > RxGOOSE > RxGOOSE Messages.
GOOSE is an efficient method for simultaneous high-speed delivery of generic substation event information by a
publishing device to more than one subscribing device. An RxGOOSE is a UR element implementing a single IEC 61850
GOOSE message subscribing service. The publishing function in URs is performed by TxGOOSE elements, as described in
the previous section.
Each UR with an IEC 61850 order code option has 64 RxGOOSE elements. Each RxGOOSE element can subscribe to GOOSE
messages from a specified publisher. Each RxGOOSE can either use the original format specified in IEC 61850 8 1:2011 or
the routable GOOSE (R-GOOSE; IEC 61850 Edition 2) format specified in IEC TR 61850-90-5:2012. Subscribed message
members can be DataObjects, SubDataObjects, DataAttributes, or SubAttributes. In E2-2.0 mode, members are restricted
to basic types BOOLEAN, FLOAT32, INT32, Dbpos, TimeStamp, or Quality. Each subscribed message can contain up to 64
values. A member can be a structure containing several values; note that it is the number of values rather than the number
of members that are limited to 64.
GOOSE messages from any device of any manufacturer that implements the IEC 61850 Edition 1.0 or 2.0 GOOSE publish
service or the 61850-90-5 R-GOOSE service (IEC 61850 Edition 2) can be subscribed to. The UR accepts both the variable-
length encoded GOOSE messages specified in IEC 61850 8 1:2004 and the fixed-length encoded GOOSE messages as
specified in IEC 61850 8 1:2011 clause A.3.
Each enabled RxGOOSE monitors for interruption of the GOOSE messages it subscribes to based on the value in the
timeAllowedtoLive field of the last message received. If a new message is not received within that time interval, the
RxGOOSE assumes that connectivity is lost. FlexLogic operands (for example RxGOOSE1 On, RxGOOSE1 Off) reflect the
status of each RxGOOSE connectivity. An RxGOOSE connection is also considered lost after the UR finishes restart until a
message is received. While any RxGOOSE connectivity is lost, a common RxGOOSE Fail self-test is activated.
Messages that contain the value true in the ndsCom field are never accepted. Messages that contain the value true in the
simulation field (test field in Edition 1.0 messages) are accepted only when the UR Test Mode Function setting is set to Test
or Test-Blocked.
RxGOOSE messages can be received through a UR CPU module Ethernet port or a UR Process Bus Module Ethernet port. A
maximum of eight RxGOOSE messages can be received from the Process Bus Module.
Navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > GOOSE > RxGOOSE > RxGOOSE Messages >
RxGOOSE1 to access the settings that specify the messages to be accepted by the first RxGOOSE element. The settings
and functionality for the other RxGOOSE are similar. The following settings are available. They allow RxGOOSE1 to
recognize the GOOSE messages to accept. Most of these settings are configured automatically by the EnerVista UR Setup
software when an association to an RxGOOSE Boolean Input, RxGOOSE DPS Input, and/or RxGOOSE Analog Input is made
as described in the following sections. For IEC 61850 Edition 2, settings R-RxGOOSE1 RECEPTION MODE, R-RxGOOSE1
SECURITY, and R-RxGOOSE SRC IP need to be completed manually as the information is not contained in publisher SCL.
Read-only settings are grey.
Figure 5-28: IEC 61850 RxGOOSE Messages panel (Edition 2)
RxGOOSE1 MODE
For Ed2: Main CPU GOOSE, Main CPU R-GOOSE, Process Bus Module GOOSE
For Ed1: GOOSE
Default: Main CPU GOOSE
When set to "Main CPU GOOSE," the relay subscribes to RxGOOSE1 messages if received on any of the three main CPU
ports and if they comply with IEC 61850-8-1:2011 GOOSE format.
When set to "Main CPU R-GOOSE," the relay subscribes to RxGOOSE1 messages if received on any of the three main CPU
ports and if they comply with the R-GOOSE format according to IEC 61850-90-5.
When set to "Process Bus Module GOOSE," the relay subscribes to RxGOOSE1 messages if received on any of the eight
UR Process Bus Module ports and if they comply with IEC 61850-8-1:2011 GOOSE format.
RxGOOSE1 goID
Range: 0 to 129 VisibleString characters
Default: empty string
If the entered value has one or more characters, the goID field of incoming GOOSE messages must exactly match this
value for the message to be accepted as a valid RxGOOSE1 message. If the entered value is the empty string, RxGOOSE1
does not check the value received in the goID field. Special characters are not allowed, such as <, >, &, ’, and ".
If the publisher is a UR 7.3x series device, this setting needs match the value of the publisher's TxGOOSE GoID setting.
5 <LDName>/LLN0.<GoCBName>
where <LDName> is the function-related name if the logical device containing the publishing control block has "ldName"
configured, otherwise the product-related name of that logical device, and <GoCBName> is the name of the publishing
control block.
The M60 translates the ACSI format required for this setting to the MMS format used in GOOSE messages:
<LDName>/LLN0$GO$<GoCBName>
If the publisher is a UR 7.3x or 7.40 series device, <LDName> is the value of the publisher's Master functional ldName
setting if that setting is not empty, otherwise it is the value of the publisher's IED NAME suffixed with "Master". If the
publisher is a UR 7.3x series device, <GoCBName> is "GoCB" suffixed with the two digit TxGOOSE instance number, for
example "GoCB01". If the publisher is a UR 7.40 series device, <GoCBName> is as specified earlier in the TxGOOSE
section of this chapter.
RxGOOSE1 datSet
Range: 0 to 32 alphanumeric and underscore characters, beginning with an alpha character
Default: empty string
If the entered value has one or more characters, the datSet field of incoming GOOSE messages must exactly match this
value prefixed by <LDName>/LLN0$ for the message to be accepted as a valid RxGOOSE1 message. <LDName> is as
specified in the RxGOOSE GoCBRef setting above. If the entered value is the empty string, RxGOOSE1 does not check the
value received in the datSet field.
If the publisher is a UR 7.3x series device, set this setting to the value of the publisher's DataSetxx name setting, where xx
is the instance number of the data set selected by the publisher's TxGOOSE datSet setting. If the publisher is a UR 7.40
series device, datSet is as specified in the DataSets section of this chapter.
RxGOOSE1 ConfRev
Range: 0 to 4294967295 in steps of 1
Default: 1
If the value entered is non-zero, the confRev field of incoming GOOSE messages must exactly match this value for the
message to be accepted as a valid RxGOOSE1 message. If the entered value is zero, RxGOOSE1 does not check the value
received in the confRev field.
If the publisher is a UR 7.3x series device, set this setting to match the value of the publisher's TxGOOSE ConfRev setting.
When the R-RxGOOSE1 RECEPTION MODE is set to SSM or ASM, the M60 sends the IGMP join group report (source
specific in case of SSM) every 60 seconds and responds to IGMP general queries issued by the router.
R-RxGOOSE1 SRC IP 5
Range: 0.0.0.0 to 255.255.255 in steps of 1
Default: 127.0.0.1
This setting applies to IEC 61850 Edition 2.
When the RxGOOSE1 MODE setting is other than R-GOOSE, the value of this setting is not used. When the RxGOOSE1
MODE setting is R-GOOSE and the R-RxGOOSE RECEPTION MODE setting is ASM, the value of this setting is not used.
Otherwise the Source IP Address field of incoming R-GOOSE messages must exactly match this value for the message to
be accepted as a valid RxGOOSE1 message. Set this setting to the value of the source IP address used by the publisher.
For UR publishers, this value is in setting PRT# IP ADDRESS.
The UR does not validate the address entered. The default IP address 127.0.0.1 is a reserved, not a valid IP address. Enter
a valid IP source address.
R-RxGOOSE1 DST IP
Range: 0.0.0.0 to 255.255.255 in steps of 1
Default: 224.0.0.0
This setting applies to IEC 61850 Edition 2.
When the RxGOOSE1 MODE setting is other than R-GOOSE, the value of this setting is not used. Otherwise the
Destination IP Address field of incoming R GOOSE messages must exactly match this value for the message to be
accepted as a valid RxGOOSE1 message. Set this setting to the same value as the R-GOOSE publisher's Destination IP
Address. For UR publishers, this value is in setting R-TxGOOSE# DST IP.
The destination IP address needs to be a valid multicast or unicast IP address. The UR does not validate the address
entered. The default IP address 224.0.0.0 is reserved, and hence not a valid multicast IP address.
R-RxGOOSE1 SECURITY
Range: None, Signature, SignatureAndEncryption
Default: None
This setting applies to IEC 61850 Edition 2.
This setting specifies the level of security (authentication/encryption) used for RxGOOSE1. None indicates no security
mechanisms are in use. Signature indicates only signature (no encryption) is in use. SignatureAndEncryption indicates
that both signature and encryption are in use. Normally this setting is set to match the GOOSE publisher's security
method.
RxGOOSE1 Member 1
Range: End of List, BOOLEAN, INT8U, INT16U, INT32U, FLOAT32, INT32, Dbpos (DPS), Quality, TimeStamp, ENUM, STRUCT
Default: End of List
This setting specifies the type that the first member of incoming GOOSE messages must be for the message to be
accepted as a valid RxGOOSE1 message. There are similar settings for each of the up to 64 members that the UR is able
to subscribe to in a given GOOSE message. The member before the first member setting set to "End of List" must be the
last member of the message for the message to be accepted as a valid RxGOOSE1 message.
If the publisher is a UR 7.3x or 7.40 series device, set these settings to match the basic type of the members of the
publisher's data set selected by the publisher's TxGOOSE datSet setting.
If the publisher dataset includes members with structured data, that is, data attributes, sub-data objects, and/or data
attributes with sub-data attributes, configuration must use one of the new 7.40 UR Setup RxGOOSE Inputs pages. In this
case the Member setting displays as the product-related name used by the publishing IED of the data object or data
attribute, in standard SCSM format (e.g. Publisher1LD1/LLN0$ST$Off$stVal).
Note that a dataset can hold at most 64 basic data attribute values, and that a single structured data object or attribute
can contain multiple basic data attribute values. UR Setup software does not allow more that 64 basic data attribute
values to be entered, in which case the last several members settings cannot be changed from End of List.
Note that the publisher's name alone does not contain all the information required for subscription, additional publisher
information model information is stored elsewhere. For this reason, manual entry of the name is not supported.
5 When this setting is configured manually, "Struct" and "Enum" are not allowed for selection. However, those two
values are placeholders in the software, when the RxGOOSE1 Members are configured using the ADD IED (via
publisher SCL file) option in the RxGOOSE Boolean/DPS/Analog Inputs screen.
RxGOOSE inputs
The values received by RxGOOSE elements need to be converted to FlexLogic or FlexAnalog operands so that they can be
used by other UR elements. This conversion is done by RxGOOSE Boolean, RxGOOSE DPS, and RxGOOSE Analog elements.
Each RxGOOSE Boolean can convert the value of a specified Boolean value received by a specified RxGOOSE to a FlexLogic
operand. Each RxGOOSE DPS can convert the value of a specified Dbpos (Double bit position) value to four FlexLogic
operands, one for each of the four possible Dbpos states. Each RxGOOSE Analog can convert the value of a specified
FLOAT32, INT8U, INT16U, INT32U, INT32 and ENUM value to a FlexAnalog operand. Each of these operands reverts to its
default state when the RxGOOSE connectivity is lost. Other types of values can be present in subscribed GOOSE messages
but cannot be converted to operands.
When an RxGOOSE Input is mapped to a value in the GOOSE message, the associated q value is validated, if the q value is
included in that GOOSE message as part of the data object or if it is part of the same dataset. For such automatic mapping,
the index of associated quality value can be seen in the RxGOOSE Member field as read-only.
RxGOOSE Boolean, RxGOOSE DPS, and RxGOOSE Analog elements are mapped to various data objects in
<iedName>Master/GGIO3. This allows reading of their values via MMS and allows references to them in SCL files. GGIO3
has no settings, nor is it visible in the EnerVista UR Setup software. See the UR Family Communications Guide for more
information on GGIO3.
For each configured RxGOOSE Input, the UR monitors the associated quality attribute if available. An RxGOOSE Input
reverts to its configured default value as follows:
• If the validity bits of the quality attribute (q.validity) are invalid
• If the validity bits of the quality attribute are questionable
• If the test bit of the quality attribute is set and IED Mode is other than Test or Test-Blocked
When the IED Mode setting is Test or Test-Blocked, the q.test bit is not validated. That is, when the relay is in test or test-
blocked mode, the q.test = False is treated same as q.test = True.
When an RxGOOSE Boolean/DPS/Analog Input is mapped to a remote GOOSE message input using the publisher SCL file,
the UR automatically maps and monitors the associated quality member as follows:
• If the publisher dataset includes members with structured data
• If the publisher dataset includes data attributes and associated quality attribute is available in the same dataset (in
any sequence)
If the publisher dataset member that is mapped to RxGOOSE input is structured data, the quality attribute is embedded in
the same structure.
If the publisher dataset member that is mapped to RxGOOSE input is a data attribute, the UR scans the rest of the
attributes in that publisher dataset for a matching quality attribute.
Set up subscriptions
Subscriptions are configured in the RxGOOSE Boolean Inputs, DPS Inputs, and Analog Inputs panels.
There are Add IED and Remove IED buttons. The Add IED button allows SCL files to be used, including ICD, CID, and SCD
(supported in version 7.40 and later). With SCL file import, for Edition 1 the IP address in the ConnectedAP element must
match one IP address of the device, while for Edition 2 one of the three IP addresses in the ConnectedAP element must
match. When the file format is SCD, the system lists all IEDs inside the SCD file and lets the user select the ones to add. The
figure shows a selection being made by importing a CID file using the Add IED function.
The "Do NOT default Remote Input ID..." check box applies when configuring GOOSE subscription. It determines if the ID
field is retained or defaulted. When enabled, the ID is retained. When disabled, the ID is defaulted. For example, you
change the ID field from "RxG Bool1" to RxG Bool1west," and the change is retained when the check box is enabled. The
check box applies on drag-and-drop, manual configuration, manual deletion, deletion using the Remove IED button, and
when clicking the Default button in the RxGOOSE message panel. The Default and Reset buttons in the RxGOOSE Boolean
Inputs, DPS Inputs, and Analog Inputs panels default all settings in the panel, including the ID, regardless of the check box. 5
The check box is available for to UR version 7.4x and later devices.
To subscribe:
1. Click the Add IED button and import a file.
2. Expand the entries by clicking the + box.
3. Drag-and-drop an entry into a Subscribed to field. The software checks for duplicates.
Most of the settings are configured by drag-and-drop. Enter manually the ID, DEFAULT STATE, and EVENTS settings when
the factory default values are not acceptable.
In the example shown, all of the entries at the bottom of the screen have been added to the subscription column.
5 Navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > GOOSE > RxGOOSE > RxGOOSE Boolean Inputs.
The number of RxGOOSE Boolean (remote inputs) is 256.
Figure 5-30: RxGOOSE Boolean Input panel (Edition 2)
As outlined earlier, most of the settings are configured by drag-and-drop. Enter manually the ID, DEFAULT STATE, and
EVENTS settings when the factory default values are not acceptable.
RxGOOSE Boolean1 ID
Range: 0 to 20 characters
Default: RxG Bool1
This setting allows the user to assign descriptive text to the name of the RxGOOSE Boolean1 FlexLogic operand. The full
operand name is the value of this setting appended with " On". The basic and enhanced front panels display the first 17
characters of this setting plus " On" to fit the 20 character display.
The setting value is auto-populated and read-only for quality mapped to a configured remote input.
RxGOOSE Boolean1 RxGOOSE
Range: None, RxGOOSE1, RxGOOSE2, and so on
Default: None
This setting selects the RxGOOSE containing the value that drives the RxGOOSE Boolean1 FlexLogic operand. If set to
None, the RxGOOSE Boolean1 FlexLogic operand assumes its default state.
The setting value is auto-populated and read-only for quality mapped to a configured remote input.
RxGOOSE Boolean1 Member
Range: 1 to 64 in steps of 1
Default: 1
This setting selects the GOOSE message member that drives the RxGOOSE Boolean1 FlexLogic operand. A setting of 1
selects the first member, 2 selects the second member, and so on. Entering a number greater than the number of
members in the message and entering the number of a member which does not contain a BOOLEAN results in the
RxGOOSE Boolean1 FlexLogic operand assuming its default state. The Subscribed to column identifies the particular
Boolean subscribed to even if the member is a structure containing more than one Boolean.
The setting value is auto-populated and read-only for quality mapped to a configured remote input.
RxGOOSE Boolean1 DEFAULT STATE
Range: On, Off, Latest/On, Latest/Off
5
Default: Off
This setting selects the logic state for the RxGOOSE Boolean1 FlexLogic operand if the UR has just completed startup and
the selected RxGOOSE has not yet received a message, or the selected RxGOOSE has lost its connectivity with the
publisher. The following choices are available:
– "On" value defaults the input to logic 1
– "Off" value defaults the input to logic 0
– "Latest/On" freezes the input in case of lost connectivity. If the latest state is unknown, such as after UR power-up
but before the first communication, the input defaults to logic 1. When communication resumes, the input
becomes fully operational.
– "Latest/Off" freezes the input in case of lost connectivity. If the latest state is unknown, such as after UR power-up
but before the first communication, the input defaults to logic 0. When communication resumes, the input
becomes fully operational.
RxGOOSE Boolean1 EVENTS
Range: Disabled, Enabled
Default: Disabled
This setting selects whether Off to On transitions of the RxGOOSE Boolean1 FlexLogic operand are recorded by the event
recorder. If set to Enabled, Off to On transitions are recorded. On to Off transitions are never recorded, even if events are
enabled.
As outlined earlier, most of the settings are configured by drag-and-drop. Enter manually the ID, DEFAULT STATE, and
5 EVENTS settings when the factory default values are not acceptable.
RxGOOSE DPS1 ID
Range: 0 to 20 characters
Default: RxG DPS1
This setting allows the user to assign descriptive text to the names of the four RxGOOSE DPS1 FlexLogic operands. The
full operand name is the value of this setting appended with "Interm," "On," "Off," or "Bad." The basic and enhanced front
panels display the first 13 characters of this setting plus the state suffix to fit the 20 character display.
RxGOOSE DPS1 RxGOOSE
Range: None, RxGOOSE1, RxGOOSE2, and so on
Default: None
This setting selects the GOOSE message containing the value that drives the RxGOOSE DPS1 FlexLogic operand. If set to
None, the RxGOOSE DPS1 FlexLogic operand assumes its default state.
RxGOOSE DPS1 Member
Range: 1 to 64 in steps of 1
Default: 1
This setting selects the GOOSE message member that drives the RxGOOSE DPS1 FlexLogic operand. A setting of 1 selects
the first member, 2 selects the second member, and so on. Entering a number greater than the number of members in
the message and entering the number of a member that is not a Dbpos results in the RxGOOSE DPS1 FlexLogic operand
assuming its default state. In the case that the member is a structure containing more than one Dbpos, the Subscribed
to column identifies the particular Dbpos subscribed to.
As outlined earlier, most of the settings are configured by drag-and-drop. Enter manually the ID, DEFAULT STATE, and
EVENTS settings when the factory default values are not acceptable.
RxGOOSE Analog1 ID
Range: 0 to 20 characters
Default: RxG Analog1
This setting allows the user to assign descriptive text to RxGOOSE Analog1. Unlike RxGOOSE Booleans and RxGOOSE DPS,
the RxGOOSE Analog operands have fixed names, for example RxGOOSE Analog1.
Some UR elements have requirements for the type of input operands, for instance current type or voltage type. These
elements assume that RxGOOSE Analog operands are of whatever type is necessary to meet these requirements.
The per-unit base setting represents thousands, not single units. For example, a PU base of 1.000 is actually 1000 and a
PU base of 0.001 is 1.
When using RxGOOSE Analogs and PU base in FlexElements, the largest value that can be displayed in the FlexElement
actual values is 2,140,000.000.
RxGOOSE Analog1 Expression
Range: None, Equal to, Not Equal to, Greater than, Less than
Default: None
This setting specifies the expression type to be used with the RxGOOSE Analog In1 FlexAnalog operand. The result of the
expression is converted into Boolean status and assigned to the RxGOOSE Analog1 Expn St operand. When the expression
result is true, RxGOOSE Analog1 Expn St operand is set. When the expression set to None, no expression is assigned and
RxGOOSE Analog1 Expn St is always in reset state.
When the expression is set to other than "None", RxGOOSE Analog In1 is compared with the configured Expression value
based on the selected Expression type.
When the remote signal type is "Float," the "Equal to" and "Not Equal to" expressions may not give accurate results
due to precision errors in decimals.
Report settings
Navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > Reports > Report Settings.
ReportSettings rptID
Range: Dyn, Conf
Default: Dyn
When set to Dyn, the RptID attribute in any buffered and unbuffered report control block can be modified by an MMS
client while the control block's RptEna attribute is false. The RptID is the name of the report.
ReportSettings optFields
Range: Dyn, Conf
Default: Dyn
When set to Dyn, the OptFlds attribute in any buffered and unbuffered report control block can be modified by an MMS
client while the control block's RptEna attribute is false.
ReportSettings bufTime
Range: Dyn, Conf
Default: Dyn
When set to Dyn, the BufTm attribute in any buffered and unbuffered report control block can be modified by an MMS
client while the control block's RptEna attribute is false.
ReportSettings trgOps
Range: Dyn, Conf
Default: Dyn
When set to Dyn, the TrgOps attribute in any buffered and unbuffered report control block can be modified by an MMS
client while the control block's RptEna attribute is false.
ReportSettings intgPd
Range: Dyn, Conf
Default: Dyn
When set to Dyn, the IntgPd attribute in any buffered and unbuffered report control block can be modified by an MMS
client while the control block's RptEna attribute is false.
An IEC 61850 Report server is an efficient method to deliver generic substation event information from a single server to a
single client, such as a supervisory control IED. A Configurable Report is a UR element implementing an IEC 61850 Report
server, either of the buffered or unbuffered kind. The following table lists the number of Configurable Report elements. Each
Configurable Report element can report the values of up to 64 FlexLogic or FlexAnalog operands. Buffered report elements
queue value changes that occur while the client is offline and delivered when the client re-connects. Up to 512 events can
be queued. Unbuffered control blocks purge all value change events when the connection to the client is lost; any events
that occur while the client is not connected are lost.
Table 5-11: Number of report elements
Number
Buffered reports 30
Unbuffered reports 18
When using IEC 61850 Edition 2, configurable Reports interoperate with any client device of any manufacturer that
conforms to the IEC 61850 edition 1.0 or 2.0 report client requirements.
When using IEC 61850 Edition 1, configurable Reports interoperate with any client device of any manufacturer that
conforms to the IEC 61850 edition 1.0 report client requirements.
The entities whose values are reported by a Configurable Report are known as members. The members are itemized in an
ordered list known as a data set. Each Configurable Report can use any one of the data sets provided.
Each enabled Configurable Report transmits an update to its client whenever a value change is detected in one or more of
its members. Also, the control block can be configured to send integrity reports containing the present value of all
members either on demand from the client or periodically. A TCP handshaking mechanism causes messages that are not
read and acknowledged by the client to be retransmitted.
For a Configurable Report to operate, its members must be selected (that is, its data set configured) and a client must open
a connection to, configure, and enable its report control block. Control blocks and data sets can be pre-configured by
sending the M60 a CID file. See the UR Family Communications Guide for details. EnerVista UR Setup also can be used to
select the data set members and to pre-configure the control blocks.
Each buffered report has the following settings.
Buffered Report1 RptID
Range for Edition 2: 0 to 129 VisibleString characters
Range for Edition 1: 0 to 65 VisibleString characters
Default: empty string
The name of the report. The entered value sets the RptID value in Buffered Report1 messages, and it can be used by the
client to discriminate Buffered Report1 messages from other messages. If the number of characters entered is zero, the
value used for RptID in messages is an ObjectReference to the report's control block, that is, "<LDName>/
LLN0$BR$"BRCB01".
Buffered Report1 Name
5
Range: 0 to 32 VisibleString characters
Default: BRCB01
The entered value sets the report control block name value for Buffered Report1.
Buffered Report1 DatSet
Range: None, TT6DataSet1, TT6 DataSet2, …, TT3DataSet01, TT3DataSet02, …
Default: None
This setting selects the data set whose members' status is reported in Buffered Report1 messages using the UR Setup
software designator for the data set. The IEC 61850 name of the data sets are configured in the Datasets panel, as
described later.
An ObjectReference to the data set, which consists of the concatenation of the string "<LDName>/LLN0$" and the data
set name, is used in the datSet field of report messages, and it can be used by the client to discriminate Buffered
Report1 messages from other messages.
The performance of the report is determined by the performance of the selected dataset. When the selection is
TT3DataSet01, TT3DataSet02, … it is possible that transient events can be missed.
To configure a DataSet, select it at the top of the window from the drop-down list, for example DataSet02 shown in the
previous figure. In the lower part of the window, drag and drop configuration items to the right side. For example select
the ST Ind001 stVal item and drag it to DataSet Member 1. Dataset members configured here affect other Report or
TxGOOSE control blocks that use the same DataSet.
Buffered Report1 ConfRev
Range: 0 to 4294967295 in steps of 1
Default: 1
The entered value sets the confRev value in Buffered Report1 messages, and it can be used by clients to discriminate
report messages of the expected configuration revision from messages of a different revision. The standard requires
that confRev be incremented each time the members or the order of the members is changed, and each time the data
set name is changed. The standard states that the value of 0 is reserved.
DataSets
Navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > DataSets.
As outlined, the members whose values are communicated by these services are itemized in an ordered list known as a
data set. Each UR with the IEC 61850 option has 18 data sets (six fast and 12 slow). Each data set can contain as many as
64 members. Any data set can be used simultaneously by any number of TxGOOSE elements and/or by any number of
Configurable Report elements. The UR software can configure any FlexLogic operands and any FlexAnalog operands as
members.
Figure 5-35: IEC 61850 DataSets (Edition 2)
UR Setup software requires data set members to be IEC 61850 data objects or data attributes with Functional Constraint
ST or MX. Certain FlexLogic and FlexAnalog operands have factory-assigned data attributes as tabulated in the UR Family
Communications Guide. All FlexLogic and FlexAnalog operands can be user-assigned to GGIO1 or GGIO4 data attributes,
so that operands without factory-assigned data attributes can still have their values published. See the GGIO1 and GGIO4
sections later for details.
Datasets used by TxGOOSE1, TxGOOSE2, and/or by reports also provide a chatter suppression service for their Boolean
members. Oscillation in a value, also known as chatter, can be caused by errors in logic programming, inadequate
hysteresis (deadband) on a threshold, or a failed station component. Chatter can flood a communications network with
GOOSE messages, degrading response time for all users. If chatter is detected in a Boolean member, TxGOOSE suspends
GOOSE event message triggering and report message triggering from that member for as long as the condition exists, and
for a minimum period of one second. While sending is suspended, a self-test message identifying the specific data item
detected as oscillating is activated.
For a summary of the panels in which the data sets are used, the path is Settings > Product Setup > Communications >
IEC 61850 > DataSets > Summary.
For the settings, navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > DataSets > TT6DataSet1 for the
first data set.
Copy and paste functions are available when right-clicking a DataSet. They allow the target dataset to be configured
based on its order code. If some dataset items are not supported, they are not pasted, and a warning message shows a list
of dataset items that were not supported and not pasted. The DataSet name is not copied or pasted. In short, use this
feature to copy a DataSet Member setting and paste it into another Member setting, a text file, or Word, as examples.
Figure 5-36: Member right-click
DataSet01 name
Range: 0 to 32 VisibleString characters
Default: DataSet01
The value entered sets the name of the data set, which is required to be unique within the UR for proper operation. The
value entered sets the name of the data set, which is required to be unique within the UR for proper operation. Fast
datasets start with TT6, and slow datasets start with TT3. Up to six fast datasets are allowed. Up to four fast GOOSE
datasets are allowed.
An ObjectReference to the data set consists of a string that is the concatenation of "<LDName>/LLN0$" and the
DataSet01 name setting value. An ObjectReference to the data set is published in the datSet field of TxGOOSE messages,
and it can be used by subscribers to discriminate the messages of that TxGOOSE from other GOOSE messages. An
ObjectReference to the data set is optionally published in the DatSet field of Report messages. Valid characters are
upper and lowercase letters, digits, and the underscore (_) character. The first character must be a letter.
DataSet01 shared by
Range: 0 to 32 VisibleString characters
Default:
Names of all control blocks that use this DataSet. Read-only field.
DataSet01 Member1
Range: End of List or any instantiated 61850 data object or data attribute with Functional Constraint ST or MX
Default: End of List
This setting specifies the first member in TxGOOSE1 messages. There is a similar setting for each of the up to 64
members that the UR allows in a Dataset. Only values of members before the first set to End of List are published.
Select the member from the drop-down list. Or right-click an entry to copy, paste, delete, or insert.
Product setup
Navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > Product Setup.
Security
This setting applies to IEC 61850 Edition 2.
Navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > Product Setup > Security.
Figure 5-37: IEC 61850 Security
SecGSAL1.SecDataClr.ctlModel
Range: direct-with-normal-security, sbo-with-normal-security
Default: direct-with-normal-security
This setting selects the control model that clients must use to clear security data via commands to
SecGSAL1.SecDataClr. "sbo" here is select-before-operate.
SecGSAL1.OpCntRs ctlModel
Range: direct-with-normal-security, sbo-with-normal-security
Default: direct-with-normal-security
This setting selects the control model that clients must use to clear security data via commands to SecGSAL1.OpCntRs.
"sbo" here is select-before-operate.
Demand
Deadband parameters of measured values related to the Demand metering are configured here.
Energy
Deadband parameters of measured values related to the Energy metering are configured here.
TmClkLTMS1.TmnsDelta.db
Range: 0.000 to 100.000 %
Default: 0.000 %
This setting is a deadband setting and is used by the relay to determine when to update the "mag" and "cVal" values
5
from the associated "instMag" and "instCVal" values. The value shall represent the percentage of difference between
maximum and minimum in units of 0.001%. The minimum and maximum values for TmnsDelta data object are
-500000000 ns and 500000000 ns respectively and for example, a setting value of 0.002% results in the dead banded
value of (500000000 - (-500000000)) * 0.002 / 100 = 20000 ns. The default setting value of 0.000% does not update the
"mag" and "cVal" values.
Deadband settings
A deadband is a range in which no action occurs, usually expressed as a percentage.
The IEC 61850 panels contain hundreds of deadband settings, such as in the following panels: Product Setup > Real Time
Clock, FlexLogic, Control Elements, and GGIO4. Each panel is not outlined here. The FlexLogic category applies to IEC 61850
Edition 2.
Deadband setting names all end either with "DB" or .db. As they all work the same way, but each on a different analog
value, a single description applicable to all deadband settings is given here. The analog value that each deadband setting
applies is usually obvious from the name of the setting. However, a tabulation of the analog values and their associated
deadband setting can be found in the UR Family Communications Guide.
GOOSE, buffered report, and unbuffered report messages are for the most part transmitted only when there is a value
change in one or more of their members. Most analog values continuously dither by an amount that is not significant.
Were a report to be sent each time an insignificant analog value change occurred, then the communications network
floods with GOOSE and report messages, degrading response time for all users.
To control this, a deadband setting is provided for each analog value. Also, in addition to the present actual value of each
5 analog ("instMag" in the following figure), there is a deadbanded value ("mag" in the figure), which is updated with the
present value only when the difference between the two exceeds the deadband setting (db in the figure). Changes to this
deadbanded value trigger transmissions when included in GOOSE and report data sets.
Figure 5-40: Deadband settings
Deadband settings are entered in UR Setup software in units of percent of the difference between the "max." and "min." of
the associated analog value. A zero deadband setting suppresses transmission triggering. The range of deadband settings
is 0.000 to 100.000% in steps of 0.001. The default value is 0.000%.
GGIO4 elements have individual settings for "min." and "max." The min. and max. for FlxEIGAPC#.OpSig.db (FLEXELEMENT #
OpSig) are -50 pu and +50 pu respectively. The min. value for all other quantities is 0. The max. values are as follows:
• Phase current — 46 x phase CT primary setting
• Neutral current — 46 x ground CT primary setting
• Ground current (sensitive ground CT) — 4.6 x sensitive ground CT primary setting
• Phase, phase-to-phase, and sequence voltage — 275 x phase VT ratio setting
• Auxiliary voltage — 275 x auxiliary VT ration setting
• Power (real, reactive, apparent, 3-phase, and 1-phase) — 4 × phase CT primary setting × 1.5 × VT Secondary setting ×
VT ratio setting
• Energy (real or imaginary) — 4 × phase CT primary setting × 1.5 × VT Secondary setting × VT ratio setting x 1 hour
• Frequency — 90 Hz
• Frequency rate of change — 90 Hz/s
• Power factor — 2
• Angle — 360 degrees
Select the deadband settings from knowledge of the characteristics of the power system quantity measured and
knowledge of the demands of the applications receiving the measurement via GOOSE or report such that changes of
significance to the application are promptly reported, yet the network is not overly burdened with event messages.
Signal sources
Deadband parameters of measured values related to the signal sources are configured here.
Breakers
The UR breaker control and status monitoring elements have certain settings that configure how the IEC 61850 protocol
interacts with these elements. These settings are described in this section. See the Breakers section in the System Setup
section of this chapter for details on the operation of breaker control elements.
Navigate to Settings > Communications > IEC 61850 > System Setup > Breakers > Breaker 1 to access the settings that
configure the IEC 61850 protocol interface with the first breaker control and status monitoring element. The settings and
functionality for the others are similar.
Figure 5-41: IEC 61850 Breaker panel (Edition 2)
Switches
The UR disconnect switch control and status monitoring elements have certain settings that configure how the IEC 61850
protocol interacts with these elements. These settings are described in this section. See the Settings > System Setup >
Disconnect Switches section later in this chapter for details on the operation of the disconnect switch control elements.
Navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > System Setup > Switches > Switch 1 to access
the settings that configure the IEC 61850 protocol interface with the first disconnect switch control and status monitoring
element. The settings and functionality for the others are similar.
Setting Groups
The UR implements a setting groups element as detailed in the Control Elements > Setting Groups section of this chapter.
The active setting group and the setting group open for edits can be selected via MMS commands SelectActiveSG and
SelectEditSG. The setting related to these IEC 61850 commands are described here.
Navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > Control Elements > Setting Groups to access
the setting that configures the IEC 61850 setting group commands.
Commands
The UR implements a number of clear records commands as detailed in the Commands and Targets chapter of this
manual. Several of these commands also can be issued via IEC 61850. The settings related to these IEC 61850 commands
are described here.
Navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > Settings for Commands to access the settings
that configure the IEC 61850 protocol interface for record clear commands. The content varies with relay capability.
UFltRptRFLO1.RsStat.ctlModel
Range: direct-with-normal-security, sbo-with-normal-security
Default: direct-with-normal-security
This setting selects the control model clients must use to successfully control the command CLEAR FAULT REPORTS. "sbo"
here is select-before-operate. Enhanced security means that the M60 reports to the client the breaker 1 position at the
end of the command sequence. 5
LLN0.EvtRcdClr.ctlModel
Range: direct-with-normal-security, sbo-with-normal-security
Default: direct-with-normal-security
This setting selects the control model clients must use to successfully control the command CLEAR EVENT RECORDS.
LPHD1.RsStat.ctlModel
Range: direct-with-normal-security, sbo-with-normal-security
Default: direct-with-normal-security
This setting selects the control model clients must use to successfully control the command CLEAR ALL RELAY RECORDS.
LPHD1.Sim.ctlModel
Range: direct-with-normal-security, sbo-with-normal-security
Default: direct-with-normal-security
This is a command that can be issued via MMS client to enable simulation mode in the relay.
Enabling the SIM CTRL VIA MMS setting allows this MMS command to be accepted by the relay.
LPHD1.TxGoSim.ctlModel
Range: direct-with-normal-security, sbo-with-normal-security
Default: direct-with-normal-security
This MMS command enables TxGOOSE sim Mode.
The sim attribute is set to TRUE in the published GOOSE frames from the relay so that the UR plays the simulator role
during the testing and commissioning phases.
OscRDRE1.RcdTrg.ctlModel
Range: direct-with-normal-security, sbo-with-normal-security
Default: direct-with-normal-security
This setting selects the control model clients must use to successfully control the command FORCE TRIGGER.
OscRDRE1.MemClr.ctlModel
Range: direct-with-normal-security, sbo-with-normal-security
Default: direct-with-normal-security
This setting selects the control model clients must use to successfully control the command CLEAR OSCILLOGRAPHY.
DatLogRDRE1.MemClr.ctlModel
Range: direct-with-normal-security, sbo-with-normal-security
Default: direct-with-normal-security
This setting selects the control model clients must use to successfully control the command CLEAR DATA LOGGER.
CBArc0SCBR1.MemClr.ctlModel
Range: direct-with-normal-security, sbo-with-normal-security
Default: direct-with-normal-security
This setting selects the control model clients must use to successfully control the command CLEAR ARC AMPS 1.
DmdMtrMMTR1.RsStat.ctlModel
Range: direct-with-normal-security, sbo-with-normal-security
Default: direct-with-normal-security
This setting selects the control model clients must use to successfully control the command CLEAR DEMAND.
EnrMtrMMTR1.RsStat.ctlModel
Range: direct-with-normal-security, sbo-with-normal-security
Default: direct-with-normal-security
This setting selects the control model clients must use to successfully control the command CLEAR ENERGY.
5 GGIO1
GGIO1 is a UR feature that allows up to 128 UR FlexLogic operands to be user-mapped to IEC 61850 information model
data attributes.
For the value of a FlexLogic operand to be read via MMS, included in TxGOOSE messages, or included in buffered/
unbuffered reports, the value must be assigned to a data attribute. GGIO1 allows those FlexLogic operands that have not
yet been factory-assigned to a data attribute to be user-assigned to a generic data attribute, and thus have their values
included in IEC 61850 communications.
Navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > GGIO > GGIO1 to access the settings for GGIO1.
Figure 5-45: IEC 61850 GGIO1 panel (Edition 2)
GGIO1 INDICATION 1
Range: any FlexLogic operand
Default: OFF
This setting selects the FlexLogic operand whose value is mapped into the IEC 61850 data attribute
<LDName>/GGIO1.Ind001.stVal. See the FlexLogic section in this chapter for a list of FlexLogic operands.
GGIO1 INDICATION 2
Range: any FlexLogic operand
Default: OFF
Selects the FlexLogic operand mapped to <LDName>/GGIO1.Ind002.stVal, and so on.
GGIO2
Virtual Inputs are controllable FlexLogic operands that can be controlled via IEC 61850 commands to GGIO2, by DNP, by
Modbus, and by the UR front panel. The settings related to these IEC 61850 commands are described here.
Navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > GGIO > GGIO2 to access the settings that
configure the IEC 61850 protocol interface for Virtual Input commands.
Figure 5-46: GGIO2 panel (Edition 2)
GGIO4
GGIO4 is a UR feature that allows up to 32 UR FlexAnalog operands to be user-mapped to an IEC 61850 information model
data attribute.
For the value of a FlexAnalog operand to be read via MMS, included in TxGOOSE messages, or included in buffered/
unbuffered reports, the value must be assigned to a data attribute. GGIO4 allows those FlexAnalog operands that have not
yet been factory-assigned to a data attribute to be user-assigned to a generic data attribute, and thus have their values
included in IEC 61850 communications.
Navigate to Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > GGIO > GGIO4 > GGIO4.AnIn1 to access the
settings for the first GGIO4 value. The settings and functionality for the others are similar.
Figure 5-47: GGIO4 panel (Edition 2)
ANALOG IN 1 VALUE
Range: any FlexAnalog operand
Default: OFF
5 This setting selects the FlexAnalog operand whose value is mapped into the IEC 61850 data attribute
<LDName>/GGIO4.AnIn01.instMag.f. The value of the FlexAnalog operand is converted automatically to the format and
scaling required by the standard, that is to say primary amperes, primary volts, and so on. See Appendix A for a list of
FlexAnalog operands.
ANALOG IN 1 DB
Range: 0.000 to 100.000% in steps of 0.001
Default: 0.000%
This setting specifies the deadband for the ANALOG IN 1 VALUE. The deadband is used to determine when to update the
deadbanded magnitude from the instantaneous magnitude. The deadband is a percentage of the difference between
the "max." and "min." values. Here, the "max." and "min." are as specified by the settings ANALOG IN 1 MAX and ANALOG IN
1 MIN.
See the Deadband Settings section earlier for a description of deadbanded values.
ANALOG IN 1 MIN
Range: -1000000000.000 to 1000000000.000 in steps of 0.001
Default: 0.000
This setting specifies the "min." value used in deadband calculations. The scaling of this setting is the same as used by
<LDName>/GGIO4.AnIn01.instMag.f. This setting is stored as an IEEE 754 / IEC 60559 floating point number. Because of
the large range of this setting, not all possible values can be stored. Some values are rounded to the closest possible
floating point number.
ANALOG IN 1 MAX
Range: -1000000000.000 to 1000000000.000 in steps of 0.001
Default: 1000000.000
This setting specifies the "max." value used in deadband calculations. The scaling of this setting is the same as used by
<LDName>/GGIO4.AnIn01.instMag.f. This setting is stored as an IEEE 754 / IEC 60559 floating point number. Because of
the large range of this setting, not all possible values can be stored. Some values are rounded to the closest possible
floating point number.
The M60 contains an embedded web server and can display pages in a web browser. The web pages are organized as a
series of menus that can be accessed starting at the M60 “Main Menu.” Web pages are read-only and are available
showing IEC 60870-5-104 points lists, Modbus registers, event records, fault reports, and so on. First connect the M60 and
a computer to an Ethernet network, then enter the IP address of the M60 Ethernet port in a web browser.
To close the port, set the port number to 0.
Any change takes effect when the M60 is restarted.
Do not set more than one protocol to the same TCP/UDP port number, as this results in unreliable operation of
those protocols.
The Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP) can be used to transfer files from the M60 over a network. The M60 operates as a
TFTP server. TFTP client software is available from various sources, including Microsoft Windows NT. The dir.txt file obtained
from the M60 contains a list and description of all available files, for example event records and oscillography.
The "put" function is not for security reasons. You can enter a "get" command but not a "put" command.
TFTP MAIN UDP PORT NUMBER — To close the port, set the port number to 0. Any change takes effect when the M60 is
restarted.
Do not set more than one protocol to the same TCP/UDP port number, as this results in unreliable operation of
those protocols.
IEC 60870-5-104 is a transmission protocol for network access, specifically for communication between a control station
and substation over a TCP/IP network.
The M60 supports the IEC 60870-5-104 protocol. This protocol is enabled when the SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP 5
COMMUNICATIONS PROTOCOL setting is set to IEC 60870-5-104. The M60 can be used as an IEC 60870-5-104 slave device
connected to a maximum of two masters (usually either an RTU or a SCADA master station). Since the M60 maintains two
sets of IEC 60870-5-104 data change buffers, ideally no more than two masters actively communicate with the M60 at one
time.
The IEC ------- DEFAULT THRESHOLD settings are used to determine when to trigger spontaneous responses containing
M_ME_NC_1 analog data. These settings group the M60 analog data into types: current, voltage, power, energy, and other.
Each setting represents the default threshold value for all M_ME_NC_1 analog points of that type. For example, to trigger
spontaneous responses from the M60 when any current values change by 15 A, the IEC CURRENT DEFAULT THRESHOLD
setting is set to 15. Note that these settings are the default values of the deadbands. P_ME_NC_1 (parameter of measured
value, short floating point value) points can be used to change threshold values, from the default, for each individual
M_ME_NC_1 analog point. Whenever power is removed and re-applied to the M60, the default thresholds are in effect.
The IEC REDUNDANCY setting decides whether multiple client connections are accepted or not. If redundancy is set to Yes,
two simultaneous connections can be active at any given time.
IEC TCP PORT NUMBER — To close the port, set the port number to 0. Any change takes effect when the M60 is restarted.
IEC COMMON ADDRESS OF ASDU — The change takes effect when the M60 is restarted.
IEC CYCLIC DATA PERIOD — The change takes effect when the M60 is restarted.
Do not set more than one protocol to the same TCP/UDP port number, as this results in unreliable operation of
those protocols.
SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS IEC 60870-5-104 PROTOCOL IEC NETWORK CLIENT
ADDRESSES
IEC NETWORK CLIENT ADDRESS 1: Range: standard IPV4 address format
CLIENT ADDRESSES 0.0.0.0
The M60 can specify a maximum of five clients for its IEC 104 connections. These are IP addresses for the controllers to
which the M60 can connect. A maximum of two simultaneous connections are supported at any given time.
The M60 is provided with optional Ethernet Global Data (EGD) communications capability, specified as a
software option at the time of ordering.
Ethernet Global Data (EGD) is a suite of protocols used for the real-time transfer of data for display and control purposes.
The relay can be configured to ‘produce’ EGD data exchanges, and other devices can be configured to ‘consume’ EGD data
exchanges. The number of produced exchanges (up to three), the data items in each exchange (up to 50), and the
exchange production rate can be configured.
5 The relay supports one fast EGD exchange and two slow EGD exchanges. There are 20 data items in the fast-produced
EGD exchange and 50 data items in each slow-produced exchange.
EGD cannot be used to transfer data between UR series relays. The relay supports EGD production only. An EGD exchange
is not be transmitted unless the destination address is non-zero, and at least the first data item address is set to a valid
Modbus register address. The default setting value of “0” is considered invalid.
Fast exchanges (50 to 1000 ms) are generally used in control schemes. The M60 has one fast exchange (exchange 1) and
two slow exchanges (exchange 2 and 3).
The settings menu for the fast EGD exchange follows.
SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS EGD PROTOCOL FAST PROD EXCH 1 CONFIGURATION
FAST PROD EXCH 1 EXCH 1 FUNCTION: Range: Disable, Enable
CONFIGURATION Disable
Slow EGD exchanges (500 to 1000 ms) are generally used for the transfer and display of data items. The settings for the
fast and slow exchanges are as follows.
EXCH 1 DESTINATION — This setting specifies the destination IP address of the produced EGD exchange. This is usually
unicast or broadcast.
EXCH 1 DATA RATE — This setting specifies the rate at which this EGD exchange is transmitted. If the setting is 50 ms, the
exchange data is updated and sent once every 50 ms. If the setting is 1000 ms, the exchange data is updated and sent
once per second. EGD exchange 1 has a setting range of 50 to 1000 ms. Exchanges 2 and 3 have a setting range of 500 to
1000 ms.
EXCH 1 DATA ITEM 1 to 20/50 — These settings specify the data items that are part of this EGD exchange. Almost any data
from the M60 memory map can be configured to be included in an EGD exchange. The settings are the starting Modbus
register address for the data item in decimal format. See the Modbus memory map in the UR Series Communications
Guide for the addresses. To convert a hexadecimal address to decimal, add a 4 before it for an actual values address and a
3 before a settings address. For example, hexadecimal actual value 82A0 becomes 482A0, which converts to 295584
decimal.
To select a data item to be part of an exchange, it is only necessary to choose the starting Modbus address of the item.
That is, for items occupying more than one Modbus register (for example, 32 bit integers and floating point values), only
the first Modbus address is required. The EGD exchange configured with these settings contains the data items up to the 5
first setting that contains a Modbus address with no data, or 0. That is, if the first three settings contain valid Modbus
addresses and the fourth is 0, the produced EGD exchange contains three data items.
The M60 is provided with optional IEC 60870-5-103 communications capability, specified as a software option
at the time of ordering.
IEC 60870-5-103 is a companion standard to the IEC 60870-5 suite of standards for transmission protocols. It defines
messages and procedures for interoperability between protection equipment and devices of a control system in a
substation for communicating on a serial line.
The IEC 60870-5-103 protocol is enabled when the SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS PROTOCOL setting
is set to IEC 60870-5-103.
The IEC 60870-5-103 is an unbalanced (master-slave) protocol for coded-bit serial communication, exchanging
information with a control system. In the context of this protocol, the protection equipment is the slave and the control
system is the master. The communication is based on a point-to-point principle. The master must be able to interpret the
IEC 60870-5-103 communication messages.
The UR implementation of IEC 60870-5-103 consists of the following functions:
• Report binary inputs
• Report analog values (measurands)
• Commands
• Time synchronization
The RS485 port supports IEC 60870-5-103.
The UR Family Communications Guide contains more information on the protocol.
IEC103 COMMON ADDRESS OF ASDU — This setting uniquely defines this M60 on the serial line. Select an ID between 0 and
254. This ID does not need to be in sequential order for all stations that communicate with a controller, but it is
recommended. Note that RS485 only allows a maximum of 32 slave stations on a communication line, so the entire range
of 254 addresses is never exhausted.
IEC103 SYNC TIMEOUT — This setting defines the time that the M60 waits for a synchronization message. The M60
synchronizes its clock using all available sources, with the source synching more frequently overwriting the time of the
other sources. Since the synchronization message received from the IEC 60870-5-103 master is less frequent than IRIG-B,
PTP, or SNTP, its time is overwritten by these three sources, if any of them is active. If the synchronization timeout occurs
and none of IRIG-B, PTP, or SNTP is active, the M60 sets the invalid bit in the time stamp of a time-tagged message.
The settings for the remaining menus are outlined as follows.
SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS IEC 60870-5-103 IEC103 INPUTS BINARY
5 IEC103 INPUTS
POINT 0 See below
BINARY
The binary input points are mapped using elements from a list of possible FlexLogic operands. A maximum of 96 binary
inputs (points) can be mapped this way.
The IEC 60870-5-103 point list always starts with point 0 and ends at the first "Off" value. Since the IEC 60870-5-103 point
list must be in a continuous block, any points assigned after the first "Off" point are ignored.
For each defined point, set appropriate values for the Function Type (FUN) and Information Number (INF), which form the
Information Object Identifier field of the ASDU, as defined in IEC 60870-5-103.
The binary input points are sent as Class 1 data. They are sent either as a response to a general interrogation received
from the controller or reported spontaneously. Spontaneous transmission occurs as a response to cyclic Class 2 requests.
If the M60 wants to transmit Class 1 data at that time, it demands access for Class 1 data transmission (ACD=1 in the
control field of the response).
For any change to take effect, restart the relay.
5 ANALOG # — This field contains the actual measurand to be sent in the response to the master. The measurands can be
mapped using elements from a list of FlexAnalog operands. The measurands sent are voltage, current, power, power
factor, and frequency. If any other FlexAnalog is chosen, the M60 sends 0 instead of its value. Note that the power is
transmitted in KW, not W. Measurands are transmitted as ASDU 3 or ASDU 9 (type identification value set to measurands I,
respectively measurands II).
Each IEC 60870-5-103 measurands list ends at the first unconfigured ("Off") value. Any measurand assigned after the first
"Off" value is ignored.
At least one measurand per ASDU must be configured in order to configure the following ASDU. For example, the user can
configure only one measurand for each ASDU, but the user is not allowed to skip ASDU 2 and configure measurands in
ASDU 3.
For any change to take effect, restart the relay.
ANALOG # FACTOR and OFFSET — For each measurand included in the ASDU, a factor and offset also can be configured. The
factor and offset allow for scaling to be performed on measurands. The final measurement sent to the IEC 60870-103
master is then "a*x + b," where x is the measurand, a is the multiplying factor and b is the offset. The master has to perform
the reversed operation in order to retrieve the actual value if such scaling is done. By default a = 1 and b = 0, so no scaling
is done if these values are left at their defaults. Examples of when scaling is appropriate are as follows:
• If the measured value contains decimals and it is important to preserve the resolution. Since the format for
transmitting the measurand does not permit decimals, a factor a>1 can be applied before transmission. For example,
a frequency F=59.9Hz can be transmitted as Ft = 10 * F = 10 * 59.9 = 599. In this case a = 10, b = 0. The master receives
599 and has to divide by 10 to retrieve the real value 59.9.
• If the measured value is larger than what fits in the format defined in IEC 103. The format defined in the standard
allows for signed integers up to 4095. By offsetting, unsigned integers up to 4096 + 4095 = 8191 are supported.
Scaling using factors <1 can be required in such cases. The calculation is outlined in the IEC 60870-5-103 chapter of
the UR Family Communications Guide. Two examples follow, where you decide factors a and b.
Example 1: Nominal power Pn = 100 MW = 100000 KW (power is transmitted in KW)
Since P can be both positive and negative:
Transmitted power Pt = (4095/(Pn*2.4)) * P = (4095/(100000 * 2.4) ) * P
= 0.017 * P
a = 0.017
b=0
Pt = 0.017 * P
For a max power 100000 KW * 2.4 = 240000 KW, we transmit
Pt = 0.017 * 240000 = 4080
A value above 240 MW is indicated by overflow.
Commands are received as General Command (Type Identification 20). The user can configure the action to perform when
an ASDU command comes.
A list of available mappings is provided on the M60. This includes 128 virtual inputs (see the following table). The ON and
OFF for the same ASDU command can be mapped to different virtual inputs.
Each command is identified by the unique combination made by the function type (FUN) and information number (INF). If
the master sends an ASDU command that does not have the FUN and INF of any configured command, the relay rejects it.
Table 5-12: Commands mapping table
Description Value
Off 0
Virtual Input 1 1
Virtual Input 2 2
... ...
Virtual Input 128 128
5 This setting applies to the USB port on the graphical front panel.
This setting enables/disables the USB port on the graphical front panel. When the port function is "Enabled," a standard
USB serial cable allows a computer running the EnerVista UR Setup software to retrieve, display, and write settings either
individually or collectively, to display status and actual values, to initiate controls, and to retrieve and display event records,
oscillography records, data logger records, and disturbance records. Installation of the EnerVista software automatically
installs the drivers required to use this USB port.
DNP is not available using the USB port on the graphical front panel.
The Modbus user map provides read-only access for up to 256 registers. The memory map can be read from the front
panel, the UR Family Communications Guide, or in a web browser. For the web browser, enter the IP address of the M60
and click a Modbus Memory Map option.
On the front panel, the address to read a specific Modbus register depends on whether the requested value is a setting or
an actual value.
Up to firmware version 7.8x, the settings and actual values are in the same Modbus table. To obtain a memory map value,
enter its address on the front panel.
Starting in firmware version 7.90, the settings have their own Modbus memory table and the actual values are in their own
table. To obtain a memory map value, use the following sequence:
1. Obtain the hexadecimal Modbus address of the data item. It must have four digits, such as 024A.
2. Prefix the address by 3 for settings or by 4 for actual values.
3. Convert the resulting hexadecimal number to decimal.
4. Enter the resulting number in the first column of the Modbus user map. The corresponding value (if programmed)
displays in second column (VALUE). A value of "0" in subsequent register lines automatically returns values of Modbus
registers having the address of the previous line incremented by 1. These subsequent addresses are all in the same
Modbus table (settings or actual values) as the address that was entered.
An address value of "0" in the initial register means "none" and values of "0" display for all registers.
Different address values can be entered as required in any of the register positions.
Here are two examples of how to add a setting or actual value to the front panel Modbus user map.
To add the setting "Phase TOC 1 Pickup" to the Modbus user map:
1. Find the address of the setting "Phase TOC 1 Pickup," which is 334Eh (334E in hexadecimal format).
2. Prefix this address by 3 to obtain 3334Eh.
3. Convert this value to decimal to obtain 209742 and enter it on the front panel.
To add the actual value "SRC 1 Frequency" to the Modbus user map:
1. Find the address of the actual value "SRC 1 Frequency," which is 1D80h.
2. Prefix this address by 4 to obtain 41D80h.
3. Convert this value to decimal to obtain 269696 and enter it on the front panel.
The relay contains a real time clock (RTC) to create time stamps for communications protocols as well as for historical data,
such as event records and oscillography. When the relay restarts, the RTC initializes from an onboard battery-backed
clock, which has the same accuracy as an electronic watch, approximately ±1 minute per month (~23 ppm). Once the RTC
is synchronized with the Precision Time Protocol (PTP), IRIG-B, or SNTP, its accuracy approaches that of the synchronizing
time delivered to the relay. While the RTC is not synchronized via PTP or IRIG-B, or the relay determines that it has an offset
possibly greater than 10 µs from the international time standard, the CLOCK UNSYNCHRONIZED FlexLogic operand is
activated.
The SYNCHRONIZING SOURCE setting displays in the software when the relay includes the IEEE 1588 software option. The
setting configures the priority sequence of the time synchronization source, to determine which of the available external
time sources to use for time synchronization. A setting of None causes the RTC and the synchrophasor clock to free-run,
and the clock can be changed from the front panel or from communications protocols. A setting of PP/IRIG-B/PTP/Other,
IRIG-B/PP/PTP/Other, or PP/PTP/IRIG-B/Other causes the relay to track the first source named that is enabled and
operational, or free-run if none of these are available. Here, PP means a time source that is strictly compliant with PP, PTP
means a time source that is not strictly compliant with PP, and Other means any less precise source (SNTP, IEC 103, IEC
104, Modbus, or DNP). When a time source fails or recovers, the relay automatically transfers synchronization as required
by this setting.
The PBM Clock setting causes the relay to use the time source from any non-HardFiber Process Bus Module clock. If the
Process Bus Module PTP FUNCTION setting is enabled and PTP grandmaster is available in the process bus network, the
Process Bus Module clock is synchronized to the PTP grandmaster, else the Process Bus Module clock free-runs. A UR can
use a synchronizing source either from the real-time clock (main CPU) or a Process Bus Module, as outlined in Settings >
Process Bus Module > PBM PTP.
Note that a UR does not need to be time synchronized to accept the sampled values. All the elements (protection, control,
monitoring, logic, and so on) in the UR (except Line Current Differential element) remain fully functional without requiring
any external synchronizing source for the UR, as long as all the sampled values subscribed by the relay are synchronized
according to the Settings > Process Bus Module > General > SmpSynch Check setting and pass the other acceptance
criteria as defined in Settings > Process Bus Module > SV Stream Config > Logic.
Some UR applications like oscillography, event recorder, and datalogger use the real-time clock for time-stamping.
When the relay does not have the IEEE 1588 software option and this setting does not display, it uses IRIG-B when enabled
and operational, then failing that SNTP when configured and operational, and otherwise it free-runs unless the clock is
changed from the front panel or from communications protocols.
Setup for IRIG-B is illustrated in the Installation chapter.
5 For the Other protocols, whenever a time synchronization message is received through any of the active protocols, the
M60 clock updates. However, given that IEC 60870-5-103, IEC 60870-5-104, Modbus, and DNP are low-accuracy time
synchronization methods, avoid their use for synchronization when better accuracy time protocols, such as IRIG-B and
PTP, are active in the system. If IRIG-B or PTP is used to update the relay clock, the other protocols (such as SNTP) are not
allowed to update, even if active.
See the COMMANDS SET DATE AND TIME menu section of this manual to manually set the RTC.
When 1 ms accuracy is required for events, oscillography, time stamping, synchrophasors, and 87L asymmetry
with respect to the master clock, the PTP clock needs to be connected to the CPU of a relay. The 1 ms accuracy
cannot be maintained if the CPU of the relay is synchronized through the Process Bus Module due to a delay up to
2 ms in transmitting a time stamp from the Process Bus Module to a CPU.
The REAL TIME CLOCK EVENTS setting allows changes to the date and/or time to be captured in the event record. The event
records the RTC time before the adjustment. A Date/Time Changed event is generated when:
• The real time clock changed from SNTP/PTP/IRIG-B and the time difference is more than one second
• The real time clock changed from the front panel or via Modbus register. The relay always generates this event
regardless of the time difference.
• The Daylight Saving Time (DST) setting gets enabled and the current relay time is already in the DST zone
• The real time clock enters or leaves DST
To enable IRIG-B synchronization, the input IRIG-B SIGNAL TYPE must be set to DC Shift or Amplitude Modulated. IRIG-B
synchronization can be disabled by making this setting None. When IRIG-B is enabled and active, clock synchronization by
communication protocols. (DNP, IEC 60870-5-103, IEC 60870-5-104) is blocked, and clock synchronization from the front
panel and over Modbus is always enabled.
Clocks can be synchronized locally among several relays using the computer time. When using a time source, such as
IRIG-B, the time is overwritten eventually by the time source. To synchronize clocks among UR devices:
1. In the EnerVista software, expand the main menu in the Online Window area and select the Synchronize Devices
entry. The window opens. The software prompts to acknowledge any offline devices.
2. Click the Synchronize Devices button at the top of the window, and confirm the action at the prompt. The devices
SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP REAL TIME CLOCK PRECISION TIME PROTOCOL (1588) PTP PORT 1(3)
PTP PORT 1 PORT 1 PTP FUNCTION: Range: Enabled, Disabled
Disabled
5
PORT 1 PATH DELAY Range: 0 to 60000 ns in steps of 1
ADDER: 0 ns
The M60 is provided with optional Precision Time Protocol capability. This feature is specified as the IEEE 1588
software option at the time of ordering.
The M60 supports the Precision Time Protocol (PTP) specified in IEEE Std 1588 2008 using the Power Profile (PP) specified in
IEEE Std C37.238 2017. This enables the relay to synchronize to the international time standard over an Ethernet network
that implements PP.
The relay can be configured to operate on some PTP networks that are not strictly PP. Time accuracy can be less than
specified for a PP network. Tolerated deviations from strict PP include 1) missing declaration of PP compliance in the
messages, 2) connection to a network device that does not support the PTP peer delay mechanism, 3) jitter substantially
greater than 1 µs in received event messages, and 4) certain non-compliant announce and sync message update rates.
The relay implements PTP according to IEEE Std 1588 2008 and the equivalent IEC 61588:2009(E), sometimes referred to as
version 2 PTP. It does not support the previous version of the standard (version 1).
PTP is a protocol that allows multiple clocks in a network to synchronize with one another. It permits synchronization
accuracies better than 1 ns, but this requires that each and every component in the network achieve very high levels of
accuracy and a very high baud rate, faster than normally used for relay communications. When operating over a generic
Ethernet network, time error can amount to 1 ms or more. PP is a profile of PTP which specifies a limited subset of PTP
suitable for use in power system protection, control, automation, and data communication applications, and thereby
facilitates interoperability between different vendor’s clocks and switches. PP specifies a worst-case delivered time error of
less than 1 µs over a 16-hop network.
In a PTP system and in a PP system, the clocks automatically organize themselves into a master-slave synchronization
hierarchy with the “best” clock available making itself the "grandmaster" at the top of the hierarchy; all others make
themselves “slaves” and track the grandmaster. Typically the grandmaster clock receives its time from GPS satellites or
some other link to the international time standard. If the grandmaster fails, the next “best” clock available in the domain
assumes the grandmaster role. When a clock on start-up discovers that it is “better” than the present grandmaster, it
assumes the grandmaster role and the previous grandmaster reverts to slave. The M60 qualification mechanism accepts a
potential master clock as a new grandmaster, when in a four-second interval it has received three announce messages
from it, all better than the present grandmaster clock and better than any other announce in this interval.
Time messages issued by the grandmaster are delayed as they pass through the network both due to the finite speed of
the signal in the interconnecting fiber or wire, and due to processing delays in the Ethernet switches. Each clock and switch
implementing PP measures the propagation delay to each of its PP neighbors, and compensates for these delays in the
time received. Each network device implementing PP measures the processing delay it introduces in each time message
and compensates for this delay in the time it transmits. As a result, the time delivered to end-devices such as the UR are
virtually identical to the grandmaster time. If one of the network devices in the hierarchy does not fully implement PP, the
associated propagation delay and/or latency may not be compensated for, and the time received at the end-device can be
in error by more than 100 µs.
See the preceding Real Time Clock section for a description of when time values received via PTP are used to update the
relay’s real time clock.
The following settings are available for configuring the relay for PTP. The PTP menu displays only when the option was
purchased.
STRICT POWER PROFILE — Power profile (IEEE Std C37.238 2017) requires that the relay only select a power profile compliant
clock as a grandmaster, that the delivered time have worst-case error of ±1 µs, and that the peer delay mechanism be
implemented. With the strict power profile setting enabled, the relay only selects as master the clocks displaying the
IEEE_C37_238 identification codes. It uses a port only when the peer delay mechanism is operational. With the strict power
5 profile setting disabled, the relay uses clocks without the power profile identification when no power profile clocks are
present, and uses ports even if the peer delay mechanism is non-operational. This setting applies to all of the relay’s PTP
capable ports.
PTP DOMAIN NUMBER — Set this setting to the domain number of the grandmaster-capable clock(s) to be synchronized to. A
network can support multiple time distribution domains, each distinguished with a unique domain number. More
commonly, there is a single domain using the default domain number zero.
This setting applies to all of the relay’s PTP capable ports.
PTP VLAN PRIORITY — This setting selects the value of the priority field in the 802.1Q VLAN tag in request messages issued
by the relay’s peer delay mechanism. In compliance with PP the default VLAN priority is 4, but it is recommended that it be
set to 7 in accordance with PTP. Depending on the characteristics of the device to which the relay is linked directly, VLAN
Priority can have no effect.
This setting applies to all of the relay’s PTP capable ports.
PTP VLAN ID — This setting selects the value of the ID field in the 802.1Q VLAN tag in request messages issued by the relay’s
peer delay mechanism. It is provided in compliance with PP. As these messages have a destination address that indicates
they are not to be bridged, their VLAN ID serves no function, and so can be left at its default value. Depending on the
characteristics of the device to which the relay is linked directly, VLAN ID can have no effect. This setting applies to all of
the relay’s PTP capable ports.
PORT 1 ... 3 FUNCTION — While this port setting is selected to disabled, PTP is disabled on this port. The relay does not
generate or listen to PTP messages on this port.
PORT 1 ... 3 PATH DELAY ADDER — The time delivered by PTP is advanced by the time value in this setting prior to the time
being used to synchronize the relay’s real time clock. This is to compensate to the extent practical for time delivery delays
not compensated for in the network. In a fully compliant PP network, the peer delay and the processing delay mechanisms
compensate for all the delays between the grandmaster and the relay. In such networks, make this setting zero.
In networks containing one or more switches and/or clocks that do not implement both of these mechanisms, not all
delays are compensated, so the time of message arrival at the relay is later than the time indicated in the message. This
setting can be used to approximately compensate for this delay. However, as the relay is not aware of network switching
that dynamically changes the amount of uncompensated delay, there is no setting that always and completely corrects
for uncompensated delay. A setting can be chosen that reduces the worst-case error to half of the range between
minimum and maximum uncompensated delay, if these values are known.
PORT 1 ... 3 PATH DELAY ASSYMMETRY — This setting corresponds to “delayAsymmetry” in PTP, which is used by the peer delay
mechanism to compensate for any difference in the propagation delay between the two directions of a link. Except in
unusual cases, the two fibers are of essentially identical length and composition, so make this setting zero.
In unusual cases where the length of the link is different in different directions, set this setting to the number of
nanoseconds the Ethernet propagation delay to the relay is longer than the mean of path propagation delays to and from
the relay. For instance, if it is known say from the physical length of the fibers and the propagation speed in the fibers that
the delay from the relay to the Ethernet switch it is connected to is 9000 ns and that the delay from the switch to the relay
is 11000 ns, then the mean delay is 10000 ns, and the path delay asymmetry is 11000 - 10000 = +1000 ns.
To use SERVER2 SNTP in broadcast mode, set the SNTP SERVER2 IP ADDR setting to "0.0.0.0" and SNTP FUNCTION to "Enabled."
The M60 SNTP client then listens to SNTP messages sent to the "all ones" broadcast address for the subnet. The M60 waits
up to 18 minutes (>1024 seconds) without receiving an SNTP broadcast message before switching to the alternate
channel.
SNTP SERVER1 UDP PORT — This setting is 123 for normal SNTP operation. If SERVER1 SNTP is not required, close the port by
changing this setting to zero.
SNTP SERVER2 UDP PORT — This setting is 123 for normal SNTP operation. If SERVER2 SNTP is not required, close the port by
changing this setting to zero.
Do not set more than one protocol to the same TCP/UDP port number, as this results in unreliable operation of
those protocols.
If SERVER1 IP ADDR and UDP PORT settings match the SERVER2 IP ADDR and UDP PORT settings, the M60 considers
only the SERVER1 SNTP server as being configured and an SNTP Failure error message generates. The failure
message also displays when both servers are unavailable.
DST START DAY: Range: Sunday to Saturday (all days of the week)
Sunday
DST STOP DAY: Range: Sunday to Saturday (all days of the week)
Sunday
The M60 maintains two times: local time and Universal Coordinated Time (UTC). Local time can be provided by IRIG-B
signals. UTC time is provided by SNTP servers.
The real-time clock (RTC) and time stamps reported in historical records and communication protocols can be incorrect if
the Local Time settings are not configured properly.
See the IRIG-B section in the Installation chapter for guidance on these settings when using an IRIG-B source that sets the
IRIG-B control bits according to IEEE Std 1344-1995.
LOCAL TIME OFFSET FROM UTC — Used to specify the local time zone offset from UTC (Greenwich Mean Time) in hours. Time
zones in the eastern hemisphere have positive values; time zones in the western hemisphere have negative values. A value
of zero causes the relay to use UTC for local time. This setting has two uses. When the system RTC is synchronized with a
communications protocol providing only local time or it is free-running, the offset setting is used to calculate UTC from the
local time these provide. When the RTC is synchronized with a communications protocol providing only UTC (such as PTP or
SNTP), the time offset setting is used to determine local time from the UTC provided. PTP
ALTERNATE_TIME_OFFSET_INDICATOR TLVs are not used to calculate local time.
DAYLIGHT SAVINGS TIME and DST — Can be used to allow the relay to follow the DST rules of the local time zone. Note that
when IRIG-B time synchronization is active, the local time in the IRIG-B signal contains any daylight savings time offset and
so the DST settings are ignored. Note that the following items do not include the DST: Time of Day Timer Start Time; Time of
Day Timer Stop Time; Event Recorder Last Cleared Date; Source x Demand VAR Maximum Date; Source x Demand WATT
Maximum Date; Source x Demand VA Maximum Date; Source x Demand Ia Maximum Date; Source x Demand Ib Maximum
Date; Source x Demand Ic Maximum Date; PMU x Last Cleared Date; PMU One-Shot Time; Data Logger Newest Time; Data
Logger Oldest Time; Oscillography Last Cleared Date; Last Settings Change Date; User Programmable Fault Report Cleared
Date; Digital Counter x Frozen Time Stamp; HIZ RMS Capture x Time; and HIZ Capture x Time.
When enabled, this function monitors the pre-fault trigger. The pre-fault data are stored in the memory for prospective
creation of the fault report on the rising edge of the pre-fault trigger. The element waits for the fault trigger as long as the
pre-fault trigger is asserted, but not shorter than 1 second. When the fault trigger occurs, the fault data is stored and the
complete report is created. If the fault trigger does not occur within 1 second after the pre-fault trigger drops out, the
element resets and no record is created.
The user programmable record contains the following information: the user-programmed relay name, detailed firmware
revision (x.xx, for example) and relay model (M60), the date and time of trigger, the name of pre-fault trigger (a specific
FlexLogic operand), the name of fault trigger (a specific FlexLogic operand), the active setting group at pre-fault trigger, the
active setting group at fault trigger, pre-fault values of all programmed analog channels (one cycle before pre-fault trigger),
and fault values of all programmed analog channels (at the fault trigger).
Each fault report is stored as a file to a maximum capacity of ten files. An eleventh trigger overwrites the oldest file. The
EnerVista software is required to view all captured data. A FAULT RPT TRIG event is automatically created when the report
is triggered.
The relay includes two user-programmable fault reports to enable capture of two types of trips (for example, trip from
thermal protection with the report configured to include temperatures, and short-circuit trip with the report configured to
include voltages and currents). Both reports feed the same report file queue.
The last record is available as individual data items via communications protocols.
PRE-FAULT 1 TRIGGER — Specifies the FlexLogic operand to capture the pre-fault data. The rising edge of this operand stores
one cycle-old data for subsequent reporting. The element waits for the fault trigger to actually create a record as long as
the operand selected as PRE-FAULT 1 TRIGGER is “On.” If the operand remains “Off” for 1 second, the element resets and no
record is created.
FAULT 1 TRIGGER — Specifies the FlexLogic operand to capture the fault data. The rising edge of this operand stores the
data as fault data and results in a new report. The trigger (not the pre-fault trigger) controls the date and time of the
report.
FAULT REPORT 1 # 1 to FAULT REPORT 1 #32 — These settings specify an actual value such as voltage or current magnitude,
true RMS, phase angle, frequency, temperature, and so on, to be stored when the report is created. Up to 32 channels can
be configured. Two reports are configurable to cope with variety of trip conditions and items of interest.
5.3.9 Oscillography
5.3.9.1 Menu
SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP OSCILLOGRAPHY
OSCILLOGRAPHY NUMBER OF RECORDS: Range: 3 to 64 in steps of 1
5
Oscillography records contain waveforms captured at the sampling rate as well as other relay data at the point of trigger.
Oscillography records are triggered by a programmable FlexLogic operand. Multiple oscillography records can be
captured simultaneously.
To retrieve an Oscillography record from a relay:
1. If not yet set up for oscillography, configure settings under Settings > Product Setup > Oscillography in the EnerVista
software.
2. Access Actual Values > Records > Oscillography in the EnerVista software.
3. In the window that opens, select the record number. The highest number is the most recent record (Newest Record
Number).
4. Click the Read button to get the waveform. When available, waveforms are displayed graphically, and otherwise error
messages display.
5. In the waveform window that opens, you can save the file, for example with the CFG extension.
When EnerVista UR Setup creates a new settings file, a Smart defaults feature automatically enters a basic oscillography
configuration. The basic configuration changes the factory default values to make the number of samples per cycle 32,
adds a selection of digital and analog channels that are often of interest, and adds a FlexLogic equation to trigger
oscillography. Review and update this basic configuration as required for the application at hand.
The NUMBER OF RECORDS is selectable, but the number of cycles captured in a single record varies considerably based on
other factors, such as sample rate and the number of operational modules. There is a fixed amount of data storage for
oscillography; the more data captured, the less the number of cycles captured per record. See the ACTUAL VALUES
RECORDS OSCILLOGRAPHY menu to view the number of cycles captured per record. The following table provides sample
configurations with corresponding cycles/record. The minimum number of oscillographic records is three.
TRIGGER MODE — A new record automatically overwrites an older record when TRIGGER MODE is set to “Automatic
Overwrite.”
TRIGGER POSITION — Set this to a percentage of the total buffer size (for example, 10%, 50%, 75%, and so on). A trigger
position of 25% consists of 25% pre- and 75% post-trigger data.
TRIGGER SOURCE — Always captured in oscillography and can be any FlexLogic parameter (element state, contact input,
virtual output, and so on). The relay sampling rate is 64 samples per cycle.
AC INPUT WAVEFORMS — Determines the sampling rate at which AC input signals (that is, current and voltage) are stored.
Reducing the sampling rate allows longer records to be stored. This setting has no effect on the internal sampling rate of
the relay, which is always 64 samples per cycle. That is, it has no effect on the fundamental calculations of the device.
When changes are made to the oscillography settings, all existing oscillography records are cleared. 5
DIGITAL 1(127) CHANNEL — This setting selects the FlexLogic operand state recorded in an oscillography trace. The length of
each oscillography trace depends in part on the number of parameters selected here. Parameters set to “Off” are ignored.
There are 127 channels and one trigger, for a total of 128.
To populate quickly the rows in the Offline Window, use Ctrl C/V to copy/paste, or click then double-click a row to display a
quick selection window.
Figure 5-50: Quick selection window
These settings select the metering actual value recorded in an oscillography trace. The length of each oscillography trace
depends in part on the number of parameters selected here. Parameters set to “Off” are ignored. The parameters available
in a given relay depend on
• the type of relay,
• the type and number of CT/VT hardware modules installed, and
• the type and number of analog input hardware modules installed
A list of all possible analog metering actual value parameters is presented in Appendix A: FlexAnalog Parameters.
All eight CT/VT module channels are stored in the oscillography file. The CT/VT module channels are named as follows:
<slot_letter><terminal_number>—<I or V><phase A, B, or C, or 4th input>
The fourth current input in a bank is called IG, and the fourth voltage input in a bank is called VX. For example, F2-IB
designates the IB signal on terminal 2 of the CT/VT module in slot F.
If there are no CT/VT modules and analog input modules, no analog traces appear in the file; only the digital traces appear.
DATA LOGGER CONFIG: Range: Not applicable - shows computed data only
0 CHNL x 0.0 DAYS
The data logger samples and records up to 16 analog parameters at a user-defined sampling rate. This recorded data can
be downloaded to EnerVista UR Setup and displayed with parameters on the vertical axis and time on the horizontal axis.
All data is stored in non-volatile memory, so the information is retained when power to the relay is lost.
For a fixed sampling rate, the data logger can be configured with a few channels over a long period or a larger number of
channels for a shorter period. The relay automatically partitions the available memory between the channels in use. The
following table outlines examples of storage capacities for a system frequency of 60 Hz.
Changing any setting affecting data logger operation clears data in the log.
DATA LOGGER MODE — This setting configures the mode in which the data logger operates. When set to “Continuous,” the
data logger actively records any configured channels at the rate as defined by the DATA LOGGER RATE. The data logger is
5
idle in this mode when no channels are configured. When set to “Trigger,” the data logger records any configured channels
at the instance of the rising edge of the DATA LOGGER TRIGGER source FlexLogic operand. The data logger ignores all
subsequent triggers and continues to record data until the active record is full. Once the data logger is full, a CLEAR DATA
LOGGER command is required to clear the data logger record before a new record can be started. Performing the CLEAR
DATA LOGGER command also stops the current record and resets the data logger to be ready for the next trigger.
DATA LOGGER TRIGGER — This setting selects the signal used to trigger the start of a new data logger record. Any FlexLogic
operand can be used as the trigger source. This setting only applies when the mode is set to “Trigger.”
DATA LOGGER RATE — This setting selects the time interval at which the actual value data is recorded.
DATA LOGGER CHNL 1(16) — This setting selects the metering actual value that is to be recorded in Channel 1(16) of the data
log. The parameters available in a given relay are dependent on: the type of relay, the type and number of CT/VT hardware
modules installed, and the type and number of Analog Input hardware modules installed. Upon startup, the relay
automatically prepares the parameter list. A list of all possible analog metering actual value parameters is shown in
Appendix A: FlexAnalog Parameters.
DATA LOGGER CONFIG — This display presents the total amount of time that the Data Logger can record the channels not
selected to “Off” without overwriting old data.
The LEDs can be customized to illuminate when a selected FlexLogic operand is in the logic 1 state. The trip and alarm
LEDs can also be customized in a similar manner. To ensure correct functionality of all LEDs, an LED test feature is also
provided.
When enabled, the LED test can be initiated from any digital input or user-programmable condition, such as a user-
programmable pushbutton. The control operand is configured under the LED TEST CONTROL setting. The test covers all
LEDs, including the LEDs of the optional user-programmable pushbuttons.
For the enhanced and basic front panels, the test consists of the following three stages:
1. All 62 LEDs on the relay are illuminated. This is a quick test to verify if any of the LEDs is “burned.” This stage lasts as
long as the control input is on, up to a maximum of one minute. After one minute, the test ends.
2. All the LEDs are turned off, and then one LED at a time turns on for one second, then back off. The test routine starts at
the top left panel, moving from the top to bottom of each LED column. This test checks for hardware failures that lead
to more than one LED being turned on from a single logic point. This stage can be interrupted at any time.
3. All the LEDs are turned on. One LED at a time turns off for one second, then back on. The test routine starts at the top
left panel moving from top to bottom of each column of the LEDs. This test checks for hardware failures that lead to
more than one LED being turned off from a single logic point. This stage can be interrupted at any time.
For the graphical front panel, the test consists of the following stages:
1. All 22 LEDs on the relay are illuminated. This is a quick test to verify if any of the LEDs is "burned." This stage lasts as
long as the control input is on, up to a maximum of one minute. After one minute, the test ends.
2. All the LEDs are turned off, and then one LED at a time turns on with the orange color for one second, then back off.
The test routine starts at the top left panel, moving from the top to bottom for all 14 LEDs. Then the eight pushbutton
LEDs are tested in the same manner. This test checks for hardware failures that lead to more than one LED being
turned on from a single logic point. This stage can be interrupted at any time.
3. All the LEDs are turned on with the orange color. One LED at a time turns off for one second, then back on. The test
routine starts at the top left panel moving from top to bottom for all 14 LEDs. Then the eight pushbutton LEDs are
tested in the same manner. This test checks for hardware failures that lead to more than one LED being turned off
from a single logic point. This stage can be interrupted at any time.
4. Additionally, stages 2 and 3 are repeated twice for the five device status LEDs and nine event cause LEDs, one time
with green color on and the other with red color on.
When testing is in progress, the LEDs are controlled by the test sequence, rather than the protection, control, and
monitoring features. However, the LED control mechanism accepts all the changes to LED states generated by the relay
and stores the actual LED states (on or off) in memory. When the test completes, the LEDs reflect the actual state resulting
from relay response during testing. The reset pushbutton does not clear any targets when the LED Test is in progress.
A dedicated FlexLogic operand, LED TEST IN PROGRESS, is set for the duration of the test. When the test sequence is initiated,
the LED TEST INITIATED event is stored in the event recorder.
The entire test procedure is user-controlled. In particular, stage 1 can last as long as necessary, and stages 2 and 3 can be
interrupted. The test responds to the position and rising edges of the control input defined by the LED TEST CONTROL
setting. The control pulses must last at least 250 ms to take effect. The following diagram explains how the test is
executed.
Figure 5-51: LED test sequence
READY TO TEST
Reset the
LED TEST IN PROGRESS
rising edge of the
operand
control input
Set the
5
LED TEST IN PROGRESS
operand
control input is on
STAGE 1 time-out
(all LEDs on) (1 minute)
rising edge
STAGE 3
of the control
(one LED off at a time) input
842011A1.CDR
Application example 1
Assume one needs to check if any of the LEDs is “burned” through user-programmable pushbutton 1. Apply the following
settings.
Configure user-programmable pushbutton 1 by making the following entries in the SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP USER-
PROGRAMMABLE PUSHBUTTONS USER PUSHBUTTON 1 menu. (The option does not display when not purchased.)
PUSHBUTTON 1 FUNCTION: “Self-reset”
PUSHBTN 1 DROP-OUT TIME: “0.10 s”
Configure the LED test to recognize user-programmable pushbutton 1 by making the following entries in the SETTINGS
PRODUCT SETUP USER-PROGRAMMABLE LEDS LED TEST menu:
LED TEST FUNCTION: “Enabled”
LED TEST CONTROL: “PUSHBUTTON 1 ON”
The test is initiated when the user-programmable pushbutton 1 is pressed. Keep the pushbutton pressed for as long as the
LEDs are being visually inspected. When finished, release the pushbutton. The relay then automatically starts stage 2. At
this point, test can be cancelled by pressing the pushbutton.
Application example 2
Assume one needs to check if any LEDs are “burned” as well as exercise one LED at a time to check for other failures. This
is to be performed via user-programmable pushbutton 1.
After applying the settings in application example 1, hold down the pushbutton as long as necessary to test all LEDs. When
finished, release the pushbutton so that the relay then automatically starts stage 2. When stage 2 is completed, stage 3
starts automatically. The test can be cancelled at any time by pressing the pushbutton.
The trip and alarm LEDs are in the first LED column (enhanced and graphical front panels) and on LED panel 1 (basic front
5 panel). Each LED can be programmed to turn on when the selected FlexLogic operand is in the logic 1 state.
For the enhanced and basic front panels, there are 48 amber LEDs across the relay LED panels. Each of these indicators
can be programmed to illuminate when the selected FlexLogic operand is in the logic 1 state.
For the basic front panel, the LEDs are located as follows:
• LED Panel 2 — User-programmable LEDs 1 through 24
• LED Panel 3 — User programmable LEDs 25 through 48
For the enhanced front panel, the LEDs are located as follows:
• LED column 2 — User-programmable LEDs 1 through 12
• LED column 3 — User-programmable LEDs 13 through 24
• LED column 4 — User-programmable LEDs 25 through 36
• LED column 5 — User-programmable LEDs 37 through 48
See the LED Indicators section in chapter 4 for information on the location of these indexed LEDs.
The user-programmable LED settings select the FlexLogic operands that control the LEDs. If the LED 1 TYPE setting is “Self-
Reset” (the default setting), the LED illumination tracks the state of the selected LED operand. If the LED 1 TYPE setting is
“Latched,” the LED, once lit, remains so until reset by the front panel RESET button, from a remote device via a
communications channel, or from any programmed operand, even if the LED operand state de-asserts.
See the figure in the Setting Groups section of the Control Elements section later in this chapter for an example of group
activation.
For the graphical front panel, the event cause LED settings select the FlexLogic operands that control the LEDs.
LED 1 TYPE — If set to "Self-Reset," the LED illumination tracks the state of the selected LED operand. If set to "Latched," the
LED, once lit, remains so even the LED operand state already de-asserts, until reset by the front panel RESET button, from a
remote device via a communications channel, or from any programmed operand.
The table outlines default input operand and output operands for each event cause LED.
Table 5-16: Default input and output operand for event cause LEDs
LED Default input operand Output operand Default color
Event Cause LED 1 LED PICKUP EVENT CAUSE LED 1 Green
Event Cause LED 2 LED VOLTAGE EVENT CAUSE LED 2 Orange
Event Cause LED 3 LED CURRENT EVENT CAUSE LED 3 Orange
Event Cause LED 4 LED FREQUENCY EVENT CAUSE LED 4 Orange
Event Cause LED 5 LED OTHER EVENT CAUSE LED 5 Orange
Event Cause LED 6 LED PHASE A EVENT CAUSE LED 6 Orange
Event Cause LED 7 LED PHASE B EVENT CAUSE LED 7 Orange
Event Cause LED 8 LED PHASE C EVENT CAUSE LED 8 Orange
Event Cause LED 9 LED NEUTRAL/GROUND EVENT CAUSE LED 9 Orange
DIRECT DEVICE OFF Range: Disabled, Enabled. Valid for units equipped
FUNCTION: Enabled with Direct Input/Output module.
All major self-test alarms are reported automatically with their corresponding FlexLogic operands, events, and targets.
This settings menu allows enabling and disabling of most minor self-test alarms.
When in the Disabled mode, minor alarms do not assert a FlexLogic operand, write to the event recorder, or display target
messages. Moreover, they do not trigger the ANY MINOR ALARM or ANY SELF-TEST messages. When in Enabled mode,
minor alarms continue to function along with other major and minor alarms. See the Relay Self-tests section in chapter 7
for information on major and minor self-test alarms.
When using the graphical front panel and setting annunciator alarms, the function needs to be enabled here too, else the
alarm is not triggered.
PB SFP MODUL # FAIL FUNCTION — For order code H85, ports 2a, 2b, 4a, 4b are not available.
Control pushbuttons
5
842813A1.CDR
An additional four control pushbuttons are included on the basic front panel when the M60 is ordered with the 12 user-
programmable pushbutton option.
Figure 5-53: Control pushbuttons (basic front panel)
67$786 (9(17&$86(
,16(59,&( 92/7$*(
7528%/( &855(17 5(6(7
7(6702'( )5(48(1&<
75,3 27+(5 86(5 7+5((
$/$50 3+$6($ 67$1'$5'
3,&.83 3+$6(% 86(5
3+$6(&
&21752/
1(875$/*5281' 86(5 386+%877216
86(5
86(5 )285(;75$
237,21$/
86(5
&21752/
86(5 386+%877216
($"'##1"34B
Control pushbuttons are not typically used for critical operations and are not protected by the control password. However,
by supervising their output operands, the user can dynamically enable or disable control pushbuttons for security
reasons.
Each control pushbutton asserts its own FlexLogic operand. Each operand need to be configured appropriately to perform
the required function. Each operand remains asserted as long as the pushbutton is pressed and resets when the
pushbutton is released. A dropout delay of 100 ms is incorporated to ensure fast pushbutton manipulation is recognized
by various features that can use control pushbuttons as inputs.
An event is logged in the event record (as per user setting) when a control pushbutton is pressed. No event is logged when
the pushbutton is released. The front panel keys (including control keys) cannot be operated simultaneously—a given key
must be released before the next one can be pressed.
Figure 5-54: Control pushbutton logic
6(77,1*
&21752/386+%87721
)81&7,21
(QDEOHG
6(77,1*6
^
6<67(06(783
!%5($.(56
!%5($.(5
!%5($.(53%&21752/
$1' 581
:KHQDSSOLFDEOH
2II
2)) 7,0(5
6<67(06(783 )/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
!%5($.(56 21 &21752/386+%7121
!%5($.(5 PVHF
!%5($.(53%&21752/
2II
$&'5
User-programmable pushbuttons provide an easy and error-free method of entering digital state (on, off) information. The
number depends on the front panel ordered.
• Enhanced horizontal front panel — 16 user-programmable pushbuttons
• Enhanced vertical front panel — 6 user-programmable pushbuttons
• Basic horizontal front panel — 12 user-programmable pushbuttons
• Graphical front panel — 48 user-programmable pushbuttons (eight physical pushbuttons, 40 graphical interface
pushbuttons)
User-programmable pushbuttons require a front panel with that option. If the front panel was ordered separately,
update the EnerVista software under Maintenance > Change Front Panel.
The digital state can be entered locally (by directly pressing the front panel pushbutton or optional graphical front panel
interface) or remotely (via FlexLogic operands) into FlexLogic equations, protection elements, and control elements. Typical
applications include breaker control, autorecloser blocking, and setting groups changes. For example, set pushbuttons 1 to
5 to select settings groups 1 to 5, or set pushbutton 1 to clear event records. The user-programmable pushbuttons are
under the control level of password protection.
Example 5
To clear event records using pushbutton 1, set Settings > Product Setup > Clear Relay Records > Clear Event Records to
FlexLogic operand PUSHBUTTON 1 ON. Then program the pushbutton by setting Settings > Product Setup > User-
Programmable Pushbuttons > Pushbutton 1 Function to "Self-reset." For a graphical front panel, to use a side
pushbutton to clear the event records, it also needs to be programmed in a single-line diagram.
The figures show user-configurable pushbuttons for the front panels.
Figure 5-55: User-programmable pushbuttons (enhanced front panel)
USER USER USER USER USER USER USER USER USER USER USER USER USER USER USER USER
LABEL 1 LABEL 2 LABEL 3 LABEL 4 LABEL 5 LABEL 6 LABEL 7 LABEL 8 LABEL 9 LABEL 10 LABEL 11 LABEL 12 LABEL 13 LABEL 14 LABEL 15 LABEL 16
842814A1.CDR
1 3 5 7 9 11
USER LABEL USER LABEL USER LABEL USER LABEL USER LABEL USER LABEL
2 4 6 8 10 12
USER LABEL USER LABEL USER LABEL USER LABEL USER LABEL USER LABEL
842779A1.cdr
3URJUDPDQ\EXWWRQVIRUSXVKEXWWRQVWR 3XVKEXWWRQVWR
5(6(7 (6&
(17(5
=e\dY\Y^>& >Udg_b[CdQRY\YdiQ^TCi^SXb_`XQc_b=UQcebU]U^dCicdU]
$&'5
Front panel pushbuttons and LEDs can be custom labeled as outlined in the Front Panel Labeling section in the previous
chapter.
Each pushbutton asserts its own “On” and “Off” FlexLogic operands (for example, PUSHBUTTON 1 ON and PUSHBUTTON 1 OFF).
These operands are available for each pushbutton and are used to program specific actions. If any pushbutton is active,
the ANY PB ON operand is asserted.
Each pushbutton has an associated LED indicator. By default, this indicator displays the present status of the
corresponding pushbutton (on or off). However, each LED indicator can be assigned to any FlexLogic operand through the
5 PUSHBTN 1 LED CTL setting.
The activation and deactivation of user-programmable pushbuttons depends on whether latched or self-reset mode is
programmed.
• Latched mode — In latched mode, a pushbutton can be set (activated) by asserting the operand assigned to the
PUSHBTN 1 SET setting, by directly pressing the associated front panel pushbutton, or with the graphical front panel
interface. The state of each pushbutton is stored in non-volatile memory and maintained through a loss of control
power.
The pushbutton is reset (deactivated) in latched mode by asserting the operand assigned to the PUSHBTN 1 RESET
setting, by directly pressing the active front panel pushbutton, or with the graphical front panel interface.
It can also be programmed to reset automatically through the PUSHBTN 1 AUTORST and PUSHBTN 1 AUTORST DELAY
settings. These settings enable the autoreset timer and specify the associated time delay. The autoreset timer can be
used in select-before-operate (SBO) breaker control applications, where the command type (close/open) or breaker
location (feeder number) must be selected prior to command execution. The selection must reset automatically if
control is not executed within a specified time period.
• Self-reset mode — In self-reset mode, a user-programmable pushbutton can be set (activated) by asserting the
operand assigned to the PUSHBTN 1 SET setting, by pressing the front panel pushbutton, or by the graphical front panel
interface. A pushbutton remains active for the time it is pressed physically or pressed in the graphical front panel
interface, plus the dropout time specified in the PUSHBTN 1 DROP-OUT TIME setting. If the pushbutton is activated via
FlexLogic, the pulse duration is specified by the PUSHBTN 1 DROP-OUT TIME only. The time the operand assigned to the
PUSHBTN 1 SET setting remains On has no effect on the pulse duration.
The pulse duration of the remote set or local front panel pushbutton must be at least 56 ms for a 60 Hz system or
60 ms for a 50 Hz system to operate the pushbutton. This allows the user-programmable pushbuttons to properly
operate during power cycling events and various system disturbances that can cause transient assertion of the
operating signals.
The local and remote operation of each user-programmable pushbutton can be inhibited through the PUSHBTN 1 LOCAL
and PUSHBTN 1 REMOTE settings. If local inhibit is applied, the pushbutton ignores set and reset commands executed
through the front panel pushbuttons. If remote inhibit is applied, the pushbutton ignores set and reset commands
executed through FlexLogic operands.
The inhibit functions are not applied to the autoreset feature. The inhibit function can be used in SBO control operations to
prevent user-programmable pushbutton activation and ensuring “one-at-a-time” select operation.
The inhibit functions can also be used to prevent pushbutton activation from the accidental pressing of the front panel
pushbuttons. The separate inhibit of the local and remote operation simplifies the implementation of local/remote control
supervision.
Pushbutton states can be logged by the event recorder. User-defined messages can also be associated with each
pushbutton and displayed on basic and enhanced front panels when the user-programmable pushbutton is activated, and
when in the latched mode when the user-programmable pushbutton is deactivated. With the graphical front panel
interface, instead of messages, the status of user-programmable pushbuttons can display on a single-line diagram and
can also display in annunciator page windows and in actual values page cells.
For the graphical front panel, the pushbuttons 1 to 8 are linked to the eight physical pushbuttons, and pushbuttons 9 and
above are mapped to the graphical interface pushbuttons. To set the buttons for pushbuttons 9 and above, access
Settings > Product Setup > Graphical Panel > Single Line Diagram Editor, click the PB symbol in the toolbox, then
configure pushbuttons 9 and above.
PUSHBUTTON 1 FUNCTION — This setting selects the mode of the pushbutton (Self-Reset, Latched, Disabled). If set to
“Disabled,” the pushbutton is not active and the corresponding FlexLogic operands (both “On” and “Off”) are de-asserted. If
set to "Latched," the pushbutton remains on until reset.
PUSHBTN 1 ID TEXT — This setting specifies the top 20-character line of the user-programmable pushbutton message and is
intended to provide ID information of the pushbutton. For example, the text displays in the Event Record. See the User-
definable Displays section in this chapter for instructions on how to enter alphanumeric characters from the keypad. On a
graphical front panel, this setting instead controls the label of the user-programmable pushbutton component on single-
5
line diagrams.
PUSHBTN 1 ON TEXT — This setting specifies the bottom 20-character line of the user-programmable pushbutton message
and is displayed when the pushbutton is in the “on” position. See the User-definable Displays section for instructions on
entering alphanumeric characters from the keypad. On a graphical front panel, this setting instead controls the on status
text of the user-programmable pushbutton component on single-line diagrams. This setting is not applied to the physical
pushbuttons on the graphical front panel.
PUSHBTN 1 OFF TEXT — This setting specifies the bottom 20-character line of the user-programmable pushbutton message
and displays when the pushbutton is deactivated and the PUSHBUTTON 1 FUNCTION is “Latched.” A message does not
display when the PUSHBUTTON 1 FUNCTION is “Self-reset” as the pushbutton operand status is implied to be “Off” upon its
release. The length of the “Off” message is configured with the PRODUCT SETUP DISPLAY PROPERTIES FLASH MESSAGE
TIME setting. On a graphical front panel, this setting instead controls the off status text of the user-programmable
pushbutton component on single-line diagrams. This setting is not applied to the physical pushbuttons on the graphical
front panel.
PUSHBTN 1 HOLD — This setting specifies the time required for a front panel pushbutton to be pressed before it is deemed
active. This timer is reset upon release of the pushbutton. Note that user-programmable pushbutton operation requires the
front panel pushbutton to be pressed a minimum of 56 ms for a 60 Hz system or 60 ms for a 50 Hz system. This minimum
time is required prior to activating the user-programmable pushbutton hold timer.
PUSHBTN 1 SET — This setting assigns the FlexLogic operand serving to activate the user-programmable pushbutton
element. The duration of the incoming set signal must be at least 56 ms for a 60 Hz system or 60 ms for a 50 Hz system.
PUSHBTN 1 RESET — This setting assigns the FlexLogic operand serving to deactivate the user-programmable pushbutton
element. This setting is applicable only if the user-programmable pushbutton is in "Latched" mode.
PUSHBTN 1 AUTORST — This setting enables the user-programmable pushbutton autoreset feature. This setting is applicable
only if the pushbutton is in “Latched” mode.
PUSHBTN 1 AUTORST DELAY — This setting specifies the time delay for automatic reset of the pushbutton when in "Latched"
mode.
PUSHBTN 1 REMOTE — This setting assigns the FlexLogic operand serving to inhibit user-programmable pushbutton
operation from the operand assigned to the PUSHBTN 1 SET or PUSHBTN 1 RESET settings.
PUSHBTN 1 LOCAL — This setting assigns the FlexLogic operand serving to inhibit user-programmable pushbutton operation
from the front panel pushbuttons. This inhibit functionality is not applicable to pushbutton autoreset.
PUSHBTN 1 DROP-OUT TIME — This setting applies only to “Self-Reset” mode and specifies the duration of the user-
programmable pushbutton active status after the front panel pushbutton or graphical front panel interface pushbutton
has been released. When activated remotely, this setting specifies the entire activation time of the pushbutton; the length
of time the operand selected by PUSHBTN 1 SET remains on has no effect on the pulse duration.
PUSHBTN 1 LED CTL — This setting assigns the FlexLogic operand serving to drive the front panel pushbutton LED. If this
setting is “Off,” then LED operation is directly linked to the PUSHBUTTON 1 ON operand. This setting is not applied to
Pushbuttons 9 and above on the graphical front panel, where the label background shows the orange glow color for the
"on" state.
PUSHBTN 1 MESSAGE — This setting controls the behavior of the user-programmable pushbutton on message that is
programmed in the PUSHBTN 1 ID and PUSHBTN 1 ON TEXT settings, and the behavior of the user-programmable pushbutton
off message that is programmed in the PUSHBTN 1 ID and PUSHBTN 1 OFF TEXT settings. This settings has no effect on the
graphical front panel.
When set to "Disabled," user-programmable pushbutton messages do not display. Otherwise the on message displays
when the user-programmable pushbutton becomes activated, and if in the "Latched" mode the off message displays
when the user-programmable pushbutton becomes deactivated.
When set to "Normal," the duration the message displays is as specified by the FLASH MESSAGE TIME setting.
When set to "High Priority," the duration of the off message is as specified by the FLASH MESSAGE TIME setting, but the on
message is displayed as long as the user-programmable pushbutton is activated. While activated, target and other
messages are suppressed. To allow front panel keypad operation, when a keypad button is pressed the message is
5 suppressed for 10 seconds.
PUSHBUTTON 1 EVENTS — If this setting is enabled, each user-programmable pushbutton state change is logged as an event
into the event recorder.
The figures show the user-programmable pushbutton logic.
6(77,1* 25
386+%716(7
PV+]
2II 7,0(5
1RQYRODWLOHODWFK
PV
6(77,1* $1' 6
$1'
386+%715(027( /DWFK
2II
PV+] 5
7,0(5
6(77,1* PV
386+%877212))
6(77,1*
386+%715(6(7 $1'
2II
25 7RXVHUSURJUDPPDEOH
6(77,1* 25 386+%8772121 SXVKEXWWRQVORJLF
6(77,1* VKHHW
386+%71$872567'(/$<
386+%71$872567
73.3
(QDEOHG
$1'
5
'LVDEOHG $1'
7,0(5
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1' PV 25
386+%8772121
6(77,1*
$1' 386+%71'5232877,0(
25
7567
$1'
$&'5
OFF MESSAGE
ENGAGE MESSAGE
SETTING
LATCHED FLASH MESSAGE TIME
SETTINGS
0 PUSHBTN ID TEXT
AND
OR TRST = XXXXXXXXXX
PUSHBTN OFF TEXT
= XXXXXXXXXX
Instantaneous
From user-programmable reset * Enhanced and standard front panels
pushbuttons logic sheet 1
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
LATCHED/SELF-RESET
AND PUSHBUTTON 1 OFF
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
PUSHBUTTON ON PUSHBUTTON 1 ON
ON MESSAGE
SETTING ENGAGE MESSAGE
PUSHBTN 1 MESSAGE
AND
= Disabled
= High Priority SETTINGS
= Normal PUSHBTN ID TEXT
= XXXXXXXXXX
OR
PUSHBTN ON TEXT
SETTING
= XXXXXXXXXX
FLASH MESSAGE TIME
0 Enhanced and standard front panels
AND
TRST The message is temporarily removed if
5
any keypad button is pressed. Ten
seconds of keypad inactivity restores
Instantaneous
Instantaneous reset is executed if any reset * the message.
front panel button is pressed or any new
target or message becomes active.
This feature provides a mechanism where any of 256 selected FlexLogic operand states can be used for efficient
monitoring. The feature allows user-customized access to the FlexLogic operand states in the relay. The state bits are
packed so that 16 states are readable in a single Modbus register. The state bits can be configured so that all states of
interest are available in a minimum number of Modbus registers.
The state bits can be read out in the “Flex States” register array beginning at Modbus address 0900h. Sixteen states are
packed into each register, with the lowest-numbered state in the lowest-order bit. Sixteen registers accommodate the 256
state bits.
5.3.16.1 Menu
SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP USER-DEFINABLE DISPLAYS
USER-DEFINABLE INVOKE AND SCROLL: Range: FlexLogic operand
DISPLAYS Off
Any existing system display can be automatically copied into an available user display by selecting the existing display
and pressing the ENTER key. The display then prompts with ADD TO USER DISPLAY LIST? After selecting “Yes,” a message
indicates that the selected display has been added to the user display list. When this type of entry occurs, the sub-menus
are automatically configured with the proper content—this content can be edited subsequently.
This menu is used to enter user-defined text and user-selected Modbus-registered data fields into the particular user
display. Each user display consists of two 20-character lines (top and bottom). The tilde (~) character is used to mark the
start of a data field – the length of the data field needs to be accounted for. Up to five separate data fields can be entered
in a user display – the nth tilde (~) refers to the nth item.
A user display can be entered from the front panel keypad or the EnerVista interface (preferred for convenience). The
following procedure shows how to enter text characters in the top and bottom lines from the front panel keypad. Press the
HELP key at any time for context sensitive help information.
1. Select the line to be edited.
2. Press the decimal key to enter text edit mode.
3. Use either VALUE key to scroll through the characters. A space is selected like a character.
4. Press the decimal key to advance the cursor to the next position.
5. Repeat step 3 and continue entering characters until the desired text is displayed.
6. Press the ENTER key to store the new settings.
To enter a numerical value for any of the five items (the decimal form of the selected Modbus address) from the front panel
keypad, use the number keypad. Use the value of “0” for any items not being used. Use the HELP key at any selected
system display (setting, actual value, or command) which has a Modbus address, to view the hexadecimal form of the
Modbus address, then manually convert it to decimal form before entering it (EnerVista usage conveniently facilitates this
conversion). See the Modbus Memory Map section earlier in this chapter for information on how to calculate the decimal
value to enter on the front panel.
Use the MENU key to go to the user displays menu to view the user-defined content. The current user displays show in
sequence, changing every four seconds. While viewing a user display, press the ENTER key and then select the ‘Yes” option
to remove the display from the user display list. Use the MENU key again to exit the user displays menu.
DISP 1 BOTTOM LINE: Shows user-defined text with second tilde marker
Current Y ~ A
If the parameters for the top line and the bottom line items have the same units, then the unit is displayed on the bottom
line only. The units are only displayed on both lines if the units specified both the top and bottom line items are different.
5.3.17.1 Menu
SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP DIRECT I/O
DIRECT I/O DIRECT OUTPUTS Range: 1 to 16 in steps of 1
DEVICE ID: 1
UNRETURNED
MESSAGES ALARM CH2
5
This option is available when an Inter-Relay Communications card is specified at the time of ordering. With the
option, direct inputs/outputs display by default. When you enable the teleprotection feature, direct I/O is not
visible.
Direct inputs and outputs exchange status information (inputs and outputs) between UR-series relays connected directly
via type 7 digital communications cards. The mechanism is very similar to IEC 61850 GOOSE, except that communications
takes place over a non-switchable isolated network and is optimized for speed. On type 7 cards that support two channels,
direct output messages are sent from both channels simultaneously. This effectively sends direct output messages both
ways around a ring configuration. On type 7 cards that support one channel, direct output messages are sent only in one
direction. Messages are resent (forwarded) when it is determined that the message did not originate at the receiver.
Direct Inputs and Outputs are initiated automatically and start running once at least one Direct Output in the given UR is
set to anything but Off.
For the direct I/Os to function properly, all UR devices sending I/Os using an Inter-Relay Communications card must have
identical firmware revisions.
Teleprotection inputs/outputs and direct inputs/outputs are mutually exclusive. As such, they cannot be used
simultaneously. Once teleprotection inputs and outputs are enabled, direct inputs and outputs are disabled, and
vice versa.
Direct output message timing is similar to GOOSE message timing. Integrity messages (with no state changes) are sent at
least every 1000 ms. Messages with state changes are sent within the main pass scanning the inputs and asserting the
outputs unless the communication channel bandwidth has been exceeded. Two self-tests are performed and signaled by
the following FlexLogic operands:
• DIRECT RING BREAK (direct input/output ring break) — Indicates that direct output messages sent from a UR-series relay
are not being received back by the relay
• DIRECT DEVICE 1 OFF to DIRECT DEVICE 16 OFF (direct device offline) — Indicate that direct output messages from at least
one direct device are not being received
Direct input and output settings are similar to remote input and output settings. The equivalent of the remote device name
strings for direct inputs and outputs is the DIRECT OUTPUT DEVICE ID setting, which identifies the relay in all direct output
messages. All UR-series IEDs in a ring need to have unique numbers assigned. The IED ID is used to identify the sender of
the direct input and output message.
If the direct input and output scheme is configured to operate in a ring (DIRECT I/O CH1 RING CONFIGURATION or DIRECT I/O
CH2 RING CONFIGURATION is “Yes”), all direct output messages are received back. If not, the direct input/output ring break
self-test is triggered. The self-test error is signaled by the DIRECT RING BREAK FlexLogic operand.
Select the DIRECT I/O DATA RATE to match the data capabilities of the communications channel. All IEDs communicating
over direct inputs and outputs must be set to the same data rate. UR-series IEDs equipped with dual-channel
communications cards apply the same data rate to both channels. Delivery time for direct input and output messages is
approximately 0.2 of a power system cycle at 128 kbps and 0.4 of a power system cycle at 64 kbps, per each "bridge."
Table 5-17: Direct input and output data rates
Module Supported data rates
2A, 2B 64 kbps
2E, 2F (legacy modules) 64 kbps
2G, 2H 128 kbps
2I, 2J 64 kbps, 128 kbps
72, 73 64 kbps, 128 kbps
74, 75 64 kbps
76, 77 64 kbps
7A, 7B, 7C, 7D 64 kbps, 128 kbps
7E, 7F, 7G 64 kbps
5 7H, 7I, 7J, 7K 64 kbps, 128 kbps
7L, 7M, 7N, 7P, 7Q 64 kbps
7R, 7S 64 kbps
7T, 7W 64 kbps
The G.703 modules are fixed at 64 kbps. The DIRECT I/O DATA RATE setting is not applicable to these modules.
The DIRECT I/O CHANNEL CROSSOVER setting applies to a M60 with dual-channel communication cards and allows crossing
over messages from channel 1 to channel 2. This places all UR-series IEDs into one direct input and output network
regardless of the physical media of the two communication channels.
The following application examples illustrate the basic concepts for direct input and output configuration. See the Inputs
and Outputs section in this chapter for information on configuring FlexLogic operands (flags, bits) to be exchanged.
Figure 5-60: Input and output extension via direct inputs and outputs
TX1
UR IED 1
RX1
TX1
UR IED 2
RX1
842711A1.CDR
85,(' %/2&.
($"'!"1!34B
For increased reliability, a dual-ring configuration (shown as follows) is recommended for this application.
Figure 5-62: Interlocking bus protection scheme via direct inputs/outputs
7; 5;
85,('
5; 7;
7; 5;
85,('
5; 7;
($"'!&1!34B
85,(' 85,('
85,(' ($"'!#1!34B
A permissive pilot-aided scheme can be implemented in a two-ring configuration, shown as follows (IEDs 1 and 2
constitute a first ring, while IEDs 2 and 3 constitute a second ring).
Figure 5-64: Single-channel open loop configuration
85,('
5; 5
7;
($"'!$1!34B
7; 5;
85,('
5; 7;
($"'!%1!34B
The M60 checks integrity of the incoming direct input and output messages using a 32-bit CRC. The CRC alarm function is
available for monitoring the communication medium noise by tracking the rate of messages failing the CRC check. The
monitoring function counts all incoming messages, including messages that failed the CRC check. A separate counter
adds up messages that failed the CRC check. When the failed CRC counter reaches the user-defined level specified by the
CRC ALARM CH1 THRESHOLD setting within the user-defined message count CRC ALARM 1 CH1 COUNT, the DIR IO CH1 CRC
ALARM FlexLogic operand is set.
When the total message counter reaches the user-defined maximum specified by the CRC ALARM CH1 MESSAGE COUNT
setting, both the counters reset and the monitoring process is restarted.
Configure the operand to drive an output contact, user-programmable LED, or selected communication-based output.
Latching and acknowledging conditions—if required—are programmed accordingly.
The CRC alarm function is available on a per-channel basis. The total number of direct input and output messages that
failed the CRC check is available as the ACTUAL VALUES STATUS DIRECT INPUTS CRC FAIL COUNT CH1 actual value.
• Message count and length of the monitoring window — To monitor communications integrity, the relay sends 1
message per second (at 64 kbps) or 2 messages per second (at 128 kbps) even if there is no change in the direct
outputs. For example, setting the CRC ALARM CH1 MESSAGE COUNT to “10000,” corresponds a time window of about 160
minutes at 64 kbps and 80 minutes at 128 kbps. If the messages are sent faster as a result of direct outputs activity,
the monitoring time interval shortens. Take this into account when determining the CRC ALARM CH1 MESSAGE COUNT
setting. For example, if the requirement is a maximum monitoring time interval of 10 minutes at 64 kbps, then the CRC
ALARM CH1 MESSAGE COUNT is set to 10 60 1 = 600.
• Correlation of failed CRC and bit error rate (BER) — The CRC check can fail if one or more bits in a packet are
corrupted. Therefore, an exact correlation between the CRC fail rate and the BER is not possible. Under certain
assumptions an approximation can be made as follows. A direct input and output packet containing 20 bytes results
in 160 bits of data being sent and therefore, a transmission of 63 packets is equivalent to 10,000 bits. A BER of 10–4
implies 1 bit error for every 10000 bits sent or received. Assuming the best case of only 1 bit error in a failed packet,
having 1 failed packet for every 63 received is about equal to a BER of 10–4.
The M60 checks integrity of the direct input and output communication ring by counting unreturned messages. In the ring
configuration, all messages originating at a given device should return within a pre-defined period of time. The unreturned
messages alarm function is available for monitoring the integrity of the communication ring by tracking the rate of
unreturned messages. This function counts all the outgoing messages and a separate counter adds the messages have
failed to return. When the unreturned messages counter reaches the user-definable level specified by the UNRET MSGS
ALARM CH1 THRESHOLD setting and within the user-defined message count UNRET MSGS ALARM CH1 COUNT, the DIR IO CH1
UNRET ALM FlexLogic operand is set.
When the total message counter reaches the user-defined maximum specified by the UNRET MSGS ALARM CH1 MESSAGE
COUNT setting, both the counters reset and the monitoring process is restarted.
Configure the operand to drive an output contact, user-programmable LED, or selected communication-based output.
Latching and acknowledging conditions, if required, are programmed accordingly.
The unreturned messages alarm function is available on a per-channel basis and is active only in the ring configuration.
The total number of unreturned input and output messages is available as the ACTUAL VALUES STATUS DIRECT INPUTS
UNRETURNED MSG COUNT CH1 actual value.
5.3.18 Teleprotection
SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP TELEPROTECTION
TELEPROTECTION TELEPROTECTION Range: Disabled, Enabled
FUNCTION: Disabled
This option is available when an Inter-Relay Communications card is specified at the time of ordering. With the
option, direct inputs/outputs display by default. When you enable the teleprotection feature, direct I/O is not
visible.
Digital teleprotection transfers protection commands between two or three relays in a secure, fast, dependable, and
deterministic way. Possible applications are permissive or blocking pilot schemes and direct transfer trip (DTT).
Teleprotection can be applied over any analog or digital channels and any communications media, such as direct fiber,
copper wires, optical networks, or microwave radio links. A mixture of communication media is possible.
Once teleprotection is enabled and the teleprotection input/outputs are configured, data packets are transmitted
continuously every 1/4 cycle (3/8 cycle if using C37.94 modules) from peer-to-peer. Security of communication channel
data is achieved by using CRC-32 on the data packet.
Teleprotection inputs/outputs and direct inputs/outputs are mutually exclusive. As such, they cannot be used
simultaneously. Once teleprotection inputs and outputs are enabled, direct inputs and outputs are blocked, and
vice versa.
5 NUMBER OF TERMINALS — Specifies whether the teleprotection system operates between two peers or three peers.
NUMBER OF CHANNELS — Specifies how many channels are used. If the NUMBER OF TERMINALS is “3” (three-terminal system),
set the NUMBER OF CHANNELS to “2.” For a two-terminal system, the NUMBER OF CHANNELS can set to “1” or “2” (redundant
channels).
LOCAL RELAY ID NUMBER, TERMINAL 1 RELAY ID NUMBER, and TERMINAL 2 RELAY ID NUMBER — In installations that use
multiplexers or modems, it is desirable to ensure that the data used by the relays protecting a given line is from the correct
relays. The teleprotection function performs this check by reading the message ID sent by transmitting relays and
comparing it to the programmed ID in the receiving relay. This check is also used to block inputs if inadvertently set to
loopback mode or data is being received from a wrong relay by checking the ID on a received channel. If an incorrect ID is
found on a channel during normal operation, the TELEPROT CH1 ID FAIL or TELEPROT CH2 ID FAIL FlexLogic operand is set,
driving the event with the same name and blocking the teleprotection inputs. For commissioning purposes, the result of
channel identification is also shown in the STATUS CHANNEL TESTS VALIDITY OF CHANNEL CONFIGURATION actual
value. The default value of “0” for the LOCAL RELAY ID NUMBER indicates that relay ID is not to be checked. On two- terminals
two-channel systems, the same LOCAL RELAY ID NUMBER is transmitted over both channels; as such, only the TERMINAL 1 ID
NUMBER has to be programmed on the receiving end.
5.3.19 Installation
SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP INSTALLATION
INSTALLATION RELAY SETTINGS: Range: Not Programmed, Programmed
Not Programmed
RELAY SETTINGS — To safeguard against the installation of a relay without any entered settings, the unit does not allow
signaling of any output relay until RELAY SETTINGS is set to "Programmed." This setting is "Not Programmed" by default. The
UNIT NOT PROGRAMMED self-test error message displays until the relay is put into the "Programmed" state.
RELAY NAME — This setting allows the user to uniquely identify a relay. This name appears on generated reports.
5
The remote resources settings configure a M60 with a Process Bus Module to work with HardFiber Bricks. Remote
resources configuration is only available through the EnerVista software, and is not available through the M60 front panel.
A Brick provides eight AC measurements, along with contact inputs, DC analog inputs, and contact outputs, to be the
remote interface to field equipment such as circuit breakers and transformers. The M60 with a Process Bus Module has
access to all of the capabilities of up to eight Bricks. Remote resources settings configure the point-to-point connection
between specific fiber optic ports on the M60 process card and specific Brick. The relay is then configured to measure
specific currents, voltages and contact inputs from those Bricks, and to control specific outputs.
The configuration process for remote resources is straightforward and consists of the following steps.
• Configure the field units. This establishes the point-to-point connection between a specific port on the relay Process
Bus Module, and a specific digital core on a specific Brick. This is a necessary first step in configuring a process bus
relay.
• Configure the AC banks. This sets the primary and secondary quantities and connections for currents and voltages. AC
bank configuration also provides a provision for redundant measurements for currents and voltages, a powerful
reliability improvement possible with process bus.
• Configure signal sources. This functionality of the M60 has not changed other than the requirement to use currents
and voltages established by AC bank configuration under the remote resources menu.
• Configure field contact inputs, field contact outputs, RTDs, and transducers as required for the application's
functionality. These inputs and outputs are the physical interface to circuit breakers, transformers, and other
equipment. They replace the traditional contact inputs and outputs located at the relay to virtually eliminate copper
wiring.
• Configure shared inputs and outputs as required for the application's functionality. Shared inputs and outputs are
distinct binary channels that provide high-speed protection quality signaling between relays through a Brick.
For additional information on how to configure a relay with a Process Bus Module, see the HardFiber Process Bus System
Instruction Manual.
PHASE CT F1 Range: 1 A, 5 A
SECONDARY: 1 A
GROUND CT F1 Range: 1 A, 5 A
SECONDARY: 1 A
Because energy parameters are accumulated, record these values and then reset immediately prior to changing CT
characteristics.
Four banks of phase and ground CTs can be set, where the current banks are denoted in the following format (X represents
the module slot position letter):
Xa, where X = {F, M} and a = {1, 5}
5 See the Introduction to AC Sources section at the beginning of this chapter for details.
These settings are critical for all features that have settings dependent on current measurements. When the relay is
ordered, the CT module must be specified to include a standard or sensitive ground input. As the phase CTs are connected
in wye (star), the calculated phasor sum of the three phase currents (IA + IB + IC = neutral current = 3I0) is used as the input
for the neutral overcurrent elements. In addition, a zero-sequence (core balance) CT which senses current in all of the
circuit primary conductors, or a CT in a neutral grounding conductor can also be used. For this configuration, the ground
CT primary rating must be entered. To detect low level ground fault currents, the sensitive ground input can be used. In this
case, the sensitive ground CT primary rating must be entered. See chapter 3 for more details on CT connections.
Enter the rated CT primary current values. For both 1000:5 and 1000:1 CTs, the entry would be 1000. For correct operation,
the CT secondary rating must match the setting (which must also correspond to the specific CT connections used).
The following example illustrates how multiple CT inputs (current banks) are summed as one source current. Given the
following current banks:
• F1: CT bank with 500:1 ratio
• F5: CT bank with 1000:1 ratio
• M1: CT bank with 800:1 ratio
The following rule applies:
SRC 1 = F1 + F5 + M1 Eq. 5-6
1 pu is the highest primary current. In this case, 1000 is entered and the secondary current from the 500:1 and 800:1 ratio
CTs are adjusted to that created by a 1000:1 CT before summation. If a protection element is set up to act on SRC 1
currents, then a pickup level of 1 pu operates on 1000 A primary.
The same rule applies for current sums from CTs with different secondary taps (5 A and 1 A).
Because energy parameters are accumulated, these values should be recorded and then reset immediately prior to
changing VT characteristics.
Two banks of phase/auxiliary VTs can be set, where voltage banks are denoted in the following format (X represents the
module slot position letter):
Xa, where X = {F, M} and a = {5}
See the Introduction to AC Sources section at the beginning of this chapter for details.
With VTs installed, the relay can perform voltage measurements as well as power calculations. Enter the PHASE VT F5
CONNECTION made to the system as “Wye” or “Delta.” An open-delta source VT connection is entered as “Delta.”
The nominal PHASE VT F5 SECONDARY voltage setting is the voltage across the relay input terminals when nominal
voltage is applied to the VT primary.
For example, on a system with a 13.8 kV nominal primary voltage and with a 14400:120 volt VT in a delta
connection, the secondary voltage is 115; that is, (13800 / 14400) × 120. For a wye connection, the voltage value
entered must be the phase to neutral voltage, which is 115 3 = 66.4.
5
On a 14.4 kV system with a delta connection and a VT primary to secondary turns ratio of 14400:120, the voltage
value entered is 120; that is, 14400 / 120.
NOMINAL FREQUENCY — The power system NOMINAL FREQUENCY value is used as a default to set the digital sampling rate if
the system frequency cannot be measured from available signals. This can happen if the signals are not present or are
heavily distorted. Before reverting to the nominal frequency, the frequency tracking algorithm holds the last valid
frequency measurement for a safe period of time while waiting for the signals to reappear or for the distortions to decay.
When using a Process Bus Module and SV streams, the SV streams need to be defaulted before changing this setting,
under Settings > Process Bus Module > SV Stream Config. After changing the NOMINAL FREQUENCY, restart the relay using
Maintenance > Reboot Relay Command.
PHASE ROTATION — The phase sequence of the power system is required to properly calculate sequence components and
power parameters. The PHASE ROTATION setting matches the power system phase sequence and informs the relay of the
actual system phase sequence, either ABC or ACB. CT and VT inputs on the relay, labeled as A, B, and C, must be connected
to system phases A, B, and C for correct operation.
FREQUENCY AND PHASE REFERENCE — This setting determines which signal source is used (and hence which AC signal) for
phase angle reference. The AC signal used is prioritized based on the AC inputs configured for the signal source. Phase
voltages takes precedence, followed by auxiliary voltage, then phase currents, and finally ground current.
For three phase selection, phase A is used for angle referencing (VANGLE REF = VA), while Clarke transformation of the phase
signals is used for frequency metering and tracking (VFREQUENCY = (2VA - VB - VC) / 3) for better performance during fault,
open pole, and VT and CT fail conditions.
The phase reference and frequency tracking AC signals are selected based upon the source configuration, regardless of
whether or not a particular signal is actually applied to the relay.
Phase angle of the reference signal always displays zero degrees and all other phase angles are relative to this signal. If
the pre-selected reference signal is not measurable at a given time, the phase angles are not referenced.
The phase angle referencing is done via a phase locked loop, which can synchronize independent UR-series relays if they
have the same AC signal reference. This results in very precise correlation of phase angle indications between different UR-
series relays.
FREQUENCY TRACKING — Set it to “Disabled” only in unusual circumstances; consult GE Grid Solutions for special variable-
frequency applications.
The frequency tracking feature functions only when the M60 is in the “Programmed” mode. If the M60 is “Not
Programmed,” then metering values are available but can exhibit significant errors.
5
5.5.3 Signal sources
SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP SIGNAL SOURCES SOURCE 1(4)
SOURCE 1 SOURCE 1 NAME: Range: up to 20 alphanumeric characters
SRC 1
SOURCE 1 PHASE CT: Range: None, F1,... up to any 6 CTs. Only Phase CT
None inputs are displayed.
SOURCE 1 GROUND CT: Range: None, F1,... up to any 6 CTs. Only Ground CT
None inputs are displayed.
Identical menus are available for each source. The "SRC 1" text can be replaced by with a user-defined name appropriate
for the associated source.
The first letter in the source identifier represents the module slot position. The number directly following this letter
represents either the first bank of four channels (1, 2, 3, 4) called “1” or the second bank of four channels (5, 6, 7, 8) called
“5” in a particular CT/VT module. See the Introduction to AC Sources section at the beginning of this chapter for details.
It is possible to select the sum of all CT combinations. The first channel displayed is the CT to which all others are referred.
For example, the selection “F1+F5” indicates the sum of each phase from channels “F1” and “F5,” scaled to whichever CT
has the higher ratio. Selecting “None” hides the associated actual values.
The approach used to configure the AC sources consists of several steps; first step is to specify the information about each
CT and VT input. For CT inputs, this is the nominal primary and secondary current. For VTs, this is the connection type, ratio
and nominal secondary voltage. Once the inputs have been specified, the configuration for each source is entered,
including specifying which CTs are summed together.
SETTING
ACTUAL
PRODUCT SETUP/DISPLAY
SOURCE 2 PROPERTIES/CURRENT
CURRENT PHASOR CUT-OFF LEVEL
I_1 I_1 - I_1’ >2*CUT-OFF FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
I_2 I_2 - I_2’ >2*CUT-OFF OR SRC 2 50DD OP
I_0 I_0 - I_0’ >2*CUT-OFF
Where I’ is 2 cycles old
SETTING
ACTUAL
PRODUCT SETUP/DISPLAY
SOURCE 6 PROPERTIES/CURRENT
CURRENT PHASOR CUT-OFF LEVEL
I_1 I_1 - I_1’ >2*CUT-OFF FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
I_2 I_2 - I_2’ >2*CUT-OFF OR SRC 6 50DD OP
I_0 I_0 - I_0’ >2*CUT-OFF
The disturbance detector responds to the change in currents of twice the current cut-off level. The default cut-off threshold
is 0.02 pu; thus by default the disturbance detector responds to a change of 0.04 pu. The metering sensitivity setting
(PRODUCT SETUP DISPLAY PROPERTIES CURRENT CUT-OFF LEVEL) controls the sensitivity of the disturbance detector
accordingly.
This configuration can be used on a two-winding transformer, with one winding connected into a breaker-and-a-half
system. The following figure shows the arrangement of sources used to provide the functions required in this application,
and the CT/VT inputs that are used to provide the data.
F1 DSP Bank
F5
Source 1 Source 2
Amps Amps
Source 3
51BF-1 51BF-2
U1 Volts Amps
A W Var 87T
A W Var 51P
Volts Amps
M1
M1 Source 4
5
UR Relay
M5
827794A1.CDR
Y LV D HV AUX
SRC 1 SRC 2 SRC 3
Phase CT M1 F1+F5 None
Ground CT M1 None None
Phase VT M5 None None
Aux VT None None U1
Figure 5-69: Examples of VTs (a) and CTs (b) switching from the main to alternate
CT 1 CT 2
CT 1 UR UR
a) b)
859791A1.vsdx
This figure depicts examples of VT switching from VT1 to VT2 when Bus 1 is de-energized, and the line is energized via Bus
2. CT switching example (b) depicts connecting bus transfer breaker CT to the line relay when main line breaker is taken for
maintenance and the line is energized via transfer bus, in this case the UR senses current from either CT 1 when line is
energized via main line breaker or via CT 2 when the line is energized via transfer bus breaker.
Figure 5-70: Logic diagram of switching CTs and VTs from the main to alternate banks
SETTINGS SETTINGS
5 None
None None
To SOURCE 1 To SOURCE 1
SRC 1 ALT PHASE CT: currents phasor SRC 1 ALT PHASE VT: voltage phasor
calculations calculations
None None
None None
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SRC1 CT ALT BANK ON
SRC1 VT ALT BANK ON
859825A1.vsdx
When a FlexLogic operand assigned to SRC 1 SWITCH ALT CT/VT is logical "0," the analog data is processed from the main CT
and VT analog data banks. When this operand is logical "1," the analog data is processed from the alternate CT and VT
analog data banks.
Note that
• Banks assigned to the same function for the main and alternate input data have to have the same CTs and VTs
nominals and connections, otherwise a warning is generated and switching functionality is prohibited. For example,
banks assigned to the PHASE CT and ALT PHASE CT have to have same primary and secondary CT values. Ground CT
input has to be same type (cannot be one regular and another sensitive ground CT input).
• During switching from the main CT/VT input data to alternate input data and vice versa, all relay functions are blocked
for two power cycles and metering data does not update
• CT bank switching is allowed if both main and alternate CT banks have the exact same combination for CTs
summation
• When it is required that switching state from the main to alternate be memorized in case of M60 restart or when the
switching signal is a pulse by nature, such as a pushbutton or IEC 61850 GOOSE, use Non-volatile Latches
• Since switching occurs in both the Phase and Ground CT (Phase and Aux VT), it is possible to keep the same set, for
example phase bank under both the main source and alternate source, but different set for ground/aux signal
5.5.4 Motor
SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP MOTOR
MOTOR MOTOR FULL LOAD AMPS Range: 0.050 to 1.000 pu in steps of 0.001
(FLA): 1.000 pu
2-SPEED MOTOR
PROTECTION: Disabled
Range: Disabled, Enabled 5
SPEED2 MOTOR SWITCH: Range: FlexLogic operand
Off
These settings reflect the design and configuration of the motor that the relay protects. Some protection elements depend
on these settings for correct operation.
Prior to revision 5.40, RTDs used for motor stator thermal model were defined in this section. With revisions 5.40 and higher,
RTDs are defined in the SETTINGS TRANSDUCER I/O RTD INPUTS menu.
MOTOR FULL LOAD AMPS — This setting represents the full load current (FLA) of the motor as a fraction of the CT primary
rating. FLA is a standard motor parameter that can be found on the motor nameplate.
MOTOR OVERLOAD FACTOR — This setting defines the current level at which the motor is considered to be overloaded. If the
motor current exceeds the MOTOR OVERLOAD FACTOR threshold, the M60 thermal model reacts by accumulating thermal
capacity. Normally, this factor is set slightly above the motor service factor to account for inherent load measuring errors
(CTs and limited relay accuracy). The typical total inaccuracy factor is 8 to 10%; as such, for motors with a thermal
capability at rated service factor of 1 or 1.15, set the MOTOR OVERLOAD FACTOR to 1.1 or 1.25, respectively.
If the average load current is between full load and the overload factor, the thermal capacity remains constant. If the
average current is less than the full load current, the thermal capacity decays exponentially.
MOTOR NAMEPLATE VOLTAGE — This setting represents the rated phase-to-phase motor voltage. It is used as a reference for
the voltage dependant thermal overload curve feature and indicates a 100% voltage starting condition.
MOTOR OFFLINE — This input must be connected to the appropriate external contact. This setting is selected to a contact
input that is connected to an auxiliary contact of the breaker or contactor used to switch the motor. The motor is declared
to be stopped when the phase current falls below 2% of motor full load current (FLA) and the external contact indicates the
switching device is open.
For example, a circuit breaker 52b auxiliary contact is closed when the breaker is open and open when the breaker is
closed. Therefore the setting is "Cont Ip n On." For a 52a contact, the setting is "Cont Ip n Off."
Four mutually exclusive FlexLogic operands that reflect the motor state are generated by a state machine in the relay to
determine motor status. They are MOTOR OFFLINE, MOTOR STARTING, MOTOR RUNNING, and MOTOR OVERLOAD.
The state machine initially sets the MOTOR OFFLINE operand, as the auxiliary contact reports the switching device is open
and motor current is less than 2% of FLA. If the previous motor status is offline, a phase current greater than 2% of FLA is
detected, and the MOTOR OFFLINE operand de-asserts, then the MOTOR STARTING operand becomes true. After one second, if
motor current is less than FLA times the MOTOR OVERLOAD FACTOR setting, the MOTOR RUNNING operand is set (this accounts
for the use of a soft-starter mechanism that slowly increases current such that it never exceeds FLA overload factor
during a starting sequence). For normal starting, the MOTOR STARTING operand remains set until the current falls below FLA
overload factor, at which time the MOTOR RUNNING operand is set. If current rises above FLA Service Factor at that point,
the MOTOR OVERLOAD operand is set. If current then falls below FLA overload factor, the MOTOR OVERLOAD operand is reset
and the MOTOR RUNNING operand is set. A MOTOR OFFLINE state is determined per the logic noted.
When two-speed motor functionality is employed, this setting is used to indicate the breaker or contactor position at
speed 1. As such, the speed 1 auxiliary contact is connected to the input specified by this setting for two-speed
applications.
EMERGENCY RESTART — As the name implies, this feature i s only used in an emergency, as it defeats the purpose of the
relay—protecting the motor. The input selected by this setting is used to reset the motor thermal capacity used from its
current value to 0% so that a hot motor can be restarted. However, trip conditions that are still present (for example, hot
RTD) still cause a trip. In the event of a real emergency, the EMERGENCY RESTART operand should remain at logic 1 until the
5 emergency is over. Any EMERGENCY RESTART operand transition is logged as an event.
MOTOR LINE SOURCE — This setting selects the source connected to phase current transformers on the power system side
of the stator winding.
NUMBER OF STARTS TO LEARN — This setting selects number of motor start and stop records to average data presented in
the ACTUAL VALUES RECORDS MOTOR LEARNED DATA menu.
MOTOR LOAD AVERAGE CALC. PERIOD — This setting specifies the period of time over which parameter averages are
calculated. The calculation is a sliding window.
2-SPEED MOTOR PROTECTION — This setting enables/disables the two-speed motor function. This function provides proper
protection for a two-speed motor where there are two different full load values. The two-speed functionality is required for
motors having two windings wound into one stator. One winding, when energized, provides one of the speeds. When the
second winding is energized, the motor takes on the speed determined by the second winding. The M60 algorithm
integrates the heating at each speed into one thermal model using a common thermal capacity used register value for
both speeds. Using the M60 for such applications provides several options, allowing the removal of traditional wiring and
interlocking:
• Use the M60 front panel pushbuttons and provide necessary operate and interlock logic via FlexLogic
• Use external pushbuttons and provide necessary operate and interlock logic using FlexLogic shown as follows
• Use a traditional external control schematic with some connections to the M60 for control and protection
SPEED2 MOTOR SWITCH — If the two-speed motor feature is used, this setting specifies a FlexLogic operand to indicate the
current motor speed. This is typically an indication that the contactor at speed 2 is energized. When the assigned FlexLogic
operand (typically a contact input operand) is asserted, the algorithm switches to speed 2 (high speed). If the assigned
FlexLogic operand is de-asserted, the algorithm switches to speed 1 (low speed). This allows the M60 to determine which
settings are to be active at any given time. To maintain correct motor status indication, the M60 expects a transition from
speed 1 to speed 2 within two seconds; otherwise, the motor status value can be reset.
SPEED2 SWITCH 2-1 DELAY — This setting specifies the time delay to transfer from high to low speed. This allows the motor
to slow down before energizing at low speed.
SPEED2 MOTOR SOURCE — This setting selects source for a motor protection when two-speed motor functionality is used.
This can be separate voltage and current banks or one voltage and current bank one with different full load current value
at the second speed (entered in the SPEED2 MOTOR FLA setting). If separate CTs with different ratios or secondary currents
are required for speed 2, then order the relay with two CT banks.
SPEED2 MOTOR FLA — This setting specifies the motor full load current for speed 2.
H T2
L2 L
H
L3 L T3
MOTOR
H T4
H T5
H T6
CT bank 1 CT bank 2
Contact
outputs
H
L
STOP
M60 protection
Contact inputs
LOW
and logic
HIGH
H
L
833723A1.CDR
5
5.5.5 Breakers
SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP BREAKERS COMMON SETTINGS
COMMON SETTINGS BKR INTERM & BAD ST Range: Common, Distinct
TIMERS: Common
5 BREAKER 1 OPEN
SEAL-IN: 0.000 s
Range: 0.000 to 65.535 s in steps of 0.001
The breaker control element contains the auxiliary logic for status and serves as the interface for opening and closing of a
circuit breaker from protection, autoreclose, SCADA, or through the front panel interface. The breaker control element can
be used to create interlocking functionality. For greater security in determination of the breaker position, both the 52/a
and 52/b auxiliary contacts are used with reporting of the discrepancy between them.
To use this element, configure the contact outputs that trip and close the breaker to use FlexLogic operands BREAKER 1 OFF
CMD (or BREAKER 1 TRIP A/B/C in the case of single-pole tripping) and BREAKER 1 ON CMD, and configure the breaker control
element inputs as described here.
A description of the operation of the breaker control and status monitoring features from the front panel is provided in
chapter 4.
BKR INTERM & BAD ST TIMERS — When set to "Common," the breaker element considers both "00" and "11" states of 52a and
52b as an intermediate state and when the Toperate timer expires, declares the breaker as bad status. When set to
"Distinct," the breaker element considers "00" state of 52a and 52b as an intermediate state and "11" as bad status. When
the breaker status detected is 00, the breaker element waits for the Toperate timer to expire before declaring the
intermediate state. When the breaker status detected is 11, the breaker element waits for the Bad ST Tsuppress timer to
expire before declaring the bad state. See breaker logic diagrams 2 and 4.
The following settings are available for each breaker control element.
BREAKER 1 FUNCTION — This setting enables and disables the operation of the breaker 1 control feature.
BREAKER 1 NAME — Assign a user-defined name (up to six characters) to the breaker. This name is used in flash messages
related to breaker 1.
BREAKER 1 MODE — Selects “3-Pole” mode, where all breaker poles are operated simultaneously, or selects “1-Pole” mode
where all breaker poles are operated either independently or simultaneously.
BREAKER1 A/3P OPND — Selects an operand, usually a contact input, that is for a normally-closed 52/b status input that
creates a logic 1 when the breaker is open. If a separate 52/b contact input is not available, then the inverted 52/a status
signal or the inverted BREAKER 1 CLOSED status signal can be used. 5
BREAKER1 A/3P CLSD — Selects an operand, usually a contact input connected to a breaker auxiliary position tracking
mechanism. This input is for a normally-open 52/a status input that creates a logic 1 when the breaker is closed. If the
BREAKER 1 MODE setting is selected as "3-Pole," this setting selects a single 52/a input as the operand used to track the
breaker open or closed position. If the mode is selected as "1-Pole," the input mentioned is used to track phase A and the
BREAKER 1 B and BREAKER 1 C settings select operands to track phases B and C, respectively.
BREAKER1 B OPENED — If the mode is selected as three-pole, this setting has no function. If the mode is selected as single-
pole, this input is used to track the breaker phase B opened position as outlined for phase A.
BREAKER1 B CLOSED — If the mode is selected as three-pole, this setting has no function. If the mode is selected as single-
pole, this input is used to track the breaker phase B closed position as outlined for phase A.
BREAKER1 C OPENED — If the mode is selected as three-pole, this setting has no function. If the mode is selected as single-
pole, this input is used to track the breaker phase C opened position as outlined for phase A.
BREAKER1 C CLOSED — If the mode is selected as three-pole, this setting has no function. If the mode is selected as single-
pole, this input is used to track the breaker phase C closed position as outlined for phase A.
BREAKER 1 ALARM DELAY — This setting specifies the delay interval during which a disagreement of status among the pole
position tracking operands does not declare a pole disagreement. This allows for non-simultaneous operation of the poles.
If single-pole tripping and reclosing is used, the breaker can trip unsymmetrically for faults. In this case, the minimum
alarm delay setting must exceed the maximum time required for fault clearing and reclosing by a suitable margin.
BREAKER 1 EXT ALARM — This setting selects an operand, usually an external contact input connected to a breaker alarm
reporting contact. While the selected operand is active, the BREAKER 1 TROUBLE operand is activated.
BREAKER 1 RACKED-IN — This setting selects a contact input to show whether the breaker is racked-in or racked-out. The
racked-in or racked-out status is used to indicate dynamically the status of breaker symbol, only applied in the single-line
diagram on the graphical front panel. If this setting is set to Off, the racked status is not considered.
BREAKER 1 OUT OF SV — Selects an operand indicating that breaker 1 is out-of-service.
BREAKER 1 OPEN — Selects an operand that when activated, and unless blocked, initiates the Breaker 1 open and individual
phase trip commands.
BREAKER 1 CLOSE — Selects an operand that when activated, and unless blocked, initiates the Breaker 1 close commands.
BREAKER 1 PB CONTROL — Local breaker control operations (that is, open/close) are allowed from front panel pushbuttons
when the selected operand value is high.
BREAKER 1 TOPERATE — This setting specifies the required interval to overcome transient disagreement between the 52/a
and 52/b auxiliary contacts during breaker operation. If transient disagreement still exists after this time has expired, the
BREAKER 1 BAD STATUS FlexLogic operand is asserted for alarm or blocking purposes.
BREAKER 1 BAD ST TSUPPRESS — When the BKR INTERM & BAD ST TIMERS setting is set to "Distinct," this setting specifies the
required interval to overcome the transient state of 11 during the breaker operation. If the 11 state still exists after this
time, the BREAKER 1 BAD STATUS FlexLogic operand is asserted. When the BKR INTERM & BAD ST TIMERS setting is set to
"Common," this setting is not used.
MANUAL CLOSE RECAL1 TIME — This setting specifies the seal-in time of the close commands due to an operator-initiated
manual close command to the circuit breaker.
BREAKER 1 OPEN SEAL-IN — This setting specifies the seal-in time of the three-pole open command initiated by either the
Trip Out element or a manual open command to the circuit breaker.
BREAKER 1 BLK OPEN — Selects an operand that prevents initiation of Breaker 1 open and individual phase trip commands.
This setting can be used for blocking circuit breaker tripping for instance when breaker monitoring detects conditions such
as low SF6 gas density during which breaker opening can cause damage.
BREAKER 1 BLK CLOSE — Selects an operand that prevents initiation of Breaker 1 close commands. This setting can be used
for blocking circuit breaker closing, for instance to prevent closing into a closed ground switch.
BREAKER 1 BYPASS — Set to "Enable" to allow the graphical front panel to bypass breaker 1 interlocking. When asserted,
BREAKER 1 BLK OPEN and BREAKER 1 BLK CLOSE settings are bypassed.
BREAKER 1 TAGGING — Breaker tagging is used to block certain operation when it is tagged for safety purposes. No other
5 action is needed after enabling the function; it is handled internally where certain functions are blocked.
Set to "Enable No Override" to allow the graphical front panel or IEC 61850 MMS control to tag breaker 1. When tagged
from the graphical front panel, tagging can be removed only from the graphical front panel, and an attempt to remove
tagging using IEC 61850 MMS control results in a negative response (-Rsp). When tagged from IEC 61850 MMS control,
tagging can be removed only by MMS control.
Set to "Enable With Override" to allow the graphical front panel or IEC 61850 MMS control to tag breaker 1. When tagged
from the graphical front panel, tagging can be removed only from the graphical front panel, and an attempt to remove
tagging using IEC 61850 MMS control results in a negative response (-Rsp). When tagged from IEC 61850 MMS control,
tagging can be removed by MMS control or from the graphical front panel. That is, the graphical front panel has an
override function.
When tagged, the following operations are disabled: pushbutton open/close, IEC 61850 open/close, and close command
initiated by BREAKER 1 CLOSE setting. The trip command issued by the Trip Out element or BREAKER 1 OPEN setting is not
affected.
BREAKER1 SUBSTITUTN — Set to "Enable" to allow the graphical front panel/IEC 61850 to substitute breaker 1 status. When
substituted, breaker 1 control open/close status is forced to the substituted value.
BREAKER 1 LOCAL — Set in the EnerVista software or via SCL file. It selects an operand that indicates the Breaker control
behavior from an IEC 61850 client. When the operand value is set, it indicates the Breaker in Local mode and the remote
commands from IEC 61850 client are blocked.
BREAKER 1 INTERLOCK OPEN — Set in the EnerVista software or via SCL file. It selects an operand that indicates the Breaker
interlock status for "Open/off" command from an IEC 61850 client. When the operand value is set (BkrCILO1.EnaOpn.stVal
is set to false), the "Open/off" command from the IEC 61850 client is rejected, if the client set the interlock-check bit in the
"Check" parameter of the control command.
BREAKER 1 INTERLOCK CLOSE — Set in the EnerVista software or via SCL file. It selects an operand that indicates the Breaker
interlock status for "Close/on" command from an IEC 61850 client. When the operand value is set (BkrCILO1.EnaCls.stVal is
set to false), the "Close/on" command from IEC 61850 client is rejected, if the client set the interlock-check bit in the "Check"
parameter of the control command.
BREAKER 1 SYNCCHECK CLS - Set in the EnerVista software or via SCL file. It selects an operand that indicates the status of
the synchrocheck function of the Breaker. When the operand value is set, the remote commands from IEC 61850 client are
rejected, if the IEC61850 client set the synchrocheck bit in the "Check" parameter of the control command.
BREAKER 1 POS-REACHED CHECK — Set in the EnerVista software. When Enabled, the IEC 61850 control value is checked for
current Breaker status and is rejected if the command value (Open/Close) from IEC 61850 client match with the present
Breaker status. When Disabled, the current Breaker status is not verified to accept the control.
IEC 61850 functionality is permitted when the M60 device is in "Programmed" mode and not in local control mode.
SE TTING
BRE AKER 1 PUSHBU TTON
CONTROL =Off AND
US ER 3 OFF/ON
To ope n BKR1-(name) BkrCS WI1.OpOpn.general
OR
Breaker 1 Open
From graphical front panel
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SE TTING (on 61850 page )
AND BRE AKER 1 M NL OPEN
BKR1 S T.LOC OPE RAND OR
= Off AND
BkroXCBR1.Pos.ctlVal = off
OR FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
BkrCS WI1.Pos.ctlVal = off
AND OR AND BRE AKER 1 OFF CMD
From IEC 61850 protocol
SETTING
SE TTING BRE AKER 1 OPEN SEAL-IN
BRE AKER 1 OPEN T P KP
= Off 0 FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AND
OR AND BRE AKER 1 TRIP A
5
BkrCS WI1.BlkOpn.ctlVal = on OR
AND
SE TTING OR Bkr0XCBR1.BlkOpn.stVal
BRE AKER 1 BLK OPE N
= Off
BkrCS WI1.BlkOpn.stVal
FLE XLOGIC OPERAND AND To 61850 protocol
BRE AKER 1 BYPAS S ON
SE TTI NG
SE TTING
MANUAL CLOSE RECAL1 TIME AND
BRE AKER 1 CLOS E
AND T P KP
= Off
0 BkrCS WI1.OpCls.ge neral
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND OR AND BRE AKER 1 ON CMD
BRE AKER 1 ENA RCLS AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
BRE AKER 1 SU BD CLSD
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
BRE AKER 1 SU BD OPEN BKR1 A CLOS ED AND BRE AKER 1 ΦA CLS D
AND
SETTING
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
BRE AKER 1 ΦA/3P CLSD
OR BKR1 A OPENED AND BRE AKER 1 ΦA OPEN
= Off AND
AND
SETTING FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
BRE AKER 1 ΦA/3P OPND SETTING AND BRE AKER 1 ΦA INTERM
OR AND
= Off AND BRE AKER 1 TOPERATE FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OR T P KP BRE AKER 1 ΦA BAD S T
AND
AND 0
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
BKR1 B CLOS ED AND BRE AKER 1 ΦB CLS D
AND
SETTING
BRE AKER 1 ΦB CLS D FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OR BKR1 B OPENED AND BRE AKER 1 ΦB OPEN
= Off AND
AND
SETTING
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
BRE AKER 1 ΦB OPENE D
OR AND AND BRE AKER 1 ΦB INTERM
= Off AND
OR SETTING
BRE AKER 1 TOPERATE FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AND AND BRE AKER 1 ΦB BAD S T
T P KP
0
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
BKR1 C CLOS ED AND BRE AKER 1 ΦC CLS D
AND
SETTING
BRE AKER 1 ΦC CLS D FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OR BKR1 C OPENED AND BRE AKER 1 ΦC OPEN
= Off AND
5
AND
SETTING
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
BRE AKER 1 ΦC OPENE D AND
OR AND BRE AKER 1 ΦC INTERM
= Off AND
OR SETTING
BRE AKER 1 TOPERATE FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AND AND BRE AKER 1 ΦC BAD ST
T P KP
0
SETTING
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
BRE AKER 1 EXT ALARM
AND BRE AKER 1 TROU BLE
= Off OR
AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
BKR1 A CLOS ED AND BRE AKER 1 ANY P OPEN
BKR1 B CLOS ED AND
BKR1 C CLOS ED
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AND BRE AKER 1 1P OPEN
XOR
SETTING
BRE AKER 1 OUT OF S V FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
= Off AND BRE AKER 1 OOS
Enable
to shee t 3
859814A1.vsdx
Figure 5-74: Dual breaker / graphical front panel control logic (Sheet 3 of 4)
from sheet 1 from sheet 1
CSWI cmd BKR 1
SETTING Blk LOCAL
BRE AKER 1 TAGG ING
= Enable No Override OR
= Enable with Override
from sheet 2
AND Enable
BkrCS WI1.TagOn.ctlVal=On AND
OR
Bkr0XCBR1.TagOn.ctlVal=On Non-volatile,
OR Reset-dominant
Breaker 1 Tag S FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
From graphical front panel Latch BRE AKER 1 TAG ON
AND BRE AKER 1 TAG OFF
OR R
OR
AND
Breaker 1 Remove Tag
OR
BkrCS WI1.TagOn.ctlVal=Off AND
AND
OR
Bkr0XCBR1.TagOn.ctlVal=Off
SETTING
BRE AKER 1 SU BSTITUTN
Non-volatile,
= Enabled
Reset-dominant
Breaker 1 Substitute Open S FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Latch BRE AKER 1 SU BD OPEN
Breaker 1 Remove Substitution
OR R
From graphical front panel
SETTING
BRE AKER 1 BYPAS S
= E nabled Non-volatile,
5
Reset-dominant
Breaker 1 Bypass S FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Breaker 1 Remove Bypass
Latch BRE AKER 1 BYPAS S ON
From graphical front panel OR R BRE AKER 1 BYPAS S OFF
859827A1.vsdx
The breaker element has direct hard-coded connections to the IEC 61850 model as shown in the logic diagram. This allows
remote open/close operation of each breaker, using either CSWI or XCBR IEC 61850 logical nodes. IEC 61850 select-before-
operate functionality, local/remote switch functionality, along with blocking of open/close commands are provided. Note
that the dwell time for the IEC 61850 trip and close commands shown is one protection pass only. To maintain the close/
open command for a certain time, do so by setting the seal-in timers BREAKER 1 OPEN SEAL-IN and MANUAL CLOSE RECAL1
TIME, on the contact outputs using the "Seal-in" setting, in the Trip Output element, and/or in FlexLogic.
SETTING
BRE AKER1 BAD ST
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
TSU PPRESS
T P KP AND BRE AKER 1 ΦA BAD ST
AND 0
SETTING
BRE AKER 1 TOPERATE FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AND T P KP AND BRE AKER 1 ΦA INTERM
0
1-Pole Enable
Where Θ is B and C
859815A1.vsdx
5 SWITCH 1 SUBSTITUTN:
Disabled
Range: Disabled, Enabled
The disconnect switch control element contains the auxiliary logic for status and serves as the interface for opening and
closing of disconnect switches from SCADA or through the front panel interface. The disconnect switch control element
can be used to create interlocking functionality. For greater security in determination of the switch pole position, both the
89/a and 89/b auxiliary contacts are used with reporting of the discrepancy between them.
To use this element, configure the contact outputs that open and close the disconnect switch to use FlexLogic operands
SWITCH 1 OFF CMD and SWITCH 1 ON CMD, and configure the disconnect switch control element's inputs as outlined here.
SW INTERM & BAD ST TIMERS — When set to "Common," the switch element considers both "00" and "11" states of 89/a and
89/b as intermediate state and when the Topearte timer expires, declares the switch as bad status. When set to "Distinct,"
the switch element considers "00" state of 89/a and 89/b as intermediate state and "11" as bad status. When the switch
status detected is 00, the switch element waits for Toperate timer to expire before declaring the intermediate state. When
the switch status detected is 11, the switch element waits for Bad ST Tsuppress timer to expire before declaring the bad
state. See the switch logic diagrams 2 and 4.
SWITCH 1 FUNCTION — This setting enables and disables operation of the disconnect switch element.
SWITCH 1 NAME — Assign a user-defined name (up to six characters) to the disconnect switch. This name is used in flash
messages related to disconnect switch 1.
SWITCH 1 MODE — This setting selects “3-Pole” mode, where disconnect switch poles have a single common auxiliary
switch, or “1-Pole” mode where each disconnect switch pole has its own auxiliary switch.
SWTCH 1 A/3P OPND — This setting selects an operand, usually a contact input, that is for a normally-closed 89/b status
input that creates a logic 1 when the disconnect switch is open. If a separate 89/b contact input is not available, then an
inverted 89/a status signal can be used.
SWTCH 1A/3P CLSD — This setting selects an operand, usually a contact input connected to a disconnect switch auxiliary
position tracking mechanism. This input is for a normally-open 89/a status input that creates a logic 1 when the
disconnect switch is closed. If the SWITCH 1 MODE setting is selected as “3-Pole,” this setting selects a single 89/a input as
the operand used to track the disconnect switch open or closed position. If the mode is selected as “1-Pole,” the input
mentioned is used to track phase A and the SWITCH 1 B and SWITCH 1 C settings select operands to track phases B and
C, respectively.
SWITCH 1 B OPENED — If the mode is selected as three-pole, this setting has no function. If the mode is selected as single-
pole, this input is used to track the disconnect switch phase B opened position as outlined for phase A.
SWITCH 1 B CLOSED — If the mode is selected as three-pole, this setting has no function. If the mode is selected as single-
pole, this input is used to track the disconnect switch phase B closed position as outlined for phase A.
SWITCH 1 C OPENED — If the mode is selected as three-pole, this setting has no function. If the mode is selected as single-
pole, this input is used to track the disconnect switch phase C opened position as outlined for phase A.
SWITCH 1 C CLOSED — If the mode is selected as three-pole, this setting has no function. If the mode is selected as single-
pole, this input is used to track the disconnect switch phase C closed position as outlined for phase A.
SWITCH 1 ALARM DELAY — This setting specifies the delay interval during which a disagreement of status among the pole
position tracking operands do not declare a pole disagreement. This allows for non-simultaneous operation of the poles.
SWITCH 1 OPEN — This setting selects an operand that when activated, and unless blocked, initiates the disconnect switch 1
open command.
SWITCH 1 CLOSE — This setting selects an operand that when activated, and unless blocked, initiates the disconnect switch
5
1 close command.
SWITCH 1 PB CONTROL — Local disconnect switch control operations (for example, open/close) are allowed from front panel
pushbuttons when the selected FlexLogic operand value is high.
SWITCH 1 TOPERATE — This setting specifies the required interval to overcome transient disagreement between the 89/a
and 89/b auxiliary contacts during disconnect switch operation. If transient disagreement still exists after this time has
expired, the SWITCH 1 BAD STATUS FlexLogic operand is asserted for alarm or blocking purposes.
SWITCH 1 BAD ST TSUPPRESS — When the SW INTERM & BAD ST TIMERS setting is set to "Distinct," this setting specifies the
required interval to overcome the transient state of 11 during the switch operation. If the 11 state still exists after this time,
the SWITCH 1 BAD STATUS FlexLogic operand is asserted. When the SW INTERM & BAD ST TIMERS setting is set to "Common,"
this setting is not used.
SWITCH 1 OPEN SEAL-IN — This setting specifies the seal-in time of the open command due to an operator-initiated manual
open command to the disconnect switch.
SWITCH 1 CLOSE SEAL IN — This setting specifies the seal-in time of the close command due to an operator-initiated manual
close command to the disconnect switch.
SWITCH 1 BLK OPEN — This setting selects an operand that prevents initiation of the disconnect switch 1 command. This
setting can be used to block the disconnect switch from opening, for instance when switchyard monitoring indicates that
current exceeding the switch's interrupting rating can be flowing through the switch.
SWITCH 1 BLK CLOSE — This setting selects an operand that prevents initiation of disconnect switch 1 close commands. This
setting can be used to block the disconnect switch from closing, for instance to prevent closing into a closed ground
switch.
SWITCH 1 BYPASS —Set to "Enable" to allow the graphical front panel to bypass switch 1 interlocking. When asserted,
SWITCH 1 BLK OPEN and SWITCH 1 BLK CLOSE settings are bypassed.
SWITCH 1 TAGGING — Switch tagging is used to block certain operation when it is tagged for safety purposes. No other
action is needed after enabling the function; it is handled internally where certain functions are blocked.
Set to "Enable No Override" to allow the graphical front panel or IEC 61850 MMS control to tag switch 1. When tagged from
the graphical front panel, tagging can be removed only from the graphical front panel, and an attempt to remove tagging
using IEC 61850 MMS control results in a negative response (-Rsp). When tagged using IEC 61850 MMS control, tagging can
be removed only by MMS control.
Set to "Enable With Override" to allow the graphical front panel or IEC 61850 MMS control to tag switch 1. When tagged
from the graphical front panel, tagging can be removed only from the graphical front panel, and an attempt to remove
tagging using IEC 61850 MMS control results in a negative response (-Rsp). When tagged from IEC 61850 MMS control,
tagging can be removed by MMS control or from the graphical front panel. That is, the graphical front panel has an
override function.
When tagged, the following operations are disabled:
• Pushbutton open/close
• IEC 61850 open/close
• Open command initiated by SWITCH 1 OPEN setting
• Close command initiated by SWITCH 1 CLOSE setting
SWITCH 1 SUBSTITUTN — Set to "Enable" to allow the graphical front panel to substitute switch 1 status. When substituted,
switch 1 control open/close status is forced to the substituted value.
SWITCH 1 LOCAL — Set in the EnerVista software or via SCL file. It selects an operand that indicates the Switch control
behavior from an IEC 61850 client. When the operand value is set, it indicates the Switch in Local mode and the remote
commands from IEC 61850 client are blocked.
SWITCH 1 INTERLOCK OPEN — Set in the EnerVista software or via SCL file. It selects an operand that indicates the Switch
interlock status for "Open/off" command from an IEC 61850 client. When the operand value is set (DiscCILO1.EnaOpn.stVal
is set to false), the "Open/off" command from the IEC 61850 client is rejected, if the client set the interlock-check bit in the
"Check" parameter of the control command.
5 SWITCH 1 INTERLOCK CLOSE — Set in the EnerVista software or via SCL file. It selects an operand that indicates the Switch
interlock status for "Close/on" command from an IEC 61850 client. When the operand value is set (DiscCILO1.EnaCls.stVal is
set to false), the "Close/on" command from IEC 61850 client is rejected, if the client set the interlock-check bit in the "Check"
parameter of the control command.
SWITCH 1 POS-REACHED CHECK — Set in the EnerVista software. When Enabled, the IEC 61850 control value is checked for
current Switch status and is rejected if the command value (Open/Close) from IEC 61850 client match with the present
Switch status. When Disabled, the current Switch status is not verified to accept the control.
IEC 61850 functionality is permitted when the M60 is in “Programmed” mode and not in local control mode.
The switch element has direct hard-coded connections to the IEC 61850 model as shown in the logic diagrams. This allows
remote open/close operation of each switch, using either CSWI or XSWI IEC 61850 logical nodes. IEC 61850 select-before-
operate functionality, local/remote switch functionality, along with blocking open/close commands are provided. Note
that the dwell time for the IEC 61850 trip and close commands shown is one protection pass only. To maintain close/open
command for a certain time, do so using the seal-in timers SWITCH 1 OPEN SEAL-IN and SWITCH 1 CLOSE SEAL IN, on the
contact outputs using the "Seal-in" setting, or in FlexLogic.
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SW ITCH 1 TAG ON
SETTING
SW ITCH 1 PB CONTROL
=Off
AND
SW ITCH 1 Ope n
From graphical front panel
AND
DiscCSW I1.BlkOpn.ctlVal = on
OR To IEC 61850 protocol
Disc0XS WI1.BlkOpn.ctlVal = on AND DiscCSWI1.BlkOpn.stVal
From IEC 61850 protocol
SETTING
SW ITCH 1 BLOCK OPEN OR Disc0XSWI1.BlkOpn.stVal
= Off To IEC 61850 protocol
AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SW ITCH 1 BYPAS S ON
To IEC 61850 protocol
AND DiscCSWI1.CmdBlk.stVal
DiscCSWI1.CmdBlk.ctlVal = on
5
SW ITCH 1 Close AND DiscCSWI1.Blk.stVal
From graphical front panel
AND
OR
Disc0XSWI1.Pos.ctlVal = on
OR FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
DiscCSWI1.Pos.ctlVal = on SE TTI NG
AND OR AND SW ITCH 1 ON CMD
From IEC 61850 protocol SW ITCH 1 CLOS E SEAL-IN
T P KP
SETTING 0 AND DiscCSWI1.OpCls.gene ral
SW ITCH 1 CLOS E
AND To IEC 61850 protocol
= Off
From IEC 61850 protocol
AND DiscCSWI1.BlkCls.stVal
DiscCSWI1.BlkCls.ctlVal = on AND
OR
Disc0XS WI1.BlkCls.ctlVal = on
OR Disc0XSWI1.BlkCls.stVal
SETTING To 61850 protocol
SW ITCH 1 BLK CLOSE AND Enable
= Off to shee t 2
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
SW ITCH 1 SU BD CLSD
SW ITCH 1 SU BD OPEN FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SW 1 A CLOSED AND SW ITCH 1 ΦA CLS D
SETTING AND
SW ITCH 1 ΦA/3P CLSD FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OR SW 1 A OPENE D AND SW ITCH 1 ΦA OPEN
= Off AND
AND
SETTING FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SW ITCH 1 ΦA/3P OPND AND SW ITCH 1 ΦA INTERM
OR AND SETTING
= Off AND
SW ITCH 1 TOPERATE FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OR
T P KP AND SW ITCH 1 ΦA BAD S T
AND 0
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SW 1 C CLOSED AND SW ITCH 1 ΦC CLS D
AND
SETTING
SW ITCH 1 ΦC CLS D FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OR SW 1 C OPENE D
5
= Off AND SW ITCH 1 ΦC OPEN
AND
AND
SETTING
SW ITCH 1 ΦC OPENE D FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OR AND AND
= Off AND SW ITCH 1 ΦC INTERM
OR SETTING
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SW ITCH 1 TOPERATE
AND AND SW ITCH 1 ΦC BAD ST
T P KP
0
SW 1 A OPENE D
AND FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SW 1 B OPENED
AND SW ITCH 1 OPEN
SW 1 C OPENE D OR
AND
Enable
to shee t 3 859812A1.vsdx
Figure 5-78: Disconnect switch control graphical front panel logic (sheet 3 of 4)
from sheet 1 from sheet 1
CSWI cmd Switch 1
SETTING Blk LOCAL
SW ITCH 1 TAGG ING
= Enable No Override OR
= Enable with Override
from sheet 2
AND Enable
DiscCSWI1.TagOn.ctlVal=On AND
OR
Disc0XS WI1.TagOn.ctlVal=On Non-volatile,
OR Reset-dominant
SW ITCH 1 Tag S FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
From graphical front panel Latch SW ITCH 1 TAG ON
AND SW ITCH 1 TAG OFF
OR R
OR
AND
SW ITCH 1 Remove Tag
OR
DiscCSWI1.TagOn.ctlVal=Off AND
AND
OR
Disc0XS WI1.TagOn.ctlVal=Off
SETTING
SW ITCH 1 SU BSTITUTN
= E nabled Non-volatile,
Reset-dominant
SW ITCH 1 Substitute Open S FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Latch SW ITCH 1 SU BD OPEN
SW ITCH 1 Remove Substitution
OR R
SETTING
5
SW ITCH 1 BYPAS S
= E nabled Non-volatile,
Reset-dominant
SW ITCH 1 Bypass S FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SW ITCH 1 Remove Bypass Latch SW ITCH 1 BYPAS S ON
From graphical front panel OR R SW ITCH 1 BYPAS S OFF
859829A1.vsdx
SETTING
SW ITCH1 BAD ST TSUPPRESS FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
T P KP AND SW ITCH1 ΦA BAD ST
AND 0
SETTING
SW ITCH1 TOPERATE FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AND T P KP AND SW ITCH1 ΦA INTERM
0
1-Pole Enable
Where Θ is B and C
859813A1.vsdx
5.5.7 FlexCurves
5.5.7.1 Settings
SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP FLEXCURVES FLEXCURE A(D)
FLEXCURVE A FLEXCURVE A TIME AT Range: 0 to 65535 ms in steps of 1
0.00 xPKP: 0 ms
FlexCurves A through D have settings for entering times to reset and operate at the following pickup levels: 0.00 to 0.98
and 1.03 to 20.00. This data is converted into two continuous curves by linear interpolation between data points. To enter
a custom FlexCurve, enter the reset and operate times (using the VALUE keys) for each selected pickup point (using the
MESSAGE up/down keys) for the required protection curve (A, B, C, or D).
The relay using a given FlexCurve applies linear approximation for times between the user-entered points. Take
care when setting the two points that are close to the multiple of pickup of 1; that is, 0.98 pu and 1.03 pu. It is
recommended to set the two times to a similar value, otherwise the linear approximation can result in undesired
behavior for the operating quantity that is close to 1.00 pu.
5
0LQLPXP5HVSRQVH7LPH057,IHQDEOHGWKH057VHWWLQJ
GHILQHVWKHVKRUWHVWRSHUDWLQJWLPHHYHQLIWKHFXUYHVXJJHVWV
DVKRUWHUWLPHDWKLJKHUFXUUHQWPXOWLSOHV$FRPSRVLWHRSHUDWLQJ
FKDUDFWHULVWLFLVHIIHFWLYHO\GHILQHG)RUFXUUHQWPXOWLSOHVORZHU
WKDQWKHLQWHUVHFWLRQSRLQWWKHFXUYHGLFWDWHVWKHRSHUDWLQJWLPH
RWKHUZLVHWKH057GRHV$QLQIRUPDWLRQPHVVDJHDSSHDUV
ZKHQDWWHPSWLQJWRDSSO\DQ057VKRUWHUWKDQWKHPLQLPXP
FXUYHWLPH
+LJK&XUUHQW7LPH$OORZVWKHXVHUWRVHWDSLFNXSPXOWLSOH
IURPZKLFKSRLQWRQZDUGVWKHRSHUDWLQJWLPHLVIL[HG7KLVLV
QRUPDOO\RQO\UHTXLUHGDWKLJKHUFXUUHQWOHYHOV7KH+&75DWLR
GHILQHVWKHKLJKFXUUHQWSLFNXSPXOWLSOHWKH+&7GHILQHVWKH
RSHUDWLQJWLPH
($"'"!1!34B
The Multiplier and Adder settings only affect the curve portion of the characteristic and not the MRT and HCT
settings. The HCT settings override the MRT settings for multiples of pickup greater than the HCT ratio.
5.5.7.4 Example
A composite curve can be created from the GE_111 standard with MRT = 200 ms and HCT initially disabled and then
enabled at eight times pickup with an operating time of 30 ms. At approximately four times pickup, the curve operating
time is equal to the MRT and from then onwards the operating time remains at 200 ms.
($"'!)1!34B
With the HCT feature enabled, the operating time reduces to 30 ms for pickup multiples exceeding eight times pickup.
Figure 5-82: Composite recloser curve with HCT enabled
($"'" 1!34B
Configuring a composite curve with an increase in operating time at increased pickup multiples is not allowed. If
this is attempted, the EnerVista software generates an error message and discards the proposed changes.
(&
5*.& TFD
(&
(& (&
(& (&
$633&/5 NVMUJQMFPGQJDLVQ
($"'"#1!34B
5
Figure 5-84: Recloser curves GE113, GE120, GE138, and GE142
(&
(&
5*.& TFD
(&
(&
$633&/5 NVMUJQMFPGQJDLVQ
($"'"%1!34B
Figure 5-85: Recloser curves GE134, GE137, GE140, GE151, and GE201
(&
5*.& TFD
(&
(& (&
(&
5
($"'# 1!34B
(&
5*.& TFD
(&
(&
(&
$633&/5 NVMUJQMFPGQJDLVQ
($"'"(1!34B
Figure 5-87: Recloser curves GE133, GE161, GE162, GE163, GE164, and GE165
(&
5*.& TFD
(&
(&
(&
(&
(&
$633&/5 NVMUJQMFPGQJDLVQ
($"'")1!34B
Figure 5-88: Recloser curves GE116, GE117, GE118, GE132, GE136, and GE139
5
(&
5*.& TFD
(&
(&
(&
(& (&
$633&/5 NVMUJQMFPGQJDLVQ
($"'"&1!34B
Figure 5-89: Recloser curves GE107, GE111, GE112, GE114, GE115, GE121, and GE122
(&
5*.& TFD
(&
(&
(&
$633&/5 NVMUJQMFPGQJDLVQ
($"'"$1!34B
5
Figure 5-90: Recloser curves GE119, GE135, and GE202
(&
5*.& TFD
(&
(&
$633&/5 NVMUJQMFPGQJDLVQ
($"'"'1!34B
The UR provides a digital process bus by use of a Process Bus Module. A digital process bus enables digital transmission of
data between the switchyard and relays in a control house using communication cables instead of hard-wired
connections.
The Process Bus Module supports the IEC 61850-9-2LE and IEC 61869 protocols, switched networks, and two redundancy
protocols (Parallel Redundancy Protocol and High-Availability Seamless Redundancy). The module is used to transfer data
streams in protection and control networks, including dataset samples referred to as sampled values (SVs), with the
stability of redundancy.
A Process Bus Module with order code 85, 86, or 87 is distinct from the HardFiber Process Bus Module with order code 81.
This section does not apply to the HardFiber module.
Configuration includes that for redundancy and synchronization of time-clock sources because data transfer occurs
among multiple devices.
For any device that is connected to a copper SFP of the Process Bus Module, set its port speed to Auto Negotiate.
The copper SFP supports 100 Mbps and 1 Gbps speeds in auto-negotiate mode. If the connected device has a fixed
port speed or its auto-negotiate is disabled, the Process Bus copper SFP communicates only with devices that use
1 Gbps.
5
5.6.1 Parallel Redundancy Protocol (PRP)
PRP enables seamless switchover and zero recovery time during a single network failure in substation automation
networks. It ensures that critical data, such as GOOSE and sampled value (SV) data, are transmitted without delay in case
of local area network (LAN) defects. In other words, with PRP functionality, the Process Bus Module can be connected to
redundant LANs and work with zero recovery time.
PRP is supported to the IEC 62439-3:2012 standard, Clause 4.
The figure shows that PRP achieves redundancy by using a combination of frame and LAN duplication. Identical frames,
here labeled frames A and B, are sent on two independent networks that connect source and destination. The frames carry
GOOSE or supervisory data. Under normal circumstances, both frames reach the destination and one of them is sent up
the stack to the destination application, while the other frame is discarded. If an error occurs in one of the networks and
traffic is prevented from flowing on that path, connectivity is provided by the other network to ensure continuous
communication. When designing this network care was taken to ensure that there is no single point of failure in the two
LANs, such as a common power supply, as such scenarios can bring down simultaneously both LANs.
RedBox Gateway
SAN
LAN A LAN B
A-frame B-frame
B-frame A-frame
1a 1b
1b 1a
PRP implements redundancy in the nodes rather than in the network by using specialized nodes called Doubly Attached
Nodes Running PRP (DANP) for handling the duplicated frames. The figure shows an example. Each DANP node has two
ports that are connected to the two independent LANs with similar (but not necessarily identical) topology. A source DANP
sends identical frames over both LANs and a destination DANP receives both frames from the two LANs within a certain
time period, consumes the first frame, and discards the duplicate frame.
Each UR device in this example implements PRP on ports 1a and 1b of the Process Bus Module. Both URs require a Process
Bus Module. Ports 1a and 1b act as DANP in the PRP network. With two ports required, Process Bus Modules with order
code 85, 86, or 87 can be used. While this example shows a UR as receiving the frames, the receiver can be a merging unit
or UR.
A device with only one port, such as a printer or computer, is called a Singly Attached Node (SAN). It is a node with non-
redundant network adapters. A SAN can communicate with other SANs and DANPs on the same LAN. When a SAN is
attached to a redundant LAN by a Redundancy Box (RedBox) device, the SAN can communicate with all DANPs and SANs
in both LANs. In other words, if redundancy for a SAN is required, the SAN is connected to both LANs through a RedBox.
A merging unit (MU), such as the GE MU320, is an interface between analog and digital worlds. With an MU, the analog
signals from the CTs and VTs in the yard are converted to digital signals and transmitted via the sampled value (SV)
network communication protocol.
The bridges shown are network switches that connect devices participating in the PRP network and otherwise do not have
an active role in PRP.
HSR is used in network topology with rings and rings of rings. All nodes in the ring are doubly attached. The figure shows
an example. The Doubly Attached Node with HSR (DANH) is a node that has two ports interconnected by full-duplex links
and participates in the HSR ring. The source node receives a frame from its upper layer, inserts an HSR tag to identify
duplicates, and sends it over its two ports in different directions, shown by the red and blue arrows. In a normal, fault-free
state, the identical frames reach the destination DANH within a certain interval, the destination DANH removes the HSR
tag, sends the first frame up the stack to the destination application and discards the second frame. If an error occurs in
one of the network nodes and traffic cannot flow on that path, connectivity is provided through the other direction and
ensures continuous communication.
Figure 5-92: HSR single-ring configuration example
1a 1b 1b 1a
UR DANH (Destination)
RedBox
5
A Singly Attached Node, or SAN, such as a computer or printer, is a node with non-redundant network adapters. It uses a
redundancy box (RedBox) to connect to the ring.
A merging unit (MU), such as the GE MU320, is an interface between analog and digital worlds. With an MU, the analog
signals from the CTs and VTs in the yard are converted to digital signals and transmitted via the sampled value (SV)
network communication protocol.
A UR with the Process Bus Module implements either single or dual HSR capability. It supports hierarchical ring topologies,
such as connected rings, mesh topology, and an HSR ring in a PRP network.
In single HSR configuration, ports 1a and 1b of the Process Bus Module act as DANH, and any other ports on the Process
Bus Module are disabled. Point-to-point configuration is not available. For single HSR, Process Bus Module 85, 86, or 87 can
be used.
In dual HSR configuration, the UR to connect to two independent HSR rings. Ports 1a and 1b form one DANH node, and
ports 3a and 3b form the second DANH node. Any other ports on the module are disabled. Traffic from HSR-1 ring is not
forwarded to the HSR-2 ring and vice versa. The UR does not facilitate any message communication between the two
independent HSR rings. In dual HSR, with four ports required, a Process Bus Module with order code 86 or 87 can be used.
While the UR does not provide RedBox functionality, an HSR ring can be connected to a PRP network using two RedBoxes,
one for each redundant LAN of the PRP network. The RedBoxes are configured to handle PRP frames on the interlinks and
HSR frames on the HSR ring. As per the IEC 62439-3:2016 standard, up to seven PRP networks can be connected to the
same HSR ring.
While the UR does not provide QuadBox functionality, a QuadBox can be added to interconnect two HSR rings, which is
beneficial when traffic on a single ring exceeds the ring’s capability.
Figure 5-93: Dual HSR, double-ring configuration example
UR DANH (Source)
1a 3a
1b 3b
HSR Ring 1 HSR Ring 2
UR DANH UR DANH
5.6.3 General
SETTINGS PROCESS BUS MODULE GENERAL
GENERAL NETWORK CONFIG: Range: INDEPENDENT, PRP, HSR, Dual HSR
INDEPENDENT
Restart the relay after changing these settings, under Maintenance > Reboot Relay Command.
NETWORK CONFIG — This setting specifies the network configuration and redundancy for the Process Bus Module.
If set to INDEPENDENT, all ports on the Process Bus Module are enabled, and the Process Bus Module can be connected
directly to merging units (MUs) or to a switch without redundancy. To enable and disable individual ports on the Process
Bus Module in a point-to-point (PPP) network, use the PORT x FUNCTION settings.
If set to PRP or HSR, ports 1a and 1b are enabled. The PORT 1a FUNCTION and PORT 1b FUNCTION settings change. 5
If set to Dual HSR, ports 1a and 1b are enabled for one HSR ring, and when using a Process Bus Module with order codes 86
or 87 then ports 3a and 3b are enabled for another HSR ring. The PORT x FUNCTION settings change.
PRP SUPV MCST ADDR — This setting changes the multicast address used by the Parallel Redundancy Protocol (PRP)
supervision frames. Configure all DANP devices in the PRP network with the same multicast address for the network
supervision to operate properly. This setting is editable when the NETWORK CONFIG setting is set to PRP.
HSR-1 SUPV MCST ADDR — This setting changes the multicast address used by High-Availability Seamless Redundancy ring
one (HSR-1 ports 1a and 1b) supervision frames, for single HSR configuration. Configure all DANH devices in the HSR
network with the same multicast address for the network supervision to operate properly. This setting is editable when the
NETWORK CONFIG setting is set to HSR or Dual HSR.
HSR-2 SUPV MCST ADDR — This setting changes the multicast address used by the HSR-2 (ports 3a and 3b) supervision
frames for the second DANH in a Dual HSR configuration. Configure all DANH devices in the HSR network with the same
multicast address for the network supervision to operate properly. This setting is editable when the NETWORK CONFIG
setting is set to Dual HSR.
PORT 1a to 4b FUNCTION — These settings manually enable and disable Process Bus Module Ethernet ports. Typically,
Process Bus Module ports are order-code dependent, and the INDEPENDENT network configuration enables all the ports
by default, changing the settings shown here. These settings allow individual ports to be enabled and disabled. For
example, to connect only a few of the ports, other ports can be disabled to avoid a PBEthPort-# Offline self-test error.
The fields active depend on order code and NETWORK CONFIG setting. For order code 85, ports 1a, 1b, 3a, and 3b are
available to be turned on or off. For order codes 86 and 87, all eight ports can be available to be turned on or off.
When a port is disabled, all transmitting and receiving traffic on the port is blocked.
Relay restart is not required when changing these port function fields.
SV TRBL PRT BLOCK — In case of loss of any subscribed SV streams or due to bad quality of any subscribed SV frames, the
protection functions of the relay need to be blocked to avoid undesired operation. This setting specifies the type of
blocking applied.
When set to Global, all the protection functions that utilize the sampled values are blocked. Communications, data logging,
and oscillography remain functional. Availability of switchgear control is determined by the SV TRBL CONT OP BLK operand.
When set to Partial, only those protection functions are blocked that utilize the sampled values from the affected SV
stream. All other protection functions remain operational. Communications, data logging, and oscillography remain
functional. Availability of switchgear control is determined by the SV TRBL CONT OP BLK operand.
SV TRBL CONT OP BLK — Selects a FlexLogic operand that determines if the contact outputs are blocked or not. When the
state of the operand is low, the contact outputs are not blocked when there is a loss of any SV stream or received SV
frames have bad quality. The user can execute control action, thus, enabling switchgear control through contact outputs
during SV stream trouble.
When the operand is high, the contact outputs are blocked when there is a loss of any SV stream or received SV frames
have bad quality. The switchgear control is not available through contact outputs during SV stream trouble.
SV DELAY ALARM — The sampled value (SV) frames can arrive with a delay from the MUs, which can be due to the MU
performance or different network path delays. This setting specifies the maximum delay expected between the time a
sample is taken at the MU and the time of arrival of that SV message, where sampling time is estimated based on the UR
Process Bus Module clock and the sampling rate. If the calculated frame delay is more than this setting value, the RxSV#
Delay Alarm FlexLogic operand asserts. The setting value needs to be calibrated and set at the commissioning time for the
given network topology. An alarm in runtime indicates the network performance is degrading over the time. In short, this
setting specifies how long the UR waits to declare that a sample is delayed. Protection is not blocked by this setting.
QUALITY CHECK — Flags are used to assess quality of sampled value data to ensure protection. This setting specifies how
the sampled values are processed by the UR when the associated q.validity is set to Questionable. Quality is checked per
AC bank, not per SV stream.
When set to Reject Questionable, the questionable data is treated the same as Invalid and the frame is rejected. Only Good
quality data is accepted.
Set it to Accept Questionable only if it is absolutely known that questionable quality from a MU is not compromising the
quality of the data for various applications. When set to Accept Questionable, the Good and Questionable quality data are
5 accepted.
ANTI-ALIASING FILTER — This setting activates or deactivates the anti-aliasing filter, which conditions the sampled values
from the Process Bus Module network.
The default value of Enabled is recommended, unless all the subscribed MUs use the Anti-Aliasing Filter for signal
conditioning. When Enabled, the device applies a low-pass-filter and cuts-off all the harmonics above the 5th order
harmonics. The protection and control functions utilize up to the 5th harmonics, beyond which the metering accuracy of
harmonics and THD cannot be ensured.
Set the filter to Disabled only if harmonics and THD measurement accuracy are required and the performance and
accuracy of the UR is tested with the MU.
SMPSYNCH CHECK — This setting is a time synchronization check. It specifies the time synchronization source of an SV
stream (SmpSynch attribute value in an SV message header) expected by the UR Process Bus Module.
Set it to Global to accept all the SV streams with SmpSynch indicating a Global (2) value. A stream with a SmpSynch value
other than Global (2) is rejected.
When set to Local, all SV streams with SmpSynch indicating a Local (1) or Global (2) area clock are accepted.
When set to Any, any SmpSynch value in the range of 0 to 254 is acceptable (0 to 127 for UR 7.80), and streams outside the
range are rejected.
Port 1b
Port 4a
Port 4b
The time synchronizing source for the relay is set using SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP REAL TIME CLOCK. Another time
source is set for the Process Bus Module.
The Process Bus Module supports the Precision Time Protocol (PTP) as PTP master and slave functionality.
The PTP state of each port is determined by the PTP settings and grandmaster clock availability on the local network.
Time synchronization supports IEEE 1588 PTPv2.
5
5.6.4.1 PBM PTP configuration
The M60 supports IEEE 1588 PTPv2 as PTP Slave or PTP Master on its Process Bus Module ports. It can be supplied with an
external RTC clock from the main CPU ports (station bus ports), the Process Bus Module ports, or both. It utilizes one of the
two clocks depending upon the configuration of the SETTINGS > PRODUCT SETUP > REAL TIME CLOCK > SYNCRONIZING
SOURCE and SETTINGS > PROCESS BUS MODULE > PBM PTP > PTP FUNCTION settings, as follows:
• To use an external PTP Grand Master clock from the Process Bus Module port (UR acts as PTP Slave only), configure the
following settings:
– SETTINGS > PRODUCT SETUP > REAL TIME CLOCK > SYNCRONIZING SOURCE = PBM clock
– SETTINGS > PROCESS BUS MODULE > PBM PTP > PTP FUNCTION = Slave-only
With this configuration, the relay RTC will use the clock from the Process Bus Module port.
If the SETTINGS > PRODUCT SETUP > REAL TIME CLOCK > SYNCRONIZING SOURCE setting is "PBM clock" and the
SETTINGS > PROCESS BUS MODULE > PBM PTP > PTP FUNCTION setting is "Disabled," the RTC clock free-runs, and
the Line Current Differential element is blocked.
• To use an external PTP Grand Master clock from the Process Bus Module port (UR in PTP Slave mode) or to enable the
M60 as PTP Master on its Process Bus Module ports, configure the following settings:
– SETTINGS > PRODUCT SETUP > REAL TIME CLOCK > SYNCRONIZING SOURCE = PBM clock
– SETTINGS > PROCESS BUS MODULE > PBM PTP > PTP FUNCTION = Master-Slave
With this configuration, the relay RTC uses the clock from the Process Bus Module port.
• To use an external clock through a main CPU port (PTP Slave, IRIG-B, other source) and to enable the M60 as PTP
Master on its Process Bus Module ports, configure the following settings:
– SETTINGS > PRODUCT SETUP > REAL TIME CLOCK > SYNCRONIZING SOURCE = PP/IRIG-B/PTP/Other, or IRIG-B/
PP/PTP/Other, or PP/PTP/IRIG-B/Other
– SETTINGS > PROCESS BUS MODULE > PBM PTP > PTP FUNCTION = Master-Slave, or Slave, or Disabled
With this configuration, the relay RTC uses the clock from the main CPU port.
The Master-Slave option in the PTP FUNCTION setting is not available in L90 and L30 relays.
Some UR applications like oscillography, event recorder, and datalogger use the real-time clock for time-stamping.
Note that in all of these scenarios, when the Grand Master clock is not available through a CPU port and/or Process Bus
Module, all the elements (protection, control, monitoring, logic, and so on) in the M60, except the Line Current Differential
element, remain functional without requiring any external synchronizing source for the M60, as long as all the sampled
values subscribed by the relay are synchronized according to the setting definition of "SmpSynch Check" (SETTINGS >
PROCESS BUS MODULE > GENERAL > SmpSynch Check) and pass the other acceptance criteria.
PTP FUNCTION — Sets the source for time synchronization for the Process Bus Module.
When set to Disabled, PTP is disabled on all ports of the Process Bus Module.
When set to Master-Slave, the Process Bus Module acts as a PTP slave when a grandmaster clock is available in the
communication path. If no better clock than its own clock is available in the communication path, the module switches to
master mode and provides the grandmaster functionality by sending Announce frames and other supporting PTP Master
frames.
When set to Slave-only, the Process Bus Module acts as a PTP slave ordinary clock if a grandmaster clock is available in the
network. If no grandmaster clock is available in the communication path, the module continues to wait for the Announce
messages.
When PTP is enabled but no grand master is available on any of the Process Bus Module ports, "PB PTP Failure" events are
generated.
To view the synchronizing source, see ACTUAL VALUES PB MODULE TIME SYNC Sync Source.
PTP PROFILE — Specifies the profile to be used for PTP Master communication. The Power Utility Profil option relates to IEC
61850-9-3, while the Power Profile option relates to IEEE C37.238 2017.
When the Process Bus Module PTP is in the slave state, this setting has no effect. As a slave, the Process Bus Module
5 accepts both the Power Profile and the Power Utility Profile.
PTP DOMAIN NUMBER — Set this to the domain number of the grandmaster-capable clock(s) to synchronize to. A network
can support multiple time distribution domains, each distinguished with a unique domain number. The Power Utility Profile
recommends 93 as the value for the domain number.
PTP VLAN PRIORITY — This setting selects the value of the priority field in the 802.1Q VLAN tag in PTP request messages
issued by the relay.
PTP VLAN ID — This setting selects the value of the ID field in the 802.1Q VLAN tag in PTP request messages issued by the
relay. As these messages have a destination address that indicates they are not to be bridged, their VLAN ID serves no
function, and so the setting can be left at its default value. Depending on the characteristics of the device to which the
relay is directly linked, VLAN ID can have no effect.
PTP MASTER PRIO1 — Priority1 is used in the execution of the best master clock algorithm and lower values take
precedence. The operation of the best master clock algorithm selects clocks from a set with a lower value of priority1 over
clocks from a set greater than priority1.
The setting values Priority1 and Priority2 decide when the UR Process Bus Module ports are selected as grandmaster
clock. In a single LAN, GE recommends the following:
• Set the Priority1 of the UR larger than the actual grandmaster, so that the grandmaster(s) takes precedence over UR
• Set the same Priority1 for all the UR Process Bus Module ports participating in one communication path
• Use Priority2 to further prioritize the UR Process Bus Module ports in the network. The UR with lower value of Priority2
is selected as best master when Priority1, clockClass, clockAccuracy, and scaledOffsetLogVariance are the same.
The setting is editable in the software when the PTP FUNCTION setting is Master-Slave.
PTP MASTER PRIO2 — Priority2 is used in the execution of the best master clock algorithm and lower values take
precedence. If the operation of the best master clock algorithm fails to order the clocks based on the values of priority1,
clockClass, clockAccuracy, and scaledOffsetLogVariance, the priority2 attribute allows the creation of up to 256 priorities
to further fine-tune the selection of best clocks.
If Priority2 is configured the same for two URs in the same communication path, best master clock algorithm uses
clockIdentity to resolve the tie-breaker.
The setting is editable in the software when the PTP FUNCTION setting is Master-Slave.
Independent of the NETWORK CONFIG and PTP FUNCTION settings, the enabled transceiver ports on the Process Bus
Module operate in stateless transparent clock mode. GE recommends always setting the NETWORK CONFIG setting
to match with the network topology to avoid unnecessary data storms. For example, if the PRP network has
multiple URs connected on PRP LAN and if the UR’s NETWORK CONFIG setting is misconfigured to "Independent,"
PTP messages other than PDelay messages are forwarded between the connected ports, which can create a PTP
data storm.
5.6.4.2 Ports
SETTINGS PROCESS BUS MODULE PBM PTP Port 1a(4b)
Port 1a PATH DELAY ADDER: Range: 0 to 60000 ns in steps of 1
0 ns
These setting are editable in the software when the PTP FUNCTION setting is not Disabled.
Up to eight ports display here, depending on the Process Bus Module.
Default port assignments for the Process Bus Module are as follows:
• Parallel Redundancy Protocol (PRP) — Ports 1a and 1b are enabled
• High-Availability Seamless Redundancy (HSR) — Ports 1a and 1b are enabled
• Dual HSR — Ports 1a and 1b support HSR-1, and ports 3a and 3b support HSR-2
• INDEPENDENT — Ports 1a to 4b are enabled
Port availability by order code is as follows:
• 85 — Ports 1a and 1b, or 3a and 3b
5
• 86 — All eight ports
• 87 — All eight ports
For the following two settings, there is no dependency with the NETWORK CONFIG setting. For order code 85, ports 1a, 1b,
3a, and 3b settings are available. For order codes 86 and 87, all the port settings are available. Configure these settings as
per your network. For example, for order code 85, while ports 1a, 1b, 3a, and 3b settings display, configure ports 1a and 1b
when your network uses these two ports.
PATH DELAY ADDER — The time delivered by PTP is advanced by the time in this setting prior to the time being used to
synchronize the relay's real-time clock. This is to compensate for time delivery delays not compensated for in the network.
In a fully compliant power utility network, the peer delay and the processing delay mechanisms compensate for all the
delays between the grandmaster and the relay. In such networks, use 0 ns for this setting.
In networks containing one or more switches and/or clocks that do not implement both of these mechanisms, not all
delays are compensated for, so the time of message arrival at the relay is later than the time indicated in the message.
This setting can be used to approximately compensate for this delay. However, as the relay is not aware of network
switching that changes dynamically the amount of uncompensated delay, there is no setting that always corrects
completely for uncompensated delay. A setting can be chosen that reduces worst-case error to half of the range between
minimum and maximum uncompensated delay, if these values are known.
Restart the relay after changing this setting, for example using Maintenance > Reboot Relay.
PATH DELAY ASYMMETRY — This setting corresponds to "delayAsymmetry" in PTP, which is used by the peer delay
mechanism to compensate for any difference in the propagation delay between the two directions of a link. Except in
unusual cases, the two fiber cables are of essentially identical length and composition, so use 0 ns for this setting.
In unusual cases where the length of the link is different in different directions, make this setting the number of
nanoseconds that the Ethernet propagation delay to the relay is longer than the mean of path propagation delays to and
from the relay. For example, if it is known from the physical length of the fiber cable and the propagation speed in the fiber
that the delay from the relay to the Ethernet switch it is connected to is 9 000 ns and that the delay from the switch to the
relay is 11 000 ns, then the mean delay is 10 000 ns, and the path delay asymmetry is +1 000 ns.
• The Show Custom Layout button toggles changes made to formatting, such as column width. Such changes can be
made with or without the button active, and they are retained when the panel is closed.
• There are up to eight RxSV, eight AC Bank, and six Source columns. A B30 can have up to 24 RxSV, 30 AC Bank (24 CT
and six VT), and 30 Source columns.
• With IEC 61869-9, the Advanced Config fields populate and are read-only when importing a file
• Rules are enforced and the configuration cannot be saved until the rules are followed. For example, Neutral Origin 1
and Neutral Origin 2 cannot be mapped to the same SV stream. See the troubleshooting section that follows.
• The window is configured based on the separate areas and not based on columns. For example, stream RxSV1 is
configured in the SV Messages area of the window, not the first column in the entire window. Or for example, Source1
in the first column can be configured to use AC Bank B2 in the second column.
• The following example shows that Source1 at the bottom of the window is set to map to AC Bank B2, which is mapped
to the first stream (RxSV1) and its available VT1 phase voltage and VT2 neutral voltage.
Figure 5-95: Understanding SV configuration
• The UR allows switching AC banks (essentially streams) from the main measuring MU to the alternate measuring MU.
Once an operand assigned to the SWITCH ALT CT/VT setting is logical "1," the input data to this source is switched from
the banks assigned to PHASE CT/GROUND CT to the banks assigned to ALT PHASE CT/ALT GROUND CT settings for
current transformers. This is similar for voltage transformers.
• Banks assigned to the same function for the main and alternate input data have to have the same CT and VT nominals
and connections, otherwise a warning is generated and switching functionality is prohibited. For example, banks
assigned to the PHASE CT and ALT PHASE CT have to have same primary and secondary CT values.
• During switching from the main CT/VT input data to alternate input data and vice versa, all relay functions are blocked
for two power cycles and metering data does not update
• See the Source Switching section under SETTINGS > SYSTEM SETUP > SIGNAL SOURCES in this manual for application
examples of AC bank switching
An example of the configuration process is as follows:
1. Configure SV streams by importing an MU CID file. This populates the SV Messages area of the window.
2. Configure the Sources fields.
3. Map the AC Bank fields to the RxSV Stream fields.
4. Troubleshoot using the messages displayed during configuration and/or upon save so that the rules are followed.
Saving frequently during configuration helps to deal with issues early.
5. Restart the relay for the changes to take effect.
The table outlines mapping examples using CT channels. VT channels are similar.
Table 5-19: CT configuration mapping examples
Scenario AC Bank configuration Advanced Config configuration
No CT signal in the SV stream --- ---
One neutral Neutral Origin 1 = RxSV1-CT1/NTR CT1-N maps to AC1
Two neutrals Neutral Origin 1 = RxSV1-CT1/NTR CT1-N maps to AC1
Neutral Origin 2 = RxSV2-CT2/NTR CT2-N maps to AC2
5 Three phases
Three phases followed by one neutral
Phase Origin 1 = RxSV1-CT1/PHS
Phase Origin 1 = RxSV1-CT1/PHS
CT1-A, B, C map to AC1, 2, 3
CT1-A, B, C, N map to AC1, 2, 3, 4
Neutral Origin 1 = RxSV1-CT1/NTR
One neutral followed by three phases Neutral Origin 1 = RxSV1-CT1/NTR CT1-N maps to AC1
Phase Origin 1 = RxSV1-CT2/PHS CT2-A, B, C map to AC2, 3, 4
One neutral followed by three phases, then Neutral Origin 1 = RxSV1-CT1/NTR CT1-N maps to AC1
followed by one neutral Phase Origin 1 = RxSV1-CT2/PHS CT2-A, B, C, N map to AC2, 3, 4, 5
Neutral Origin 2 = RxSV2-CT2/NTR
Three phases followed by one neutral, then Phase Origin 1 = RxSV1-CT1/PHS CT1-A, B, C, N map to AC1, 2, 3, 4
another neutral Neutral Origin 1 = RxSV1-CT1/NTR CT2-N maps to AC5
Neutral Origin 2 = RxSV2-CT2/NTR
Two three-phases Phase Origin 1 = RxSV1-CT1/PHS CT1-A, B, C map to AC1, 2, 3
Phase Origin 2 = RxSV2-CT2/PHS CT2-A, B, C map to AC4, 5, 6
Three phases followed by one neutral, then Phase Origin 1 = RxSV1-CT1/PHS CT1-A, B, C, N map to AC1, 2, 3, 4
another three phases Neutral Origin 1 = RxSV1-CT1/NTR CT2-A, B, C map to AC5, 6, 7
Phase Origin 2 = RxSV2-CT2/PHS
Three phases followed by another three phases, Phase Origin 1 = RxSV1-CT1/PHS CT1-A, B, C map to AC1, 2, 3
then one neutral Phase Origin 2 = RxSV2-CT2/PHS CT2-A, B, C, N map to AC4, 5, 6, 7
Neutral Origin 2 = RxSV2-CT2/NTR
Three phases, one neutral, then another three Phase Origin 1 = RxSV1-CT1/PHS CT1-A, B, C, N map to AC1, 2, 3, 4
phases and one neutral. Neutral Origin 1 = RxSV1-CT1/NTR CT2-A, B, C, N map to AC5, 6, 7, 8
See the following figure. Phase Origin 2 = RxSV2-CT2/PHS
Neutral Origin 2 = RxSV2-CT2/NTR
Figure 5-96: Example three phases, one neutral, then three phases and one neutral
5.6.5.1 Logic
The logic diagram follows.
SETTING
SV Stream FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
= OR RxSV# Off
svID
Dst MAC
5
ConfRev
Sim Bit FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SmpCnt RxSV# On
SmpSync MUX
Analog1 (instMag.i) (Align frames using
timest amp) + Success = 0 FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Analog1 (q)
Qualit y Check + OR SV# Processing Fail
... SimBit Check +
….
Fail = 1
Advanced Miss
Analog16 (instMag.i) Sample Algorithm
Analog16 (q)
* Note: RxSV# SimBit On and RxSV# SynChk Fail and RxSV#
QualChk Fail reset (i.e. drop out) when RxSV# Lost operand is
asserted (no frame received for 2 cycles)
859787A1.vsd
SV streams are accepted based on the following settings that need to match the MU:
• SmpSynch Check — Time synchronization check as outlined earlier in the General section
• Quality Check — Outlined earlier
• svID — Multicast Sampled Value Identification of a stream
• Dst MAC — Destination Media Access Control address in the header of the SV message
• ConfRev — When the configuration revision is non-zero, the UR accepts the frame when it matches its configured
value
The relay decodes an SV stream when the DstMAC attribute of the injected SV stream matches any of the
configured SV stream subscriptions.
Each qualified SV stream (that is, with matching svID, Dst MAC, and ConfRev) that is mapped to any of the AC Banks is
checked for the SV delay, matching Sim bit, time synchronization source, and quality checks.
When four samples in 1/8th of power cycle duration fail any of these checks, a corresponding FlexLogic operand is
asserted, with a drop-out timer of one protection pass. The drop-out timer is retriggered each time that the check fails.
The RxSV# Lost FlexLogic operand is set when consecutive 160 samples (two cycles) are lost following the assertion of SV
DELAY ALARM. The time accuracy for the assertion of this operand can be up to two protection passes.
The RxSV# Off FlexLogic operand is set when the "Miss Sample Algorithm" fails (for example, due to temporary loss of
stream or stream rejected due to any condition check failure) or the stream is lost, with a drop-out time of 17 protection
passes. Every "Miss Sample Algorithm" fail condition for that RxSV# stream retriggers the drop-out timer for the RxSV# Off
operand.
• If SV messages with simulation bit TRUE are not received, the RxSv# continues to use the actual SV frames
• When the value of @Master/LPHD1.Sim.stVal changes from TRUE to FALSE
– Subscribed SV messages with simulation bit TRUE are ignored immediately after this change
– Only subscribed SV messages with simulation bit FALSE are accepted
5.6.5.5 Settings
The following settings are available.
SV Stream
Range: Disabled, IEC 61850-9-2LE r2-1, IEC 61869-9 ed1.0
Default: Disabled
This setting enables an SV stream and selects the SV frame format, or protocol.
When set to IEC 61850-9-2LE, the UR assumes that the received SV frame references to datasets that comply with IEC
61850-9-2LE, Table 6: Dataset (PhsMeas1). The UR must be configured with a system frequency of 50 or 60 Hz for
correct operation.
When set to IEC 61869-9, the UR assumes that the dataset rules comply with IEC 61869-9 ed1.0 and that the number of
Application-layer Service Data Units (ASDUs) are user-configurable.
When set to Disabled, the rest of the RxSV# setting fields are read-only default values.
Recycle power to the relay when changing this setting.
svID
Range: 1 up to 129 Visible String characters
Default: empty string
5 svID refers to the name of the sampled value packet. The svID field of incoming SV messages must exactly match this
value for the message to be accepted as a valid RxSV# message. The svID field of the sampled value frame must be
unique within the system/substation.
Dst MAC
Range: any valid multicast MAC (12-digit hexadecimal number)
Default: 01-0C-CD-04-00-00
Only received SV messages having a destination Media Access Control (MAC) address equal to this value are accepted as
valid RxSV# messages. Each address must be unique.
The destination MAC increases the overall performance of multicast message reception by filtering only the configured
messages for processing. For a received SV message, the Dst MAC is validated if it matches with any of the configured
RxSV# Dst MAC. If validation is successful, the message is forwarded for further checks. There is no explicit check for the
configured Dst MAC versus the SvID for a received SV message.
ConfRev
Range: 0 to 2147483647 in steps of 1
Default: 0
ConfRev refers to configuration revision, which is a count of configuration changes in the SV control block. If the value
entered here is non-zero, the ConfRev field of incoming SV messages must match this value for the message to be
accepted as a valid RxSV# message. If the setting is zero, RxSV# does not check the value received in the ConfRev field.
Stream Status
This is an LED status indicator for the reception of an SV stream (RxSV#).
A green LED reflects the RxSV# On FlexLogic operand, meaning that the SV stream is online.
A red LED reflects the RxSV# Off FlexLogic operand, meaning that the SV stream is offline.
An orange LED reflects the RxSV# Lost FlexLogic operand, meaning that the SV stream is completely lost and no SVs are
received.
When the EnerVista UR Setup software is not online or the stream is disabled, the LED is greyed-out with Not Available,
or "-NA-" status.
Advanced Configuration
Click the button to display or hide the fields.
These are settings to import an MU CID file and/or support IEC 61869-9 based SV streams, as per Table 902 on Standard
sample rates. IEC 61869-9 allows flexibility on numbers of current and voltage channels. It can be in one of these
sequences: A, B, C, N or A, AB, B, BC, C, CA, N. The UR supports up to eight CT channels and up to eight VT channels and
one or two ASDUs for protection applications. The following settings are active when the SV Stream field is set to IEC
61869-9, and they also depend on the MU Variant Code.
MU SCL Import
Use this feature to configure SV streams by importing an MU CID file. The setting file comparison with IEC 61869-9-2LE
configuration is not available. The IEC 61850 Merge feature with IEC 61869-9-2LE is not available.
Upon clicking the Import button and selecting a .cid file, a window appears from which to select the stream to import.
Figure 5-98: Selecting a stream to import from a merging unit CID file
5
Rules for accepting a CID file include
• The same remote channel cannot be mapped to more than one AC bank channel
• An AC bank channel cannot be mapped to more than one remote channel
• For each AC bank, there are three phase inputs from the same SV control block and all three inputs are configured
• Phase 1 and Phase 2 inputs are not from the same SV control block
• Phase 1 and Phase 2 aux inputs are not from the same SV control block
• A configured Phase consumes three analog channels and Aux consumes one analog channel, with a maximum of 24
channels
SvCBRef
Range: 0 up to 129 alphanumeric, underscore, slash, and period characters, beginning with an alpha character
Default: empty string
This field is read-only. When imported, the MU SCL file populates this field. The value is an ObjectReference to the
publishing control block in the format:
<LDName>/LLN0.<SvCBName>
where <LDName> is the function-related name, if any, of the logical device containing the publishing control block,
otherwise the product-related name of that logical device, and <SvCBName> is the name of the publishing control block.
When RxSV# is configured manually, the field is empty.
CT Channels
Range: 0 to 8
Default: 4
This setting specifies the number of CT channels available in the subscribed RxSV# message from the publisher MU. The
CT-1 fields reflect the number selected here. The number of current quantities matches the number specified by the
Variant Code of the MU.
Typically, a CT channel includes four current channels (three phase-ground currents and one ground/neutral/earth
current). A current channel is the combination of the current sample value attribute (AmpSv.instMag.i) and the
subsequent quality attribute (AmpSv.q).
If CT Channels is 4, CT1-A/B/C/N are supported for the stream.
If CT Channels is 8, CT2-A/B/C/N also are supported for the stream.
If CT Channels is 0, no CT channels display for AC input selection.
This setting is read-only and fixed at 4 when an SV Stream is set to IEC 61850-9-2LE.
If a message displays that "the number of channels being selected for CT inputs...exceeds the total allowable 4 CT
channels," it means that the CT Channels field is set at 4 and there are entries in the CT2-A/B/C/N fields. Set the latter
fields to None or increase the number of channels.
VT Channels
Range: 0 to 8
Default: 4
This setting specifies the number of VT channels in the subscribed RxSV# message from the publisher MU. Typically, VT
channels include four voltage channels (three phase-ground voltages and auxiliary voltage). This setting specifies the
number of voltage channels in the subscribed RxSV# message. The voltage channel is the combination of voltage
sample value attribute (VolSv.instMag.i) and the corresponding quality attribute (VolSv.q). The VT-1 fields reflect the
number selected here. The number of voltage quantities matches the number specified by the Variant Code of the
dataset.
If VT Channels is 4, VT1-A/B/C/N are supported for the stream.
If VT Channels is 8, VT2-A/B/C/ also are supported for the stream.
If VT Channels is 0, no VT channels display for AC input selection.
5 This setting is read-only and fixed at 4 when an SV Stream is set to IEC 61850-9-2LE.
If a message displays that "the number of channels being selected for VI inputs...exceeds the total allowable 2 VT
channels," it means that the VT Channels field is set at 2 and there are more than two entries in the VT1-A/B/C/N fields.
The number of configured VT1 fields needs to match the VT Channels field.
ASDUs
Range: 1, 2
Default: 1
This setting specifies the number of Application-layer Service Data Units (ASDUs) concatenated in one Application
Protocol Data Unit (APDU) in the subscribed RxSV# message. When concatenating several ASDUs into one frame, the
ASDU with the oldest samples is the first one in the frame.
This setting is read-only and set at the default when an SV Stream is set to IEC 61850-9-2LE.
Recycle power to the relay when changing this setting.
Variant Code
The EnerVista software auto-populates the Variant Code for the RxSV# message based on the settings Sample Rate, the
number of ASDUs, the number of CT Channels, and the number of VT Channels configured.
For example, F4800S2I8U0 describes sampled values with 4800 samples per second, two ASDU (samples) per message,
8 currents, and no voltages.
As another example, F4800S1I8U4 means sampled values with 4800 samples per second, 1 ASDU per message, 8 CT
channels, and 4 VT channels.
This field is read-only as per IEC 61869-9: 2016, Clause-6.903.2.
The number of samples (sample rate) in the variant code is set based on the SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP POWER
SYSTEM NOMINAL FREQUENCY setting. This value displays 4000 Hz for 50 Hz nominal frequency. This value displays
4800 Hz for 60 Hz nominal frequency or any other nominal frequency except 50 Hz. IEC 61869-9 suggests the 4800 Hz
sample rate for general measuring and protective applications, regardless of the power system frequency.
CT1-A/B/C
Range: None, AC1 to AC16
Default: AC1/AC2/AC3
This setting specifies the sequence of Analog Channel (per phase) that is mapped to the CT-1 of the corresponding
stream. An origin to CT Phase input defines the physical measurement input to the CT bank by mapping specific AC
inputs from that merging unit (or SV message).
The fields are active when the SV Stream field is set to IEC 61869-9. The CT1 phases are available if the number of CT
Channels is 4 or below. CT2 is added if CT Channels is 5 or higher.
The fields are set to the defaults and are read-only when the SV Stream field is set to IEC 61850-9-2LE.
CT1- N
Range: None, AC1 to AC16
Default: AC4
This setting specifies the Analog Channel that is mapped to the CT ground/neutral input. An origin to CT1-N input
defines the physical measurement input to the CT bank by mapping specific AC inputs from that MU (or SV message). If
the MU does not publish any CT1-N inputs, configure the setting as None.
In the EnerVista software, the CT Aux input setting only populates the current channels of that RxSV#.
This CT Aux input setting is active when the SV Stream field is set to IEC 61869-9.
This CT Aux input setting is set to AC4 and is read-only when the SV Stream is set to IEC 61850-9-2LE.
VT1-A/B/C
Range: None, AC1 to AC16
Default: AC5/AC6/AC7
This setting specifies the Analog Channel (per phase) that is mapped to the VT1- phase inputs. An origin to VT Phase
input defines the physical measurement input to the VT bank by mapping specific AC inputs from that MU (or SV
message). If the MU does not publish any VT channels, configure the setting as None.
5
The VT1 phase fields are active when the SV Stream field is set to IEC 61869-9. The VT1 phases are available if the
number of VT Channels is 4 or below. VT2 is added if VT Channels is 5 or higher.
The fields are set to the defaults and are read-only when the SV Stream field is set to IEC 61850-9-2LE.
VT1-N
Range: None, AC1 to AC16
Default: AC8
This setting specifies the Analog Channel that is mapped to the VT Aux/neutral input. An origin to VT input defines the
physical measurement input to the VT bank by mapping specific AC inputs from that MU (or SV message). If the MU does
not publish any VT1-N inputs, configure the setting as None.
In the EnerVista software, the VT Aux input setting only populates the voltage channels of that RxSV#.
The VT1-N input setting is active when the SV Stream field is set to IEC 61869-9.
The VT1-N input setting is set to the default and is read-only when the SV Stream field is set to IEC 61850-9-2LE.
AC BANKS
The UR platform supports up to six AC Banks. They can be CT or VT banks (similar to SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP AC
INPUTS CURRENT/VOLTAGE BANK). That is, each AC Bank can be configured either as current or voltage (not both). If
configured as current, inapplicable voltage settings (such as VT ratio, VT secondary) are inactive. Similarly, if a bank is
configured as voltage, current settings (such as CT primary, CT secondary) are inactive. In addition, bank level
redundancy (that is, Origin-1 and Origin-2) is supported using crosschecking of each channel signal received from two
different SV streams that are connected to the same electrical point on the primary power system. A maximum 24
channels can be configured to the AC Banks.
Click the button to display or hide the fields.
The following settings are available for each AC bank.
Each Phase Origin setting consumes three phase channels Ia/Va, Ib/Vb, or Ic/Vc, and a Neutral Origin setting consumes
one ground or Aux Channel In/Vn, which means that
– An AC Bank with Phase Origin1 and Neutral Origin1 settings configured consumes four channels
– An AC Bank with both Phase Origin 1 and Phase Origin 2 and both Neutral Origin 1 and Neutral Origin 2 settings
configured consumes eight channels
A maximum of 24 channels can be configured to the AC Banks.
For changes in this section, restart the relay, for example using Maintenance > Reboot Relay Command.
Phase Origin 1, 2
Range: None, RxSV1-CT1/PHS, RxSV1-VT1/PHS to RxSV8-CT1/PHS, RxSV8-VT1/PHS
Default: None
An origin to an AC bank defines the physical measurement input to the bank by mapping specific AC inputs from a
specific MU to the bank.
The UR Process Bus Module provides for the reliability of AC values for protection, metering, and oscillography by
allowing duplicate origins of AC data. An origin is considered unavailable when set to None. If origin 1 is available, the
relay uses the values from origin 1 for protection, metering, and oscillography. Otherwise if origin 2 is available, the relay
uses the values from origin 2. If both origins are unavailable, then the bank AC values are forced to zero to prevent
ambiguity of measurement.
With crosschecking, the relay can use different origins. See the Crosschecking setting for information regarding
automatic protection blocking possibilities on loss of one or both origins.
The two-phase origins in an AC bank must be of the same type and connected to the same electrical point in the
primary power system. The two origins must be two currents with the same CT settings, or two voltages with the same
VT settings. The current/voltage type of the phase and auxiliary origins must also match on each AC bank. It is intended
that the origin AC inputs measure the same primary quantity with the same ratio. The same ratio and connection
settings are applied to both origins.
5 Neutral Origin 1, 2
Range: None, RxSV1-CT1/NTR, RxSV1-VT1/ NTR to RxSV8-CT1/NTR, RxSV8-VT1/ NTR
Default: None
These settings specify the field units that are the origins of the auxiliary input IN or VN. Duplicate auxiliary origins are
supported in the same way as phase origins.
The two auxiliary origins in an AC bank must be of the same type. The two origins must be two currents with the same CT
secondary setting, or two voltages. The current/voltage type of the phase and auxiliary origins also must match on each
AC bank. It is intended that the origin AC inputs measure the same primary quantity with the same ratio. The same ratio
and connection settings are applied to both origins.
Crosschecking
Range: None, Depend Origin-1 Pref, Depend Origin-2 Pref
Default: None
The crosschecking feature allows application-level redundancy by checking between two independent SV streams from
the same electrical connection of the instrument transformers. In addition to the network redundancy provided by PRP/
HSR, the UR Process Bus Module allows the relay to communicate with redundant merging units.
When set to None, crosschecking is disabled. Use this on a non-protection-critical AC bank, such as one used for a
synchrocheck voltage. GE strongly recommends setting it to None when redundancy is not supported at the merging
unit level; otherwise the "ACBank# Orig1(2) In Use" operand status is inaccurate.
Origin preference is supported in case of discrepancy in dependability mode. This allows testing (secondary injection) or
replacement of an MU that is configured to non-preferred origin without affecting protection functions since these
functions are using a preferred origin stream when online. As such, dependability with Origin-1 preference allows
continued use of Origin-1 in case of discrepancy between both online origin stream sampled values. Similarly,
dependability with Origin-2 preference allows continued use of Origin-2 in case of discrepancy between both online
origin stream sampled values.
The table shows how the Crosschecking setting, the availability of AC bank origins, and discrepancy checks determine
whether protection is blocked. Blocked here means only protection elements. It does not inhibit metering, actual values,
oscillography, or other functions.
When set to Depend Origin-1 Pref, protection is blocked if there is no good signal from both the Origin-1 and Origin-2
sources. When both the merging unit sources are good, the preference is given always for Origin-1. When the preferred
MU sources fails, the alternate MU source is used for protection and measurement.
When set to Depend Origin-2 Pref, protection is blocked if there is no good signal from both the Origin-1 and Origin-2
sources. When both the merging unit sources are good, the preference is given always for Origin-2. When the preferred
MU sources fails, the alternate MU source is used for protection and measurement.
While switching from a preferred to non-preferred channel, the protection functions are delayed for two cycles.
While switching back to a preferred channel, the protection functions are delayed for one cycle.
SIGNAL SOURCES
Click the button to display or hide the fields. The first six Sources are the platform sources and can accept both current
banks and voltage banks and are associated with AC bank 1 to 6. The first six sources allow current summation for
phase and auxiliary CTs.
Recycle power to the relay when changing a source.
Name
Range: up to 20 alphanumeric characters
Default: SRC 1
This setting specifies an alphanumeric name for the source.
5 Phase CT
Range: None, B1, B2, B3, B4, B5, B6, B1+B2, ... B1+B2+B3+B4+B5+B6 or B7...B28
Default: None
This setting selects the phase CTs of an AC bank or the sum of the phase CTs of multiple AC banks to be the phase
current of the source. That is, it select the AC Banks section above in the window.
If you see the message "the AC Bank x assigned...is not configured..," it means that you need to configure the AC Banks
section in the software window before setting this field. The AC Bank selected can match the Origins fields and Sources,
such as a Phase CT set at B1 with Phase Origin 1 RxSV1-CT1/PHS and source SRC1. Another example is to use Phase CT
set at B2 with Phase Origin 1 RxSV2-CT1/PHS and source SRC2.
Ground CT
Range: None, B1, B2, B3, B4, B5, B6, B1+B2, ... B1+B2+B3+B4+B5+B6 or B7...B28
Default: None
This setting selects the ground CTs of an AC bank or the sum of the ground CTs of multiple AC banks to be the ground
current of the source. That is, it selects the AC Banks section above in the window.
Phase VT
Range: None, B1, B2, B3, B4, B5, B6
Default: None
This setting selects the phase VTs of an AC bank to be the phase voltages of the source.
Aux VT
Range: None, B1, B2, B3, B4, B5, B6
Default: None
This setting selects the auxiliary VT input of an AC bank to be the auxiliary voltage of the source.
Alt Phase CT
Range: None, B1, B2, B3, B4, B5, B6, B1+B2, ... B1+B2+B3+B4+B5+B6 or B7...B28
Default: None
This setting is for switching between main and alternate sources. It selects the alternate phase CTs of an AC bank or the
sum of the phase CTs of multiple AC banks to be the phase current of the source.
Alt Ground CT
Range: None, B1, B2, B3, B4, B5, B6, B1+B2, ... B1+B2+B3+B4+B5+B6 or B7...B28
Default: None
This setting is for switching between main and alternate sources. It selects the ground CTs of an AC bank or the sum of
the ground CTs of multiple AC banks to be the ground current of the source.
Switch Alt CT
Range: FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
This setting is for switching the alternate source on or off.
Alt Phase VT
Range: None, B1, B2, B3, B4, B5, B6
Default: None
This setting is for switching between main and alternate sources. It selects the phase VTs of an AC bank to be the phase
voltages of the source.
Alt Aux VT
Range: None, B1, B2, B3, B4, B5, B6
Default: None
This setting is for switching between main and alternate sources. It selects the auxiliary VT input of an AC bank to be the 5
auxiliary voltage of the source.
Switch Alt VT
Range: FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
This setting is for switching the alternate source on or off.
5.7 FlexLogic
5.7.1 FlexLogic operands
For flexibility, the arrangement of internal digital logic combines fixed and user-programmed parameters. Logic upon
which individual features are designed is fixed, and all other logic, from contact input signals through elements or
combinations of elements to contact outputs, is variable. The user has complete control of all variable logic through
FlexLogic. In general, the system receives analog and digital inputs that it uses to produce analog and digital outputs. The
figure shows major subsystems of a generic UR-series relay involved in this process.
CTs DSP
VTs (A/D) FlexLogic™ Virtual
equations outputs
Calculate
DCmA parameters Measuring
Analog and
or
input decision Digital Flags
RTD
(A/D) elements elements
inputs
V I
Contact Form-A and
inputs FlexLogic™ SCR only
Block counters
operation Contact
(each outputs
element)
Keypad
Virtual Remote
inputs (FlexLogic operands) outputs
OR
Remote Display
inputs Control and LEDs
(GOOSE) and Display
monitoring
features
fiber Analog
Direct output (D/A)
G.703 inputs
RS422 (dcmA)
5 (Status) Direct
outputs
Fiber
G.703
RS422
(Actual values) (Status)
827022A7.cdr
The states of all digital signals used in the M60 are represented by flags (or FlexLogic operands, which are described later
in this section). A digital “1” is represented by a set flag. Any external contact change-of-state can be used to block an
element from operating, as an input to a control feature in a FlexLogic equation, or to operate a contact output. The state
of the contact input can be displayed locally or viewed remotely via the communications facilities provided. If a simple
scheme where a contact input is used to block an element is wanted, this selection is made when programming the
element. This capability also applies to the other features that set flags: elements, virtual inputs, remote inputs, schemes,
and human operators.
If more complex logic than shown in the figure is required, it is implemented via FlexLogic. For example, to have the closed
state of contact input H7a and the operated state of the phase undervoltage element block the operation of the phase
time overcurrent element, the two control input states are programmed in a FlexLogic equation. This equation ANDs the
two control inputs to produce a virtual output that is then selected when programming the phase time overcurrent to be
used as a blocking input. Virtual outputs can only be created by FlexLogic equations.
Traditionally, protective relay logic has been relatively limited. Any unusual applications involving interlocks, blocking, or
supervisory functions had to be hard-wired using contact inputs and outputs. FlexLogic minimizes the requirement for
auxiliary components and wiring while making more complex schemes possible.
The logic that determines the interaction of inputs, elements, schemes, and outputs is field-programmable through the use
of logic equations that are sequentially processed. The use of virtual inputs and outputs in addition to hardware is
available internally and on the communication ports for other relays to use (distributed FlexLogic).
FlexLogic allows users to customize the relay through a series of equations that consist of operators and operands. The
operands are the states of inputs, elements, schemes, and outputs. The operators are logic gates, timers, and latches (with
set and reset inputs). A system of sequential operations allows any combination of operands to be assigned as inputs to
specified operators to create an output. The final output of an equation is a numbered register called a virtual output.
Virtual outputs can be used as an input operand in any equation, including the equation that generates the output, as a
seal-in or other type of feedback.
A FlexLogic equation consists of parameters that are either operands or operators. Operands have a logic state of 1 or 0.
Operators provide a defined function, such as an AND gate or a Timer. Each equation defines the combinations of
parameters to be used to set a Virtual Output flag. Evaluation of an equation results in either a 1 (=ON, or flag set) or 0
(=OFF, or flag not set). Each equation is evaluated at least four times every power system cycle.
Some types of operands are present in the relay in multiple instances, for example contact and remote inputs. These types
of operands are grouped together (for presentation purposes only) on the front panel display. The table lists characteristics
of the different types of operands.
Table 5-21: M60 FlexLogic operand types
Operand type State Example of format Characteristics
[Input Is ‘1’ (= ON) if...]
Contact Input On Cont Ip On Voltage is applied presently to the input (external contact
closed)
Off Cont Ip Off Voltage is not applied presently to the input (external
contact open)
Contact Output Contact Closed Cont Op 1 Closed Contact output is closed
(type Form-A contact
Current On Cont Op 1 Ion Current is flowing through the contact
only)
Voltage On Cont Op 1 VOn Voltage exists across the contact
Voltage Off Cont Op 1 VOff Voltage does not exist across the contact
Direct Input On DIRECT INPUT 1 On The direct input is presently in the ON state
Element Pickup PHASE TOC1 PKP The tested parameter is presently above the pickup setting
(Analog) of an element that responds to rising values or below the
pickup setting of an element that responds to falling values
5
Dropout PHASE TOC1 DPO This operand is the logical inverse of the above PKP
operand
Operate PHASE TOC1 OP The tested parameter has been above/below the pickup
setting of the element for the programmed delay time, or
has been at logic 1 and is now at logic 0 but the reset timer
has not finished timing
Block PHASE TOC1 BLK The output of the comparator is set to the block function
Element Pickup Dig Element 1 PKP The input operand is at logic 1
(Digital)
Dropout Dig Element 1 DPO This operand is the logical inverse of the above PKP
operand
Operate Dig Element 1 OP The input operand has been at logic 1 for the programmed
pickup delay time, or has been at logic 1 for this period and
is now at logic 0 but the reset timer has not finished timing
Element Higher than Counter 1 HI The number of pulses counted is above the set number
(Digital Counter)
Equal to Counter 1 EQL The number of pulses counted is equal to the set number
Lower than Counter 1 LO The number of pulses counted is below the set number
Fixed On On Logic 1
Off Off Logic 0
RxGOOSE Boolean On RxGOOSE Boolean 1 On The RxGOOSE Boolean is presently in the ON state
Virtual Input On Virt Ip 1 On The virtual input is presently in the ON state
Virtual Output On Virt Op 1 On The virtual output is presently in the set state (that is,
evaluation of the equation that produces this virtual output
results in a "1")
The following table lists the operands available for the relay. The operands can be viewed online by entering the IP address
of the relay in a web browser and accessing the Device Information Menu.
5 LED PHASE C
LED NEUTRAL/GROUND
Asserted when phase C involved and to turn PHASE C LED on
Asserted when a neutral or ground element involved and to turn NEUTRAL/
GROUND LED on
LED INDICATORS: LED IN SERVICE Asserted when the front panel IN SERVICE LED is on
Graphical front panel LED TROUBLE Asserted when the front panel TROUBLE LED is on
LED TEST MODE Asserted when the front panel TEST MODE LED is on
LED TRIP Asserted when the front panel TRIP LED is on
LED ALARM Asserted when the front panel ALARM LED is on
LED PICKUP Asserted when an element picks up and to turn Event Cause LED 1 on by
default
LED VOLTAGE Asserted when a voltage element involved and to turn Event Cause LED 2 on
by default
LED CURRENT Asserted when a current element involved and to turn Event Cause LED 3 on
by default
LED FREQUENCY Asserted when a frequency element involved and to turn Event Cause LED 4
on by default
LED OTHER Asserted when a composite element involved and to turn Event Cause LED 5
on by default
LED PHASE A Asserted when phase A involved and to turn Event Cause LED 6 on by default
LED PHASE B Asserted when phase B involved and to turn Event Cause LED 7 on by default
LED PHASE C Asserted when phase C involved and to turn Event Cause LED 8 on by default
LED NEUTRAL/GROUND Asserted when a neutral or ground element involved and to turn Event Cause
LED 9 on by default
LED INDICATORS: LED TEST IN PROGRESS An LED test has been initiated and has not finished
LED test
LED INDICATORS: LED USER 1 Asserted when user-programmable LED 1 is on
User-programmable
LEDs
Enhanced and basic
front panels
LED USER 2 to 48 The operand above is available for user-programmable LEDs 2 through 48
LED INDICATORS: EVENT CAUSE LED 1 Asserted when event cause LED 1 is on
User-programmable
EVENT CAUSE LED 2 to 9 Same operand as EVENT CAUSE LED 1
LEDs
Graphical front panel
5 PB CLOCK UNSYCHRONIZED
deviation is below 100 micro seconds.
Process Bus Module clock is free-running, that is, when both PTP
grandmaster clock on Process Bus Module and one pulse per second (PPS)
from main CPU are not available. Resets when any of the references is
available.
SIMULATION TxGOOSE SIM ON Sim bit enabled in all Tx GOOSE
IED IN SIM MODE Relay is in simulation mode and accepts simulated GOOSE and SV values
TEMPERATURE TEMP MONITOR Asserted while the ambient temperature is greater than the maximum
MONITOR operating temperature (80°C)
USER- PUSHBUTTON 1 ON Pushbutton number 1 is in the “On” position
PROGRAMMABLE PUSHBUTTON 1 OFF Pushbutton number 1 is in the “Off” position
PUSHBUTTONS ANY PB ON Any of 12 pushbuttons is in the “On” position
PUSHBUTTON 2 to 6, 12, 16, or 48 Same set of operands as PUSHBUTTON 1
depending on front panel
Some operands can be re-named. These are the names of the breakers in the breaker control feature, the ID (identification)
of contact inputs and outputs, the ID of virtual inputs, and the ID of virtual outputs. If the user changes the default name or
ID of any of these operands, the assigned name appears in the relay list of operands. The default names are shown in the
FlexLogic operands table.
The characteristics of the logic gates are tabulated in the following table, and the operators available in FlexLogic are listed
in the FlexLogic operators table.
Table 5-23: FlexLogic gate characteristics
Gates Number of inputs Output is ‘1’ (= ON) if...
NOT 1 input is ‘0’
OR 2 to 16 any input is ‘1’
AND 2 to 16 all inputs are ‘1’
NOR 2 to 16 all inputs are ‘0’
NAND 2 to 16 any input is ‘0’
XOR 2 only one input is ‘1’
FlexLogic provides built-in latches that by definition have a memory action, remaining in the set state after the set
input has been asserted. These built-in latches are reset dominant, meaning that if logical "1" is applied to both set
and reset entries simultaneously, then the output of the latch is logical "0." However, they are volatile, meaning that
they reset upon removal of control power.
When making changes to FlexLogic entries in the settings, all FlexLogic equations are re-compiled whenever any
new FlexLogic entry value is entered, and as a result of the re-compile all latches are reset automatically.
To implement FlexLogic using a graphical user interface, see the FlexLogic Design and Monitoring using Engineer
section in the previous chapter.
9LUWXDORXWSXW
VWDWH 2Q
5 9LUWXDORXWSXW
6HW
VWDWH 2Q
/DWFK
9LUWXDOLQSXW 25 5HVHW
VWDWH 2Q
;25
'LJLWDOHOHPHQW 7LPHU
VWDWH 3LFNXS 7LPH'HOD\ 2SHUDWHRXWSXW
25
RQGURSRXW UHOD\+
'LJLWDOHOHPHQW 7LPHU
PV
VWDWH 2SHUDWHG 7LPHGHOD\
$1' RQSLFNXS
PV
&RQWDFWLQSXW+F
VWDWH &ORVHG
$&'5
1. Inspect the example logic diagram to determine if the required logic can be implemented with the FlexLogic
operators. If this is not possible, the logic must be altered until this condition is satisfied. Once done, count the inputs
to each gate to verify that the number of inputs does not exceed the FlexLogic limits, which is unlikely but possible. If
the number of inputs is too high, subdivide the inputs into multiple gates to produce an equivalent. For example, if 25
inputs to an AND gate are required, connect Inputs 1 through 16 to AND(16), 17 through 25 to AND(9), and the outputs
from these two gates to AND(2).
Inspect each operator between the initial operands and final virtual outputs to determine if the output from the
operator is used as an input to more than one following operator. If so, the operator output must be assigned as a
virtual output.
For the example shown, the output of the AND gate is used as an input to both OR#1 and Timer 1, and must therefore
be made a virtual output and assigned the next available number (that is, Virtual Output 3). The final output must also
be assigned to a virtual output as virtual output 4, which is programmed in the contact output section to operate relay
H1 (that is, contact output H1).
Therefore, the required logic can be implemented with two FlexLogic equations with outputs of virtual output 3 and
virtual output 4, shown as follows.
Virtual output 1
state = On
Virtual output 2
Set
state = On
Latch
OR #1 Reset
Virtual input 1
state = On Timer 2
XOR Time delay
Digital element 1 OR #2 Virtual output 4
on dropout
state = Pickup
(200 ms)
827026A2.CDR
2. Prepare a logic diagram for the equation to produce virtual output 3, as this output is used as an operand in the virtual
output 4 equation (create the equation for every output that is used as an operand first, so that when these operands
are required they already have been evaluated and assigned to a specific virtual output). The logic for virtual output 3
is shown as follows with the final output assigned.
Figure 5-102: Logic for virtual output 3
Digital element 2 5
state= Operated
3. Prepare a logic diagram for virtual output 4, replacing the logic ahead of virtual output 3 with a symbol identified as
virtual output 3, shown as follows.
Figure 5-103: Logic for virtual output 4
9LUWXDORXWSXW
VWDWH 2Q
9LUWXDORXWSXW
6HW
VWDWH 2Q
/DWFK
25 5HVHW
9LUWXDOLQSXW
VWDWH 2Q 7LPHU
;25 7LPHGHOD\
25 9LUWXDORXWSXW
'LJLWDOHOHPHQW RQGURSRXW
VWDWH 3LFNXS
PV
7LPHU
9LUWXDORXWSXW 7LPHGHOD\
VWDWH 2Q RQSLFNXS
PV
&RQWDFWLQSXW+F
VWDWH &ORVHG
$&'5
4. Program the FlexLogic equation for virtual output 3 by translating the logic into available FlexLogic parameters. The
equation is formed one parameter at a time until the required logic is complete. It is generally easier to start at the
output end of the equation and work back towards the input, as shown in the following steps. It is also recommended
to list operator inputs from bottom to top. For demonstration, the final outputs are arbitrarily identified as parameter
99, and each preceding parameter decremented by one in turn. Until accustomed to using FlexLogic, it is suggested
that a worksheet with a series of cells marked with the arbitrary parameter numbers be prepared shown as follows.
Figure 5-104: FlexLogic worksheet
01
02
03
04
05
.....
97
98
99
827029A1.VSD
FlexLogic entry:
95
Dig Element 2 (DE2) OP
AND Virtual output 3
FlexLogic entry:
96
Cont Ip 2 On (H1c)
FlexLogic entry:
97
NOT
FlexLogic entry:
98
AND (2)
FlexLogic entry:
99
= Virt Op 3 (VO3)
827030A2.CDR
6. Repeating the process described for virtual output 3, select the FlexLogic parameters for Virtual Output 4.
– 99: The final output of the equation is virtual output 4, which is parameter “= Virt Op 4".
– 98: The operator preceding the output is timer 2, which is operand “TIMER 2". Note that the settings required for
the timer are established in the timer programming section.
– 97: The operator preceding timer 2 is OR #2, a 3-input OR, which is parameter “OR(3)”.
– 96: The lowest input to OR #2 is operand “Cont Ip H1c On”.
– 95: The center input to OR #2 is operand “TIMER 1".
– 94: The input to timer 1 is operand “Virt Op 3 On".
– 93: The upper input to OR #2 is operand “LATCH (S,R)”.
– 92: There are two inputs to a latch, and the input immediately preceding the latch reset is OR #1, a 4-input OR,
which is parameter “OR(4)”.
– 91: The lowest input to OR #1 is operand “Virt Op 3 On".
– 90: The input just above the lowest input to OR #1 is operand “XOR(2)”. 5
– 89: The lower input to the XOR is operand “DIG ELEM 1 PKP”.
– 88: The upper input to the XOR is operand “Virt Ip 1 On".
– 87: The input just below the upper input to OR #1 is operand “Virt Op 2 On".
– 86: The upper input to OR #1 is operand “Virt Op 1 On".
– 85: The last parameter is used to set the latch, and is operand “Virt Op 4 On".
The equation for virtual output 4 is:
[85] Virt Op 4 On
[86] Virt Op 1 On
[87] Virt Op 2 On
[88] Virt Ip 1 On
[89] DIG ELEM 1 PKP
[90] XOR(2)
[91] Virt Op 3 On
[92] OR(4)
[93] LATCH (S,R)
[94] Virt Op 3 On
[95] TIMER 1
[96] Cont Ip H1c On
[97] OR(3)
[98] TIMER 2
[99] = Virt Op 4
Now check that the selection of parameters produce the required logic by converting the set of parameters into a
logic diagram. The result is shown in the figure, which is compared to the logic for virtual output 4 diagram as a check.
5 7. Now write the complete FlexLogic expression required to implement the logic, making an effort to assemble the
equation in an order where Virtual Outputs that are used as inputs to operators are created before needed. In cases
where a lot of processing is required to perform logic, this can be difficult to achieve, but in most cases does not cause
problems as all logic is calculated at least four times per power frequency cycle. The possibility of a problem caused
by sequential processing emphasizes the necessity to test the performance of FlexLogic before it is placed in service.
In the following equation, virtual output 3 is used as an input to both latch 1 and timer 1 as arranged in the following
order:
DIG ELEM 2 OP
Cont Ip H1c On
NOT
AND(2)
= Virt Op 3
Virt Op 4 On
Virt Op 1 On
Virt Op 2 On
Virt Ip 1 On
DIG ELEM 1 PKP
XOR(2)
Virt Op 3 On
OR(4)
LATCH (S,R)
Virt Op 3 On
TIMER 1
Cont Ip H1c On
OR(3)
TIMER 2
= Virt Op 4
END
In this expression, the virtual output 4 input to the four-input OR is listed before it is created. This is typical of a form of
feedback, in this case, used to create a seal-in effect with the latch, and is correct.
8. Always test the logic after it is loaded into the relay, in the same way as has been used in the past. Testing can be
simplified by placing an "END" operator within the overall set of FlexLogic equations. The equations are evaluated up
There are 1,024 FlexLogic entries available, numbered from 1 to 1024, with default END entry settings. If a "Disabled"
element is selected as a FlexLogic entry, the associated state flag is never set to ‘1’. Press the +/– key when editing
FlexLogic equations to quickly scan through the major parameter types.
There are 64 identical FlexLogic timers available. These timers are used as operators for FlexLogic equations.
TIMER 1 TYPE — Selects the time measurement unit.
TIMER 1 PICKUP DELAY — Sets the time delay to pickup. If a pickup delay is not required, set this function to "0."
TIMER 1 DROPOUT DELAY — Sets the time delay to dropout. If a dropout delay is not required, set this function to "0."
5.7.7 FlexElements
SETTINGS FLEXLOGIC FLEXELEMENTS FLEXELEMENT 1(16)
FLEXELEMENT 1 FLEXELEMENT 1 Range: Disabled, Enabled
FUNCTION: Disabled
A FlexElement is a universal comparator used to monitor any analog actual value calculated by the relay or a net
difference of any two analog actual values of the same type. The effective operating signal can be treated as a signed
number or its absolute value can be used.
FlexElements run every half power cycle (every four protection passes).
5 The element can be programmed to respond either to a signal level or to a rate-of-change (delta) over a pre-defined period
of time. The output operand is asserted when the operating signal is higher than a threshold or lower than a threshold, as
per your choice.
Figure 5-107: FlexElement logic
6(77,1*
6(77,1*
)/(;(/(0(17
)81&7,21 )/(;(/(0(17,1387
02'(
(QDEOHG )/(;(/(0(17&203
02'(
)/(;(/(0(17
',5(&7,21
6(77,1*
)/(;(/(0(173,&.83
)/(;(/(0(17%/. )/(;(/(0(17,1387
$1' +<67(5(6,6
2II
)/(;(/(0(17GW81,7 6(77,1*
6(77,1* )/(;(/(0(173.3
)/(;(/(0(17GW '(/$<
)/(;(/(0(17,1 )/(;(/(0(17567
581 '(/$<
$FWXDO9DOXH )/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
W3.3
)/(;(/(0(17,1 )[(23
W567
$FWXDO9DOXH )[('32
)[(3.3
$&78$/9$/8(
)OH[(OHPHQW2S6LJ
$&'5
FLEXELEMENT 1 +IN — This setting specifies the first (non-inverted) input to the FlexElement. Zero is assumed as the input if
this setting is set to “Off.” For proper operation of the element, at least one input must be selected. Otherwise, the element
does not assert its output operands.
FLEXELEMENT 1 –IN — Specifies the second (inverted) input to the FlexElement. Zero is assumed as the input if this setting is
set to “Off.” For proper operation of the element, at least one input must be selected. Otherwise, the element does not
assert its output operands. This input is used to invert the signal if needed for convenience, or to make the element
respond to a differential signal, such as for a top-bottom oil temperature differential alarm. The element does not operate
if the two input signals are of different types, for example if one tries to use active power and phase angle to build the
effective operating signal.
The element responds directly to the differential signal if the FLEXELEMENT 1 INPUT MODE setting is set to “Signed” The
element responds to the absolute value of the differential signal if this setting is set to “Absolute.” Sample applications for
the “Absolute” setting include monitoring the angular difference between two phasors with a symmetrical limit angle in
both directions, monitoring power regardless of its direction, or monitoring a trend.
The element responds directly to its operating signal—as defined by the FLEXELEMENT 1 +IN, FLEXELEMENT 1 –IN and
FLEXELEMENT 1 INPUT MODE settings—if the FLEXELEMENT 1 COMP MODE setting is set to “Level.” The element responds to the
rate of change of its operating signal if the FLEXELEMENT 1 COMP MODE setting is set to “Delta.” In this case, the FLEXELEMENT
1 dt UNIT and FLEXELEMENT 1 dt settings specify how the rate of change is derived.
FLEXELEMENT 1 DIRECTION — Enables the relay to respond to either high or low values of the operating signal. The following
figure explains the application of the FLEXELEMENT 1 DIRECTION, FLEXELEMENT 1 PICKUP, and FLEXELEMENT 1 HYSTERESIS
settings.
Figure 5-108: FlexElement direction, pickup, and hysteresis
)/(;(/(0(173.3
)/(;(/(0(17
',5(&7,21 2YHU
5
3,&.83 +<67(5(6,6 RI3,&.83
)OH[(OHPHQW 6LJ2S
)/(;(/(0(173.3
)/(;(/(0(17
',5(&7,21 8QGHU
+<67(5(6,6 RI3,&.83
)OH[(OHPHQW 6LJ2S
3,&.83
$&'5
In conjunction with the FLEXELEMENT 1 INPUT MODE setting, the element can be programmed to provide two extra
characteristics, as shown in the following figure.
)/(;(/(0(173.3
)/(;(/(0(17
',5(&7,21 2YHU
)/(;(/(0(17,1387
02'( 6LJQHG
)OH[(OHPHQW2S6LJ
)/(;(/(0(173.3
)/(;(/(0(17
',5(&7,21 2YHU
)/(;(/(0(17,1387
02'( $EVROXWH
)OH[(OHPHQW2S6LJ
)/(;(/(0(173.3
)/(;(/(0(17
',5(&7,21 8QGHU
5 )/(;(/(0(17,1387
02'( 6LJQHG
)OH[(OHPHQW2S6LJ
)/(;(/(0(173.3
)/(;(/(0(17
',5(&7,21 8QGHU
)/(;(/(0(17,1387
02'( $EVROXWH
)OH[(OHPHQW2S6LJ
$&'5
FLEXELEMENT 1 PICKUP — This setting specifies the operating threshold for the effective operating signal of the element. If
set to “Over,” the element picks up when the operating signal exceeds the FLEXELEMENT 1 PICKUP value. If set to “Under,” the
element picks up when the operating signal falls below the FLEXELEMENT 1 PICKUP value.
When using FlexElements for Voltage Elements, 1 pu is always equal to phase to ground voltage nominal secondary
voltage, even if you select a phase to phase voltage as an operating quantity.
FLEXELEMENT 1 HYSTERESIS — This setting controls the element dropout. Notice that both the operating signal and the
pickup threshold can be negative, facilitating applications such as reverse power alarm protection. The FlexElement can be
programmed to work with all analog actual values measured by the relay. The FLEXELEMENT 1 PICKUP setting is entered in
per-unit values using the following definitions of the base units.
Table 5-25: FlexElement base units
Unit Description
BREAKER ACC ARCING AMPS BASE = 2000 kA2 cycle
(Brk X Acc Arc Amp A, B, and C)
Unit Description
BREAKER ARCING AMPS BASE = 1 kA2 cycle
(Brk X Arc Amp A, B, and C)
CURRENT UNBALANCE BASE = 100%
(Amp Unbalance)
DCmA BASE = maximum value of the DCMA INPUT MAX setting for the two transducers configured
under the +IN and –IN inputs
DELTA TIME BASE = 1 µs
FREQUENCY fBASE = 1 Hz
PHASE ANGLE BASE = 360 degrees (see the UR angle referencing convention)
POWER FACTOR PFBASE = 1.00
RTDs BASE = 100°C
SENSITIVE DIR POWER PBASE = maximum value of 3 VBASE IBASE for the +IN and –IN inputs of the sources configured
(Sns Dir Power) for the sensitive power directional element(s).
SOURCE CURRENT IBASE = maximum nominal primary RMS value of the +IN and –IN inputs
SOURCE ENERGY EBASE = 10000 MWh or MVAh, respectively
(Positive and Negative Watthours,
Positive and Negative Varhours)
SOURCE POWER PBASE = maximum value of VBASE IBASE for the +IN and –IN inputs
SOURCE VOLTAGE VBASE = maximum nominal primary RMS value of the +IN and –IN inputs
STATOR DIFFERENTIAL CURRENT IBASE = maximum primary RMS value of the +IN and –IN inputs
(Stator Diff Iar, Ibr, and Icr) (CT primary for source currents, and bus reference primary current for bus differential currents)
STATOR RESTRAINING CURRENT IBASE = maximum primary RMS value of the +IN and –IN inputs
(Stator Diff Iad, Ibd, and Icd) (CT primary for source currents, and bus reference primary current for bus differential currents)
THERMAL MODEL
(Model Capacity Used)
BASE =100%
5
(Model Motor Unbalance)
THERMAL MODEL BASE = 10 minutes
(Model Lockout Time)
THERMAL MODEL BASE = 1.00 pu of FLA
(Thermal Model Load)
(Biased Motor Load)
THERMAL MODEL BASE = 10 seconds
(Trip Time on Overload)
FLEXELEMENT 1 HYSTERESIS — This setting defines the pickup–dropout relation of the element by specifying the width of the
hysteresis loop as a percentage of the pickup value as shown in the FlexElement Direction, Pickup, and Hysteresis diagram.
FLEXELEMENT 1 dt UNIT — Specifies the time unit for the setting FLEXELEMENT 1 dt. This setting is applicable only if
FLEXELEMENT 1 COMP MODE is set to “Delta.”
FLEXELEMENT 1 dt — Specifies duration of the time interval for the rate of change mode of operation. This setting is
applicable only if FLEXELEMENT 1 COMP MODE is set to “Delta.”
FLEXELEMENT 1 PKP DELAY — Specifies the pickup delay of the element.
FLEXELEMENT 1 RST DELAY — Specifies the reset delay of the element.
The non-volatile latches provide a permanent logical flag that is stored safely and do not reset upon restart after the relay
is powered down. Typical applications include sustaining operator commands or permanently blocking relay functions,
such as Autorecloser, until a deliberate interface action resets the latch.
LATCH 1 TYPE — This setting characterizes Latch 1 to be Set- or Reset-dominant.
LATCH 1 SET — If asserted, the specified FlexLogic operands 'sets' Latch 1.
LATCH 1 RESET — If asserted, the specified FlexLogic operand 'resets' Latch 1.
/$7&+)81&7,21 /$7&+7<3(
(QDEOHG 581
6(77,1*
/$7&+6(7
5 2II 6(7
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
/$7&+21
/$7&+2))
6(77,1*
/$7&+5(6(7
Each of the six setting group menus is identical. Setting group 1 (the default active group) is active automatically when no
other group is active.
If the device incorrectly switches to group 1 after power cycling, upgrade the firmware to version 7.31 or later to correct
this issue.
5.8.3 Motor
5.8.3.1 Menu
SETTINGS GROUPED ELEMENTS SETTING GROUP 1(6) MOTOR
MOTOR ACCELERATION See below
TIME
AMP UNBALANCE 2
Many motors have a large time margin between acceleration-time and the stall limit. It is advantageous to detect stalling
during a start as early as possible to minimize re-starting delays once the cause of the stall is remedied, for example
neglecting to release a fan brake.
The acceleration time element compares actual starting time with a pre-determined time setting and operates when it is
exceeded. This element has the functionality to adapt the tripping time for starts with lower starting current, and it stores
acceleration time and current of the last five starts. The element uses currents configured under SYSTEM SETUP MOTOR
MOTOR LINE SOURCE and motor status asserted by the thermal model element. Both the signal source and thermal
protection must be configured properly in order for the acceleration time protection to operate.
The following figure shows examples of constant and variable acceleration currents and explains measurement of the
acceleration time and current. Part A represents a constant current start, and part B represents a variable current start.
The element stores the basic statistics for the last five successful starts. The following values are retained, available for
display, and accessible via communications: date and time of starting; acceleration time (in seconds); effective
acceleration current (in multiplies of FLC); and peak acceleration current (in multiplies of FLC). Recorded effective
acceleration current and time can be used to fine-tune the relay settings.
$&&(/&855(17
L
L
L
L
FXUUHQW
FXUUHQW
L L LQ
$&&(/ &855(17
Q
L
)/$[6(59,&()$&725 )/$[6(59,&()$&725
D E
(## !$1!34B
ACCELERATION CURRENT — This setting is only used in the Adaptive mode. It defines a constant current that accelerates the
motor within the normal acceleration time. The setting is used to adapt the tripping action when the current is changing
significantly during the start, such as due to voltage dips.
ACCELERATION TIME — This setting specifies the maximum acceleration time. If the motor is not in the running state when
this time expires, the element operates. This setting can be estimated experimentally by starting a given motor several
times under various load and electrical conditions and measuring the starting time. Also apply a security margin.
ACCELERATION MODE — This setting defines the operating mode of the acceleration time element. When set to “Definite 5
Time,” the element times duration of the motor start and operates when the starting time exceeds the ACCELERATION TIME
setting. When set to “Adaptive,” the element uses the effective accelerating current to adapt to the starting conditions. The
operating equation assumes that the accelerating power is proportional to the square of the current and neglects any
current unbalance or impact of the rotor slip. Consequently, in the adaptive mode, the element operates when the square
of the current integrated from the beginning of the start up to a given time exceeds
(Acceleration Current)2 x Acceleration Time.
Figure 5-112: Acceleration time logic
6(77,1*6
$&&(/(5$7,21
)81&7,21
(QDEOHG
$&&(/(5$7,21%/2&.
2II $1'
027252))/,1(
2Q
6(77,1* 6(77,1*6
$&&&(/(5$7,2102'( $&&(/(5$7,217,0(
'HILQLWH7LPH $&&(/(5$7,21
&855(17
$GDSWLYH 'HILQLWH7LPH
581
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1'6
0272567$57,1*
027255811,1*
$&'5
The thermal model is the primary protective function of the relay. It consists of the following five key functions:
• Thermal model curve (overload)
• Overload pickup level
• Unbalance biasing of the motor current while the motor is running
• Motor cooling time constants
• Biasing of the thermal model based on hot/cold information and/or measured stator temperature
The algorithm integrates both stator and rotor heating into a single model. The motor heating level is maintained in the
thermal capacity used register. When the motor has been stopped for a long time, it is at ambient temperature and
thermal capacity used is zero. When the motor is in overload, the output operand is set once the thermal capacity used
reaches 100%.
Once the motor load current exceeds the overload level (FLA x overload factor), it enters an overload phase; that is, the
heat accumulation becomes greater than the heat dissipation. The M60 thermal model reacts by incrementing the
thermal capacity used (TCU) at a rate dependent on the selected thermal curve and overload level. When the thermal
capacity reaches 100%, the MOTOR THERMAL OP operand (typically configured to trip the motor) is set. This operand
remains asserted until TCU decays to the level that permits a new motor start. For details, see the description of the START 5
INHIBIT TCU MARGIN setting in this section.
THERMAL MODEL CURVE — The thermal model curve determines the thermal limit overload conditions that can damage the
motor. This curve accounts for motor heating in both the stator and rotor during stall, acceleration, and running conditions.
The overload curve can take one of the following six formats: Motor, FlexCurve A, FlexCurve B, FlexCurve C, FlexCurve D, or
IEC. The selected curve can also serve as a base for a voltage dependent overload curve if the VOLTAGE DEPENDENT
FUNCTION setting is “Enabled.” The algorithm uses memory in the form of a register called Thermal Capacity Used. This
register is updated every power cycle using the following equation:
1 e f (in ms)
TC used t = TC used (t – 1) + ---------------------------- u 100% Eq. 5-7
time_to_trip
where time_to_trip represents the time coordinate on the time-current overload curve, corresponding to the equivalent
motor current detected within any power cycle period of motor overload. Always set the overload curve slightly lower
than the thermal limits provided by the motor manufacturer. This ensures that the motor is tripped before the thermal limit
is reached.
The “Motor” curve is based on typical motor thermal limit curves and is normally used for standard motor applications (see
the Standard Motor Curves figure and Standard Curve Multipliers table that follow). The pickup level for the “Motor” curve is
calculated as MOTOR OVERLOAD FACTOR setting (OF) times the MOTOR FULL LOAD AMPS setting (FLA). The MOTOR FULL LOAD
AMPS (FLA) setting can be found in the SYSTEM SETUP MOTOR menu.
5 4.50
4.75
4.54
4.06
9.08
8.11
13.63
12.17
18.17
16.22
22.71
20.28
27.25
24.33
31.80
28.39
36.34
32.44
40.88
36.50
45.42
40.55
49.97
44.61
54.51
48.66
59.05
52.72
63.59
56.77
68.14
60.83
5.00 3.64 7.29 10.93 14.57 18.22 21.86 25.50 29.15 32.79 36.43 40.08 43.72 47.36 51.01 54.65
5.50 2.99 5.98 8.97 11.96 14.95 17.94 20.93 23.91 26.90 29.89 32.88 35.87 38.86 41.85 44.84
6.00 2.50 5.00 7.49 9.99 12.49 14.99 17.49 19.99 22.48 24.98 27.48 29.98 32.48 34.97 37.47
6.50 2.12 4.24 6.36 8.48 10.60 12.72 14.84 16.96 19.08 21.20 23.32 25.44 27.55 29.67 31.79
7.00 1.82 3.64 5.46 7.29 9.11 10.93 12.75 14.57 16.39 18.21 20.04 21.86 23.68 25.50 27.32
7.50 1.58 3.16 4.75 6.33 7.91 9.49 11.08 12.66 14.24 15.82 17.41 18.99 20.57 22.15 23.74
8.00 1.39 2.78 4.16 5.55 6.94 8.33 9.71 11.10 12.49 13.88 15.27 16.65 18.04 19.43 20.82
10.00 1.39 2.78 4.16 5.55 6.94 8.33 9.71 11.10 12.49 13.88 15.27 16.65 18.04 19.43 20.82
15.00 1.39 2.78 4.16 5.55 6.94 8.33 9.71 11.10 12.49 13.88 15.27 16.65 18.04 19.43 20.82
20.00 1.39 2.78 4.16 5.55 6.94 8.33 9.71 11.10 12.49 13.88 15.27 16.65 18.04 19.43 20.82
If “IEC” is selected as the thermal model curve, the M60 can apply the IEC 255-8 hot and cold curve characteristics to the
thermal model. The M60 evaluates the thermal capacity at motor start and chooses the appropriate curve. The hot curve
characteristic is applied when the thermal capacity is greater than or equal to 5% (that is, a point above where the motor
is not at complete rest, or cold). Otherwise, the cold curve characteristic is applied.
The IEC255-8 cold curve trip time is defined as follows:
§ 2 ·
I
t = W u ln ¨ ---------------------------
-¸ Eq. 5-8
© I – k u I b 2¹
2
where
t = time to trip
τ = IEC time constant defined by IEC CURVE TIME CONSTANT setting
I = measured motor load current
Ip = Motor load current before overload occurs
k = k-factor (overload factor) defined by IEC CURVE k FACTOR setting applied to Ib
Ib = Motor rated current specified by the MOTOR FULL LOAD AMPS setting
IEC CURVE k FACTOR — This setting applies only to the IEC motor curve and is applied as described in the THERMAL MODEL
CURVE setting description. See the IEC 255-8 standard for details on its application.
IEC CURVE TIME CONSTANT — This setting specifies the thermal time constant for IEC motor curves in the previous equations
per the IEC 255-8 standard. When the IEC motor curves are selected, the M60 calculates the time to trip using the IEC255-
8 cold curve and IEC255-8 hot curve equations and increases thermal capacity used as defined by the thermal capacity
used equation earlier. If the overload disappears or the motor is tripped (stopped), then the thermal capacity used
decreases as per the following equations to simulate motor cooling, depending on the motor status and the values
programmed for the COOL TIME CONSTANT RUNNING and COOL TIME CONSTANT STOPPED settings.
If the IEC curve is selected, then the following applies:
• For two-speed motor applications, the IEC CURVE k FACTOR and IEC CURVE TIME CONSTANT settings are used at both
speeds
• Voltage dependent overload curves are not applicable
• The motor status is evaluated using motor FLA (Ib) and the IEC CURVE k FACTOR setting
THERMAL MODEL CURVE EFFECT — This setting affects the time-to-trip thermal curves when the THERMAL MODEL CURVE is
selected as “Motor.” This setting takes into account the design of the machine with respect to overload capability as
determined by the overload (service) factor. For motor designs where temperature rise above ambient is based on full load
current, select this setting as “Cutoff.” The time to trip is then calculated using the following equation.
TD u 2.2116623
trip time = ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
5
I motor 2 I motor
0.02530337 u © ------------- – 1·¹ + 0.05054758 u §© ------------
§ - – 1·¹ Eq. 5-10
FLA FLA
In the equation, the motor stator current (Imotor) and motor rated current (FLA) are expressed in per units of relay current.
For specialized motor designs where temperature rise above ambient is based on the product of the service factor and full
load current (OF × FLA), select “Shifted” for this setting. The time to trip is then calculated using the following equation.
TD u 2.2116623
trip time = -----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
I 2 I motor
0.02530337 u § -------------------- – 1· + 0.05054758 u § -------------------
motor
- – 1· Eq. 5-11
© OF u FLA ¹ © OF u FLA ¹
In the equation, the motor stator current (Imotor) and motor rated current (FLA) are expressed in per units of relay current.
In case of uncertainty, use the more conservative “Cutoff” value.
The following figure illustrates the impact of this setting on the time to trip thermal curves.
1000
Trip time (seconds)
100
5 1
0 5 8
Stator current (multiples of FLA)
THERMAL MODEL TD MULTIPLIER — This multiplier is used to shift the overload curve on the time axis to create a family of the
different curves. The TD multiplier value is used to select the curve that best matches the thermal characteristics of the
protected motor.
If thermal model curve is selected as “Motor,” then the THERMAL MODEL TD MULTIPLIER can be specified between “1.00” and
“15.00” as indicated in the following Standard Motor Curves diagram.
10000
1000
Time To Trip in Seconds
100
x15
10
x1
1.00
0.10 1.00 10 100
833003A2.CDR
During the interval of discontinuity, the longer of the two trip times is used to reduce the chance of nuisance tripping
during motor starts.
In some applications, the shape of the motor thermal damage curve substantially deviates from the standard.
Furthermore, the characteristics of the starting (locked rotor and acceleration) and running thermal damage curves may
not correspond smoothly. In these cases, it can be necessary to use a custom curve so the motor can be started
successfully and used to its full potential without compromising protection. For these conditions, it is recommended that
the FlexCurves be used. FlexCurves allows the user to program selected trip times for pre-determined current levels. As
seen in the following figure, if the running (2) and the locked rotor thermal limit curves were smoothed into one standard
overload curve, the motor cannot start at 80% line voltage. A custom curve (1) is required.
For high inertia load applications (when the VOLTAGE DEPENDENT FUNCTION is enabled), the locked rotor thermal limit
section of the programmed motor or the FlexCurve overload curve is modified and becomes dynamically adaptive to
system voltage changes. This function is explained later in this section.
1000
5 Motor current at 80% voltage
2
100
Time to trip (in seconds)
5
3
10
4
5
1.0
0.1
pu 0.56 5.6 56
Amp 280 2800 28000
FLA 1 10 100
833004A2.CDR
The FlexCurve programming is based on per-unit current values. The equivalent primary amperes and multiplier of full load
current are also indicated above.
UNBALANCE BIAS K FACTOR — Unbalanced phase currents cause rotor heating that is not shown in the motor thermal
damage curve. When the motor is running, the rotor rotates in the direction of the positive sequence current at near
synchronous speed. Negative sequence current, which has a phase rotation that is opposite to the positive sequence
current, and hence opposite to the direction of rotor rotation, generates a rotor voltage that produces a substantial current
in the rotor. This current has a frequency that is approximately twice the line frequency: 100 Hz for a 50 Hz system or 120
Hz for a 60 Hz system. Skin effect in the rotor bars at this frequency cause a significant increase in rotor resistance and
therefore, a significant increase in rotor heating. This extra heating is not accounted for in the thermal limit curves supplied
by the motor manufacturer as these curves assume positive sequence currents from a perfectly balanced supply voltage
and motor design.
The thermal model can be biased to reflect the additional heating that is caused by negative sequence current when the
motor is running. This biasing is done by creating an equivalent motor heating current rather than simply using average
three phase RMS. This equivalent current is calculated using the following equation.
2 I_2 2
I eq = I per_unit §© 1 + k §© -------·¹ ·¹ Eq. 5-12
I_1
where
Ieq = equivalent motor heating current
Iper_unit = per unit current based on FLA
I_1 = positive sequence current
I_2 = negative sequence current
k = constant
The following figure shows the motor derating as a function of voltage unbalance as recommended by the National
Electrical Manufacturers Association (NEMA). Assuming a typical induction motor with an inrush of 6 x FLA and a negative
sequence impedance of 0.167, voltage unbalances of 1, 2, 3, 4, and 5% equals current unbalances of 6, 12, 18, 24, and 30%
respectively. Based on this assumption, the amount of motor derating for different values of k entered for setting
UNBALANCE BIAS K FACTOR is also shown. Note that the curve created when k = 8 is almost identical to the NEMA derating
5 curve.
Figure 5-116: Medium motor derating factor due to unbalance voltage
1.05 1.05
1.00 1.00
DERATING FACTOR
DERATING FACTOR
0.95 0.95
k=2
0.90 0.90
k=8
0.75 0.75
k=10
0.70 0.70
0 1 2 3 4 5 0 1 2 3 4 5
NEMA GE Multilin
808728A2.CDR
If a value of k = 0 is entered, unbalance biasing is defeated and the overload curve times out against the measured per unit
motor positive sequence current. The following equations can be used to calculate k.
175 230
k = -------- (typical estimate); k = -------- (conservative estimate), where ILR is the per unit locked rotor current
2
I LR
2
I LR Eq. 5-13
COOL TIME CONSTANT RUNNING / STOPPED — The thermal capacity used value is reduced in an exponential manner when
the motor current is below the full load amps x service factor settings to simulate motor cooling. Enter the motor cooling
time constants for both the stopped and running cases. A stopped motor normally cools significantly slower than a
running motor.
I eq hot
TCU end = § --------------------------------------· § 1 – ---------· u 100% Eq. 5-15
© overload_pickup¹ © cold¹
where
TCU = thermal capacity used
TCUstart = TCU value caused by overload condition
TCUend = TCU value dictated by the hot/cold curve ratio when the motor is running. This value is 0 when the motor is
stopped)
t = time in minutes
τ = cool time constant (running or stopped per current motor status and corresponding COOL TIME CONSTANT RUNNING and
COOL TIME CONSTANT STOPPED settings)
Ieq = equivalent motor heating current
overload_pickup = overload pickup setpoint as a multiple of FLA
hot / cold = hot/cold curve ratio
75 75
25 25
0 0
0 30 60 90 120 150 180 0 30 60 90 120 150 180
Time in Minutes Time in Minutes
100 100
5 75 75
Thermal Capacity Used
25 25
0 0
0 30 60 90 120 150 180 0 30 60 90 120 150 180
Time in Minutes Time in Minutes
HOT/COLD SAFE STALL RATIO — The motor manufacturer sometimes provides thermal limit information for a hot/cold motor.
The M60 algorithm uses this data if this setting is programmed. The value entered for this setting dictates the level at which
thermal capacity used settles for current that is below the motor service factor times FLA. When the motor is running at a
level that is below this limit, thermal capacity used rises or falls to a value based on Iequivalent (average three phase RMS
and the selected setting. Thermal capacity used either rises at the fixed rate of 5% per minute or falls as dictated by the
running cool time constant.
hot
TCU end = I eq u § 1 – ---------· u 100% Eq. 5-16
© cold¹
where
TCUend = THERMAL CAPACITY USED if Iequivalent remains steady state
hot
TCU at RTD_Bias_Center = §© 1 – ---------·¹ u 100% Eq. 5-17
cold
where
RTD_Bias_TCU = thermal capacity used due to hottest stator RTD
Tempacutal = current temperature of the hottest stator RTD
Tempmin = RTD Bias minimum setting
Tempcenter = RTD Bias center setting
Tempmax = RTD Bias maximum setting
TCU at RTD_Bias_Center = thermal capacity used defined by the HOT/COLD SAFE STALL RATIO setting
In simple terms, the RTD bias feature is feedback of measured stator temperature. This feedback acts to correct the
assumed thermal model. Since RTDs have a relatively slow response, RTD biasing is useful for slow motor heating. Other
portions of the thermal model are required during starting and heavy overload conditions when motor heating is relatively
fast.
The RTD bias feature alone cannot create a trip. Even if the RTD bias feature forces the RTD bias thermal capacity used to
100%, the load current must be above the overload pickup setting to set the output.
Do not program RTD BIAS MAXIMUM setpoint greater than 200°C if using a remote RTD unit, since the RRTD only measures
temperatures up to 200°C.
Hot/Cold = 0.85
60
40
20
RTD Bias Center Point
RTD Bias Minimum
0
–50 0 50 100 150 200 250
Maximum Stator RTD Temperature
808721A1.CDR
START INHIBIT TCU MARGIN — This setting prevents starting of a motor if there is insufficient thermal capacity available for a
successful start. The motor start inhibit logic algorithm is defined by MOTOR START INHIBIT MARGIN setpoint. If MOTOR START
INHIBIT MARGIN is set to “0”, the MOTOR START INHIBIT FlexLogic operand is asserted only when motor is tripped by thermal
protection (TCU = 100%). After being asserted, the MOTOR START INHIBIT operand resets and a new motor start is permitted
5 when TCused decays to a level of 15%. The thermal lockout time is calculated as follows.
–T e W
TCU end = TCU start u e Eq. 5-20
where
TCUstart is the thermal capacity level when the MOTOR START INHIBIT operand is asserted
TCUend is the thermal capacity level when the MOTOR START INHIBIT operand is reset
τ is the COOL TIME CONSTANT STOPPED setpoint
To calculate the thermal lockout time for the case when MOTOR START INHIBIT MARGIN is set to “0,” the following TCU values
are to be applied to the previous equation: TCUstart = 100% and TCUend = 15%.
If the motor is tripped or stopped by a means other than thermal protection (TCU < 100%), the MOTOR START INHIBIT
operand is not asserted and a new start is permitted. There is a potential risk in this situation to trip out the motor
by thermal protection during the new start.
If MOTOR START INHIBIT MARGIN is greater than “0,” the MOTOR START INHIBIT operand is asserted either when the motor is
tripped by thermal protection (TCU = 100%) or tripped/stopped for any other reason (TCU < 100%).
Each time the motor is tripped/stopped by a means other than thermal protection (TCU < 100%) the available thermal
capacity (100% – TCU) is evaluated and compared to the TC required for starting the motor. If the available thermal
capacity is not sufficient to perform a new motor start, then the MOTOR START INHIBIT operand is asserted. The thermal
capacity required for starting the motor (TCUonStart) is defined from the following equation:
where
TCUmargin is the relay setpoint
TCUmaxStart is the maximum thermal capacity value from the last five successful motor starts
The relay monitors motor starting and captures the TCU for each successful start. The largest value from the last five starts
is used in the start inhibit calculation.
In this case, the MOTOR START INHIBIT operand resets when TCU decays to the level satisfying the following equation.
To calculate the thermal lockout time for the case when the MOTOR START INHIBIT MARGIN setting is greater than “0,” the
following TCU values are applied.
TCU start = TC accumulated from the moment the motor was stopped
TCU margin· ·
TCU end = 100% – §© TCU maxStart u §© 1 + ---------------------
- Eq. 5-23
100% ¹ ¹
If MOTOR START INHIBIT MARGIN is greater than “0,” but the relay does not contain records for five successful starts, then the
MOTOR START INHIBIT operand can be asserted again either when the motor is tripped by thermal protection (TCU = 100%) or
ÖØ reason (TCaccumulated < 100%). However, operand reset is evaluated based on 15% level of
tripped/stopped by any other
thermal capacity. To calculate
ÖØ the thermal lockout time in this case, the following values of TCU are applied to the previous
equation: TCUstart = thermal capacity accumulated from the moment the motor was stopped, and TCUend = 15%.
VOLTAGE DEPENDENT FUNCTION — If the motor is called upon to drive a high inertia load, it is quite possible and acceptable
for the acceleration time to exceed the safe stall time (keeping in mind that a locked rotor condition is different than an
acceleration condition). The voltage dependent overload curve feature is tailored to protect these types of motors. This
curve is composed of the three characteristic of thermal limit curve shapes as determined by the stall or locked rotor
condition, acceleration, and running overload. The following figure presents the typical thermal limit curve for high inertia
application.
5
g GE Multilin
HIGH INERTIA LOAD OVERLOAD CURVES
8800 HP, 13.2 kV, REACTOR COOLANT PUMP
1000
900
800
700
1- Running Overload Thermal Limit
600 1
2- Acceleration Thermal Limit at 80%V
500 3- Acceleration Thermal Limit at 100%V
4- Locked Rotor Thermal Limit
400 5- Motor Acceleration Curve at 80% V
6- Motor Acceleration Curve at 100%V
300
2
200
100
90
80
TIME TO TRIP (SECONDS)
70
60
50
5
40
30
20
10
9
8
7
4
6
5
4
5
3
6
2
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
MULTIPLES OF FULL LOAD AMPS 806821A4.CDR
TVoltage dependent overload functionality is operational only if the selected MOTOR LINE SOURCE in the SYSTEM
MOTOR SETUP menu is assigned to a valid three-phase VT.
In this instance, each distinct portion of the thermal limit curve must be known and protection coordinated against the
curve. The relay protecting the motor must be able to distinguish between a locked rotor condition (curve 4) and an
accelerating condition for different levels of the system voltage (curves 2 and 3). Voltage is continually monitored during
motor starting and the acceleration thermal limit portion of the relay overload curve is dynamically adjusted based on
motor voltage variations.
The acceleration thermal limit is a function of motor speed during the start. The dynamically shifted voltage dependent
overload curve inherently accounts for the change in motor speed as a function of motor impedance. The change in
impedance is reflected by motor terminal voltage and line current. This method aids to set dynamically the appropriate
value of the thermal limit time for any given line current at any given terminal voltage.
The VOLTAGE DEPENDENT FUNCTION setpoint enables the voltage dependent feature and modifies the locked rotor portion
of the programmed relay overload curve with respect to the acceleration thermal limits. These thermal limits are typically
available from the machine specifications provided by motor manufacturer.
VOLTAGE DEPENDENT MIN MOTOR VOLTS — This setting defines the minimum allowable line voltage applied to the motor
during the acceleration if the VOLTAGE DEPENDENT FUNCTION is enabled. This voltage is expressed as a percentage of the
SYSTEM SETUP MOTOR MOTOR NAMEPLATE VOLTAGE setting. If the measured line voltage drops below this setting
ÖØ
during acceleration, the thermal
ÖØ curve is switched to one based on the programmed minimum voltage thermal limit, as
follows.
2
I1 u t1
trip_time = ------------
-
I
2 Eq. 5-24
VD VOLTAGE LOSS — This setting is used to address situations when the voltage input into thermal model has been lost. In
this case, the voltage dependent algorithm readjusts the voltage dependent curve to avoid an inadequate thermal
protection response. The VT fuse failure function typically is used to detect a voltage loss condition. If a voltage loss has
been detected while motor accelerates, the thermal curve is switched to one based on the programmed 100% voltage
thermal limit, as follows.
5
2
I3 u t3
trip_time = ------------
-
I
2 Eq. 5-25
VD STALL CURRENT @ MIN V — This setting defines the locked rotor current level at minimum motor voltage (I1).
VD SAFE STALL TIME @ MIN V — This setting defines the maximum time that motor is allowed to withstand the locked rotor
current at minimum motor voltage (t1).
VD ACCEL. INTERESECT @ MIN V — This setting defines the starting current level corresponding to the crossing point between
the acceleration thermal limit at minimum voltage and the programmed relay overload curve (I2). This value can be
typically determined from motor acceleration curves. The value at the breakdown torque for the minimum voltage start is
recommended for this setting.
(##'!$1!34B
VD STALL CURRENT @ 100% V — This setting defines the locked rotor current level at the rated motor voltage (I3).
VD SAFE STALL TIME @ 100% V — This setting defines the maximum time the motor is allowed to withstand the locked rotor
7+(50$/02'(/&859(
$&&(/(5$7,21,17(56(&7#PLQ9
$&&(/(5$7,21,17(56(&7#9
$&&(/(5$7,21,17(56(&7#9
$ /2&.('527257+(50$//,0,7&859(
&
7,0( 72 75,3 6(&21'6
%
7+(50$//,0,7&859(6
)25$%1250$/&21',7,216
/(667+$19PLQ$
5
025(7+$19%
/2662)92/7$*(&
6$)(67$//32,17#PLQ9
6$)(67$//32,17#9
6$)(67$//32,17#9
3(581,7&855(17
$&'5
This figure and the following procedure illustrate the construction of the voltage overload curves.
1. Draw a curve for the running overload thermal limit. The curve is one that has been selected in the relay as a THERMAL
MODEL CURVE.
2. Determine the point of intersection between the THERMAL MODEL CURVE and the vertical line corresponding to the per-
unit current value of VD ACCEL. INTERESECT @ MIN V (see point 2).
3. Determine the locked rotor thermal limit point for the minimum voltage motor start. The coordinates of this point are
the per-unit current value of VD STALL CURRENT @ MIN VOLTS and the time value of VD SAFE STALL TIME @ MIN V (see point
1).
4. The line connecting points 1 and 2 constructs the acceleration curve for the system voltage level defined by the
VOLTAGE DEPENDENT MIN MOTOR VOLTS setting. The acceleration time-current curve for the minimum voltage starting
–I e V
trip_time = A FACTOR u e
I1 – I2 I eV
- and A FACTOR = t 1 u e 1
where V = -------------------- Eq. 5-26
ln t 2 e t 1
where
I is a variable multiplier of the motor rated current (values between I1 and I2)
I1 is a multiplier of the rated motor current (FLA) specified by the VD STALL CURRENT @ MIN V setting
t1 is a time value specified by the VD SAFE STALL TIME @ MIN V setting
I2 is a multiplier of the rated motor current (FLA) specified by the VD ACCEL. INTERESECT @ MIN V setting
t2 is a time coordinate of the intersection point between the thermal model curve and the vertical line corresponding
to the per-unit current value of the VD ACCEL. INTERESECT @ MIN V setting
5. Determine the point of intersection between the thermal model curve and the vertical line corresponding to the
multiplier of the rated current value of the VD ACCEL. INTERESECT @ 100% V setting (see point 4).
6. Draw the locked rotor thermal limit point for the 100% voltage motor start. The coordinates of this point are the
multiplier of the rated current value (FLA) of the VD STALL CURRENT @ 100% V setting and the time value of the VD SAFE
STALL TIME @ 100% V setting (see point 3).
7. The line connecting points 3 and 4 constructs the acceleration curve for the motor rated system voltage. The
acceleration time-current curve for the rated voltage starting is calculated from the same equations, but the setpoints
associated with the 100% voltage starting are applied.
8. The line connecting points 1, 3, and 5 represent the motor safe stall conditions for any system voltage from the
minimum to 110% of rated. Ideally, all the points on this line are characterized by the same thermal limit (I2t), but the
5 equivalent starting impedance at reduced voltage is greater than the impedance at full voltage. As such, the higher
terminal voltages tend to reduce I2t. The rate of I2t reduction is dictated by the VD STALL CURRENT and VD SAFE STALL
TIME setpoints for rated and minimum voltage conditions. For voltage conditions above rated, the locked rotor thermal
limit and acceleration curve are extrapolated up to 110% of the terminal voltage. The point coordinates (Is, Ts) for
110% are extrapolated based on the I1, T1, I3, and T3 values. For starting currents at voltages higher than 110%, the
trip time computed from 110% V thermal limit value will be used.
The voltage dependent curve for current values above 1.1 x VD STALL CURRENT @ 100% V are clamped and the
time to trip is frozen at the level calculated for the 8 times pickup current.
The following three figures illustrate the resultant overload protection curve for minimum, 100%, and maximum line
voltages. For voltages between these limits, the M60 shifts the acceleration curve linearly and constantly, based on the
measured line voltage during a motor start.
1000.00
100.00
10.00
1.00
0 1 2 3 4 5
Per unit current
6 7 8
5
833716A2.CDR
1000.00
100.00
10.00
5 1.00
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Per unit current
833717A2.CDR
1000.00
100.00
10.00
1.00
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 5
Per unit current
833718A2.CDR
The following three figures illustrate the motor starting curves for the following abnormal conditions: line voltages below
the minimum, above 110%, and the situation for voltage loss.
Figure 5-125: Voltage dependent overload curve protection at less than minimum voltage
10000.00
1000.00
100.00
10.00
5 1.00
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Per unit current
833719A2.CDR
Figure 5-126: Voltage dependent overload curve protection at voltage loss condition
10000.00
1000.00
100.00
10.00
1.00
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 5
Per unit current
833720A2.CDR
Figure 5-127: Voltage dependent overload curve protection at more than 110% voltage
10000.00
1000.00
100.00
10.00
5 1.00
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Per unit current
833721A2.CDR
For the three abnormal voltage situations, the M60 makes a transition from the acceleration curve to Motor or FlexCurve
when the MOTOR RUNNING or MOTOR OVERLOADED operands are asserted.
5% u
U *
6(77,1* u *
u *
&XUYH
0RWRU
$1' )OH[&XUYH
)OH[&XUYH
6(77,1*
9ROWDJH'HSHQGHQW9ROWDJH $1'
/RVV
2II
$1'
IURPWKH6\VWHP6HWXS!0RWRUPHQX
6(77,1*6
0RWRU/LQH6RXUFH
65& 9ROWDJHGHSHQGHQW
$1'
0RWRU1DPHSODWH9ROWDJH PRWRUFXUYH
9UDWHG
IURPWKH6\VWHP6HWXS
!$&,QSXWV!9ROWDJHPHQX
73.4 u 7SBUJP
6(77,1*6 7
7SBUFE
3KDVH975DWLR 9ROWDJHGHSHQGHQW
$1'
$X[LOLDU\975DWLR )OH[&XUYH
9UDWLR 7NJO 7 7
7 ! 7 YROWDJH
$1'
ORFNHGURWRUFXUYH
6(77,1*
* u U
9ROWDJH'HSHQGHQW0LQ U *
0RWRU9ROWV 77NJO *
9PLQ
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
027255811,1*
$1'
0LQLPXPYROWDJH
ORFNHGURWRUFXUYH
* u U
5
U *
25 *
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
0272529(5/2$'
YROWDJH
$1'
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1' ORFNHGURWRUFXUYH
0272567$57,1* * u U
U *
* $&'5
THERMAL MODEL BLOCK — The thermal model can be blocked by any asserted FlexLogic operand. While the blocking signal
is applied, the element remains running and updates the thermal memory, but the states of the MOTOR START INHIBIT and
MOTOR THERMAL OP operands remain unchanged. When the element blocking signal is removed, the element logic is based
on the new value of thermal capacity and updates the status of the MOTOR START INHIBIT and MOTOR THERMAL OP operands.
In the event of a loss of control power to the relay while the motor status is not offline, the thermal capacity remains
unchanged when control power is restored. If the motor status is offline when control power is lost, the thermal capacity
decays for the duration of the loss of control power based on the stopped motor cooling rate.
RTD BIAS:
RTD BIAS
MINIMUM:
RTD BIAS CENTER
POINT:
RTD BIAS
MAXIMUM:
TCU MARGIN:
THERMAL MODEL
CURVE:
THERMAL MODEL
SETTING
TD MULTIPLIER:
THERMAL MODEL
COOL TIME CONSTANT SETTING FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
FUNCTION:
RUNNING:
Enabled=1 TC USED MARGIN: MOTOR START INHIBIT
COOL TIME CONSTANT
STOPPED: TCU Margin = 0% AND AND
SETTING
AND RUN TCU Margin > 0%
THERMAL MODEL THERMAL MEMORY
BLOCK : TC Used > 15%
Off=0 AND OR OR R
OR
AND
5 STARTS History Available AND
TC Used on START > TC available
(
TC Used on Start=TCMAX Start x TCU MARGIN(%)+100%
100% )
AND
TCU 100% Stop
Stop TC Used
on START AND
START INHIBIT
5
MOTOR OFFLINE FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
RESTART:
MOTOR STARTING MOTOR THERMAL OP
Off=0 Reset TC Used To 0% ACTUAL VALUES
MOTOR RUNNING
ACTUAL VALUE MOTOR OVERLOAD
IEq PICKUP MOTOR THERMAL PKP
MOTOR LINE
SOURCE: MOTOR THERMAL DPO
IA RMS
IB RMS t
IC RMS
TC used =
Pos Seq I
Neg Seq I TC used 100%
I
ACTUAL VALUE
STATOR TEMP SENSOR 1 AND S
TC OR
STATOR TEMP SENSOR 2
STATOR TEMP SENSOR 3
TC used RTD=
STATOR TEMP SENSOR 4
STATOR TEMP SENSOR 5 MAX STATOR RTD TC used 100%
STATOR TEMP SENSOR 6 Hottest RTD 833007A6.CDR
This element receives current inputs from the source selected by the SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP MOTOR MOTOR
LINE SOURCE setting. Generally, this element compares the ratio of motor negative sequence current (I_2) to the positive
sequence current (I_1) times an adjustment factor to compensate for the actual motor load to a set threshold. The
adjustment factor is used to prevent nuisance alarms at light loads. If the motor is operating at an average current level
equal to or greater than the programmed full load current (FLA, as selected by the SYSTEM SETUP MOTOR MOTOR
FULL LOAD AMPS setting) the adjustment factor is one. If the motor is operating at an average current level less than the
programmed full load current (as selected by the SYSTEM SETUP MOTOR MOTOR FULL LOAD AMPS setting) the
adjustment factor is the ratio of average current to full load current. It is intended that the Amp Unbalance 1 element is
used to generate an alarm and Amp Unbalance 2 element is used to generate a trip.
A declaration of a “single-phasing” condition is made two seconds after the unbalanced current level exceeds 40%, or the
average current is above 25% of FLA and the current in any one phase is less than 2% of FLA.
AMP UNBAL 1(2) PICKUP — This setting selects the level of unbalanced current that generates a stage 1 (intended to alarm)
output. Note that a supply voltage unbalance of 1% creates a current unbalance of 6% in a typical three-phase induction
motor; a supply voltage unbalance of 2% creates a current unbalance of 12%. As a 2% voltage unbalance is common in
most applications, a setting of 0.15 is often used as the alarm level, and AMP UNBAL 1 PICKUP is usually set to this level or
higher.
AMP UNBAL 1(2) PICKUP DELAY — The alarm delay is often set from 5 to 10 seconds. A higher level of unbalance causes
motor stress in a shorter period; a reasonable setting is 3 to 10 seconds.
AMP UNBAL 1(2) RESET DELAY — This timer can be used to maintain the output until other equipment or an operator can
react to the unbalance condition.
Figure 5-130: AMP unbalance logic
SETTING
5
AMP UNBAL 1
FUNCTION:
Enabled = 1
ACTUAL VALUES
AMP UNBALANCE
SETTING
AND
AMP UNBAL 1
BLK:
Off = 0 NOTE: SETTING
- FLA is programmed in
*SYSTEM SETUP / MOTOR / FULL LOAD AMPS
AMP UNBAL 1
SETTING SETTING PICKUP DELAY: FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
SYSTEM SETUP/MOTOR/ AMP UNBAL 1 AMP UNBAL 1 AMP UNBALANCE 1 PKP
MOTOR LINE SOURCE: PICKUP: PICKUP RESET: AMP UNBALANCE 1 DPO
I_1 RUN t PKP
I_2 I_2
Kx
I_1
x100% UNBAL >
= PKP 1 t RST
IA If Iavg >
IA+IB+IC = Iavg = FLA*, K=1
IB Iavg FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
3 If Iavg < FLA*, K=
FLA* OR AMP UNBALANCE 1 OP
IC
Iavg >
= 0.25 FLA*
OR 2s
0
AND
AND
IA < 0.02 FLA*
AND OR
IB < 0.02 FLA*
AND
IC < 0.02 FLA* 833002A5.CDR
A motor load can become constrained (mechanical jam) during startup or when running. The starting current magnitude
alone cannot provide a definitive indication of a mechanical jam. The running current magnitude can. The Mechanical Jam
element is specifically designed to operate for running load jams. Startup load jams are detected by monitoring
acceleration time and speed. The thermal element also operates during mechanical jams but after a delay when the
thermal capacity reaches 100%. Not only is this ineffective due to the delay, but it also implies the maximum waiting time
for cooling before a restart, which can be restrictive.
This element is armed as long as the motor status is not “Starting.” This includes “Running,” “Overload,” and “Offline.” As
soon as any phase current exceeds the user-selectable threshold, the element picks up and operates after the
programmed time delay. The element uses currents configured under SYSTEM SETUP MOTOR MOTOR LINE SOURCE
and motor status asserted by the thermal model element. Both the signal source and thermal protection must be
configured properly in order for the mechanical jam protection to operate.
MECH JAM OVERCURRENT PICKUP — This setting defines excessive current condition that identifies a mechanical jam. As the
element is not armed during start conditions, this threshold can be set below the starting current. Since the element is
5 armed during overload conditions, make this setting higher than the maximum overload current. The setting is entered in
multiplies of FLA (defined in the SYSTEM SETUP MOTOR menu).
MECH JAM PICKUP DELAY — This setting specifies the pickup delay of the element. In the case of large motors that can feed
close-in feeder faults, this setting can coordinate with feeder protection to avoid false tripping due to excessive fault
currents fed by the motor.
MECH JAM RESET DELAY — This setting defines the reset delay of the element. Typical application includes time seal-in of the
tripping command.
Figure 5-131: Mechanical jam logic
SETTING
Enabled = 1
SETTING
SETTING MECH JAM
OVERCURRENT PICKUP:
MECH JAM BLK:
AND RUN SETTINGS
Off = 0 MECH JAM PICKUP
DELAY:
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND IA PICKUP OR MECH JAM RESET
MOTOR STARTING DELAY:
IB > PICKUP OR FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
t PKP
t RST MECHANICAL JAM OP
SETTING IC > PICKUP MECHANICAL JAM DPO
SYSTEM SETUP/MOTOR/
MECHANICAL JAM PKP
MOTOR LINE SOURCE:
IA mag
IB mag
IC mag 833012A2.CDR
UNDERCURRENT EVENTS:
Disabled
Range: Disabled, Enabled 5
The undercurrent function uses the source defined by the SYSTEM SETUP MOTOR MOTOR LINE SOURCE setting. Phase
currents must be configured on this source; otherwise, the undercurrent function is not operational. The element responds
to a per-phase current.
If the undercurrent function is enabled, a trip or alarm is initiated once the IA, IB, or IC current magnitude falls below the
pickup level for a time specified by the delay setting. For example, the undercurrent element can be used to detect loss-of-
load conditions. This can be especially useful for detecting process related problems.
The undercurrent element is active when the motor is running at speed 1, that is, when the motor status is running and
speed 2 is not employed or active.
UNDERCURRENT START BLOCK DLY — This setting specifies the length of time to block the undercurrent function when motor
is starting. If not in the starting state, the motor status is indicated by the MOTOR OFFLINE operand. See the Motor section
under SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP MOTOR for information on using the MOTOR OFFLINE operand for state determination.
The undercurrent element is active only when the motor is running and is blocked upon the initiation of a motor start for a
period of time specified by this setting. For example, this block delay can be used to allow pumps to build up head before
the undercurrent element trips or alarms. A value of 0 specifies that the feature is not blocked from start. For values other
than 0, the feature is disabled when the motor is stopped and also from the time a start is detected until the time entered
expires.
UNDERCURRENT ALARM PICKUP — This setting specifies a pickup threshold for the alarm stage. Set the alarm pickup
threshold less than the motor load current during normal operations.
UNDERCURRENT ALARM PICKUP DLY — This setting specifies a time delay for the alarm stage. Set the time delay long enough
to overcome any short lowering of the current (for example, during system faults).
UNDERCURRENT TRIP PICKUP — This setting specifies a pickup threshold for the trip stage. Set the pickup less than the
corresponding setting for the alarm stage.
UNDERCURRENT TRIP PICKUP DLY — This setting specifies a time delay for the trip stage. Set the time delay long enough to
overcome any short lowering of the current (for example, during system faults).
UNDERCURRENT TRIP RESET DLY — This setting specifies a time delay to reset the trip command. Set this delay to be long
enough to allow breaker or contactor to disconnect the motor.
UNDERCURRENT BLOCK — This setting specifies an operand used to block the undercurrent function. A panel cutoff switch
or other user specified condition is typically used to block the function.
Figure 5-132: Undercurrent logic
6(77,1*6
81'(5&855(17
)81&7,21
(QDEOHG
81'(5&855(17%/2&. $1'
2II
6(77,1*6
81'(5&855(1767$57
%/2&.'/< $1'
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1' 73.3 6(77,1*6
027252))/,1(
6(77,1* 81'(5&855(17$/$50
3,&.83'/<
81'(5&855(17$/$50
0272567$786 3,&.83 81'(5&855(1775,3
5XQQLQJDWVSHHG 3,&.83'/<
581
81'(5&855(1775,3
PDJQLWXGH,D3,&.83 5(6(7'/<
73.3 )/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
PDJQLWXGH,E3,&.83 25 8&855$/$5023
PDJQLWXGH,&3,&.83 73.3 )/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
8&85575,323
7567
6(77,1*
81'(5&855(1775,3
3,&.83
581
6(77,1* PDJQLWXGH,D3,&.83 )/(;/2*,&23(5$1'6
02725/,1(6285&(
5
8&855$/$503.3
,D PDJQLWXGH,E3,&.83 25 8&85575,33.3
,E
,F PDJQLWXGH,&3,&.83
$&'5
The two-speed motor menu appears only if two-speed motor functionality is enabled in the SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP
MOTOR menu.
SPEED2 THERMAL MODEL Range: 0.00 to 16.00 in steps of 0.01 when speed 2
TD MULTIPLIER: 1.00 thermal model curve is Motor, otherwise 0.00 to
600.00 in steps of 0.01
SPEED2 VOLT DEPEND Range: Disabled, Enabled
FUNCTION: Disabled
When two-speed motor functionality is used, these settings allow the selection of proper parameters for the thermal
model when the motor is switched to the second speed. There is one thermal model in the M60, and it has inputs for
overload conditions from calculations at both speeds. As such, the accumulated thermal capacity is calculated from
overload contributions at each speed.
See the Thermal Model section earlier for details on settings for the thermal model at the second motor speed.
Figure 5-133: Two-speed motor thermal model logic
SETTING
5
MOTOR LINE SOURCE
= Ia
Ia
= Ib
= Ic
Ib
VOLTAGE CONNECTION
Wye Delta Ic
Thermal model,
Vag Vab voltage dependent
Va
Vbg Vbc
Vcg Vca
Vb
SETTING
SPEED2 MOTOR SOURCE Vc
= Ia Thermal model Thermal model
= Ib settings, speed 1 settings, speed 2
= Ic
Off On
VOLTAGE CONNECTION
Wye Delta ACTIVE
Vag Vab
Vbg Vbc
Vcg Vca
SETTING
SPEED2 MOTOR SWITCH SETTING
Off = 0 SPEED2 SWITCH 2-1
DELAY
0 FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SETTING
AND MOTOR SPD2 TR 2-1 OP
2-SPEED MOTOR TRST
PROTECTION
Enabled = 1 833020A1.CDR
If the speed 2 acceleration time functionality is enabled, the element reads current from the source selected for speed 2 by
the SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP MOTOR 2-SPEED MOTOR SOURCE setting when the motor is switched from speed 1 to
speed 2.
Acceleration time settings and functionality at speed 2 are identical to those of speed 1 and are described in the
Acceleration Time section earlier. This applies to the SPEED2 ACCELERATION CURRENT, SPEED2 ACCELERATION TIME, and
SPEED2 ACCEL MODE settings.
Two additional settings define the transition between speeds. A two-speed motor is usually started at a low speed (speed
1) and then switched to a higher speed (speed 2) when required. When the motor starts directly at high speed, then the
SPEED2 ACCELERATION TIME setting specifies the maximum acceleration time at speed 2. When the motor is switched from
a low-to-high speed setting, the SPEED2 TIMER FROM SPEED 1-2 setting specifies the acceleration time. When motor is
switched from high speed to low speed, the SPEED2 TRANS 2-1 OP FlexLogic operand is set for time defined by the SPEED2
SWITCH 2-1 DELAY setting to allow inputs for control logic of contactors and breakers at both speeds. FlexLogic operands
required for contactor and breaker control are provided. The acceleration time at speed 2 becomes functional only if the
acceleration time at speed 1 is enabled. When the acceleration time at any speed is not required, it can be permanently
blocked.
SPEED2 ACCEL TIME FROM SPEED 1-2 — This setting is provide to select maximum accelerating time from speed 1 to speed 2
when the motor switches from low-to-high speed.
Figure 5-134: Two-speed acceleration time logic
5 SETTING
SPEED 2 ACCEL BLOCK
= Off
AND SETTINGS
SPEED 2 MOTOR SWITCH
SPEED 2 ACCELERATION
= Off TIME
SPEED2 ACCELERATION
SETTING CURRENT
SPEED2 ACCEL MODE SPEED2 ACCEL TIME FROM
= Definite Time Definite Time SPEED 1-2
= Adaptive RUN
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
T > Acceleration time MOTOR SPD2 ACL t OP
Adaptive
OR MOTOR SPD2 ACL t DPO
RUN
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
MOTOR STARTING
MOTOR RUNNING 833021A1.CDR
The speed 2 undercurrent function uses the same source as other speed 2 motor functions as defined by the SYSTEM SETUP
MOTOR 2-SPEED MOTOR SOURCE setting. The phase currents must be configured on this source; otherwise, the
function is disabled. The element responds to per-phase currents.
If the speed 2 undercurrent function is enabled, a trip or alarm are initiated once the IA, IB or IC current magnitude falls
below the pickup level for a period of time specified by the delay. For example, undercurrent can be used to detect loss-of-
load conditions. This can be especially useful for detecting process related problems.
This element is active if the motor is running at speed 2. The undercurrent function at speed 2 becomes functional only if
undercurrent at speed 1 is enabled. When the undercurrent function at any speed is not required, it can be permanently
blocked.
SPEED2 U/CURR START BLOCK DLY — This setting specifies a time to block the undercurrent function when motor is starting
directly at speed 2. Prior to starting, the motor state is determined from the MOTOR OFFLINE operand. See the Motor section
under the SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP MOTOR menu for additional information on the motor offline state
determination. The speed 2 undercurrent element is active only when the motor is running at speed 2 and is blocked upon
the initiation of a motor start for a period of time defined by the SPEED2 U/CURR START BLOCK DLY setting (for example, this 5
block can be used to allow pumps to build up head before the undercurrent element trips or alarms). A value of 0 specifies
that the feature is not blocked from start. For values other than 0, the feature is disabled when the motor is stopped and
also from the time a start is detected until the time entered expires.
SPEED2 U/CURR ALARM PICKUP — This setting specifies a pickup threshold for the alarm stage. Set it less than the motor load
current during normal operations.
SPEED2 U/CURR ALARM PICKUP DLY — This setting specifies a time delay for the alarm stage. Set it long enough to overcome
any short lowering of the current (for example, during system faults).
SPEED2 U/CURR TRIP PICKUP — This setting specifies a pickup threshold for the trip stage. Set it less than the corresponding
setting for the alarm stage.
SPEED2 U/CURR TRIP PICKUP DLY — This setting specifies a time delay for the trip stage. Set it long enough to overcome any
short lowering of the current (for example, during system faults).
SPEED2 U/CURR TRIP RESET DLY — This setting specifies a time delay to reset the trip command. Set it long enough to allow
the breaker or contactor to disconnect the motor.
SPEED2 U/CURR BLOCK — This setting specifies an operand used to block the speed 2 undercurrent function. A panel cutoff
switch or other user specified condition typically is used to block the function.
The stator differential protection element is intended for use on the stator windings of rotating machinery.
differential
Operate Block
Slope 2
Slope 1
Pickup
Break 1
Break 2
restraining
830735A1.CDR
This element has a dual slope characteristic. The main purpose of the percent-slope characteristic is to prevent a
maloperation caused by unbalances between CTs during external faults. CT unbalances arise as a result of the following
factors:
• CT accuracy errors
• CT saturation
5
The characteristic allows for very sensitive settings when fault current is low and less sensitive settings when fault current
is high and CT performance can produce incorrect operate signals.
STATOR DIFF LINE END SOURCE — This setting selects the source connected to CTs in the end of the machine stator winding
closest to the load and farthest from the winding neutral point. Wire both line and neutral-side CTs to measure their
currents in the same direction with respect to the neutral point of the winding.
If the two-speed motor functionality is employed with two separate CTs at each speed, the source that is sum of currents
of two CT banks at line side should be assigned with this setting for proper differential functionality.
STATOR DIFF NEUTRAL END SOURCE — Selects the source connected to CTs in the end of the machine stator winding farthest
from the load and closest to the winding neutral point. Wire both line and neutral-side CTs to measure their currents in the
same direction with respect to the neutral point of the winding.
STATOR DIFF PICKUP — Defines the minimum differential current required for operation. This setting is based on the amount
of differential current that can be seen under normal operating conditions. A setting of 0.1 to 0.3 pu is generally
recommended.
STATOR DIFF SLOPE 1 — This setting is applicable for restraint currents from zero to STATOR DIFF BREAK 1, and it defines the
ratio of differential to restraint current above which the element operates. This slope is set to ensure sensitivity to internal
faults at normal operating current levels. The criteria for setting this slope is to allow for maximum expected CT mismatch
error when operating at the maximum permitted current. This maximum error is generally in the range of 5 to 10% of CT
rating.
STATOR DIFF BREAK 1 — Defines the end of the Slope 1 region and the start of the transition region. Set it just above the
maximum normal operating current level of the machine.
STATOR DIFF SLOPE 2 — This setting is applicable for restraint currents above the STATOR DIFF BREAK 2 setting when the
element is applied to generator stator windings. This slope is set to ensure stability under heavy external fault conditions
that can lead to high differential currents as a result of CT saturation. A setting of 80 to 100% is recommended. The
transition region (as shown on the characteristic plot) is a cubic spline, automatically calculated by the relay to result in a
smooth transition between STATOR DIFF SLOPE 1 and STATOR DIFF SLOPE 2 with no discontinuities.
STATOR DIFF BREAK 2 — This setting defines the end of the transition region and the start of the Slope 2 region. Set it to the
level at which any of the protection CTs are expected to begin to saturate.
5 when energizing a step-up transformer, the inrush current being limited only by the machine impedance can be
significant and can last for a very long time. In order to provide additional security against maloperations during these
events, the M60 incorporates saturation detection logic. When saturation is detected, the element makes an additional
check on the angle between the neutral and output current. If this angle indicates an internal fault, then tripping is
permitted.
The saturation detector is implemented as a state machine (see figure). "NORMAL" is the initial state of the machine. When
in "NORMAL" state, the saturation flag is not set (SAT = 0). The algorithm calculates the saturation condition, SC. If SC = 1
while the state machine is "NORMAL," the saturation detector goes into the "EXTERNAL FAULT" state and sets the saturation
flag (SAT = 1). The algorithm returns to the "NORMAL" state if the differential current is below the first slope, SL, for more
than 200 ms. When in the "EXTERNAL FAULT" state, the algorithm goes into the "EXTERNAL FAULT & CT SATURATION" state if
the differential flag is set (DIF = 1). When in the "EXTERNAL FAULT & CT SATURATION" state, the algorithm keeps the
saturation flag set (SAT = 1). The state machine returns to the "EXTERNAL FAULT" state if the differential flag is reset (DIF = 0)
for 100 ms.
SAT := 1
DIF = 0
for 100 ms
EXTERNAL FAULT
AND CT SATURATION
SAT := 1
830736A1.CDR
6<5H<?793?@5B1>4C
CD1D?B4966@;@2 6<5H<?793?@5B1>4
CD1D?B4966C1D2 1>4 CD1D?B4966?@2
?B
CD1D?B496649B2
6<5H<?793?@5B1>4C
CD1D?B4966@;@3 6<5H<?793?@5B1>4
CD1D?B4966C1D3 1>4 CD1D?B4966?@3
?B
CD1D?B496649B3
6<5H<?793?@5B1>4
?B CD1D?B4966?@
($"' '1!34B
5.8.5.1 Menu
SETTINGS GROUPED ELEMENTS SETTING GROUP 1(6) PHASE CURRENT
PHASE CURRENT PHASE TOC 1 See page 5-277
PHASE TOC 6
PHASE
DIRECTIONAL 2
A time dial multiplier setting allows selection of a multiple of the base curve shape (where the time dial multiplier = 1) with
the curve shape (CURVE) setting. Unlike the electromechanical time dial equivalent, operate times are directly proportional
to the time multiplier (TD MULTIPLIER) setting value. For example, all times for a multiplier of 10 are 10 times the multiplier 1
or base curve values. Setting the multiplier to zero results in an instantaneous response to all current levels above pickup.
Time overcurrent time calculations are made with an internal energy capacity memory variable. When this variable
indicates that the energy capacity has reached 100%, a time overcurrent element operates. If less than 100% energy
capacity is accumulated in this variable and the current falls below the dropout threshold of 97 to 98% of the pickup value,
the variable must be reduced. Two methods of this resetting operation are available: “Instantaneous” and “Timed.” The
“Instantaneous” selection is intended for applications with other relays, such as most static relays, which set the energy
capacity directly to zero when the current falls below the reset threshold. The “Timed” selection can be used where the
relay must coordinate with electromechanical relays.
The URs calculate operate time corresponding to the values in the range of 1.03 to 20 multiples of the pickup current.
Above 20 multiples of the pickup current, URs clamp the operate time to the value at a multiple of 20, resulting in the flat
part of the characteristics. Reset time is calculated in the range of 0 to 0.97 multiples of the pickup current.
IEEE curves
The IEEE time overcurrent curve shapes conform to industry standards and the IEEE C37.112-1996 curve classifications for
extremely, very, and moderately inverse curves. The IEEE curves are derived from the operate and reset time equations.
A tr
------------------------------- + B -------------------------------
-
T = TDM u § --------------· p – 1
I , T RESET = TDM u I 2 Eq. 5-28
© I pickup¹ 1 – §© -------------- ·¹
I pickup
where
T = operate time (in seconds)
TDM = Multiplier setting
I = input current
Ipickup = Pickup Current setting
A, B, p = constants defined in the table
TRESET = reset time in seconds (assuming energy capacity is 100% and RESET is “Timed”)
tr = characteristic constant defined in the table
Table 5-28: IEEE inverse time curve constants
IEEE curve shape A B p tr
IEEE Extremely Inverse 28.2 0.1217 2.0000 29.1
IEEE Very Inverse 19.61 0.491 2.0000 21.6
IEEE Moderately Inverse 0.0515 0.1140 0.02000 4.85
IEC curves
For European applications, the relay offers three standard curves defined in IEC 255-4 and British standard BS142. These
are defined as IEC Curve A, IEC Curve B, and IEC Curve C. The IEC curves are derived by the operate and reset time
equations.
K tr
----------------------------------- ----------------------------------
-
T = TDM u I e I pickup E – 1 , T RESET = TDM u 1 – I e I 2 Eq. 5-29
pickup
where
T = operate time (in seconds)
TDM = Multiplier setting
I = input current
Ipickup = Pickup Current setting
K, E = constants defined in the table
tr = characteristic constant defined in the table
TRESET = reset time in seconds (assuming energy capacity is 100% and RESET is “Timed”)
Table 5-30: IEC (BS) inverse time curve constants
IEC (BS) curve shape K E tr
5 IEC Curve A (BS142) 0.140 0.020 9.7
IEC Curve B (BS142) 13.500 1.000 43.2
IEC Curve C (BS142) 80.000 2.000 58.2
IEC Short Inverse 0.050 0.040 0.500
IAC curves
The curves for the General Electric type IAC relay family are derived from the formulae:
§ B D E ·
T = TDM u ¨ A + --------------------------- + ---------------------------------2 + ---------------------------------3¸ tr
, T RESET = TDM u ---------------------------- Eq. 5-30
5
I e I – C I e I – C I e I – C -
© pkp pkp pkp ¹ 2
1 – I e I pkp
where
T = operate time (in seconds)
TDM = Multiplier setting
I = Input current
Ipkp = Pickup Current setting
A to E = constants defined in the table
tr = characteristic constant defined in the table
TRESET = reset time in seconds (assuming energy capacity is 100% and RESET is “Timed”)
Table 5-32: GE type IAC inverse time curve constants
IAC curve shape A B C D E tr
IAC Extreme Inverse 0.0040 0.6379 0.6200 1.7872 0.2461 6.008
IAC Very Inverse 0.0900 0.7955 0.1000 –1.2885 7.9586 4.678
IAC Inverse 0.2078 0.8630 0.8000 –0.4180 0.1947 0.990
IAC Short Inverse 0.0428 0.0609 0.6200 –0.0010 0.0221 0.222
5 0.5
1.0
0.072
0.143
0.047
0.095
0.035
0.070
0.031
0.061
0.028
0.057
0.027
0.054
0.026
0.052
0.026
0.051
0.025
0.050
0.025
0.049
2.0 0.286 0.190 0.140 0.123 0.114 0.108 0.105 0.102 0.100 0.099
4.0 0.573 0.379 0.279 0.245 0.228 0.217 0.210 0.204 0.200 0.197
6.0 0.859 0.569 0.419 0.368 0.341 0.325 0.314 0.307 0.301 0.296
8.0 1.145 0.759 0.559 0.490 0.455 0.434 0.419 0.409 0.401 0.394
10.0 1.431 0.948 0.699 0.613 0.569 0.542 0.524 0.511 0.501 0.493
I2t curves
The I2t curves are derived as follows:
100 100
----------------------- -------------------------
I · 2 , T RESET = TDM u § I · –2
T = TDM u § ------------- Eq. 5-31
- --------------
© I pickup ¹ © I pickup ¹
where
T = Operate time (in seconds)
TDM = Multiplier setting
I = Input current
Ipickup = Pickup Current setting
TRESET = reset time in seconds (assuming energy capacity is 100% and RESET is “Timed”)
FlexCurves
FlexCurves are described in the FlexCurves section later in this chapter. The curve shapes for the FlexCurves are derived
from the formulae:
I I
T = TDM u FlexCurve Time at §© --------------·¹ when § --------------· t 1.00
© I pickup¹
I pickup Eq. 5-32
I I
T RESET = TDM u FlexCurve Time at §© --------------·¹ when § --------------· d 0.98
© I pickup¹
I pickup Eq. 5-33
where
T = operate time (in seconds)
TDM = Multiplier setting
I = Input Current
Ipickup = Pickup Current setting
TRESET = Reset Time in seconds (assuming energy capacity is 100% and RESET: Timed)
5
Definite time curve
The Definite Time curve shape operates as soon as the pickup level is exceeded for a specified period of time. The base
definite time curve delay is in seconds. The curve multiplier of 0.00 to 600.00 makes this delay adjustable from
instantaneous to 600.00 seconds in steps of 10 ms. The definite time curve shapes are defined as follows:
where
T = Operate Time (in seconds)
TDM = Multiplier setting
I = Input Current
Ipickup = Pickup Current setting
TRESET = Reset Time in seconds (assuming energy capacity is 100% and RESET: Timed)
Recloser curves
The M60 uses the FlexCurve feature to facilitate programming of 41 recloser curves. See the FlexCurves settings section
earlier in this chapter for details.
5 PHASE TOC1
EVENTS: Disabled
Range: Disabled, Enabled
The phase time overcurrent element can provide a specified time-delay operating characteristic versus the applied
current or be used as a simple definite time element. The phase current input quantities can be programmed as
fundamental phasor magnitude or total waveform RMS magnitude as required by the application.
Two methods of resetting operation are available: “Timed” and “Instantaneous” (see the Inverse TOC Curve Characteristics
section earlier for details on curve setup, trip times, and reset operation). When the element is blocked, the time
accumulator resets according to the reset characteristic. For example, if the element reset characteristic is set to
“Instantaneous” and the element is blocked, the time accumulator clears immediately.
The PHASE TOC1 PICKUP setting can be reduced dynamically by a voltage restraint feature (when enabled). This is
accomplished via the multipliers (Mvr) corresponding to the phase-phase voltages of the voltage restraint characteristic
curve (see the figure); the pickup level is calculated as Mvr times the PHASE TOC1 PICKUP setting. If the voltage restraint
feature is disabled, the pickup level always remains at the setting value.
0 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.8 0.9 1.0
Phase-Phase Voltage ÷ VT Nominal Phase-phase Voltage
VOLTAGE RESTRAINT CHARACTERISTIC FOR PHASE TIME O/C
818784A4.CDR
FUNCTION — This setting enables and disables the phase time overcurrent protection element.
SIGNAL SOURCE — Selects the signal source for the phase time overcurrent protection element.
INPUT — Selects how phase current input quantities are interpreted by the M60. Inputs can be selected as fundamental
phasor magnitudes or total waveform RMS magnitudes as required by the application.
PICKUP — Specifies the phase time overcurrent pickup level in per-unit values.
CURVE — Selects the time inverse overcurrent curve style.
TD MULTIPLIER — Specifies a multiple of the base curve shape specified by the CURVE setting. Programming this value to
5
zero results in an instantaneous response to all current levels above pickup.
RESET — The “Instantaneous” reset method is intended for applications with other relays, such as most static relays, which
set the energy capacity directly to zero when the current falls below the reset threshold. The “Timed” reset method can be
used where the relay must coordinate with electromechanical relays.
VOLTAGE RESTRAINT — Enables and disables the phase time overcurrent voltage restraint feature.
BLOCK A — Assertion of the operand assigned to this setting blocks phase A of the phase time overcurrent element.
EVENTS — Enables and disables the logging of phase time overcurrent events in the sequence of events recorder.
SETTING
PHASE TOC1
BLOCK-A :
Off=0
SETTING
PHASE TOC1
BLOCK-B:
Off=0
SETTING
SETTING
PHASE TOC1
PHASE TOC1 INPUT:
BLOCK-C:
PHASE TOC1
Off=0 PICKUP:
PHASE TOC1
SETTING CURVE:
PHASE TOC1 PHASE TOC1
SOURCE: TD MULTIPLIER:
IA
PHASE TOC1
IB RESET: FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
IC AND RUN PHASE TOC1 A PKP
IA PICKUP
Seq=ABC Seq=ACB PHASE TOC1 A DPO
MULTIPLY INPUTS
RUN
t PHASE TOC1 A OP
VAB VAC Set
Calculate Multiplier Set Pickup AND RUN PHASE TOC1 B PKP
RUN
Multiplier-Phase A IB PICKUP
Set PHASE TOC1 B DPO
VBC VBA Set Pickup
Calculate Multiplier t PHASE TOC1 B OP
RUN
Multiplier-Phase B
Set AND RUN PHASE TOC1 C PKP
VCA VCB IC PICKUP
Calculate Multiplier Set Pickup PHASE TOC1 C DPO
Multiplier-Phase C
t PHASE TOC1 C OP
SETTING OR PHASE TOC1 PKP
PHASE TOC1 VOLT
RESTRAINT:
5
OR PHASE TOC1 OP
Enabled
827072A5.CDR
The phase instantaneous overcurrent element can be used as an instantaneous element with no intentional delay or as a
definite time element. The input current is the fundamental phasor magnitude.
FUNCTION — This setting enables and disables the phase instantaneous overcurrent protection element.
SOURCE — Selects the signal source for the phase instantaneous overcurrent protection element.
PICKUP — Specifies the phase instantaneous overcurrent pickup level in per-unit values.
DELAY —Delays the assertion of the PHASE IOC OP operands. It is used to achieve timing coordination with other elements
and relays.
RESET DELAY — Specifies a delay for the reset of the phase instantaneous overcurrent element between the operate output
state and the return to logic 0 after the input passes outside the defined pickup range. This setting is used to ensure that
the relay output contacts are closed long enough to ensure reception by downstream equipment.
BLOCK A — Assertion of the operand assigned to this setting block’s phase A of the phase instantaneous overcurrent
element.
EVENTS — Enables and disables the logging of phase instantaneous overcurrent events in the sequence of events recorder.
5
IC > Pickup PHASE IOC1 B OP
= IC TRST
PHASE IOC1 C OP
The TARGET setting is not user-selectable and forced to "Disabled". If Targets are required from directional elements,
it can be achieved by assigning directional element output to a digital element, where targets selection can be
used as required.
The phase directional elements (one for each of phases A, B, and C) determine the phase current flow direction for steady
state and fault conditions and can be used to control the operation of the phase overcurrent elements via the BLOCK inputs
of these elements.
Figure 5-143: Phase A directional polarization
TS 0
TPU
OU
-90o
VPol
VAG(Faulted) IA
ECA
set @ 30 o
VBC
VBC
VCG VBG +90o
827800A2.CDR
This element is intended to apply a block signal to an overcurrent element to prevent an operation when current is flowing
in a particular direction. The direction of current flow is determined by measuring the phase angle between the current
from the phase CTs and the line-line voltage from the VTs, based on the 90° or quadrature connection. If there is a
requirement to supervise overcurrent elements for flows in opposite directions, such as can happen through a bus-tie
breaker, program two phase directional elements with opposite element characteristic angle (ECA) settings.
To increase security for three phase faults very close to the VTs used to measure the polarizing voltage, a voltage memory
feature is incorporated. This feature stores the polarizing voltage the moment before the voltage collapses, and uses it to
determine direction. The voltage memory remains valid for one second after the voltage has collapsed.
The main component of the phase directional element is the phase angle comparator with two inputs: the operating signal
(phase current) and the polarizing signal (the line voltage, shifted in the leading direction by the characteristic angle, ECA).
The table shows the operating and polarizing signals used for phase directional control.
Table 5-35: Operating and polarizing signals
Phase Operating signal Polarizing signal Vpol
ABC phase sequence ACB phase sequence
A angle of IA angle of VBC (1ECA) angle of VCB (1ECA)
Mode of operation
• When the function is “Disabled” or the operating current is below 5% CT nominal, the element output is logic “0”
• When the function is “Enabled,” the operating current is above 5% CT nominal, and the polarizing voltage is above
the PRODUCT SETUP DISPLAY PROPERTIES VOLTAGE CUT-OFF LEVEL value, the element output is dependent on the
phase angle between the operating and polarizing signals:
– The element output is logic “0” when the operating current is within polarizing voltage ±90°
– For all other angles, the element output is logic “1”
• Once the voltage memory has expired, the phase overcurrent elements under directional control can be set to block or
trip on overcurrent as follows:
– When BLOCK WHEN V MEM EXP is set to “Yes,” the directional element blocks the operation of any phase
overcurrent element under directional control when voltage memory expires
– When BLOCK WHEN V MEM EXP is set to “No,” the directional element allows tripping of phase overcurrent elements
under directional control when voltage memory expires
In all cases, directional blocking is permitted to resume when the polarizing voltage becomes greater than the polarizing
voltage threshold.
Settings
PHASE DIR 1 FUNCTION — This setting enables and disables the phase directional overcurrent protection element. 5
PHASE DIR 1 SIGNAL SOURCE — This setting is used to select the source for the operating and polarizing signals. The
operating current for the phase directional element is the phase current for the selected current source. The polarizing
voltage is the line voltage from the phase VTs, based on the 90° or quadrature connection and shifted in the leading
direction by the element characteristic angle (ECA).
PHASE DIR 1 BLOCK — Assertion of the operand assigned to this setting blocks operation of the phase directional
overcurrent element.
PHASE DIR 1 ECA — This setting specifies the element characteristic angle, that is, the angle by which the polarizing voltage
is shifted in the leading direction to achieve dependable operation. In the design of the UR-series elements, a block is
applied to an element by asserting logic 1 at the blocking input. Program the phase directional overcurrent element using
this setting so that the output is logic 1 for current in the non-tripping direction.
PHASE DIR 1 POL V THRESHOLD — This setting is used to establish the minimum level of voltage for which the phase angle
measurement is healthy and reliable. Do not set this setting too low because the element can continue using the actual
voltage already distorted by the fault instead of using healthy memory voltage—this can cause wrong directional
discrimination.
PHASE DIR 1 BLOCK WHEN V MEM EXP — This setting is used to select the required operation upon expiration of voltage
memory. When set to "Yes," the directional element blocks the operation of any phase overcurrent element under
directional control, when voltage memory expires. When set to "No," the directional element allows tripping of phase
overcurrent elements under directional control.
PHASE DIR 1 EVENTS — This setting enables and disables the logging of phase directional overcurrent events in the
sequence of events recorder.
The phase directional element responds to the forward load current. In the case of a following reverse fault, the
element needs some time—in the order of 8 ms—to establish a blocking signal. Some protection elements, such as
instantaneous overcurrent, respond to reverse faults before the blocking signal is established. Therefore, a
coordination time of at least 10 ms must be added to all the instantaneous protection elements under the
supervision of the phase directional element. If current reversal is of concern, a longer delay—in the order of 20
ms—is needed.
6(77,1*
$1'
3+$6(',5
%/2&.
2II
6(77,1*
6(77,1* 3+$6(',5(&$
6(77,1* 86($&78$/92/7$*(
3+$6(',5%/2&.2&
:+(190(0(;3 86(0(025,=('92/7$*(
1R
<HV
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
3+$6(%/2*,&6,0,/$5723+$6($ 3+',5%/.%
5
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
3+$6(&/2*,&6,0,/$5723+$6($ 3+',5%/.&
$&'5
5.8.6.1 Menu
SETTINGS GROUPED ELEMENTS SETTING GROUP 1(6) NEUTRAL CURRENT
NEUTRAL CURRENT NEUTRAL TOC 1 See below
NEUTRAL TOC 6
NEUTRAL
DIRECTIONAL OC2
The M60 has up to four neutral instantaneous overcurrent elements (dependent on CT/VT modules ordered).
The neutral time overcurrent element can provide a desired time-delay operating characteristic versus the applied current
5
or be used as a simple definite time element. The neutral current input value is a quantity calculated as 3I0 from the phase
currents and can be programmed as fundamental phasor magnitude or total waveform RMS magnitude as required by the
application.
Two methods of resetting operation are available: “Timed” and “Instantaneous” (see the Inverse TOC Curve Characteristics
section for details on curve setup, trip times, and reset operation). When the element is blocked, the time accumulator
resets according to the reset characteristic. For example, if the element reset characteristic is set to “Instantaneous” and
the element is blocked, the time accumulator clears immediately.
NEUTRAL TOC1 FUNCTION — This setting enables and disables the neutral time overcurrent protection element.
NEUTRAL TOC1 SIGNAL SOURCE — This setting selects the signal source for the neutral time overcurrent protection element.
NEUTRAL TOC1 INPUT — This setting selects how neutral current input quantities are interpreted by the M60. Inputs can be
selected as fundamental phasor magnitudes or total waveform RMS magnitudes as required by the application.
NEUTRAL TOC1 PICKUP — This setting specifies the neutral time overcurrent pickup level in per-unit values.
NEUTRAL TOC1 CURVE — This setting selects the inverse time overcurrent curve style.
NEUTRAL TOC1 TD MULTIPLIER — This setting specifies a multiple of the base curve shape specified by the CURVE setting.
Programming this value to zero results in an instantaneous response to all current levels above pickup.
NEUTRAL TOC1 RESET — The “Instantaneous” reset method is intended for applications with other relays, such as most static
relays, which set the energy capacity directly to zero when the current falls below the reset threshold. The “Timed” reset
method can be used where the relay must coordinate with electromechanical relays.
NEUTRAL TOC1 BLOCK — Assertion of the operand assigned to this setting blocks operation of the neutral time overcurrent
element.
NEUTRAL TOC1 EVENTS — This setting enables and disables the logging of neutral time overcurrent events in the sequence
of events recorder.
SETTING
NEUTRAL TOC1
INPUT
SETTING NEUTRAL TOC1
NEUTRAL TOC1 PICKUP
FUNCTION NEUTRAL TOC1
Enabled = 1 CURVE
NEUTRAL TOC1
TD MULTIPLIER
NEUTRAL TOC 1 FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SETTING
RESET NEUTRAL TOC1 PKP
NEUTRAL TOC1
AND RUN IN ≥ PICKUP NEUTRAL TOC1 DPO
SOURCE
NEUTRAL TOC1 OP
IN t
I
SETTING
NEUTRAL TOC1
BLOCK
Off = 0 827034A4.VSD
5 NEUTRAL IOC1
PICKUP: 1.000 pu
Range: 0.020 to 30.000 pu in steps of 0.001
The neutral instantaneous overcurrent element can be used as an instantaneous function with no intentional delay or as a
definite time function. The element essentially responds to the magnitude of a neutral current fundamental frequency
phasor calculated from the phase currents. A positive-sequence restraint is applied for better performance. A small portion
(6.25%) of the positive-sequence current magnitude is subtracted from the zero-sequence current magnitude when
forming the operating quantity of the element as follows:
Iop = 3 x (|I_0| - K x |I_1|) where K = 1/16 Eq. 5-36
The positive-sequence restraint allows for more sensitive settings by counterbalancing spurious zero-sequence currents
resulting from:
• System unbalances under heavy load conditions
• Transformation errors of current transformers (CTs) during double-line and three-phase faults
• Switch-off transients during double-line and three-phase faults
The positive-sequence restraint must be considered when testing for pickup accuracy and response time (multiple of
pickup). The operating quantity depends on how test currents are injected into the relay, where single-phase injection is
Iop = 0.9375 x Iinjected and three-phase pure zero-sequence injection is Iop = 3 x Iinjected
NEUTRAL IOC1 FUNCTION — This setting enables and disables the neutral instantaneous overcurrent protection element.
NEUTRAL IOC1 SIGNAL SOURCE — This setting selects the signal source for the neutral instantaneous overcurrent protection
element.
NEUTRAL IOC1 PICKUP — This setting specifies the neutral instantaneous overcurrent pickup level in per-unit values.
NEUTRAL IOC1 PICKUP DELAY — This setting delays the assertion of the NEUTRAL IOC OP operands. It is used to achieve timing
coordination with other elements and relays.
NEUTRAL IOC1 RESET DELAY — This setting specifies a delay for the reset of the neutral instantaneous overcurrent element
between the operate output state and the return to logic 0 after the input passes outside the defined pickup range. This
setting is used to ensure that the relay output contacts are closed long enough to ensure reception by downstream
equipment.a
NEUTRAL IOC1 BLOCK — Assertion of the operand assigned to this setting blocks operation of the neutral instantaneous
overcurrent element.
NEUTRAL IOC1 EVENTS — This setting enables and disables the logging of neutral instantaneous overcurrent events in the
sequence of events recorder.
Figure 5-146: Neutral IOC1 logic
6(77,1*
6(77,1*6
1(875$/,2&)81&7,21 1(875$/,2&
6(77,1* 3,&.83'(/$<
(QDEOHG )/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
1(875$/,2&
1(875$/,2&3,&.83 1(875$/,2&3.3
5(6(7'(/$<
6(77,1* 1(875$/,2&'32
$1' 581 W3.3
W567 1(875$/,2&23
1(875$/,2&%/2&. _,B_._,B_3,&.83
2II
6(77,1*
5
1(875$/,2&6285&(
,B
$&'5
The neutral directional overcurrent element provides both forward and reverse fault direction indications for the NEUTRAL
DIR OC1 FWD and NEUTRAL DIR OC1 REV operands, respectively. The output operand is asserted if the magnitude of the
operating current is above a pickup level (overcurrent unit) and the fault direction is seen as forward or reverse,
respectively (directional unit).
The overcurrent unit responds to the magnitude of a fundamental frequency phasor of either the neutral current
calculated from the phase currents or the ground current. There are separate pickup settings for the forward-looking and
reverse-looking functions. If set to use the calculated 3I_0, the element applies a positive-sequence restraint for better
performance: a small user-programmable portion of the positive-sequence current magnitude is subtracted from the
zero-sequence current magnitude when forming the operating quantity.
5 Iop = 3 x (|I_0| - K x |I_1|) Eq. 5-37
The positive-sequence restraint allows for more sensitive settings by counterbalancing spurious zero-sequence currents
resulting from
• System unbalances under heavy load conditions
• Transformation errors of current transformers (CTs) during double-line and three-phase faults
• Switch-off transients during double-line and three-phase faults
The positive-sequence restraint must be considered when testing for pickup accuracy and response time (multiple of
pickup). The operating quantity depends on the way the test currents are injected into the relay (single-phase injection:
Iop = (1 – K) Iinjected ; three-phase pure zero-sequence injection: Iop = 3 Iinjected.
The positive-sequence restraint is removed for low currents. If the positive-sequence current is below 0.8 pu, the restraint is
removed by changing the constant K to zero. This facilitates better response to high-resistance faults when the unbalance
is very small and there is no danger of excessive CT errors as the current is low.
The directional unit uses the zero-sequence current (I_0) or ground current (IG) for fault direction discrimination and can
be programmed to use either zero-sequence voltage (“Calculated V0” or “Measured VX”), ground current (IG), or both for
polarizing. The zero-sequence current (I_0) must be greater than the PRODUCT SETUP DISPLAY PROPERTIES CURRENT
CUT-OFF LEVEL setting value and IG must be greater than 0.05 pu to be validated as the operating quantity for directional
current. The following tables define the neutral directional overcurrent element. V_0 is the zero-sequence voltage, I_0 is
the zero-sequence current, ECA is the element characteristic angle, and IG is the ground current.
where
1
V_0 = --- VAG + VBG + VCG = zero sequence voltage
3 5
1 1
I_0 = --- IN = --- IA + IB + IC = zero sequence current
3 3
ECA = element characteristic angle
IG = ground current
Z_offset is the offset impedance, for which magnitude is the OFFSET setting and angle is the FWD ECA
When NEUTRAL DIR OC1 POL VOLT is set to “Measured VX,” one-third of this voltage is used in place of V_0. The following
figure explains the usage of the voltage polarized directional unit of the element.
The figure shows the voltage-polarized phase angle comparator characteristics for a phase A to ground fault, with:
• ECA = 90° (element characteristic angle = centerline of operating characteristic)
• FWD LA = 80° (forward limit angle = the ± angular limit with the ECA for operation)
• REV LA = 80° (reverse limit angle = the ± angular limit with the ECA for operation)
Take the bias into account when using the neutral directional overcurrent element to directionalize other protection
elements.
#FO \Y^U
B5F<1 6G4<1
\Y^U \Y^U
F17
bUVUbU^SU
B5F?`UbQdY^W 6G4?`UbQdY^W
BUWY_^ BUWY_^
<1 <1
#9O \Y^U
531
531\Y^U
531\Y^U
F37 <1
F27
5
B5F<1 6G4<1
\Y^U \Y^U
#FO \Y^U
("'( %1!34B
NEUTRAL DIR OC1 POLARIZING — This setting selects the polarizing mode for the directional unit.
• If “Voltage” polarizing is selected, the element uses the zero-sequence voltage angle for polarization. The user can use
either the zero-sequence voltage V_0 calculated from the phase voltages, or the zero-sequence voltage supplied
externally as the auxiliary voltage V_X, both from the NEUTRAL DIR OC1 SOURCE.
The calculated V_0 can be used as polarizing voltage only if the voltage transformers are connected in Wye. The
auxiliary voltage can be used as the polarizing voltage provided SYSTEM SETUP AC INPUTS VOLTAGE BANK
AUXILIARY VT CONNECTION is set to “Vn” and the auxiliary voltage is connected to a zero-sequence voltage source
(such as broken delta connected secondary of VTs).
The zero sequence voltage V_0 must be greater than PRODUCT SETUP DISPLAY PROPERTIES VOLTAGE CUT-OFF
LEVEL to be validated for use as polarizing signal. Additionally, when offset impedance is applied and zero-sequence
current is above 0.2 pu, compensated zero-sequence voltage -V_0 + Z_offset x I_0 has to be above 0.02 pu in order to
discriminate fault direction; otherwise when zero-sequence current is less than 0.2 pu, -V_0 is then used as the
polarizing signal. If the polarizing signal is invalid, neither forward nor reverse indication is given.
• If “Current” polarizing is selected, the element uses the ground current angle connected externally and configured
under NEUTRAL OC1 SOURCE for polarization. The ground CT must be connected between the ground and neutral point
of an adequate local source of ground current. The ground current must be greater than 0.05 pu to be validated as a
polarizing signal. If the polarizing signal is not valid, neither forward nor reverse indication is given. In addition, the
zero-sequence current (I_0) must be greater than the PRODUCT SETUP DISPLAY PROPERTIES CURRENT CUT-OFF
LEVEL setting value.
For a choice of current polarizing, it is recommended that the polarizing signal be analyzed to ensure that a known
direction is maintained irrespective of the fault location. For example, if using an autotransformer neutral current as a
polarizing source, ensure that a reversal of the ground current does not occur for a high-side fault. Assume that the
low-side system impedance is minimal when checking for this condition. A similar situation arises for a wye/delta/wye
transformer, where current in one transformer winding neutral can reverse when faults on both sides of the
transformer are considered.
• If “Dual” polarizing is selected, the element performs both directional comparisons as described. A given direction is
confirmed if either voltage or current comparators indicate so. If a conflicting (simultaneous forward and reverse)
indication occurs, the forward direction overrides the reverse direction.
• If "Dual-V" polarizing is selected, "Voltage" polarizing is performed and "Current" polarizing is ignored if the voltage
polarizing signal is valid; otherwise "Current" polarizing is performed if the current polarizing signal is valid. If neither of
them is valid, neither forward nor reverse indication is given.
• If "Dual-I" polarizing is selected, "Current" polarizing is performed and "Voltage" polarizing is ignored if the current
polarizing signal is valid; otherwise "Voltage" polarizing is performed if the voltage polarizing signal is valid. If neither of
them is valid, neither forward nor reverse indication is given.
NEUTRAL DIR OC1 POL VOLT — Selects the polarizing voltage used by the directional unit when "Voltage," "Dual," "Dual-V," or
"Dual-I" polarizing mode is set. The polarizing voltage can be programmed to be either the zero-sequence voltage
calculated from the phase voltages ("Calculated V0") or supplied externally as an auxiliary voltage ("Measured VX").
NEUTRAL DIR OC1 OP CURR — This setting indicates whether the 3I_0 current calculated from the phase currents, or the
ground current is used by this protection. This setting acts as a switch between the neutral and ground modes of operation
(ANSI devices 67N and 67G). If set to “Calculated 3I0,” the element uses the phase currents and applies the positive-
sequence restraint. If set to “Measured IG,” the element uses ground current supplied to the ground CT of the CT bank
configured as NEUTRAL DIR OC1 SOURCE. If this setting is “Measured IG,” then the NEUTRAL DIR OC1 POLARIZING setting must
be “Voltage”, as it is not possible to use the ground current as an operating and polarizing signal simultaneously. IG current
has to be above 0.05 pu to be used as operate quantity.
NEUTRAL DIR OC1 POS-SEQ RESTRAINT — This setting controls the amount of the positive-sequence restraint. Set it to 0.063
for backward compatibility with firmware revision 3.40 and older. Set it to zero to remove the restraint. Set it higher if large
system unbalances or poor CT performance are expected. 5
NEUTRAL DIR OC1 OFFSET — This setting specifies the offset impedance used by this protection. The primary application for
the offset impedance is to guarantee correct identification of fault direction on series compensated lines. In regular
applications, the offset impedance ensures proper operation even if the zero-sequence voltage at the relaying point is very
small. If this is the intent, the offset impedance is not to be larger than the zero-sequence impedance of the protected
circuit. Practically, it shall be several times smaller. Enter the offset impedance in secondary ohms.
NEUTRAL DIR OC1 FWD ECA — This setting defines the characteristic angle (ECA) for the forward direction in the "Voltage"
polarizing mode. The "Current" polarizing mode uses a fixed ECA of 0°. The ECA in the reverse direction is the angle set for
the forward direction shifted by 180°.
NEUTRAL DIR OC1 FWD LIMIT ANGLE — This setting defines a symmetrical (in both directions from the ECA) limit angle for the
forward direction.
NEUTRAL DIR OC1 FWD PICKUP — This setting defines the pickup level for the overcurrent unit of the element in the forward
direction. When selecting this setting, keep in mind that the design uses a positive-sequence restraint technique for the
“Calculated 3I0” mode of operation.
NEUTRAL DIR OC1 REV LIMIT ANGLE — This setting defines a symmetrical (in both directions from the ECA) limit angle for the
reverse direction.
NEUTRAL DIR OC1 REV PICKUP — This setting defines the pickup level for the overcurrent unit of the element in the reverse
direction. When selecting this setting, keep in mind that the design uses a positive-sequence restraint technique for the
“Calculated 3I0” mode of operation.
SETTING
AND SETTINGS
NEUTRAL DIR OC1 BLK: AND
NEUTRAL DIR OC1 FWD
ECA:
Off=0
NEUTRAL DIR OC1 FWD FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
LIMIT ANGLE:
SETTING AND NEUTRAL DIR OC1 FWD
NEUTRAL DIR OC1 NEUTRAL DIR OC1 REV
SOURCE: LIMIT ANGLE:
}
Measured VX OR
Calculated V_0 FWD
1.25 cy
-3V_0 AND
Zero Seq Crt (I_0)
Ground Crt (IG) IG 0.05 pu } REV
3I_0 REV
1.5 cy
Voltage Polarization
5
Current REV
Dual, Dual-V, Dual-I OR
NOTE:
1) CURRENT POLARIZING IS POSSIBLE ONLY IN RELAYS WITH
THE GROUND CURRENT INPUTS CONNECTED TO
AN ADEQUATE CURRENT POLARIZING SOURCE SETTING
NEUTRAL DIR OC1 REV
2) GROUND CURRENT CAN NOT BE USED FOR POLARIZATION PICKUP:
AND OPERATION SIMULTANEOUSLY AND FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
NEUTRAL DIR OC1 OP
3) POSITIVE SEQUENCE RESTRAINT IS NOT APPLIED WHEN CURR: NEUTRAL DIR OC1 REV
I_1 IS BELOW 0.8pu
NEUTRAL DIR OC1 POS-
SEQ RESTRAINT:
RUN
3( I_0 - K I_1 ) PICKUP
OR
827077AE.CDR
IG PICKUP
5.8.7.1 Menu
SETTINGS GROUPED ELEMENTS SETTING GROUP 1(6) GROUND CURRENT
GROUND CURRENT GROUND TOC1 See page 5-298
GROUND TOC4
A time dial multiplier setting allows selection of a multiple of the base curve shape (where the time dial multiplier = 1) with
the curve shape (CURVE) setting. Unlike the electromechanical time dial equivalent, operate times are directly proportional
to the time multiplier (TD MULTIPLIER) setting value. For example, all times for a multiplier of 10 are 10 times the multiplier 1
or base curve values. Setting the multiplier to zero results in an instantaneous response to all current levels above pickup.
Time overcurrent time calculations are made with an internal energy capacity memory variable. When this variable
indicates that the energy capacity has reached 100%, a time overcurrent element operates. If less than 100% energy
capacity is accumulated in this variable and the current falls below the dropout threshold of 97 to 98% of the pickup value,
the variable must be reduced. Two methods of this resetting operation are available: “Instantaneous” and “Timed.” The
“Instantaneous” selection is intended for applications with other relays, such as most static relays, which set the energy
capacity directly to zero when the current falls below the reset threshold. The “Timed” selection can be used where the
relay must coordinate with electromechanical relays.
The URs calculate operate time corresponding to the values in the range of 1.03 to 20 multiples of the pickup current.
5
Above 20 multiples of the pickup current, URs clamp the operate time to the value at a multiple of 20, resulting in the flat
part of the characteristics. Reset time is calculated in the range of 0 to 0.97 multiples of the pickup current.
IEEE curves
The IEEE time overcurrent curve shapes conform to industry standards and the IEEE C37.112-1996 curve classifications for
extremely, very, and moderately inverse curves. The IEEE curves are derived from the operate and reset time equations.
A tr
------------------------------- + B -------------------------------
-
I ·p
T = TDM u § ------------- , T RESET = TDM u I 2 Eq. 5-38
© I pickup¹ – 1
- 1 – §© -------------- ·¹
I pickup
where
T = operate time (in seconds)
TDM = Multiplier setting
I = input current
Ipickup = Pickup Current setting
A, B, p = constants defined in the table
TRESET = reset time in seconds (assuming energy capacity is 100% and RESET is “Timed”)
tr = characteristic constant defined in the table
Table 5-39: IEEE inverse time curve constants
IEEE curve shape A B p tr
IEEE Extremely Inverse 28.2 0.1217 2.0000 29.1
IEEE Very Inverse 19.61 0.491 2.0000 21.6
IEEE Moderately Inverse 0.0515 0.1140 0.02000 4.85
5 1.0
2.0
6.439
12.878
3.803
7.606
2.432
4.864
1.946
3.892
1.688
3.377
1.526
3.051
1.412
2.823
1.327
2.653
1.260
2.521
1.207
2.414
4.0 25.756 15.213 9.729 7.783 6.753 6.102 5.647 5.307 5.041 4.827
6.0 38.634 22.819 14.593 11.675 10.130 9.153 8.470 7.960 7.562 7.241
8.0 51.512 30.426 19.458 15.567 13.507 12.204 11.294 10.614 10.083 9.654
10.0 64.390 38.032 24.322 19.458 16.883 15.255 14.117 13.267 12.604 12.068
IEC curves
For European applications, the relay offers three standard curves defined in IEC 255-4 and British standard BS142. These
are defined as IEC Curve A, IEC Curve B, and IEC Curve C. The IEC curves are derived by the operate and reset time
equations.
K tr
----------------------------------- ----------------------------------
-
T = TDM u I e I pickup E – 1 , T RESET = TDM u 1 – I e I 2 Eq. 5-39
pickup
where
T = operate time (in seconds)
TDM = Multiplier setting
I = input current
Ipickup = Pickup Current setting
K, E = constants defined in the table
tr = characteristic constant defined in the table
TRESET = reset time in seconds (assuming energy capacity is 100% and RESET is “Timed”)
Table 5-41: IEC (BS) inverse time curve constants
IEC (BS) curve shape K E tr
IEC Curve A (BS142) 0.140 0.020 9.7
IEC Curve B (BS142) 13.500 1.000 43.2
IAC curves
The curves for the General Electric type IAC relay family are derived from the formulae:
§ B D E ·
T = TDM u ¨ A + --------------------------- + ---------------------------------2 + ---------------------------------3¸ tr
, T RESET = TDM u ---------------------------- Eq. 5-40
I e I pkp – C I e I pkp – C I e I pkp – C ¹ -
© 2
1 – I e I pkp
where
I2t curves
The I2t curves are derived as follows:
100 100
----------------------- -------------------------
I · 2 , T RESET = TDM u § I · –2
T = TDM u § ------------- Eq. 5-41
- --------------
© I pickup ¹ © I pickup ¹
where
T = Operate time (in seconds)
TDM = Multiplier setting
I = Input current
Ipickup = Pickup Current setting
TRESET = reset time in seconds (assuming energy capacity is 100% and RESET is “Timed”)
FlexCurves
FlexCurves are described in the FlexCurves section later in this chapter. The curve shapes for the FlexCurves are derived
from the formulae:
I I
T = TDM u FlexCurve Time at §© --------------·¹ when §© --------------·¹ t 1.00
I pickup I pickup Eq. 5-42
I I
T RESET = TDM u FlexCurve Time at §© --------------·¹ when §© --------------·¹ d 0.98
I pickup I pickup Eq. 5-43
where
T = operate time (in seconds)
TDM = Multiplier setting
I = Input Current
Ipickup = Pickup Current setting
TRESET = Reset Time in seconds (assuming energy capacity is 100% and RESET: Timed)
where
T = Operate Time (in seconds)
TDM = Multiplier setting
I = Input Current
Ipickup = Pickup Current setting
TRESET = Reset Time in seconds (assuming energy capacity is 100% and RESET: Timed)
Recloser curves
The M60 uses the FlexCurve feature to facilitate programming of 41 recloser curves. See the FlexCurves settings section
earlier in this chapter for details.
This element can provide a required time-delay operating characteristic versus the applied current or be used as a simple
definite time element. The ground current input value is the quantity measured by the ground input CT and is the
fundamental phasor or RMS magnitude. Two methods of resetting operation are available: “Timed” and “Instantaneous”
(see the Inverse TOC Curve Characteristics section for details). When the element is blocked, the time accumulator resets
according to the reset characteristic. For example, if the element reset characteristic is set to “Instantaneous” and the
element is blocked, the time accumulator clears immediately.
GROUND TOC1 FUNCTION — This setting enables and disables the ground time overcurrent protection element.
GROUND TOC1 SIGNAL SOURCE — This setting selects the signal source for the ground time overcurrent protection element.
GROUND TOC1 INPUT — This setting selects how ground current input quantities are interpreted by the M60. Inputs can be
selected as fundamental phasor magnitudes or total waveform RMS magnitudes as required by the application.
GROUND TOC1 PICKUP — This setting specifies the ground time overcurrent pickup level in per-unit values. With a Process
Bus Module, accuracy of the element is determined by the sum of the relay internal processing errors and input signal
from the merging unit errors, which can be significant depending on the merging unit design. For low level pickup settings,
especially less than 0.020 pu with a Process Bus Module, ensure that the selected merging unit meets given application
accuracy requirements.
GROUND TOC1 CURVE — This setting selects the inverse time overcurrent curve style.
GROUND TOC1 TD MULTIPLIER — This setting specifies a multiple of the base curve shape specified by the CURVE setting.
Programming this value to zero results in an instantaneous response to all current levels above pickup.
GROUND TOC1 RESET — The “Instantaneous” reset method is intended for applications with other relays, such as most static
relays, which set the energy capacity directly to zero when the current falls below the reset threshold. The “Timed” reset
method can be used where the relay must coordinate with electromechanical relays.
GROUND TOC1 BLOCK — Assertion of the operand assigned to this setting blocks operation of the ground time overcurrent
element.
These elements measure the current that is connected to the ground channel of a CT/VT module. The conversion
range of a standard channel is from 0.02 to 46 times the CT rating.
This channel can be also equipped with a sensitive input. The conversion range of a sensitive channel is from 0.002
to 4.6 times the CT rating.
5
Figure 5-149: Ground TOC1 logic
SETTINGS
GROUND TOC1
INPUT:
SETTING GROUND TOC1
GROUND TOC1 PICKUP:
FUNCTION: GROUND TOC1
Enabled = 1 CURVE:
GROUND TOC1
TD MULTIPLIER:
GROUND TOC 1 FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
SETTING
RESET: GROUND TOC1 PKP
GROUND TOC1
AND RUN IG PICKUP GROUND TOC1 DPO
SOURCE:
GROUND TOC1 OP
IG t
I
SETTING
GROUND TOC1
BLOCK:
827036A4.VSD
Off = 0
The ground instantaneous overcurrent element can be used as an instantaneous element with no intentional delay or as a
definite time element. The ground current input is the quantity measured by the ground input CT and is the fundamental
phasor magnitude.
GROUND IOC1 FUNCTION — This setting enables and disables the element.
GROUND IOC1 SIGNAL SOURCE — This setting selects the signal source for the element.
GROUND IOC1 PICKUP — This setting specifies the pickup level in per-unit values. With a Process Bus Module, accuracy of
the element is determined by the sum of the relay internal processing errors and input signal from the merging unit errors,
which can be significant depending on the merging unit design. For low level pickup settings, especially less than 0.020 pu
with a Process Bus Module, ensure that the selected merging unit meets the given application accuracy requirements.
GROUND IOC1 PICKUP DELAY — This setting specifies the definite time delay after which the operate signal asserts.
GROUND IOC1 RESET DELAY — This setting specifies the reset time delay.
5 GROUND IOC1 BLOCK — Assertion of the operand assigned to this setting blocks operation of the element.
These elements measure the current that is connected to the ground channel of a CT/VT module. The conversion
range of a standard channel is from 0.02 to 46 times the CT rating.
This channel can be equipped with a standard or sensitive input. The conversion range of a sensitive channel is
from 0.002 to 4.6 times the CT rating.
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
GROUND IOC1 PKP
SETTING GROUND IOIC DPO
GROUND IOC1
SETTINGS GROUND IOC1 OP
FUNCTION:
Enabled = 1 GROUND IOC1 PICKUP
SETTING DELAY:
GROUND IOC1 GROUND IOC1 RESET
SETTING
PICKUP: DELAY:
GROUND IOC1
AND RUN tPKP
SOURCE:
IG
IG PICKUP tRST
SETTING
GROUND IOC1
BLOCK:
827037A5.VSD
Off = 0
5 A breaker failure scheme determines that a breaker signaled to trip has not cleared a fault within a definite time, so further
tripping action must be performed. Tripping from the breaker failure scheme trips all breakers, both local and remote, that
can supply current to the faulted zone. Usually operation of a breaker failure element causes clearing of a larger section of
the power system than the initial trip. Because breaker failure can result in tripping a large number of breakers and this
affects system safety and stability, a very high level of security is required.
Two schemes are provided: one for three-pole tripping only (identified by the name “3BF”) and one for three pole plus
single-pole operation (identified by the name “1BF”). The philosophy used in these schemes is identical. The operation of a
breaker failure element includes three stages: initiation, determination of a breaker failure condition, and output.
FAULT cycles
OCCURS
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
827083A6.CDR
The current supervision elements reset in less than 0.7 of a power cycle for any multiple of pickup current as shown in the
following figure.
0.8
Margin
0.4
0.2
0
0 20 40 60 80 100 120 140
MulWLple of pickup fault current
threshold setting 836769A4.CDR
5.8.8.5 Settings
BF1 MODE — This setting is used to select the breaker failure operating mode: single or three pole.
BF1 USE AMP SUPV — If set to "Yes," the element is initiated if current flowing through the breaker is above the supervision
5 pickup level.
BF1 USE SEAL-IN — If set to "Yes," the element is sealed-in if current flowing through the breaker is above the supervision
pickup level.
BF1 3-POLE INITIATE — This setting selects the FlexLogic operand that initiates three-pole tripping of the breaker.
BF1 RETRIP PICKUP DELAY — This setting specifies a pickup delay for the re-trip command. Set this delay longer than the
possible spurious contact input activation duration due to transients or temporary DC grounds, taking into account the
contact input de-bounce time to avoid re-trip operation for such transients.
BF1 PH AMP SUPV PICKUP — This setting is used to set the phase current initiation and seal-in supervision level. Generally this
setting detects the lowest expected fault current on the protected breaker. It can be set as low as necessary (lower than
breaker resistor current or lower than load current)—HISET and LOWSET current supervision guarantee correct operation.
BF1 N AMP SUPV PICKUP — This setting is used to set the neutral current initiate and seal-in supervision level. Generally this
setting detects the lowest expected fault current on the protected breaker. Neutral current supervision is used only in the
three phase scheme to provide increased sensitivity. This setting is valid only for three-pole tripping schemes.
BF1 USE TIMER 1 — If set to "Yes," the early path is operational.
BF1 TIMER 1 PICKUP DELAY — Timer 1 is set to the shortest time required for breaker auxiliary contact Status-1 to open, from
the time the initial trip signal is applied to the breaker trip circuit, plus a safety margin.
BF1 USE TIMER 2 — If set to "Yes," the main path is operational.
BF1 TIMER 2 PICKUP DELAY — Timer 2 is set to the expected opening time of the breaker, plus a safety margin. This safety
margin was historically intended to allow for measuring and timing errors in the breaker failure scheme equipment. In
microprocessor relays this time is not significant. In M60 relays, which use a Fourier transform, the calculated current
magnitude ramps-down to zero one power frequency cycle after the current is interrupted, however this lag does not
need to be included in the overall margin duration due to a novel current supervision reset element, as it occurs after
current interruption. As shown in the previous figure, this current supervision reset element guarantees breaker failure
reset in less than 0.7 power cycles for any subsidence current and irrespective of the magnitude of the fault current.
Note that in bulk oil circuit breakers, the interrupting time for currents less than 25% of the interrupting rating can be
significantly longer than the normal interrupting time.
BF1 USE TIMER 3 — If set to "Yes," the Slow Path is operational.
BF1 TIMER 3 PICKUP DELAY — Timer 3 is set to the same interval as Timer 2, plus an increased safety margin. Because this
path is intended to operate only for low level faults, the delay can be in the order of 300 to 500 ms.
BF1 BKR POS1 A/3P — This setting selects the FlexLogic operand that represents the protected breaker early-type auxiliary
switch contact (52/a). When using the single-pole breaker failure scheme, this operand represents the protected breaker
early-type auxiliary switch contact on pole A. This is normally a non-multiplied form-A contact. The contact can even be
adjusted to have the shortest possible operating time.
BF1 BKR POS2 A/3P — This setting selects the FlexLogic operand that represents the breaker normal-type auxiliary switch
contact (52/a). When using the single-pole breaker failure scheme, this operand represents the protected breaker auxiliary
switch contact on pole A. This can be a multiplied contact.
BF1 BKR TEST ON — This setting is used to select the FlexLogic operand that represents the breaker in-service/out-of-service
switch set to the out-of-service position.
BF1 PH AMP HISET PICKUP — This setting sets the phase current output supervision level. Generally this setting is to detect
the lowest expected fault current on the protected breaker, before a breaker opening resistor is inserted.
BF1 N AMP HISET PICKUP — This setting sets the neutral current output supervision level. Generally this setting is to detect
the lowest expected fault current on the protected breaker, before a breaker opening resistor is inserted. Neutral current
supervision is used only in the three pole scheme to provide increased sensitivity. This setting is valid only for three-pole
breaker failure schemes.
BF1 PH AMP LOSET PICKUP — This setting sets the phase current output supervision level. Generally this setting is to detect
the lowest expected fault current on the protected breaker, after a breaker opening resistor is inserted (approximately 90%
of the resistor current).
BF1 N AMP LOSET PICKUP — This setting sets the neutral current output supervision level. Generally this setting is to detect
the lowest expected fault current on the protected breaker, after a breaker opening resistor is inserted (approximately 90%
of the resistor current). This setting is valid only for three-pole breaker failure schemes.
BF1 LOSET TIME DELAY — Sets the pickup delay for current detection after opening resistor insertion. 5
BF1 TRIP DROPOUT DELAY — This setting is used to set the period of time for which the trip output is sealed-in. This timer
must be coordinated with the automatic reclosing scheme of the failed breaker, to which the breaker failure element sends
a cancel reclosure signal. Reclosure of a remote breaker can also be prevented by holding a transfer trip signal on longer
than the reclaim time.
BF1 PH A INITIATE / BF1 PH B INITIATE / BF1 PH C INITIATE — These settings select the FlexLogic operand to initiate phase A, B,
or C single-pole tripping of the breaker and the phase A, B, or C portion of the scheme, accordingly. This setting is only valid
for single-pole breaker failure schemes.
BF1 BKR POS1 B / BF1 BKR POS 1 C — These settings select the FlexLogic operand to represents the protected breaker
early-type auxiliary switch contact on poles B or C, accordingly. This contact is normally a non-multiplied Form-A contact.
The contact can even be adjusted to have the shortest possible operating time. This setting is valid only for single-pole
breaker failure schemes.
BF1 BKR POS2 B — Selects the FlexLogic operand that represents the protected breaker normal-type auxiliary switch
contact on pole B (52/a). This can be a multiplied contact. This setting is valid only for single-pole breaker failure schemes.
BF1 BKR POS2 C — This setting selects the FlexLogic operand that represents the protected breaker normal-type auxiliary
switch contact on pole C (52/a). This can be a multiplied contact. For single-pole operation, the scheme has the same
overall general concept except that it provides re-tripping of each single pole of the protected breaker. The approach
shown in the following single pole tripping diagram uses the initiating information to determine which pole is supposed to
trip. The logic is segregated on a per-pole basis. The overcurrent detectors have ganged settings. This setting is valid only
for single-pole breaker failure schemes.
Upon operation of the breaker failure element for a single pole trip command, a three-pole trip command needs to be
given via output operand BKR FAIL 1 TRIP OP.
5.8.8.6 Logic
Figure 5-153: Single-pole breaker failure, initiate logic
SETTINGS
Function
Enabled = 1
AND
Block
Off = 0
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
TRIP PHASE A
from the trip output element
OR Initiated
SETTING To breaker failure
Phase A Initiate single-pole logic sheet 2
Off = 0 OR SETTING
BF1 RETRIP PICKUP
DELAY FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND OR
TRIP 3-POLE AND BKR FAIL 1 RETRIP A
0
from the trip output element
OR Initiated phase A
SETTING
Three-Pole Initiate To breaker failure
Off = 0 single-pole logic sheet 2
SETTING
AND
Use Seal-In
Yes = 1
Seal-in path
No = 0
AND OR
SETTING OR
Use Current Supervision
Yes = 1 SETTING
No = 0 OR BF1 RETRIP PICKUP
AND DELAY FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND AND BKR FAIL 1 RETRIP B
Seal-in path 0
TRIP PHASE B
from the trip output element
Initiated phase B
OR
5
OR
SETTING To breaker failure
single-pole logic sheet 2
Phase B Initiate
Off = 0
OR
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AND
TRIP PHASE C SETTING
from the trip output element BF1 RETRIP PICKUP
OR DELAY FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Seal-in path AND BKR FAIL 1 RETRIP C
SETTING 0
Phase C Initiate SETTING
Off = 0 Phase Current Initiated phase C
Supervision Pickup
RUN To breaker failure
IA = Pickup single-pole logic sheet 2
SETTING
SETTING
Source RUN OR
IA IB = Pickup
IB RUN
IC IC = Pickup
IC
to breaker failure
IB
single-pole logic sheet 3
IA
859773A1.CDR
25
$1' ,$ 3LFNXS
,QLWLDWHGSKDVH$
IURPVLQJOHSROHEUHDNHU 6(77,1*
IDLOXUHORJLFVKHHW 6(77,1*
7LPHU3LFNXS'HOD\ /R6HW7LPH'HOD\ 6(77,1*
3KDVH&XUUHQW/R6HW3LFNXS
6(77,1*
$1' 581
8VH7LPHU
<HV ,$ 3LFNXS
1R
6(77,1*
6(77,1*6
7LPHU3LFNXS'HOD\ $1' 6(77,1*
%UHDNHU3RV3KDVH%
3KDVH&XUUHQW+L6HW3LFNXS
2II
$1' 25 581
,QLWLDWHGSKDVH% ,% 3LFNXS
IURPVLQJOHSROHEUHDNHU 6(77,1*
IDLOXUHORJLFVKHHW 6(77,1*
,$
,%
Figure 5-154: Single-pole breaker failure, timers logic
,&
6(77,1*6
8VH7LPHU
<HV
%UHDNHU3RV3KDVH$3
2II 6(77,1*
%UHDNHU3RV3KDVH% 7LPHU3LFNXS'HOD\
2II )/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
%UHDNHU3RV3KDVH& $1' %.5)$,/723
2II
%UHDNHU7HVW2Q
2II
,QLWLDWHG
IURPVLQJOHSROHEUHDNHUIDLOXUHORJLFVKHHW $&'5
5-307
GROUPED ELEMENTS
5
GROUPED ELEMENTS CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS
SETTING
BF1 FUNCTION:
Disable=0
Enable=1
SETTING AND
BF1 BLOCK:
Off=0
SETTING
BF1 INITIATE: SETTING
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
BF1 RETRIP PICKUP
DELAY
BKR FAIL 1 RETRIP
Off=0
OR 0
AND
TO SHEET 2 OF 2
SETTING (Initiated)
BF1 USE SEAL-IN:
YES=1
NO=0
AND
Seal In Path
AND
OR
SETTING
BF1 USE AMP SUPV:
YES=1
NO=0 OR
5 SETTINGS
BF1 PH AMP SUPV
PICKUP:
RUN
IA ³ PICKUP
IA
RUN
IB IB ³ PICKUP
OR
RUN
IC IC ³ PICKUP
RUN
IN ³ PICKUP
IN
TO SHEET 2 OF 2
(827068.cdr)
859775A1.cdr
6(77,1*
%)%.5326Ů$3
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
2II %.5)$,/723
6(77,1*
%)7,0(53,&.83
6(77,1* '(/$<
25
%)86(7,0(5
$1'
<(6
12
6(77,1*6
%)3+$03+,6(7
3,&.83
581
,%
,% t3,&.83
581
,&
,& t3,&.83
581
,1
,1 t3,&.83
6(77,1*6
%)3+$03/26(7 6(77,1*
6(77,1* 3,&.83
6(77,1* %)75,3'523287
%)/26(77,0( 7,0('(/$<
%)1$03/26(7 )/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
%)86(7,0(5 '(/$<
3,&.83
25 %.5)$,/75,323
<(6 581
Figure 5-156: Three-pole breaker failure, timers logic
12
,$ t3,&.83
581
,% t3,&.83
6(77,1*
%)%.5326Ů$3 581
,& t3,&.83
2II 581
6(77,1* ,1 t3,&.83
6(77,1* %)7,0(53,&.83
'(/$<
%)%5($.(57(6721
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
$1'
2II
%.5)$,/723
$FGU
5-309
GROUPED ELEMENTS
5
GROUPED ELEMENTS CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS
5.8.9.1 Menu
SETTINGS GROUPED ELEMENTS SETTING GROUP 1(6) VOLTAGE ELEMENTS
VOLTAGE ELEMENTS PHASE See below
UNDERVOLTAGE1
PHASE
UNDERVOLTAGE3
5 NEG SEQ OV 3
AUXILIARY OV2
D
T = ------------------------------
V ·
§ 1 – --------------- - Eq. 5-46
© V pickup¹
where
T = operating time
D = undervoltage delay setting (D = 0.00 operates instantaneously)
V = secondary voltage applied to the relay
Vpickup = pickup level
For reset time, see the settings section of the applicable element.
Figure 5-157: Inverse time undervoltage curves
Time (seconds)
% of voltage pickup
842788A1.CDR
At 0% of pickup, the operating time equals the corresponding undervoltage element DELAY setting.
7LPHVHFRQGV
'
'
'
5
RIYROWDJHSLFNXS
$&'5
This element is used to give a time-delay operating characteristic versus the applied fundamental voltage.
PHASE UV1 SIGNAL SOURCE — Selects the signal source for the phase undervoltage protection element.
PHASE UV1 MODE — This setting defines the mode of operation that can be Phase-to-Phase or Phase-to-Ground voltage.
Phase-to-ground or phase-to-phase voltages can be applied for wye VT connection, while phase-to-phase voltages can be
applied for delta VT connections only.
PHASE UV1 PICKUP — This setting specifies the phase undervoltage protection element pickup level.
PHASE UV1 CURVE — This setting defines the timing characteristic of the element, which can be Definite Time, Inverse Time
(per the curves described earlier in the Voltage Elements > Undervoltage Inverse Time Curves section), or FlexCurves A
through D. The timing characteristic depends on this setting and the Delay setting that follows.
PHASE UV1 DELAY — This setting defines the operation time of the element.
When the PHASE UV1 CURVE setting is set to Definite Time, the PHASE UV1 DELAY setting defines definite time delay for
element operation.
When the PHASE UV1 CURVE setting is set to Inverse Time, the PHASE UV1 DELAY setting defines the inverse curve time delay
multiplier (D) that is used in the curve equation explained in the Voltage Elements > Undervoltage Inverse Time Curves
section.
When the PHASE UV1 CURVE setting is set to one of the FlexCurves, the PHASE UV1 DELAY setting defines the FlexCurve time
delay multiplier (D) that is used in the following curve equation:
T = D × FlexCurve time at (Vpkp/V) Eq. 5-48
For FlexCurves configuration instructions, see the System Setup > FlexCurves section.
PHASE UV1 RESET DELAY — When the Curve setting is set to Definite Time or Inverse Time, the element resets when applied
voltage exceeds the dropout voltage for the duration of the selected RESET DELAY setting.
When the Curve setting is set to one of the FlexCurves, the element reset is based on the equation and not the PHASE UV1
RESET DELAY setting.
5
As shown in the equation, because the element is supposed to operate in undervoltage condition, the multiple of pickup
value that defines the point on the FlexCurve characteristic is derived from the ratio of the set pickup value to the
measured voltage (and not the reverse). For example, if Pickup is set to 0.9 pu, when measured voltage is 0.82 pu, the ratio
is 0.9/0.82 = 1.1. Therefore, in FlexCurve, the corresponding operate time is at 1.1 x PKP (not at 0.82 x PKP). On the other
hand, when measured voltage is 1 pu, the ratio is 0.9/1 = 0.9. Therefore, in FlexCurve, the corresponding reset time is at
0.9 x PKP.
PHASE UV1 MINIMUM VOLTAGE — This setting selects the operating voltage below which the element is blocked (a setting of
"0" allows a dead source to be considered a fault condition).
PHASE U V1 MODE:
859824A1.vsdx
This element gives a time-delay operating characteristic versus the applied fundamental voltage.
PHASE OV1 SIGNAL SOURCE — Selects the signal source for the phase overvoltage protection element.
PHASE OV1 MODE — This setting defines the mode of operation, which can be Phase-to-Phase or Phase-to-Ground voltage.
Phase-to-ground or phase-to-phase voltages can be applied for wye VT connection, while phase-to-phase voltages can be
applied for delta VT connections only.
PHASE OV1 PICKUP — This setting specifies phase overvoltage protection element pickup level.
PHASE OV1 CURVE — This setting defines the timing characteristic of the element, which can be: Definite Time, Inverse Time
(per the curves described in the Voltage Elements > Overvoltage Inverse Time Curves section), FlexCurves A through D. The
timing characteristic depends on this setting and the Pickup Delay setting that follows.
PHASE OV1 PICKUP DELAY — This setting defines the operation time of the element.
When the PHASE OV1 CURVE setting is set to Definite Time, the PHASE OV1 PICKUP DELAY setting defines definite time delay
for element operation.
When the PHASE OV1 CURVE setting is set to Inverse Time, the PHASE OV1 PICKUP DELAY setting defines the inverse curve
time delay multiplier (D) that is used in the Voltage Elements > Overvoltage Inverse Time Curves section.
When the PHASE OV1 CURVE setting is set to one of the FlexCurves, the PHASE OV1 PICKUP DELAY setting defines the
FlexCurve time delay multiplier (D) that is used in the following curve equation:
T= D × FlexCurve time at (V/Vpkp) Eq. 5-49
For FlexCurves configuration instructions, see the System Setup > FlexCurves section.
PHASE OV1 RESET DELAY — When the Curve setting is set to Definite Time or Inverse Time, the element resets when applied
voltage goes below the dropout voltage for the duration of the selected RESET DELAY setting.
When the Curve setting is set to one of the FlexCurves, the element reset is based on the equation and not the PHASE OV1
RESET DELAY setting.
As shown in the equation, the multiple of pickup value that defines the point on the FlexCurve characteristic is derived from
the ratio of the measured voltage to the set pickup. For example, if Pickup is set to 1.1 pu when the measured voltage is 1.3
pu, the ratio is 1.3/1.1 = 1.2. Therefore, in FlexCurve, the corresponding operate time is at 1.2 x PKP (not at 1.3 x PKP). On the
other hand, when measured voltage is 1 pu, the ratio is 1/1.1 = 0.9. Therefore, in FlexCurve, the corresponding reset time is
at 0.9 x PKP.
Figure 5-160: Phase overvoltage logic
SETTING
5
PHASE OV1 CURVE:
SETTING
The neutral overvoltage element is used to detect asymmetrical system voltage condition due to a ground fault or to the
loss of one or two phases of the source. The element responds to the system neutral voltage (3V_0), calculated from the
phase voltages. The nominal secondary voltage of the phase voltage channels entered under SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP
AC INPUTS VOLTAGE BANK PHASE VT SECONDARY is the p.u. base used when setting the pickup level.
The neutral overvoltage element can provide a time-delayed operating characteristic versus the applied voltage (initialized
from FlexCurves A, B, or C) or be used as a definite time element. The NEUTRAL OV1 PICKUP DELAY setting applies only if the
5 NEUTRAL OV1 CURVE setting is “Definite Time.” The source assigned to this element must be configured for a phase VT.
VT errors and normal voltage unbalance must be considered when setting this element. This function requires the VTs to
be wye-connected.
Figure 5-161: Neutral overvoltage1 logic
SETTING
NEUTRAL OV1
FUNCTION:
SETTING SETTING
Enabled=1
NEUTRAL OV1 PICKUP
NEUTRAL OV1 PICKUP: DELAY :
SETTING
AND RUN NEUTRAL OV1 RESET
DELAY :
NEUTRAL OV1 BLOCK:
NEUTRAL OV1 CURVE :
Off=0
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
3V_0< Pickup tPKP
t NEUTRAL OV1 OP
SETTING tRST
NEUTRAL OV1 DPO
NEUTRAL OV1 SIGNAL
SOURCE: NEUTRAL OV1 PKP
ZERO SEQ VOLT (V_0)
827848A3.CDR
5
DELAY:
Off = 0 NEG SEQ OV1 DPO
t PKP
t RST NEG SEQ OV1 OP
SETTING V_2 > PICKUP
NEG SEQ OV1 SIGNAL
SOURCE:
NEG SEQ VOLTAGE V_2
827839A4.CDR
5 For FlexCurves configuration instructions, see the System Setup > FlexCurves section.
AUX UV1 RESET DELAY — When the Curve setting is set to Definite Time or Inverse Time, the element resets when applied
voltage exceeds the dropout voltage for the duration of the selected RESET DELAY setting.
When the Curve setting is set to one of the FlexCurves, the element reset is based on the equation and not the AUX UV1
RESET DELAY setting.
As shown in the equation, because the element is supposed to operate in undervoltage condition, the multiple of pickup
value that defines the point on the FlexCurve characteristic is derived from the ratio of the set pickup value to the
measured voltage (and not the reverse). For example, if the Pickup is set to 0.9 pu, when the measured voltage is 0.82 pu,
the ratio is 0.9/0.82 = 1.1. Therefore, in the FlexCurve, the corresponding operate time is at 1.1 x PKP (not at 0.82 x PKP). On
the other hand, when measured voltage is 1 pu, the ratio is 0.9/1 = 0.9. Therefore, in the FlexCurve, the corresponding reset
time is at 0.9 x PKP.
AUX UV1 DELAY — Selects the minimum operating time of the auxiliary undervoltage element.
AUX UV1 RESET DELAY — The element resets if the applied voltage exceeds the dropout voltage for the duration of the
selected RESET DELAY setting.
AUX UV1 MINIMUM VOLTAGE — Selects the operating voltage below which the element is blocked.
SETTING
AUX UV1 SETTING
FUNCTION:
AUX UV1 PICKUP:
Enabled=1
Off=0 AND
AUX UV1 RESET DELAY:
SETTING FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
SETTING RUN Vx Pickup AUX UV1 PKP
AUX UV1 MINIMUM
AUX UV1 SIGNAL VOLTAGE: t AUX UV1 DPO
SOURCE:
AUX UV1 OP
AUX VOLT Vx Vx Minimum
V
TRST
859822A1.vsdx
This element is intended for monitoring overvoltage conditions of the auxiliary voltage. Monitoring the neutral voltage
supplied from an open-delta VT connection is a typical application for this element. Another typical application is
monitoring the zero-sequence voltage (3V_0) supplied from an open-corner-delta VT connection.
AUX OV1 SIGNAL SOURCE — Selects the signal source for the auxiliary overvoltage protection element.
AUX OV1 PICKUP — This setting specifies auxiliary overvoltage protection element pickup level in per-unit values.
The nominal secondary voltage of the auxiliary voltage channel entered under SYSTEM SETUP AC INPUTS VOLTAGE
BANK X5 AUXILIARY VT SECONDARY is the per-unit base used when setting the pickup level.
AUX OV1 CURVE — This setting defines the timing characteristic of the element, which can be: Definite Time, Inverse Time
(per the curves described in the Voltage Elements > Overvoltage Inverse Time Curves section), FlexCurves A through D. The
timing characteristic depends on this setting and the Pickup Delay setting that follows.
AUX OV1 PICKUP DELAY — This setting defines the operation time of the element.
When the AUX OV1 CURVE setting is set to Definite Time, the AUX OV1 PICKUP DELAY setting defines definite time delay for
element operation.
When the AUX OV1 CURVE setting is set to Inverse Time, the AUX OV1 PICKUP DELAY setting defines inverse curve time delay
multiplier (D), that is used in the Voltage Elements > Overvoltage Inverse Time Curves section.
When the AUX OV1 CURVE setting is set to one of the FlexCurves, the AUX OV1 PICKUP DELAY setting defines the FlexCurve
time delay multiplier (D) that is used in the following equation:
T = D × FlexCurve time at (V/Vpkp) Eq. 5-51
For FlexCurves configuration instructions, see the System Setup > FlexCurves section.
AUX OV1 RESET DELAY — When the Curve setting is set to Definite Time or Inverse Time, the element resets when applied
voltage goes below the dropout voltage for the duration of the selected RESET DELAY setting.
When the Curve setting is set to one of the FlexCurves, the elements reset is based on the equation and not the AUX OV1
RESET DELAY setting.
As shown in the equation, the multiple of pickup value that defines the point on the FlexCurve characteristic is derived from
the ratio of the measured voltage to the set pickup. For example, if Pickup is set to 1.1 pu, when measured voltage is 1.3 pu,
the ratio is 1.3/1.1 = 1.2. Therefore, in the FlexCurve, the corresponding operate time is at 1.2 x PKP (not at 1.3 x PKP). On the
other hand, when measured voltage is 1 pu, the ratio is 1/1.1 = 0.9. Therefore, in the FlexCurve, the corresponding reset
time is at 0.9 x PKP.
Figure 5-164: Auxiliary overvoltage logic
SETTING
AUX OV1
FUNCTION:
Enabled=1 SETTING
SETTING
AUX OV1 CURVE:
SETTING AUX OV1 PICKUP:
AND
5
AUX OV1 PICKUP DELAY:
AUX OV1 BLOCK: RUN
t
SETTING
Vx ≥ Pickup V FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
AUX OV1 SIGNAL
SOURCE: TRST AUX OV1 OP
AUX OV1 DPO
AUXILIARY VOLT (Vx)
AUX OV1 PKP
859821A1.vsdx
5.8.10 Power
5.8.10.1 Menu
SETTINGS GROUPED ELEMENTS SETTING GROUP 1(6) POWER
POWER SENSITIVE See below
DIRECTIONAL POWER
The sensitive directional power element responds to three-phase directional power and is designed for reverse power and
low forward power applications for synchronous machines or interconnections involving co-generation. The relay
measures the three-phase power from either a full set of wye-connected VTs or a full set of delta-connected VTs. In the
latter case, the two-wattmeter method is used. See the UR-series Metering Conventions section in chapter 6 for details
regarding the active and reactive powers used by the sensitive directional power element.
The element has an adjustable characteristic angle and minimum operating power as shown in the Directional Power
5
Characteristic diagram that follows. The element responds to the following condition:
P cos θ + Q sin θ > SMIN Eq. 5-52
where
P and Q are active and reactive powers as measured per the UR metering convention
is a sum of the element characteristic (DIR POWER 1 RCA) and calibration (DIR POWER 1 CALIBRATION) angles
SMIN is the minimum operating power
The operating quantity is displayed in the ACTUAL VALUES METERING SENSITIVE DIRECTIONAL POWER 1(2) actual value.
The element has two independent (as to the pickup and delay settings) stages for alarm and trip, respectively.
Figure 5-165: Directional power characteristic
A
^
Y_
Sd
bU
4Y
?@5B1D5
B31
31<92B1D9?>
C=9>
@
B5CDB19>
($"' !1!34B
By making the characteristic angle adjustable and providing for both negative and positive values of the minimum
operating power, a variety of operating characteristics can be achieved as presented in the following figure. For example,
section (a) in the figure shows settings for reverse power, while section (b) shows settings for low forward power
applications.
Figure 5-166: Directional power element sample applications
D 4 E 4
5(675$,1
23(5$7( 5(675$,1 23(5$7(
3 3
F 4 G 4
23(5$7( 23(5$7(
5 3 3
5(675$,1 5(675$,1
5&$ R 5&$ R
60,1 60,1!
H 4
23(5$7(
I 4
5(675$,1
5(675$,1 23(5$7(
3 3
($"' "1!34B
DIR POWER 1 RCA — Specifies the relay characteristic angle (RCA) for the sensitive directional power function. Application of
this setting is threefold:
• It allows the element to respond to active or reactive power in any direction (active overpower/underpower, and so on)
• Together with a precise calibration angle, it allows compensation for any CT and VT angular errors to permit more
sensitive settings
• It allows for required direction in situations when the voltage signal is taken from behind a delta-wye connected
power transformer and the phase angle compensation is required
For example, the active overpower characteristic is achieved by setting DIR POWER 1 RCA to “0°,” reactive overpower by
setting DIR POWER 1 RCA to “90°,” active underpower by setting DIR POWER 1 RCA to “180°,” and reactive underpower by
setting DIR POWER 1 RCA to “270°.”
DIR POWER 1 CALIBRATION — This setting allows the relay characteristic angle to change in steps of 0.05°. This is useful
when a small difference in VT and CT angular errors is to be compensated to permit more sensitive settings. This setting
virtually enables calibration of the directional power function in terms of the angular error of applied VTs and CTs. The
element responds to the sum of the DIR POWER 1 RCA and DIR POWER 1 CALIBRATION settings.
DIR POWER 1 STG1 SMIN — This setting specifies the minimum power as defined along the relay characteristic angle (RCA)
for the stage 1 of the element. The positive values imply a shift towards the operate region along the RCA line; the negative
values imply a shift towards the restrain region along the RCA line. See the Directional Power Sample Applications figure
for details. Together with the RCA, this setting enables a wide range of operating characteristics. This setting applies to
three-phase power and is entered in per-unit (pu) values. The base quantity is 3 x VT pu base x CT pu base for wye
connected VTs, and 3 x VT pu base x CT pu base for delta connected VTs.
For example, a setting of 2% for a 200 MW machine is 0.02 200 MW = 4 MW. If 13.8kV is line voltage and 10 kA is a
primary CT current, the source pu quantity is 239 MVA, and thus, SMIN needs to be set at 4 MW / 239 MVA = 0.0167 pu
0.017 pu. If the reverse power application is considered, RCA = 180° and SMIN = 0.017 pu.
The element drops out if the magnitude of the positive-sequence current becomes virtually zero, that is, it drops below the
cutoff level.
DIR POWER 1 STG1 DELAY — This setting specifies a time delay for stage 1. For reverse power or low forward power
applications for a synchronous machine, stage 1 is typically applied for alarming and stage 2 for tripping.
Figure 5-167: Sensitive directional power logic
SETTING
DIR POWER 1
FUNCTION:
Enabled = 1
5
SETTINGS SETTING
SETTING DIR POWER 1 RCA: DIR POWER 1 STG1
DIR POWER 1 BLK: DELAY:
AND
DIR POWER 1 OP
Three-phase reactive power (Q)
DIR POWER 1 STG2 DPO
DIR POWER 1 STG2 OP
SETTING
DIR POWER 1 STG2
DELAY:
tPKP
100 ms
842003A3.CDR
The underpower function uses the source selected by the SYSTEM SETUP MOTOR MOTOR LINE SOURCE setting. Phase
currents and voltages must be configured on that source, otherwise the underpower function is not functional. The
underpower element responds to total three-phase apparent power measured from the phase current and voltages.
When the underpower element is enabled, a trip or alarm is initiated once the magnitude of three-phase apparent power
falls below the pickup level for a period of time specified by the delay. For example, underpower can be used to detect
loss-of-load conditions. Loss of load conditions do not always cause a significant loss of current. Power is a more accurate
representation of loading and can be used for more sensitive detection of load loss or pump cavitations. This can be
especially useful for detecting process related problems.
5 UNDERPOWER 1 START BLOCK DELAY — This setting specifies the length of time to block the underpower function when the
motor is starting. If not in the starting state, the motor status is indicated by the MOTOR OFFLINE operand. See the Motor
setup section under the SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP MOTOR menu for additional information on using the MOTOR
OFFLINE operand for state determination.
The underpower element is active only when the motor is running and is blocked upon the initiation of a motor start for a
period of time specified by this setting. For example, this block can be used to allow pumps to build up head before the
underpower element trips or alarms. A value of 0 specifies that the feature is not blocked from start. For values other than
0, the feature is disabled when the motor is stopped and also from the time a start is detected until the time entered
expires.
UNDERPOWER 1 ALARM PWR PICKUP — This setting specifies a pickup threshold for the alarm stage. The base per-unit power
quantity is 3 × VT pu base × CT pu base per source selected as a motor line source. Set it less than the motor load current
during normal operations.
UNDERPOWER 1 ALARM PICKUP DLY — This setting specifies a time delay for the alarm stage. Set it long enough to overcome
any short lowering of the current (for example, during system faults).
UNDERPOWER 1 TRIP PWR PICKUP — This setting specifies a pickup threshold for the trip stage. The base quantity is 3-phase
power on primary side, which is calculated as √3 x Phase CT Primary x Phase VT Ratio x Phase VT Secondary in case of
delta connected VTs, and as 3 x Phase CT Primary x Phase VT Ratio x Phase VT Secondary in case of wye connected VTs.
Set this setting less than the corresponding setting for the alarm stage.
UNDERPOWER 1 TRIP PICKUP DLY — This setting specifies a time delay for the trip stage. Set it long enough to overcome any
short lowering of the current (for example, during system faults).
UNDERPOWER 1 TRIP RESET DLY — This setting specifies a time delay to reset the trip command. Set it long enough to allow
breaker or contactor to disconnect the motor.
UNDERPOWER 1 BLOCK — This setting specifies an operand used to block the underpower function. A panel cutoff switch or
other user specified condition typically is used to block the function.
The trip bus element allows aggregating outputs of protection and control elements without using FlexLogic and assigning
them a simple and effective manner. Each trip bus can be assigned for either trip or alarm actions. Simple trip conditioning
such as latch, delay, and seal-in delay are available.
The easiest way to assign element outputs to a trip bus is through the EnerVista software under Settings > Protection
Summary. Navigate to a specific protection or control protection element and check the bus box by hovering over the
blank check box and selecting an option that displays. Once the required element is selected for a specific bus, a list of
element operate-type operands are displayed and can be assigned to a trip bus. If more than one operate-type operand is
required, it can be assigned directly from the trip bus menu.
Figure 5-169: Trip bus fields in the protection summary
SETTINGS
TRIP BUS 1 FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
FUNCTION
TRIP BUS 1 PKP
= Enabled
TRIP BUS 1 BLOCK AND
= Off
SETTINGS
TRIP BUS 1
LATCHING
= Enabled
TRIP BUS 1 RESET
= Off
OR
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
RESET OP 842023A1.CDR
The setting groups menu controls the activation and deactivation of up to six groups of settings in the GROUPED ELEMENTS
settings menu. The active setting group can be indicated on the front display of the M60 by configuring User-
Programmable LEDs to display the state of the SETTING GROUP ACT FlexLogic operands.
On a setting group change, protection elements are blocked temporarily to allow the relay to re-initialize with the new
settings. The duration of the block depends on relay configuration and can last up to four cycles. The actual block duration
on the group switching can be verified by the PROTSUPV operand.
SETTING GROUPS FUNCTION — When Enabled, allows setting groups other than group 1 (the default active group) to be
activated. When Disabled, the default setting group is forced active. When changed from Disabled to Enabled, it resets the
active setting group to 1 independent of the Control Mode setting.
Control Mode — This setting displays when IEC 61850 is used by the M60. It selects the active setting group selection control
mode. When set to "Local," active setting group selection is based on the FlexLogic operand states selected by GROUP
ACTIVATE ON settings and the SelectActiveSG request from an IEC 61850 client generates a negative response. When set to
"IEC61850 Client," the SelectActiveSG request from an IEC 61850 client selects the active setting group and the FlexLogic
operand states of the GROUP ACTIVATE ON settings are ignored/not used.
The logic diagram shows the active setting group selection behavior based on the Control Mode setting.
When the Control Mode is "Local," the priority scheme makes active the highest numbered group selected by the GROUP
ACTIVATE ON settings. The most recent active group selection is preserved while the M60 is powered down or reset.
When the Control Mode is "IEC61850 Client," the SelectActiveSG selection has an initial value that can be set on a CID file
download by the IEC 61850 setting Initial Setting Group. See the Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850
protocol > Setting Groups section earlier for details. The most recent SelectActiveSG selection is preserved while the M60
is powered down or reset. If it becomes necessary to cancel the SelectActiveSG selection without using a SelectActiveSG
service request, change the SETTING GROUPS FUNCTION setting to Disabled. This resets the SelectActiveSG selection to 1.
When the Control Mode is changed, the current active setting group selection is preserved.
Figure 5-171: Logic diagram for Control Mode setting
SETT ING
SETTING GROUPS FUNCTION
= Enabled
5
SETT ING
SETTING GROUPS BLK
= Off AND RUN
Priority Scheme
SETT ING
Group # Activate On
= FlexLogic operand
Control M ode A
Active setting group
= Local / IEC61850 Client
se lection
AND RUN
IEC 61850 SG
se rvice processing
<MasterLD>/LLN0.ActSG
Active setting group selection can be made either by IEC 61850 MMS SelectActiveSG service or Local by the
FlexLogic operand states selected by GROUP # ACTIVATE ON settings. Simultaneous setting group control is not
permissible.
SETTING GROUPS BLK — Prevents the active setting group from changing when the selected FlexLogic operand is "On." This
can be useful in applications where it is undesirable to change the settings under certain conditions, such as during a
control sequence.
GROUP 2 ACTIVATE ON to GROUP 6 ACTIVATE ON — Selects a FlexLogic operand which, when set, makes the particular setting
group active for use by any grouped element. A priority scheme ensures that only one group is active at a given time —
the highest-numbered group that is activated by its ACTIVATE ON parameter takes priority over the lower-numbered
groups. There is no activate on setting for group 1 (the default active group), because group 1 automatically becomes
active if no other group is active.
The settings are read-only with default values when the Control Mode setting is set to "IEC61850 Client."
A setting group selection can also be made by the IEC 61850 MMS service SelectActiveSG to the control block @Master/
LLN0.SGCB. An active group selection can be done either by SelectActiveSG service from a IEC 61850 client or by GROUP
ACTIVATE ON settings, but mixed operation is not allowed.
An initial setting group value is initialized to the GROUP ACTIVATE ON setting value on M60 reboot immediately following the
receipt of a valid CID file.
SETTING GROUP 1 NAME to SETTING GROUP 6 NAME — Allows the user to assign a name to each of the six settings groups.
Once programmed, this name appears on the second line of the GROUPED ELEMENTS SETTING GROUP 1(6) menu display.
The relay can be set up via a FlexLogic equation to receive requests to activate or de-activate a particular non-default
settings group. The following FlexLogic equation (see the following figure) illustrates requests via remote communications
(for example, VIRTUAL INPUT 1 ON) or from a local contact input (for example, CONTACT IP 1 ON) to initiate the use of a
particular settings group, and requests from several overcurrent pickup measuring elements to inhibit the use of the
particular settings group. The assigned VIRTUAL OUTPUT 1 operand is used to control the “On” state of a particular settings
group.
Figure 5-172: Example of FlexLogic control of a setting group
9,57,3219,
25
&217,321+$
25
$1' 9,572392
3+$6(72&3.3
127
5
3+$6(72&3.3
127
$1'
9,572392
(1'
$&'5
The selector switch element is intended to replace a mechanical selector switch. Typical applications include setting group
control or control of multiple logic sub-circuits in user-programmable logic.
The element provides for two control inputs. The step-up control allows stepping through selector position one step at a
time with each pulse of the control input, such as a user-programmable pushbutton. The three-bit control input allows
setting the selector to the position defined by a three-bit word.
The element allows pre-selecting a new position without applying it. The pre-selected position gets applied either after
time-out or upon acknowledgement via separate inputs (user setting). The selector position is stored in non-volatile
memory. Upon power-up, either the previous position is restored or the relay synchronizes to the current three-bit word
5 (user setting). Basic alarm functionality alerts the user under abnormal conditions; for example, the three-bit control input
being out of range.
A selector switch runs every two power cycles.
SELECTOR 1 FULL RANGE — This setting defines the upper position of the selector. When stepping up through available
positions of the selector, the upper position wraps up to the lower position (position 1). When using a direct three-bit control
word for programming the selector to a desired position, the change would take place only if the control word is within the
range of 1 to the SELECTOR FULL RANGE. If the control word is outside the range, an alarm is established by setting the
SELECTOR ALARM FlexLogic operand for three seconds.
SELECTOR 1 TIME-OUT — This setting defines the time-out period for the selector. This value is used by the relay in the
following two ways. When the SELECTOR STEP-UP MODE is “Time-out,” the setting specifies the required period of inactivity
of the control input after which the pre-selected position is automatically applied. When the SELECTOR STEP-UP MODE is
“Acknowledge,” the setting specifies the period of time for the acknowledging input to appear. The timer is re-started by
any activity of the control input. The acknowledging input must come before the SELECTOR 1 TIME-OUT timer expires;
otherwise, the change does not take place and an alarm is set.
SELECTOR 1 STEP-UP — This setting specifies a control input for the selector switch. The switch is shifted to a new position at
each rising edge of this signal. The position changes incrementally, wrapping up from the last (SELECTOR 1 FULL RANGE) to
the first (position 1). Consecutive pulses of this control operand must not occur faster than every 50 ms. After each rising
edge of the assigned operand, the time-out timer is restarted and the SELECTOR SWITCH 1: POS Z CHNG INITIATED target
message is displayed, where Z the pre-selected position. The message is displayed for the time specified by the FLASH
MESSAGE TIME setting. The pre-selected position is applied after the selector times out (“Time-out” mode), or when the
acknowledging signal appears before the element times out (“Acknowledge” mode). When the new position is applied, the
relay displays the SELECTOR SWITCH 1: POSITION Z IN USE message. Typically, a user-programmable pushbutton is
configured as the stepping up control input.
SELECTOR 1 STEP-UP MODE — This setting defines the selector mode of operation. When set to “Time-out,” the selector
changes its position after a pre-defined period of inactivity at the control input. The change is automatic and does not
require any explicit confirmation of the intent to change the selector's position. When set to “Acknowledge,” the selector
changes its position only after the intent is confirmed through a separate acknowledging signal. If the acknowledging
signal does not appear within a pre-defined period of time, the selector does not accept the change and an alarm is
established by setting the SELECTOR STP ALARM output FlexLogic operand for three seconds.
SELECTOR 1 ACK — This setting specifies an acknowledging input for the stepping up control input. The pre-selected
position is applied on the rising edge of the assigned operand. This setting is active only under “Acknowledge” mode of
operation. The acknowledging signal must appear within the time defined by the SELECTOR 1 TIME-OUT setting after the last
activity of the control input. A user-programmable pushbutton is typically configured as the acknowledging input.
SELECTOR 1 3BIT A0, A1, and A2 — These settings specify a three-bit control input of the selector. The three-bit control word
pre-selects the position using the following encoding convention:
A2 A1 A0 Position
0 0 0 rest
0 0 1 1
0 1 0 2
0 1 1 3
1 0 0 4
1 0 1 5
1 1 0 6
1 1 1 7
The “rest” position (0, 0, 0) does not generate an action and is intended for situations when the device generating the three-
bit control word is having a problem. When SELECTOR 1 3BIT MODE is “Time-out,” the pre-selected position is applied in
SELECTOR 1 TIME-OUT seconds after the last activity of the three-bit input. When SELECTOR 1 3BIT MODE is “Acknowledge,”
the pre-selected position is applied on the rising edge of the SELECTOR 1 3BIT ACK acknowledging input.
The stepping up control input (SELECTOR 1 STEP-UP) and the three-bit control inputs (SELECTOR 1 3BIT A0 through A2) lock-out
mutually: once the stepping up sequence is initiated, the three-bit control input is inactive; once the three-bit control
sequence is initiated, the stepping up input is inactive.
SELECTOR 1 3BIT MODE — This setting defines the selector mode of operation. When set to “Time-out,” the selector changes 5
its position after a pre-defined period of inactivity at the control input. The change is automatic and does not require
explicit confirmation to change the selector position. When set to “Acknowledge,” the selector changes its position only
after confirmation via a separate acknowledging signal. If the acknowledging signal does not appear within a pre-defined
period of time, the selector rejects the change and an alarm established by invoking the SELECTOR BIT ALARM FlexLogic
operand for three seconds.
SELECTOR 1 3BIT ACK — This setting specifies an acknowledging input for the three-bit control input. The pre-selected
position is applied on the rising edge of the assigned FlexLogic operand. This setting is active only under the
“Acknowledge” mode of operation. The acknowledging signal must appear within the time defined by the SELECTOR TIME-
OUT setting after the last activity of the three-bit control inputs. Note that the stepping up control input and three-bit
control input have independent acknowledging signals (SELECTOR 1 ACK and SELECTOR 1 3BIT ACK, accordingly).
SELECTOR 1 POWER-UP MODE — This setting specifies the element behavior on power up of the relay.
When set to “Restore,” the last position of the selector (stored in the non-volatile memory) is restored after powering up the
relay. If the position restored from memory is out of range, position 0 (no output operand selected) is applied and an alarm
is set (SELECTOR 1 PWR ALARM).
When set to “Synchronize,” the selector switch acts as follows. For two power cycles, the selector applies position 0 to the
switch and activates SELECTOR 1 PWR ALARM. After two power cycles expire, the selector synchronizes to the position
dictated by the three-bit control input. This operation does not wait for time-out or the acknowledging input. When the
synchronization attempt is unsuccessful (that is, the three-bit input is not available (0,0,0) or out of range), then the selector
switch output is set to position 0 (no output operand selected) and an alarm is established (SELECTOR 1 PWR ALARM).
The operation of “Synch/Restore” mode is similar to the “Synchronize” mode. The only difference is that after an
unsuccessful synchronization attempt, the switch attempts to restore the position stored in the relay memory. The
“Synch/Restore” mode is useful for applications where the selector switch is employed to change the setting group in
redundant (two relay) protection schemes.
The following figures illustrate the operation of the selector switch. In these diagrams, “T” represents a time-out setting.
STEP-UP
T T
3BIT A0
3BIT A1
3BIT A2
T T
POS 1
POS 2
POS 3
5
POS 4
POS 5
POS 6
POS 7
BIT 0
BIT 1
BIT 2
STP ALARM
BIT ALARM
ALARM
842737A1.CDR
STEP-UP
ACK
3BIT A0
3BIT A1
3BIT A2
3BIT ACK
POS 1
POS 2
5 POS 3
POS 4
POS 5
POS 6
POS 7
BIT 0
BIT 1
BIT 2
STP ALARM
BIT ALARM
ALARM
842736A1.CDR
Application example
Consider an application where the selector switch is used to control setting groups 1 through 4 in the relay. The setting
groups are to be controlled from both user-programmable pushbutton 1 and from an external device via contact inputs 1
through 3. The active setting group is to be available as an encoded three-bit word to the external device and SCADA via
output contacts 1 through 3. The pre-selected setting group is to be applied automatically after five seconds of inactivity
of the control inputs. When the relay powers up, it is to synchronize the setting group to the three-bit control input.
Make the following changes to setting group control in the SETTINGS CONTROL ELEMENTS SETTING GROUPS menu:
FUNCTION: “Enabled”
Block: “Off”
GROUP 2 ACTIVATE ON: “SELECTOR 1 POS 2"
GROUP 3 ACTIVATE ON: “SELECTOR 1 POS 3"
GROUP 4 ACTIVATE ON: “SELECTOR 1 POS 4"
GROUP 5 ACTIVATE ON: “Off”
GROUP 6 ACTIVATE ON: “Off”
Make the following changes to selector switch element in the SETTINGS CONTROL ELEMENTS SELECTOR SWITCH
SELECTOR SWITCH 1 menu to assign control to user programmable pushbutton 1 and contact inputs 1 through 3:
SELECTOR 1 FUNCTION: “Enabled”
SELECTOR 1 FULL-RANGE: “4”
SELECTOR 1 STEP-UP MODE: “Time-out”
SELECTOR 1 TIME-OUT: “5.0 s”
SELECTOR 1 STEP-UP: “PUSHBUTTON 1 ON”
SELECTOR 1 ACK: “Off”
SELECTOR 1 3BIT A0: “CONT IP 1 ON”
SELECTOR 1 3BIT A1: “CONT IP 2 ON”
SELECTOR 1 3BIT A2: “CONT IP 3 ON”
SELECTOR 1 3BIT MODE: “Time-out”
SELECTOR 1 3BIT ACK: “Off”
SELECTOR 1 POWER-UP MODE: “Synchronize”
Now, assign the contact output operation (assume the H6E module) to the selector switch element by making the following
changes in the SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS CONTACT OUTPUTS menu:
OUTPUT H1 OPERATE: “SELECTOR 1 BIT 0"
OUTPUT H2 OPERATE: “SELECTOR 1 BIT 1"
5
OUTPUT H3 OPERATE: “SELECTOR 1 BIT 2"
Finally, assign configure user-programmable pushbutton 1 by making the following changes in the SETTINGS PRODUCT
SETUP USER-PROGRAMMABLE PUSHBUTTONS USER PUSHBUTTON 1 menu:
PUSHBUTTON 1 FUNCTION: “Self-reset”
PUSHBUTTON 1 DROP-OUT TIME: “0.10 s”
The figure shows the logic for the selector switch.
6(77,1*6
6(/(&725)8//5$1*(
6(/(&72567(38302'(
6(/(&725%,702'(
6(/(&7257,0(287 $&78$/9$/8(
6(77,1*6
6(/(&725326,7,21
6(/(&725)81&7,21 6(/(&72532:(58302'(
(QDEOHG 581
6(/(&72567(383 )/(;/2*,&23(5$1'6
2II VWHSXS 6(/(&725326
6(/(&725$&. 6(/(&725326
2II DFNQRZOHGJH 6(/(&725326
6(/(&725%,7$
6(/(&725326
WKUHHELWFRQWUROLQSXW
2II 6(/(&725326
21
6(/(&725%,7$
6(/(&725326
2II
6(/(&725326
6(/(&725%,7$
2II )/(;/2*,&23(5$1'6
6(/(&725%,7$&.
6(/(&725673$/$50
2II ELWDFNQRZOHGJH
6(/(&725%,7$/$50
ELWSRVLWLRQRXW
25
6(/(&725$/$50
6(/(&7253:5$/$50
6(/(&725%,7
6(/(&725%,7
5 6(/(&725%,7
$&'5
The steady-state frequency of a power system is a certain indicator of the existing balance between the generated power
and the load. Whenever this balance is disrupted through the loss of an important generating unit or the isolation of part of
the system from the rest of the system, the effect is a reduction in frequency. If the control systems of the system
generators do not respond fast enough, the system can collapse. A reliable method to quickly restore the balance
between load and generation is to automatically disconnect selected loads, based on the actual system frequency. This
technique, called “load-shedding,” maintains system integrity and minimize widespread outages. After the frequency
returns to normal, the load can be restored automatically or manually.
UNDERFREQ 1 SOURCE — This setting is used to select the source for the signal to be measured. The element first checks for
a live phase voltage available from the selected source. If voltage is not available, the element attempts to use a phase
current. If neither voltage nor current is available, the element does not operate, as it does not measure a parameter below
the minimum voltage/current setting.
UNDERFREQ 1 MIN VOLT/AMP — Selects the minimum per unit voltage or current level required to allow the underfrequency
element to operate. This threshold is used to prevent an incorrect operation because there is no signal to measure.
UNDERFREQ 1 PICKUP — Selects the level at which the underfrequency element is to pickup. For example, if the system
frequency is 60 Hz and the load shedding is required at 59.5 Hz, the setting is 59.50 Hz.
Figure 5-176: Underfrequency logic
SETTING
UNDERFREQ 1 FUNCTION:
Enabled=1
5
5.9.6 Overfrequency (ANSI 81O)
SETTINGS CONTROL ELEMENTS OVERFREQUENCY OVERFREQUENCY 1(4)
OVERFREQUENCY 1 OVERFREQ 1 FUNCTION: Range: Disabled, Enabled
Disabled
The steady-state frequency of a power system is an indicator of the existing balance between the generated power and
the load. Whenever this balance is disrupted through the disconnection of significant load or the isolation of a part of the
system that has a surplus of generation, the effect is an increase in frequency. If the control systems of the generators do
not respond fast enough, to quickly ramp the turbine speed back to normal, the overspeed can lead to the turbine trip. The
overfrequency element can be used to control the turbine frequency ramp down at a generating location. This element
can also be used for feeder reclosing as part of the "after load shedding restoration."
The OVERFREQ 1 SOURCE setting selects the source for the signal to be measured.
The OVERFREQ 1 PICKUP setting selects the level at which the overfrequency element is to pickup.
Figure 5-177: Overfrequency logic
SETTING
OVERFREQ 1 FUNCTION:
SETTING
Enabled = 1
OVERFREQ 1 PICKUP : SETTING
SETTING OVERFREQ 1 PICKUP
AND RUN DELAY :
OVERFREQ 1 BLOCK: FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
OVERFREQ 1 RESET
OVERFREQ 1 PKP
DELAY :
Off = 0 OVERFREQ 1 DPO
tPKP
tRST OVERFREQ 1 OP
SETTING f ≡ PICKUP
OVERFREQ 1 SOURCE:
Frequency 827832A6.CDR
5.9.7.1 Menu
SETTINGS CONTROL ELEMENTS START SUPERVISION
START SUPERVISION MAXIMUM STARTING See below
RATE (STARTS/HR)
The motor start supervision feature consists of three elements that guard against excessive starting duty. These elements
are in addition to the start inhibit that can be imposed by the thermal model. A method to prevent starting is by wiring an
M60 output contact actuated by motor start supervision elements in the motor energizing control circuit. The output
contact changes state only when the motor is stopped to accommodate control circuits that must be continuously
energized, such as a contactor.
The three elements of motor start supervision are
• Maximum starting rate (starts per hour) — This element defines the number of start attempts allowed in a
programmable time interval. Only the number of restart attempts during the interval is controlled and not the time
between. The latter is controlled by the time between starts element. When the motor is stopped after the last allowed
start, the energizing or closing control circuit is disabled until the end of the defined interval. Every start initiates a new
interval in which the start number is limited. A typical starting frequency is three starts per hour.
• Time between starts — This function enforces a programmable minimum time duration between two successive start
attempts. A time delay is initiated with every start, and if the motor is stopped a restart is not allowed until the
specified interval has lapsed.
• Restart delay — The restart delay function defines a programmable delay after a motor has stopped before it can be
started again. It allows load interruption transient conditions, such as down-hole pump applications where
gravitational force causes reverse rotation to subside. Starting when the load is reversing can cause damage to the
motor or pump.
The element can be programmed to perform the classical monitoring function of Starts Per Hour. However, time interval
units specified by the START/HR TIME INTERVAL setting are in minutes for increased flexibility. The STARTS/HR MAX NUMBER OF
STARTS setting specifies the start attempt number limit during the interval. The time unit and ranges accommodate the
starting requirements of large direct-on-line motors.
The element asserts the following three FlexLogic operands:
• The STARTS-PER-HOUR PKP operand indicates that the maximum permitted starting rate has been reached. When 5
stopped, the motor is not restarted until the lockout time elapses.
• The STARTS-PER-HOUR OP operand indicates that the motor stopped when the maximum permitted starting rate was
already reached. Use this operand to inhibit the start command.
• The STARTS-PER-HOUR DPO operand indicates that the maximum permitted starting rate has not been reached. When
stopped, the motor can be restarted immediately.
The element uses motor status asserted by the Thermal Model element. The thermal protection must be configured
properly in order for this function to operate.
Figure 5-178: Maximum starting rate logic
6(77,1*6
6(77,1*6
67$576+5)81&7,21 67$576+57,0(,17(59$/
(QDEOHG 67$576+50$;180%(52)67$576
$1'
67$57
67$57
6723
6723
6723
67$5763(5+28523
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1'6 $&78$/9$/8(
3.3 23 '32
0272567$57,1*
67$576+5/2&.287
027252))/,1( /2&.2877,0(
UHVHW IURP
6(77,1*6
ORFNRXW
6(77,1*66<67(0
6(78302725
(0(5*(1&<5(67$57
2II
(## !%1"34B
The time between starts element prevents restart attempts in quick succession. It requires that the minimum duration
specified by the TIME BETWEEN STARTS MIN TIME setting expires before a subsequent start attempt is allowed. The time
between starts supervising element complements the maximum starting rate element in that the former controls the time
spacing between starts and the latter limits the number of starts.
The element asserts the following three FlexLogic operands:
• The TIME-BTWN-STARTS PKP operand indicates that the time since the last start was too short. When stopped, the motor
should not be restarted until the lockout time elapses.
• The TIME-BTWN-STARTS OP operand indicates that the motor stopped when the time since the last start was too short.
Use this operand to inhibit the start command.
5 • The TIME-BTWN-STARTS DPO operand indicates that the time between the last two starts was long enough. When
stopped, the motor can be restarted immediately.
The element uses motor status asserted by the Thermal Model element. The thermal protection must be configured
properly in order for this function to operate.
Figure 5-179: Time between starts logic
6(77,1*6
7,0(%(7:((167$576 6(77,1*
)81&7,21
7,0(%(7:((167$576
(QDEOHG 0,17,0(
7,0(%:167$576%/.
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1'6
2II
$1'
7,0(%7:167$5763.3
W 567
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1' 7,0(%7:167$576'32
$1'
0272567$57,1* 7,0(%7:167$57623
027252))/,1(
$&78$/9$/8(
6(77,1*6
UHVHW IURP
ORFNRXW
%7:167$576/2&.287
6(77,1*66<67(0
6(78302725
(0(5*(1&<5(67$57
2II
(## !&1"34B
The RESTART DELAY MIN TIME setting specifies the lockout time before starting the motor after the motor has stopped. The
restart delay element asserts the RESTART DELAY OP FlexLogic operand for RESTART DELAY MIN TIME after the motor has
stopped. The element uses the motor status asserted by the Thermal Model element. The thermal protection must be
configured properly in order for this function to operate.
Figure 5-180: Restart delay logic
SETTING
Function SETTING
Enabled = 1 Minimum Time
Block 0 FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Off = 0 AND RESTART DELAY OP
TRESET
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
MOTOR OFFLINE
ACTUAL VALUE
SETTING Restart Delay Lockout
Emergency Restart
restart from lockout
= Off
from the motor setup settings 833017A4.CDR
The M60 can control the transition of a motor start from reduced to full voltage. This feature uses motor load and a
supervisory timer to initiate a one second control signal (the REDUCED VOLT CTRL operand) that can be used to switch to full
voltage. The feature can also assert a trip signal (the REDUCED VOLT OP operand) from the starting logic if the current or timer
transitions do not occur as expected. This transition can be defined as current only, current or timer, or current and timer.
signifies an
open transition
time
FlexLogic™
operand
states
MOTOR STARTING
MOTOR RUNNING
5 833752A1.CDR
All FlexLogic operands are asserted upon the initiation of a motor start. The REDUCED VOLT OP operand is set when
the transition timer expires if the motor load never exceeds the REDUCED VOLT FLA setting and the motor status is
starting. The REDUCED VOLT CTRL operand is set when the transition timer expires and the motor load has dropped
below the motor full load current setting; that is, the motor status is not starting.
REDUCED VOLTAGE STARTING — This setting enables and disables the reduced voltage starting feature.
TRANSITION MODE — This setting selects the reduced voltage starting transition method. The reduced voltage timer is
initiated at the beginning of a motor start; that is, when the motor status transitions from offline to starting. There are three
modes of transition:
• “Current Only” — When the motor load falls below the REDUCED VOLTAGE FLA setting prior to the expiration of the
reduced voltage timer, a transition is initiated by asserting the REDUCED VOLT CTRL operand for a period of one second.
Any contact output assigned to this operand operates for this period of time. If the reduced voltage timer expires prior
to the motor load dropping below the REDUCED VOLTAGE FLA setting, the REDUCED VOLT CTRL operand does not change
state and the REDUCED VOLT OP operand is asserted.
• “Current Or Timer” — When the motor load falls below the REDUCED VOLTAGE FLA setting, or if the reduced voltage
timer expires, a transition is initiated by asserting the REDUCED VOLT CTRL operand for one second. Any contact output
assigned to this control signal operates for this period of time.
• “Current And Timer” — A transition is initiated by asserting the REDUCED VOLT CTRL operand for one second when the
reduced voltage timer expires and the motor load has dropped below the REDUCED VOLTAGE FLA setting prior to the
expiration of the reduced voltage timer. If the reduced voltage timer expires prior to the motor load dropping below the
REDUCED VOLTAGE FLA setting, the REDUCED VOLT CTRL operand does not change state and the REDUCED VOLT OP operand
is asserted.
REDUCED VOLT FLA — This setting specifies the current level used when determining the transition mode and initiating the
REDUCED VOLT CTRL operand. Set it greater than the product of the MOTOR FULL LOAD AMPS setting and the MOTOR OVERLOAD
FACTOR setting. See the Motor section under the SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP MOTOR menu for details.
REDUCED VOLT TIMER — This setting specifies the time-out value of the transition timer used in the selected transition mode.
SETTING OR
TRANSITION MODE
= Current Only AND
= Current or Timer
= Current and Timer TIMER
0 FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AND
OR REDUCED VOLT CTRL
1 sec.
OR
SETTING
AND
REDUCED VOLTAGE
STARTING
= Enabled
REDUCED VOLT BLOCK SETTING
= Off REDUCED VOLT TIMER
TPKP
AND
SETTING 0
REDUCED VOLT TIMER
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND 0
MOTOR STARTING
TPKP
833023A1.CDR
There are 96 identical digital elements available, numbered 1 to 96. A digital element can monitor any FlexLogic operand
and present a target message and/or enable events recording depending on the output operand state. The digital element
settings include a name to be referenced in any target message, a blocking input from any selected FlexLogic operand,
and a timer for pickup and reset delays for the output operand.
DIGITAL ELEMENT 1 INPUT — Selects a FlexLogic operand to be monitored by the digital element.
DIGITAL ELEMENT 1 PICKUP DELAY — Sets the required time delay from element pickup to element operation. If a pickup
delay is not required, set to "0," To avoid nuisance alarms, set the delay greater than the operating time of the breaker.
DIGITAL ELEMENT 1 RESET DELAY — Sets the time delay to reset. If a reset delay is not required, set to “0.”
DIGITAL ELEMENT 1 PICKUP LED — This setting enables or disabled the digital element pickup LED. When set to “Disabled,” the
operation of the pickup LED is blocked.
Figure 5-183: Digital element logic
SETTING
DIGITAL ELEMENT 01
FUNCTION: SETTINGS
Enabled = 1 DIGITAL ELEMENT 01
SETTING PICKUP DELAY:
DIGITAL ELEMENT 01 DIGITAL ELEMENT 01 FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
SETTING
NAME: RESET DELAY: DIG ELEM 01 DPO
DIGITAL ELEMENT 01
AND RUN tPKP
INPUT: DIG ELEM 01 PKP
Off = 0 DIG ELEM 01 OP
INPUT = 1 tRST
SETTING
DIGITAL ELEMENT 01
BLOCK:
Off = 0
827042A2.VSD
5
Circuit monitoring applications
Some versions of the digital input modules include an active voltage monitor circuit connected across form-A contacts. The
voltage monitor circuit limits the trickle current through the output circuit (see technical specifications for form-A).
As long as the current through the voltage monitor is above a threshold (see technical specifications for form-A), the Cont
Op 1 VOn FlexLogic operand is set (for contact input 1—corresponding operands exist for each contact output). If the output
circuit has a high resistance or the DC current is interrupted, the trickle current drops below the threshold and the Cont Op 1
VOff FlexLogic operand is set. Consequently, the state of these operands can be used as indicators of the integrity of the
circuits in which form-A contacts are inserted.
H1a
I
H1b DC–
V DC+
H1c 52a Trip coil
I = current monitor
V = voltage monitor 827073A2.CDR
Assume the output contact H1 is a trip contact. Using the contact output settings, this output is given an ID name; for
example, “Cont Op 1." Assume a 52a breaker auxiliary contact is connected to contact input H5a to monitor breaker status.
Using the contact input settings, this input is given an ID name, for example, “Cont Ip 1," and is set “On” when the breaker is
closed. The settings to use digital element 1 to monitor the breaker trip circuit are indicated (EnerVista example shown).
5
with form-A contacts
The wiring connection for two examples above is applicable to both form-A contacts with voltage monitoring and
solid-state contact with voltage monitoring.
There are eight identical digital counters, numbered from 1 to 8. A digital counter counts the number of state transitions
from Logic 0 to Logic 1. The counter is used to count operations such as the pickups of an element, the changes of state of
an external contact (for example, breaker auxiliary switch), or pulses from a watt-hour meter.
COUNTER 1 UNITS — Assigns a label to identify the unit of measure pertaining to the digital transitions to be counted. The
units label appears in the corresponding actual values status.
COUNTER 1 PRESET — Sets the count to a required preset value before counting operations begin, as in the case where a
substitute relay is to be installed in place of an in-service relay, or while the counter is running. 5
COUNTER 1 COMPARE — Sets the value to which the accumulated count value is compared. Three FlexLogic output
operands are provided to indicate if the present value is ‘more than (HI)’, ‘equal to (EQL)’, or ‘less than (LO)’ the set value.
COUNTER 1 UP — Selects the FlexLogic operand for incrementing the counter. If an enabled UP input is received when the
accumulated value is at the limit of +2,147,483,647 counts, the counter rolls over to –2,147,483,648.
COUNTER 1 DOWN — Selects the FlexLogic operand for decrementing the counter. If an enabled DOWN input is received
when the accumulated value is at the limit of –2,147,483,648 counts, the counter rolls over to +2,147,483,647.
COUNTER 1 BLOCK — Selects the FlexLogic operand for blocking the counting operation. All counter operands are blocked.
CNT1 SET TO PRESET — Selects the FlexLogic operand used to set the count to the preset value. The counter sets to the
preset value in the following situations:
• When the counter is enabled and the CNT1 SET TO PRESET operand has the value 1 (when the counter is enabled and
CNT1 SET TO PRESET operand is 0, the counter sets to 0)
• When the counter is running and the CNT1 SET TO PRESET operand changes the state from 0 to 1 (CNT1 SET TO PRESET
changing from 1 to 0 while the counter is running has no effect on the count)
• When a reset or reset/freeze command is sent to the counter and the CNT1 SET TO PRESET operand has the value 1
(when a reset or reset/freeze command is sent to the counter and the CNT1 SET TO PRESET operand has the value 0, the
counter sets to 0)
COUNTER 1 RESET — Selects the FlexLogic operand for setting the count to either “0” or the preset value depending on the
state of the CNT1 SET TO PRESET operand.
COUNTER 1 FREEZE/RESET — Selects the FlexLogic operand for capturing (freezing) the accumulated count value into a
separate register with the date and time of the operation, and resetting the count to “0.”
COUNTER 1 FREEZE/COUNT — Selects the FlexLogic operand for capturing (freezing) the accumulated count value into a
separate register with the date and time of the operation, and continuing counting. The present accumulated value and
captured frozen value with the associated date/time stamp are available as actual values. If control power is interrupted,
the accumulated and frozen values are saved into non-volatile memory during the power-down operation.
SETTING
COUNTER 1 BLOCK:
Off = 0 SET TO PRESET VALUE
5 Off = 0
827065A2.VSD
5.9.11.1 Menu
SETTINGS CONTROL ELEMENTS MONITORING ELEMENTS
MONITORING BREAKER 1 See below
ELEMENTS ARCING CURRENT
BREAKER 2
ARCING CURRENT
BREAKER
FLASHOVER 2
BREAKER RESTRIKE 2
There is one breaker arcing current element available per CT bank, with a minimum of two elements.
This element calculates an estimate of the per-phase wear on the breaker contacts by measuring and integrating the
current squared passing through the breaker contacts as an arc. These per-phase values are added to accumulated totals
for each phase and compared to a programmed threshold value. When the threshold is exceeded in any phase, the relay
can set an output operand to “1.” The accumulated value for each phase can be displayed as an actual value.
The operation of the scheme is shown in the following logic diagram. The same output operand that is selected to operate
the output relay used to trip the breaker, indicating a tripping sequence has begun, is used to initiate this feature. A time
delay is introduced between initiation and the starting of integration to prevent integration of current flow through the
breaker before the contacts have parted. This interval includes the operating time of the output relay, any other auxiliary
relays, and the breaker mechanism. For maximum measurement accuracy, measure the interval between change-of-
state of the operand (from 0 to 1) and contact separation for the specific installation. Integration of the measured current
continues for 100 ms, which is expected to include the total arcing period.
The feature is programmed to perform fault duration calculations. Fault duration is defined as a time between operation of
the disturbance detector occurring before initiation of this feature, and reset of an internal low-set overcurrent function.
Correction is implemented to account for a non-zero reset time of the overcurrent function.
Breaker arcing currents and fault duration values are available under the ACTUAL VALUES RECORDS MAINTENANCE
BREAKER 1(2) menus.
BKR 1 ARC AMP INT-A(C) — Select the same output operands that are configured to operate the output relays used to trip the
breaker. In three-pole tripping applications, configure the same operand to initiate arcing current calculations for poles A,
B, and C of the breaker. In single-pole tripping applications, configure per-pole tripping operands to initiate the calculations
for the poles that are actually tripped.
BKR 1 ARC AMP DELAY — This setting is used to program the delay interval between the time the tripping sequence is
initiated and the time the breaker contacts are expected to part, starting the integration of the measured current.
BKR 1 ARC AMP LIMIT — Selects the threshold value above which the output operand is set.
BKR 1 CLR ARC AMPS — Selects a FlexLogic Operand to clear the accumulated I2t values (kA2-cycle), reset fault duration
items (breaker operating time), clear ARCING AMPS (kA2-cycle) and AMP MAX (kA) values of the last event.
BKR 1 INTERUPTION RATING — This setting specifies the maximum symmetrical interruption rating of the circuit breaker.
Total Area =
Breaker
Arcing
Current
(kA cycle)
Programmable
Start Delay 100 ms
Start Stop
Integration Integration
827792A1.CDR
SETTING
BREAKER 1 ARCING
AMP INIT - B:
Off = 0
BREAKER 1 ARCING SETTING ACTUAL VALUES
AMP INIT - C :
AND BREAKER 1 ARCING BKR 1 AMP MAX FA
Off = 0 AMP DELAY: BKR 1 AMP MAX FB
100 ms
RUN
SETTING Integrate
BREAKER 1 ARCING Add to SETTING
AMP SOURCE : RUN Accumulator BREAKER 1 ARCING
2
IA IA - Cycle AMP LIMIT : FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
Select
2 2
Figure 5-188: Breaker arcing current logic
ACTUAL VALUES
BKR 1 ARCING AMP FA
BKR 1 ARCING AMP FB
BKR 1 ARCING AMP FC
827071A5CDR
5-351
CONTROL ELEMENTS
5
CONTROL ELEMENTS CHAPTER 5: SETTINGS
BRK 1 FLSHOVR SPV C: Range: FlexLogic operand
Off
Voltages must be present prior to flashover conditions. If the three VTs are placed after the breaker on the line (or
feeder), and the downstream breaker is open, the measured voltage is zero and the flashover element is not
initiated.
The flashover detection resets if the current drops below BRK 1 FLSHOVR AMP PKP, the breaker closes, or the FlexLogic
operand selected by BRK 1 FLSHOVR SPV A changes to high. It is recommended to use the supervision BRK 1 FLSHOVR SPV A
setting, and select a trip operand that does not allow the flashover element to pick up prior to the trip.
The flashover detection can be used for external alarm, re-tripping the breaker, or energizing the lockout relay.
Consider the following configuration:
Bus
CTs Breaker
Line/Feeder
Bus VTs
842746A1.CDR
The source 1 (SRC1) phase currents are feeder CTs and phase voltages are bus VTs, and Contact Input 1 is set as Breaker
52a contact. The conditions prior to flashover detection are:
• 52a status = 0
• VAg is greater than the BRK 1 FLSHOVR V PKP setting 5
• IA is below BRK 1 FLSHOVR AMP PKP (ideally, IA = 0)
The conditions at flashover detection are:
• 52a status = 0
• VAg is greater or lesser than the BRK 1 FLSHOVR V PKP setting
• IA is greater than the BRK 1 FLSHOVR AMP PKP setting
Bus
CTs Breaker
Line/Feeder
VTs
VTs
842745A1.CDR
The source 1 (SRC1) phase currents are CTs and phase voltages are bus VTs. The source 2 (SRC2) phase voltages are line
VTs. Contact input 1 is set as the breaker 52a contact (optional).
The conditions prior to flashover detection are:
• 52a status = 0
• VAg or Vag greater than the BRK 1 FLSHOVR V PKP setting
• IA is below BRK 1 FLSHOVR AMP PKP (ideally, IA = 0)
• VA is greater than the BRK 1 FLSHOVR DIFF V PKP setting
The conditions at flashover detection are:
• 52a status = 0
• VAg or Vag greater or lesser than the BRK 1 FLSHOVR V PKP setting
5 • IA is greater than the BRK 1 FLSHOVR AMP PKP setting
• VA is less than the BRK 1 FLSHOVR DIFF V PKP setting
The element operates only when phase-to-ground voltages are connected to relay terminals. The flashover
element does not operate if delta voltages are applied.
Settings
BRK 1 FLSHOVR SIDE 1 SRC — This setting specifies a signal source used to provide three-phase voltages and three-phase
currents from one side of the current breaker. The source selected as a setting and must be configured with breaker phase
voltages and currents, even if only three VTs are available across the breaker.
BRK 1 FLSHOVR SIDE 2 SRC — This setting specifies a signal source used to provide another set of three phase voltages
whenever six VTs are available across the breaker. For a three-VT application, set this setting to "None."
BRK 1 STATUS CLSD A to BRK 1 STATUS CLSD C — These settings specify FlexLogic operands to indicate the closed status of the
breaker. A separate FlexLogic operand can be selected to detect individual breaker pole status and provide flashover
detection. The recommended setting is 52a breaker contact or another operand defining the breaker poles closed status.
Leaving this setting off, meaning not configuring any FlexLogic to indicated Closed Breaker leads to maloperation
of the element.
BRK 1 FLSHOVR V PKP — This setting specifies a pickup level for the phase voltages from one or both sides of the breaker. If
six VTs are available, opening the breaker leads to two possible combinations – live voltages from only one side of the
breaker, or live voltages from both sides of the breaker. The detection of voltage above the selected value on either side of
the breaker sets the scheme ready for flashover detection. Set BRK FLSHOVR V PKP to 85 to 90% of the nominal voltage.
BRK 1 FLSHOVR DIFF V PKP — This setting specifies a pickup level for the phase voltage difference when two VTs per phase
are available across the breaker. Set this setting to be lower than the monitored voltage difference that is observed when
closed or opened breaker resistors are left in service. The setting is selected as primary volts difference between the
sources.
BRK 1 FLSHOVR AMP PKP — This setting specifies the normal load current which can flow through the breaker. Depending on
the flashover protection application, the flashover current can vary from levels of the charging current when the line is not
loaded to well above the maximum line (feeder) load (line/feeder connected to load).
BRK 1 FLSHOVR SPV A to BRK 1 FLSHOVR SPV C — These settings specify FlexLogic operands (per breaker pole) that supervise
the operation of the element per phase. Supervision can be provided by operation of other protection elements, breaker
failure, and close and trip commands. A six-cycle time delay applies after the selected FlexLogic operand resets.
BRK FLSHOVR PKP DELAY — This setting specifies the time delay to operate after a pickup condition is detected. Do not set it
too long else the flashover current can disappear before its detection.
One breaker restrike element is provided for each DSP in the M60.
According to IEEE standard C37.100 entitled IEEE Standard Definitions for Power Switchgear, restrike is defined as “a
resumption of current between the contacts of a switching device during an opening operation after an interval of zero
current of ¼ cycle at normal frequency or longer.”
Figure 5-190: Typical restrike waveform and detection flag
10
8
6
4
current (amps)
2
0.01 0.03
0 time (ms)
0.02 0.05
–2
–4
–6
–8
OPERATE
–10
834764A1.CDR
The breaker restrike algorithm responds to a successful interruption of the phase current following a declaration of
capacitor bank offline as per the breaker pole indication. If a high-frequency or system frequency current with a
magnitude greater than the threshold is resumed at least ¼ of a cycle later than the phase current interruption, then a
breaker restrike condition is declared in the corresponding phase and the BRK RESTRIKE 1 OP operand asserts for a short
period of time. The user can add counters and other logic to facilitate the decision making process as to the appropriate
actions upon detecting a single restrike or a series of consecutive restrikes.
A restrike event (FlexLogic operand) is declared if all of the following hold:
• The current is initially interrupted
• The breaker status is open
• An elevated high frequency current condition occurs (if the BREAKER RESTRIKE 1 HF DETECT setting is Enabled,
otherwise the condition is bypassed), and
• The current subsequently drops out again
The algorithm is illustrated in the following state machine diagram.
Figure 5-191: Algorithm illustration of state machine to detect restrike
Breaker open
command or breaker
open state
Capacitor bank
offline
Breaker
close
Current
Capacitor bank
interruption
Breaker online
(overcurrent)
close
5 High-frequency
elevated current Breaker close
(if enabled)
Current
interruption
(overcurrent)
Restrike detected:
OP state asserted
834768A2.CDR
In this way, a distinction is made between a self-extinguishing restrike and permanent breaker failure condition. The latter
can be detected by the breaker failure function or a regular instantaneous overcurrent element. Also, a fast succession of
restrikes is picked up by breaker failure or instantaneous overcurrent protection.
The following settings are available for each element.
BREAKER RESTRIKE 1 FUNCTION — Enables and disables operation of the breaker restrike detection element.
BRK RESTRIKE 1 BLOCK — Blocks operation of the breaker restrike detection element.
BREAKER RESTRIKE 1 SOURCE — Selects the source of the current for this element. This source must have a valid CT bank
assigned.
BREAKER RESTRIKE 1 PICKUP — Specifies the pickup level of the overcurrent detector in per-unit values of CT nominal
current.
BREAKER RESTRIKE 1 RST DELAY — Specifies the reset delay for this element. When set to “0 ms,” then FlexLogic operand is
picked up for only 1/8th of the power cycle.
BREAKER RESTRIKE 1 HF DETECT — Enables/disables high-frequency (HF) pattern detection when breaker restrike occurs.
High-frequency pattern is typical for capacitor bank, cables, and long transmission lines applications.
BRK RSTR 1 BRK OPEN — Assigns a FlexLogic operand indicating the open position of the breaker. It must be logic “1” when
the breaker is open. It is important to assign either 52 contact with this setting or breaker close command with BRK RSTR 1
CLS CMD setting to give clear indication to the relay about breaker status.
BRK RSTR 1 OPEN CMD — Assigns a FlexLogic operand indicating a breaker open command. It must be logic “1” when the
breaker is opened, either manually or from protection logic.
BRK RSTR 1 CLS CMD — Assigns a FlexLogic operand indicating a breaker close command. It must be logic “1” when the
breaker is closed.
Figure 5-192: Breaker restrike logic
6(77,1*
%5($.(55(675,.(
)81&7,21
(QDEOHG
6(77,1*
%.5567523(1&0'
2II
25
25 %.55(675,.(23
5
$1'
6(77,1*
%.55675&/6&0'
2II
$&'5
The CT failure function detects problems with system current transformers used to supply current to the relay. This logic
detects the presence of a zero-sequence current at the supervised source of current without a simultaneous zero-
sequence current at another source, zero-sequence voltage, or some protection element condition.
The CT failure logic (see later) is based on the presence of the zero-sequence current in the supervised CT source and the
absence of one of three or all of the three following conditions:
• Zero-sequence current at different source current (can be different set of CTs or different CT core of the same CT)
• Zero-sequence voltage at the assigned source
• Appropriate protection element or remote signal
Settings are described as follows.
CT FAIL 1 FUNCTION — Enables or disables operation of the CT failure element.
CT FAIL 1 BLOCK — Selects a FlexLogic operand to block operation of the element during some condition (for example, an
open pole in process of the single pole tripping-reclosing). Local signals or remote signals representing operation of some
remote current protection elements via communication channels can also be chosen.
CT FAIL 1 3I0 INPUT 1 — Selects the current source for input 1. The most critical protection element should also be assigned
to the same source.
CT FAIL 1 3I0 INPUT 1 PICKUP — Selects the 3I_0 pickup value for input 1 (the main supervised CT source).
CT FAIL 1 3I0 INPUT 2 — Selects the current source for input 2. Input 2 should use a different set of CTs or a different CT core
5 of the same CT. If 3I_0 does not exist at source 2, then a CT failure is declared.
CT FAIL 1 3I0 INPUT 2 PICKUP — Selects the 3I_0 pickup value for input 2 (different CT input) of the relay.
CT FAIL 1 3V0 INPUT — Selects the voltage source.
CT FAIL 1 3V0 INPUT PICKUP — Specifies the pickup value for the 3V_0 source.
CT FAIL 1 PICKUP DELAY — Specifies the pickup delay of the CT failure element.
6(77,1*
&7)$,/)81&7,21
(QDEOHG
6(77,1*
&7)$,/%/2&.
2II 6(77,1*
&7)$,/,2,1387 &7)$,/,2,13873.3
6(77,1* 6(77,1*
25
&7)$,/92,1387 &7)$,/92,1387
Every signal source includes a fuse failure scheme. A signal source must have a three-phase VT bank and a three-phase CT
bank assigned to it, in order for the fuse failure scheme to operate.
The VT fuse failure detector is used to raise an alarm and/or block elements that operate incorrectly for a full or partial loss
of AC potential caused by one or more blown fuses. Some elements that can be blocked (via the BLOCK input) are distance,
voltage restrained overcurrent, and directional current.
There are two classes of fuse failure that occur:
• Class A — Loss of one or two phases
• Class B — Loss of all three phases
Different means of detection are required for each class. An indication of class A failures is a significant level of negative-
sequence voltage, whereas an indication of class B failures is when positive sequence current is present and there is an
insignificant amount of positive sequence voltage. Also, a rapid decrease in the phase voltages magnitude from a healthy
voltage level without disturbance in current can indicate VT fuse fail conditions. These noted indications of fuse failure can
also be present when faults are present on the system, so a means of detecting faults and inhibiting fuse failure
declarations during these events is provided.
Once the fuse failure condition is declared, it is sealed-in until the cause that generated it disappears.
An additional condition is introduced to inhibit a fuse failure declaration when the monitored circuit is de-energized;
positive-sequence voltage and current are both below threshold levels.
VT FUSE FAILURE 1 FUNCTION — Enables and disables the fuse failure feature for Source 1 VT Fuse Fail.
NEUTRAL WIRE OPEN 1 DETECTION — Enables and disables the VT neutral wire open detection function. When the VT is
connected in Delta, do not enable this function because there is no neutral wire for Delta connected VT.
NEUTRAL WIRE OPEN 1 3 HRAM PKP — Specifies the pickup level of 3rd harmonic of 3V0 signal for the NEUTRAL WIRE OPEN
DETECTION logic to pick up.
Base voltage for this element is PHASE VT SECONDARY setting in the case of WYE VTs and (PHASE VT SECONDARY)/ 3 in case
of DELTA VTs. The setting is found under SETTINGS
ÖØ SYSTEM SETUP Ö AC INPUTS
ÖØ VOLTAGE BANK Ö PHASE VT SECONDARY.
V _1 R un
V _1 < 0.0 5 pu
I_1
AND FUS E
R un
FAIL
I_1 > 0.0 75 pu
TIMER
R un 2 c ycles SET
TIME R AND OR
V _1 < 0.8 0 pu 0
5
2 cy cles
FLE XLO GIC O PE RAN DS
R un AND
I_1 < 0.0 5 pu La tch SR C1 V T FUSE FAIL OP
20 cy cle s
SR C1 V T FUSE FAIL DPO
FLE XLO GIC O PE RAN DS
SR C1 5 0DD OP
OP EN POLE OP
Th e O PEN PO LE O P op eran d ap pl ies
to th e C60 , C9 5, D60 , L60, L9 0, an d N60 AND
TIMER
OR 30 cyc les RESET
AND 0
R eset-d omi na nt
TIME R
SE TTIN G 5 cy cles
AND
3 HARM P KP
0
AND R un FLE XLO GIC O PE RAN D
SE TTIN G 3V _0 3 rd Har m >settin g OR SR C1 V T NEU WIR E O PEN
TIME R
Ne utra l Wi re Ope n Detect
0
En ab led = 1
AND 20 cy cle s
859808 A1.vsd
The M60 is provided with optional broken rotor bar detection, specified as a software option at the time of
ordering.
The broken rotor bar detection function uses the same source as other motor protection functions. This source is defined 5
by the SYSTEM SETUP MOTOR MOTOR LINE SOURCE setting. The following items must addressed for the broken rotor
bar detection function to operate:
• Phase Currents must be configured on this source for the broken rotor bar detection function
• The AC INPUT WAVEFORMS oscillography setting must not be “Off”
• The Thermal Model must be enabled.
This function monitors only phase A current.
When the broken rotor bar detection function is enabled, an alarm is initiated once the value of ratio of the broken bar
related sideband component versus the system fundamental component is greater than the pickup level for two
consecutive measurements. To reduce probability of a false alarm (caused by impairments other than a rotor bar failure),
the element is active only if the following conditions hold:
• The motor status is “Running” and the motor load is between preset minimum acceptable value and a value just below
the overload (defined by MOTOR FULL LOAD AMPS × MOTOR OVERLOAD FACTOR).
Trying to detect the broken rotor bar during a motor start returns an incorrect result because of the rapid movement
of broken rotor bar components and a heavy change in the motor current. On the other hand, while the motor load is
small, there is not enough resolution to accurately calculate a miniscule spectral component caused by a rotor bar
failure.
• The motor load is steady.
Variations in motor load cause spectral components that can be misinterpreted as rotor bar failure. Instantaneous
motor load values are collected alongside with data for the broken rotor bar algorithm to prevent this from happening.
The average motor load and its standard deviation are calculated. If the standard deviation is greater than its
corresponding setting, the data set is discarded and the broken bar algorithm is not initiated.
• The motor current unbalance is below a corresponding setpoint.
The excessive current unbalance stresses the motor, and it can cause false broken rotor bar detection.
It is recommended that frequency tracking be enabled to avoid possible false broken rotor bar detection results when the
system frequency drifts from the nominal frequency.
The following settings are available for the broken rotor bar detection element.
START OF BRB OFFSET — This setting specifies the beginning of the frequency range where the spectral component due to a
rotor bar failure is searched. The beginning of the frequency range is defined as follows, where f1 is the system frequency
and fstart_offset is this setting.
fstart = f1 + fstart_offset Eq. 5-53
If the upper sideband is to be measured, this setting is programmed as follows, where f1 is the system frequency and s is
the motor slip at full load.
fstart_offset = 2sf1 - max(0.3, min(2sf1 - 0.4, 1.0)) Eq. 5-54
For example, if the full load slip is 0.01, program this setting as follows for a 60 Hz power system.
fstart_offset = 2sf1 - max(0.3, min(2sf1 - 0.4, 1.0))
= 2 x 0.01 x 60 Hz - 0.8 = 0.40 Hz Eq. 5-55
If the lower sideband is to be measured, this setting is programmed as follows, where f1 is the system frequency and s is
the motor slip at full load.
fstart_offset = -2sf1 - max(0.3, min(2sf1 - 0.4, 1.0)) Eq. 5-56
Using the same values from previous example, this value is programmed as follows.
fstart_offset = -2sf1 - max(0.3, min(2sf1 - 0.4, 1.0))
= -2 x 0.01 x 60 Hz - 0.8 = -2.00 Hz Eq. 5-57
END OF BRB OFFSET — This setting specifies the end of the frequency range where the spectral component due to a rotor
bar failure is searched. The end of the frequency range is defined as follows, where f1 is the system frequency and
fend_offset is this setting.
fend = f1 + fend_offset Eq. 5-58
5 If the upper sideband is to be measured, this setting is programmed as follows, where f1 is the system frequency and s is
the motor slip at full load.
fend_offset = 2sf1 + max(0.3, min(2sf1 - 0.4, 1.0)) Eq. 5-59
For example, if the full load slip is 0.01, program this setting as follows for a 60 Hz power system.
fend_offset = 2sf1 + max(0.3, min(2sf1 - 0.4, 1.0))
= 2 x 0.01 x 60 Hz + 0.8 = 2.00 Hz Eq. 5-60
If the lower sideband is to be measured, this setting is programmed as follows, where f1 is the system frequency and s is
the motor slip at full load.
fend_offset = -2sf1 + max(0.3, min(2sf1 - 0.4, 1.0)) Eq. 5-61
Using the same values from previous example, this value is programmed as follows.
fend_offset = -2sf1 + max(0.3, min(2sf1 - 0.4, 1.0))
= -2 x 0.01 x 60 Hz + 0.8 = -0.40 Hz Eq. 5-62
BRB START BLOCK DELAY — This setting is used to block the broken rotor bar detection function while the motor is starting for
the time specified. This ensures that the broken rotor bar element is active only when the motor is running.
MINIMUM MOTOR LOAD — When the motor load is less than the value specified by this setting, the data acquisition of the
broken rotor bar detection function is blocked. The broken rotor bar detection algorithm cannot accurately determine the
broken rotor bar spectral component when a motor is lightly loaded.
MAX. LOAD DEVIATION — When the standard deviation of the motor load is greater than the value specified by this setting,
the data acquisition of the broken rotor bar detection function is blocked. The broken rotor bar detection algorithm cannot
accurately determine the broken rotor bar spectral component when the motor load varies.
MAXIMUM CURRENT UNBALANCE — When the current unbalance is greater than the value specified by this setting, the data
acquisition of the broken rotor bar detection function is blocked. The broken rotor bar detection algorithm cannot
accurately determine the broken rotor bar spectral component in a current unbalance situation.
BROKEN ROTOR BAR PICKUP — This setting specifies the pickup threshold for the broken rotor bar detection feature. The
pickup threshold normally is set to a level between –54 dB (very likely, a cracked rotor bar) and –50 dB (probably a broken
rotor bar).
BROKEN ROTOR BAR RESET DLY — This setting specifies a time delay to reset the broken rotor bar detection feature. This
setting can be left at its default value since the element updates its state one to two times per minute.
BRB BLOCK — This setting selects a FlexLogic operand used to block the broken rotor bar detection feature. Typically, a
panel cut-off switch or other user-specified conditions blocks this function.
5.10 Inputs/outputs
5.10.1 Contact inputs
SETTINGS INPUTS / OUTPUTS CONTACT INPUTS
CONTACT INPUTS
Contact inputs and outputs are digital signals associated with connections to hard-wired contacts. Wet and dry contacts
are supported.
The contact inputs menu contains configuration settings for each contact input as well as voltage thresholds for each
group of four contact inputs. Upon startup, the relay processor determines (from an assessment of the installed modules)
which contact inputs are available and then display settings for only those inputs.
An alphanumeric ID can be assigned to a contact input for diagnostic, setting, and event recording purposes. The CONTACT
IP X On (Logic 1) FlexLogic operand corresponds to contact input “X” being closed, while CONTACT IP X Off corresponds to
contact input “X” being open. The CONTACT INPUT DEBNCE TIME defines the time required for the contact to overcome
‘contact bouncing’ conditions. As this time differs for different contact types and manufacturers, set it as a maximum
contact debounce time (per manufacturer specifications) plus some margin to ensure proper operation. If CONTACT INPUT
EVENTS is set to “Enabled,” every change in the contact input state triggers an event.
A raw status is scanned for all Contact Inputs synchronously at the constant rate of 0.5 ms as shown in the following
figure. The DC input voltage is compared to a user-settable threshold. A new contact input state must be maintained for a
user-settable debounce time in order for the Product to validate the new contact state. In the following figure, the
debounce time is set at 2.5 ms; thus the 6th sample in a row validates the change of state (mark no. 1 in the diagram). Once
validated (de-bounced), the contact input asserts a corresponding FlexLogic operand and logs an event as per user setting.
A time stamp of the first sample in the sequence that validates the new state is used when logging the change of the
contact input into the Event Recorder (mark no. 2 in the figure).
Protection and control elements, as well as FlexLogic equations and timers, are executed eight times in a power system
cycle. The protection pass duration is controlled by the frequency tracking mechanism. The FlexLogic operand reflecting
the debounced state of the contact is updated at the protection pass following the validation (marks no. 3 and 4 on the
figure that follows). The update is performed at the beginning of the protection pass so all protection and control functions,
as well as FlexLogic equations, are fed with the updated states of the contact inputs.
The FlexLogic operand response time to the contact input change is equal to the debounce time setting plus up to one
protection pass (variable and depending on system frequency if frequency tracking enabled). If the change of state occurs
just after a protection pass, the recognition is delayed until the subsequent protection pass; that is, by the entire duration
of the protection pass. If the change occurs just prior to a protection pass, the state is recognized immediately. Statistically
a delay of half the protection pass is expected. Owing to the 0.5 ms scan rate, the time resolution for the input contact is
below 1 ms.
For example, eight protection passes per cycle on a 60 Hz system correspond to a protection pass every 2.1 ms. With a
contact debounce time setting of 3.0 ms, the FlexLogic operand-assert time limits are: 3.0 + 0.0 = 3.0 ms and 3.0 + 2.1 = 5.1
ms. These time limits depend on how soon the protection pass runs after the debouncing time.
Regardless of the contact debounce time setting, the contact input event is time-stamped with a 1 ms accuracy using the
time of the first scan corresponding to the new state (mark no. 2 shown). Therefore, the time stamp reflects a change in the
DC voltage across the contact input terminals that was not accidental as it was subsequently validated using the
debounce timer. Keep in mind that the associated FlexLogic operand is asserted/de-asserted later, after validating the
change.
The debounce algorithm is symmetrical: the same procedure and debounce time are used to filter the LOW-HIGH (marks
no.1, 2, 3, and 4 in the figure) and HIGH-LOW (marks no. 5, 6, 7, and 8) transitions.
5 Figure 5-195: Input contact debouncing mechanism and time stamp sample timing
92/7$*(
,1387
86(5352*5$00$%/(7+5(6+2/'
7LPHVWDPSRIWKHILUVW
70
7LPHVWDPSRIWKHILUVW $WWKLVWLPHWKH 7KH)OH[/RJLF VFDQFRUUHVSRQGLQJWRWKH
$WWKLVWLPHWKHQHZ
VFDQFRUUHVSRQGLQJWR QHZ+,*+ RSHUDQGLVJRLQJWR QHZYDOLGDWHGVWDWHLV
/2:FRQWDFWVWDWHLV
WKHQHZYDOLGDWHGVWDWHLV FRQWDFWVWDWHLV EHDVVHUWHGDWWKLV ORJJHGLQWKH62(UHFRUG
YDOLGDWHG
ORJJHGLQWKH62(UHFRUG YDOLGDWHG SURWHFWLRQSDVV
5$: &217$&7
7KH)OH[/RJLF70
RSHUDQGLVJRLQJWREH
67$7(
GHDVVHUWHGDWWKLV
SURWHFWLRQSDVV
'(%281&(7,0(
XVHUVHWWLQJ
7KH)OH[/RJLF70RSHUDQG
'(%281&(7,0(
7KH)OH[/RJLF70RSHUDQG FKDQJHVUHIOHFWLQJWKH
6&$17,0( XVHUVHWWLQJ
FKDQJHVUHIOHFWLQJWKH YDOLGDWHGFRQWDFWVWDWH
)/(;/2*,&70
PVHF YDOLGDWHGFRQWDFWVWDWH
23(5$1'
3527(&7,213$66
WLPHVDF\FOHFRQWUROOHGE\WKH
IUHTXHQF\WUDFNLQJPHFKDQLVP
$FGU
Contact inputs are isolated in groups of four to allow connection of wet contacts from different voltage sources for each
group. The CONTACT INPUT THRESHOLDS determine the minimum voltage required to detect a closed contact input. This
value is selected according to the following criteria: 17 for 24 V sources, 33 for 48 V sources, 84 for 110 to 125 V sources
and 166 for 250 V sources.
For example, to use contact input H5a as a status input from the breaker 52b contact to seal-in the trip relay and record it
in the Event Records menu, make the following settings changes:
CONTACT INPUT H5a ID: "Breaker Closed (52b)"
CONTACT INPUT H5a EVENTS: "Enabled"
Note that the 52b contact is closed when the breaker is open and open when the breaker is closed.
The virtual inputs and outputs are digital signals associated with UR-series internal logic signals. Virtual inputs include
signals generated by the local user interface. The virtual outputs are outputs of FlexLogic equations used to customize the
device. Virtual outputs can also serve as virtual inputs to FlexLogic equations.
The virtual inputs can be individually programmed to respond to input signals from the keypad (via the COMMANDS menu)
and communications protocols. All virtual input operands are defaulted to “Off” (logic 0) unless the appropriate input signal
is received. 5
If the VIRTUAL INPUT x FUNCTION is to “Disabled,” the input is forced to off (logic 0) regardless of any attempt to alter the
input. If set to “Enabled,” the input operates as shown on the logic diagram and generates output FlexLogic operands in
response to received input signals and the applied settings.
There are two types of operation: self-reset and latched. If VIRTUAL INPUT x type is “Self-Reset,” when the input signal
transits from off to on, the output operand is set to on for only one evaluation of the FlexLogic equations and then return to
off. If set to “Latched,” the virtual input sets the state of the output operand to the same state as the most recent received
input.
The self-reset operating mode generates the output operand for a single evaluation of the FlexLogic equations. If the
operand is to be used anywhere other than internally in a FlexLogic equation, it likely needs to be lengthened in time. A
FlexLogic timer with a delayed reset can perform this function.
Figure 5-196: Virtual inputs logic
SETTING
VIRTUAL INPUT 1
FUNCTION:
Enabled=1 S
AND
Latch
“Virtual Input 1 to ON = 1”
SETTING
“Virtual Input 1 to OFF = 0” R VIRTUAL INPUT 1 ID:
AND
SETTING (Flexlogic Operand)
OR
Virt Ip 1
VIRTUAL INPUT 1
TYPE:
Latched AND
Self - Reset 827080A3.CDR
A contact inputs and outputs are digital signals associated with connections to hard-wired contacts. Wet and dry contacts
are supported.
Upon startup of the relay, the main processor determines from an assessment of the modules installed in the chassis
which contact outputs are available and then presents the settings for only these outputs. Where the contact input is non-
latching, the settings are as shown.
An ID can be assigned to each contact output. The signal that can OPERATE a contact output can be any FlexLogic
operand (virtual output, element state, contact input, or virtual input). An additional FlexLogic operand can be used to
SEAL-IN the relay. Any change of state of a contact output can be logged as an Event if programmed to do so.
For example, the trip circuit current is monitored by providing a current threshold detector in series with some Form-A
5 contacts (see the trip circuit example in the Digital Elements section). The monitor sets a flag (see the specifications for
Form-A). The name of the FlexLogic operand set by the monitor, consists of the output relay designation, followed by the
name of the flag; for example, Cont OP 1 IOn.
In most breaker control circuits, the trip coil is connected in series with a breaker auxiliary contact used to interrupt current
flow after the breaker has tripped, to prevent damage to the less robust initiating contact. This can be done by monitoring
an auxiliary contact on the breaker which opens when the breaker has tripped, but this scheme is subject to incorrect
operation caused by differences in timing between breaker auxiliary contact change-of-state and interruption of current
in the trip circuit. The most dependable protection of the initiating contact is provided by directly measuring current in the
tripping circuit, and using this parameter to control resetting of the initiating relay. This scheme is often called trip seal-in.
This can be realized using the Cont OP 1 IOn FlexLogic operand to seal-in the contact output as follows:
CONTACT OUTPUT H1 ID: “Cont Op 1"
OUTPUT H1 OPERATE: any suitable FlexLogic operand
OUTPUT H1 SEAL-IN: “Cont Op 1 IOn”
CONTACT OUTPUT H1 EVENTS: “Enabled”
SETT ING
CONTACT OUTPU T H1 SEAL-IN H1a
AND
= On
H1b
H1c
859743A1.vsd
The latching output contacts are mechanically bi-stable and controlled by two separate (open and close) coils. As such
they retain their position even if the relay is not powered up. The relay recognizes all latching output contact cards and
populates the setting menu accordingly. On power up, the relay reads positions of the latching contacts from the
hardware before executing any other functions of the relay (such as protection and control features or FlexLogic).
The latching output modules, either as part of the relay or as individual modules, are shipped from the factory with all
latching contacts open. It is highly recommended to double-check the programming and positions of the latching contacts
when replacing a module.
Since the relay asserts the output contact and reads back its position, it is possible to incorporate self-monitoring
capabilities for the latching outputs. If any latching outputs exhibits a discrepancy, the LATCHING OUTPUT ERROR self-test
error is declared. The error is signaled by the LATCHING OUT ERROR FlexLogic operand, event, and target message.
Settings shown use H1a as an example. The menu varies; not all fields shown display.
OUTPUT H1a OPERATE — This setting specifies a FlexLogic operand to operate the ‘close coil’ of the contact. The relay seals-
in this input to safely close the contact. Once the contact is closed and the RESET input is logic 0 (off), any activity of the
OPERATE input, such as subsequent chattering, does not have any effect. With both the OPERATE and RESET inputs active
(logic 1), the response of the latching contact is specified by the OUTPUT H1a TYPE setting.
OUTPUT H1a RESET or SEAL-IN — This setting specifies a FlexLogic operand to operate the ‘trip coil’ of the contact. The relay
seals-in this input to safely open the contact. Once the contact is opened and the OPERATE input is logic 0 (off), any activity
of the RESET input, such as subsequent chattering, does not have any effect. With both the OPERATE and RESET inputs
active (logic 1), the response of the latching contact is specified by the OUTPUT H1a TYPE setting.
OUTPUT H1a TYPE — This setting specifies the contact response under conflicting control inputs; that is, when both the
OPERATE and RESET signals are applied. With both control inputs applied simultaneously, the contact closes if set to
“Operate-dominant” and opens if set to “Reset-dominant.”
Figure 5-198: Contact input/output module type 4L contact 1 logic
SETTING
CONTACT OUTPUT H1a OPERATE Non-volatile,
= On Set-dominant
AND S
SETTING OR Latch On
CONTACT OUTPUT H1a TYPE Close
= Operate-dominant R
H1b
= Reset-dominant
Non-volatile,
SETTING OR Set-dominant
H1a
CONTACT OUTPUT H1a RESET AND S
= On Open
Latch
R
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Cont Op 1 Closed
859744A1.vsd
Application example 1
A latching output contact H1a is to be controlled from two user-programmable pushbuttons (buttons number 1 and 2). The
following settings are applied.
Program the Latching Outputs by making the following changes in the SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS CONTACT
OUTPUTS CONTACT OUTPUT H1a menu (assuming an H4L module):
Application example 2
A relay, having two latching contacts H1a and H1c, is to be programmed. The H1a contact is to be a Type-a contact, while
the H1c contact is to be a Type-b contact (Type-a means closed after exercising the operate input; Type-b means closed
after exercising the reset input). The relay is to be controlled from virtual outputs: VO1 to operate and VO2 to reset.
Program the Latching Outputs by making the following changes in the SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS CONTACT
OUTPUTS CONTACT OUTPUT H1a and CONTACT OUTPUT H1c menus (assuming an H4L module):
OUTPUT H1a OPERATE: “VO1”
OUTPUT H1a RESET: “VO2”
OUTPUT H1c OPERATE: “VO2”
OUTPUT H1c RESET: “VO1”
Since the two physical contacts in this example are mechanically separated and have individual control inputs, they do
not operate at exactly the same time. A discrepancy in the range of a fraction of a maximum operating time can occur.
Therefore, a pair of contacts programmed to be a multi-contact relay do not guarantee any specific sequence of operation
(such as make before break). If required, the sequence of operation must be programmed explicitly by delaying some of
the control inputs as shown in the next application example.
Application example 3
A make before break functionality must be added to the preceding example. An overlap of 20 ms is required to implement
this functionality.
Application example 4
A latching contact H1a is to be controlled from a single virtual output VO1. The contact is to remain closed as long as VO1
is high, and is to remain opened when VO1 is low. Program the relay as follows. 5
Write the following FlexLogic equation (EnerVista example shown).
Program the Latching Outputs by making the following changes in the SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS CONTACT
OUTPUTS CONTACT OUTPUT H1a menu (assuming an H4L module):
OUTPUT H1a OPERATE: “VO1”
OUTPUT H1a RESET: “VO2”
The virtual inputs and outputs are digital signals associated with UR-series internal logic signals. Virtual inputs include
signals generated by the local user interface. The virtual outputs are outputs of FlexLogic equations used to customize the
device. Virtual outputs can also serve as virtual inputs to FlexLogic equations.
The virtual outputs can be assigned using FlexLogic. If not assigned, the output is forced to ‘OFF’ (Logic 0). An ID also can be
assigned to each virtual output. Virtual outputs are resolved in each pass through the evaluation of the FlexLogic
equations. Any change of state of a virtual output can be logged as an event if programmed to do so.
For example, if Virtual Output 1 is the trip signal from FlexLogic and the trip relay is used to signal events, the settings is
programmed as follows:
VIRTUAL OUTPUT 1 ID: "Trip"
VIRTUAL OUTPUT 1 EVENTS: "Disabled"
5.10.5 Resetting
Some events can be programmed to latch the front panel LED event indicators, target messages, and/or graphical front
panel annunciator windows. Once set, the latching mechanism holds the latched indicators, messages, or windows in the
set state after the initiating condition has cleared until a RESET command is received to return these latches (not including
FlexLogic latches) to the reset state where the initiating condition has cleared. The RESET command can be sent from the
front panel RESET button, a remote device via a communications channel, or any selected operand. The Modbus execute
function 05h with operation code 1 command is also available to perform the same function as the front panel RESET key.
RESET OPERAND — The three sources of RESET commands each activates the RESET OP FlexLogic operand. Each individual
source of a RESET command also activates its individual operand RESET OP (PUSHBUTTON), RESET OP (COMMS), or RESET OP
(OPERAND) to identify the source of the command. Each of these three operands generates an event in the event record
when activated. The RESET OPERAND setting here selects the operand that activates the RESET OP (OPERAND) operand.
RESET ANNUNCIATOR — Used to select a FlexLogic operand that when activated acknowledges/resets all annunciator
windows on the graphical front panel. The other methods to acknowledge/reset annunciator windows include:
• On the displayed page, press the RESET pushbutton with none of the annunciator windows selected to acknowledge/
reset all annunciator windows on that page
• To acknowledge/reset a specific annunciator window, use the Up, Down, Left and Right pushbuttons to select the
window, and press the RESET or ENTER pushbutton
• All annunciator windows can be reset remotely by programming a Virtual Input (for example Virtual Input 1) as the
input to the RESET ANNUNCIATOR setting. Then the Modbus execute function 05h with operation code 1000h command
(or function 10h with address 400h) is used to set the state of Virtual Input 1.
For the RESET ANNUNCIATOR setting, the RESET ANCTR OP FlexLogic operand is activated by the two sources of RESET
command, operand source and manual source. Each individual source of a RESET ANNUNCIATOR command also activates
its individual operand RESET OP (OPRD) or RESET ANCTR OP (MNUL) to identify the source of the command. Each of these two
operands generates an event in the event record when activated. The setting here selects the operand that activates the
RESET ANCTR OP (OPRD) operand. The RESET pushbutton on the front panel or the reset command from the software
activates the RESET ANCTR OP (MNUL) operand.
DIR OUT 1 NAME — This setting allows the user to assign a descriptive name to the direct output.
DIR OUT 1 OPERAND — This sets the FlexLogic operand that determines the state of this direct output.
TX1
UR IED 1
RX1
TX1
UR IED 2
RX1
842711A1.CDR
Assume that contact input 1 from UR IED 2 is to be used by UR IED 1. The following settings are applied (Direct Input 5 and
bit number 12 are used, as an example).
UR IED 1:
DIRECT INPUT 5 DEVICE ID = “2”
DIRECT INPUT 5 BIT NUMBER = “12”
UR IED 2:
DIRECT OUT 12 OPERAND = “Cont Ip 1 On”
5 The Cont Ip 1 On operand of UR IED 2 is now available in UR IED 1 as DIRECT INPUT 5 ON.
85,(' %/2&.
($"'!"1!34B
Assume that Phase Instantaneous Overcurrent 1 is used by Devices 2, 3, and 4 to block Device 1. If not blocked, Device 1
trips the bus upon detecting a fault and applying a short coordination time delay.
The following settings are applied (assume Bit 3 is used by all 3 devices to send the blocking signal and Direct Inputs 7, 8,
and 9 are used by the receiving device to monitor the three blocking signals).
UR IED 2:
DIRECT OUT 3 OPERAND: "PHASE IOC1 OP"
UR IED 3:
DIRECT OUT 3 OPERAND: "PHASE IOC1 OP"
UR IED 4:
DIRECT OUT 3 OPERAND: "PHASE IOC1 OP"
UR IED 1:
DIRECT INPUT 7 DEVICE ID: "2"
DIRECT INPUT 7 BIT NUMBER: "3"
DIRECT INPUT 7 DEFAULT STATE: select "On" for security, select "Off" for dependability
85,(' 85,('
5
85,(' ($"'!#1!34B
Assume the Hybrid Permissive Overreaching Transfer Trip (Hybrid POTT) scheme is applied using the architecture shown
as follows. The scheme output operand HYB POTT TX1 is used to key the permission.
Figure 5-202: Single-channel open-loop configuration
5;
85,('
7;
($"'!$1!34B
In this architecture, Devices 1 and 3 do not communicate directly. Therefore, Device 2 must act as a "bridge." The following
settings are applied:
UR IEC 1:
85,(' 85,('
5 ',5(&7287 +<%32777; ',5(&7,1387
',5(&7,1387 ',5(&7287 +<%32777;
',5(&7,1387 ',5(&7287 ',5(&7,1387
',5(&7287 ',5(&7,1387
',5(&7,1387
85,(' ',5(&7,1387
',5(&7,1387
',5(&7287 +<%32777;
($"'!'1!34B
In three-terminal applications, both the remote terminals must grant permission to trip. Therefore, at each terminal, direct
inputs 5 and 6 are ANDed in FlexLogic and the resulting operand configured as the permission to trip (HYB POTT RX1
setting).
5.10.7 Teleprotection
5.10.7.1 Overview
The relay provides 16 teleprotection inputs on communications channel 1 (numbered 1-1 through 1-16) and 16
teleprotection inputs on communications channel 2 (on two-terminals two-channel and three-terminal systems only,
numbered 2-1 through 2-16). The remote relay connected to channels 1 and 2 of the local relay is programmed by
assigning FlexLogic operands to be sent via the selected communications channel. This allows the user to create
distributed protection and control schemes via dedicated communications channels. Some examples are directional
comparison pilot schemes and direct transfer tripping. Note that failures of communications channels affect
teleprotection functionality. The teleprotection function must be enabled to utilize the inputs.
Setting the TELEPROT INPUT ~~ DEFAULT setting to “On” defaults the input to logic 1 when the channel fails. A value of “Off”
defaults the input to logic 0 when the channel fails.
The “Latest/On” and “Latest/Off” values freeze the input in case of lost communications. If the latest state is not known,
such as after relay power-up but before the first communication exchange, then the input defaults to logic 1 for “Latest/
On” and logic 0 for “Latest/Off.”
As the following figure demonstrates, processing of the teleprotection inputs/outputs is dependent on the number of
communication channels and terminals. On two-terminal two-channel systems, they are processed continuously on each
channel and mapped separately per channel. Therefore, to achieve redundancy, the user must assign the same operand
on both channels (teleprotection outputs at the sending end or corresponding teleprotection inputs at the receiving end).
On three-terminal two-channel systems, redundancy is achieved by programming signal re-transmittal in the case of
channel failure between any pair of relays.
EB! EB"
13DE1<F1<E5C C5DD9>7
381>>5<!CD1DEC* D5<5@B?D9>@ED!!
4561E<D*
C5DD9>7 cQ]UV_b!"!!&
D5<5@B?D?ED@ED!!*
cQ]UV_b!"!!& ?^ 6<5H<?793?@5B1>4
6QY\
?VV6\Uh\_WYS?`UbQ^T ?VV D5<5@B?9>@ED!!?^
?; ?B
cQ]UV_b!"!!&
13DE1<F1<E5C
C5DD9>7
381>>5<!CD1DEC*
D5<5@B?D9>@ED!! 3_]]e^YSQdY_^SXQ^^U\!
4561E<D*
cQ]UV_b!"!!& DU\U`b_dUSdY_^9?5^QR\UT C5DD9>7
6<5H<?793?@5B1>4 D5<5@B?D?ED@ED!!*
?^ cQ]UV_b!"!!&
6QY\
D5<5@B?9>@ED!!?^ ?VV
?B ?; ?VV6\Uh\_WYS?`UbQ^T
cQ]UV_b!"!!&
EB"_bEB#
13DE1<F1<E5C C5DD9>7
381>>5<"CD1DEC* D5<5@B?D9>@ED"!
4561E<D*
C5DD9>7 cQ]UV_b"""!&
D5<5@B?D?ED@ED"!*
cQ]UV_b!"!!& ?^ 6<5H<?793?@5B1>4
6QY\
?VV D5<5@B?9>@ED"!?^
?VV6\Uh\_WYS?`UbQ^T ?; ?B
cQ]UV_b"""!&
13DE1<F1<E5C
C5DD9>7
381>>5<"CD1DEC*
D5<5@B?D9>@ED"! 3_]]e^YSQdY_^SXQ^^U\"
4561E<D*
cQ]UV_b!"!!& ?^#dUb]Y^Q\cicdU]_b"dUb]Y^Q\ C5DD9>7
6<5H<?793?@5B1>4
gYdXbUTe^TQ^dSXQ^^U\
D5<5@B?D?ED@ED"!*
?^ cQ]UV_b"""!&
6QY\
D5<5@B?9>@ED"!?^ ?VV
?B ?; ?VV6\Uh\_WYS?`UbQ^T
cQ]UV_b!"!!&
($"'% 1"34B
5
5.11 Transducer inputs/outputs
5.11.1 DCmA inputs
SETTINGS TRANSDUCER I/O DCMA INPUTS DCMA INPUT H1(W8)
DCMA INPUT H1 DCMA INPUT H1 Range: Disabled, Enabled
FUNCTION: Disabled
The M60 is provided with optional DCmA capability, specified at the time of ordering.
Hardware and software are provided to receive signals from external transducers and to convert these signals into a
digital format for use as required. The relay accepts inputs in the range of –1 to +20 mA DC, suitable for use with most
common transducer output ranges; all inputs are assumed to be linear over the complete range. Hardware details are
contained in chapter 3.
Before the DCmA input signal can be used, the value of the signal measured by the relay must be converted to the range
and quantity of the external transducer primary input parameter, such as DC voltage or temperature. The relay simplifies
this process by internally scaling the output from the external transducer and displaying the actual primary parameter.
DCmA input channels are arranged in a manner similar to CT and VT channels. Configure the individual channels with the
settings shown here.
The channels are arranged in sub-modules of two channels, numbered from 1 through 8 from top to bottom. On power-up,
the relay automatically generates configuration settings for every channel, based on the order code, in the same general
manner that is used for CTs and VTs. Each channel is assigned a slot letter followed by the row number, 1 through 8
inclusive, which is used as the channel number. The relay generates an actual value for each available input channel.
Settings are generated automatically for every channel available in the specific relay as shown above for the first channel
of a type 5F transducer module installed in slot H.
The function of the channel can be “Enabled” or “Disabled.” If “Disabled,” no actual values are created for the channel. An
alphanumeric “ID” is assigned to each channel; this ID is included in the channel actual value, along with the programmed
units associated with the parameter measured by the transducer, such as volts, °C, megawatts, and so on. This ID is also
used to reference the channel as the input parameter to features designed to measure this type of parameter. The DCMA
INPUT H1 RANGE setting specifies the mA DC range of the transducer connected to the input channel.
The DCMA INPUT H1 MIN VALUE and DCMA INPUT H1 MAX VALUE settings are used to program the span of the transducer in
primary units. For example, a temperature transducer might have a span from 0 to 250 °C; in this case the DCMA INPUT H1
MIN VALUE value is “0” and the DCMA INPUT H1 MAX VALUE value is “250.” Another example is a watts transducer with a span
from –20 to +180 MW; in this case the DCMA INPUT H1 MIN VALUE value is “–20” and the DCMA INPUT H1 MAX VALUE value is
“180.” Intermediate values between the minimum and maximum values are scaled linearly.
RTD INPUT H1 TYPE: Range: 100Ω Nickel, 10Ω Copper, 100Ω Platinum,
100Ω Platinum 120Ω Nickel
RTD INPUT H1 TRIP Range: None, Group, RTD Inp H1, RTD Inp H2,...,
VOTING: None RTD Inp W8
The RTD inputs convert values of input resistance into temperature for further operations. These channels are intended to
be connected to any of the RTD types in common use. Hardware details are contained in chapter 3.
RTD input channels are arranged in a manner similar to CT and VT channels. Configure individual channels with the
settings shown here.
The channels are arranged in sub-modules of two channels, numbered from 1 through 8 from top to bottom. On power-up,
the relay generates automatically the configuration settings for every channel, based on the order code, in the same
general manner that is used for CTs and VTs. Each channel is assigned a slot letter followed by the row number, 1 through
8 inclusive, which is used as the channel number. The relay generates an actual value for each available input channel.
Settings are generated automatically for every channel available in the specific relay as shown above for the first channel
of a type 5C transducer module installed in the first available slot.
RTD INPUT H1 FUNCTION — The function of the channel can be either “Enabled” or “Disabled.” When disabled, there is no
actual value created for the channel.
RTD INPUT H1 ID — Assigns an alphanumeric ID to the channel. This ID is included in the channel actual values. It is also
used to reference the channel as the input parameter to features designed to measure this type of parameter.
RTD INPUT H1 TYPE — Specifies the RTD type. Four different RTD types are available: 100 Ω Nickel, 10 Ω Copper, 100 Ω
Platinum, and 120 Ω Nickel. The following table outlines reference temperature values for each type.
RTD INPUT H1 APPLICATION — This setting allows each individual RTD to be assigned to a group application. This is useful for
applications that require group measurement for voting. A value of “None” specifies that the RTD operates individually and
not part of any RTD group. All RTDs programmed to “Stator” are used for RTD biasing of the M60 thermal model. Common
groups are provided for rotating machines applications such as ambient, bearing, group 1, or group 2. If the RTD INPUT H1
TRIP VOTING setting value is “Group”, then it is allowed to issue a trip if N – 1 RTDs from the same group also pick up, where
N is the number of enabled RTDs from the group.
RTD INPUT H1 ALARM TEMPERATURE — Specifies the temperature pickup level for the alarm stage.
RTD INPUT H1 ALARM PKP DELAY — Specifies time delay for the alarm stage until the output can be asserted.
RTD INPUT H1 TRIP TEMPERATURE — Specifies the temperature pickup level for the trip stage.
RTD INPUT H1 TRIP PKP DELAY — Specifies time delay for the trip stage until the output can be asserted.
RTD INPUT H1 TRIP RST DELAY — Specifies the reset delay to seal-in the trip signal.
RTD INPUT H1 TRIP VOTING — Allows securing trip signal by voting with other RTDs. A value of “None” indicates that element
operates individually and no voting takes place.
A value of “Group” indicates that element is allowed to issue a trip if N – 1 of other RTDs of the same group pick up as well
(where N is the number of enabled RTDs from the group). For example, if three RTDs are assigned to the same group, there
needs to be at least one additional RTD of the same group picked up to issue a trip command.
The “RTD Inp H1” through “RTD Inp W8” values indicate that element is allowed to issue a trip if the corresponding peer RTD
is also picked up.
RTD INPUT H1 OPEN — Allows monitoring of an open RTD sensor circuit. If this functionality is not required, then a value of
“None” disables monitoring and assertion of output operands. If set to “Alarm”, the monitor sets an alarm when a broken
sensor is detected. If set to “Block,” the monitor sets an alarm and simultaneously blocks RTD operation when a broken
sensor is detected.
If targets are enabled, a message appears on the display identifying the broken RTD. If this feature is used, it is
recommended that the alarm be programmed as latched so that intermittent RTDs are detected and corrective action can
be taken.
RTD INPUT H1 BLOCK — This setting is used to block RTD operation.
5 = RTD Inp H1
RTD INPUT H1 TYPE
RTD INPUT H1 ALARM
TEMPERATURE
RUN
RTD INPUT H1 ALARM
PKP DELAY
TPKP
RTD INPUT H1 TRIP
VOTING
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Resistance to Voting logic RTD Ip TRIP OP
temperature > TRIP PICKUP TDPO
temperature conversion
RUN TPKP
AND temperature > ALARM PICKUP From other RTDs for voting FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
0
RTD Ip ALARM OP
SETTING
RTD Ip TRIP PKP
RTD INPUT H1 OPEN
Block RTD Ip TRIP DPO
RUN
Alarm RTD Ip ALARM PKP
R ³ 250°C OR
None RTD Ip ALARM DPO
RUN RTD Ip OPEN
RTD Ip SHORTED
R £ –50°C
833019A2.CDR
5.11.3.1 Menu
SETTINGS TRANSDUCER I/O RRTD INPUTS
RRTD INPUTS RRTD 1 See below
RRTD 12
RRTD 1 TRIP VOTING: Range: None, Group, Remote RTD 1, Remote RTD 2,...,
None Remote RTD 12
The remote RTD inputs convert values of input resistance into temperature for further operations. These inputs are
intended to be connected to any of the RTD types in common use. Hardware details are contained in chapter 3.
On power up, the M60 reads and saves all application and type settings from the RRTD. This synchronizes the RRTD and
M60. Any changes to RRTD settings (function, application, or type) from the M60 interface are immediately reflected in the
RRTD. The following rules are followed:
• If the RRTD 1 FUNCTION setting is “Enabled,” then the RRTD 1 APPLICATION setting value is written to RRTD device
• If the RRTD 1 FUNCTION setting is “Disabled,” then RRTD1 APPLICATION setting value is set as “None”
• If the RRTD 1 APPLICATION or RRTD 1 TYPE settings are changed, then these settings are immediately written to the
RRTD device
• If the RRTD 1 APPLICATION setting is “Group 1” or “Group 2,” then a value of “Other” is written to the RRTD device
An RRTD actual value of –43°C implies that the RRTD 1 FUNCTION setting is “Enabled” but the corresponding RRTD 1
APPLICATION setting is “None.”
If the RRTD communication link with the M60 is broken, then the last temperature actual values are retained until the RRTD
communication failure is detected. When this occurs, a RRTD COMM FAILURE self-test alarm and target message is
generated, an event is logged in the event recorder, and the temperature actual values are reset to 0. When the link is re-
established, the RRTD 1 APPLICATION and RRTD 1 TYPE settings are read from the RRTD to re-synchronize the device.
RRTD 1 FUNCTION — This setting enables and disables the remote RTD. When disabled, no actual value is created for the
remote RTD.
RRTD 1 ID — Assign an alphanumeric ID to the remote RTD. This ID is included in the remote RTD actual values. It is also used
to reference the remote RTD input to features using the remote RTD.
RRTD 1 TYPE — This setting specifies the remote RTD type. Four different RTD types are available: 100 Ω Nickel, 10 Ω Copper,
100 Ω Platinum, and 120 Ω Nickel.
The RRTD converts resistance to temperature as per the values in the following table. The M60 reads the RTD temperatures
from the RRTD once every five seconds and applies protection accordingly. The RRTDs can be used to provide RTD bias in
the existing thermal model.
Table 5-47: RTD temperature vs resistance
Temperature Resistance (in ohms)
°C °F 100 ohm Pt 120 ohm Ni 100 ohm Ni 10 ohm Cu
(DIN 43760)
–40 –40 84.27 92.76 79.13 7.49
–30 –22 88.22 99.41 84.15 7.88
–20 –4 92.16 106.15 89.23 8.26
–10 14 96.09 113 94.58 8.65
0 32 100 120 100 9.04
10 50 103.9 127.17 105.6 9.42
20 68 107.79 134.52 111.2 9.81
30 86 111.67 142.06 117.1 10.19
40 104 115.54 149.79 123 10.58
50 122 119.39 157.74 129.1 10.97
60 140 123.24 165.9 135.3 11.35
5 70 158 127.07 174.25 141.7 11.74
80 176 130.89 182.84 148.3 12.12
90 194 134.7 191.64 154.9 12.51
100 212 138.5 200.64 161.8 12.9
110 230 142.29 209.85 168.8 13.28
120 248 146.06 219.29 176 13.67
130 266 149.82 228.96 183.3 14.06
140 284 153.58 238.85 190.9 14.44
150 302 157.32 248.95 198.7 14.83
160 320 161.04 259.3 206.6 15.22
170 338 164.76 269.91 214.8 15.61
180 356 168.47 280.77 223.2 16
190 374 172.46 291.96 231.6 16.39
200 392 175.84 303.46 240 16.78
An RRTD open condition is detected when actual RRTD resistance is greater than 1000 ohms and RRTD open is displayed
as “250°C” in the M60.
An RRTD short condition is detected when actual RRTD temperature is less than –40°C and RRTD short is displayed as is “–
50°C” in the M60.
RRTD 1 APPLICATION — This setting allows each remote RTD to be assigned to a group application. This is useful for
applications that require group measurement for voting. A value of “None” specifies that the remote RTD operates
individually and not part of any RTD group. All remote RTDs programmed to “Stator” are used for RTD biasing of the M60
thermal model. Common groups are provided for rotating machines applications, such as ambient, bearing, group 1, or
group 2. If the REMOTE RTD 1 TRIP VOTING setting value is “Group”, then it is allowed to issue a trip if N – 1 RTDs from the
same group also pick up, where N is the number of enabled RTDs from the group.
RRTD 1 ALARM TEMPERATURE — This setting specifies the temperature pickup level for the alarm stage. The range of 1 to
200°C differs from the existing RTD settings to correspond to the range of the RRTD unit.
RRTD 1 ALARM PKP DELAY — This setting specifies time delay for the alarm stage until the output can be asserted. The range
of 5 to 600 seconds differs from the existing RTD settings to correspond to the range of the RRTD unit.
RRTD 1 TRIP TEMPERATURE — This setting specifies the temperature pickup level for the trip stage. The range of 1 to 200°C
differs from the existing RTD settings to correspond to the range of the RRTD unit.
RRTD 1 TRIP PKP DELAY — This setting specifies time delay for the trip stage until the output can be asserted. The range of 5
to 600 seconds differs from the existing RTD settings to correspond to the range of the RRTD unit.
RRTD 1 TRIP RST DELAY — This setting specifies the reset delay to seal-in the trip signal.
RRTD 1 TRIP VOTING — This setting allows securing trip signal by voting with other RTDs. A value of “None” indicates that
element operates individually and no voting takes place.
A value of “Group” indicates that element is allowed to issue a trip if N – 1 of other RTDs of the same group pick up as well
(where N is the number of enabled RTDs from the group). For example, if three RTDs are assigned to the same group, there
needs to be at least one additional RTD of the same group picked up to issue a trip command.
The “Remote RTD 1” through “Remote RTD 12” values indicate that element is allowed to issue a trip if the corresponding
peer RTD is also picked up.
RRTD 1 OPEN — This setting allows monitoring an open remote RTD sensor circuit. If this functionality is not required, then a
value of “None” disables monitoring and assertion of output operands. If set to “Alarm”, the monitor sets an alarm when a
broken sensor is detected. If set to “Block”, the monitor sets an alarm and simultaneously block remote RTD operation
when a broken sensor is detected.
If targets are enabled, a message appears on the display identifying the broken RTD. If this feature is used, it is
recommended that the alarm be programmed as latched so that intermittent RTDs are detected and corrective action can
be taken.
RRTD 1 BLOCK — This setting is used to block remote RTD operation.
SETTINGS
SETTINGS Trip Pickup Delay SETTINGS
AND
Trip Temperature Trip Reset Delay Application
SETTING
Alarm Temperature Alarm Pickup Delay Trip Voting
Type
RUN TPKP FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Temperature read Voting logic REMOTE RTD 1 TRIP OP
temperature > Trip Pickup TDPO
from RRTD
RUN TPKP
temperature > Alarm Pickup From other remote FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
0 RTDs for voting
RRTD 1 ALARM OP
SETTING
RRTD 1 TRIP PKP
Open
Block RRTD 1 TRIP DPO
RUN
Alarm RRTD 1 ALARM PKP
R > 1000 ohms OR
None RRTD 1 ALARM DPO
RUN RRTD 1 OPEN
RRTD 1 SHORTED
T £ –40°C
833026A1.CDR
Hardware and software is provided to generate DCmA signals that allow interfacing with external equipment. Hardware
details are contained in chapter 3. The DCmA output channels are arranged in a manner similar to transducer input or CT
and VT channels. The user configures individual channels with the settings as follows.
The channels are arranged in sub-modules of two channels, numbered 1 through 8 from top to bottom. On power-up, the
relay automatically generates configuration settings for every channel, based on the order code, in the same manner
used for CTs and VTs. Each channel is assigned a slot letter followed by the row number, 1 through 8 inclusive, which is
used as the channel number.
Both the output range and a signal driving a given output are user-programmable via the following settings menu (an
example for channel M5 is shown).
The relay checks the driving signal (x in equations below) for the minimum and maximum limits, and subsequently re-
scales so the limits defined as MIN VAL and MAX VAL match the output range of the hardware defined as RANGE. The
following equation is applied:
where
I max – I min
k = -------------------------------------------
- Eq. 5-64
MAX VAL – MIN VAL
The feature is intentionally inhibited if the MAX VAL and MIN VAL settings are entered incorrectly, for example when MAX VAL
– MIN VAL < 0.1 pu. The resulting characteristic is illustrated in the following figure.
Figure 5-207: DCmA output characteristic
9]Qh
?ED@ED3EBB5>D
9]Y^
4B9F9>7C97>1<
($"'#)1!34B =9>F1< =1HF1<
Settings
DCMA OUTPUT H1 SOURCE — This setting specifies an internal analog value to drive the analog output. Actual values
(FlexAnalog parameters) such as power, current amplitude, voltage amplitude, power factor, etc. can be configured as
sources driving DCmA outputs. See Appendix A for a list of FlexAnalog parameters.
DCMA OUTPUT H1 RANGE — This setting allows selection of the output range. Each DCmA channel can be set independently
to work with different ranges. The three most commonly used output ranges are available.
DCMA OUTPUT H1 MIN VAL — This setting allows setting the minimum limit for the signal that drives the output. This setting
is used to control the mapping between an internal analog value and the output current. The setting is entered in per-unit
values. The base units are defined in the same manner as the FlexElement base units.
DCMA OUTPUT H1 MAX VAL — This setting allows setting the maximum limit for the signal that drives the output. This setting
is used to control the mapping between an internal analog value and the output current. The setting is entered in per-unit
values. The base units are defined in the same manner as the FlexElement base units.
The DCMA OUTPUT H1 MIN VAL and DCMA OUTPUT H1 MAX VAL settings are ignored for power factor base units (i.e. if
the DCMA OUTPUT H1 SOURCE is set to FlexAnalog value based on power factor measurement).
The base unit for power (refer to the FlexElements section in this chapter for additional details) is:
The minimum and maximum power values to be monitored (in pu) are:
– 20.65 MW 20.65 MW
minimum power = -------------------------- = – 1.247 pu, maximum power = ----------------------- = 1.247 pu Eq. 5-68
16.56 MW 16.56 MW
The base unit for current (see the FlexElements section in this chapter for additional details) is:
The minimum and maximum power values to be monitored (in pu) are:
0 kA 6.3 kA
minimum current = ---------- = 0 pu, maximum current = -------------- = 1.26 pu Eq. 5-71
5 kA 5 kA
400 kV 400 kV
V min = 0.7 u ---------------- = 161.66 kV, V max = 1.1 u ---------------- = 254.03 kV
3 3 Eq. 5-72
The base unit for voltage (see the FlexElements section in this chapter for additional details) is:
The minimum and maximum voltage values to be monitored (in pu) are:
161.66 kV 254.03 kV
minimum voltage = ----------------------- = 0.404 pu, maximum voltage = ----------------------- = 0.635 pu Eq. 5-74
400 kV 400 kV
The following settings are entered:
DCMA OUTPUT H3 SOURCE: “SRC 2 V_1 mag”
DCMA OUTPUT H3 RANGE: “0 to 1 mA”
DCMA OUTPUT H3 MIN VAL: “0.404 pu”
DCMA OUTPUT H3 MAX VAL: “0.635 pu”
The limit settings differ from the expected 0.7 pu and 1.1 pu because the relay calculates the positive-sequence quantities
scaled to the phase-to-ground voltages, even if the VTs are connected in “Delta” (see the Metering Conventions section in
chapter 6), while at the same time the VT nominal voltage is 1 pu for the settings. Consequently the settings required in this
example differ from naturally expected by the factor of 3 .
The worst-case error for this application could be calculated by superimposing the following two sources of error:
• ±0.5% of the full scale for the analog output module, or ± 0.005 x (1-0) x 254.03 kV = ±1.27 kV
• ±0.5% of reading
For example, under nominal conditions, the positive-sequence reads 230.94 kV and the worst-case error is
0.005 230.94 kV + 1.27 kV = 2.42 kV.
5.12 Testing
5.12.1 IED mode config
SETTINGS TESTING IED MODE CONFIG
IED MODE CONFIG IED MODE: Range: On, Test, Test-Blocked
On
IED BEHAVIOR:
On
Range: On, Test, Test-Blocked
5
The M60 provides a test facility to verify the functionality of contact inputs and outputs, some communication functions
and the Phasor Measurement Unit (PMU, where applicable), using simulated conditions. It is accessible in the software and
graphical front panel.
IED MODE — Can be in one of three states: On, Test, or Test-Blocked. In UR 7.7 and later, as outlined in the Simulation section
that follows, the UR test mode and GOOSE simulation mode are isolated, and they no longer depend on the mode setting
here.
The On mode is for normal in service operation; the relay protection, control, and communication function is normal. Test
features are disabled, except channel tests and PMU tests remain usable when provided. In On mode, the front panel Test
Mode LED is off.
The Test-Blocked mode allows the relay to be placed quickly in a state where the relay cannot negatively impact the
power system or other parts of the substation automation system. This is to allow changing settings, loading new
firmware, changing hardware modules, and changing communication connections. As far as practical all relay output
signals are blocked. Contact outputs are de-energized, latching outputs are frozen. Commands to HardFiber Bricks are
blocked. The test bit of quality attribute of values that can be output via IEC 61850 services is set to "TRUE." The validity bit
of the quality attribute of the data sent via IEC 61850 services is set to "GOOD" if no major error is active. Direct I/O channel
tests and PMU tests are usable on applicable models. In Test-Blocked mode, the front panel Test Mode LED is on.
The Test mode is for testing involving forcing relay operation by test signal injection and verifying correct relay output. This
mode is also for tests to verify the relay outputs (both contact and communications) have the intended impact on specific
power system devices or on specific other substation automation devices. Contact outputs can be selectively enabled or
forced as described in the Force Contact Inputs and Force Contact Outputs sections that follow. Shared outputs to Bricks
have their test mode flag raised, which results in their value only being accepted by relays also in forcible Test mode. The
test bit and validity bit of the quality attribute of data sent via IEC 61850 services are set as "TRUE" and "GOOD"
respectively. In Test mode, the front panel Test Mode LED flashes.
Otherwise, the UR remains fully operational while in the Test mode, allowing for various testing procedures. In particular,
the protection and control elements, and FlexLogic function normally. Other than the IEC 61850 protocol, communications
based inputs and outputs remain fully operational. The test procedure must take this into account. Direct I/O channel tests
and PMU tests are usable on applicable models.
When set to Test mode and the operand selected by the CONTACT I/O FORCING setting is "On"
• If the FORCE Cont Ip # setting is set to Open or Closed, the respective quality attribute of the data sent via IEC 61850
services is set to q.source = "substituted"
• If the FORCE Cont Op # setting is set to Energized, De-energized, or Freeze, the respective quality attribute of the data
sent via IEC 61850 services is set to q.source = "substituted"
When the Breaker Status is substituted manually from a graphical front panel, the respective quality attribute of the
breaker position data sett via IEC 61850 services is set to q.source = "substituted."
The IED MODE setting can be selected through
• Front panel
• EnerVista UR Setup software
• FlexLogic operands
• IEC 61850 control to LLN0.Mod
• "INITIATE TEST MODE ON SIM" setting (under SIMULATION > SUBSCRIBE TO SIMULATED VALUES menu)
TEST MODE INPUT — This setting selects a FlexLogic operand that can put the UR into Test mode as per the logic diagram.
Any FlexLogic operand can be assigned to enable forcible Test mode, that is driven by any remote inputs, logic outputs,
front panel (user-programmable push buttons), and so on.
TEST-BLK MODE INPUT — This setting selects a FlexLogic operand that can put the UR into Test-Blocked mode as per the
logic diagram. Any FlexLogic operand can be assigned to enable test isolated mode, that is driven by any remote inputs,
logic outputs, front panel (user-programmable push buttons) and so on.
MODE CTRL VIA MMS — This setting selects a FlexLogic operand for an IEC 61850 client to control the IED mode. When the
operand is low/off, IED mode control from the IEC 61850 client is disabled, and the control request to LLN0.Mod.ctlVal
returns return a negative response. When high/on, IED mode control by an IEC 61850 client is accepted.
5 CONTACT I/O FORCING — When in Test mode, the operand selected by this setting dictates further response of the UR to
testing conditions, as described in the Force Contact Inputs and Force Contact Outputs sections that follow. When no
operand is specified in this setting, forcing of inputs and outputs during Test mode are not available.
The test mode state is indicated on the relay front panel by a combination of the Test Mode LED indicator, the In-Service
LED indicator, and by the critical fail relay, as shown in the table.
Table 5-48: Test mode operation
IED MODE In-Service LED Test Mode LED Critical fail relay CONTACT I/O Contact input and output
setting FORCING setting behavior
On Unaffected Off Normal No effect Normal
Test-Blocked Off On De-energized No effect Contact outputs disabled
Test Off Flashing De-energized Off Normal
On Controlled by forcing
features
Following a restart or power-up, the CONTACT I/O FORCING setting remains at the last value before restart, but force
contact input and force contact output settings revert to Normal state.
Before uploading settings to the Online Window from the Offline Window of the software, ensure that the settings
in this panel in the Offline Window have been set to required values. Otherwise, undesired relay operation can
occur.
IED BEHAVIOR — Displays the actual behavior of the IED based on different inputs to control the IED MODE. Note that the test
mode can be changed through the front panel, EnerVista software, FlexLogic operands, IEC 61850 control to LLN0.Mod,
and INITIATE TEST MODE ON SIM setting, with the following behavior.
SETTINGS A’’
D
OR SIM_Test_Q AND
C’’
A’
D’’
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
ANY MAJOR ERROR
LLN0.Mod.stVal= Test-Blocked
SETTINGS
C’ AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
IED Beh Test-Blocked RES ET
Set dominant
A
D AND
OR SIM_Test_Blk_Q
C’
A’’
D’’
IEC 618 50 protocol D LLN0.Beh.stVal= On
LLN0.Mod.ctlVal = On OR SET FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
A
AND D’’ IED Beh On
5
SETTINGS FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
IED Beh Test-Blocked
MOD E CTRL VIA MMS: OR
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND RES ET
(From front panel o r EnerVista)
IED Beh Test Re set dominant
Off=0
A’’ OR
C’’
FLEXLOGIC OPERAN D
D’’
IED IN SIM MOD E SET
AND
SETTINGS SIM_Test_Q
RES ET
INITIATE TEST MODE ON SIM:
Set dominant
(From front panel o r EnerVista)
Disabled SET
Test SIM_Test_Blk_Q
AND
Test-Blocked RES ET
Set dominant
Legend:
FLEXLOGIC OPERAN D OR Rising edge trigger.
IED IN SIM MOD E Ho lds state for one pass.
859 785A1.vsdx
The force contact inputs feature provides a method of performing checks on the function of all contact inputs.
While in Test mode, the relay contact inputs can be pre-programmed to respond in the following ways:
• If set to “Normal,” the input remains fully operational. It is controlled by the voltage across its input terminals and can
be turned on and off by external circuitry. Select this value if a given input must be operational during the test. This
includes, for example, an input initiating the test, or being a part of a user pre-programmed test sequence.
• If set to “Open,” the input is forced to report as opened (Logic 0) while the operand selected by CONTACT I/O FORCING
setting is On, regardless of the voltage across the input terminals. While the selected operand is Off, the input behaves
as it does when in service.
• If set to “Closed,” the input is forced to report as closed (Logic 1) while the operand selected by CONTACT I/O FORCING
setting is On regardless of the voltage across the input terminals. While the selected operand is Off, the input behaves
as it does when in service.
Following a restart or power-up, the CONTACT I/O FORCING setting remains at the last value before restart, but force
contact input and force contact output settings revert to Normal state.
Following a restart or power-up, the CONTACT I/O FORCING setting remains at the last value before restart, but force
contact input and force contact output settings revert to Normal state.
5.13 Simulation
SETTINGS SIMULATION
SETTINGS SUBSCRIBE TO See below
SIMULATION SIMULATED VALUES
The M60 is provided with optional IEC 61850 communications that include simulation. The option is specified
at the time of ordering. The field reads "Unavailable" when IEC 61850 is not present.
Prior to UR 7.7, when the UR TEST MODE FUNCTION is set to "Test-Blocked" or "Test," the sim bit in the header of all
transmitted GOOSE messages is set to "TRUE," so that the UR plays the simulator role during the testing and
commissioning phases. The "Sim" data attribute in the relay is set (<MasterLD>/LPHD1.Sim.stVal = TRUE), so that if GOOSE
messages are received with the "simulation" flag set, these are used in place of the normal messages. The quality attribute
values that are transmitted via GOOSE services are set to "valid" + "test."
5 In UR 7.7 and later, the UR test mode and GOOSE simulation mode are isolated. The sim bit in the transmitted GOOSE
messages and the relay "Sim" attribute (<MasterLD>/LPHD1.Sim.stVal) are controlled via new Modbus settings and MMS
control requests. They no longer depend on the UR TEST MODE FUNCTION or IED MODE.
The settings also display in the software when the M60 is set to IEC 61850 Edition 2. When using IEC 61850 Edition 1, the
settings are read-only.
SIMULATION MODE — When set to Disabled, the relay "Sim" attribute (<MasterLD>/LPHD1.Sim.StVal) is set to False and the
GOOSE/SV messages received with simulation flag/bit set are ignored.
When set to Enabled, the relay "Sim" attribute (<MasterLD>/LPHD1.Sim.StVal) is set to True, so that if GOOSE/SV messages
are received with the "simulation" flag/bit set, these are used in place of the normal messages.
SV messages has a simulation bit in the Reserved 1 field.
SIM MODE INPUT — This setting selects a FlexLogic operand. When set, the relay Simulation mode is enabled and, if the
messages (either GOOSE or SV) are received with the simulation bit true, messages from simulation devices are used in
place of actual messages. Any FlexLogic operand can be assigned to enable simulation mode, that is, driven by any
remote inputs, logic outputs, front panel (user-programmable pushbuttons), and so on.
SIM CTRL VIA MMS — This setting selects a FlexLogic operand for the IEC 61850 client to control the simulation mode.
When set to Off, simulation mode selection via IEC 61850 client is disabled and control request to LPHD.Sim.ctlVal returns
return negative response.
When set to On, simulation mode selection via IEC 61850 client is accepted.
This setting can be set from the front panel, EnerVista UR Setup software, FlexLogic operand, and IEC61850 control to
LPHD.Sim.ctlVal.
INITIATE TEST MODE ON SIM — This setting initiates the selected test mode when simulation mode is enabled.
When set to Disabled, any command (from an IEC 61850 client, front panel, or Flex Operand) to set the simulation mode
enables the Sim mode irrespective of the current IED mode.
When set to Test or Test-Blocked, any command to set the simulation mode selects respective test mode, if the relay is not
already in Test or Test-Blocked mode. If the relay is already in Test or Test-Blocked mode by any user command (from IEC
61850 client, front panel, or Flex Operand), the respective priority defined in test mode processing decides the resultant
test mode.
In summary, enabling the Test or Test-Blocked mode via the IED MODE setting (from front panel or EnerVista), via a
IEC61850 client command to LLN0.Mod.ctlVal, or via TEST MODE INPUT and TEST-BLK MODE INPUT settings (FlexLogic
operands) has no impact on the simulation mode. However, enabling the simulation mode using the SIMULATION MODE
setting (from front panel or EnerVista), via an IEC61850 client command to LPHD.Sim.ctlVal, or via SIM MODE INPUT setting
(FlexLogic operand) enables the selected test mode by the INITIATE TEST MODE ON SIM setting. A user can independently
disable the test or test-blocked mode by any specified command type, but the relay simulation mode continues and
accepts the simulated values in place of actual values until the simulation mode is disabled.
SIMULATION MODE STATUS — This is an actual value that indicates the present simulation mode of the relay.
Enabled=1
A
OR
SETTING
SIM MOD E INPUT
Off=0
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OR IED IN SIM MOD E
From IEC 61850 protocol
LPHD1.Sim.ctlVal = TRUE
LPHD1.Sim.stVal
SETTING
AND SET
5
SIM CTRL VIA MM S
(From front panel or EnerVista)
A
Enabled=1 RES ET
OR
Set dominant
TxGOOSE SIM MODE — When set to Disabled, the sim bits in all transmitted GOOSE messages are set to FALSE.
When set to Enabled, the sim bits in all transmitted GOOSE messages are set to TRUE.
This setting can be modified through the front panel, EnerVista UR Setup software, IEC 61850 client control to <MasterLD>/
LPHD1.TxGoSim.
SIM Q.VALIDITY — This setting simulates the validity bits of the quality attribute values included in all transmitted GOOSE
messages. When set to NONE, the q.Validity bits are set based on the logical node behavior value. When set to any other
value, the q.Validity bits of quality attributes included in all transmitted GOOSE messages are set to the selected value.
This setting is used when TxGOOSE SIM MODE is set to Enabled. It can be modified through the front panel and EnerVista UR
Setup software.
SIM Q.TEST — This setting simulates the Test bit of the quality attribute values included in all transmitted GOOSE messages.
When set to NONE, the q.Test bit is set based on the relay TEST MODE FUNCTION / IED MODE. When set to any other value,
the q.Test bit of quality attributes included in all transmitted GOOSE messages is set to the selected value.
This setting is used when TxGOOSE SIM MODE is set to Enabled. It can be modified through the front panel and EnerVista UR
Setup software.
Actual values
This chapter outlines viewing of data on the front panel, software, and/or web browser.
AMP UNBALANCE
SOURCE SRC 2
SOURCE SRC 3
SOURCE SRC 4
DATA LOGGER
See page 6-34 6
MAINTENANCE See page 6-34
For status reporting, ‘On’ represents Logic 1 and ‘Off’ represents Logic 0.
6 Annunciator alarms can be acknowledged and reset, and LEDs and pushbuttons can be viewed.
To view alarms for the graphical front panel in EnerVista:
1. Access Actual Values > Graphical Panel > Annunciator Panel. Alarms are listed, allowing remote acknowledgement/
reset.
2. Click the Acknowledge or Reset button for an alarm.
Figure 6-2: Annunciator alarms displayed in the software)
6.3 Status
6.3.1 IED
ACTUAL VALUES STATUS IED
IED IED BEHAVIOUR: Range: On, Test, Test-Blocked
On
IED BEHAVIOUR — Displays the SETTINGS TESTING IED MODE CONFIG IED MODE value.
SIMULATION MODE STATUS — Displays the SETTINGS SIMULATION SUBSCRIBE TO SIMULATED VALUES SIMULATION MODE
value, meaning if simulation mode is enabled or disabled on a device.
6.3.2 Motor
ACTUAL VALUES STATUS MOTOR
MOTOR MOTOR STATUS:
Offline
MOTOR THERMAL
CAPACITY USED: 0%
THERMAL LOCKOUT
TIME: 0 min
START/HOUR LOCKOUT
TIME: 0 min
TIME-BTWN-STARTS LO
6
TIME: 0 min
RESTART DELAY LO
TIME: 0 s
The present status of the contact inputs is shown here. The first line of a message display indicates the ID of the contact
input. For example, ‘Cont Ip 1’ refers to the contact input in terms of the default name-array index. The second line of the
display indicates the logic state of the contact input.
The present status of the 128 virtual inputs is shown here. The first line of a message display indicates the ID of the virtual
input. For example, ‘Virt Ip 1’ refers to the virtual input in terms of the default name. The second line of the display indicates
the logic state of the virtual input.
This menu displays when the product includes an IEC 61850 software option.
This menu displays when the product includes an IEC 61850 software option.
The present state of teleprotection inputs from communication channels 1 and 2 are shown here. The state displayed is
that of corresponding remote output unless the channel is declared failed.
The present state of each virtual output displays here. The first line of a message display indicates the ID of the virtual
output. For example, ‘Virt Op 1’ refers to the virtual output in terms of the default name-array index. The second line of the
display indicates the logic state of the virtual output, as calculated by the FlexLogic equation for that output.
This menu displays when the product includes an IEC 61850 software option.
The All RxGOOSE Online actual value does not consider RxGOOSE that are not configured or are not used by any RxGOOSE
Input.
This menu displays when the product includes an IEC 61850 software option.
6
stNum — State number. The most recently received value in GOOSE message field stNum. The publisher increments stNum
each time that the state of one or more of the GOOSE message members is sent with a revised value.
sqNum — Sequence number. The most recently received value in GOOSE message field sqNum. The publisher sets sqNum
to zero each time the state of one or more of the GOOSE message members is sent with a new value, and it increments it
whenever a GOOSE message is resent without any member value change.
Counter 1 FROZEN:
0
The present status of the eight digital counters displays here. The status of each counter, with the user-defined counter
name, includes the accumulated and frozen counts (the count units label also appears). Also included, is the date and time
stamp for the frozen count. The COUNTER 1 MICROS value refers to the microsecond portion of the time stamp.
The display shows both the current position and the full range. The current position only (an integer from 0 through 7) is the
actual value.
6.3.14 FlexStates
ACTUAL VALUES STATUS FLEX STATES
FLEX STATES PARAM 1: Off Range: On, Off
Off
PARAM 256: Off Range: On, Off
Off
There are 256 FlexStateTM bits available. The second line value indicates the state of the given FlexState bit.
6.3.15 Ethernet
ACTUAL VALUES STATUS ETHERNET
ETHERNET ETHERNET PRI LINK Range: Fail, OK
STATUS: Fail
These values indicate the status of the first, second, and third Ethernet ports.
This menu displays when the product includes an IEEE 1588 software option.
RTC SYNC SOURCE — The time synchronizing source the relay is using at present. Possible sources include Port 1 PTP Clock
to Port 3 PTP Clock. A value of Other means a less precise source (IEC 103, IEC 104, Modbus, DNP). An actual value displays
when the relay includes the IEEE 1588 software option.
GRANDMASTER ID — The grandmasterIdentity code being received from the present PTP grandmaster, if any. When the
relay is not using any PTP grandmaster, this actual value is zero. The grandmasterIdentity code is specified by PTP to be
globally unique, so one can always know which clock is grandmaster in a system with multiple grandmaster-capable
clocks.
ACCURACY — The estimated maximum time error at present in the RTC, considering the quality information imbedded in the
received time signal. The value 999,999,999 indicates that the magnitude of the estimated error is one second or more, or
that the error cannot be estimated.
PORT 1…3 PTP STATE — The present state of the port’s PTP clock. The PTP clock state is:
• Disabled if the port’s function setting is Disabled
• No Signal if enabled but no signal from an active master has been found and selected
• Calibrating if an active master has been selected but lock is not at present established
• Synch’d (No Pdelay) if the port is synchronized, but the peer delay mechanism is non-operational
• Synchronized if synchronized
PTP - IRIG-B DELTA — The time difference, measured in nanoseconds, between the fractional seconds portion of the time
being received via PTP and that being received via IRIG-B. A positive value indicates that PTP time is fast compared to IRIG-
B time.
6 DIRECT INPUTS
AVERAGE MSG RETURN
TIME CH1: 0 ms
UNRETURNED MSG
COUNT CH1: 0
UNRETURNED MSG
COUNT CH2: 0
DIRECT INPUT 1
On
DIRECT INPUT 32
On
The AVERAGE MSG RETURN TIME is the time taken for direct output messages to return to the sender in a direct input/output
ring configuration (this value is not applicable for non-ring configurations). This is a rolling average calculated for the last
ten messages. There are two return times for dual-channel communications modules.
The UNRETURNED MSG COUNT values (one per communications channel) count the direct output messages that do not
make the trip around the communications ring. The CRC FAIL COUNT values (one per communications channel) count the
direct output messages that have been received but fail the CRC check. High values for either of these counts can indicate
on a problem with wiring, the communication channel, or one or more relays. The UNRETURNED MSG COUNT and CRC FAIL
COUNT values can be cleared using the CLEAR DIRECT I/O COUNTERS command.
The DIRECT INPUT 1 to DIRECT INPUT values represent the state of each direct input.
These actual values represent the state of direct devices 1 through 16.
FAST EXCHANGE 1
DATA LENGTH: 0
These values provide information for debugging an Ethernet Global Data (EGD) network. The EGD signature and packet size
for the fast EGD exchange display. 6
6.3.19.2 Slow exchange
ACTUAL VALUES STATUS EGD PROTOCOL STATUS PRODUCER STATUS SLOW EXCHANGE 1(2)
SLOW EXCHANGE 1 SLOW EXCHANGE 1
SIGNATURE: 0
SLOW EXCHANGE 1
DATA LENGTH: 0
These values provide information for debugging an EGD network. The EGD signature and packet size for the slow EGD
exchanges display.
6 SFTP (max 4)
4
Range: 0 to 4
These values specify the remaining number of TCP connections still available for each protocol. The display depends on
the options applicable to your device. Each time a connection is used, the remaining number of connections decrements.
When released, the remaining number of connections increments. If no connection is made over the specific protocol, the
number equals the maximum number available for the specific protocol.
For example, the maximum number of Modbus TCP connections is 4. Once an EnerVista session is opened on a computer
connected to the UR over Ethernet, the Modbus TCP status shows 3. If the EnerVista application is closed, the Modbus TCP
status shows 4.
For the graphical front panel, the remaining connections refer to TCP connections only.
MMS TCP — The number of IEC 61850 connections remaining.
This menu displays when the product includes a PRP software option.
Total Received Port A is a counter for total messages received (either from DANPs or from SANs) on Port A.
Total Received Port B is a counter for total messages received (either from DANPs or from SANs) on Port B.
Total Errors is a counter for total messages received with an error (bad port code, frame length too short).
Mismatches Port A is a counter for total messages received with an error on Port A (PRP frame, but port received through
and LAN ID in the frame do not match).
Mismatches Port B is a counter for total messages received with an error on Port B (PRP frame, but port received through
and LAN ID in the frame do not match).
This status is relevant to R-GOOSE reception when configured for SSM or ASM reception modes. It is not relevant for GOOSE
or for R-GOOSE in unicast reception mode.
ARP — The unicast mode of R-GOOSE transmission requires Address Resolution Protocol (ARP) for the resolution of the
network layer address into the MAC layer address. R-TxGOOSE## ARP status On indicates that ARP responses are being
received and the destination MAC address for R-GOOSE transmissions has been obtained. This status remains Off if
TxGOOSE## is not configured for R-GOOSE. It also remains Off if setting R-TxGOOSE1 DST IP is set to a multicast address. In
the case where setting R-TxGOOSE1 DST IP is configured with a unicast address and this status indicates Off, TxGOOSE##
transmission will be off, and therefore communication network diagnosis needs to be carried out.
This status is only applicable for R-GOOSE transmission with setting R-TxGOOSE1 DST IP set to a unicast IP address. It is not
applicable for GOOSE or for R-GOOSE when setting R-TxGOOSE1 DST IP is multicast.
6.3.24 Protocol
ACTUAL VALUES STATUS PROTOCOL
PROTOCOL IEC61850 EDITION: Range: Edition1, Edition2
Edition2
This menu displays when the product includes an IEC 61850 software option.
Displays the IEC 61850 edition currently being used, as set under Settings > Product Setup > Communications > Protocol
> IEC61850 SCL Edition. This value displays only on the front panel.
6.4 Metering
6.4.1 Metering conventions
Figure 6-3: Flow direction of signed values for watts and VARs
PER IEEE CONVENTIONS
Generator
Parameters as seen by
G the UR-series relays
Voltage +Q
VCG
Watts = Positive IC
PF = Lead PF = Lag
Vars = Positive
PF = Lag IA
VAG –P +P
Current IB IA
PF = Lag PF = Lead
UR-SERIES IED
VBG
–Q
M LOAD –Θ1°
Inductive Resistive S=VI
Generator
G
VCG +Q
Voltage
PF = Lead PF = Lag
Watts = Positive IA
Vars = Negative IC
PF = Lead VAG –P +P
IA
Current
PF = Lag PF = Lead
IB
UR-SERIES IED
VBG –Q
S=VI
LOAD
–Θ2°
Resistive
Inductive Resistive
M LOAD
VCG +Q
Current
VBG
IC PF = Lag
–Q
PF = Lead
6
UR-SERIES IED
G S=VI
–Θ3°
Generator
Resistive
LOAD
+Q
VCG
Voltage IB
PF = Lead PF = Lag
Watts = Negative IA
Vars = Positive VAG –P +P
PF = Lead
IA IC
The relay first determines if any “Phase VT” bank is indicated in the source. If it is, voltage channel VA of that bank is used
as the angle reference. Otherwise, the relay determines if any “Aux VT” bank is indicated; if it is, the auxiliary voltage
channel of that bank is used as the angle reference. If neither of the two conditions is satisfied, then two more steps of this
hierarchical procedure to determine the reference signal include “Phase CT” bank and “Ground CT” bank.
If the AC signal pre-selected by the relay upon configuration is not measurable, the phase angles are not referenced. The
phase angles are assigned as positive in the leading direction, and are presented as negative in the lagging direction, to
more closely align with power system metering conventions. The figure illustrates this.
Figure 6-4: UR phase angle measurement convention
-270o
-225o -315o
positive
angle
direction
-180o 0o
UR phase angle
reference
-135o -45o
-90o
827845A1.CDR
6 The URs calculate voltage symmetrical components for the power system phase A line-to-neutral voltage, and
symmetrical components of the currents for the power system phase A current. Owing to the above definition, phase
angle relations between the symmetrical currents and voltages stay the same irrespective of the connection of instrument
transformers. This is important for setting directional protection elements that use symmetrical voltages.
For display and oscillography purposes the phase angles of symmetrical components are referenced to a common
reference as described in the previous sub-section.
1 1
V_0 = -- V AG + V BG + V CG V_0 = -- V AG + V BG + V CG
3 3
1 2 1 2
V_1 = -- V AG + aV BG + a V CG V_1 = -- V AG + a V BG + aV CG
3 3
1 2 1 2
V_2 = -- V AG + a V BG + aV CG V_2 = -- V AG + aV BG + a V CG
3 3
The zero-sequence voltage is not measurable under the Delta connection of instrument transformers and is defaulted to
zero. The table below shows an example of symmetrical components calculations for the ABC phase rotation.
Table 6-1: Symmetrical components calculation example
SYSTEM VOLTAGES, sec. V * VT conn. relay INPUTS, sec. V SYMM. COMP, sec. V
VAG VBG VCG VAB VBC VCA F5ac F6ac F7ac V0 V1 V2
13.9 76.2 79.7 84.9 138.3 85.4 WYE 13.9 76.2 79.7 19.5 56.5 23.3
0° –125° –250° –313° –97° –241° 0° –125° –250° –192° –7° –187°
UNKNOWN (only V1 and V2 84.9 138.3 85.4 DELTA 84.9 138.3 85.4 N/A 56.5 23.3
can be determined) 0° –144° –288° 0° –144° –288° –54° –234°
* The power system voltages are phase-referenced – for simplicity – to VAG and VAB, respectively. This, however, is a
relative matter. It is important to remember that the M60 displays are always referenced as specified under SETTINGS
SYSTEM SETUP POWER SYSTEM FREQUENCY AND PHASE REFERENCE.
The example above is illustrated in the following figure.
Figure 6-5: Measurement convention for symmetrical components
System voltages Symmetrical
components
UR-series phase
angle reference
6
UR-series phase
angle reference
1
A
Wye VTs
C
B
0
2
UR
an -s
gl eri
e es
re p
fe ha
re s
nc e
e
U 1
A an R-s
gl eri
e es
re p
fe ha
re s
Delta VTs nc e
e
C
B
2
827844A1.CDR
6.4.2 Motor
ACTUAL VALUES METERING MOTOR
MOTOR MOTOR LOAD:
0.00 x FLA
CURRENT UNBALANCE:
0%
The phasors of differential and restraint currents are displayed in primary amperes.
6.4.4 Sources
6.4.4.1 Menu
ACTUAL VALUES METERING SOURCE SRC 1
SOURCE SRC 1 PHASE CURRENT See below
SRC 1
This menu displays the metered values available for each source.
Metered values presented for each source depend on the phase and auxiliary VTs and phase and ground CTs assignments
for this particular source. For example, if no phase VT is assigned to this source, then any voltage, energy, and power
values are unavailable.
The metered phase current values are displayed in this menu. The "SRC 1" text gets replaced by whatever name was
programmed by the user for the associated source (see SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP SIGNAL SOURCES).
The metered ground current values are displayed in this menu. The "SRC 1" text is replaced by the name programmed by
the user for the associated source (see SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP SIGNAL SOURCES).
The metered phase voltage values are displayed in this menu. The "SRC 1" text is replaced by the name programmed by
the user for the associated source (see SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP SIGNAL SOURCES).
The metered auxiliary voltage values are displayed in this menu. The "SRC 1" text is replaced by the name programmed by
the user for the associated source (see SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP SIGNAL SOURCES).
This menu displays metered values for real, reactive, and apparent power, as well as power factor. The "SRC 1" text is
replaced by the name programmed by the user for the associated source (see SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP SIGNAL
SOURCES).
When VTs are configured in wye, the M60 calculates power in each phase and three-phase power is measured as
S = VA x ÎA + VB x ÎB + VC x ÎC Eq. 6-1
When VTs are configured in delta, the M60 does not calculate power in each phase and three-phase power is measured as
S = VAB x ÎA + VCB x ÎC Eq. 6-2
where
S is the apparent power
VA, VB, VC, IA, IB, IC are phase voltage and phase current phasors
This menu displays metered values for real and reactive energy. The "SRC 1" text is replaced by the name programmed by
the user for the associated source (see SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP SIGNAL SOURCES). Because energy values are
accumulated, record them and then reset them immediately prior to changing CT or VT characteristics.
The metered frequency values are displayed in this menu. The "SRC 1" text is replaced by the name programmed by the
user for the associated source (see SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP SIGNAL SOURCES).
SOURCE FREQUENCY is measured via software-implemented zero-crossing detection of an AC signal. The signal is either a
Clarke transformation of three-phase voltages or currents, auxiliary voltage, or ground current as per source configuration
(see the SYSTEM SETUP POWER SYSTEM settings). The signal used for frequency estimation is low-pass filtered. The final
6 frequency measurement is passed through a validation filter that eliminates false readings due to signal distortions and
transients.
COMPONENT FREQ.:
61.85 Hz
MAXIMUM COMPONENT
LEVEL: -58.3 dB
MAXIMUM COMPONENT
FREQ.: 62.05 Hz
The following metered values are available for the broken rotor bar detection feature.
COMPONENT LEVEL — This value indicates the level of the broken rotor bar spectral component relative to the spectral
component of the system frequency.
COMPONENT FREQ — Indicates the frequency of the broken rotor bar spectral component.
MOTOR LOAD AT BRB CALC. — Indicates the average motor load at the time of the broken rotor bar data acquisition stage.
LOAD DEV.AT BRB CALC. — Indicates the motor load standard deviation at the time of the broken rotor bar data acquisition
stage.
TIME OF BRB CALC. — Indicates the time stamp of the broken rotor bar calculation.
MAXIMUM COMPONENT LEVEL — Indicates the learned maximum level of the broken rotor bar spectral component since the
last data clear.
MAXIMUM COMPONENT FREQ. — Indicates the frequency of the learned maximum broken rotor bar spectral component.
MOTOR LOAD AT BRB MAX — Indicates the average motor load at the time when data for the maximum broken rotor bar was
acquired.
LOAD DEV. AT BRB MAX — Indicates the motor load standard deviation at the time when data for the maximum broken rotor
bar was acquired.
TIME OF MAXIMUM BRB — Indicates the time stamp of the maximum broken rotor bar component level.
The tracking frequency displays here. The frequency is tracked based on the selection of the reference source with the
FREQUENCY AND PHASE REFERENCE setting in the SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP POWER SYSTEM menu. See the Power
System section of chapter 5 for details.
6.4.7 FlexElements
ACTUAL VALUES METERING FLEXELEMENTS FLEXELEMENT 1(16)
FLEXELEMENT 1 FLEXELEMENT 1
OpSig: 0.000
The operating signals for the FlexElements are displayed in pu values using the following definitions of the base units.
Table 6-2: FlexElement base units
Base unit Description
BREAKER ACC ARCING AMPS BASE = 2000 kA2 cycle
(Brk X Acc Arc Amp A, B, and C)
BREAKER ARCING AMPS BASE = 1 kA2 cycle
(Brk X Arc Amp A, B, and C)
CURRENT UNBALANCE BASE = 100%
(Amp Unbalance)
The effective operating quantities of the sensitive directional power elements display here. The display is useful to
calibrate the feature by compensating the angular errors of the CTs and VTs with the use of the RCA and CALIBRATION
settings.
This menu displays when the product includes an IEC 61850 software option.
The RxGOOSE Analog values display in this menu. The RxGOOSE Analog values are received via IEC 61850 GOOSE
messages sent from other devices.
Actual values for each DCmA input channel that is enabled are displayed with the top line as the programmed channel ID
and the bottom line as the value followed by the programmed units.
ACTUAL VALUES METERING TRANSDUCER I/O RTD INPUTS RTD INPUT xx
RTD INPUT xx RTD INPUT xx
-50 °C
Actual values for each RTD input channel that is enabled are displayed with the top line as the programmed channel ID
and the bottom line as the value.
Actual values for each RRTD input channel that is enabled are displayed this menu. The top line the programmed RRTD ID 6
and the bottom line displays the metered value.
LOCAL TRANSCEIVER:
TX POWER: 0.0 dBm
BRICK TRANSCEIVER
RX POWER: 0.0 dBm
BRICK TRANSCEIVER
TX POWER: 0.0 dBm
LOCAL TRANSCEIVER
RX POWER: 0.0 dBm
This menu displays when using a Process Bus Module for a HardFiber Brick.
These menus display when the product includes a Process Bus Module with order code 85, 86, or 87. The
actual values display on the front panel and software. Additional values display in a web browser; enter the IP
address of the relay and access the Process Card Menu.
Ports applicable to the Process Bus Module display. The example shows all eight ports.
The information also displays in a web browser under Process Card Menu > Process Card Port Information.
SV 1 Delay: Range: us
0 us
Additional actual values for sampled values display in a web browser. Enter the IP address of the relay and access Process
Card Menu > Process Card Diagnostics, for which the following fields are explained.
All SV diagnostics are volatile and are cleared when power is cycled.
Sample Value processing delay...Min Delay — The minimum time delay in received sample values. The accuracy
threshold of this diagnostics is within 1/8 of a power system cycle.
Sample Value processing delay...Max Delay — The maximum time delay in received sample values. The accuracy
threshold of this diagnostics is within 1/8 of a power system cycle.
Sample Value processing delay...Avg Delay — The average time delay for received sample values. A delay up to about 1.5
milliseconds (1500 µsec) is normal. The accuracy threshold of this diagnostics is within 1/8 of a power system cycle.
SV Delay Alarm Counter — The number of times that sampled values from a configured SV stream are delayed for more
than the Settings > Process Bus Module > General > SV Delay Alarm setting. Counters wrap around when they reach
4294967295.
Sample Estimation Counter — The number of times that the relay used an internal estimation algorithm to substitute a
missing sample value. Counters wrap around when they reach 4294967295.
Stream Status — The status of a configured SV stream. If the Settings > Process Bus Module > SV Stream Config > SV
Stream setting is set to Disabled, this value is shown as Disabled. If the setting is set to IEC 61850-9-2LE or IEC 61869-9 and
received sample values are accepted by the relay, this value is shown as Online. If received sample values are rejected, or
sample values are lost (frames not received), stream status changes to Offline.
Latest Unacceptable Quality — Time stamp of the latest sample value with unacceptable quality, in any data item in a
dataset. This time stamp has 1/8 of a power system cycle accuracy threshold.
Latest Sim Bit Change — The time stamp of latest change in simulation bit status of the received RxSV# messages. This
time stamp has 1/8 of a power system cycle accuracy threshold.
SmpSync Latest Update Time — The time stamp of the latest sample value for which the SmpSync attribute was different 6
from the previous samples. This value determines when the time source that sample value stream is synchronized to has
changed. This time stamp has 1/8 of a power system cycle accuracy threshold.
SmpSync Changes in Past 24hrs — The number of times the SmpSync attribute in the sample value messages from this
stream has changed in the past 24 hours. This counter is updated every hour. Counters wrap around when they reach
4294967295. The accuracy of this metric is 1.5 hours over a 24-hour period.
Sample Estimate Fail-Last 10s — The number of times that three or more out of five consecutive samples has been lost in
the last 10 seconds. This counter is updated every second. Counters wrap around when they reach 4294967295.
Sample Value Trouble Counter — The number of times that the SV Stream Trouble minor self-test error is detected by the
Process Bus Module. Counters wrap around when they reach 4294967295.
Additional actual values for time are available under Actual Values > Status > Real Time Clock Synchronizing.
Sync Source — This is the time synchronizing source that the UR Process Bus Module is using at present. It displays CPU
Clock when the 1 pulse per second (PPS) signal from the main CPU drives the Process Bus Module clock. It displays None
when the Process Bus Module clock free runs. It displays SV Sync Stream when the Process Bus Module clock is
synchronized to the configured reference stream. It displays PBM Clock when the Process Bus Module clock is
synchronized to a PTP grandmaster clock. The time synchronizing source itself is set using SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP
REAL TIME CLOCK and SETTINGS PROCESS BUS MODULE PBM PTP PTP FUNCTION. If the latter is not set, then the Sync
Source displays None even when the REAL TIME CLOCK setting is configured.
Grandmaster ID — This is the grandmaster clock (grandmasterIdentity) of the present PTP network if any. When the UR
Process Bus Module is not using any PTP grandmaster, this actual value is set to the ID of that relay and the relay is acting
as grandmaster in the network. The ID code is specified by PTP to be globally unique, so one can always know which clock
is grandmaster in a system with multiple grandmaster-capable clocks.
Accuracy — This is the estimated time error based on the clockAccuracy information embedded in the received time signal.
This actual value indicates the grandmaster clock accuracy. The clockAccuracy enumeration information received from
the grandmaster is translated into nanoseconds as specified in the following table. The value 999,999,999 indicates that
the magnitude of the estimated error is one second or more, or that the error cannot be estimated. The value 999,999,999
is used if the clockAccuracy received from grandmaster is in the ranges: 00 - 1F and 2F - FF. If the relay is the grandmaster,
the actual value indicates the estimated accuracy of the local clock and the same information is embedded in the
transmitted PTP messages. See defaultDS.clockQuality.clockAccuracy for more information.
Table 6-3: Clock accuracy
Value (hex) Specification
00-1F Reserved
20 The time is accurate to within 25 ns
21 The time is accurate to within 100 ns
22 The time is accurate to within 250 ns
23 The time is accurate to within 1 µs
24 The time is accurate to within 2.5 µs
25 The time is accurate to within 10 µs
26 The time is accurate to within 25 µs
6 27 The time is accurate to within 100 µs
28 The time is accurate to within 250 µs
29 The time is accurate to within 1 ms
2A The time is accurate to within 2.5 ms
2B The time is accurate to within 10 ms
2C The time is accurate to within 25 ms
2D The time is accurate to within 100 ms
2E The time is accurate to within 250 ms
2F The time is accurate to within 1 s
30 The time is accurate to within 10 s
31 The time is accurate to greater than 10 s
32-7F Reserved
80-FD For use by alternate PTP profiles
FE Unknown
FF Reserved
6.6.4 PRP
Actual values for the Parallel Redundancy Protocol (PRP) display in a web browser. Enter the IP address of the relay and
access the Process Card Menu > Process Card PRP Statistics, which displays only when PRP is used.
PRP Status — PRP is Enabled if Settings > Process Bus Module > General > Network Config is set to PRP, else it is Disabled.
Total Rx Port A — Counter indicating the number of frames received on port A, for example port 1a.
Total Rx Port B — Counter indicating the number of frames received on port B, for example port 1b.
Total Tx Port A — Counter indicating the number of frames sent on port A, for example port 1a.
Total Tx Port B — Counter indicating the number of frames sent on port B, for example port 1b.
Mismatches Port A — Counter indicating the number of erroneous frames received on port A, for example port 1a.
Mismatches Port B — Counter indicating the number of erroneous frames received on port B, for example port 1b.
Duplicates Removed Port A — Number of PRP duplicate frames received from port A and discarded, for example port 1a.
Duplicates Removed Port B — Number of PRP duplicate frames received from port B and discarded, for example port 1b.
6.6.5 HSR
Actual values for High-Availability Seamless Redundancy (HSR) display in a web browser. Enter the IP address of the relay
and access the Process Card Menu > Process Card HSR Statistics, which displays only when HSR is used.
HSR1 Status — Status of the first ring, either enabled or disabled. Enabled when redundancy is set to HSR or Dual-HSR.
HSR2 Status — Status of the second ring, either enabled or disabled. Enabled when redundancy is set to HSR or Dual-HSR.
Total Rx Port A — Counter indicating the number of frames received on port A, for example port 1a.
Total Rx Port B — Counter indicating the number of frames received on port B for example port 1b.
Total Tx Port A — Counter indicating the number of frames sent on port A, for example port 1a.
Total Tx Port B — Counter indicating the number of frames sent on port B, for example port 1b.
Duplicates Removed Port A — Number of HSR duplicate frames received from port A and discarded, for example port 1a.
Duplicates Removed Port B — Number of HSR duplicate frames received from port B and discarded, for example port 1b.
6.7 Records
6.7.1 User programmable fault reports
6
ACTUAL VALUES RECORDS USER PROGRAMMABLE FAULT REPORTS
USER PROGRAMMABLE NEWEST RECORD
FAULT REPORTS NUMBER: 0
This menu displays the user-programmable fault report actual values. See the User Programmable Fault Report section in
chapter 5 for information on this feature.
START 1 ACCELERATION
TIME: 4.57 s
START 1 EFFECTIVE
CURRENT: 5.85 x FLA
START 1 PEAK
CURRENT: 6.70 x FLA
Up to five motor starts are displayed. When the buffer is full, the newest record overwrites the oldest record.
LAST AVRG MOTOR LOAD Range: value in multiples of full load current
LEARNED: 0.00 x FLA
The learned values for acceleration time and effective starting current are the maximum of the individual values acquired
for the last N successful starts, where N is defined by the NUMBER OF STARTS TO LEARN setting.
The learned value for the starting thermal capacity is calculated using the maximum of the last motor start measurements
and incorporates a security margin defined by the SETTINGS GROUPED ELEMENTS SETTING GROUP 1(6) MOTOR
THERMAL MODEL START INHIBIT TCU MARGIN setting. For example, if the thermal capacity used for the last five starts is
24, 23, 27, 26, and 21%, respectively, with the START INHIBIT TCU MARGIN = 25%, then the LEARNED STARTING CAPACITY is
27% × 1.25 = 33.75%.
Learned values associated with motor acceleration require the acceleration time function to be enabled. The
learned features are not be used until at least N + 1 successful motor starts have occurred.
The starting capacity, starting current, and acceleration time values for the last start are displayed in the ACTUAL VALUES
STATUS MOTOR menu. Clearing the motor data (see the Clear Records section in chapter 7) resets these values to their
default.
Figure 6-6: Motor learned data functionality
Idle
Motor starting
(status)
Capture starting
thermal capacity
11 12 1
10 2
9
8 4
3
Acceleration time
7 6 5
No
I > 0 and
I < overload PKP
Yes Successful start
Motor running
(status)
−N
Capture thermal TC learned = max TC nlearned ,..., TC nlearned Store learned thermal capacity used
capacity used × Start TCU margin
11 12 1
10
9
8
2
4
3
1 minute Store last thermal capacity used
7 6 5
n n− N
Every 1 minute - sum I ,..., I
Iload = load load Store average load current every
capture load current tavg tavg interval and update display
Motor stopped
(status)
833724A1.CDR
EVENT: 3 EVENT 3
POWER ON DATE: 2020/07/14
EVENT: 2 EVENT 3
POWER OFF TIME: 14:53:00.03405
EVENT: 1
EVENTS CLEARED
The event records menu shows the contextual data associated with up to the last 1024 events, listed in chronological order
from most recent to oldest. When all 1024 event records have been filled, the oldest record is removed as a new record is
added. Each event record shows the event identifier/sequence number, cause, and date/time stamp associated with the
event trigger. See the COMMANDS CLEAR RECORDS menu for clearing event records.
Only major output operands generate events, not every operand. Elements that assert output per phase, for example, log
operating phase output only without asserting the common three-phase operand event.
See also the system log (syslog) information in the previous chapter.
The event records are viewable in the software and in a web browser. The figure shows the event records in the software.
Figure 6-7: Event records viewed in EnerVista software
6.7.5 Oscillography
6
6.7.5.1 Enhanced and standard front panels
ACTUAL VALUES RECORDS OSCILLOGRAPHY
OSCILLOGRAPHY FORCE TRIGGER? Range: No, Yes
No
NUMBER OF TRIGGERS:
0
AVAILABLE RECORDS:
0
This menu allows the user to view the number of triggers involved and number of oscillography traces available. The
cycles per record value is calculated to account for the fixed amount of data storage for oscillography. See the
Oscillography section of chapter 5 for details.
A trigger can be forced here at any time by setting “Yes” to the FORCE TRIGGER? command. See the COMMANDS CLEAR
RECORDS menu for information on clearing the oscillography records.
To view a waveform:
2. Access Actual Values > Records > Oscillography in the EnerVista software.
3. In the window that opens, select the record number. The highest number is the most recent record (Newest Record
Number).
4. Click the Read button to get the waveform. When available, waveforms are displayed graphically, and otherwise error
messages display.
5. In the waveform window that opens, you can save the file, for example with the CFG extension.
The OLDEST SAMPLE TIME represents the time at which the oldest available samples were taken. It is static until the log gets
full, at which time it starts counting at the defined sampling rate.
The NEWEST SAMPLE TIME represents the time the most recent samples were taken. It counts up at the defined sampling
rate. If the data logger channels are defined, then both values are static.
See the COMMANDS CLEAR RECORDS menu for clearing data logger records.
BKR 1 OPERATING
TIME: 0 ms
OPERATING TIME:
0:00:00
Range: HH:MM:SS
6
PMU FEATURE ACTIVE: Range: Yes, No
No
The order code, serial number, Ethernet MAC address, date and time of manufacture, and operating time are shown here.
The rear panel on the device contains similar information. The information is read-only in the software and modifiable on
the front panel. For example, the order code can be corrected using the front panel.
ETHERNET MAC ADDRESS — UR devices with firmware 7.0x and above have three Ethernet ports that can be used on three
networks. The MAC address displays for port 1. The MAC address for port 2 is one higher. The MAC address for port 3 is one
higher than port 2. In redundant mode, the MAC addresses for ports 2 and 3 are the same as port 2.
PBM MAC ADDRESS — The MAC address for the Process Bus Module.
6 PB CVFPGA FPGA
REVISION: 0.00
Range: 0.00 to 655.35
The shown data is illustrative only. A modification file number of 0 indicates that, currently, no modifications have been
installed. PB and process bus refer to the Process Bus Module.
This chapter outlines the Commands and Targets menus and self-tests/error messages. Commands related to the IEC
61850 protocol are outlined in the IEC 61850 section of the Settings chapter. Log/error messages for IEC 61850 are
outlined in the UR Family Communications Guide.
COMMANDS
COMMANDS
VIRTUAL INPUTS
COMMANDS
CLEAR RECORDS
COMMANDS
SET DATE AND TIME
COMMANDS
RELAY MAINTENANCE
COMMANDS
SECURITY
The commands menu contains relay directives intended for operations personnel. All commands can be protected from
unauthorized access via the command password; see the Security section of chapter 5 for details. The following flash
message appears after successfully command entry.
COMMAND
EXECUTED
The states of up to 128 virtual inputs are changed here. The first line of the display indicates the ID of the virtual input. The
second line indicates the current or selected status of the virtual input. This status is a state off (logic 0) or on (logic 1).
This menu contains commands for clearing historical data such as the event records. Data is cleared by changing a
command setting to “Yes” and pressing the ENTER key. After clearing data, the command setting automatically reverts to
“No.”
CLEAR PBM DIAGNOSTICS — Clears the sampled value diagnostics information for a non-HardFiber Process Bus Module. All
other Process Bus Module diagnostics information is reset up relay power cycling, such as HSR and PTP.
COMMANDS CLEAR RECORDS CLEAR IEC61850 XWSI OPCNT
CLEAR IEC61850 CLEAR XSWI 1 Range: No, Yes
XWSI OPCNT OpCnt? No
CLEAR XSWI 24 Range: No, Yes
OpCnt? No
The Clear XSWI commands clear the disconnect operation counters for each phase and the three-phase counter. Similarly,
the Clear XCBR commands clear the circuit breaker operation counters for each phase and the three-phase counter.
The date and time can be entered on the front panel keypad. The time setting is based on the 24-hour clock. The complete
date, as a minimum, must be entered to allow execution of this command. The new time and date take effect when the
ENTER key is pressed.
The clock also can be synchronized to the local computer time among several UR devices. Use the Synchronize Devices
entry in the Online Window area of the EnerVista software. (Click the button at the top of the window that opens.)
When the relay is synchronizing to an external time source such as PTP, IRIG-B, or SNTP, the manually entered time or the
manually synchronized time is over-written.
The timescale of the entered time is local time, including daylight savings time where and when applicable.
7
7.1.4 Relay maintenance
COMMANDS RELAY MAINTENANCE
COMMANDS PERFORM LAMP TEST? Range: No, Yes
RELAY MAINTENANCE No
PERFORM LCD TEST? Range: Off, Red, Green, Blue, White & Text Pattern,
Off Black & Text Pattern, TV Test Pattern
This menu contains commands for relay maintenance purposes. Commands for the lamp test and order code are
activated by changing a command setting to “Yes” and pressing the ENTER key. The command setting then automatically
reverts to “No.” The service command is activated by entering a numerical code and pressing the ENTER key.
Not all commands display in the software; use the front panel when required.
PERFORM LAMP TEST — Turns on all front panel LEDs and display pixels for a short duration.
PERFORM LCD TEST — This command detects either stuck-ON or stuck-OFF pixels (dead pixels) in the display screen on the
graphical front panel. RED/GREEN/BLUE is to display the solid background color in the whole screen. WHITE & TEXT
PATTERN shows the white background and black texts. BLACK & TEXT PATTERN shows the black background and white
texts. TV TEST PATTERN displays a standard television test pattern (SMPTE color bars). The test screen can be canceled by
pressing any pushbutton or after 30 seconds of inactivity.
PERFORM PUSHBUTTON TEST — This command tests the pushbuttons on the graphical front panel. During testing, press the
corresponding pushbutton according to the prompt text. A failure message is given if the expected action is not detected
in one minute. Holding the ESCAPE button for five seconds to interrupt the test sequence. The designated function of a
specific pushbutton is bypassed in the test.
UPDATE ORDER CODE — Use this command to read and update the order code, for example when hardware modules have
been changed inside the relay. It causes the relay to scan the backplane for the modules and update the order code to
match. All settings are defaulted with an update. When an update occurs, the following message displays and the relay
restarts.
UPDATING...
PLEASE WAIT
There is no impact if there have been no changes to the hardware modules. When an update does not occur, the ORDER
CODE NOT UPDATED message displays.
REBOOT RELAY — Restarts the relay so that changes to configuration settings can take effect. In most cases, if changes are
made to the configuration settings these changes do not take effect unless the relay is rebooted.
With the CyberSentry option, the Administrator and Operator roles can initiate the Reboot Relay command.
SERVICE COMMAND — Performs specific M60 service actions. Presently, there are two service actions available. Code
"20511" returns all settings to their factory default value and restarts the relay (then you re-enter IP address, restart, set
7 unit to "Programmed"). Code “101” is used to clear factory diagnostic information stored in the non-volatile memory. If a
code other than these two is entered, the command is ignored and no action is taken. Various self-checking diagnostics
are performed in the background while the M60 is running, and diagnostic information is stored on the non-volatile
memory from time to time based on the self-checking result. Although the diagnostic information is cleared before the
M60 is shipped from the factory, the user can want to clear the diagnostic information for themselves under certain
circumstances. For example, you clear diagnostic information after replacement of hardware. Once the diagnostic
information is cleared, all self-checking variables are reset to their initial state and diagnostics restart from scratch.
SAVE VOLATILE DATA — Saves this data to compact flash memory prior to shutdown. This allows the saved data to be as
recent as possible instead of relying on the periodic timer to save the data.
7.1.5 Security
COMMANDS SECURITY
SECURITY ADMINISTRATOR Range: Yes, No
LOGOFF: No
With the CyberSentry option, this setting is available to enable or disable the following commands.
ADMINISTRATOR LOGOFF — Selecting ‘Yes’ allows the Supervisor to forcefully logoff an administrator session.
ENGINEER LOGOFF — Selecting ‘Yes’ allows the Supervisor to forcefully logoff an engineer session.
OPERATOR LOGOFF — Selecting ‘Yes’ allows the Supervisor to forcefully logoff an operator session.
CLEAR SECURITY DATA — Selecting ‘Yes’ allows the Supervisor to forcefully clear all the security logs and clears all the
operands associated with the self-tests.
TARGETS
PHASE TOC4 Displayed only if targets for this element are active.
OP: A B - Example shown.
DIGITAL ELEMENT 48: Displayed only if targets for this element are active.
LATCHED Example shown.
A target enables the EnerVista UR Setup software to monitor automatically and display the status of any active target
messages of all the devices inserted into that site.
Each M60 element with a TARGET setting has a target message that when activated by its element is displayed in
sequence with any other currently active target messages in the TARGETS menu. In the example shown, the Phase TOC4
and Digital Element 48 target settings are active and so have their targets displayed. The down arrow below the two
elements indicates that there can be other active elements beyond these two.
For more information, see the description of target messages in the next section, and the Introduction to Elements section
in the Settings chapter for instructions on TARGET setting. 7
When no targets are active, the display reads NO ACTIVE TARGETS.
If a self test error is detected, a message appears indicating the cause of the error. For example UNIT NOT PROGRAMMED
indicates that the minimal relay settings have not been programmed.
7.2.2.1 Description
The relay performs a number of self-test diagnostic checks to ensure device integrity. The two types of self-tests (major
and minor) are listed in the following tables. When either type of error occurs, the Trouble LED Indicator turns on and a
target message displays. All errors record an event in the event recorder. Latched errors can be cleared by pressing the
RESET key, providing the condition is no longer present.
Major self-test errors also result in the following:
• The critical fail relay on the power supply module de-energizes
• All other output relays de-energize and are prevented from further operation
• The front panel In Service LED indicator turns off
• A RELAY OUT OF SERVICE event is recorded
To view error messages in EnerVista software:
1. Access Actual Values > Records > Event Records.
Messages display on the front panel with one or two lines of text. An example is as follows. In the tables that follow,
messages are grouped using the first line of text. For example, MAINTENANCE ALERT, then a row for 4L Discrepancy, then a
row for Bad IRIG-B Signal.
MAINTENANCE ALERT:
4L Discrepancy
MAINTENANCE ALERT:
Bad IRIG-B Signal
The consequence of an
incorrect SFP can range from
damage to the M60 to no
power information for the
M60 on its web page (enter IP
address in a web browser,
then click the SFP
Transceiver Information —
only the type of SFP displays
and not power data).
Chapter 8: Commissioning
Commissioning
8.1 Testing
8.1.1 Testing underfrequency and overfrequency elements
Underfrequency and overfrequency protection requires techniques with subtle testing implications. Whereas most
protection is designed to detect changes from normal to fault conditions that occur virtually instantaneously, power
system inertia requires frequency protection to pick up while the frequency is changing slowly. Frequency measurement
is inherently sensitive to noise, making high precision in combination with high speed challenging for both relays and test
equipment.
Injection to a particular M60 frequency element must be to its configured source and to the channels that the source uses
for frequency measurement. For frequency measurement, a source uses the first quantity configured in the following
order:
1. Phase voltages
2. Auxiliary voltage
3. Phase currents
4. Ground current
For example, if auxiliary voltage and phase currents are configured, the source uses the auxiliary voltage, not the phase
voltages or any of the currents.
When phase voltages or phase currents are used, the source applies a filter that rejects the zero-sequence component. As
such, the same signal must not be injected to all three phases, or the injected signal is completely filtered out. For an
underfrequency element using phase quantities, the phase A signal must be above the MIN VOLT/AMP setting value.
Therefore, either inject into phase A only, or inject a balanced three-phase signal.
Source frequency
Tracking frequency
Pickup
frequency
Time
Underfrequency element detection time
The static accuracy of the frequency threshold is determined by slowly adjusting the frequency of the injected signal
about the set pickup. If the M60 frequency metering feature is used to determine the injected frequency, verify the
metering accuracy by checking it against a known standard (for example, the power system).
To accurately measure the time delay of a frequency element, a test emulating realistic power system dynamics is
required. Let the injected frequency ramp smoothly through the set threshold, with the ramp starting frequency
sufficiently outside the threshold so that the relay becomes conditioned to the trend before operation. For typical
interconnected power systems, the recommended testing ramp rate is 0.20 Hz/s.
The required delay time is the interval from the point the frequency crosses the set threshold to the point that the element
operates. Some test sets can measure only the time from the ramp start to element operation, necessitating the
subtraction of the pre-threshold ramp time from the reading. For example, with a ramp rate of 0.20 Hz/s, start the ramp
0.20 Hz before the threshold and subtract 1 second from the test set time reading of ramp start to relay operation.
Note that the M60 event records only show the “pickup delay” component, a definite time timer. This is exclusive of the
time taken by the frequency responding component to pickup.
M60 oscillography can be used to measure the time between the calculated source frequency crossing the threshold and
8 element operation; however, this method omits the delay in the calculated source frequency. The security features of the
source frequency measurement algorithm result in the calculated frequency being delayed by two to four cycles (or
longer with noise on the input). In addition, oscillography resolution is 0.004 Hz, which at 0.20 Hz/s corresponds to a delay
of 20 ms. Do not use the tracking frequency in timing measurements, as its algorithm involves phase locking, which
purposely sets its frequency high or low to allow the M60 sample clock to catch-up or wait as necessary to reach
synchronism with the power system.
Theory of operation
TTER
RN
TTE
LT PA
OPERATE
A
LT P
L FAU
FAU
BLOCK
RNA
NAL
INTE
E R
EXT
TERN
EXTERNAL FAULT PAT
restraining
836728A1.CDR
The CT saturation condition is declared by the saturation detector when the magnitude of the restraining signal becomes
larger than the higher breakpoint (HIGH BPNT) and at the same time the differential current is below the first slope (LOW
SLOPE). The said condition is of a transient nature and requires a seal-in. A special logic in the form of a “state machine” is
used for this purpose as depicted in the following figure on saturation detector state machine.
As the phasor estimator introduces a delay into the measurement process, the aforementioned saturation test fails to
detect CT saturation occurring very fast. In order to cope with very fast CT saturation, another condition is checked that
uses relations between the signals at the waveform level. The basic principle is similar to that described. Additionally, the
sample-based stage of the saturation detector uses the time derivative of the restraining signal (di/dt) to better trace the
saturation pattern shown in the following figure.
The saturation detector is capable of detecting saturation occurring in approximately 3 ms from fault inception. The
saturation detector, although having no dedicated settings, uses the main differential characteristic for proper operation.
This must be kept in mind when setting the characteristic as its parameters must retain their original meaning.
The operation of the saturation detector is available as the FlexLogic operand STATOR DIFF SAT A/B/C.
Figure 9-2: Saturation detector state machine
NORMAL
SAT := 0
The differential
current below the saturation
first slope for a condition
certain period of
time
EXTERNAL
FAULT
SAT := 1
The differential-
The differential restraining trajectory
characteristic out of the differential
entered characteristic for a
certain period of time
EXTERNAL
FAULT and CT
SATURATION
SAT := 1
836729A1.CDR
Maintenance
This chapter outlines monitoring, maintenance, repair, storage, and disposal of the hardware and software.
10.1 Monitoring
Devices and data can be monitored.
The first row in the figure shows that Contact Output 1 operation is being monitored. Its Modbus address is CAFA. The
actual value read from the device is 0, which means that it is off.
The second row in the figure shows the Contact Output 1 Name. It has a Modbus address of CAF0 and a default value of
"Cont Op 1." None of Selection column settings render this value because they present the information based on
numbering systems.
Figure 10-2: Modbus Analyzer used to monitor actual values on a UR
Address (HEX) — Modbus address in hexadecimal. See the Modbus memory map in the UR Family Communications Guide
or in the web interface (enter IP address of UR device in a web browser). Convert the decimal address in the Modbus
memory map to hexadecimal.
Modbus Type
Actual Value — To read the data in the UR device
Setting — To read a setting in the UR device
Coil — To read a command in the UR device
# of — Element, input, or output to read. An example is 1 for Contact Output 1.
Selection (examples demonstrate various ways to represent 0)
Hex — A decimal numbering system based on 16 possible values, from 0 to 9 and A to F. An example is 0x0000.
Char — A single unicode character, such as C. An example is 0.
Int — A 32-bit number, either positive or negative. An example is 0.
UInt — Unsigned 32-bit integer, which means that it cannot be negative but can be twice as large as a signed integer. An
example is 0.
Long — A 64-bit number, either positive or negative. An example is 0.
ULong — Unsigned 64-bit number, which means that it cannot be negative but can be twice as large as a signed 64-bit
number. An example is 0.
Float — A numbering system with no fixed number of digits before or after the decimal point. An example is 0.000000.
Binary — A numbering system using 0 and 1. An example is 0000-0000-0000-0000.
10
To avoid deterioration of electrolytic capacitors, power up units that are stored in a de-energized
state once per year, for one hour continuously.
5. Click the Read File button. The file is saved to the destination folder. The EnerVista window remains open to download
additional files.
Do not unplug the USB drive while copying is in progress, else the USB drive can be compromised.
4. When done, to exit unplug the USB drive or press the ESCAPE pushbutton.
Change Method — Format code F229 for the settings control change method.
0 = None
1 = Keypad
2 = Front port
3 = COM1 (not used)
4 = COM2 (RS485)
5 = Ethernet
3. Convert the settings by right-clicking one of the files in the Offline Window and selecting the Convert Device Settings
option.
If the option does not display, click the Admin > User Management menu item and enable the Update Info check box
for the user. Save.
Or if the option does not display, click the Admin > User Management menu item and enable the Enable Security
check box. Save. Select the Admin > User Login menu item. Enter "Administrator" for the user and enter the password.
(Contact GE Grid Solutions if you do not know the default password.)
GE recommends converting settings in firmware steps, for example when converting from 6.0 to 7.4x, convert first to
7.0 then 7.4 in order to follow embedded conversion rules and keep settings.
The settings convert and a report generates.
Figure 10-5: Upgrade settings
4. Review the conversion report. The values of all settings that have been defaulted during conversion are not listed in
the conversion report; to find the value of a setting before conversion, inspect the device backup file made before
conversion.
In the example shown here, settings have been reset to factory defaults and several settings are new in firmware
version 7.6 under Settings > System Setup > Switches and Breakers.
10
5. Change settings in the new file, for example by looking at the original file.
6. Write the converted file to the device, for example by dragging and dropping from the Offline Window to the Online
Window.
7. Check settings and operation.
2. For groups of settings, enable the Export Selected Settings option, then enable the check boxes of the options to
export. The example shows that FlexLogic equations are to be exported.
3. Click the OK button, and specify a file name in the window that opens. The format is XML. Click the button to start the
export, which takes a minute or two.
If prompted about a file being repaired, review the report. The path to the file displays, and otherwise it sits with the
URS, CID, and ICD files of the device with a file name of _Repair_Report.txt, such as B30 81x_Repair_Report.txt. The
example shows that some settings were added at default values. The explanation is that the EnerVista software was
updated, but the offline file predates the update.
Figure 10-8: Settings report
There are two ways to compare devices: devices in the Offline area or between Online and Offline devices.
To compare settings of two devices in the Offline Window area:
1. Right-click a first device in the Offline Window area and select Compare Two Devices.
2. In the window that opens, select a second device and click the Receive button. The file generates and the number of
differences displays.
3. To save the report, click File > Save As, select the TXT, PDF, or CSV format from the drop-down list, and enter a name
for the file.
To create a new settings file in the URS format in EnerVista Offline Window:
1. In EnerVista, right-click in the Offline Window area and select New Device. A window opens.
2. Change the file name at the end of the Path field, keeping the .urs extension.
3. From the Associate File with Device drop-down list, select the UR device. Other fields complete automatically.
Otherwise, when you do not select a device from the drop-down list, all fields need to be completed manually and
only devices that match the entered order code and version display in the list.
4. The Serial # Lock field is the serial number of the intended device. It ensures that the settings file is sent only to the
specific relay that matches the serial number.
5. Click the OK button to create the .urs file in the Offline Window area.
2. Right-click the device name in the Online Window area and select Read IID File. The option is not present when the
device does not have the IEC 61850 option. A window opens when successful.
3. Select or enter a file name and location, and click the Receive button. A .iid file is created.
3. Two prompts are possible, first that the URS file does not include the complete IEC 61850 configuration and that it
10 needs to be recreated if you continue. This means that the URS file is from UR version 7.30 or higher, has the IEC 61850
software option in the order code, but any IEC 61850 content will be compromised and will need to be configured.
Second, a message can display that the URS file is part of a device folder and to use the device’s CID file. This means
that the URS file is from UR version 7.3 or higher, has the IEC 61850 software option in the order code, and is part of the
device folder. The user is trying to add a URS file from inside a device’s folder. Instead, the user needs to use the CID file
from the device folder.
These messages display because the roles of the protection engineer and network engineer can be separate. The
former can require a URS file, while the latter can require stored Modbus settings and protection schemes.
4. Manually copy the remaining settings, outlined as follows.
4. Navigate to and select the file with .cid extension. When prompted, enter a file name to give to an intermediate URS
file. The URS file is added to the Offline Window area.
5. Drag the imported file in the Offline Window to the device in the Online Window. Note that the RELAY SETTINGS value
also is written to a device, and the accepting relay is put into "Programmed" or "Not Programmed" mode as
configured in the offline file.
6. Manually copy the remaining settings, outlined as follows.
The silent installation is not truly silent because it invokes the user interface. The installation is silent at step 5. Double-
clicking on the .exe file for installation is faster.
To install the software silently:
1. Uninstall any existing EnerVista UR Setup software.
2. In a command line window, run the executable file, such as entering URPC810.exe -r
3. Follow the prompts to install the software using the wizard. The action creates a setup.iss file in the C:\WINNT,
C:\Windows\Setup, or other folder that records user inputs.
4. Copy the .exe and .iss files to the same folder.
5. In a command line window, enter URPC810.exe /s, where URPC810.exe is the executable file name. The software
installs and generates a setup.log file in the same folder. A result code of "0" at the end the log file means that the
installation succeeded.
When updating the boot file, ensure that power is not lost, else the relay must be returned to the
factory for repair.
To update the firmware, select the firmware update by locating the .SFD file, and proceed with the update.
When asked if upgrading over the Internet, the difference is the flash memory buffer size each time the software
sends data to the relay. Yes means that the flash memory buffer size is 256 bytes. No means that it is 1024 bytes,
which is faster.
If a warning message displays about the firmware not being supported by the EnerVista software, it means that the
firmware is a later version than the software. Upgrade the software to the same or later version as the firmware, then
try again.
If an "Unable to put relay in flash mode" message displays, set the Settings > Product Setup > Security > Dual
Permission Security Access > Remote Setting Authorized and Local Setting Authorized settings to "ON" and try
again.
When the update is finished, the relay restarts automatically. The upgrade process takes about 20 minutes when
using a graphical front panel because of writing to the front panel.
6. Restart the EnerVista software, and refresh the order code in EnerVista under the Device Setup button.
7. Verify the boot and firmware version while the device is starting up or in EnerVista under Actual Values > Product Info
> Firmware Revisions. The Revision is the firmware version, for example, revision 8.20 is UR firmware release 8.20.
The Boot Program Revision is the bootloader release.
10
8. Set the device to "programmed" under Settings > Product Setup > Installation. A self-test error displays on the device
until this is done.
9. If you changed the Remote Setting Authorized, the Local Setting Authorized settings, or relay lock settings, return
them to their previous settings.
10. To apply any previously saved settings, right-click the saved settings file in the Offline Window area and select Write
to Device. Optionally convert the saved settings to the new firmware version before writing to the device by right-
clicking and selecting Convert Device Settings.
The field-programmable gate array (FPGA) can be upgraded under Maintenance > Update FPGA when the device
is connected via serial cable and the firmware revision is 7.0 or higher.
Modbus addresses assigned to firmware modules, features, settings, and corresponding data items (that is, default
values, minimum/maximum values, data type, and item size) can change slightly from version to version of
firmware. The addresses are rearranged when new features are added or existing features are enhanced or
modified. The EEPROM DATA ERROR message displayed after upgrading/downgrading the firmware is a resettable,
self-test message intended to inform users that the Modbus addresses have changed with the upgraded firmware.
This message does not signal any problems when appearing after firmware upgrades.
Withdraw or insert a module only when control power has been removed from the unit, and be
sure to insert only the correct module type into a slot, else personal injury, damage to the unit
or connected equipment, or undesired operation can result.
To avoid damage to the equipment, use proper electrostatic discharge protection (for example, a
static strap) when coming in contact with modules while the relay is energized.
The relay, being modular in design, allows for the withdrawal and insertion of modules. Replace modules only with like
modules in their original factory configured slots.
Two procedures follow: replace a module with the same module, and upgrade a module.
To replace a module with the same module:
1. Open the enhanced front panel to the left once the thumb screw has been removed. This allows for easy access of the
modules for withdrawal. The new wide-angle hinge assembly in the enhanced front panel opens completely and
allows easy access to all modules in the M60.
10
Figure 10-15: Modules inside relay with front cover open (enhanced front panel)
The basic front panel can be opened to the left once the black plastic sliding latch on the right side has been pushed
up, as shown below.
Figure 10-16: Removing module (basic front panel)
2. With power to the unit off, disconnect individually the connections at the front and back of the module before
removing the module from the chassis.
For any Process Bus Module in slot H for use with a HardFiber Brick, also remove the two screws at the back that
attach the module to the chassis.
3. To properly remove a module, pull simultaneously the ejector/inserter clips, located at the top and bottom of the
module. Record the original location of the module to ensure that the same or replacement module is inserted into the
correct slot. While modules with current input provide automatic shorting of external CT circuits, for CT/VT modules it
is recommended to short/isolate external circuits accordingly for maximum safety.
4. To properly insert a module, ensure that the correct module type is inserted into the correct slot position. The ejector/
inserter clips located at the top and at the bottom of each module must be in the disengaged position as the module
is smoothly inserted into the slot. Once the clips have cleared the raised edge of the chassis, engage the clips
simultaneously. When the clips have locked into position, the module is fully inserted.
When adding a module (versus replacing a module), check that settings have not changed. Depending on the
module, settings can reset to default values.
10
The new CT/VT modules can only be used with new CPUs; similarly, old CT/VT modules can only be used with old
CPUs. In the event that there is a mismatch between the CPU and CT/VT module, the relay does not function and a
DSP ERROR or HARDWARE MISMATCH error displays.
An upgrade example is replacing the CPU module with a more recent one, such as swapping 9G/9H/9N with 9T/9U/9V/9W.
A power supply module upgrade does not affect an order code.
To upgrade a module:
1. Back up settings by sending the device to the Offline Window area. Convert the settings to the new order code by
right-clicking in the Offline Window area. Replace the module as outlined in the previous procedure. In the Online
Window area, reset all settings to factory defaults and read the new order code from the device using Commands >
Relay Maintenance > Update Order Code. Send the saved settings from the Offline Window area to the online device.
Refresh the order code in the Device Setup window and set the device to "Programmed" under Settings > Product
Setup > Installation.
10.12 Battery
A battery powers the real time clock on startup of the device.
When required, the battery can be replaced. The battery type is 3 V cylindrical.
The power supply module contains the battery. The power supply modules were upgraded in 2014 to SH/SL from RH/RL,
but the order code when purchasing a UR with redundant power supply remained as RH/RL so that customers can
continue to use the same order codes. The order code can read RH or RL, while the module inside the unit reads SH or SL.
The order code for replacement redundant power supply modules was changed to SH/SL.
To avoid injury, ensure that the unit has been powered off for a minimum of three minutes
before replacing the battery.
Risk of fire if battery is replaced with incorrect type or polarity.
1. Turn off the power to the unit.
2. Wait a minimum of three minutes to ensure that there is no power to the battery.
3. As outlined in the previous section, open the unit by sliding up the plastic latch on the right side of the front panel
(basic front panel) or unscrewing the panel (enhanced front panel).
4. For the basic front panel, it needs to be removed in order to access the power supply module, which is typically in the
first slot on the left side and blocked by the hinge of the front panel. To remove the front panel, unscrew the bracket on
the left side of the unit.
5. Remove the power supply module by simultaneously pulling the ejector clips at the top and bottom of the module and
sliding it out.
6. Unscrew all four screws (not three) that attach the metal cover to the module. The fourth screw is at the back end of
the module, on the opposite side from the clips, beside the white electronics part (see figure).
7. Slide the metal cover away from the clips about 0.5 cm (1/8 inch) and remove the cover.
8. Unclip the black plastic holder that keeps the battery in place. The plastic clips into the socket at the bottom on both
sides—pull the plastic away from the battery. Use a flat-head screwdriver if you cannot unclip the plastic with your
fingers.
9. Replace the battery with the identical make and model. For example, do not use a rechargeable battery. Observe the
+ and - polarity of the battery and replace it with the same polarity as marked on the battery holder.
10
10. Reinstall the battery holder and the metal cover, and reinsert the power supply module into the unit.
11. Power on the unit.
12. Dispose of the old battery as outlined in the next section.
10
10
10
10.14 Repairs
The battery and modules inside the case can be replaced without return of the device to the factory. The firmware and
software can be upgraded without return of the device to the factory.
Fuses in the power supply module are not field-replaceable.
Files can be requested for use by technical support staff, for example the Service Report (click the icon in the software or
connect a USB drive to the graphical front panel) or under Maintenance > Retrieve File, as outlined elsewhere in this
document.
For issues not solved by troubleshooting, the process to return the device to the factory for repair is as follows:
• Contact a GE Grid Solutions Technical Support Center. Contact information is found in the first chapter.
• Obtain a Return Materials Authorization (RMA) number from the Technical Support Center.
• Verify that the RMA and Commercial Invoice received have the correct information.
• Tightly pack the unit in a box with bubble wrap, foam material, or styrofoam inserts or packaging peanuts to cushion
the item(s). You may also use double boxing whereby you place the box in a larger box that contains at least 5 cm of
cushioning material.
• Ship the unit by courier or freight forwarder, along with the Commercial Invoice and RMA, to the factory.
GE GRID SOLUTIONS
650 MARKLAND STREET
MARKHAM, ONTARIO
CANADA L6C 0M1
ATTN: SERVICE DEPT.
RMA# : ______________
Customers are responsible for shipping costs to the factory, regardless of whether the unit is under warranty.
• Fax a copy of the shipping information to the GE Grid Solutions service department in Canada at +1 905 927 5098.
Use the detailed return procedure outlined at
https://www.gegridsolutions.com/multilin/support/ret_proc.htm
The current warranty and return information are outlined at
https://www.gegridsolutions.com/multilin/warranty.htm
10.15 Storage
Store the unit indoors in a cool, dry place. If possible, store in the original packaging. Follow the storage temperature range
outlined in the Specifications.
10
To avoid deterioration of electrolytic capacitors, power up units that are stored in a de-energized
state once per year, for one hour continuously.
10.16 Disposal
Other than the battery, there are no special requirements for disposal of the unit at the end its service life. For customers
located in the European Union, dispose of the battery as outlined earlier. To prevent non-intended use of the unit, remove
the modules as outlined earlier, dismantle the unit, and recycle the metal when possible. See the UR Family Recycling and
Disposal Instructions (GET-20096).
10
10
Appendices
FlexAnalog operands
A
00041A58 SRC 2 Vbc Mag Volts Source 2 phase BC voltage magnitude
00041A5A SRC 2 Vbc Angle Degrees Source 2 phase BC voltage angle
00041A5B SRC 2 Vca Mag Volts Source 2 phase CA voltage magnitude
00041A5D SRC 2 Vca Angle Degrees Source 2 phase CA voltage angle
00041A5E SRC 2 Vx RMS Volts Source 2 auxiliary voltage RMS
00041A60 SRC 2 Vx Mag Volts Source 2 auxiliary voltage magnitude
00041A62 SRC 2 Vx Angle Degrees Source 2 auxiliary voltage angle
00041A63 SRC 2 V_0 Mag Volts Source 2 zero-sequence voltage magnitude
00041A65 SRC 2 V_0 Angle Degrees Source 2 zero-sequence voltage angle
00041A66 SRC 2 V_1 Mag Volts Source 2 positive-sequence voltage magnitude
00041A68 SRC 2 V_1 Angle Degrees Source 2 positive-sequence voltage angle
00041A69 SRC 2 V_2 Mag Volts Source 2 negative-sequence voltage magnitude
00041A6B SRC 2 V_2 Angle Degrees Source 2 negative-sequence voltage angle
00041A80 SRC 3 Vag RMS Volts Source 3 phase AG voltage RMS
00041A82 SRC 3 Vbg RMS Volts Source 3 phase BG voltage RMS
00041A84 SRC 3 Vcg RMS Volts Source 3 phase CG voltage RMS
00041A86 SRC 3 Vag Mag Volts Source 3 phase AG voltage magnitude
00041A88 SRC 3 Vag Angle Degrees Source 3 phase AG voltage angle
00041A89 SRC 3 Vbg Mag Volts Source 3 phase BG voltage magnitude
00041A8B SRC 3 Vbg Angle Degrees Source 3 phase BG voltage angle
00041A8C SRC 3 Vcg Mag Volts Source 3 phase CG voltage magnitude
00041A8E SRC 3 Vcg Angle Degrees Source 3 phase CG voltage angle
00041A8F SRC 3 Vab RMS Volts Source 3 phase AB voltage RMS
00041A91 SRC 3 Vbc RMS Volts Source 3 phase BC voltage RMS
00041A93 SRC 3 Vca RMS Volts Source 3 phase CA voltage RMS
00041A95 SRC 3 Vab Mag Volts Source 3 phase AB voltage magnitude
00041A97 SRC 3 Vab Angle Degrees Source 3 phase AB voltage angle
00041A98 SRC 3 Vbc Mag Volts Source 3 phase BC voltage magnitude
00041A9A SRC 3 Vbc Angle Degrees Source 3 phase BC voltage angle
00041A9B SRC 3 Vca Mag Volts Source 3 phase CA voltage magnitude
00041A9D SRC 3 Vca Angle Degrees Source 3 phase CA voltage angle
00041A9E SRC 3 Vx RMS Volts Source 3 auxiliary voltage RMS
00041AA0 SRC 3 Vx Mag Volts Source 3 auxiliary voltage magnitude
00041AA2 SRC 3 Vx Angle Degrees Source 3 auxiliary voltage angle
00041AA3 SRC 3 V_0 Mag Volts Source 3 zero-sequence voltage magnitude
00041AA5 SRC 3 V_0 Angle Degrees Source 3 zero-sequence voltage angle
00041AA6 SRC 3 V_1 Mag Volts Source 3 positive-sequence voltage magnitude
00041AA8 SRC 3 V_1 Angle Degrees Source 3 positive-sequence voltage angle
00041AA9 SRC 3 V_2 Mag Volts Source 3 negative-sequence voltage magnitude
00041AAB SRC 3 V_2 Angle Degrees Source 3 negative-sequence voltage angle
00041AC0 SRC 4 Vag RMS Volts Source 4 phase AG voltage RMS
00041AC2 SRC 4 Vbg RMS Volts Source 4 phase BG voltage RMS
00041AC4 SRC 4 Vcg RMS Volts Source 4 phase CG voltage RMS
00041AC6 SRC 4 Vag Mag Volts Source 4 phase AG voltage magnitude
00041AC8 SRC 4 Vag Angle Degrees Source 4 phase AG voltage angle
00041AC9 SRC 4 Vbg Mag Volts Source 4 phase BG voltage magnitude
00041ACB SRC 4 Vbg Angle Degrees Source 4 phase BG voltage angle
A
00041C36 SRC 2 Sc VA Source 2 phase C apparent power
00041C38 SRC 2 PF --- Source 2 three-phase power factor
00041C39 SRC 2 Phase A PF --- Source 2 phase A power factor
00041C3A SRC 2 Phase B PF --- Source 2 phase B power factor
00041C3B SRC 2 Phase C PF --- Source 2 phase C power factor
00041C40 SRC 3 P Watts Source 3 three-phase real power
00041C42 SRC 3 Pa Watts Source 3 phase A real power
00041C44 SRC 3 Pb Watts Source 3 phase B real power
00041C46 SRC 3 Pc Watts Source 3 phase C real power
00041C48 SRC 3 Q Vars Source 3 three-phase reactive power
00041C4A SRC 3 Qa Vars Source 3 phase A reactive power
00041C4C SRC 3 Qb Vars Source 3 phase B reactive power
00041C4E SRC 3 Qc Vars Source 3 phase C reactive power
00041C50 SRC 3 S VA Source 3 three-phase apparent power
00041C52 SRC 3 Sa VA Source 3 phase A apparent power
00041C54 SRC 3 Sb VA Source 3 phase B apparent power
00041C56 SRC 3 Sc VA Source 3 phase C apparent power
00041C58 SRC 3 PF --- Source 3 three-phase power factor
00041C59 SRC 3 Phase A PF --- Source 3 phase A power factor
00041C5A SRC 3 Phase B PF --- Source 3 phase B power factor
00041C5B SRC 3 Phase C PF --- Source 3 phase C power factor
00041C60 SRC 4 P Watts Source 4 three-phase real power
00041C62 SRC 4 Pa Watts Source 4 phase A real power
00041C64 SRC 4 Pb Watts Source 4 phase B real power
00041C66 SRC 4 Pc Watts Source 4 phase C real power
00041C68 SRC 4 Q Vars Source 4 three-phase reactive power
00041C6A SRC 4 Qa Vars Source 4 phase A reactive power
00041C6C SRC 4 Qb Vars Source 4 phase B reactive power
00041C6E SRC 4 Qc Vars Source 4 phase C reactive power
00041C70 SRC 4 S VA Source 4 three-phase apparent power
00041C72 SRC 4 Sa VA Source 4 phase A apparent power
00041C74 SRC 4 Sb VA Source 4 phase B apparent power
00041C76 SRC 4 Sc VA Source 4 phase C apparent power
00041C78 SRC 4 PF --- Source 4 three-phase power factor
00041C79 SRC 4 Phase A PF --- Source 4 phase A power factor
00041C7A SRC 4 Phase B PF --- Source 4 phase B power factor
00041C7B SRC 4 Phase C PF --- Source 4 phase C power factor
00041D00 SRC 1 Pos Watthour kWh Source 1 positive Watthour
00041D02 SRC 1 Neg Watthour Wh Source 1 negative Watthour
00041D04 SRC 1 Pos varh varh Source 1 positive varhour
00041D06 SRC 1 Neg varh varh Source 1 negative varhour
00041D10 SRC 2 Pos Watthour kWh Source 2 positive Watthour
00041D12 SRC 2 Neg Watthour Wh Source 2 negative Watthour
00041D14 SRC 2 Pos varh varh Source 2 positive varhour
00041D16 SRC 2 Neg varh varh Source 2 negative varhour
00041D20 SRC 3 Pos Watthour kWh Source 3 positive Watthour
00041D22 SRC 3 Neg Watthour kWh Source 3 negative Watthour
A
000434FC RTD Ip 13 --- RTD input 13 actual value
000434FD RTD Ip 14 --- RTD input 14 actual value
000434FE RTD Ip 15 --- RTD input 15 actual value
000434FF RTD Ip 16 --- RTD input 16 actual value
00043500 RTD Ip 17 --- RTD input 17 actual value
00043501 RTD Ip 18 --- RTD input 18 actual value
00043502 RTD Ip 19 --- RTD input 19 actual value
00043503 RTD Ip 20 --- RTD input 20 actual value
00043504 RTD Ip 21 --- RTD input 21 actual value
00043505 RTD Ip 22 --- RTD input 22 actual value
00043506 RTD Ip 23 --- RTD input 23 actual value
00043507 RTD Ip 24 --- RTD input 24 actual value
00043508 RTD Ip 25 --- RTD input 25 actual value
00043509 RTD Ip 26 --- RTD input 26 actual value
0004350A RTD Ip 27 --- RTD input 27 actual value
0004350B RTD Ip 28 --- RTD input 28 actual value
0004350C RTD Ip 29 --- RTD input 29 actual value
0004350D RTD Ip 30 --- RTD input 30 actual value
0004350E RTD Ip 31 --- RTD input 31 actual value
0004350F RTD Ip 32 --- RTD input 32 actual value
00043510 RTD Ip 33 --- RTD input 33 actual value
00043511 RTD Ip 34 --- RTD input 34 actual value
00043512 RTD Ip 35 --- RTD input 35 actual value
00043513 RTD Ip 36 --- RTD input 36 actual value
00043514 RTD Ip 37 --- RTD input 37 actual value
00043515 RTD Ip 38 --- RTD input 38 actual value
00043516 RTD Ip 39 --- RTD input 39 actual value
00043517 RTD Ip 40 --- RTD input 40 actual value
00043518 RTD Ip 41 --- RTD input 41 actual value
00043519 RTD Ip 42 --- RTD input 42 actual value
0004351A RTD Ip 43 --- RTD input 43 actual value
0004351B RTD Ip 44 --- RTD input 44 actual value
0004351C RTD Ip 45 --- RTD input 45 actual value
0004351D RTD Ip 46 --- RTD input 46 actual value
0004351E RTD Ip 47 --- RTD input 47 actual value
0004351F RTD Ip 48 --- RTD input 48 actual value
00043520 Ohm Inputs 1 Value Ohms Ohm inputs 1 value
00043521 Ohm Inputs 2 Value Ohms Ohm inputs 2 value
0004376D PTP–IRIG-B Delta ns PTP time minus IRIG-B time
000437C0 Motor Start Time 1 seconds Acceleration 1 Starting Time
000437C1 Motor Start Ieff 1 A Acceleration 1 Effective Current
000437C3 Motor Start Ipeak 1 A Acceleration 1 Peak Current
000437CD Motor Start Time 2 seconds Acceleration 2 Starting Time
000437CE Motor Start Ieff 2 A Acceleration 2 Effective Current
000437D0 Motor Start Ipeak 2 A Acceleration 2 Peak Current
000437DC Motor Start Time 3 seconds Acceleration 3 Starting Time
000437DD Motor Start Ieff 3 A Acceleration 3 Effective Current
A
00044FBC SRC 2 I_1 Mag Amps Source 2 positive-sequence current magnitude
00044FBE SRC 2 I_1 Angle Degrees Source 2 positive-sequence current angle
00044FBF SRC 2 I_2 Mag Amps Source 2 negative-sequence current magnitude
00044FC1 SRC 2 I_2 Angle Degrees Source 2 negative-sequence current angle
00044FC2 SRC 2 Igd Mag Amps Source 2 differential ground current magnitude
00044FC4 SRC 2 Igd Angle Degrees Source 2 differential ground current angle
00044FE0 SRC 3 Ia RMS Amps Source 3 phase A current RMS
00044FE2 SRC 3 Ib RMS Amps Source 3 phase B current RMS
00044FE4 SRC 3 Ic RMS Amps Source 3 phase C current RMS
00044FE6 SRC 3 In RMS Amps Source 3 neutral current RMS
00044FE8 SRC 3 Ia Mag Amps Source 3 phase A current magnitude
00044FEA SRC 3 Ia Angle Degrees Source 3 phase A current angle
00044FEB SRC 3 Ib Mag Amps Source 3 phase B current magnitude
00044FED SRC 3 Ib Angle Degrees Source 3 phase B current angle
00044FEE SRC 3 Ic Mag Amps Source 3 phase C current magnitude
00044FF0 SRC 3 Ic Angle Degrees Source 3 phase C current angle
00044FF1 SRC 3 In Mag Amps Source 3 neutral current magnitude
00044FF3 SRC 3 In Angle Degrees Source 3 neutral current angle
00044FF4 SRC 3 Ig RMS Amps Source 3 ground current RMS
00044FF6 SRC 3 Ig Mag Amps Source 3 ground current magnitude
00044FF8 SRC 3 Ig Angle Degrees Source 3 ground current angle
00044FF9 SRC 3 I_0 Mag Amps Source 3 zero-sequence current magnitude
00044FFB SRC 3 I_0 Angle Degrees Source 3 zero-sequence current angle
00044FFC SRC 3 I_1 Mag Amps Source 3 positive-sequence current magnitude
00044FFE SRC 3 I_1 Angle Degrees Source 3 positive-sequence current angle
00044FFF SRC 3 I_2 Mag Amps Source 3 negative-sequence current magnitude
00045001 SRC 3 I_2 Angle Degrees Source 3 negative-sequence current angle
00045002 SRC 3 Igd Mag Amps Source 3 differential ground current magnitude
00045004 SRC 3 Igd Angle Degrees Source 3 differential ground current angle
00045020 SRC 4 Ia RMS Amps Source 4 phase A current RMS
00045022 SRC 4 Ib RMS Amps Source 4 phase B current RMS
00045024 SRC 4 Ic RMS Amps Source 4 phase C current RMS
00045026 SRC 4 In RMS Amps Source 4 neutral current RMS
00045028 SRC 4 Ia Mag Amps Source 4 phase A current magnitude
0004502A SRC 4 Ia Angle Degrees Source 4 phase A current angle
0004502B SRC 4 Ib Mag Amps Source 4 phase B current magnitude
0004502D SRC 4 Ib Angle Degrees Source 4 phase B current angle
0004502E SRC 4 Ic Mag Amps Source 4 phase C current magnitude
00045030 SRC 4 Ic Angle Degrees Source 4 phase C current angle
00045031 SRC 4 In Mag Amps Source 4 neutral current magnitude
00045033 SRC 4 In Angle Degrees Source 4 neutral current angle
00045034 SRC 4 Ig RMS Amps Source 4 ground current RMS
00045036 SRC 4 Ig Mag Amps Source 4 ground current magnitude
00045038 SRC 4 Ig Angle Degrees Source 4 ground current angle
00045039 SRC 4 I_0 Mag Amps Source 4 zero-sequence current magnitude
0004503B SRC 4 I_0 Angle Degrees Source 4 zero-sequence current angle
0004503C SRC 4 I_1 Mag Amps Source 4 positive-sequence current magnitude
A
0004A022 Load At Brb Calc × FLA Motor load at broken rotor bar calculation
0004A023 Load Dev At Brb Calc × FLA Motor load deviation at broken rotor bar calculation
0004A026 Max Brb Comp. Level dB Maximum broken rotor bar detection component level
0004A027 Max Brb Comp. Freq. Hz Maximum broken rotor bar detection component frequency
0004A028 Load At Brb Max × FLA Motor load at maximum broken rotor bar calculation
0004A029 Load Dev At Brb Max × FLA Motor load deviation at maximum broken rotor bar calculation
0004A02A Time St. At Brb Max --- Time stamp at maximum broken rotor bar
0004A0B2 V0 3rd Harmonic 1 Volts VTFF 1 V0 3rd Harmonic
0004A0B4 V0 3rd Harmonic 2 Volts VTFF 2 V0 3rd Harmonic
0004A0B6 V0 3rd Harmonic 3 Volts VTFF 3 V0 3rd Harmonic
0004A0B8 V0 3rd Harmonic 4 Volts VTFF 4 V0 3rd Harmonic
0004A212 Amp Unbalance --- Current unbalance actual value
0004B210 RxGOOSE Analog 1 --- RxGOOSE analog input 1
0004B212 RxGOOSE Analog 2 --- RxGOOSE analog input 2
0004B214 RxGOOSE Analog 3 --- RxGOOSE analog input 3
0004B216 RxGOOSE Analog 4 --- RxGOOSE analog input 4
0004B218 RxGOOSE Analog 5 --- RxGOOSE analog input 5
0004B21A RxGOOSE Analog 6 --- RxGOOSE analog input 6
0004B21C RxGOOSE Analog 7 --- RxGOOSE analog input 7
0004B21E RxGOOSE Analog 8 --- RxGOOSE analog input 8
0004B220 RxGOOSE Analog 9 --- RxGOOSE analog input 9
0004B222 RxGOOSE Analog 10 --- RxGOOSE analog input 10
0004B224 RxGOOSE Analog 11 --- RxGOOSE analog input 11
0004B226 RxGOOSE Analog 12 --- RxGOOSE analog input 12
0004B228 RxGOOSE Analog 13 --- RxGOOSE analog input 13
0004B22A RxGOOSE Analog 14 --- RxGOOSE analog input 14
0004B22C RxGOOSE Analog 15 --- RxGOOSE analog input 15
0004B22E RxGOOSE Analog 16 --- RxGOOSE analog input 16
0004B230 RxGOOSE Analog 17 --- RxGOOSE analog input 17
0004B232 RxGOOSE Analog 18 --- RxGOOSE analog input 18
0004B234 RxGOOSE Analog 19 --- RxGOOSE analog input 19
0004B236 RxGOOSE Analog 20 --- RxGOOSE analog input 20
0004B238 RxGOOSE Analog 21 --- RxGOOSE analog input 21
0004B23A RxGOOSE Analog 22 --- RxGOOSE analog input 22
0004B23C RxGOOSE Analog 23 --- RxGOOSE analog input 23
0004B23E RxGOOSE Analog 24 --- RxGOOSE analog input 24
0004B240 RxGOOSE Analog 25 --- RxGOOSE analog input 25
0004B242 RxGOOSE Analog 26 --- RxGOOSE analog input 26
0004B244 RxGOOSE Analog 27 --- RxGOOSE analog input 27
0004B246 RxGOOSE Analog 28 --- RxGOOSE analog input 28
0004B248 RxGOOSE Analog 29 --- RxGOOSE analog input 29
0004B24A RxGOOSE Analog 30 --- RxGOOSE analog input 30
0004B24C RxGOOSE Analog 31 --- RxGOOSE analog input 31
0004B24E RxGOOSE Analog 32 --- RxGOOSE analog input 32
0004D000 Brk 1 Acc Arc Amp A kA2-cyc Breaker 1 Acc arcing amp phase A
0004D002 Brk 1 Acc Arc Amp B kA2-cyc Breaker 1 Acc arcing amp phase B
0004D004 Brk 1 Acc Arc Amp C kA2-cyc Breaker 1 Acc arcing amp phase C
This appendix outlines how to set up a RADIUS server for user authentication.
# ##########################################################
# GE VSAs
############################################################
VENDOR GE 2910
# Management authorization
BEGIN-VENDOR GE
B # Role ID
ATTRIBUTE GE-UR-Role 1 integer
# GE-UR-ROLE values
VALUE GE-UR-Role Administrator 1
VALUE GE-UR-Role Supervisor 2
VALUE GE-UR-Role Engineer 3
VALUE GE-UR-Role Operator 4
VALUE GE-UR-Role Observer 5
END-VENDOR GE
#############################################################
6. In the dictionary file in the <Path_to_Radius>\etc\raddb folder, add the following line.
$INCLUDE dictionary.ge
For example, the file can look like the following:
$INCLUDE ../share/freeradius/dictionary
$INCLUDE dictionary.ge
7. For the first start, run the RADIUS server in debug mode to ensure that there are no compiling errors.
<Path_to_Radius>/start_radiusd_debug.bat
8. Set up the RADIUS parameters on the UR as follows.
8.1. If logging in, select Device for the Authentication Type, and use Administrator for the User Name. The default
password is "ChangeMe1#".
8.2. Access Settings > Product Setup > Security. Configure the IP address (10.14.61.122 in this example) and ports
(default values in this example) for the RADIUS server. Leave the GE vendor ID field at the default of 2910.
Update the RADIUS shared secret (Testing!123 in this example) as specified in the clients.conf file. Restart the
relay for the IP address and port changes to take effect.
9. Verify operation. Log in to the UR software as follows. In the login window, select Server as the Authentication Type,
enter the user name entered (for example user name Tester and password "TesterPw1#"). Check that the RADIUS
server log file shows the access with an "Access-Accept" entry.
SetupCLI -h
Display help.
It displays the content outline here.
SetupCLI <Application> login -d <device> [-A <authentication type>] [-a <account>] -w <password> [-s]
Authenticate with device <device> using password <password>.
For non-CyberSentry devices — Set <authentication type> to "traditional". Note that <authentication type> defaults to
"traditional" if not specified. Set <account> to "COMMANDS" or "SETTINGS". If not specified, the SETTINGS account is
used.
Example: SetupCLI URPC login -d "C30 Melbourne" -A traditional -a SETTINGS -w 1password1
Example of a batch file that checks for an error (this batch file uses standard batch file operations to check the return
code (ERRORLEVEL) and jump to an error handler):
SetupCLI URPC start
SetupCLI URPC login -d demoDevice -a SETTINGS -w WrongPassword -A traditional
IF NOT ERRORLEVEL 0 GOTO FAILED
SetupCLI URPC putsettings -d demoDevice -f "example file.urs"
SetupCLI URPC inservice -d demoDevice
SetupCLI URPC reboot -d demoDevice
SetupCLI URPC exit
exit
:FAILED
echo Please try again C
exit
For CyberSentry devices with local authentication — Set <authentication type> to "local". Set <account> to
"Supervisor", "Administrator", "Engineer", "Operator", or "Observer".
For CyberSentry devices with RADIUS authentication — Set <authentication type> to "radius". Set <account> to the
user's account on the RADIUS server.
The device is named as DEV@SETUP_CLI, which is used as the device name required by the <device> parameter of other
SetupCLI commands.
The device name DEV@SETUP_CLI is always assigned to the device that is connected most recently by performing
'adddevice' command. It means that the Application only keeps up to one device named as DEV@SETUP_CLI, the
'adddevice' command disconnects/deletes the device DEV@SETUP _CLI that was connected previously by performing
'adddevice' command.
The device name DEV@SETUP_CLI is never used to configure/connect to a device through the graphical user interface.
Example of a batch file using a device IP address to retrieve its settings file:
SetupCLI URPC start
SetupCLI URPC adddevice -I 192.168.140.113 -S 113 -P 502
SetupCLI URPC getsettings -d DEV@SETUP_CLI -f C:\example.urs
SetupCLI URPC exit
After connecting the device using IP address, the device name DEV@SETUP_CLI is used to identify this device in
'getsettings' command.
Example of a batch file using a device IP address to retrieve a settings file when RADIUS authentication is required: C
SetupCLI URPC start
SetupCLI URPC adddevice -I 192.168.140.113 -S 113 -P 502
SetupCLI URPC login -d DEV@SETUP_CLI -a %1 -w %2 -A radius
SetupCLI URPC getsettings -d DEV@SETUP_CLI -f "example file.urs"
SetupCLI URPC logout -d DEV@SETUP_CLI
SetupCLI URPC exit
DEV@SETUP_CLI has to be used as the device name in the commands followed by the 'adddevice' command.
Appendix D: Miscellaneous
Miscellaneous
This chapter provides the warranty, revision history, and open source information.
D.1 Warranty
For products shipped as of 1 October 2013, GE Grid Solutions warrants most of its GE manufactured products for 10 years.
For warranty details including any limitations and disclaimers, see the Terms and Conditions at
http://www.gegridsolutions.com/multilin/warranty.htm
For products shipped before 1 October 2013, the standard 24-month warranty applies.
D 1601-0108-R2
1601-0108-R3
5.4x
5.4x
31 August 2007
17 October 2007
URX-246
URX-251
1601-0108-S1 5.5x 7 December 2007 URX-253
1601-0108-S2 5.5x 22 February 2008 URX-258
1601-0108-S3 5.5x 12 March 2008 URX-260
1601-0108-T1 5.6x 27 June 2008 08-0390
1601-0108-U1 5.7x 29 May 2009 09-0938
1601-0108-U2 5.7x 30 September 2009 09-1165
1601-0108-V1 5.8x 29 May 2010 09-1457
1601-0108-V2 5.8x 04 January 2011 11-2237
1601-0108-W1 5.9x 12 January 2011 11-2227
1601-0108-X1 6.0x 21 December 2011 11-2840
1601-0108-X2 6.0x 5 April 2012 12-3254
1601-0108-Y1 7.0x 30 September 2012 12-3529
1601-0108-Y2 7.0x 11 November 2012 12-3601
1601-0108-Z1 7.1x 30 March 2013 13-0126
1601-0108-AA1 7.2x 1 August 2013 13-0401
1601-0108-AB1 7.3x 7 November 2014 14-1408
1601-0108-AB2 7.3x 1 September 2015 15-2215
1601-0108-AC1 7.40x 8 December 2016 16-3319
1601-0108-AE1 7.41x 31 January 2017 17-3427
1601-0108-AE3 7.4x 28 April 2017 17-3561
1601-0108-AF1 7.6x 30 June 2017 17-3779
1601-0108-AF2 7.6x 31 October 2017 17-3935
1601-0108-AG1 7.7x 31 March 2018 18-4430
1601-0108-AG2 7.7x 4 May 2018 18-4517
1601-0108-AH1 7.8x 17 December 2018 18-4703
1601-0108-AI1 7.9x 24 October 2019 19-5181
1601-0108-AJ1 8.0x 30 October 2019 19-5182
1601-0108-AJ2 8.0x 15 June 2020 20-5580
1601-0108-AK1 8.1x 20 November 2020 20-6096
1601-0108-AL1 8.2x 16 February 2021 21-6228
Table D-3: Major changes for the M60 AL1 release (English)
Page Description
--- General revision
5-54 Updated SFTP Protocol setting to be enabled by default
D
Abbreviations
CONN Connection
Abbreviations
A Ampere
AC Alternating Current CONT Continuous, Contact
A/D Analog to Digital CO-ORD Coordination
AE Accidental Energization, Application Entity CPU Central Processing Unit
AMP Ampere CRC Cyclic Redundancy Code/Check
ANG Angle CRL Certificate Revocation List
ANSI American National Standards Institute CRT, CRNT Current
APDU Application Protocol Data Unit CSA Canadian Standards Association
AR Automatic Reclosure CT Current Transformer
ARP Address Resolution Protocol CVT Capacitive Voltage Transformer
ASDU Application-layer Service Data Unit
ASYM Asymmetry D/A Digital to Analog
AUTO Automatic DA Data Attribute
AUX Auxiliary DANH Doubly Attached Node with HSR
AVG Average DANP Doubly Attached Node with DANP
AWG American Wire Gauge DC (dc) Direct Current
DCE Data Communications Equipment
BCD Binary-Coded Decimal DCS Distributed Control System
BCS Best Clock Selector DD Disturbance Detector
BER Bit Error Rate DFLT Default
BF Breaker Fail DGNST Diagnostics
BFI Breaker Failure Initiate DIFF Differential
BKR Breaker DIR Directional
BLK Block DISCREP Discrepancy
BLKG Blocking DIST Distance
BNC Bayonet Neill-Concelman DMD Demand
BPNT Breakpoint of a characteristic DNP Distributed Network Protocol
BRKR Breaker DPO Dropout
DPS Double-Point Status
CA Certificate Authority DSP Digital Signal Processor
CAP Capacitor DST Daylight Savings Time
CC Coupling Capacitor dt Rate of Change
CCVT Coupling Capacitor Voltage Transformer DTT Direct Transfer Trip
CFG Configure / Configurable DUTT Direct Under-reaching Transfer Trip
.CFG Filename extension for oscillography files
CHK Check EGD Ethernet Global Data
CHNL Channel ENCRMNT Encroachment
CID Configured IED Description EPRI Electric Power Research Institute
CLS Close .EVT Filename extension for event recorder files
CLSD Closed EXT Extension, External
CMND Command
CMPRSN Comparison F Field
CO Contact Output FAIL Failure
COM Communication FCDA Functional Constraint Data Attributes
COMM Communications FD Fault Detector
COMP Compensated, Comparison FDH Fault Detector high-set
ConfRev Configuration Revision FDL Fault Detector low-set
FIR Finite Impulse Response
G Generator M Machine
GCM Galois Counter Mode M2M Machine to Machine
GDOI Group Domain of Interpretation mA MilliAmpere
GE General Electric MAG Magnitude
GFP Graphical Front Panel MAN Manual / Manually
GIS Gas Insulated Switchgear MAX Maximum
GND Ground Mb Megabit
GNTR Generator MIC Model Implementation Conformance
GoCB GOOSE Control Block MIN Minimum, Minutes
GOOSE General Object Oriented Substation Event MMI Man Machine Interface
GPS Global Positioning System MMS Manufacturing Message Specification
GSU Generator Step-Up MRT Minimum Response Time
MSG Message
HARM Harmonic / Harmonics MTA Maximum Torque Angle
HCT High Current Time MTR Motor
HGF High-Impedance Ground Fault (CT) MU Merging Unit
HIZ High-Impedance and Arcing Ground MVA MegaVolt-Ampere (total 3-phase)
HMI Human-Machine Interface MVA_A MegaVolt-Ampere (phase A)
HSR High-availability Seamless Redundancy MVA_B MegaVolt-Ampere (phase B)
HTTP Hyper Text Transfer Protocol MVA_C MegaVolt-Ampere (phase C)
HV High Voltage MVAR MegaVar (total 3-phase)
HYB Hybrid MVAR_A MegaVar (phase A)
Hz Hertz MVAR_B MegaVar (phase B)
MVAR_C MegaVar (phase C)
I Instantaneous MVARH MegaVar-Hour
I_0 Zero Sequence current MW MegaWatt (total 3-phase)
I_1 Positive Sequence current MW_A MegaWatt (phase A)
I_2 Negative Sequence current MW_B MegaWatt (phase B)
IA Phase A current MW_C MegaWatt (phase C)
IAB Phase A minus B current MWH MegaWatt-Hour
IB Phase B current
IBC Phase B minus C current N Neutral
IC Phase C current N/A, n/a Not Applicable
ICA Phase C minus A current NCIT Non-conventional instrument transformer
ICD IED Capability Description NEG Negative
ID Identification NMPLT Nameplate
IED Intelligent Electronic Device NOM Nominal
IEC International Electrotechnical Commission NTR Neutral
IEEE Institute of Electrical and Electronic Engineers
IG Ground (not residual) current O Over
Igd Differential Ground current OC, O/C Overcurrent
IGMP Internet Group Management Protocol OCSP Online Certificate Status Protocol
IID Instantiated IED Capability Description OF Overload Factor
IN CT Residual Current (3I0) or Input O/P, Op Output
INC SEQ Incomplete Sequence OP Operate
INIT Initiate OPER Operate
INST Instantaneous OPERATG Operating
INV Inverse O/S Operating System
I/O Input/Output OSI Open Systems Interconnect
IOC Instantaneous Overcurrent OSB Out-of-Step Blocking
IOV Instantaneous Overvoltage OUT Output
IRC Inter-Relay Communication OV Overvoltage
IRIG Inter-Range Instrumentation Group OVERFREQ Overfrequency
ISO International Standards Organization OVLD Overload
IUV Instantaneous Undervoltage
P Phase
K0 Zero Sequence Current Compensation PB Process Bus
kA kiloAmpere PBM Process Bus Module
KDC Key Distribution Center PC Phase Comparison, Personal Computer
kV kiloVolt PCNT Percent
PF Power Factor (total 3-phase)
LCD Liquid Crystal Display PF_A Power Factor (phase A)
LDBN Bias Neutral Level Detector PF_B Power Factor (phase B)
Index
Index
H
HardFiber
Brick Trouble message .................................................................. 7-14
interface module described ........................................................ 3-19
order codes for compatible URs ..................................................2-7
remote resources actual values ............................................... 6-25
remote resources settings .........................................................5-151
self-test errors ................................................................................... 7-12
Heartbeat messages ............................................................ 5-71, 5-75
Help, getting ..............................................................................................1-2
J
Jam, mechanical .............................................................................. 5-261
Japanese limited to 10 character input ................................. 5-27
K M
Keyboard ..................................................................................................4-57 MAC address
Keypad .......................................................................................................4-39 actual values ...................................................................................... 6-35
examples .............................................................................................. 5-45
RxGOOSE .............................................................................................. 5-78
settings for redundancy ............................................................... 5-47
L
TxGOOSE .............................................................................................. 5-73
Labels, front panel ..................................................................4-45, 4-77
Maintenance
Lamp test ................................................................................................... 7-3
actual values ...................................................................................... 6-34
Language setting .................................................................................5-27 alert error message ...........................................................................7-8
Laser module .........................................................................................3-42 battery replacement ....................................................................10-19
Latching outputs cleaning ................................................................................................ 2-39
application examples ..................................................................5-370 commands .............................................................................................7-3
settings ...............................................................................................5-369 module replacement ....................................................................10-17
specifications ......................................................................................2-32 upgrade or downgrade ...............................................................10-15
LC fiber ............................................................................................. 2-7, 3-12 Manufacturing date ........................................................................... 6-35
LC fiber connector ...............................................................................3-13 Maximum 6X, 6X wire size ............................................................. 3-22
LED test Maximum CT/VT wire size .............................................................. 3-18
commands ............................................................................................. 7-3 Maximum starting rate
FlexLogic operand .........................................................................5-216 logic diagram ...................................................................................5-339
settings ...............................................................................................5-128 settings ...............................................................................................5-339
specifications ......................................................................................2-27 Measurements of UR and panel cutout ....................................3-2
LEDs Mechanical jam
clear .....................................................................................................5-372 FlexLogic operands .......................................................................5-211
custom labels .....................................................................................4-45 logic diagram ...................................................................................5-262
explained ..............................................................................................4-40 settings ...............................................................................................5-261
In Service ..............................................................................................3-56
Media storage alarm message ................................................... 7-10
power supply module .....................................................................3-17
Memory low message .........................................................................7-8
settings ...............................................................................................5-130
Memory requirements ..................................................................... 3-58
Trouble ...................................................................................................3-56
view in software for graphical front panel ............................. 6-4
Menu navigation .................................................................................. 4-51
License Message about upgrade over Internet ................................10-16
open source ..........................................................................................D-3 Messages
single user ............................................................................................3-59 clear front panel .............................................................................5-372
Link power budget ..............................................................................2-35 error ...........................................................................................................7-6
errors and warnings in Engineer .............................................. 4-70
Load shedding ....................................................................................5-336
Metering
Local access denied message .........................................4-62, 5-21
conventions ............................................................................ 6-14, 6-15
Local access, explained ..................................................................... 5-9
editor in graphical front panel ................................................... 4-37
Local Setting Authorization .........................................................10-16
frequency specifications .............................................................. 2-29
Lock power specifications ...................................................................... 2-28
firmware ............................................................3-74, 5-11, 5-22, 5-24
voltage specifications .................................................................... 2-28
settings ..........................................................................3-74, 5-22, 5-24
Microsoft Windows requirement ............................................... 3-58
Lockout from software .....................................................................5-14
Mimic diagrams ................................................................................... 4-21
Log in with password ............................................................3-74, 5-10
Missing messages, RxGOOSE fail ............................................... 7-10
Log in, multiple users cannot .......................................................... 2-5
MMS connections remaining ........................................................ 6-12
Log out
Modbus
Administrator manually from front panel .............................5-21
connections remaining ................................................................. 6-12
users forcefully .................................................................................... 7-3
enter values in Modbus Analyzer ............................................. 10-1
Logic diagram Flex State parameters .................................................................5-140
create .....................................................................................................4-63
Modbus Analyzer window ........................................................... 10-1
explained ..............................................................................................4-62
port, close ............................................................................................ 5-52
Logic gates, FlexLogic ........................................................4-84, 5-219 register entry ...................................................................................5-116
Logical node or device ......................................................................5-64 settings ................................................................................................. 5-52
Logs, system ...........................................................................................5-25 user map ............................................................................................5-116
Lost password ......................................................................................... 5-8 Model information, view .................................................................. 6-35
Low on Memory message ................................................................ 7-8 Model number ..........................................................................................3-1
Outputs Passwords
contact outputs ..............................................................................5-368 authentication by device or server ......................................... 5-16
control power specifications .......................................................2-33 bypass authentication .................................................................. 5-23
critical failure relay specifications ............................................2-32 change .................................................................................................. 4-60
Fast form-C relay specifications ...............................................2-32 change after installation .............................................................. 3-74
Form-A relay ...........................................................................2-31, 3-20 change does not take relay out of service .............................5-1
Form-C relay .......................................................................................3-20 command ................................................................................ 4-61, 5-10
Form-C relay specifications .........................................................2-32 default ................................................................................................... 5-14
latching output specifications ....................................................2-32 explained .................................................................................................2-4
latching outputs .............................................................................5-369 FlexLogic operands .......................................................................5-217
virtual outputs .................................................................................5-371 lockout ....................................................................................... 4-62, 5-14
Over Temperature message .........................................................7-11 lost password ........................................................................................5-8
Overcurrent curves requirements .........................................................................................5-8
FlexCurves .......................................................................... 5-277, 5-297 reset to factory defaults ..................................................................5-8
IAC .......................................................................................... 5-275, 5-295 rules ...........................................................................................................5-8
IEC .......................................................................................... 5-274, 5-294 settings ..................................................................................... 4-61, 5-10
types ..................................................................................... 5-272, 5-293 settings templates ..............................................................................4-8
Overfrequency wrong entry ........................................................................................ 4-62
FlexLogic operands .......................................................................5-212 PBM PTP settings ................................................................5-186, 5-188
logic diagram ...................................................................................5-338 Permissive functions .......................................................................5-310
settings ...............................................................................................5-337 Per-unit quantity ....................................................................................5-4
specifications ......................................................................................2-24 Phase angle metering ...................................................................... 6-15
testing ...................................................................................................... 8-1 Phase current metering .................................................................. 6-19
Overvoltage Phase directional overcurrent
auxiliary ..................................................................................2-24, 5-319 FlexLogic operands .......................................................................5-212
negative sequence ........................................................................5-316 logic diagram ...................................................................................5-284
negative-sequence ..........................................................................2-24 phase A polarization .....................................................................5-282
neutral .....................................................................................2-24, 5-315 settings ...............................................................................................5-281
phase ........................................................................ 2-23, 5-212, 5-314 specifications ..................................................................................... 2-21
Phase IOC
FlexLogic operands .......................................................................5-212
P logic diagram ...................................................................................5-281
Panel cutout .............................................................................................. 3-2 settings ...............................................................................................5-280
Parallel Redundancy Protocol specifications ..................................................................................... 2-21
actual values .......................................................................................6-12 Phase overvoltage
explained ..............................................................................................5-48 FlexLogic operands .......................................................................5-212
settings ..................................................................................................5-46 logic diagram ...................................................................................5-315
settings with Process Bus Module .........................................5-183 settings ...............................................................................................5-314
specifications ......................................................................................2-34 specifications ..................................................................................... 2-23
Parity ...........................................................................................................5-43 Phase rotation ....................................................................................5-153
Part numbering ....................................................................................... 2-7 Phase TOC
FlexLogic operands .......................................................................5-212
logic diagram ...................................................................................5-280
settings ...............................................................................................5-277
specifications ..................................................................................... 2-21
Phase undervoltage
FlexLogic operands .......................................................................5-212
logic diagram ...................................................................................5-314
settings ...............................................................................................5-312
specifications ..................................................................................... 2-23
Phasor display graphical front panel .......................... 4-58, 5-33
Ping test times out .............................................................................. 5-47
PMU
status of activation ......................................................................... 6-35
Points List, view DNP ......................................................................... 5-57
Teleprotection TOC
actual values ......................................................................................... 6-7 ground ................................................................................................ 5-298
clearing counters ................................................................................ 7-2 neutral ................................................................................................ 5-285
FlexLogic operands .......................................................................5-214 phase .................................................................................................. 5-277
logic diagram ...................................................................................5-378 specifications ..................................................................................... 2-21
overview .............................................................................................5-376 Toolbar ...................................................................................................... 4-81
settings ................................................................................ 5-149, 5-377 Torque for screws ....................................................... 2-39, 3-12, 3-22
specifications ..................................................................................... 2-31 Traceability
Temp Monitor message .................................................................. 7-11 data ........................................................................................................ 4-14
Temperature overview ............................................................................................... 4-13
FlexLogic monitor operand .......................................................5-218 rules ........................................................................................................ 4-15
operating ............................................................................................. 2-37 view data .............................................................................................. 4-15
Test voltages ......................................................................................... 3-16 Tracking frequency ............................................................................ 6-23
Testing Transducer I/O
force contact inputs .....................................................................5-392 actual values ...................................................................................... 6-25
force contact outputs ................................................... 5-393, 5-395 settings ............................................................................................... 5-378
lamp test ................................................................................................. 7-3 specifications ..................................................................................... 2-30
LEDs ........................................................................................................... 7-3 wiring ..................................................................................................... 3-33
over/underfrequency ....................................................................... 8-1 Transfer files to relay ........................................................................ 10-7
pushbuttons .......................................................................................... 7-3 Transfer files with USB drive ......................................................... 4-18
self-test error messages .................................................................. 7-6 Triangle in Offline Window ............................................................. 4-70
settings ...............................................................................................5-389 Trip bus
TFTP FlexLogic operands ...................................................................... 5-215
port, close ..........................................................................................5-108 logic diagram .................................................................................. 5-327
put cannot be done ......................................................................5-108 settings ............................................................................................... 5-325
settings ...............................................................................................5-108 Trip LEDs ................................................................................................ 5-130
The URS file is part of a device folder ....................................10-13 Trouble indicator ....................................................................................7-6
Thermal capacity used ..................................................................5-235 Trouble LED ............................................................................................. 3-56
Thermal model Troubleshooting
curves ..................................................................................................5-235 access to device ............................................................................... 3-71
FlexAnalogs ........................................................................................ A-10 breaker not working .................................................................... 5-343
FlexLogic operands .......................................................................5-211 connection ........................................................................................... 5-47
logic diagram ...................................................................................5-260 dark graphical front panel ........................................................... 5-33
settings ...............................................................................................5-234 Engineer .................................................................................... 4-71, 4-72
specifications ..................................................................................... 2-20 error messages ....................................................................................7-6
Third Ethernet Fail setting not working ...................................................................... 5-343
error message ...................................................................................... 7-9 SV Stream Config window ......................................................... 5-197
set alarm .............................................................................................. 5-39 unit not programmed error ...................................................... 5-150
Tilda on front panel ............................................................................ 4-18 Turn off alarm ....................................................................................... 4-35
Time Two-speed motor
actual values ............................................................................. 6-9, 6-34 acceleration time .......................................................................... 5-265
FlexLogic timer settings ..............................................................5-225 FlexLogic operands ...................................................................... 5-211
graphical front panel format ...................................................... 5-31 logic diagram .................................................................................. 5-265
operating ............................................................................................. 6-35 thermal model ................................................................................ 5-264
overwritten by external source .................................................... 7-3 undercurrent ................................................................................... 5-266
set ..........................................................5-29, 5-117, 5-189, 6-28, 7-3 undercurrent logic diagram ..................................................... 5-268
synchronize ........................................................... 5-117, 5-189, 6-28 TxGOOSE
Time between starts actual values ...................................................................................... 6-13
FlexAnalogs ........................................................................................ A-10 settings .................................................................................................. 5-70
FlexLogic operands .......................................................................5-215 TxGOOSEa & TxGOOSEb assigned to PBM message ...... 5-74
logic diagram ...................................................................................5-340
settings ...............................................................................................5-340
Time overcurrent
see Phase, Neutral, and Ground TOCs
U
Time Sync settings ............................................................................. 6-28 UDP for TFTP ....................................................................................... 5-108
Timeout, connection ......................................................................... 5-53 UL certification ...................................................................................... 2-39
To Install Settings message ............................................................. 7-7 Unable to connect to relay ................................................ 3-71, 5-47
Unable to put relay in flash mode .......................................... 10-16
VT fuse failure
FlexAnalogs ........................................................................................ A-11
FlexLogic operands .......................................................................5-213
logic diagram ...................................................................................5-362
settings ...............................................................................................5-361
VT inputs .............................................................. 3-17, 3-18, 5-7, 5-152
VT wiring .................................................................................................. 3-18
VTFF ..............................................................................................5-361, A-11
W
Warning messages in Engineer .................................................. 4-72
Warning symbol in Offline Window ......................................... 4-70
Warning, firmware upload not supported .........................10-16
Warranty ....................................................................................................D-1
Watt-hour
actual values ...................................................................................... 6-22
specifications ..................................................................................... 2-28
Waveform
view in actual values window .................................................... 6-33
view in event record ....................................................................... 6-32
Waveform files, view ......................................................................... 4-81
Web access port ...............................................................................5-107
Web server protocol ........................................................................5-107
Windows 10
disconnect USB cable when upgrading ..............................10-14
driver for USB to serial cable ...................................................... 3-67
Windows requirement ..................................................................... 3-58
Wire size
CT/VT ...................................................................................................... 3-18
F485 converter .................................................................................. 3-58
G.703 and fiber interface ............................................................. 3-50
G.703 interface .................................................................................. 3-43
module 7S ........................................................................................... 3-43
modules 6X, 6W ................................................................................ 3-22
modules 7E, 7F, 7G, 7Q, 75 .......................................................... 3-50
modules 7L, 7M, 7N, 7P, 74 ......................................................... 3-49
modules 7T, 7W ................................................................................ 3-47
power supply module .................................................................... 3-17
RS422 and fiber interface ............................................................ 3-49
RS422 interface ................................................................................ 3-47
Wiring diagram .................................................................................... 3-14
Withdraw UR from operation ....................................................10-23
Wrong Transceiver message ....................................................... 7-12
X
XOR gate explained ........................................................................... 4-84
Y
Yellow caution icon in Offline Window ................................... 4-70
Z
Zero-sequence core balance ....................................................... 3-18